Showing fragments matching your search for: <strong>""</strong>

No matching fragments found in this document.



                                     The

                             Technical Bulletins

                                     of

                          Dianetics and Scientology








                                     by

                               L. Ron Hubbard

                    FOUNDER OF DIANETICS AND SCIENTOLOGY





                               AUDITING SERIES


                                   Volume

                                     IX

                                  1965-1975







_____________________________________________________________________


































           I will not always be here on guard.
                 The stars twinkle in the Milky Way
           And the wind sighs for songs
                 Across the empty fields of a planet
           A Galaxy away.


           You won't always be here.
                 But before you go,
           Whisper this to your sons
                 And their sons -
           "The work was free.
                 Keep it so."


                                  L. RON HUBBARD
                                                                       [pic]


                                                              L. Ron Hubbard
                                        Founder of Dianetics and Scientology



                               AUDITING SERIES
                                  1965-1975

                                  CONTENTS


                            AUDITOR ADMIN SERIES


2     Nov. 72 R  1 R   The Auditor Admin Series for Use by All Auditors
(BTB) 3
25    Aug. 71    2     How to Get Results in an HGC (HCO B)   5
3     Nov. 72 R  3 R   The Pc Folder and Its Contents (BTB)   9
4     Nov. 72    4     The Folder (BTB) 13
5     Nov. 72 R  5 R   Case Progress Sheet (BTB)   16
14    Sept. 71 RA            Case Progress Sheet (BPL)   17
5     Nov. 72R   6 R   The Yellow Sheet (BTB)      20
5     Nov. 72R   7 R   The Folder Summary (BTB)    21
5     Nov. 72    8     OCA Graphs (BTB) 26
6     Nov. 72 R  9 R   The Program Sheet (BTB)     27
6     Nov. 72R   10 R  The Auditor's C/S (BTB)     29
6     Nov. 72 RA 11 RA The Exam Report (BTB) 31
8     Mar. 71          Examiner's Form (HCO PL)    34
6     Nov. 72R   12 R  The Summary Report Form (BTB)     35
20    June 70          Summary Report (BTB)  37
6     Nov. 72R   13 R  The Auditor Report Form (BTB)     39
6     Nov. 72R   14 R  The Worksheets (BTB)  41
3     Nov. 71    15    Auditor's Worksheets (HCO B)      44
7     Nov. 72R   16 R  Correction Lists (BTB)      45
      Dec. 74          Word Clearing Lists for Prepared Lists (HCO B)
46
7     Nov.72 R   18 R  L&N Lists (BTB)  49
7     Nov.72R    19 R  Dianetic Assessment Lists (BTB)   51
7     Nov.72 R   20 R  Miscellaneous Reports (BTB) 52
8     Nov.72R    21 R  The Dianetic Flow Table (BTB)     55
8     Nov.72 RA  22 RA Folder Error Summaries (BTB)      56
8     Nov. 72 RA 23 RA Invoice Form and Routing Form (BTB)    58
                            BASIC AUDITING SERIES

3     Jan. 72R         Form (Revised) (BPL)  60

23    May 71R    1 R   The Magic of the Communication Cycle (HCO B) 63

23    May 71R    2 R   The Two Parts of Auditing (HCO B) 65

23    May 71     3     The Three Important Communication Lines (HCO B)
68

23    May 71R    4 R   Communication Cycles Within the Auditing Cycle
                 (HCO B)      69

23    May 71R    5 R   The Communication Cycle in Auditing (HCO B)   73

23    May 71     6     Auditor Failure to Understand (HCO B)   75

23    May 71     7     Premature Acknowledgements (HCO B)      77

5     Feb. 66    8     "Letting the Pc Itsa"-The Properly Trained Auditor
                 (HCO B)      78

23    May 71     9     Comm Cycle Additives (HCO B)       81

23    May 71R    10 R  Recognition of Rightness of the Being (HCO B)
82

23    May 71     11    Metering (HCOB)   84


                               CRAMMING SERIES


22    Apr. 71R   1 R   Cramming (BTB)    87

8     Mar. 75    2 RB  Cramming Actions (BTB)      93

8     Mar. 75    3 R   Types of Cramming-Admin Cramming (BTB) 96

8     Mar. 75    4 RB  High Crime Checkouts and Technical OKs (BTB) 99

8     Mar. 75    5 RB  TRs in Cramming (BTB) 102

8     Mar. 75    6 RA  Cramming Expertise (BTB)    104

8     Mar. 75    7 RA  Cramming Officer Statistic (BTB)  106

12    Dec. 71R   8 R   How to Write Up a Cramming Order (BTB) 107

8     Dec. 71    9     The C/S and Cramming Cycles (BTB) 108

10    June 73RA  10 RA Cramming (HCO B) 109

10    June 73RA  11 RA Cramming Officer Post Requirements (BTB)     110

12    June 73    12    The Tools of Cramming (BTB) 112

12    June 73 RA       13 RA      Cramming Heavy Hussar Handling for a
Badly Bogged
                 Tech Personnel or Staff Member (BTB)    116

15    Oct. 74    14    Cramming Over Out Ruds (HCO B)    119

18    Mar. 75    15    Meter Use in Qual (HCOB)    121

6     Apr. 72 R  16    How to Find a Why on a Person and Handle (BPL)
122
                          EXPANDED DIANETICS SERIES


15    Apr. 72    1 R   Expanded Dianetics Series 1R (HCO B)   127

3     Apr. 72R   2 R   Clearing Lists and R3-R(BTB)      129

2     Apr. 72RB  3 RB  L3 EXD RB-Expanded Dianetics Repair List (HCO B)
131

20    Apr. 72    4     Suppressed Pcs and PTS Tech (HCO B)    136

24    Apr. 72    5     PTS Interviews (HCO B)      137

10    Aug. 72    6     Dianetic HCO B-Interest (HCO B)   138

13    Sept. 72   7     Catastrophes From and Repair of "No Interest"
                 Items (HCO B)    139

30    Aug. 72    8     Expanded Dianetic Case A(BTB)     140

30    Aug. 72    9     Expanded Dianetic Case B (BTB)    146

18    Sept. 72   10    Expanded Dianetic Case C (BTB)    155

19    Oct. 72    11    Expanded Dianetic Case D (BTB)    162

20    Oct. 72    12    Expanded Dianetic Case E (BTB)    174

21    Oct. 72R   13 R  Expanded Dianetic Case F (BTB)    183

22    Oct. 72    14    Expanded Dianetic Case G (BTB)    195

24    Oct. 72    15    Expanded Dianetic Case I(BTB)     201

25    Oct. 72    16    Expanded Dianetic Case J (BTB)    211

29    Oct. 72    17    Expanded Dianetic Case K (BTB)    215

30    Oct. 72    18    Expanded Dianetic Case L (BTB)    230

1     Nov. 72    19    Expanded Dianetic Case M (BTB)    237

15    Feb. 74    20    Service Facsimile Theory and Expanded Dianetics
                 (HCO B)     249

28    Mar. 74    21    Expanded Dianetics-Developments Since the
                 Original Lectures (HCO B)   251

23    Apr. 74R   22 R  Expanded Dianetics Requisites (HCO B)  254

17    July 74    23    XDN Case B (HCO B)    255

27    Mar. 75R   24 R  Ex Dn and PTS RD Notes (BTB)      256
                         INTEGRITY PROCESSING SERIES


4     Dec. 72R    1 R  Definitions (BTB)     261

5     Dec. 72RA   2 RA Procedure (BTB)  264

8     Dec. 72RA   3 RA, 4 R  Integrity Processing and O/Ws Repair List
            & 5 RA     -L1 RA (BTB)     266

9     Dec. 74     6 RA Effectiveness of Overts in Processing
                 (HCO B)     268

10    Dec. 72     7    Fundamentals (BTB)    270

11    Dec. 72RA   8 RA The Tech and Ethics of Integrity Processing
                 (BTB) 274

12    Dec. 72    9     Rudiments (BTB)  277

13    Dec. 72R   10 R  Integrity Processing Questions Must
                 Be F/Ned (HCO B) 278

14    Dec. 72R   11 R  Generalities Won't Do (HCO B)     279

15    Dec. 72R   12 R  Withholds, Missed and Partial (HCO B)  281

16    Dec. 72    13    Help the Pc (HCO B)   283

17    Dec. 72    14    Havingness (HCO B)    284

18    Dec. 72R   15 R  Aspects of Integrity Processing (BTB)  285

6     June 68RA  16 RA IntegrityProcessingInfo(BTB)      287

23    Dec. 72R   17 R  C/SingIntegrityProcessing(BTB)    289

21    Dec. 72    18    Formulating Integrity Processing Questions
                 (BTB) 291

22    Dec. 72 R  19 R  Ordering Personnel to Integrity Processing
                 (BTB) 293


                         INTEGRITY PROCESSING FORMS


24    Dec. 72R   1     The Basic Integrity List (BTB)    294

24    Dec. 72R   2     General Staff Integrity List (BTB)     297

24    Dec. 72 R  3     Auditor Integrity List (BTB)      300

24    Dec. 72R   4     Supervisor Integrity List (BTB)   303

24    Dec. 72R   5     Student Integrity List (BTB)      305
                                STUDY SERIES


18    Sept. 67         Study-Complexity and Confronting (HCO PL)    309

21    Sept. 70   1     Study Definitions (HCO B)   311

2     June 71    2     Confronting (HCOB)    314

22    July 71    3     Confronting, Addition (BTB) 317

13    May 72     4     Chinese School (HCO PL)     318

30    Mar. 72R   5 R   The Primary Correction Rundown Revised (HCO B)
320

3     Apr. 72    6     Primary Rundown Note (HCO B)      322

4     Apr. 72R         Primary Rundown (Revised) (HCO B) 323

20    July 72          Primary Correction Rundown Handling (HCO B)  326

4     Feb. 72RD  7     Study Correction List Revised (BTB)    329

26    Apr. 72    8     The Glib Student (HCO B)    345

4     Jan. 73    9     Confront (HCO B) 346


                             TAPE COURSE SERIES

20    Nov. 71     1    Course Translation to Tape (HCO B)     349

21    Nov. 71    2     Dianetics and Scientology in Other Languages (HCO B)
351

21    Nov. 71R   3 R   Teaching a Tape Course(HCOB)      354

22    Nov. 71    4     Tape Players-Description and Care (BTB)      357

21    Nov. 74    5     Translated Tapes for Staff and Student Use (BTB)
361

10    Nov. 71R   6 R   Tapes, How to Use (HCO B)   364

25    Nov. 71 R  7     Setting Up and Using a Tape Player (BTB)     368

26    Nov. 71 RA 8     Handling Misunderstood Words on Tape Recorded
                 Materials (BTB)  370

27    Nov. 71 R  9     Method 2 Word Clearing on Tapes and Tape Courses
                 (BTB) 372

17    Aug. 72R   10    Method 4 Notes (HCO B)      375

6     Apr. 72RA  11 R  Basic Tape Rundown(BTB)     377

18    Feb. 72R   12 R  Tape Translations to Tape (BTB)   379

9     Jan. 74R   13    Tape Course Checksheets (BTB)     381

23    Nov. 74    14    Tape Course Series Revisions and Cancellations (BTB)
385
                            WORD CLEARING SERIES


23    June 71     1    The Secret of Fast Courses (BTB)  389

24    June 71     2    Word Clearing (HCO B) 392

25    June 71R    3 R  Barriers to Study (HCO B)   393

26    June 71R    4 R  Supervisor Two-Way Comm and the Misunderstood
                 Word (HCO B)     396

27    June 71R    5 R  Supervisor Two-Way Comm Explained (HCO B)    399

28    June 71R    6 R  Method Two-Metered Word Clearing in the
                 Course Room (BTB)      401

29    June 71R    7 R  Steps to Speed Student Product Flow (BTB)    402

30    June 71R   8 RB  Standard C/S for Word Clearing in Session
                 -Method 1 (HCO B)      404

1     July 71    9     The Three Types of Word Clearing (BTB) 406

1     July 71R   10 R  Speeding Up a Slow Course (BTB)   409

2     July 71RA  11 RA       Word Clearing Successes (BTB)    412

27    July 71RA  12 RA       Important-Allow No Bugs on Word Clearing
                 Procedure (BTB)  415

2     July 71    13    Word Clearing Clarification (HCO B)    417

27    July 71    14    EP of Word Clearing (BTB)   418

26    Feb. 72    15 R  Word Clearing Series 1 5R (HCO B) 420

31    Aug. 71R   16 R  Confused Ideas (HCO B)      421

2     Sept. 71   17    Words and Posts (HCO B)     423

4     Sept. 71R  18 R  Faults in Word Clearing Commonly Met (BTB)   424

4     Sept. 71   19    Alterations (HCO B)   426

4     Sept. 71   20    Simple Words (HCO B)  427

6     Sept. 71   21    Correct Sequence-Qualifications of Word Clearers
                 (HCO B)     429

4     Sept. 71R  22 R  How to Use a Dictionary (BTB)     431

13    Sept. 71   23    Trouble Shooting (HCO B)    433

17    Sept. 71   24    Library (HCO B)  435

10    Nov. 71R   25 R  Tapes, How to Use (HCO B)   436

26    Nov. 71RA  26 RA       Handling Misunderstood Words on Tape Recorded
                 Materials (BTB)  440

27    Nov. 71R   27 R  Method 2 Word Clearing on Tapes and Tape Courses
                 (BTB) 442

10    Oct. 71R   28 R  Tech Points on a Word Clearing Festival (BTB)
445

10    Dec. 71R   29R   Word Clearing-OK to Do (BTB)      446

                        WORD CLEARING SERIES (cont.)


2     Jan. 72    30    WCl Comes First (HCO B)     447

7     Feb. 72RA  31 RA Method 3 Word Clearing (BTB)      448




22    Feb. 72 RA 32 RA Word Clearing Method 4 (HCO B)    450

14    Mar. 72RA  33 RA Word Clearing Lines (BTB)   452

19    Mar. 72 RA 34 RA High Crime Policy and Word Clearing (BTB)    454

21    July 71RD  35 RD Word Clearing Correction List Revised (BTB)  455

9     June 72    36    Grammar (HCO B)  459

19    June 72    37    Dinky Dictionaries (HCO B)  460

21    June 72    38    Method 5 (HCO B) 461

21    June 72    39    Method 6 (HCO B) 462

21    June 72    40    Method 7 (HCO B) 463

21    June 72    41    Method 8 (HCO B) 464

17    Aug. 72R   42 R  Method 4 Notes (HCO B)      466

18    Aug. 72    43    Grammar Definition (HCO B)  468

6     Nov. 72    44    Illiteracy and Work (HCO B) 470

30    Jan. 73RA  45 RA Word Clearing-The Key Repair Tool for an Org (BTB)
472

30    Jan. 73RA  46 RA Method 9 (BTB)   473

30    Jan. 73R   47R   Difficulties With Word Clearing (BTB)  475

30    Jan. 73          48         Word Clearing on Foreign Language
Students,
                 Pcs or Staff (BTB)     477

30    Jan. 73R   49 R  Build Up Powerful Word Clearers (BTB)  478

16    Dec. 73    51    Word Clearing Errors (BTB)  479

6     Jan. 74    52    Word Clearing Translators (BTB)   480

8     July 74R   53 R  Clear to F/N (HCO B)  482

7     Sept. 74   54    Superliteracy and the Cleared Word (HCO B)   483


                                 ART SERIES


30    Aug. 65    1     Art (HCO B)      489

29    July 73    2     Art, More About (HCO B)     493

10    Apr. 74    3     Stage Manners (HCO B) 498

25    Apr. 74    4     Rhythm (HCO B)   500


                                _____________


7     Apr. 72R         Touch Assists-Correct Ones (BTB)  502


                                _____________


                 Subject Index    507

                 Alphabetical List of Titles 523
                                LONG CONTENTS


Auditor Admin Series 1R
BTB 2 Nov. 1972R THE AUDITOR ADMIN SERIES FOR USE BY ALL
            AUDITORS, 3

      Purpose of Auditor Admin Series, 3
      Definition of auditor administration, 3
      Auditor's responsibility for administration, 3
      Use of the Auditor Admin Series, 4

Auditor Admin Series 2, C/S Series 56
HCO B 25 Aug. 1971 HOW TO GET RESULTS IN AN HGC, 5

      Auditing is a team activity, 5
      To improve tech results you must improve administration, 5
      Auditing requires administration, 5
      C/S and auditor attitude, 5
      Organize to improve results, 6
      Org wins and stats, 7
      How to get on policy with tech organization, 7

Auditor Admin Series 3R
BTB 3 Nov. 1972R THE PC FOLDER AND ITS CONTENTS, 9

      Front cover items, 9
      The folder contents, 10
      The back cover items, 11

Auditor Admin Series 4
BTB 4 Nov. 1972 THE FOLDER, 13

      New folders, 14
      Storage of folders, 14
      Transport of folders, 14
      No admin folder, 15

Auditor Admin Series 5R
BTB 5 Nov. 1972R CASE PROGRESS SHEET, 16

      Use of Case Progress Sheet, 16

BPL 14 Sept. 1971 RA CASE PROGRESS SHEET, 17

Auditor Admin Series 6R
BTB 5 Nov. 1 972R THE YELLOW SHEET, 20

      Use of Yellow Sheet, 20

Auditor Admin Series 7R
BTB 5 Nov. 1972R THE FOLDER SUMMARY, 21

      Admin details, 21
      Process details, 21
      Exam Report, 21
      Attests, 21
      Advanced Course data, 22
      Medical data, 22
      Ethics data, 22
      Folder Summary sample, 23
      Folder Summary form, 24, 25

Auditor Admin Series 8
BTB 5 Nov. 1972 OCA GRAPHS, 26

      When the pc takes the OCA test, 26
      Plotting the OCA tests, 26
      Position of graph in folder, 26
      Responsibility of getting OCA done, 26

Auditor Admin Series 9R
BTB 6 Nov. 1972R THE PROGRAM SHEET, 27

      The three types of programs, 27
      The responsibility of the C/S regarding programs, 27
      Marking of evil purposes and R/Ses, 28

Auditor Admin Series 10R
BTB 6 Nov. 1972R THE AUDITOR'S C/S, 29

      Description of auditor's C/S, 29
      Position in folder, 29
      Ethics situation noted on auditor's C/S form, 30

Auditor Admin Series 11RA
BTB 6 Nov. 1972RA THE EXAM REPORT, 31

      Contents of Exam Report, 31
      Scale of pc indicators, 32
      F/N sizes, 32
      Red tags, 32
      Medical Exam Reports, 33
      Exam Report Form location in folder, 33

HCO PL 8 Mar. 1971 EXAMINER'S FORM, 34

Auditor Admin Series 12R
BTB 6 Nov. 1972R THE SUMMARY REPORT FORM, 35

      Use of Summary Reports, 35
      Filling in the Summary Report Form, 35

BTB 20 June 1970 SUMMARY REPORT, 37

Auditor Admin Series 13R
BTB 6 Nov. 1972R THE AUDITOR REPORT FORM, 39

      What is written on Auditor's Report Form, 39
      Auditor's Report Form, 40

Auditor Admin Series 14R
BTB 6 Nov. 1972R THE WORKSHEETS, 41

      Content of worksheet, 41
      Shorthanding session actions on worksheets, 42
      Legibility of worksheets, 42
      Necessity of worksheets, 43

Auditor Admin Series 15, C/S Series 66
HCO B 3 Nov. 1971 AUDITOR'S WORKSHEETS, 44

      C/S must insist on good legible handwriting of auditors, 44
      C/S misunderstoods from worksheets, 44
      Solutions to illegible auditor handwriting, 44

Auditor Admin Series 16R
BTB 7 Nov. 1972R CORRECTION LISTS, 45

      Correction list defined, 45
      Correction list's relation to worksheet admin, 45

HCO B 1 Dec. 1974 WORD CLEARING LISTS FOR PREPARED LISTS, 46

      List of prepared lists with their word clearing lists, 46
Auditor Admin Series 18R
BTB 7 Nov. 1972R L&N LISTS, 49

      Listing and nulling lists defined, 49
      Admin on L&N lists, 49
      Correcting L&N lists, 49
      R3Ring an L&N item, 50

Auditor Admin Series 19R
 BTB 7 Nov. 1972R DIANETIC ASSESSMENT LISTS, 51

      Dianetic assessment list defined, 51
      Position in folder, 51
      R3 R'd items, 51

Auditor Admin Series 20R
 BTB 7 Nov. 1972R MISCELLANEOUS REPORTS, 52

      Miscellaneous report defined, 52
      D of P Interviews, 52
      Declare?, 52
      Mis-declare, 52
      Cramming orders, 52
      Medical Officer Reports, 53
      Ethics Reports, 53

Auditor Admin Series 21R
BTB 8 Nov. 1972R THE DIANETIC FLOW TABLE, 55

      Dianetic Flow Table defined, 55
      Example of Dianetic Flow Table, 55

Auditor Admin Series 22RA
BTB 8 Nov. 1972RA FOLDER ERROR SUMMARIES, 56

      Two methods of FESing, 56
      Flaw in FESes, 56
      New format for FESes, 56
      What is wanted in an FES, 57
      What isn't wanted in an FES, 57

Auditor Admin Series 23RA
BTB 8 Nov. 1972RA INVOICE FORM AND ROUTING FORM, 58

      Pc beginning intensive, 58
      Pc runs out of paid hours, 58
      Free service = free fall, 59
      Invoices for staff services, 59
      Invoice form, 60

Basic Auditing Series 1R
HCO B 23 May 1971R THE MAGIC OF THE COMMUNICATION CYCLE, 63

      Auditor and pc as two pole system to bring about an as-ising of mass,
63
      Difficulties of auditing are difficulties of the communication cycle,
63
      Basic tool of auditing is the communication cycle of auditing, 63
      Basic auditing is called basic auditing because it goes prior to the
technique, 64

Basic Auditing Series 2R
HCO B 23 May 1971R THE TWO PARTS OF AUDITING, 65

      Auditing goes in two stages: form a communication line; do something
           for the pc, 65
      Aberrations are hard to keep, one has to work at it, 65
      Process doesn't work until auditor has a comm line to pc, 66
      Pc justifying himself and trying to uphold status is not in comm with
           auditor, 66
      Theory of overrun, 67
      Auditor must keep in his communication line with pc, 67

Basic Auditing Series 3
HCO B 23 May 1971 THE THREE IMPORTANT COMMUNICATION LINES, 68

      Itsa Maker line is pc's line to his bank, 68
      Itsa line is pc's line to the auditor, 68
      What's-it line is auditor's line to the pc, 68
      Itsa line is a report on what has been as-ised, 68


Basic Auditing Series 4R
HCO B 23 May 1971R COMMUNICATION CYCLES WITHIN THE AUDITING
            CYCLE, 69

      Basically two communication cycles between auditor and pc that make
up auditing cycle, 69  Acknowledgement cycle, 69
      Six communication cycles which make up one auditing cycle, 71
      Communication cycle consists of just cause, distance, effect with
           intention, attention, duplication and understanding, 71
      Handling of pc origination, 71


Basic Auditing Series 5R
HCO B 23 May 1971R THE COMMUNICATION CYCLE IN AUDITING, 73

      Obnosis (observation of the obvious), 73
      Auditor watches pc s comm cycle; auditor's own is perfect, 73
      Auditor must know when pc has finished answering the command, 73
      The magic of acknowledgement, 74


Basic Auditing Series 6
HCO B 23 May 1971 AUDITOR FAILURE TO UNDERSTAND, 75

      Auditor response when he doesn't understand pc, 75
      Invalidation-avoid use of "you" to pc, 75
      Evaluation-auditor repeating what pc says, 75
      Don't tell the pc what the pc said and don't gesture to find what the
    pc meant, 75
      Don't drive in anchor points by shoving things at or gesturing toward
    pc, 76
      Rock slammer, 76


Basic Auditing Series 7
HCO B 23 May 1971 PREMATURE ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS, 77

      Effects of premature acknowledgement, 77
      What premature acknowledgement does to conversation, 77
      Premature acknowledgement leads to inadvertent withholds, 77


Basic Auditing Series 8
HCO B 5 Feb. 1966 "LETTING THE PC ITSA"-THE PROPERLY TRAINED
            AUDITOR, 78

      What Itsa is, 78
      Cure for auditor who is "letting the pc itsa", 79
      Tech savvy, 79
      Cure for auditor who can't control pc, 80


Basic Auditing Series 9
HCO B 23 May 1971 COMM CYCLE ADDITIVES, 81

      There are no additives permitted on the auditing comm cycle, 81
      Mannerism additives, 81


Basic Auditing Series 10R
HCO B 23 May 1971 R RECOGNITION OF RIGHTNESS OF THE BEING, 82

      Idea of the additive data to the thetan, 82
      Auditing is the business of deleting wrongnesses from the individual,
           82
      Auditor must look at rightnesses of pc, not just wrongnesses, 82
      Pc's ability to as-is or erase in a session is directly proportional
           to the number of good indicators present in the session, 83
      Pc's bad indicators vs. good indicators, 83
Basic Auditing Series 11
HCO B 23 May 1971 METERING, 84

      Auditor does not tell the pc anything about the meter or its reads
           ever, except to indicate an F/N, 84
      Steering a pc, 84


Cramming Series 1R
BTB 22 Apr. 1971R CRAMMING, 87

      Purpose of Cramming, 87
      Cramming stable data, 87
      Route to 100% results on the students is persistence in finding the
      actual cause, 87
      Log book, 88
      Program, 88
      Trend of student's daily graph of study stats, 88
      Cramming tech, 88 Basic tool of Cramming, 88
      When simply asking for a missed word draws a blank, 89
      Counter-policy and counter-tech, 89
      Slow students, 89
      Cramming auditors, 90
      Course outnesses which must be corrected, 90
      Cramming Supervisor and C/S, 90
      The student hat, 91
      Coaching to a no win, 91
      Invalidation and correcting the wrong Why, 91
      There is a cause, 91
      Most common misunderstoods lie in the basics, 91
      Cramming Officer check for basics, 92


Cramming Series 2RB
BTB 8 Mar. 1975 CRAMMING ACTIONS, 93

      Areas of expertise a Cramming Officer has to have, 93
      Cramming Officer's procedure for handling auditors, 93
      Show me, 94
      Tell me, 94
      Obnosis, 94
      What happened just before that?, 94
      Ethics, 94
      Supervisor cramming, 95


Cramming Series 3R
BTB 8 Mar. 1975 TYPES OF CRAMMING-ADMIN CRAMMING, 96

      Two areas of cramming: tech and admin, 96
      Two types of cramming, 96
      Admin cramming, 96
      Sources for admin staff correction, 96
      Steps of handling an admin cramming cycle, 97
      Org outpoint corrections, 97
      Areas which can cause trouble, 97


Cramming Series 4RB
BTB 8 Mar. 1975 HIGH CRIME CHECKOUTS AND TECHNICAL OKs, 99

      Actions to be done regarding new issues, 99
      High Crimes New Issues Log Book, 99
      High Crime checkouts, 100
      Mimeo delays, 100
      Ethics inspections of High Crime Log Book, 100
      Technical OKs, 100

Cramming Series 5RB
BTB 8 Mar. 1975 TRs IN CRAMMING, 102

      TR training, 102

Cramming Series 6RA
BTB 8 Mar. 1975 CRAMMING EXPERTISE, 104

      "Good cramming is the key to flubless auditors and auditing"-LRH, 104
      Cramming Officer requirements, 104
      Cramming log book, 104
      Word Clearing in Cramming, 104
      Three main areas investigated in Cramming, 104
      Overlong cramming orders, 105
      No F/N at Exams, 105

Cramming Series 7RA
BTB 8 Mar. 1975 CRAMMING OFFICER STATISTIC, 106

      List of Cramming points, 106

Cramming Series 8R, C/S Series 70R
BTB 12 Dec. 1971 R HOW TO WRITE UP A CRAMMING ORDER, 107

      Isolate and state briefly the exact outnesses; order those HCO Bs or
    PLs crammed, 107
      Cramming Officer is not bound to accept any cramming order, 107

Cramming Series 9, C/S Series 68
BTB 8 Dec. 1971 THE C/S AND CRAMMING CYCLES, 108

      Cramming finds the real Why of an auditor error when an auditor is
sent to
      Cramming, 108
      Cramming Officer to report the real Why to the C/S, 108

Cramming Series 10RA
HCO B 10 June 1973RA CRAMMING, 109

      Qual does not take orders on what to do to correct, 109
      Product of Qual Admin, 109

Cramming Series 11RA
BTB 10 June 1973RA CRAMMING OFFICER POST REQUIREMENTS, 110

      Minimum requirements for Cramming Officer, 110
      Steps to upgrade Cramming quality, 110

Cramming Series 12
BTB 12 June 1973 THE TOOLS OF CRAMMING, 112

      Examples of LRH cramming cycles, 112
      Cramming auditors, 112
      Cramming C/S I/T, 113
      Auditor admin cramming, 113
      Cramming execs and admin personnel, 113

Cramming Series 13RA
BTB 12 June 1973RA CRAMMING HEAVY HUSSAR HANDLING FOR A BADLY
BOGGED TECH PERSONNEL OR STAFF MEMBER, 116

      Cause of badly bogged tech personnel or staff member, 116
      Heavy Hussar Cramming handling steps, 116
      Cramming tools, 117
      Handling staff member never crammed before, 118


Cramming Series 14
HCO B 15 Oct. 1974 CRAMMING OVER OUT RUDS, 119


      Result of cramming over out ruds, 119
      Cramming Officer flubs, 119
      Incomplete handling, 119
      Maxim of Cramming, 120


Cramming Series 15
HCO B 18 Mar. 1975 METER USE IN QUAL, 121


      Cramming actions done in Qual must be done on a meter, 121


Cramming Series 16
BPL 6 Apr. 1972R HOW TO FIND A WHY ON A PERSON AND HANDLE, 122


      Steps to find a Why on a person and handle, 122
      Examples of finding Why on a person and handling, 123
      Metered Why finding, 124


Expanded Dianetics Series 1R
HCO B 15 Apr. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETICS SERIES 1R, 127


      Expanded Dianetics vs. Standard Dianetics, 127
      Expanded Dianetics is very specifically adjusted to the pc, 127
      Expanded Dianetic training, 127
      Hubbard Graduate Dianetic Specialist, 128
      Charges for Expanded Dianetics, 128
      Auditor prerequisites for Expanded Dianetics, 128


Expanded Dianetics Series 2R
BTB 3 Apr. 1972R CLEARING LISTS AND R3-R, 129


      Two causes of inability to run engrams: drugs and uncleared commands,
      129
      List of the words in R3-R procedure and the L3-EXD RB, 129


Expanded Dianetics Series 3RB
HCO B 2 Apr. 1972RB L3 EXD RB-EXPANDED DIANETICS REPAIR LIST, 131

Expanded Dianetics Series 4
HCO B 20 Apr. 1972 SUPPRESSED PCS AND PTS TECH, 136


      Characteristics of PTS persons, 136
      Administrative tech of PTS Rundown, 136


Expanded Dianetics Series 5, C/S Series 79
HCO B 24 Apr. 1972 PTS INTERVIEWS, 137


      PTS Interview questions, 137
      Required actions of PTS Interview, 137


Expanded Dianetics Series 6, C/S Series 82
HCO B 10 Aug. 1972 DIANETIC HCO B-INTEREST, 138


      On drugs, evil purposes or intentions one does not ask the pc if he is
      interested in running the item, 138
      Dianetic "no interest" items, 138


Expanded Dianetics Series 7, C/S Series 85
HCO B 13 Sept. 1972 CATASTROPHES FROM AND REPAIR OF
      "NO INTEREST" ITEMS, 139


      Drug Rundown can fail by asking for interest on items, 139
      Don't ask for interest on intentions, evil purposes and drug items,
      139
      Repair of "no interest" items, 139


Expanded Dianetics Series 8
BTB 30 Aug. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE A, 140

Expanded Dianetics Series 9
BTB 30 Aug. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE B, 146

Expanded Dianetics Series 10
BTB 18 Sept. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE C, 155

Expanded Dianetics Series 11
BTB 19 Oct. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE D, 162
Expanded Dianetics Series 12
BTB 20 Oct. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE E, 174

Expanded Dianetics Series 13R
BTB 21 Oct. 1972R EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE F, 183

Expanded Dianetics Series 14
BTB 22 Oct. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE G, 195

Expanded Dianetics Series 15
BTB 24 Oct. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE I, 201

Expanded Dianetics Series 16
BTB 25 Oct. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE J, 211

Expanded Dianetics Series 17
BTB 29 Oct. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE K, 215

Expanded Dianetics Series 18
BTB 30 Oct. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE L, 230

Expanded Dianetics Series 19
BTB 1 Nov. 1972 EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE M, 237

Expanded Dianetics Series 20
HCO B 15 Feb. 1974 SERVICE FACSIMILE THEORY AND EXPANDED
            DIANETICS, 249

      Service Facs by Dynamics, 249
      Service facsimile theory, 249
      Service facsimile handling, 250

Expanded Dianetics Series 21
HCO B 28 Mar. 1974 EXPANDED DIANETICS DEVELOPMENTS SINCE THE
            ORIGINAL LECTURES, 251

      Expanded Dianetics programming, 251
      Expanded Dianetics set-ups, 251
      Pc trouble on engrams, 251
      Ex Dn Rundowns, 251
      Class VIII C/S-6 list, 251
      Intentions in AEI Treble Assessments, 252
      Evil purposes, 252
      R/S Handling, also called the Responsibility RD, 252
      The Wants Handled Rundown, 252
      The Multiple-Flow E. Purp Rundown, 252
      Ex Dn program is designed for an individual, 253

Expanded Dianetics Series 22R
HCO B 23 Apr. 1974R EXPANDED DIANETICS REQUISITES, 254

      Ex Dn set-up checklist, 254

Expanded Dianetics Series 23
HCO B 17 July 1974 XDN CASE B, 255

      Further data on XDn Series 9, 255
      Drug Rundown is a must before Ex Dn, 255
      Headache and Int-Ext, 255

Expanded Dianetics Series 24R
BTB 27 Mar. 1975R EX DN AND PTS RD NOTES, 256

      PT environment, 256
      Intentions handling, 256
      Quad Ex Dn, 256
      Flow 0 commands on the PTS RD, 257

Integrity Processing Series 1R
BTB 4 Dec. 1972R DEFINITIONS, 261

      Definitions of Integrity Processing, overt, withhold, missed withhold,
      integrity, ethics, 261
      Development of Integrity Processing, 261
      The two uses of Integrity Processing, 262
      Historical precedence-religious confession, 262

Integrity Processing Series 2RA
BTB 5 Dec. 1972RA PROCEDURE, 264

      Basic procedure for Integrity Processing, 264

Integrity Processing Series 3RA, 4R, 5RA
BTB 8 Dec. 1972RA INTEGRITY PROCESSING AND O/Ws REPAIR LIST
            -L1 RA, 266

Integrity Processing Series 6RA
HCO B 9 Dec. 1974 EFFECTIVENESS OF OVERTS IN PROCESSING, 268

      ARC breaks, 268
      Why overts work, 268

Integrity Processing Series 7
BTB 10 Dec. 1972 FUNDAMENTALS, 270

      A case with withholds will not clear, 270
      What is a withhold, 270
      Transgressions against different mores, 270
      Survival mechanisms and withholds, 271
      Data on pulling withhold, 271
      End phenomena of an Integrity question, 272
      Responsibility level and withholds, 272
      Use of Integrity Processing Forms, 273

Integrity Processing Series 8RA
BTB 11 Dec. 1972RA THE TECH AND ETHICS OF INTEGRITY
            PROCESSING, 274

      Integrity Processing question must be taken to F/N, 274
      Integrity Processing buttons, 274
      24 hour rule, 275
      Overt, ARC break, problem, 275
      The E-Meter and the criminal, 275
      HCO and case gain, 275

Integrity Processing Series 9
BTB 12 Dec. 1972 RUDIMENTS, 277

      Integrity Processing must be done in Model Session form with a rud
      flown at start of session if no F/N, 277


Integrity Processing Series 10R
HCO B 13 Dec. 1972R INTEGRITY PROCESSING QUESTIONS MUST BE
            F/Ned, 278

      What happens when Integrity questions are left unflat, 278
      Prevention of Integrity Processing being left unflat, 278

Integrity Processing Series 11R
HCO B 14 Dec. 1972R GENERALITIES WON'T DO, 279

      Best way to "miss" Integrity Processing question is to let the pc
           indulge in generalities or "I thought . . .", 279
      Handling general withholds and other people's withholds, 279
      How to get withholds off an "irresponsible pc", 279
      Withhold pulling, "don't know" version, 279

Integrity Processing Series 12R
HCO B 15 Dec. 1972R WITHHOLDS, MISSED AND PARTIAL, 281

      Natterings, upsets, ARC breaks, critical tirades, lost students,
           ineffective motions are restimulated but missed or partially
           missed withholds, 281
      Knowledge to the average person is only this: a knowledge of his or
           her withholds, 281
      Wild animal reaction that makes man a cousin to the beasts, 281
      Handling critical, upset, ARC breaky pc, 282

Integrity Processing Series 13
HCO B 16 Dec. 1972 HELP THE PC, 283

      Use of steering in withhold pulling, 283
      Pc is always willing to reveal, 283
      It wouldn't read on the E-Meter if pc knew all the answer, 283

Integrity Processing Series 14
HCO B 17 Dec. 1972 HAVINGNESS, 284

      Havingness is the concept of being able to reach; no-havingness is the
           concept of not being able to reach, 284
      Havingness sags in the presence of withholds, 284
      Havingness must be run to get the benefit of having pulled most
           withholds, 284

Integrity Processing Series 15R
BTB 18 Dec. 1972R ASPECTS OF INTEGRITY PROCESSING, 285

      Auditor attitude, 285
      Starting session, 285
      Grooving in the question, 285
      Use of E-Meter, 285

Integrity Processing Series 16RA
BTB 6 June 1968RA INTEGRITY PROCESSING INFO, 287

      List of points to keep in during Integrity Processing, 287

Integrity Processing Series 17R
BTB 23 Dec. 1972R C/Sing INTEGRITY PROCESSING, 289

      Key points C/S looks for on Integrity Processing, 289

Integrity Processing Series 18
BTB 21 Dec. 1972 FORMULATING INTEGRITY PROCESSING
                                        QUESTIONS, 291

      Transgressions against the mores of a group, 291
      Compiling an Integrity Processing Form to suit the situation, 291

Integrity Processing Series 19R
BTB 22 Dec. 1972R ORDERING PERSONNEL TO INTEGRITY
            PROCESSING, 293

Integrity Processing Form 1
BTB 24 Dec. 1972R THE BASIC INTEGRITY LIST, 294

Integrity Processing Form 2
BTB 24 Dec. 1972R GENERAL STAFF INTEGRITY LIST, 297

Integrity Processing Form 3
BTB 24 Dec. 1972R AUDITOR INTEGRITY LIST, 300

Integrity Processing Form 4
BTB 24 Dec. 1972R SUPERVISOR INTEGRITY LIST, 303

Integrity Processing Form 5
BTB 24 Dec. 1972R STUDENT INTEGRITY LIST, 305



HCO PL 18 Sept. 1967 STUDY-COMPLEXITY AND CONFRONTING, 309

      Basic law on complexity, 309
      The basis of aberration is a non-confront, 309
      All subjects have as their basis a point of first assumption, 309
      The subject of navigation, 309
      Any complexity stems from an initial point of non-confront, 310
      The basic thing man can't or won't confront is evil, 310
      No-confront leads to aberration, 310


Study Series 1
HCO B 21 Sept. 1970 STUDY DEFINITIONS, 311


Study Series 2
HCO B 2 June 1971 CONFRONTING, 314


      First requisite of any subject is the ability to confront the various
      components of the subject itself, 314
      Student who learns rapidly has a high ability to confront that
      subject, 314
      "Glib" students, 314
      "Confronting" is actually the ability to be there comfortably and
      perceive, 315
      Definitions of gradient scale, skipped gradient, flattening,
      overrunning, invalidation, 315
      Gradient of confronting study, 315

Study Series 3
BTB 22 July 1971 CONFRONTING, ADDITION, 317

      Confronting an HCO B or HCO PL, 317

Study Series 4, Establishment Officer Series 17, Language Series 4
HCO PL 13 May 1972 CHINESE SCHOOL, 318

      What is a Chinese School, 318
      Chinese School on org board, 319

Study Series 5R
HCO B 30 Mar. 1972R THE PRIMARY CORRECTION RUNDOWN REVISED, 320

      When the Primary Correction Rundown is given, 320
      Primary Correction Rundown checklist, 320

Study Series 6
 HCO B 3 Apr. 1972 PRIMARY RUNDOWN NOTE, 322

      Primary Rundown handling of Study Tapes, 322

HCO B 4 Apr. 1972R PRIMARY RUNDOWN (REVISED), 323

      Primary Rundown consists of Word Clearing and study tech; it makes a
           student super-literate, 323 Keynote of Primary Rundown is
           honesty, 323
      Primary Rundown steps, 3 24
      No Interference zone, 325
      Primary Correction Rundown takes care of people who have trouble on
           the Primary Rundown, 325
      Students who are or have been on drugs need a Drug Rundown before
           tackling Word Clearing Method 1, 325


HCO B 20 July 1972 PRIMARY CORRECTION RUNDOWN HANDLING, 326

      Who PCRDs are given to, 326
      The purpose of the PCRD is to get the person through the PRD, 326
      Folder study, 326
      Out lists, 326
      Idle student, 327
      Resistive students, 327
      Pre-PCRD steps, 327
      End phenomena of a Primary Correction Rundown, 328

Study Series 7
BTB 4 Feb. 1972RD STUDY CORRECTION LIST REVISED, 329

Study Series 8
HCO B 26 Apr. 1972 THE GLIB STUDENT, 345

      Glib student can confront the words and ideas; he cannot confront the
           physical universe or people around him and so cannot apply, 345
      Handling the glib student, 345

Study Series 9
HCO B 4 Jan. 1973 CONFRONT, 346

      Definitions of confront, 346
      If one can confront he can be aware; if he is aware he can perceive
      and act, 346

Tape Course Series 1
HCO B 20 Nov. 1971R COURSE TRANSLATION TO TAPE, 349

      How to translate a course, 349
      Primary targets, 349
      Operating targets, 350

Tape Course Series 2
HCO B 21 Nov. 1971 DIANETICS AND SCIENTOLOGY IN OTHER
            LANGUAGES, 351

      Minimum translated materials an org needs, 351
      Printed material, 351
      Recorded tapes, 352
      Minimum list of translated tapes, 352
      Keeping Dianetics and Scientology on source, 353

Tape Course Series 3R
HCO B 21 Nov. 1971R TEACHING A TAPE COURSE, 354

      Rules and description, 3 54
      Enrollment, 354
      Files, 355
      Checksheet, 355
      Notebooks, 355
      Checkout, 355
      Practical, 355
      Clay table, 355
      Definitions, 355
      Checksheet sequence, 356
      Progress board, 356
      Slow students, 356

Tape Course Series 4
BTB 22 Nov. 1971 TAPE PLAYERS-DESCRIPTION AND CARE, 357

      Tape players and tape recorders, 357
      Tape player diagram, 358
      Helpful pointers on using a tape player, 359

Tape Course Series 5
BTB 21 Nov. 1974 TRANSLATED TAPES FOR STAFF AND STUDENT USE, 361

      Translated administrative and hat materials, 361
      Translated course materials, 361
      Tape notes, 362
      Protection of materials, 362
      Tape file, 362
      Cramming, 362
      Qual library, 363
      Availability of translated admin and hat materials and translated
      course materials, 363

Tape Course Series 6R, Word Clearing Series 25R
HCO B 10 Nov. 1971R TAPES, HOW TO USE, 364

      Types of tapes, 364
      Course study tapes, 365
      Public lecture tapes, 365
      Briefing tapes, 366
      Model performance tapes, 367

Tape Course Series 7
BTB 25 Nov. 1971 R SETTING UP AND USING A TAPE PLAYER, 368

      Setting up the tape player, 368
      Using the tape player, 369

Tape Course Series 8, Word Clearing Series 26RA
BTB 26 Nov. 1971 RA HANDLING MISUNDERSTOOD WORDS ON TAPE
            RECORDED MATERIALS, 370

      Method 3 Word Clearing on tapes, 370

Tape Course Series 9, Word Clearing Series 27R
BTB 27 Nov. 1971R METHOD 2 WORD CLEARING ON TAPES AND TAPE
            COURSES, 372

       The two uses of Method 2 Word Clearing, 372
       Procedure for resolving study difficulty on a tape, with Method 2
           Word Clearing, 372
       Method 2 Word Clearing as a study method on tape materials, 374

Tape Course Series 10, Word Clearing Series 42R
HCO B 17 Aug. 1972R METHOD 4 NOTES, 375

      Break down the materials when doing Word Clearing Method 4, 375
      Word Clearing Method 4 of tapes, 375
      Word Clearing Method 4 of books, 375
      Errors in Word Clearing Method 4, 376

Tape Course Series 11R
BTB 6 Apr. 1972RA BASIC TAPE RUNDOWN, 377

      List of Tape Course Series HCO Bs and BTBs, 377
      Individual Why for non-use of tapes, 378
      Basic Tape Rundown steps, 378

Tape Course Series 12R
BTB 18 Feb. 1972R TAPE TRANSLATIONS TO TAPE, 379

      Method for translating taped lectures, 379

Tape Course Series 13
BTB 9 Jan. 1974R TAPE COURSE CHECKSHEETS, 381

      Procedure for making tape course checksheets, 381
      Tape course checksheet sample, 382

Tape Course Series 14
BTB 23 Nov. 1974 TAPE COURSE SERIES REVISIONS AND
            CANCELLATIONS, 385

Word Clearing Series 1
BTB 23 June 1971 THE SECRET OF FAST COURSES, 389

      Effect of Word Clearing illustrated, 389

Word Clearing Series 2
HCO B 24 June 1971 WORD CLEARING, 392

      Word Clearing Method One, 392
      Word Clearing Method Two, 392
      Word Clearing Method Three, 392

Word Clearing Series 3R
HCO B 25 June 1971R BARRIERS TO STUDY, 393

      Absence of mass, 393
      Too steep a study gradient, 393
      Bypassed definition, 394
      Effects of misunderstood word, 394
      Misunderstood word and doingness, 395


Word Clearing Series 4R
HCO B 26 June 1971R SUPERVISOR TWO-WAY COMM AND THE
            MISUNDERSTOOD WORD, 396

      Supervisor two-way comm vs. auditor two-way comm, 396
      Total dialogue of a Supervisor, 396
      Effects of misunderstood words, 397
      Supervisor actions, 398


Word Clearing Series 5R
HCO B 27 June 1971R SUPERVISOR TWO-WAY COMM EXPLAINED, 399

      What Supervisor two-way comm consists of, 399
      Student's stat down, check for misunderstood word, 399
      Verbal advice or tech is deadly and will turn any Academy sour, 400
      Misunderstood word tech is the sole course tech when course admin is
           in and materials are available, 400


Word Clearing Series 6R
BTB 28 June 1971R METHOD TWO-METERED WORD CLEARING IN THE
            COURSE ROOM, 401

      Word Clearing Method Two procedure, 401


Word Clearing Series 7R
BTB 29 June 1971R STEPS TO SPEED STUDENT PRODUCT FLOW, 402

      Supervising at a below F/N level, 402
      Steps for handling non-F/Ning students, 402


Word Clearing Series 8RB
HCO B 30 June 1971R STANDARD C/S FOR WORD CLEARING IN SESSION
            -METHOD 1, 404

Word Clearing Series 9
BTB 1 July 1971 THE THREE TYPES OF WORD CLEARING, 406

      Verbal in classroom, 406
      By meter in classroom, 407
      By meter in session, 408


Word Clearing Series 10R
BTB 1 July 1971R SPEEDING UP A SLOW COURSE, 409

      Course is slow, Supervisor uses Word Clearing Method 4, 409
      Use of Qual Word Clearer, 410
      Tech and Qual Word Clearer actions illustrated, 411


Word Clearing Series 11RA
BTB 2 July 1971 RA WORD CLEARING SUCCESSES, 412

      Word Clearing success from Flag D of T, 412
      Successes from Supervisor-Word Clearing, 412
      Successes from metered Word Clearing in the course room, 413
      Successes from session Word Clearing, 413
      Successes of Word Clearers, 414

Word Clearing Series 12RA
BTB 27 July 1971 RA IMPORTANT-ALLOW NO BUGS ON WORD CLEARING
            PROCEDURE, 415

      Points to prevent bugs on Word Clearing, 415


Word Clearing Series 13
HCO B 2 July 1971 WORD CLEARING CLARIFICATION, 417

      Word Clearing Method 1 is unlimited, 417
      Word Clearing Method 1 can be done with no folder, 417
      Word Clearing Method 1 EP is a persistent F/N on whole list, 417


Word Clearing Series 14
BTB 27 July 1971 EP OF WORD CLEARING, 418

      Data on end phenomenon of Method 1, 418
      LRH C/Ses from Word Clearing sessions, 418


Word Clearing Series 15R
HCO B 26 Feb. 1972 WORD CLEARING SERIES 15R, 420

      Word Clearing any words on any test at any time is a High Crime, 420
      Foreign language persons use translated tests, 420
      Mis Us on tests, 420


Word Clearing Series 16R
HCO B 31 Aug. 1971R CONFUSED IDEAS, 421

      A misunderstood word exists at the bottom of a confusion, 421
      Example of clearing up a confusion with Word Clearing Method 2, 421
      There is not also misunderstood ideas; there is only the misunderstood
           word which breeds, then, huge towering wrong ideas, 421
      Picture of a student's mind, 422


Word Clearing Series 17
HCO B 2 Sept. 1971 WORDS AND POSTS, 423

      Failed posts and duties trace back to misunderstood words, 423
      Psychosis and misunderstood words are the only reasons for post
      failure, 423


Word Clearing Series 18R
BTB 4 Sept. 1971R FAULTS IN WORD CLEARING COMMONLY MET, 424

Word Clearing Series 19
HCO B 4 Sept. 1971 ALTERATIONS, 426

      At the bottom of all alteration of meaning or action is a
      misunderstood word, 426
      Just before or with the point a person begins to alter will be found a
      misunderstood word, 426


Word Clearing Series 20
HCO B 4 Sept. 1971 SIMPLE WORDS, 427

      It takes a big dictionary to define simple words fully, 427
      Stupidity is the effect of misunderstood words, 427
      The earliest misunderstood word in a subject is a key to later
           misunderstood words in that subject, 427


Word Clearing Series 21
HCO B 6 Sept. 1971 CORRECT SEQUENCE-QUALIFICATIONS OF WORD
            CLEARERS, 429

      Use of Word Clearing Methods 1, 2 and 3, 429
      Post Purpose Clearing, 429
      Word Clearing program, 429
      Word Clearing Word Clearers, 430
Word Clearing Series 22R
BTB 4 Sept. 1971 R HOW TO USE A DICTIONARY, 431

      The alphabet, 431
      How to break up a word, 431
      Look up words in the definition, 431
      Use a big enough dictionary, 432
      Get the word used in sentences as long as it has TA, 432
      Back track words-get the earlier misunderstood word, 432
      Foreign words-get a dictionary of that language, 432

Word Clearing Series 23
HCO B 13 Sept. 1971 TROUBLE SHOOTING, 433

      Word Clearing troubles, 433
      Use of Word Clearing Correction List, 433
      What is learned on a TR Course, 433
      Word Clearer training, 434
      Auditor training is not only for professional auditors, 434

Word Clearing Series 24
 HCO B 17 Sept. 1971 LIBRARY, 435

      Word Clearing library, 435
      Use of the local library, 435

Word Clearing Series 25R, Tape Course Series 6R
HCO B 10 Nov. 1971R TAPES, HOW TO USE, 436

      Types of tapes, 436
      Course study tapes, 437
      Public lecture tapes, 437
      Briefing tapes, 438
      Model performance tapes, 439

Word Clearing Series 26RA, Tape Course Series 8
BTB 26 Nov. 1971 RA HANDLING MISUNDERSTOOD WORDS ON TAPE
            RECORDED MATERIALS, 440

      Method 3 Word Clearing on tapes, 440

Word Clearing Series 27R, Tape Course Series 9
BTB 27 Nov. 1971R METHOD 2 WORD CLEARING ON TAPES AND
            TAPE COURSES, 442

      The two uses of Method 2 Word Clearing, 442
      Procedure for resolving study difficulty on a tape, with Method 2
Word
      Clearing, 442
      Method 2 Word Clearing as a study method on tape materials, 444

Word Clearing Series 28R
 BTB 10 Oct. 1971 R TECH POINTS ON A WORD CLEARING FESTIVAL, 445

      Word Clearing Method 2 is not done on someone incomplete on Method 1,
445
      Word Clearing Festival actions, 445

Word Clearing Series 29R
BTB 10 Dec. 1971R WORD CLEARING-OK TO DO, 446

      Points concerning course Word Clearing, 446

Word Clearing Series 30
HCO B 2 Jan. 1972 WC1 COMES FIRST, 447

      Don't do Word Clearing Method 2 before Method 1, 447
      Word Clearing Method 2 EP, 447

Word Clearing Series 31RA
BTB 7 Feb. 1972RA METHOD 3 WORD CLEARING, 448

      F/Ning student system, 448
      Steps of Method 3 Word Clearing, 448


Word Clearing Series 32RA
HCO B 22 Feb. 1972RA WORD CLEARING METHOD 4, 450

      Use of Word Clearing Method 4, 450
      Word Clearing Method 4 procedure, 450
      Supervisor's use of Word Clearing Method 4, 451


Word Clearing Series 33RA
BTB 14 Mar. 1972RA WORD CLEARING LINES, 452

      Handling of Word Clearing pc, 452
      Qual tools to handle a bogged or failed student, 452


Word Clearing Series 34RA
BTB 19 Mar. 1972RA HIGH CRIME POLICY AND WORD CLEARING, 454

      OK to Word Clear system, 454


Word Clearing Series 35RD
BTB 21 July 1971RD WORD CLEARING CORRECTION LIST REVISED, 455

Word Clearing Series 36
HCO B 9 June 1972 GRAMMAR, 459

      Grammatical words and small words should be looked up in a simple
grammar textbook, 459  Grammar textbooks, 459
      Grammar Course before Word Clearing, 459


Word Clearing Series 37
HCO B 19 June 1972 DINKY DICTIONARIES, 460

      Small dictionaries are very often a greater liability than they are a
 help, 460
      Which are the best dictionaries, 460


Word Clearing Series 38
HCO B 21 June 1972 METHOD 5, 461

      Word Clearing Method 5 is called Material Clearing, 461
      Word Clearing Method 5 procedure, 461


Word Clearing Series 39
HCO B 21 June 1972 METHOD 6, 462

      Word Clearing Method 6 is called Key Word Clearing, 462
      Word Clearing Method 6 procedure, 462
      Post trouble remedied by Word Clearing Method 6, 462


Word Clearing Series 40
HCO B 21 June 1972 METHOD 7, 463

      Word Clearing Method 7 is reading aloud, 463
      Word Clearing Method 7 procedure, 463


Word Clearing Series 41
HCO B 21 June 1972 METHOD 8, 464

      Word Clearing Method 8 is an action used in the Primary Rundown, 464
      Word Clearing Method 8 procedure, 464


Word Clearing Series 42R, Tape Course Series 10
HCO B 17 Aug. 1972R METHOD 4 NOTES, 466

      Break down the materials when doing Word Clearing Method 4, 466
      Word Clearing Method 4 of tapes, 466
      Word Clearing Method 4 of books, 466
      Errors in Word Clearing Method 4, 467


Word Clearing Series 43
HCO B 18 Aug. 1972 GRAMMAR DEFINITION, 468

      Grammar is a systematic description of the ways in which words are
           used in a particular language, 468
      Word classes, 468
      Rules of grammar, 468
      Types of grammar, 469


Word Clearing Series 44
HCO B 6 Nov. 1972 ILLITERACY AND WORK, 470

      Educating illiterate or semi-literate populations, 470
      Example of educating a primitive culture, 470
      Education must not skip gradients in culture or in training, 471


Word Clearing Series 45RA
BTB 30 Jan. 1973RA WORD CLEARING-THE KEY REPAIR TOOL FOR AN
            ORG, 472

      Three actions to increase production, 472
      Materials must be read, 472 Misunderstoods are cleaned up with Word
Clearing, 472
      Action is drilled to raise confront, 472


Word Clearing Series 46RA
BTB 30 Jan. 1973RA METHOD 9, 473

      Word Clearing Method 9 is Corrective Word Clearing, 473
      Word Clearing Method 9 procedure, 473


Word Clearing Series 47R
BTB 30 Jan. 1973R DIFFICULTIES WITH WORD CLEARING, 475

      Word Clearing Correction List must be used at the first hint of
trouble in Word Clearing, 475     Word Clearing can become lengthy until
Method One is completed, 475
      Symptom of a person requiring Word Clearing Method I, 475
      Interrelated uses of Word Clearing, 475


Word Clearing Series 48
BTB 30 Jan. 1973 WORD CLEARING ON FOREIGN LANGUAGE STUDENTS,
            PCS OR STAFF, 477

      Handling of foreign language students on Word Clearing, 477
      First language encountered is handled first in Word Clearing, 477


Word Clearing Series 49R
BTB 30 Jan. 1973R BUILD UP POWERFUL WORD CLEARERS, 478

      Training steps for Word Clearers, 478


Word Clearing Series 51
BTB 16 Dec. 1973 WORD CLEARING ERRORS, 479

      A student must look up every definition of the word being cleared,
 479


Word Clearing Series 52
BTB 6 Jan. 1974 WORD CLEARING TRANSLATORS, 480

      Importance of word clearing a translator, 480
      Steps for word clearing a translator, 480

Word Clearing Series 53R
HCO B 8 July 1974R CLEAR TO F/N, 482
      TA must be in normal range to start Word Clearing on meter, 482
      All words must be F/Ned in Word Clearing on meter, 482
      Word Clearing red tab, 482

Word Clearing Series 54
HCO B 7 Sept. 1974 SUPERLITERACY AND THE CLEARED WORD, 483

      Education and superliteracy, 483
      What is superliteracy, 483
      Action of superliterate illustrated, 485
      Cleared words, 486

Art Series 1
HCOB 30 Aug. 1965 ART, 489

      The fundamentals of art, 489
      Art is a word which summarizes the quality of communication, 489
      Perfection vs. communication, 490
      An artist's relation to his audience, 491
      Decline of art forms, 491

Art Series 2
HCO B 29 July 1973 ART, MORE ABOUT, 493

      How good does a work of art have to be to be good, 493
      Art for self satisfaction vs. audience, 493
      Technique of art, 494
      What is technical expertise, 495
      "Technical expertise adequate to produce an emotional impact" and
       "message", 496
      Art quality and form, 496
      Living itself is an art form, 496

Art Series 3
HCO B 10 Apr. 1974 STAGE MANNERS, 498

      Basics of appearing before an audience, 498
      Stage manner rules, 498
      Stage manner drills, 499

Art Series 4
HCO B 25 Apr. 1974 RHYTHM, 500

      Definition of rhythm, 500
      Six distinct types of rhythm in music, 500
      Usage, 500
      Repetition, 500
      Rapport, 500
      Impingement, 50 1
      Rhythm in art forms, 501

BTB 7 Apr. 1972R TOUCH ASSISTS-CORRECT ONES, 502

      Errors in a Touch Assist, 502
      The nerve system of the body, 502
      Importance of balance in Touch Assist, 502
      Effect of shock on the muscles, 503
      Demonstration by LRH, 503
      On the assist you must go to extremities, 503
      The spine, 504
      Schools of healing, 504
      Difference between mesmerism and hypnotism, 504
      In assist you don't want rapport, 505

































                            Auditor Admin Series
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              2 NOVEMBER 1972R
Remimeo       Revised & Reissued 5 August 1974 as BTB
All Auditors
All C/Ses   CANCELS
All W/Cers      HCO BULLETIN OF 2 NOVEMBER 1972
FES Unit Hat     SAME TITLE
Qual Div Hats
             (The only revision is in the second last paragraph:
                    the phrase "or BTB" has been added.)


                           Auditor Admin Series 1R


                          THE AUDITOR ADMIN SERIES
                           FOR USE BY ALL AUDITORS


                                   PURPOSE

    Over  the  years  much  "know-how"  has  been  developed   in   Auditor
Administration.


    The  purpose  of  this  Series  is  to  bring  a  standard  in  Auditor
Administration throughout the world.


                                 DEFINITIONS

AUDITOR-    A listener or one who listens carefully to what people  have  to
           say. An Auditor is a person trained and  qualified  in  applying
           Scientology processes to others for their betterment.


ADMINISTRATION-  Consists of the formation and handling  of  the  lines  and
                   terminals involved in production.


AUDITOR ADMINISTRATION-      would include:


    1.      The know-how of writing session reports.


    2.      The know-how of folder arrangement.


    3.      The know-how of all lines  and  terminals  in  the  Tech  Area.
        (Covered mainly in C/S Series 25.)


    4.      The know-how of other lines  and  terminals  in  the  Org  that
        directly relate to an Auditor getting out his product.


                                 LRH QUOTES


    "ALWAYS ADMINISTRATION IS A COMMUNICATION."


    "Administration is important because the Administration is a  piece  of
truth."


    "'Administration of a Folder'  is  a  responsibility  and  so  is  'The
Administrative Lines of the Technical Division'."


    "NO AUDITOR HAS ANY BUSINESS BEING IGNORANT OF ADMINISTRATION. "

(Reference:      TAPE 12.6.71 WELCOME TO THE
            FLAG INTERN COURSE)
                                C/S SERIES 56

    C/S Series 56 can be considered as Auditor Admin  Series  2  and  comes
next in this Series.


    C/S Series 56  covers  the  function  of  Administration  in  obtaining
excellent case results.

                              USE OF THE SERIES

    The Auditor Admin Series is made into packs.


    The packs are made available to Student Auditors, HGC Auditors,  C/Ses,
HGC  Admin  Personnel,  Cramming,  the  Qual  Library,  and  all   Technical
Executives.


    The Series is added to Auditor and C/S Course Checksheets.


    It is used by HGC Auditors and Internes to check if the Admin they  are
turning in is "by the book".


    It can be used by the C/S through  the  Cramming  Officer  to  cram  an
Auditor on an Admin Error.


    An Error would be handled by directing the Auditor to one specific  HCO
B or BTB in the Series that  dealt  with  that  specific  point.  Continuing
Admin Errors would get the whole pack.

                                   PRODUCT

    The product of the application  of  this  Series  is  Standard  Auditor
Administration  throughout  the  world,  with  the  viability  of   improved
Auditing Delivery and Results.


                                        Compiled by
                                        Training & Services Bur

                                  Revised & Reissued as BTB by Flag  Mission
                                  1234


                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                  Authorized  by  AVU  for  the  BOARDS   OF
                                  DIRECTORS of the CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:MD:AL:MH:BL:bl:mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 25 AUGUST 1971
                        Re-issued 2 November 1972 as
Remimeo

                           Auditor Admin Series 2

                                C/S Series 56


                             HOW TO GET RESULTS
                                  IN AN HGC


    Obtaining excellent case results is  an  ADMINISTRATIVE  not  a  wholly
technical function.


    Auditors and C/Ses are often weak on Administrative. They think general
tech results improve only by more tech study.  If  they  continue  to  think
this way they wind up squirreling. For they are working on  a  wrong  target
for improvement, a wrong WHY or reason.


    Auditing is a team activity. The day of the individual  country  doctor
is dead. Even if an individual field auditor starts out as an individual  he
goes one of two directions-he overworks and squirrels himself  into  failure
or he builds up a team-may only be a receptionist and an apprentice  auditor
but he is still building up a team. I have never  seen  individual  auditors
succeed over a long period. Failing to form or become part of a  team,  they
eventually fade out or squirrel.


    The reason is simple enough.


    These rules apply:


    TO IMPROVE TECH RESULTS YOU MUST IMPROVE ADMINISTRATION.


    And I don't mean just writing better in folders.

                                 DEFINITION

    ADMINISTRATION consists of the formation and handling of the lines  and
terminals involved in production.


    Unless an auditor understands this fully, he will  never  insist  on  a
Tech Sec, a Tech Establishment  Officer,  D  of  P,  C/S,  Examiner,  Pages,
Folder Admin and himself will begin to omit keeping  a  Folder  Summary  and
then omit the session actions and then, with big loses, retire from it all.


    If I were an auditor and saw some  of  these  things  missing,  I'd  be
liable to say, "Are you guys kidding? I thought we were here to audit pcs."


    Without the correct pattern  of  lines  and  terminals  YOU  DON'T  GET
RESULTS, you get headaches, mad neighbors and refunds.


    Auditing on lines, an auditor should regard himself as a highly skilled
expert, a technical specialist whose work requires respect and service.


    And Case Supervising  on  lines,  a  Case  Supervisor  should  consider
himself a sort of Czar whose word is so law even the  Exec  Director  thinks
several times before he approaches-duly servile of  course  and  bowing  the
prescribed three times as he exits.
A Class XII on Flag is listened to by others with a hush even if he is  only
commenting on the weather.


    These are the stars of the team. Their worldwide reputation for  smooth
flubless auditing is an administrative result!


    Short of space, overloaded, short of admin personnel, turning  out  the
highest well done hours in the world, Flag's Div IV produces because  of  an
Admin system.


    The highest of  these  C/Ses  and  auditors  goes  to  Cramming  if  he
misplaces a comma or drops a TR 1.


    If the sessions' exams at Examiner drop from 90% F/N  the  whole  place
gets overhauled.


    Folders are Folder Error  Summaried  by  an  FES  section.  The  Folder
Summary is kept up each session (or Cramming). The  folder  is  studied  and
C/Sed. The D of P assigns the  sessions.  The  C/S  is  done  correctly  (or
Cramming). The folder travels on its lines. The tests are done.


    In short it is a complex but constantly flowing pattern of moving  pcs,
folders and examinations interspersed with testing and  interviews  and  re-
registration.


    There is a right  way to do it.

                                   RESULTS

    If an org has only 65% of its sessions F/N VGIs at Examiner  the  right
answer is to organize the place.


    Why?


    Well, the first answer is that the third dynamic is stronger  than  the
first dynamic.


    An auditor auditing alone is  a  first  dynamic.  The  pc  is  a  first
dynamic. As it is the  auditor  plus  pc  that  must  be  greater  than  the
reactive mind, one can easily work the rest out.


    If the auditor is part of a functioning  third  dynamic,  not  just  an
individual, the auditor plus pc versus the bank  is  a  LOT  more  than  the
bank.


    Another answer is that an auditor knows the  pc,  if  only  because  of
sessions, and personal opinion enters into it. That is not a pure  technical
view as a C/S's must be.


    Another answer is that an auditor in a group gets more auditing done.


    Individually practicing auditors often fail because  nobody  is  taking
care of the auditor as a person. Further they get loses. No one  sends  them
to Cramming. When they get loses they often  start  squirreling.  Then  they
really get loses.


    That ends them as auditors.


    An auditor working in a good on policy organization is  given  service.
He does get sent to Cramming. He does keep his tech updated. He  gets  wins.
When he doesn't he's put back on standard tech. So he  happily  keeps  going
and makes lots of happy people.


    So if I were auditing in a group I would insist as a condition of  work
that Div IV and Div V be good on policy divisions, fully organized  with  no
nonsense.


    I know whereof I speak. As a part-time duty I work as a consulting  C/S
with a good IV and a good V. Sometimes I have had to  take  over  the  whole
C/S line. When the organization bogs in any way I know the  whole  thing  is
heading toward single-
handing the lot. So I get the lines back in and get people to  Cramming  and
get the F/N at Examiner ratio approaching 100% again.


    Thus, the advice you get about C/Sing  is  live-live-live,  not  canned
theory.


                                  ORG WINS


    Being on administrative lines to all orgs, I can  tell  you  pointblank
that


    THEIR STATS DEPEND ON THEIR VOLUME AND QUALITY OF SERVICE.


    That isn't propaganda. It's pure fact.


    The F/N-no F/N at Examiner ratio tells you at once if Divs IV and V are
organized and operating or if they are just fooling about.


    At 50% to 75% F/N at Examiner the administrative functions of  Divs  IV
and V are stinking bad. C/S Series 25 is out. Cramming is out.  Hidden  data
lines exist. HCO Bs, books and tapes are not used.


    The public, at that % of F/N, will stay away in droves. Registrars will
go batty and adopt "Hot Prospect Systems".


    The staff will go low pay and the execs will be a perpetual dark  shade
of purple from yelling. The cash-bills ratio will be the subject of  finance
missions and the neighbors will be phoning the police.


    Why?


    Because an org is itself a technical delivery organization and  50%  to
75% F/N at Examiner is an overt product.


    The Academy has already failed to apply student  study  tech  and  word
clearing. Qual is a joke.


    There is no library of tech available and if available isn't read.


    The org as a tech service delivery unit is treating its public to a no-
auditing situation and will get in trouble.


                                   REMEDY

    The way to remedy is to get on policy with tech organization.


    Put in a Qual with word clearing and a library and cramming.


    Put in the C/S Series 25 Tech lines.


    Tolerate NO out-tech or out-admin in folders.


    Dummy run the lines until they're in.


    Cram Cram Cram C/S and auditor and tech personnel flubs  whenever  they
    occur.


    Get the organization functioning.


    Your F/N at Examiner ratio will climb straight up to 90% 95% 98%.


    By actual test pcs will flood in, Reg  lines  will  get  easy,  success
    stats soar.


    More auditors more C/Ses, more organization. A second, a third HGC.
    And the more thoroughly the admin lines are manned the better the  tech
    lines work.


    This conclusion came from actual inspections of  orgs  and  studies  of
their stats.


    Orgs should be selling more training than processing.


    But why train if you can't interne them in a good Qual and HGC? They'll
never amount to anything as auditors unless they  work  in  an  organization
that is on tech and on policy.


    So you need an HGC.


    Tech, done in a proper administrative framework, works.


    Some orgs really don't believe they  could  ever  attain  the  flubless
auditing quality of Flag.


    But they can.


    It is even easy.


    It is even easier to attain flubless quality of auditing than any other
kind.


    You put in a real on policy admin pattern in IV and V. You begin with a
Qual Interne Course.


    You send to Cramming for any  C/S  or  auditing  error  no  matter  how
minute.


    The results come up.


    The errors cease.


    You're a success! If you do it.




                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1971, 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              3 NOVEMBER 1972R
                      Reissued 18 September 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 3 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                 SAME TITLE
                           Revised 7 February 1973

             (Only revisions are drawings on following two pages
            where the staples were originally drawn incorrectly.)


                           Auditor Admin Series 3R



                       THE PC FOLDER AND ITS CONTENTS


    The "current" folder being used for the Pc is arranged into four  basic
parts:

                                    [pic]

                                 THE FOLDER

    The Folder  is a folded sheet  of  cardboard  which  encloses  all  the
session reports  and  other  items.  The  folder  is  foolscap  size,  light
cardboard.


                              FRONT COVER ITEMS

    The case Progress Sheet   is  a  sheet  which  details  the  Levels  of
Processing and Training the Pc  has  acheived  while  moving  up  the  Grade
Chart. It also lists Incidental Rundowns and Set-up Actions the Pc has  had.
The Sheet gives at a glance the Pc's progress to OT.
The Yellow Sheet is  a sheet  detailing  each  Correction  List  or  Set  of
Commands which have been Word  Cleared.  It  also  lists  the  Pc's  current
Havingness process and the type of cans the Pc uses.


    The Folder Summary is  written on sheets located inside the Front Cover
and is an adequate summary of actions taken on a Pc in consecutive order.


    The OCA Graph is  a specially prepared graph which plots 10 traits of a
Pc's personality from a Personality Test taken by the Pc.


    OCA = Oxford Capacity Analysis.


    The Personality Test is also known as the APA  =  American  Personality
Analysis.


    The Program Sheet is a sheet which outlines the  sequence  of  actions,
session by session, to be run on the Pc to bring about a definite result.
                                    [pic]


    The Case Progress Sheet, Yellow Sheet and Folder  Summary  are  stapled
inside the Front Cover. The OCA Graph and Program Sheets  are  clipped  over
the Folder Summary with a big wide paper clip.


                             THE FOLDER CONTENTS

    The Auditor's C/S is a sheet  on  which  the  Auditor  writes  the  C/S
instructions for the next session.


    The Exam Report is a report made out by the Qual Examiner when  the  Pc
goes to Exams after session or goes on his own  volition.  It  contains  the
Meter details, Pc's indicators and the Pc's statement.


    The Summary Report Form is written by the Auditor after the session  on
a fill-in type standard form and is simply an exact record of what  happened
and what was observed during the session.


    The Auditor's Report Form is made out at the end of each session and is
an outline of what actions were taken during the session.


    The Worksheets are the sheets on which the Auditor  writes  a  complete
running record of the session from beginning to end,  page  after  page,  as
the session goes along.


    A Correction List is a list of prepared questions on  a  mimeoed  sheet
which is used by the Auditor for  the  repair  of  a  particular  situation,
action, or Rundown.


    An L&N List (Listing and Nulling List) is a list of items given by a Pc
in response to a Listing Question and written down by  the  Auditor  in  the
exact sequence that they are given to him by  the  preclear.  Each  list  is
done on a separate sheet.
A Dianetic Assessment List is a list of somatic items  given  by  a  Pc  and
written down by the Auditor with the reads marked that occur on the Meter.


    A Miscellaneous Report is a report such as an  MO  Report,  a  D  of  P
Interview, an Ethics Report, a Success Story, etc, which is put in the  Pc's
folder and gives a C/S more information about the case.
                                    [pic]


    The reports filed in the folder from one session consist of:


    The Worksheets stapled together with the Auditor's Report Form on  Top.
Any Correction List used goes under the Worksheets and is  included  in  the
stapling.


    Any L&N Lists or Dn Assessment Lists are  not  so  stapled  but  remain
loose and are put under the other session reports.


    On top of the stapled sheaf comes the Summary  Report  Form,  then  the
Exam Report and then the Auditor's C/S.


    All the session reports are now paper clipped together.


    Session Reports as above are put in the folder consecutively with  more
recent on top.


    Any Miscellaneous  Reports  are  filed  appropriately  at  the  correct
chronological point in the folder.


                            THE BACK COVER ITEMS

    A Dianetic Flow Table is a chronological list of  Dn  Items  run,  from
earliest to latest, with the flows that have been run.


    An FES (Folder Error Summary) is a summary  of  auditing  errors  in  a
folder and on a Pc's case not corrected at the time the summary is done.


    The Routing Form is the form that lists the Org terminals the Pc has to
check through in order to arrive in the HGC and in the auditing chair.


    The Invoice Form is a summary sheet of  how  much  auditing  a  Pc  has
signed up and paid for, and how much of that has been delivered.

[pic]
      The Invoice Form is stapled to the back cover. The rest of  the  items
are paper clipped inside the cover.


                                        Compiled by:
                                        Training & Services Bur

      Reissued as BTB by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                  Authorized by AVU
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY



BDCS:SW:AL:MH:MM:sb.mh.rd
Copyright � 1972,1973, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               4 NOVEMBER 1972
                 Revised & Reissued 21 September 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 4 NOVEMBER 1972
                                 SAME TITLE


                           Auditor Admin Series 4


                                 THE FOLDER


    A Folder is provided for each pc. The folder is  foolscap  size,  light
card.


    The pc's name and Grade is printed (using a fat felt pen) on the  front
of the folder and also along the spine. It's on the spine so  you  can  pull
it out of a stack, if they are lying in piles.


    Folders of pcs on Advanced Course levels are marked "Confidential"  and
striped on the front cover with green tape for  R6EW  and  Clear,  and  gold
(yellow in practice because gold tape not so readily available)  for  OT  I-
VIII.


    Expanded Dn folders are marked with red coloured tape, from  the  front
cover round the back of the bind, so they can be  picked  out  of  a  folder
stack.


    If an Org has  two  HGCs,  coloured  tape  can  be  used  similarly  to
distinguish which folder goes to which C/S.


    Tape colour flashes so far in use are:


    Red -Expanded Dianetic Folders


    Green -Folders of pcs at Advanced Courses Levels R6EW and Clear


    Gold -Folders of pcs at Advanced Courses Levels OT I-OT VIII


and these colours should not be used for any other purpose.


    EXAMPLE:
                                    [pic]
This is the folder of pc Helen Long, OT IIIX, who is  currently  having  Exp
Dn auditing.


    A rubber band or elastic garter is placed around each folder to prevent
loss of contents and make for easier handling.


                                 NEW FOLDERS

    HGC Admin should not let the folders get too fat  as  this  wrecks  the
folder and makes handling difficult.


    When the current folder gets too fat (approximately 2l/2'' or 6 cms)  a
new folder is started.


    The Case Progress Sheet, Yellow Sheet, Folder Summary,  OCA  Graph  and
Program Sheets are all carried forward to the front of the new  folder.  The
Invoice Form, Routing Form, Dn Flow Table and FES are  also  transferred  to
the back of the folder.


    The new folder is given a folder number (for example 2) which is marked
boldly on the bottom left-hand side of the front cover and along the spine.


    The old folder which already is numbered (with the folder number 1) has
the dates of the contents marked against the number 1 (on the front  and  on
the spine).

            i.e.       (1)   25 MAR 71---------- 4 OCT  71

    The fact of the change to a new folder  is  marked  in  on  the  Folder
Summary.


    Solo Folders are similarly given numbers SOLO 1, SOLO 2, SOLO  3,  etc,
and when a new Solo Folder is started, the change to a new folder is  marked
in the Folder Summary of the current HGC folder.


    In this way a C/S can tell if he has all the folders.


    It is the responsibility of HGC Admin (or Adv  Courses  Admin)  to  see
that all the above is done.

                              DIANETIC FOLDERS

    NO separate Dianetic folders are kept. All auditing reports of whatever
type of action are simply filed chronologically in the current HGC folder.


    The only separate category of folders is Solo Folders held by  Advanced
Courses.

                             STORAGE OF FOLDERS

    Old folders and those of pcs not currently on auditing lines are  filed
in alphabetical order in a store.


    A log book of pc folders is maintained. This  includes  the  number  of
folders for each pc (and where stored if not in current use).

                            TRANSPORT OF FOLDERS

    Folders are never  handed to the pc. They are handled as per C/S Series
25.


    When pc folders are sent to another Org (such as an  AO  or  Flag)  the
folders are checked for  completeness,  packaged  securely,  and  tied  with
string which is sealed (with a sealing wax).
A "Mail Slip" system is used to ensure that the  folders  are  not  lost  in
transit.


    The mail slips are done in 3 copies: plain  paper  or  3  copy  invoice
books can be purchased.


    The original is kept by the sender. The other two copies (and they must
be dark and legible) go inside the mail pack. They may  not  be  put  in  an
envelope in the pack. They are left on the top visible.


    The package is addressed to "The Director of Tech Services" of the  Org
to which it is being mailed.


    On receipt of the folders, one of the copies is sent on normal dispatch
lines back to the originating Org to complete the cycle.

                               NO ADMIN FOLDER

    The practice of starting a separate "Admin  Folder"  to  hold  all  the
admin bits and pieces is not necessary and is not standard admin.


    References:  HCO PL     8 Aug 66    "OT COLOUR FLASH"


                       TAPE       7 Apr 72   Exp Dn Tape 3
                                        "AUDITOR ADMINISTRATION"


                       Flag Order 2183  "THE MAIL SYSTEM"
                       8 Nov 69


                                        Compiled by:
                                        Training & Services Bur

      Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                  Authorized by AVU
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:SW:AL:MH:MM:sb:mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              5 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                   Issue I
                   Revised & Reissued 28 July 1975 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 5 NOVEMBER 1972
                                   Issue I
                                 SAME TITLE

                   (Attach to this BTB-BPL 14 Sept 1971RA,
                "Case Progress Sheet", Revised 28 July 1975.)


                           Auditor Admin Series 5R


                             CASE PROGRESS SHEET


    The Case Progress  Sheet  is  a  sheet  which  details  the  Levels  of
Processing and Training the Pc  has  achieved  while  moving  up  the  Grade
Chart.


    It also lists Incidental Rundowns and Set-up Actions the Pc has had.


    The Sheet gives at a glance the Pc's progress to OT.


    IT DOES NOT CONSTITUTE THE PC PROGRAM AND NOT ALL  THE  ITEMS  ON  THIS
SHEET NEED NECESSARILY BE RUN ON THE PC.


                                USE OF SHEET

    The Progress Sheet as issued in BPL 14 Sept 71RA (revised 28  July  75)
is stapled to the inside of the front cover of the folder by  Tech  Services
(HGC Admin).


    The form is originally filled in by the FESer, C/S  or  Auditor-whoever
makes a full and careful study of all the Pc's folders.


    Things the Pc has achieved falsely are marked in  red.  Things  the  Pc
made from the bottom walking an honest road are marked in green.


    (Seeing the whole Training Cycle Half of the Sheet continue blank means
more ignorance and trouble for the Pc in making his gains stable.)


                        KEEPING THE SHEET UP TO DATE

    The Form is kept up to date by the Auditor as the actions are completed
and attested to.

References: BPL 14 Sept 71RA (Revised 28 July 1975)
      CASE PROGRESS SHEET

      HCO B 12 June 70, C/S Series 2
      PROGRAMMING OF CASES

      Compiled by
      Training & Services Bureau
      Revised & Reissued as BTB by
      Flag Mission 1234 2nd Molly Harlow
      Approved by
      The Commodore's Staff Aides and
BDCS:CSA:Bof I:MH:BL:mh.rd   The Board of Issues for the
Copyright � 1972,1975  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                             BOARD POLICY LETTER

                            14 SEPTEMBER 1971 RA
                                   Issue I
                           Revised 24 October 1972
                   Revised & Reissued 28 July 1975 as BPL
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                   HCO POLICY LETTER OF 14 SEPTEMBER 1971R
                                 SAME TITLE

                             CASE PROGRESS SHEET

    Each current HGC Pc folder is to have this sheet stapled to the  inside
front cover of the folder by Tech Services. The form  is  originally  filled
in by the FESer, C/S or Auditor (whoever makes a full and careful  study  of
all the Pc's folders). The form is kept up to date by  the  Auditor  as  the
actions are completed and attested to.

PC'S NAME_______________________________________________

    Please mark in the date each item was honestly attained  in  green;  if
falsely attained, mark it in red.
                                    [pic]
                                    [pic]

                                    [pic]













         Amended by Training & Services
         Bureau

         Revised & Reissued as BPL
         by Flag Mission 1234 2nd
         Molly Harlow

         Approved by
         The Commodore's Staff Aides and
         The Board of Issues
         for the
         BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
         of the
         CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:CSA:Bofl:BL:MM:WS:MH:mh.rd
Copyright � 1971,1972, 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              5 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue II
                   Revised & Reissued 24 July 1974 as BTB
                        (Revision in this type style)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 5 NOVEMBER 1972
                                  Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE



                           Auditor Admin Series 6R



                              THE YELLOW SHEET


    The Yellow Sheet is a sheet detailing each Correction List  or  set  of
commands which have been Word  Cleared.  It  also  lists  the  Pc's  current
Havingness process and the type of cans the Pc uses.

    Example:

      RUDS  20.8.72    20.8.72    FOOTPLATES
      WCCL  21.8.72
      R3R COMMANDS     21.8.72    20.8.72    Notice that_______
      L3RD  21.8.72    19.10.72   Feel that _______

    The sheet is kept up by the Auditor.


    Reference:   BTB 2 May 72R, "CLEARING COMMANDS".


                                  Compiled by
                                  Training & Services Bur

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:MD:AL:MH:BL:MM:mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              5 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue III
                 Revised & Reissued 9 September 1974 as BTB
                        (Revision in this type style)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 5 NOVEMBER 1972
                                  Issue III
                                 SAME TITLE


                           Auditor Admin Series 7R


                             THE FOLDER SUMMARY



    The Folder Summary is written on sheets located on the  inside  of  the
Front Cover and is an adequate summary of the  actions  taken  on  a  pc  in
consecutive order.


    It is stapled inside the Front Cover of the  pc's  current  folder  and
requires the following data:


1.    ADMIN DETAILS

    Session date, length of time of session and  admin  time.  When  a  new
folder is started. The total time of a series  of  auditing  sessions.  When
OCA taken. When an FES done.


2.    PROCESS DETAILS

    What was run and whether it ran. Mark an EP beside each  action  taken,
or if it was not taken to EP mark in red UNFLAT, O/R, or whatever.


    The listing question of an L&N action is written out in full.


    R3R items are written out in full.


    If an item or terminal R/Ses in session, it is  noted  in  red  on  the
Summary Report with the page number and circled.


    Similarly an evil purpose arising in a session is marked  in  red  with
the date and circled.


3.    EXAM REPORT

    At the bottom of  the  process  details  mark  F/N  indicating  an  F/N
occurred at the Examiner, or BER (red) if a Bad Exam Report. If TA was  high
or low at exam, it can also be noted.


4.    ATTESTS

    Date and what attested.


    If pc sent to attest but did NOT this is noted.
5.    ADVANCED COURSE DATA

    Date started Advanced Course, Level, Date attested to Completion.


    (The individual solo sessions are NOT noted but should be entered on  a
separate Folder Summary in the Advanced Course Folder.)


6.    MEDICAL DATA

    When pc reports sick.


    Date and brief statement of illness.


    Then a further entry when pc OFF M.O. Lines.


7.    ETHICS DATA

    Any Ethics cycles or Conditions.


    A BLUE or BLACK pen is used for normal entries. A RED pen  is  used  to
mark any R/Sing item, Ev Purp, list or Dn item correction, BER, high or  low
TA at Exams, flubbed attest, medical action or Ethics cycle.


    In the HGC the Auditor is responsible for keeping up this Summary after
each  session  and  immediately  on  receipt  of  a  Medical  Report  or  pc
volunteered BER. It is standard part of the Auditor's Session Admin.


    When the pc goes  into  Advanced  Courses  all  folders  (HGC  and  any
Advanced Course folders) go to the Advanced Course C/S who  keeps  the  Case
Progress Sheet, Yellow Sheet, and Summary Sheet in the  HGC  folder  updated
as outlined above.


    The Solo Auditor keeps updated the separate Solo Folder Summary on  the
inside front cover of his current Solo Folder.


    The Folder Summary Sheets are  foolscap,  divided  into  four  columns.
Below is an example of how the Folder Summary is kept:
                                    [pic]


                             FOLDER SUMMARY FORM

    When a new pc starts auditing and the first folder is made up a copy of
the attached form is stapled by two staples at the top to the  inside  front
cover.


    The form is mimeoed on lightweight paper so that it is not bulky.


    The Auditor fills in this form as he progresses with the auditing.


    New sheets are added as needed, earliest at the bottom to  most  recent
on the top.


    When a new folder is made up, ALL Summary Sheets are removed  from  the
old folder and advanced to the inside cover of the new folder  so  that  the
completed Folder Summary of the case is always in the current HGC folder.


    It is the HGC Admin's responsibility to see that the above is done.



    Reference:   Tape  7 Apr 72   Exp Dn Tape 3
                                        AUDITOR ADMINISTRATION


                                  Compiled by
                                  Training & Services Bur

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:MD:AL:MH:BL:MM:mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                                    [pic]
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               5 NOVEMBER 1972
                                  Issue IV
                         Reissued 2 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 5 NOVEMBER 1972
                                  Issue IV
                                 SAME TITLE

                           Auditor Admin Series 8

                                 OCA GRAPHS

    The OCA Graph is a specially prepared graph which plots 10 traits of  a
pc's personality from a Personality Test taken by the pc.

                       WHEN THE PC TAKES THE OCA TEST

    Several OCA Tests can be taken by a pc during a series  of  intensives.
Usually one is taken before an intensive to give the C/S information  as  to
what is to be audited, and one is taken after a big win, at the end of a  RD
or at the completion of a Grade-as an indication of what has been  achieved.
This can however be overdone by too frequent use.


                           PLOTTING THE OCA TESTS

    The results of the OCA (and an IQ Test) are entered on an OCA GRAPH.


    A series of OCAs are drawn on the same graph to give an  indication  of
the change that has occurred.


    Each graph line is drawn in  a  different  colour  (red,  blue,  black,
green) or in a different fashion  (bold  line,  normal  line,  broken  line,
dotted line) so that each line of the graph can  be  distinguished.  On  the
top of the graph a key is drawn that gives  the  date  when  each  Test  was
done. The month is written in letters so no confusion on numbers occurs.

                              POSITION OF GRAPH

    The graph is kept paper clipped on the inside cover of the  folder  (on
top of the F/S and below the programs), so it can be taken out and the  next
OCA drawn in.


    The answer sheet that the pc fills in is placed with the worksheets  of
that date, after the graph is drawn.

                               RESPONSIBILITY

    It is the responsibility of HGC Admin to see that when the C/S requests
an OCA, the pc is routed to Testing and the test gets done, and the  results
entered on the graph and the test sheets filed in the folder.

References:      HCO B       17 July 71      C/S Series 51
                 OUT OF VALENCE
            HCO B      19 Dec 71  C/S Series 71
                 D OF P OPERATES BY OCAs
            HCO B      24 Feb 72  C/S Series 71A
                 WORD CLEARING OCAs

                                        Compiled by
                                        Training & Services Bur
      Reissued as BTB by Flag Mission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow
                                        Authorized by AVU
BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BL:MM:mh.rd    for the
Copyright � 1972,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              6 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue II
                   Revised & Reissued 15 July 1974 as BTB
                  (The only change is "LRH" and References
                       added to page 1, paragraph 1.)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 6 NOVEMBER 1972
                                  Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE

                           Auditor Admin Series 9R

                              THE PROGRAM SHEET

    A program by  definition  is  "the  sequence  of  actions,  session  by
session, to be undertaken on a case by the C/S  in  his  directions  to  the
Auditor or Auditors auditing the case" LRH, and is "any  series  of  actions
designed  by  a  C/S  to  bring  about  definite  results  in  a  pc."   LRH
(References: HCO B 23 August 1971, C/S Series 1, and HCO  B  12  June  1970,
C/S Series 2.)

                         THE THREE TYPES OF PROGRAMS

There are three types of programs:

1.    THE PROGRESS  (REPAIR)  PROGRAM:  to  eradicate  case  mishandling  by
    current life or auditing errors. This  program  is  written  on  a  red
    sheet.

2.    THE ADVANCE (RETURN) PROGRAM:  major actions to be undertaken  to  get
    the case back on the Class  Chart  from  wherever  he  has  erroneously
    gotten to on it. This program is written on a blue sheet.

3.    THE BASIC PROGRAM:  laid  out  in  the  Classification  and  Gradation
    Chart.

    (Note: An Exp Dn Program is written on a green sheet.)


    The Program consists of the pc's name, the date, brief  case  notes  of
why the program is being written, and the actions numbered 1, 2, 3,  etc  to
be done on the pc to bring about a definite result. The person  writing  the
program prints his name at the bottom.


    These Program Sheets are kept paper clipped on the inside of the  Front
Cover, earliest at the bottom to latest on top.

                            THE RESPONSIBILITY OF
                                   THE C/S

    A C/S works at completing the program that is topmost. As each step  of
the program is completed it is ticked off marked "DONE" with the date.


    When the whole program is done, it is marked "PROGRAM DONE (DATE)".


    All flubs made in doing the program are marked in and repaired.


    If while doing a  blue  (or  green)  program  an  extensive  repair  is
undertaken then this is programmed on a red sheet and then this becomes  the
topmost program. The blue sheet should however be marked  at  the  point  it
was left and can be resumed when the red one is done.
Any program retired because of new data about a case  should  be  so  marked
with the date.


    The auditor as C/S is responsible  for  marking  off  the  programs  as
above.

                           EVIL PURPOSES AND R/Ses

    Evil Purposes and R/S items are marked on the  left-hand  edge  of  the
topmost program in red with the date and worksheet page number.

References:      HCO B       12 June 70      C/S Series 2
                                  PROGRAMMING OF CASES

            TAPE       7 Apr 72   Exp Dn Tape 3
                                  AUDITOR ADMINISTRATION


                                  Compiled by
                                  Training & Services Bur

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:MD:AL:MH:BL:MM:mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              6 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue III
                   Revised & Reissued 27 July 1974 as BTB
                        (Revision in this type style)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 6 NOVEMBER 1972
                                  Issue III
                                 SAME TITLE


                          Auditor Admin Series 10R


                              THE AUDITOR'S C/S


    The Auditor's C/S is a sheet  on  which  the  Auditor  writes  the  C/S
instructions for the next session.


    This is per C/S Series 25:




Full blank page.


Pc's Name (red)  Date
Auditor's Name (red)   Class of Auditor
      required next session


(Session Grade) left blank


Auditor's comment (red) or think about the case if he wishes.


    The next C/S

    1.      Blue


    2.      Blue


    3.      Blue


    4.      Blue


                                  Auditor Signature (red)


    The Auditor does not grade his own session. He leaves this blank.


                             POSITION IN FOLDER

    The C/S Instructions for the session go under  that session, so you get
C/S 4.6.68, Auditing Session 4.6.68, C/S 5.6.68,  Auditing  Session  5.6.68,
C/S 7.6.68, etc, etc.
                              ETHICS SITUATION

    Under Auditor's comments would be noted any Ethics Situation that  came
to light in the session.

    References:  HCO B      25 June 70  C/S Series 11
                       HCO B      5 Mar 71   C/S Series 25
                                        "THE FANTASTIC NEW HGC LINE"
                       TAPE       7 Apr 72   Exp Dn Tape 3
                                        "AUDITOR ADMINISTRATION"


                                  Compiled by
                                  Training & Services Bur

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:MD:AL:MH:BL:MM:mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED

                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              6 NOVEMBER 1972RA
                                  Issue IV
Remimeo     Revised & Reissued 30 August 1974 as BTB
Pc Examiner's    Revised 20 November 1974
Hat
                                   CANCELS
                           BTB OF 6 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue IV
                                 SAME TITLE

                     (Revisions are in this type sty/e)

                          Auditor Admin Series 11RA
                    (Attach to this BTB, HCO PL 8 Mar 71,
                             "Examiner's Form")


                               THE EXAM REPORT


    The Exam Report is a report made out by the Qual Examiner when  the  Pc
goes to Exams after session or goes on his own volition.

                                  CONTENTS

    The Exam  Report  contains  the  meter  details,  Pc's  indicators  and
statement.


    The attached HCO PL "Examiner's Form" is filled in as follows:


Top left:


    If AFTER SESSION, put a tick on that line. If after Solo print SOLO  on
    the line. If it is a query of the Pc requested  by  the  C/S  (and  not
    after a session) print C/S QUERY on the line.


    If VOLUNTEERED, put a large tick.


    If MEDICAL, circle the word "Medical" then write ON  (if  Pc  is  going
    onto medical lines) or OFF on the line as the case may be, or REPORT if
    that's what it is.

Top right:

    QUAL DIV: When the stencil of HCO PL "Examiner's Form" is  made  up  in
    Mimeo, the Org's name can be typed in on this line and so is reproduced
    on each Examiner's Form and that saves a lot of writing.


    DATE is noted, e.g. 4 June 72.


    TIME is noted, e.g. 1803.

The Date and Time are important as it prevents altered sequence.

PC or PRE-OT NAME is printed in.

LAST GRADE ATTAINED: This is important from the C/S viewpoint  as  it  saves
him Dev-T in searching through the folder looking for it.

GRADE, COURSE OR ACTION  BEING  ATTESTED:  Whatever  it  happens  to  be  on
declare-write DECLARE across the  line  and  the  Grade,  State,  Course  or
Action being declared.

PC STATEMENT: Write down exactly what Pc says. Note also  what  reads,  BDs,
and where his indicators change and vary, tone in which statements are  made
and so forth.

TA POSITION AND ANY BD: Note TA position at start of exam  and  TA  position
at end if different.
PC INDICATORS are judged on the following scale:

      VBIs  Very Bad Indicators
      BIs   Bad Indicators
      POOR  Poor Indicators
      OK    Indicators OK
      GIs   Good Indicators
      VGIs  Very Good Indicators
      VVGIs VERY Very Good Indicators

    However, any obvious manifestation that would be helpful for the C/S is
    noted.


    Examples:

            BIs        Pc crying
            BIs        Pc frowning
            VVGIs      Pc radiant, skin tone very pink

STATE OF NEEDLE:  This  is  important  as  different  needle  manifestations
indicate different things, i.e. R/S, DN, RISE, etc.

    Also on F/Ns note the size.

      Small F/N  =     1" to 2"
      Normal F/N =     2" to 3"
      Wide F/N   =     3" to 4"
      Dial F/N   =     Floating from one pin to the other right  across  the
dial
      Flopping F/N
      or    Floating F/N
      or    TA F/N     =     Can't get the needle on dial, just falls over.

                        On this it is sometimes possible to  get  TA  range,
                        e.g. needle comes on dial at 2.3 and again  at  2.5.
                        This would be indicated as TA F/N = 2.5 - 2.3.

    Size of F/Ns is important. A TA F/N at session end, to a small  F/N  at
Examiner, would indicate something out.

F/N INDICATED TO PC: If F/N has been indicated to the Pc write YES,  if  not
write NO.

SIGNATURE OF EXAMINER: The form is signed  by  the  person  doing  the  Exam
along this line.

SENSITIVITY: All Exams are done at proper sensitivity per HCO B 18  Mar  74,
"E-Meter-Sensitivity Errors".

FOOTPLATES: If a Pc is audited on footplates he or she must be  examined  on
footplates. This is noted by writing FOOTPLATES above the TA reading.

RED TAGS Definitions:

A FLOATING NEEDLE "is the idle uninfluenced movement of the  needle  on  the
dial without any patterns or reactions in it. It can be as small  as  1"  or
as large as dial wide. It does not fall or drop to the right  of  the  dial.
It moves to the left at the same speed as it  moves  to  the  right.  It  is
observed on a Mark V E-Meter calibrated with the  TA  between  2.0  and  3.0
with GIs in on the Pc. It can occur after a cognition blowdown of the TA  or
just moves into floating. The Pc may or may not voice the cognition." LRH

A RED TAG EXAM  is  where  the  Examiner  sees  any  one  of  the  following
manifestations in a Pc after a session:


    1.      Non-optimum TA position (above 3, below 2);


    2.      Non-optimum needle (ARC Break needle, stage 4, rockslam, stuck,
        still or dirty);


    3.      Bad Indicators as per BTB 26 April 1969, "Bad Indicators";



        4.        Non-optimum  statement  from   Pc,   critical,   hostile,
        belittling, sad, etc.


    5.      Sick report after session or within  a  few  days  of  a  Major
        Auditing Action.


    6.      Major Out Tech in session which could cause Pc trouble.


    7.      Flunked Declare? accompanied by a BER.

    When a Red Tag Exam occurs the Examiner clips a red  tag  to  the  Exam
Form. Red Tag folders must not be held onto by the Auditor until the end  of
the day. They go immediately to the C/S and get handled on a  rush  priority
basis.

                            MEDICAL EXAM REPORTS

    A Pc goes to the Medical Liaison Officer  via  the  Examiner.  The  MLO
writes up a report to the Ethics Officer. The Examiner takes a  carbon  copy
(or copies the original Exam Form) and gives it immediately to the  MLO  and
gets the original to Tech Services quickly. Tech Services pulls the  folders
and routes rapidly to the C/S or Staff C/S if a staff member is sick.


    This MUST get into the Pc's folder so the C/S does not  order  a  major
action done on a sick Pc.


    The Exam Report is similarly handled when the Pc comes off MLO lines.


    The MLO sends a daily report to the C/S on ALL  persons  on  his  lines
with a final report when they route off with Exam attached.

                             LOCATION IN FOLDER

    The Exam Report Form is put in the  folder  on  top  of  the  Auditor's
Report Form (or Summary Report if used).


    Volunteered Exam Report Forms are put in the folder at the  appropriate
date.


    It is the responsibility of Tech Services (HGC Admin) to see that these
forms get into the folder.

References:      HCO B       21 Oct 68  "Floating Needle"
            HCO PL     8 Sept 70  "Examiner's 24 Hour Rule"
            HCO B      5 Mar 71   C/S Series  25,  "The  Fantastic  New  HGC
Line"
            BPL  26 Jan 70   "Examiner and Floating Needle"
            Flag Ship Order 259
                             3 Mar 71   "Current C/S Policy"
            BTB  20 Jan 73RB      C/S Series 86RB, "The Red Tag Line"
                                  Rev. 18.9.74

                                  Compiled by
                                  Training & Services Bur

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY



BDCS:MD:AL:MH:BL:MM:mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO POLICY LETTER OF 8 MARCH 1971
Remimeo
Examiner's Hat   (Replaces and Revises HCO PLs of
Tech Services    9 May 69 and 26 Jan AD20, "Examiner's Form")
Hat
                               EXAMINER'S FORM

    (Important Note: This form is handled exactly as per HCO P/L of 26  Jan
AD20 AND NO EXAMINER MAY EXAMINE UNLESS STARRATED ON THAT P/L, and HCO  B  5
Mar 71 (C/S Series 25) AND AN E-METER COURSE. Students and pcs can  be  very
upset if this post's duties are not done correctly and  org  pc  and  course
results ruined.)

After Session    Qual Div    (Place)

Volunteered Date

Medical     Time

Pc or Pre OT name

Last Grade Attained

Grade, Course or Action Being Attested

Pc's Statement (Write down exactly what pc says.)










TA Position and any BD                  Pc Indicators

State of Needle

F/N Indicated to pc

                                            ________________________________
                                        Signature of Examiner

ROUTE THIS FORM TO TECH SERVICES WHICH ROUTES IT INTO THE FOLDER.

WHEN ILLNESS REPORTED MAKE THIS OUT WITH A CARBON UNDER IT  AND  ROUTE  ORIG
TO T/S AND FOLDER AND CARBON TO MO OR QUAL SEC.

RUSH ROUTE ANY ROLLER COASTER LATER REPORT OR SICK RPT TO FOLDER TO  PREVENT
C/S ERRORS.
      L. RON HUBBARD
LRH:mes.rd  Founder
Copyright � 1971 [Two earlier issues of the Examiner's Form, HCOPLs 18
by L. Ron Hubbard      September 1968 and 30 September 1968,  IssueII,  were
revised
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    by HCO PL  9  May  1969  which  is  revised  by  this
issue.]
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              6 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                   Issue V
                   Revised & Reissued 28 July 1974 as BTB
                        (Revision in this type sty/e)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 6 NOVEMBER 1972
                                   Issue V
                                 SAME TITLE

                    (Attach to this BTB-BTB  20 June 70,
                             "Summary Report".)

                          Auditor Admin Series 12R

                           THE SUMMARY REPORT FORM

    The Summary Report Form is a report used simply as an exact  record  of
what happened and what was observed during the session.


    The form BTB  20 June 70, "SUMMARY REPORT"  is  used  and  the  Auditor
fills in the appropriate data.

                           USE OF SUMMARY REPORTS

    With the introduction of C/S Series THE FANTASTIC NEW HGC LINE, Summary
Report Forms were omitted from the admin procedure at Flag.


    However, the use of Summary  Report  Forms  is  left  entirely  to  the
discretion of the C/S of an Org.


    They are used extensively in training.


    EVERY STUDENT AUDITOR ON COURSES AND  CO-AUDIT  MUST  WRITE  A  SUMMARY
REPORT FORM AFTER EACH SESSION.


    It is a tool for increasing an Auditor's obnosis of what goes on  in  a
session. It teaches Auditors  how  to  quickly  and  concisely  analyze  and
report on a case.

                            FILLING IN THE REPORT

    The Summary Report Form is filled in as follows:

1.    The date.

2.    The pc's name and the Auditor's name, in BLOCK letters.

3.    The process run, the total tone arm action for  the  session  and  the
    length of the session in hours and minutes.

4.    Goals are no longer set at the beginning of session but if the  pc  in
    passing mentions any goals he has attained, or more likely gains he has
    had in the session, these are noted at this point.

5.    Aspects of running process-each of the questions 1 to 22 of  the  form
    are answered. Here write down briefly what the preclear  was  doing  in
    the session. Do not write opinions with regard to what was happening or
    how the preclear was running the process. Here we are interested in the
    aspects of the case in relationship to the process or  processes  being
    run.
    6.      Ethics Report   )     These are written on the Auditor's C/S
            )    Sheet per C/S Series 25.
7.    Suggest          )

    The Summary should be done for the session given the preclear  for  the
day. It is not stapled to the worksheets but is paper-clipped on top of  the
Auditor's Report Form and beneath the Exam Report.


    Two sessions in one day calls for only one Summary Report with  the  TA
and data of each session.


    It should be LEGIBLE and READABLE. If an Auditor's handwriting is poor,
it should be printed out by the Auditor.


    Writing the reports should only take the Auditor 15 minutes  to  do  at
the most. Having just audited the preclear you should quite easily fill  the
report out.

References:      HCO B       14 June 65      "Summary Report"
            HCO B      7 May 69   "Summary of How to Write an Auditor's
                                  Report"
            HCO B      5 Mar 71   "C/S Series  25,  The  Fantastic  New  HGC
Line"
            BTB  20 June 70  "Summary Report"

                                        Compiled by
                                        Training & Services Bur

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:HE:AL:MH:MM:mh.rd.jh
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                20 JUNE 1970
                        Reissued 21 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                        HCO BULLETIN OF 20 JUNE 1970
                                 SAME TITLE




                               SUMMARY REPORT



    The auditor checks each one off and fills in the appropriate data.


      DATE:

PC or PRE OT:    AUDITOR:

PROCESS RUN:     TA:   TIME:

GOALS AND GAINS:

ASPECTS AND GAINS:

1.    How did pc do in relation to what was run?

2.    Effectiveness of process.

3.    Any free needles.

4.    General needle behaviour.

5.    Did TA go below 2.0 (how low)?    Did it come up?

6.    Did TA go high?  Did it come down?

7.    General TA range.

8.    Emotional tone of the pc and whether this improved.

9.    Any misemotion.

10.   Preclear appearance.

11.   Mannerisms.

12.   Mannerism changes.

13.   Any change in skin tone.

14.   Did colour of eyes change?  Get brighter?      Get dull?

15.   Any comm lags.

16.   Any cognitions.

17.   Any pains turn on      blown
18.   Any sensations turn on            blown
19.   Any difficulties.
20.   Did you complete C/S instructions?
21.   Was pc happy at session end?
22.   TA at session end                 Needle at session end


ETHICS REPORT:





















SUGGEST:














      James Fuller

      Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

      I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU

BDCS:SW:AL:MH:JFF.mh.jh      for the
Copyright � 1970,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              6 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue VI
                  Revised & Reissued 27 August 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 6 NOVEMBER 1972
                                  Issue VI
                                 SAME TITLE

                          Auditor Admin Series 13R

                           THE AUDITOR REPORT FORM

    An Auditor's Report Form is made out at the end  of  each  session.  It
gives an outline of what actions were taken during the session.


    Each Report Form should be filled in at the top with:


    (a)     Preclear's name (full name) and Grade (very prominent).


    (b)     Auditor's name (full name).


    (c)     Date.


    (d)     No. of intensive hours scheduled (121/2-25-50 etc).


    (e)     Time length of session excluding time for breaks (example 5 hrs
        15 m). This is "hours in the chair".


    (f)     Running total of scheduled hours completed to date.


    (g)     Total TA for session.  Often  neglected  but  important  as  an
        indicator of case progress.




    The body of the form is filled in with the following information:


    (h)     Time started and ended session.


    (i) Condition of pc.


    (j)     TA and Sensitivity setting at beginning and end of session.


    (k)     Rudiments.


    (l)      What  process  was  run-LISTING  THE  EXACT  COMMANDS   (often
        forgotten by most Auditors).


    (m)     Time, TA and Sens at start and end of process.


    (n)     Whether process is flat or not.


    (o)     Any F/Ns.


    (p)     Any R/S Items or Ev Purps are noted in the  right-hand  column,
        in red.


    (q)     TA range.

    At the bottom of the form the Trim Check result is noted.
                                    [pic]
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              6 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue VII
                   Revised & Reissued 25 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo

                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 6 NOVEMBER 1972
                                  Issue VII
                                 SAME TITLE

              (The only revision is under CONTENT OF WORKSHEET:
                           "G. Reads" was added.)

                          Auditor Admin Series 14R


                               THE WORKSHEETS


    The Worksheets are the sheets on which the Auditor  writes  a  complete
running record of the session from beginning to end,  page  after  page,  as
the session goes along.


    A Worksheet is always foolscap, 8 x 13 inches, written  on  both  sides
and each page is numbered, back and front, top center of page.


    This is so an Auditor can say, "Now the R/S occurred on page 25," which
saves a lot of time. Further  it  gives  the  proper  number  of  pages  the
session went.


    The Worksheet is written in two columns. The Auditor  writes  down  the
left-hand column and then down the right-hand column.

                            CONTENT OF WORKSHEET

    The most important parts of the session to be noted are:


    A.      When the TA goes up (on what?)


    B.      When the TA goes down (on what?)


    C.      When an F/N occurs (on what-any cog?)


    D.      When VGIs occur (on what?)


    E.      When BIs occur (on what?)


    F.      How the process ran (what commands are being run?)


    G.      Reads

    TA and time notations should be made at  regular  intervals  throughout
the session.


    When a process reaches EP-write in the pc's cognition, circle  the  F/N
and whether or not it was indicated, note the pc's indicators, the time  and
TA.


    When  Two-Way  Comming  a  subject  it  is  essential  that  all  items
(terminals, statements, etc) that read are so marked on  the  worksheets-LF,
LFBD. All reading items are circled in green after the session.


    R/S items, Ethics situations, Ser Facs and Evil Purps are marked, after
the session, by ringing them on the W/S with a red pen.
                                SHORTHANDING

    Auditors usually develop a system of shorthanding the  session  actions
being done, so that session speed is not hampered by Admin.


    For example, the repetitive process:

            Recall a change
            Recall a no-change
            Recall a failed change

is run as a bracket (the pc is given the first command, then the second  and
then the third and then the first and then the second, etc).

    The first command can be abbreviated to 1, the second  to  2,  and  the
third to 3.


    The W/S therefore would look like:

      12.32 2.8
a   _

failed   _  (note that each word of the command is
      cleared before clearing the command as
change   _  a whole)

no-change   _

recall    _ (F/N)

1.

      cleared

2.

      cleared

3.

      cleared

      12.49 2.6

1.    Mother went on
      holiday

2.    at school

3.    didn't sell bike

1.    moved to new house

2.    etc.

    After the session when the commands are written  out  in  full  on  the
Auditor's Report Form, the numbers are again  noted  so  that  the  C/S  can
refer to them.


    WHATEVER SYSTEM OF ABBREVIATION IS USED BY THE AUDITOR,  THE  WORKSHEET
MUST COMMUNICATE TO THE C/S WHAT ACTIONS WERE TAKEN DURING THE SESSION.
                                 LEGIBILITY

    Worksheets should be written legibly. They are never recopied.


    The Auditor should always read over his W/sheets before turning in  the
folder to the Case Supervisor and if any words or  letters  are  missing  or
cannot be read, they should be put in in block print, in red.


    Example:
                                    [pic]


    This can be overdone, to the extent that it is almost sarcasm.  At  the
most it should just run into one or  two  corrections  to  a  page.  If  the
Auditor is having to correct the page more than that he should learn how  to
write rapidly and legibly. See HCOB 3 Nov  71,  C/S  Series  66,  "Auditor's
Worksheets", which also appears as Auditor Admin Series 15  and  comes  next
in this series.

                           NECESSITY OF WORKSHEETS

    It is a CRIME to give any session without making  an  Auditor's  Report
(i.e. actual W/S taken at that time) or to copy the original W/sheets  after
the session and submit a copy instead of the real reports.


    Assist Reports that use only Contact or Touch Assist are written  after
the session and sent to HGC Admin to be filed in the pc folder.  The  pc  is
sent to the Examiner after an assist.

References:      HCO P/L 19 Nov 65 "Auditing Reports"
            HCO B 7 May 69 "Summary of How to Write an Auditor's Report"
            Tape 12 June 71 "Welcome to the Flag Intern Course"
            HCO B 3 Nov 71 C/S Series 66, "Auditor's Worksheets"
            Tape 7 April 72 Exp Dn Tape 3, "Auditor Administration"


                                        Compiled by
                                        Training & Services Bur

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:HE:AL:MH:MM:mh.rd.jh
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 3 NOVEMBER 1971
Remimeo
                        Re-issued 6 November 1972 as

                           Auditor Admin Series 15

                                C/S Series 66


                            AUDITOR'S WORKSHEETS


    A very fast way for a C/S to do himself in is to fail to insist on GOOD
LEGIBLE HANDWRITING.


    When a C/S has auditors who can't  write  well  and  rapidly,  he  gets
misunderstood words when he tries to read the worksheets.


    One temporary solution is to make the auditor block print the  word  in
red above each hard to read word. Some auditors go to an  extreme  of  block
printing the whole WIS.


    The more permanent solution is to have Auditors  in  Cramming  practice
writing WELL and CLEARLY no matter how  slowly  and  then,  maintaining  the
same clarity, speed it up. The auditor after  many  such  practice  sessions
winds up writing clearly and fast. This can be increased  until  an  auditor
can write clearly as fast as people talk.


    The occasional headaches a C/S might get are not from the restim of the
case he's studying but are from the words on W/Ses he can't make out.


    If a C/S does not insist on both block print clarification and  auditor
writing practice, he will wind up not reading worksheets and  may  even  get
foggy about certain cases.


    A remedy is to go back to the first folders not understood and get  the
words clarified and then keep this C/S Series HCO B IN.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


PS: In the 19th Century secretaries  wrote  beautiful  copperplate  longhand
faster than a man could talk. So don't say it can't be done.











LRH :nt.kjm.rd
Copyright � 1971, 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              7 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                   Issue I
                  Revised & Reissued 12 August 1974 as BTB
                        (Revision in this type style)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 7 NOVEMBER 1972
                                   Issue I
                                 SAME TITLE


                          Auditor Admin Series 16R

                              CORRECTION LISTS


    A Correction List is a list of prepared questions on  a  mimeoed  sheet
which is used by the Auditor for  the  repair  of  a  particular  situation,
action or rundown.


    If a Correction List is used it must be stapled  at  the  back  of  the
W/Sheets.


    The Correction List must not be omitted and  must  be  in  the  session
reports so the C/S can look at the original assessment.


    If a Correction List is not completely handled in one  session,  it  is
not stapled as above but left free. It is stapled to the worksheets  of  the
session in which its handling is completed.

                         RELATION TO WORKSHEET ADMIN

    When using a Correction List, the number of the question being  handled
is marked on the W/Sheet.


    Example:


    On an L1C question 2 "Has a withhold been missed?" reads.


    WORKSHEET:

                 L1C
            2.   SF
      Well I took the money and etc, etc.

    The List is marked to show it is handled.


    Example:

    1.      Has there been an error in listing?
            (If this reads change to L4BR at once) X
    2.      Has a withhold been missed? SF to F/N
    3.      Has some emotion been rejected? X
    4.      etc.

References:      HCO B 3 July 71 "Auditing by Lists Revised"
            BTB  11 Aug 72R C/S Series 83R, "Correction Lists"

                                        Compiled by
                                        Training & Services Bur
      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow
      Authorized by AVU
BDCS:HE:AL:MH:MM:mh.rd.jh    for the
Copyright � 1972, 1974 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 1 DECEMBER 1974
Remimeo


                           WORD CLEARING LISTS FOR
                               PREPARED LISTS

                 Reference:  LRH ED 257 INT
                                        DELIVERY REPAIR LISTS


    Here is the list of prepared lists with their word clearing lists.

PREPARED LIST    WC LIST

HCO B 24 Nov 73RA      BTB 9 Apr 72RA, Issue VII
C/S Series 53RI  Revised 1 Dec 74
SHORT HI-LO TA   CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
ASSESSMENT C/S   SCIENTOLOGY-C/S SERIES 53RI

HCO B I Jan 72RA BTB 9 Apr 72RA, Issue IX
LIX HI-LO TA LIST      Revised 1 Dec 74
REVISED     CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
      SCIENTOLOGY-LIX HI-LO TA
      LIST REVISED

HCO B 29 Oct 71 R      BTB 9 Apr 72R, Issue X
INT RUNDOWN CORRECTION CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
LIST REVISED     SCIENTOLOGY-INT RUNDOWN
      CORRECTION LIST REVISED

HCO B 15 Dec 68R BTB 9 Apr 72R, Issue V
L4BR  CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
      SCIENTOLOGY-L4BR

HCO B 19 Mar 71  BTB 9 Apr 72, Issue VI
L 1 C CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
      SCIENTOLOGY-L 1 C

HCO B 11 Apr 71 RA     BTB 28 Apr 74
L3RD  DIANETICS-CLEARING LISTS
      AND R3R

HCO B 2 Apr 72RB, Issue II   BTB 3 Apr 72R, Issue I
Expanded Dianetics Series 3RB     EXPANDED DIANETICS SERIES 2R
L3 EXD RB   CLEARING LISTS AND R3R

HCO B 29 Feb 72R -----
FALSE TA CHECKLIST

HCO B 16 Apr 72  BTB 1 Dec 74, Issue VII
PTS RD CORRECTION LIST CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
      SCIENTOLOGY-PTS RD
      CORRECTION LIST

HCO PL 7 Apr 70RA      BTB 9 Apr 72RA, Issue I
GREEN FORM  Revised 1 Dec 74
      CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
      SCIENTOLOGY-GREEN FORM
PREPARED LIST    WC LIST

HCO B 30 June 71 BTB 9 Apr 72R, Issue III
EXPANDED GF 40 RR      CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
      SCIENTOLOGY-EXPANDED
      GF 40 RR

HCO B 15 Nov 73R -----
FEAR OF PEOPLE LIST-R

HCO B 15 Nov 74  BTB 15 Nov 74
STUDENT REHABILITATION LIST  CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
      SCIENTOLOGY-STUDENT
      REHABILITATION LIST

HCO B 4 Feb 72RC BTB 9 Apr 72R, Issue XI
STUDY CORRECTION LIST  CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
REVISED-Study Series 7 SCIENTOLOGY-STUDY
      CORRECTION LIST REVISED

HCO B 27 Mar 72, Issue I     BTB 1 Dec 74, Issue II
STUDENT CORRECTION LIST      CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
-STUDY CORR LIST 1     SCIENTOLOGY-STUDENT
      CORRECTION LIST

HCO B 27 Mar 72R, Issue II   BTB 1 Dec 74, Issue III
COURSE SUPERVISOR CORRECTION CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
LIST-STUDY CORR LIST 2 SCIENTOLOGY-COURSE
      SUPERVISOR CORRECTION LIST

HCO B 27 Mar 72, Issue III   BTB 1 Dec 74, Issue IV
AUDITOR CORRECTION LIST      CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
-STUDY CORR LIST 3     SCIENTOLOGY-AUDITOR
      CORRECTION LIST

HCO B 27 Mar 72, Issue IV    BTB 1 Dec 74, Issue V
CASE SUPERVISOR CORRECTION   CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
LIST-STUDY CORR LIST 4RA     SCIENTOLOGY-CASE SUPERVISOR
      CORRECTION LIST

HCO B 27 Mar 72, Issue V     BTB 1 Dec 74, Issue VI
EXECUTIVE CORRECTION LIST    CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
-STUDY CORR LIST 5     SCIENTOLOGY-EXECUTIVE
      CORRECTION LIST

HCO B 21 July 71RC     BTB 9 Apr 72R, Issue IV
WORD CLEARING CORRECTION     CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
LIST REVISED     SCIENTOLOGY-WORD CLEARING
      CORRECTION LIST

HCO PL 9 Apr 72  -----
ETHICS-CORRECT DANGER
CONDITION HANDLING (Danger
Assessment, Long Form and
Short Form)

HCO PL 13 Mar 72 -----
Esto Series 5-PRODUCTION
AND ESTABLISHMENT-ORDERS
AND PRODUCTS (Product
Clearing Short Form)
PREPARED LIST    WC LIST

HCO PL 23 Mar 72 -----
Esto Series 11-FULL PRODUCT
CLEARING LONG FORM

HCO PL 12 June 72      -----
Data Series 26, Esto Series 18
LENGTH OF TIME TO EVALUATE
(Slow Eval Assessment)

HCO B 28 Aug 70RA      BTB 9 Apr 72R, Issue VIII
HC OUT-POINT PLUS-POINT      Revised 30 Nov 74
LISTS RA    CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
      SCIENTOLOGY-HC OUT-POINT
      PLUS-POINT LISTS

HCO B 2 Dec 74   BTB 1 Dec 74, Issue VIII
DYNAMIC SORT OUT ASSESSMENT  CLEARING LIST WORDS IN
(Revised from BTB 4 Dec 71,  SCIENTOLOGY-DYNAMIC SORT
Issue II, Replacing HCO B 4 Dec 7 1,    OUT ASSESSMENT
Issue II, R-1C Assessment
by Dynamics)

                                 __________


    KEEP THESE LISTS IN SUPPLY FOR USE. TRAIN AUDITORS TO MAKE THESE  LISTS
READ. USE THEM FOR RAVE RESULTS AND YOU WILL SEE A GOLDEN  ERA  OF  TECH  IN
YOUR ORG.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED



















[Auditor Admin Series 17, HCO B 7 November 1972, Issue  II,  Clearing-Lists,
gave a short summary  of  Correction  Lists  and  the  Clearing  Lists  that
corresponded to them and it gave some of the admin  for  Clearing-Lists.  It
was cancelled by BTB 10 December 1974, Issue IX, Cancellation  of  Bulletins
1972,1973, 1974, which says to see the above HCO B 1 December 1974.]
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              7 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue III
                   Revised & Reissued 28 July 1974 as BTB
                        (Revision in this type sty/e)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 7 NOVEMBER 1972
                                  Issue III
                                 SAME TITLE

                          Auditor Admin Series 18R

                                  L&N LISTS


    An L&N List (Listing and Nulling List) is a list of Items given by a pc
in response to a Listing Question and written down by  the  Auditor  in  the
exact sequence that they are given to him by the preclear.


    An L&N List is always done on a separate sheet.


    It's best to do an L&N List on faint-lined paper.


    The pc's name and date are put on the top of the sheet.


    The listing question is  written  out,  usually  before  the  start  of
session.


    When the listing question is checked the read is marked by the question
(sF, F, LF, LFBD). If Suppress or Inval is used that is also noted.


    As each item is given by the pc the reads are marked-sF, F,  LF,  LFBD.
This is done AS YOU LIST. If the item does not read you mark it with an X.


    TA is noted periodically as the pc lists, and especially  when  the  TA
rises.


    The LFBD F/N item is circled. If indicated to the pc it is marked IND.


    When extending a list a line is drawn from where it has  been  extended
with the date.

    Example:     Item  Joe X
            Shoes sF
            Socks X
                                _________________    Ext 24.2.72


            Sky X
            Wax X
            Pigs etc etc.

    L&N Lists are never stapled to the W/S but are paper-clipped under  the
session reports.


                            CORRECTING L&N LISTS

    Old lists are NOT TO BE COPIED.


    They are to be corrected in their original form but using  a  different
coloured pen to show what has been done-always date new uses of these  lists
also using the same colour pen as used for renulling or addition to them.
When a list is pulled forward to correct it, a sheet of  paper  is  left  at
that date giving the data of the Listing Question and the date it is  pulled
forward to, so it can be easily located.


    The corrected lists are left with the session reports of the session in
which they were corrected. A note  in  red  is  made  in  the  F/S  of  this
correction.

                             R3RING AN L&N ITEM

    If an L&N Item is later R3Red it should be so  noted  on  the  list  by
adding: "R3R TRIPLED (date)".

References:      HCO B       30 Sept 68      "Lists"

      HCO B      19 Sept 68  "Old Lists"

      HCO B      7 May 69    "Summary of How to Write an
                                  Auditor's Report"

      BTB   20 Aug 70R       "Two Complete Differences
                                  Assessment-Listing and Nulling"


                                        Compiled by
                                        Training & Services Bur

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:HE:AL:MH:MM:mh.rd.jh
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              7 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue IV
                   Revised & Reissued 27 July 1974 as BTB
                        (Revision in this type style)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 7 NOVEMBER 1972
                                  Issue IV
                                 SAME TITLE

                          Auditor Admin Series 19R

                          DIANETIC ASSESSMENT LISTS

    A Dianetic Assessment List is a list of Somatics/Items given  by  a  Pc
and written down by the Auditor with the reads  marked  that  occur  on  the
Meter.


    A Dn Assessment List is always done on a separate sheet.


    The Pc's name and the date are put on the top of the sheet.


    The assessment question is noted.


    In the Dianetic assessment the read is taken when the Pc first says the
Item and this is written down next to the Item. Suppress and  Inval  buttons
can be put in on an unreading Item if needed. This is noted on the list.


    If interest is asked of the Pc this is noted by the Item. (Drug  Items,
intentions and  Evil  Purposes  are  automatically  run  if  they  read  and
interest is not asked.)

                             POSITION IN FOLDER

    These Lists are not stapled to the W/sheets but are paper clipped under
the W/sheets the same as L&N Lists.


    In Exp Dn, PSEA lists (possible 4 separate lists) coming from the  same
subject can be stapled together and then paper clipped as above.

                                 R3R'D ITEMS

    Items on the list that are R3R'd should be  circled  and  marked:  "R3R
TRIPLED (date)."


    Details of the Dn Assessment List and all Items on it  run  R3R  Triple
are noted IN FULL on the Folder Summary.

References:      HCO B       29 Apr 69  "Assessment and Interest"
            HCO B      21 May 69  "Assessment"
            HCO B      28 Feb 71  C/S Series 24, "Metering Reading Items"
            HCO B      13 Sept 72        Exp  Dn  Series  12,  "Catastrophes
from
                 and Repair of 'No Interest' Items"

                                        Compiled by
                                        Training & Services Bur

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
BDCS:HE:AL:MH:MM:mh.rd.jh    for the
Copyright � 1972, 1974 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              7 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                   Issue V
                 Revised & Reissued 20 November 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 7 NOVEMBER 1972
                                   Issue V
                                 SAME TITLE

                       (Revisions in this type style)


                          Auditor Admin Series 20R


                            MISCELLANEOUS REPORTS


    A Miscellaneous Report is a report such as an  MO  Report,  a  D  of  P
Inteview, an Ethics Report, a Success Story, etc, which is put in  the  pc's
folder and gives a C/S more information about a case.


    It is the responsibility of HGC Admin to see that Miscellaneous Reports
get into the folder.


    It is the Auditor's responsibility to enter these details in the Folder
Summary.

                              D OF P INTERVIEWS

    D of P Interviews are always done on a meter, and the report  from  the
interview is filed in the folder.

                                  DECLARE?

    When a person goes to Declare? and  through  lines,  the  Exam  Report,
Attestation and Success Story are stapled together and go into  the  folder.
The fact is noted in the Folder Summary.

                                 MIS-DECLARE

    A pc who will not Declare? or who does not have F/N VGIs on a  Declare?
examination is not sent through to Certs and Awards.


    The folder is sent through to the  Senior  C/S  or  Qual  Sec  and  any
outnesses are located and the C/S and Auditor get cramming.


    The folder is then sent back to the C/S and the HGC to handle.


    The fact of a mis-declare is noted in red on the Folder Summary.


    Corrective actions on persons sent incorrectly to Declare? are  rapidly
handled with no delay to the pc as he is Red-Tagged.

                               CRAMMING ORDERS

    Tech Cramming Orders are written in duplicate. The original goes direct
to the Cramming Officer and the second in the pc folder.


    By leaving a copy in the folder the corrective actions given an Auditor
can be viewed.
When the folder arrives at a  Senior  Org  the  Flub  Catch  System  can  be
activated on the C/S as well as the Auditor.

References: HCO B      6 Oct 70   C/S Series 19, "Folder Error Summaries"
            BPL        4 Sept 72  "Cramming Admin & Lines"
            BTB  12 Dec 71R  C/S Series 69, "Mandatory C/Sing Checklist"

                           MEDICAL OFFICER REPORTS

    A pc goes to the MO via the Examiner. The Pc Examiner  makes  a  carbon
copy of any Medical Exam Report  and  gives  it  to  the  MO  and  gets  the
original to Tech Services quickly.


    This must get into the folder so the C/S does not order a major  action
done on a sick pc.


    While the pc is on MO lines, reports from  the  MO  get  filed  in  the
folder.


    The pc when going off MO lines goes to the Examiner and the "now  well"
Exam report goes over to Tech Services who puts it in the pc's folder.

References:      Tape 4 Mar 71, "Short Conference  of  the  C/S  Policy  and
Tech Lines"
            Flag Ship Order 259, 3 Mar 71, "Current C/S Policy"

                               ETHICS REPORTS

    When an Auditor finds an Ethics Situation he should mark it and  circle
it in red after the session. The pc is not necessarily turned in  because  a
pc cannot be tried on his auditing, it's illegal,  but  the  Auditor  should
make mention of it on his Auditor's C/S.


    If it is a serious Ethics Situation that affects others, then it is the
Auditor's responsibility to report it.


    The Auditor would make out the report with a carbon copy. He marks it

                          "SESSION KNOWLEDGE REPORT
                       NON-ACTIONABLE ON (pc's name)"

and makes out the report. Both copies  are  left  in  the  folder.  The  C/S
initials the one for Ethics and sends it on. The other stays in the folder.

    Sometimes one finds another person's offences than the pc's in  getting
off  withholds.  These  when  serious  should  be  reported  to  Ethics  for
investigation.


    Pcs can be sent to Ethics (i.e. for PTS handling, Court of  Ethics  for
refusing to answer an Auditing Question, etc, etc) but  the  following  rule
applies:


    THERE IS NO DIRECT ROUTING OF PRECLEARS TO THE  ETHICS  OFFICER  EXCEPT
THROUGH THE CHANNELS OF THE QUALIFICATIONS DIVISION.


    When the C/S decides to send  the  pc  to  Ethics,  he  marks  a  small
goldenrod card "ETH", clips it to the folder and sends  the  folder  to  the
Examiner.


    The Examiner checks over the folder, and calls pc in via Qual  I&I  for
an Examination. If  folder  not  okay,  it  is  returned  to  the  C/S  with
appropriate Cramming Orders.


    If all is correct the Examiner sends the pc direct to Ethics.


    If not, pc is routed back to the  HGC  and  the  Examiner  or  Cramming
Officer writes up the required Cramming Orders.
When pc has finished his Ethics Cycle he is routed back to the Examiner  and
is returned to the HGC via Qual I & I.


    It is D of P's responsibility to keep a tension line in with Ethics  to
make sure the Ethics cycle is completed and  the  pc  is  returned  to  Tech
lines.


    If the pc is returned to HGC lines for a PTS situation to be handled by
auditing, a small yellow card is clipped to the outside  of  the  folder  by
the C/S until the pc finishes the PTS R/D.


    All data about such actions are filed in the folder, including  a  copy
of the Ethics Officer Interview notes.


    It is the responsibility of HGC Admin to see that Conditions Orders and
Ethics Orders that affect the preclear's auditing progress get  put  in  the
pc's folder for the C/S to see.


    Cases undergoing Ethics actions,  Comm  Evs,  amends  projects  or  low
conditions should not be audited until the Ethics matter is cleared  up  and
complete. It only louses up their  cases  to  audit  them  when  under  such
stress.


    Pcs in lowered conditions should be  encouraged  to  work  out  of  the
condition and when they reach Emergency the auditing may be resumed.


    Details of these Ethics cycles should be entered by the Auditor in  the
Folder Summary.

References: HCO P/L    19 Apr 65  "Ethics"
      HCO P/L    29 Apr 65   "Ethics-Review"
      HCO P/L    4 July 65   "Pc Routing Review Code"
      HCO P/L    1 May 65    "Staff Member Reports"
      HCO P/L    17 Jun 65   "Staff Auditor Advices"
      HCO P/L    30 July 65  "Pc Routing to Ethics"
      HCO P/L    16 Nov 71   "Conditions, Awards and Penances"
      Tape  7 April 72 Exp Dn Tape 3 "Auditor Administration"
      HCO B 29 Mar 70  "Auditing and Ethics"


      Compiled by:
      Training & Services Bureau

      Corrected by CS-5
      Ens. Judy Ziff

      Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

      I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow

      Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:Bof I:AL:MH:JZ:BL:MM:mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              8 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                   Issue I
                   Revised & Reissued 6 August 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 8 NOVEMBER 1972
                                   Issue I
                                 SAME TITLE

                   (The only Revision is under References:
                   the Revision date of HCO B 21 April 71
                      has been revised to read-"Revised
                      14 May 72, Revised 8 April 74".)


                          Auditor Admin Series 21R


                           THE DIANETIC FLOW TABLE


    The Dn Flow Table is  a  chronological  list  of  Dn  Items  run,  from
earliest to latest, with the flows that have been run.

    Here is an example of the way to do it:

DATE  ITEM  F-1  F-2   F-3

2 Feb 62    Guf Shoulder     Unflat

3 Feb 62    Gow in Foot      EP

29 Sept 67  Chow in Chump    EP   Unflat     Unflat
                 Repaired to EP   Repaired to EP
                 2 Oct 70 (red)   2 Oct 70 (red)
30 Sept 69  LX Anger   Unflat

      LX Peeved  Unflat

4 Oct 70    Feeling Numb     EP   EP       EP

16 Dec 70   Ext/Int R/D     Sec   EP    EP      Unflat

                           Eng    EP    EP      EP

3 May 72    Intention to     EP   EP       EP
      fall off a log

    Any flow that is later repaired is marked on the table in  a  different
colour, with the date.


    The Flow Table is kept at the back of the folder for reference and use.

References: HCO B 21 April 71RA (Revised 14 May 72, Revised 8 April 74)
      "C/S Series 36RA, Dianetics".

                                        Compiled by
                                        Training & Services Bur
      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow
      Authorized by AVU
BDCS:HE:AL:MH:MM:mh.rd.jh    for the
Copyright � 1972, 1974 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

Remimeo     8 NOVEMBER 1972RA
FES Units   Issue II
C/S Hats    Revised 4 June 1975

                         Auditor Admin Series 22 RA

                           FOLDER ERROR SUMMARIES

                 Ref:  HCO B 6 Oct 70   C/S Series 19,
                                        "Folder Error Summaries"
                       TAPE   7 Apr 72  Ex Dn Tape 3,
                                        "Auditor Administration"

         (NOTE: Data for this revision was taken from LRH's written
                reply to a letter from former Tech C/S ASHO.)

                            TWO METHODS OF FESing

    There are two methods of FESing a case. The first is  a  full  detailed
FES where one goes back and picks up and notes down all past errors  on  the
case so that a Progress and Advance Program can be done.


    Where the C/S is interested in handling  the  case  more  rapidly,  the
procedure is to go back to where the Pc was running well and  come  forward,
looking for the goofs to repair. This would also apply in the case of  a  Pc
who, already repaired, was goofed in further auditing. These  are  different
FES methods-a Progress Program  and  Repair  C/Sing.  Neither  one  includes
Admin errors or errors which do not affect the case.

                                  THE FLAW

    Folder Error Summaries (FESes) which do not  show  clearly  whether  an
error has been corrected later in the Pc's auditing, can lead the  C/S  into
over-repair. Such a flaw lessens the usefulness of an FES.

                                 NEW FORMAT

    To handle the above flaw, the layout and contents of the FES have  been
revised. The following is the format of the FES which should be on legal  or
equivalent size pink or red paper according to availability.


                                    [pic]


    One can see at a glance that all the noted errors have been  corrected.
A blank space in the right-hand column would indicate  that  the  error  had
not yet been fixed.
This column is filled in by the FESer as he goes along, or  by  the  Auditor
as correction is done. For example  a  note:  "Chronic  high  TA"  would  be
marked off by the Auditor "C/S 53RJ to F/N List. TA normal" with  the  date,
when that action had been completed.


    Any error noted in the correction of the case IS NOTED AS A  NEW  ERROR
ON THE FES.


    THE FES IS KEPT IN PT BY THE AUDITOR AS ERRORS ARE NOTED.


    The C/S will use the FES as a help in further programming of the Pc.


    It is kept in the inside back cover of the Pc's folder.

                          WHAT IS WANTED IN AN FES

    An FES should contain those points of error in the auditing of  a  case
which might cause the Pc future difficulty or may  require  handling.  These
would include rundowns left unflat or with missing steps;  signs  of  unflat
grades; absence of any of the parts of EP, noting what was  being  run;  any
chronic problem or difficulty; by-passed  EP  on  any  rundown;  illness  or
ethics trouble after an auditing cycle.


    The most important points which can bog a case are well covered in  the
C/S Series, with which an FESer should be familiar.  In  particular,  anyone
doing an FES must know very well C/S Series 1, 2, 15, 19, 29,  30,  34,  38,
59. He must be able to recognize  and  pick  out  any  of  the  case  errors
described in the above issues.


    Anyone doing FES work must be thoroughly  familiar  with  the  GF40XRR.
Anything on the case which falls under any of  the  headings  on  this  list
should also be clearly noted in the FES, "Pc was a  member  of  black  magic
society" could be the thing which is stalling her case.


                              WHAT ISN'T WANTED

    An FES is NOT the same as  an  FS.  The  2  must  not  be  combined  or
confused.


    Opinions have no part in FES.


    Do not note admin errors in an FES.


    Any error which is not part of the case or its auditing has no place on
the FES.


    It can be the subject of a chit or separate report.


    Examples of this would be: "Auditor did not fill in the Folder Summary"
or "Pc not being audited on any program" or "No-one C/Sing the folder".


    Statements which R/Sed, and Ev Purps  given  off  by  the  Pc  are  not
usually noted in an FES. THE FACT THAT HE DOES R/S,  OR  DOES  GIVE  OFF  EV
PURPS MUST BE NOTED ON THE LEFT-HAND EDGE OF THE PC'S TOPMOST PROGRAM.


    R/S statements (which the Pc said that R/Sed when he said  it)  and  Ev
Purps are noted on the Pgm in red ink and may be noted on the FS.


    Dianetic chains that did not go to EP, flows not run, are  noted  on  a
Full Flow Table, not on the FES. The fact that a series of items was run  F1
only, or did not EP, is  noted on the FES, to be marked off when corrected.


    A C/S and his FES unit work closely together and the C/S would  usually
apprentice these people until they can very rapidly and accurately FES  even
a thick folder.


      Revised by Marion Kimmich
      Flag Tech Comps I/C

      for W/O Ron Shafran, CS-4

      Approved by
BDCS:RS:MK:nt jh Commodore's Staff Aides and
Copyright � 1972, 1975 the Board of Issues
by L. Ron Hubbard.     for the BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    of the CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              8 NOVEMBER 1972RA
                                  Issue III
                   Revised & Reissued 13 July 1974 as BTB
                          Revised 20 November 1974
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                           BTB OF 8 NOVEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue III
                                 SAME TITLE

                            (Paragraphs 6, 7 & 8
                             have been revised)


                         Auditor Admin Series 23 RA


                        INVOICE FORM AND ROUTING FORM


    The Form of Board PL 3 Jan 72 (Revised) is stapled to the  inside  back
cover of the pc's current folder by HGC Admin.

                           PC BEGINNING INTENSIVE

    When a pc signs up and pays for auditing he arrives at  the  HGC  Admin
with a Routing Form and a Pink Invoice Copy.


    The Invoice is used for pc scheduling, verification of  payment  before
delivery of service, and preparation of the weekly income report.


    The Invoice does not go into the pc auditing folder  and  must  not  be
lost as this could prevent scheduling, delivery of  service,  or  result  in
auditing without payment.


    The Invoice details are filled in on the Form  (see  attached)  at  the
back of the folder.


    The Invoice is placed in the basket of invoices for the  weekly  income
breakdown sheet, and afterwards filed in a weekly  envelope  with  the  Tech
copy of the weekly income breakdown sheet in Tech Services.


    Advance payment invoices received are filed alphabetically in files  in
Tech Services. When the invoice  indicating  final  payment  of  service  is
received, all related invoices for that person and service  are  pulled  out
of the alphabetical AP files and stapled to the final payment  invoice,  and
the name and date  of  expected  arrival  posted  up  on  a  board  in  Tech
Services.  The  invoices  are  filed  alphabetically  in  a   special   file
containing only paid up invoices, which are the Tech  Div  "hot"  files  for
new students and pcs.


    The Routing Form is paper-clipped to the front of the folder.


    The Auditor enters the Intensive Hours paid (i.e. 121/2 or 25)  on  his
next Auditor's Report Form and keeps a running total of hours  used  on  the
succeeding Auditor's Report Forms.

                          PC RUNS OUT OF PAID HOURS

    When the pc's used total approaches close to the Intensive Hours  paid,
the Auditor puts a note on the front of the folder to  HGC  Admin  to  route
the pc to buy more hours.
HGC Admin routes the pc through lines to buy more hours.


    These particulars are noted on the Invoice Form. (See attached form for
example.)

                          FREE SERVICE = FREE FALL

    AN AUDITOR CONTINUING TO AUDIT A PERSON OVER AND ABOVE  THE  AMOUNT  OF
HOURS SIGNED AND PAID FOR, AND WHO  DOES  NOT  SEND  THAT  PC  BACK  TO  THE
REGISTRAR  FOR  SIGN-UP  AND  PAYMENT  OF  ADDITIONAL  HOURS  IN  ORDER   TO
SUCCESSFULLY COMPLETE THE AUDITING PGM, IS GUILTY OF

    A.      COVERTLY ROBBING HIS FELLOW STAFF MEMBERS OF THEIR PAY, AND


    B.      IN A CONDITION OF DOUBT TO HIS ORG, AND IS SO ASSIGNED.

    SIMILARLY, AN AUDITOR CONTINUING TO AUDIT A STAFF MEMBER OVER AND ABOVE
THE AMOUNT OF HOURS SIGNED AND INVOICED FOR, AND WHO DOES NOT  SEND  THE  PC
BACK TO THE REGISTRAR  AND  CASHIER  FOR  SIGN-UP  AND  DEBIT  INVOICING  OF
ADDITIONAL HOURS IN ORDER TO SUCCESSFULLY  COMPLETE  THE  AUDITING  PGM,  IS
GUILTY OF A AND B ABOVE.

    Invoices for staff services must carry the mention:

                                "STAFF DEBIT
                       Amount due in full in the event
                         of staff contract breakage"

and be accompanied by a signed promissory note for the full  amount  of  the
service.

    An Auditor using the Invoice Form in conjunction with the running total
of hours on his Auditor's Report Form will  comfortably  know  the  position
with regard to used up hours.

References: HCO PL     28 Aug 62  "How to Write an Auditor's Report"
      BPL   3 Jan 72   "Invoices"
      BPL   22 Dec 71  "Free Services = Free Fall"
      BPL   22 Dec 71-1      (Addition 12 Oct 72) "Free Services =
                 Free Fall"

      Compiled by:
      Training & Services Bureau

      Revised by CS-5
      Ens. Judy Ziff

      In co-ordination with
      Flag Mission 1234

      I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow

      Commodore's Staff Aides
      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:BL:MM:mh.rd    of the
Copyright � 1972, 1974 CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
[pic]
























































                            Basic Auditing Series
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 23 MAY 1971R
                                   Issue I
                           REVISED 4 DECEMBER 1974
Remimeo
Auditors
Supervisors (Revision in this type style)
Students
Tech & Qual

                          Basic Auditing Series 1R


                    THE MAGIC OF THE COMMUNICATION CYCLE

                     From the LRH Tape 6 February 1964,
                          "Comm Cycle in Auditing"


    If you look  over  communication  you  will  find  that  the  magic  of
communication is about the only thing that makes auditing work.


    The Thetan in this universe has begun to consider himself mest and  has
begun to consider himself mass and the being that considers himself mass  of
course responds to the laws of electronics and the laws  of  Newton.  He  is
actually incapable of generating very much or as-ising very much.


    An individual considers himself mesty or massy and therefore he has  to
have a second terminal. A second  terminal  is  required  to  discharge  the
energy.


    Here we have two poles. We have an auditor and a pc and as long as  the
auditor audits and the pc replies we get an  exchange  of  energy  from  the
pc's point of view.


    Many auditors think they are being a second terminal to the degree that
they pick up the somatics and illnesses of the  pc.  Actually  there  is  no
backflow of any kind that hits the auditor but if he is  so  convinced  that
he is mest he will turn on somatics in echo  of  the  pc.  Actually  nothing
hits the auditor, it has to be mocked up or envisioned by him.


    You have set up in essence a two pole system and that will bring  about
an as-ising of mass.


    It isn't burning the mass, it is as-ising the mass and that's why there
is nothing hitting the auditor.


    Now that is the  essence  of  the  situation.  The  magic  involved  in
auditing is contained in the communication cycle of auditing.  You  see  now
you are handling the SMOOTH INTERCHANGE BETWEEN THESE TWO POLES.


    When you look over the difficulties of auditing realize  that  you  are
handling simply the difficulties of the communication  cycle  and  when  you
yourself as the auditor do not  permit  A  SMOOTH  FLOW  BETWEEN  YOU  AS  A
TERMINAL AND THE PC AS A TERMINAL, AND THE PC AS A  TERMINAL  BACK  TO  YOU,
you get a no as-ising of mass. So you don't get TA action.


    Part of the trick of course is what has to be as-ised and how do you go
about it, but that we call technique-(what button has  to  be  pressed).  We
find, oddly enough, if the auditor is actually  capable  of  making  the  pc
willing to talk to him, he wouldn't have to hit a button  to  get  tone  arm
action. (He cannot make the pc get  tone  arm  action  basically  because  a
communication cycle doesn't exist )
The person who is insisting continuously upon a new technique is  neglecting
the basic  tool  of  his  auditing  which  is  the  communication  cycle  of
auditing.


    When the communication cycle does not exist in an auditing  session  we
get this horrible compounding of a felony of trying to get  a  technique  to
work  but  the  technique  cannot  be  administered  because  there  is   no
communication cycle to administer it.


    Basic auditing is called basic auditing  because it goes PRIOR  to  the
technique.


    A communication cycle must exist  before the technique can exist.


    The fundamental entrance to the case is not on a level of the technique
but is on a level of the communication cycle.


    Communication is simply a familiarization process based  on  reach  and
withdraw.


    When you speak to a pc you are reaching. When you cease  to  speak  you
are withdrawing. When he hears you, he's at that moment a bit withdrawn  but
then he reaches toward you with the answer.


    You'll see him go into a withdraw while he thinks it all over. Then  he
reaches the reason. Now he will reach the auditor with  the  reason  and  he
will say that was it.


    You have made an exchange from the pc to the auditor and  will  see  it
reflect on the meter because that exchange now  is  giving  an  as-ising  of
energy.


    IN THE ABSENCE OF THAT COMMUNICATION YOU DO NOT GET METER ACTION.


    So THE FUNDAMENTAL OF AUDITING IS THE COMMUNICATION CYCLE. That's   the
fundamental  of  auditing  and  that  is  really  the  great   discovery  of
Dianetics and Scientology.


    It's such a simple discovery but you realize that nobody knew  anything
about it.


      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder


LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 23 MAY 1971 R
Remimeo     Issue II
Auditors
Supervisors REVISED 6 DECEMBER 1974
Students
Tech & Qual
                          Basic Auditing Series 2R


                          THE TWO PARTS OF AUDITING
                       From the LRH Tape 2 July 1964,
                        "O/W Modernised and Reviewed"

    In order to do something for somebody you have to have a  communication
line to that person.


    Communication lines depend upon reality and communication and  affinity
and where an individual is too demanding the affinity tends  to  break  down
slightly.


    Processing goes in two stages.

      1.    To get into communication with that  which  you  are  trying  to
process.

      2.    Do something for him.

    There is many a pc who will go around raving about his  auditor,  whose
auditor has not done anything for  the pc. All that has happened is  that  a
tremendous communication line has been established with the pc and  this  is
so novel and so strange to the pc that  he  then  considers  that  something
miraculous has occurred.


    Something miraculous has occurred but in this particular  instance  the
auditor has totally neglected why he formed that communication line  in  the
first place. He formed it in the first place to do something for the pc.


    He very often mistakes the fact that  he  has  formed  a  communication
line, and the reaction on the pc for his  having  formed  one,  with  having
done  something for the pc.


    There are two stages.

    1.      Form a communication line.


    2.      Do something for the pc.

    Those are the two distinct stages. It is something like (1) Walking  up
to the bus, and (2) Driving off.  If  you  don't  drive  off  you  never  go
anyplace.


    It is a very tricky and no small thing to be able to communicate  to  a
human being who has  never  been  communicated  to  before.  This  is  quite
remarkable, and is such a remarkable feat that it appears to be  an  end-all
of Scientology to some.


    But you see that's just walking up to the bus. Now you have got  to  go
someplace.


    Any upset that the individual has is so poised,  it  is  so  delicately
balanced, that it is difficult to maintain.  /t  is  not  difficult  to  get
well. It is very hard to remain batty. A fellow has to work at it.


    If your communication line is very good and very  smooth  and  if  your
auditing discipline is perfect so you don't upset  this  communication  line
and if you just made a foray of no more  importance  than  saying  something
like-What are you doing that's sensible and why  is  it  sensible?-and  kept
your communication line up all the while and kept your affinity up with  the
pc all the while, did  it  with  perfect  discipline,  you  would  see  more
aberration fall to pieces per  square  inch  than  you  ever  thought  could
exist.


    Now that's what I mean when I say do something for the pc.
You must audit well, get  perfect  discipline  and  get  your  communication
cycle in. Don't ARC Break the pc, let your cycles of action complete.


    All of  that  is  simply  an  entrance.  You  see,  the  discipline  of
Scientology makes it possible to do this, and one of the reasons  why  other
fields of the mind never got anyplace and could never get near  anybody  was
because they couldn't communicate to anybody.


    So that discipline is important.


    That is the ladder that goes up to the door and if you can't get to the
door you can't do anything.


    The perfect discipline of which we  speak,  the  perfect  communication
cycle, the perfect auditor presence,  perfect  meter  reading-all  of  these
things are just to get you in  a  state  where  you  can  do  something  for
somebody.


    So when you're real slow picking up the discipline, real  slow  picking
up keeping in the communication cycle, when you're pokey on the subject  you
are still 9 miles from the ball. You're not even attending yet.


    What you want to be able to do is audit perfectly. By that we mean keep
in a communication cycle, be able to approach the pc, be  able  to  talk  to
the pc, and be able to maintain the ARC. Get the pc to give you  answers  to
your questions. Be able to read a meter and get the reactions.


    All of those things have to be awfully good because it's very difficult
to get a communication line in to somebody  anyway.  They  all  have  to  be
present and they all have to be perfect. If they are all  present  and  they
are all perfect, then we can start to process somebody. THEN  we  can  start
to process somebody.


    I'm giving you an entrance point here  of,  if  all  your  cycles  were
perfect, if you were able to sit there and confront the pc  and  meter  that
pc and keep your auditing report and do all these multiple  various  things,
and keep a pleasant smile on your face and not chop his communication,  well
then there is something you do with these things. It takes a process now.


    We used to have it all backwards. We used to try and teach people  what
they could do for somebody. But they could never get in  communication  with
him to do it, so therefore you had failures in processing.


    The  most  elementary  procedure  would  be-''What  do  you  think   is
sensible?"-or anything of that sort. The pc  says,  "Well,  I  think  horses
sleep in beds. That's sensible. '' The auditor says, "Alright.  Now  why  is
that sensible?"  The pc says, "Well ... ah  ....  Hey!  .  .  .  That's  not
sensible. That's nuts!"' You actually wouldn't  have  to  do  anything  more
than that He's cognited. You've flattened it. It's so easy to  do,  but  you
keep looking for some magic.


    Well, your magic is in getting into communication with the person.  The
rest is very easy to do, all you have to do is remain in communication  with
the  person  while  you  are  doing  this,  and  realize  that  these   huge
aberrations he's  got  are  poised  with  the  most  fantastically  delicate
balance on little pinheads. All you have  to  do  is  to  phooph  and  these
things crash.


    Now if you're not in communication with this person he doesn't cognite.
He takes it as an accusative action. He tries to justify thinking that  way.
He tries to make himself look good to you and  tries  to  put  on  a  public
front of some kind or another. He tries to hold up his status.


    Anytime I see a bunch of  pcs  around  who  want  to  jump  happily  to
something else because sane people run on  that  and  crazy  people  run  on
something else, and they never have to be run on  the  crazy  one,  I  right
away know their auditors  are  not  in  communication  with  them  and  that
auditing discipline itself has broken down  because  the  pc  is  trying  to
justify himself and  trying  to  uphold  his  own  status.  So  he  must  be
defending himself against the auditor.


    The auditor couldn't possibly be in communication with him.



So we are right back to the fundamental of why didn't the auditor  get  into
comm with the pc in the first place.


    You get into communication with the pc in  the  first  place  by  doing
proper Scientology discipline. That is not any trick. It goes off 1,  2,  3,
4.


    You sit down and you start the session and you start  handling  the  pc
and his problems and that sort of thing and you DO  IT  BY  COMPLETING  YOUR
COMMUNICATION CYCLES AND NOT CUTTING HIS COMMUNICATION-THE VERY  THINGS  YOU
ARE TAUGHT IN THE TRs, and you  find  you  are  in  communication  with  the
person. Now you've got to do something for the person.


    Unless, having gotten into communication,  you  do  something  for  the
person, you lose your communication line because the R-Factor of why  you're
in communication with the pc breaks down. He doesn't think you're  so  good,
and you go out of communication with him. That having happened,  the  person
will be in a sort of status defensive and wonder why he is being processed.


    On the other hand, if you have done something for the pc and he has had
his cognition, and you try and go on and get more TA action out of the  fact
that "all horses sleep in  beds"-you  don't  get  there  as  you've  already
flattened the process.


    You can over-audit and you can under-audit.


    If you don't notice that one answer come your way, that  indicates  you
have done something for the pc and if you keep  him  working  on  that  same
thing, your TA action will disappear, your pc will get resentful and  you'll
lose your communication line.


    He's already had the cognition you see. You are now  restimulating  the
pc. You have gotten your key-out destimulation factor-it has occurred  right
before your eyes. You have done something for the pc. One  more  mention  of
the subject and you've had it.


    There are a lot of things you could  do  with  the  pc,  without  doing
anything for him. You can turn on some very very handsome somatics on  a  pc
at one time or another without turning them off either.  You've  got  to  do
something for the pc, not to him.


    Now you can be doing something (A), and the pc is doing (B), and you go
on doing (A), while the pc is doing (B) then somewhere on down the line  you
wind up in a hell of a mess and you wonder what happened.


    Well the pc never did what you said so you didn't do anything  for  the
pc. There was in actual fact no barrier to your willingness to do  something
for  the  pc  but  there  must  have  been  a  tremendous  barrier  to  your
understanding of what was going on.


    That you could ask (A), while the pc answered (B), in itself showed the
auditor observation was  very  poor  so  therefore  the  auditor  wasn't  in
communication with the pc.


    So again the communication factor was out  and  once  more  we  weren't
doing anything for the pc.


    It requires of the auditor discipline  to  keep  in  his  communication
line. He has got to stay in communication with his  pc.  Those  cycles  have
got to be perfect. He can't be distracting the pc's attention onto  the  TA,
e.g.  "I'm  not  getting  any  TA  action  now."  That's  not   staying   in
communication with the pc-has nothing to do with it. You're distracting  the
pc from his own zones and areas.


    Don't put the pc's attention out of session. Keep him  going  and  keep
that communication line in. And the next  requirement  is  to  do  something
productive for the pc using the communication line.


      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder

LRH:nt.jh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                         HCO BULLETIN OF 23 MAY 1971
                                  Issue III
                          Reissued 1 December 1974
Remimeo
Auditors    CANCELS
Supervisors BTB OF 23 MAY 1971
Students    Issue III
Tech & Qual SAME TITLE


                           Basic Auditing Series 3


                   THE THREE IMPORTANT COMMUNICATION LINES

                        From the LRH Tape 15 Oct 63,
                          "Essentials of Auditing"

    When you are sitting in an auditing session what are  the  3  important
communication lines and what is their order of importance?

    1.      The first is the Pc's line to his bank. The Itsa Maker line.


    2.      The second is the Pc's line to the Auditor. The Itsa line.


    3.      The third is the Auditor's line to the Pc. The What's-it line.

    Now the definition, "Willing to talk to the Auditor", is very  easy  to
interpret as "Talking to the Auditor". So the Auditor cuts the line  the  Pc
has to the bank in order to get the Pc to talk, because "It's the Itsa  line
that blows the charge," he says.


    So the Auditor cuts the Pc's communication line with his bank in  order
to bring about an Itsa line-and then he wonders why he  gets  no  TA  action
and why the Pc ARC Breaks.


    This cut communication line is not perceivable to the naked  eye.  It's
hidden because it's from the Pc-a Thetan unseen by the Auditor-to  the  Pc's
bank-unseen by the Auditor.


    The Auditor is simply there to use the What's-it line in order  to  get
the Pc to confront his bank. The charge blows off  it  to  the  degree  that
it's confronted and this is represented by the Itsa line.


    The Itsa line is a report on what has been as-ised, that gives  it  its
flow.


    The sequence of use of these lines in an auditing cycle is  3,  1,  and
then 2.


    Where the Auditor neglects this hidden line from the  Pc  to  the  Pc's
bank, where he doesn't understand that hidden line and  can't  integrate  it
or do anything with it he is going to fail.

                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH:nt.ts.rd
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

Remimeo     HCO BULLETIN OF 23 MAY 1971R
Auditors    Issue IV
Supervisors REVISED 4 DECEMBER 1974
Students
Tech & Qual
                          Basic Auditing Series 4R


                       COMMUNICATION CYCLES WITHIN THE
                               AUDITING CYCLE

                   (Taken from the LRH Tape, "Comm Cycles
                         in Auditing", 25 July 1963)


    The difficulty that an Auditor gets into is normally found in  his  own
auditing cycle.


    There are basically two communication cycles between  the  Auditor  and
the Pc that make up the auditing cycle.


    They are cause, distance, effect with the Auditor at cause and  the  Pc
at effect, and cause, distance, effect with the Pc at cause and the  Auditor
at effect.

      Cause  ----------------------       Distance   ---------------------->
Effect

Auditor
Pc

       Effect   <--------------------    Distance   ------------------------
Cause

    These are completely distinct one from the other. The only  thing  that
connects them and makes an auditing cycle, is the fact that the Auditor,  on
his communication cycle, has calculatingly restimulated something in the  Pc
which is then discharged by the Pc's communication cycle.


    What the Auditor has said has caused a restimulation and  then  the  Pc
needs to answer the question to get rid of the restimulation.


    If the Pc does not answer the  question  he  doesn't  get  rid  of  the
restimulation. That is the game that is being played in  an  auditing  cycle
and that is the entirety of the game. (Some  auditing  breaks  down  because
the Auditor is unwilling to restimulate the Pc.)


    There is a little extra communication cycle on here. The Auditor  says,
"Thank you" and you have this as the acknowledgement cycle.


      C -------------------------   Command  -------------------->  E

Auditor      E    <---------------------------Answer------------------------
C                 Pc

      E  ---------------------  Acknowledgement  --------------->   E


    Now there are some little inner cycles that can throw you off and  make
you think that there are some other things to the auditing cycle.  There  is
another little shadow cycle: it is the observation of "Has the  Pc  received
the auditing command?" This is such a tiny "cause" that nearly all  Auditors
who are having any trouble finding out what's  going  on  with  the  Pc  are
missing this one. "Does he receive it?" Actually there is another  cause  in
here and you're missing that one when you're not perceiving the Pc.
You can tell by looking at the Pc that he didn't  hear  or  understand  what
you'd said or that he was doing something peculiar with the command  he  was
receiving. Whatever that message is in response, it rides on this line.

            Did Pc receive,
      e <------------------------understand and-------------------  c
            answer command?

      C -------------------------   Command  -------------------->  E

Auditor      E    <---------------------------Answer------------------------
C                 Pc

      E  ---------------------  Acknowledgement  --------------->   E

    An Auditor who isn't watching a Pc at all never notices a Pc who  isn't
receiving or understanding the  auditing  command.  Then  all  of  a  sudden
somewhere along the line there is an ARC Break and then  we  do  assessments
and we patch up the session and all kinds of things go wrong.

    Well, they actually needn't ever have gone wrong in the first place  if
this line  had  been  in.  What  is  the  Pc  doing  completely  aside  from
answering? Well, what he is doing is this other little sub-cause,  distance,
effect line.


    Another of these tiny lines is the cause, distance, effect line  of-"Is
the Pc ready to receive an auditing command?"


    This is the Pc causing and it rides up the  line  across  distance,  is
received at the Auditor and the Auditor  perceives  that  the  Pc  is  doing
something else.


    It is an important one and you find that Auditors goof  that  one  very
often; the Pc's attention is still on a prior action.


    Now here's another  one-"Has  the  Pc  received  the  acknowledgement?"
Sometimes you violate this one.  You  have  been  acknowledging  but  you've
never seen that he didn't receive the acknowledgement. That  perception  has
another little tiny one in it that actually comes on this line; it  is-''Has
the Pc answered everything?''


    The Auditor is watching the Pc and the Auditor sees that the Pc has not
said all that the Pc is going to say. You sometimes get  into  trouble  with
Pcs that way. Everything at "cause" hasn't moved on down the line to  effect
and you  haven't  perceived  all  of  the  "effect"  and  you  go  into  the
acknowledgement one before this line has completed itself.


    That's  chopping  the  Pc's   communication.   You   didn't   let   the
communication cycle flow to its  complete  end.  The  acknowledgement  takes
place and of course it can't go through as it's an  inflowing  line  and  it
jams right there on the Pc's incomplete outflowing answer line.

            Is Pc ready
      e <----------------------for the command?-------------------  c

            Did Pc receive,
      e <------------------------understand and-------------------  c
            answer command?

      C -------------------------   Command  -------------------->  E

Auditor      E    <---------------------------Answer------------------------
C                 Pc

      E  ---------------------  Acknowledgement  --------------->   E
So if you want to break it all down,  there  are  six  communication  cycles
which make up one auditing cycle. Six, not more than six  unless  you  start
running into trouble. If you violate one of these  six  communication  lines
you of course are going to get into trouble which causes a mish-mash of  one
kind or another.


    There is another communication cycle inside the auditing cycle and that
is at the point of the Pc. It's a little additional  one  and  it's  between
the Pc and himself. This is him talking to  him.  You're  listening  to  the
inside of his skull when you're examining it. /t actually  can  be  multiple
as it depends upon the complications of the mind.


    This happens to be the least important of all the actions  except  when
it isn't being done. And of course it's the hardest to detect when it  isn't
being done. Pc says: "Yes.  ''  Now  what  has  the  Pc  said  yes  to?  And
sometimes you are insufficiently  curious.  And  that  in  essence  is  this
internal perception of  line.  It  includes  this  cause,  distance,  effect
backflash here-''Is the Pc answering the command I gave him?''


    So with this, there are  seven  communication  cycles  involved  in  an
auditing cycle. It is a multiple cycle.


    A communication cycle consists of just  cause,  distance,  effect  with
intention, attention, duplication and understanding. How many of  these  are
there in one auditing cycle?  You'd  have  to  answer  that  with  how  many
principal ones there are because some auditing cycles contain  a  few  more.
If a Pc indicates that he didn't get the command (cause, distance,  effect),
the Auditor would give a repeat of it (cause,  distance,  effect)  and  that
would add 2 more communication cycles to the auditing cycle, so  you've  got
9-because there was a flub. So anything unusual that happens  in  a  session
adds to the number of communication cycles in the auditing cycle,  but  they
are still all part of the auditing cycle.


    Repetitive commands as an auditing cycle, is doing the same cycle  over
and over again.


    Now there is a completely different cycle inside the same pattern.  The
Pc is going to originate and it's  got  nothing  to  do  with  the  auditing
cycle.  The  only  thing  they  have  in  common  is  that  they  both   use
communication cycles. But this is brand new. The Pc says something  that  is
not germane to what the Auditor is saying or doing and you actually have  to
be alert for this happening at any time and the way to  prepare  for  it  is
just to realize that it can happen at any time and just go  into  the  drill
that handles it. Don't get it confused with the drill that you  have  as  an
auditing cycle. Consider it its own drill. You shift gears into  this  drill
when the pc does something unexpected.


    And, by the way, this handles such a thing  as  the  Pc  originates  by
throwing down the cans. That's still an origin. It has nothing  to  do  with
the auditing cycle. Maybe  the  auditing  cycle  went  to  pieces  and  this
origination cycle came in. Well, the auditing cycle can't  complete  because
this origin cycle is now here.  That  doesn't  mean  that  this  origin  has
precedence or dominance but it can start and  take  place  and  have  to  be
finished off before the auditing cycle can resume.


    So this is an interruptive cycle and it is cause, distance, effect. The
Pc causes something. The Auditor now has to originate as the Auditor has  to
understand what the Pc is talking about-and then  acknowledge.  And  to  the
degree that it is hard to understand, you have the cause,  distance,  effect
of the Auditor trying to clarify this  thing;  and  every  time  he  asks  a
question, he's got a new communication cycle.


    You can't put a machine action at that point because the thing  has  to
be understood. And this must be done in such a way that the Pc isn't  merely
repeating his same origination or the Pc will go frantic. He'll  go  frantic
because he can't get off that line-he's stuck in time and it  really  upsets
him. So the Auditor has to be able to understand what the devil  the  Pc  is
talking about. And  there's  really  no  substitute  for  simply  trying  to
understand it.
There is a little line where the Pc indicates he is going to say  something.
This is a line (cause, distance, effect) that comes  before the  origination
takes place so you don't run into a jam and  you  don't  give  the  auditing
command. The effect at the Auditor's point is to shut up and let him.  There
can be another little line  (cause,  distance,  effect)  where  the  Auditor
indicates he is listening. Then there  is  the  origination,  the  Auditor's
acknowledgement of it and then there is the perception of the fact that  the
Pc received the acknowledgement.

    That's your origination cycle.


    An Auditor should draw all these communication cycles out on a scrap of
paper. Just take a look at all these things; mock up a session and all of  a
sudden it will become very straight how these things are and you won't  have
a couple of them jammed up. What's mainly wrong with your auditing cycle  is
that you have confused a couple of communication cycles  to  such  a  degree
that you don't differentiate that they exist. That's why you sometimes  chop
a Pc who is trying to answer the question.


    You know whether the Pc has answered the question or not. How  did  you
know? Even if it's  telepathy  it's  cause,  distance,  effect.  It  doesn't
matter how that communication took place, you  know  whether  he's  answered
the command by a communication cycle. I don't care how you sense this.


    If you are nervy on the subject of handling the basic tool of  auditing
and if that's giving you trouble (and if you get into  trouble  by  suddenly
breaking it down and analyzing  it)  then  it  should  be  broken  down  and
analyzed at a time when you're auditing something nice and simple.


    I've given you a general  pattern  for  an  auditing  cycle;  maybe  in
working it over you can find a couple of extra communication cycles  in  the
thing. But they are all there and if you made someone go  through  each  one
painstakingly, you would find out where his auditing cycle is jammed up.  It
isn't necessarily jammed up on his ability to say "Thank you". It  may  very
well be jammed up in another quarter.


      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder


LRH:nt jh
Copyright �1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 23 MAY 1971 R
Remimeo     Issue V
Auditors    REVISED 29 NOVEMBER 1974
Supervisors (Revision in this type style)
Tech & Qual
Students
                          Basic Auditing Series 5R


                     THE COMMUNICATION CYCLE IN AUDITING

                         From the LRH tape 6 Feb 64,
                          "Comm Cycle in Auditing"


    The ease with which you can handle a  communication  cycle  depends  on
your ability to observe what  the pc is doing.


    We have to add to the simplicity of  the  communication  cycle  OBNOSIS
(observation of the obvious).


    Your inspection of what you are  doing  should  have  ended  with  your
training. Thereafter it should be taken up exclusively with the  observation
of what the pc is doing or is not doing.


    Your handling of a communication cycle ought to be so  instinctive  and
so good that you're never worried about what you do now.


    The time for you to get all this fixed up is in training. If  you  know
your communication cycle is good you haven't any  longer  got  to  be  upset
about whether you're doing it right or not. You know yours is good,  so  you
don't worry about it any more.


    In actual auditing, the communication cycle that you watch is the pc's.
Your business is the communication cycle and responses of the pc.


    This is what makes the auditor who can crack any case and  when  absent
you have an auditor who couldn't crack an egg if he stepped on it.


    This is the difference, it's whether or not this  auditor  can  observe
the communication cycle of the pc and repair its various lapses.


    It's so simple.


    It simply consists of asking a question that the  pc  can  answer,  and
then observing that the pc answers it, and when  the  pc  has  answered  it,
observing that the pc  has  completed  the  answer  to  it  and  is  through
answering it. Then give him the acknowledgement.  Then  give  him  something
else to do. You can ask the same question or you can ask another question.


    Asking the pc a question he can answer involves clearing  the  auditing
command. You also ask it of the pc so that the pc  can  hear  it  and  knows
what he's being asked.


    When the pc answers the question be bright enough to know that  the  pc
is answering that question and not some other question.


    You have to develop a sensitivity-when did the pc finish answering what
you've asked. You can tell when  the  pc  has  finished.  It's  a  piece  of
knowingness. He looks
like he's finished and he feels like he's finished. It's  part  sense;  it's
part his vocal intonation; but it's an instinct that you develop.  You  know
he's finished.


    Then knowing he's finished answering you tell him he's finished with an
acknowledgement, OK, Good, etc. It's like pointing out the by-passed  charge
to the pc. Like-"You have now found and  located  the  by-passed  charge  in
answer to  the  question  and  you  have  said  it."  That's  the  magic  of
acknowledgement.


    If you don't  have  that  sensitivity  for  when  the  pc  is  finished
answering-he answers, gets nothing from you, you sit there and look at  him,
his social machinery goes into action, he gets onto self  auditing  and  you
get no TA action.


    The degree of stop you put on your acknowledgement is  also  your  good
sense because you can acknowledge a pc so hard that you finish  the  session
right there.


    It's all very well to do this  sort  of  thing  in  training  and  it's
forgivable, but NOT in an auditing session.


    Get your own communication cycle sufficiently well  repaired  that  you
don't have to worry about it after training.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder



LRH:nt.rd jh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                         HCO BULLETIN OF 23 MAY 1971
                                  Issue VI
Remimeo
Auditors
Supervisors
Students    HCOB of 17 Oct 1962, Reissued verbatim as
Tech & Qual

                           Basic Auditing Series 6


                        AUDITOR FAILURE TO UNDERSTAND


    If a pc says something and the auditor fails to understand what the  pc
said or meant, the correct response is:


    "I did not (hear you) (understand what was said) (get that last)."


    To do anything else is not only bad form, it can amount to a heavy  ARC
Break.


    INVALIDATION


    To say "You did not speak loud enough_____" or any other use  of  "you"
is an invalidation.


    The pc is also thrown out of session by having responsibility  hung  on
him or her.


    The Auditor is responsible for the session. Therefore the  auditor  has
to assume responsibility for all comm breakdowns in it.


                                 EVALUATION

    Far more serious than Invalidation above, is the accidental  evaluation
which may occur when the auditor repeats what the pc said.


    NEVER repeat anything a pc says after him, no matter why.


    Repeating not only does not show the pc you heard but  makes  him  feel
you're a circuit.


    The highest advance of 19th Century Psychology was a machine  to  drive
people crazy. All it did was repeat after the person everything  the  person
said.


    Children also do this to annoy.


    But that isn't the main reason you do not repeat what the pc said after
the pc. If you say it wrong the pc is thrown  into  heavy  protest.  The  pc
must correct the wrongness and hangs up right there. It may take an hour  to
dig the pc out of it.


    Further, don't gesture to find out. To say, pointing,  "You  mean  this
item, then," is not only an evaluation but a nearly  hypnotic  command,  and
the pc feels he must reject very strongly.


    Don't tell the pc what the pc said and don't gesture to find  what  the
pc meant.


    Just get the pc to say it again or get the pc to point  it  out  again.
That's the correct action.
                          DRIVING IN ANCHOR POINTS

    Also, do not shove things at a pc  or  throw  things  to  a  pc.  Don't
gesture toward a pc. It drives in anchor points and makes the pc reject  the
auditor.


                                ROCK SLAMMER

    The reason a person who Rock Slams on Scientology or  auditors  or  the
like can't audit well is that they are wary of  a  pc  and  feel  they  must
repeat after the pc, correct the pc or gesture toward the pc.


    But Rock Slammer or not, any new auditor may fall into these bad habits
and they should be broken fast.


                                   SUMMARY

    A very high percentage of ARC Breaks occur  because  of  a  failure  to
understand the pc.


    Don't prove you  didn't with gestures or erroneous repeats.


    Just audit, please.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder




LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1962, 1971
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                         HCO BULLETIN OF 23 MAY 1971
                                  Issue VII
Remimeo
Supervisors HCOB of 7 Apr AD 15, Reissued verbatim as
Students
Tech & Qual
                           Basic Auditing Series 7

                         PREMATURE ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS


    Here's a new  discovery. Imagine my making  one  on  the  Comm  Formula
after all these years.


    Do people ever explain to you long after you have understood?


    Do people get  cross  with  you  when  they  are  trying  to  tell  you
something?


    If so, you are suffering from Premature Acknowledgement.


    Like body odor and bad breath, it is not conducive to social happiness.
But you don't use Lifebuoy soap or Listerine to cure it, you  use  a  proper
comm formula.


    When you "coax" a person to talk after he has begun with a nod or a low
"yes" you ack, make him forget, then make him believe  you  haven't  got  it
and then make him tell you  at  GREAT  length.  He  feels  bad  and  doesn't
cognite and may ARC Break.


    Try it out. Have somebody tell you about something and  then  encourage
before he has completely told you all.


    THAT'S why pcs Itsa on and on and on and on with no gain.  The  auditor
prematurely acknowledged. THAT'S why pcs get  cross  "for  no  reason".  The
auditor has prematurely and unwittingly acknowledged. THAT'S why  one  feels
dull when talking to certain people. They  prematurely  acknowledge.  That's
why one thinks another is stupid-that person prematurely acknowledges.


    The quickest way to become a social  pariah  (dog)  is  to  prematurely
acknowledge. One can do it in many ways.


    The quickest way to start the longest conversation  is  to  prematurely
acknowledge for the person believes  he  has  not  been  understood  and  so
begins to explain at greater and greater length.


    So this was the hidden ARC Break  maker,  the  cognition  wrecker,  the
stupidifier, the Itsa prolonger in sessions.


    And why some people believe others are stupid or don't understand.


    Any  habit  of  agreeable  noises  and  nods  can   be   mistaken   for
acknowledgement, ends cycle on the  speaker,  causes  him  to  forget,  feel
dull, believe the listener is stupid, get cross,  get  exhausted  explaining
and ARC Break. The missed withhold is inadvertent. One didn't get  a  chance
to say what one was going to  say  because  one  was  stopped  by  premature
acknowledgement.  Result,  missed  w/h  in  the  speaker,   with   all   its
consequences.


    This can be counted on to make you feel frightened of being  "agreeable
with noises or gestures" for a bit and then you'll get it straight.


    What a piece of tech to remain incompletely explained. Fair scares  one
it does. And in the Comm Formula too!


LRH:nt.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1965,1971                              Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 5 FEBRUARY 1966
Remimeo
Auditors    Issue II
Supervisors
Students
Tech & Qual Reissued 23 May 71 verbatim as


                           Basic Auditing Series 8


                            "LETTING THE PC ITSA"
                        THE PROPERLY TRAINED AUDITOR


    The most painful thing I ever hope to see is an auditor "letting  a  pc
Itsa".


    I have seen auditors let a pc talk and talk and talk and talk  and  run
down and talk and run down and  talk  again  until  one  wondered  where  if
anywhere that auditor had been trained.


    In the first place such an auditor could not know the  meaning  of  the
word ITSA.


    The word means "It is a ........"


    Now how an auditor letting a pc talk believes he is  getting  a  pc  to
spot what IT is is quite beyond me.


    This pc has been talking all his life.  He  isn't  well.  Analysts  had
people talk for five years and they seldom got well.


    So how is it supposed to happen today that a pc, let talk enough,  will
get well.


    It won't.


    The auditor does not know the very basics of  auditing  skills.  That's
all. These are the TRs.


    An auditor who can't do his TRs can't audit. Period.


    Instead he says he is "letting the pc Itsa".


    If by this he means he is letting the pc drive all over the road and in
both ditches, then this isn't auditing.


    In auditing an auditor guides. He gives the  pc  something  to  answer.
When the pc
    answers the pc has said "IT IS A .. " and that's Itsa.


    If the pc answers and the auditor acknowledges too soon the pc tends to
go into an anxiety-he has been chopped. So he talks more than he wanted.


    If the pc answers and the auditor does not  acknowledge,  then  the  pc
talks on and on, hoping for an  acknowledgement  that  doesn't  come,  "runs
dry", tries again, etc.


    So premature or late-or-never acks result  in  the  same  thing-the  pc
running on and on and on.


    And they call it "letting the pc Itsa". Bah! If a pc talks too much  in
session he either is getting cut off too fast by the auditor or  hasn't  got
an auditor at all. It isn't
"Itsa". It's lousy TRs. (The one single exception is the pc  who  had  years
in analysis but even he begins to get better with proper TRs used on him.)

The proper cure is to drill the auditor until the auditor realizes:

    1.      The auditor  asks the questions.


    2.      The pc says what is the answer, "It's a ........"


    3.      The  auditor  acks  when  the  pc  has  said  it  to  the  pc's
        satisfaction and


    4.      The auditor acks when  the  pc  has  finished  saying  "It's  a
        ......."


    And that's Itsa.


    Scientology auditing is a precision skill, not a gag blop goo slup guck
        blah.


    1.      The auditor wants to know ........


    2.      The pc says it is ........


    1. 2. 1. 2. 1. 2. etc.

                                 TECH SAVVY

    Now an auditor who doesn't know his technology about the mind  and  his
processes of course never knows what to ask. So he or she simply  sits  like
a lump of sacking hoping the pc will say something that makes  the  pc  feel
better.


    A sure sign that an auditor doesn't know an engram  from  a  cow  about
processes is seeing a pc "Itsa" on and on and on.


    In Scientology we do know what the mind is, what a being is, what  goes
wrong in the mind and how to correct it.


    We aren't  psychoanalysts  or  psychiatrists  or  Harley  Street  witch
doctors. We do know.


    The data about beings and life is there in Scientology to be learned.


    It isn't "our idea" of how things are, or "our opinion of" ....


    Scientology is a precision subject. It has axioms. Like  geometry.  Two
equilateral  triangles  aren't  similar  because  Euclid  said  so.  They're
similar because they are. If you don't believe it, look at them.


    There isn't a single datum in  Scientology  that  can't  be  proven  as
precisely as teacups are teacups and not saucepans.


    Now if we get a  person  fresh  out  of  the  study  of  "the  mystical
metaphysics of Cuffbah" he's going to have trouble. His  pcs  are  going  to
"Itsa" their heads off and never get well or  better  or  anything.  Because
that person doesn't know Scientology but thinks it's all imprecise opinion.


    The news about Scientology is that it put the study of  the  mind  into
the precise exact sciences. If one doesn't know that, one's  pcs  "Itsa"  by
the hour for one doesn't know what he is handling  that  he  is  calling  "a
pc".


    By my definition, an auditor is a real auditor  when  his  or  her  pcs
DON'T overtalk or undertalk but answer the  auditing  question  and  happily
now and then originate.
So how to tell an auditor, how to determine  if  you  have  trained  one  at
last, is DO HIS PCS ANSWER UP OR DO THEY TALK ON AND ON.

    If I had an auditor in an HGC whose pcs yapped and yapped and  ran  dry
and yapped while the auditor just sat there like a Chinese pilot  frozen  on
the controls, I would do the following to that "auditor":

    1.      Remedy A, Book of Case Remedies.


    2.      Remedy B, Book of Case Remedies.


    3.       Disagreements  with  Scientology,  technology  and  orgs   and
        Scientology personalities all found and traced to basic and blown.


    4.      A grind study assignment of the Scientology  Axioms  until  the
        "auditor" could DO THEM IN CLAY.


    5.      A memorization of the Logics,  Qs  (Prelogics)  and  Axioms  of
        Dianetics and Scientology.


    6.      TRs 0 to 4 until they ran out of his or her ears.


    7.      Trs 5 to 9.


    8.      Op Pro by Dup until FLAT.


    9.      A hard long study of the Meter.


    10.     The ARC triangle and other scales.


    11.     The Processes of Level 0.


    12.     Some wins.

    And I'd have an auditor. I'd have one that  could  make  a  Grade  Zero
Release every time.


    And it's lack of the above that causes an "auditor" to say "I  let  the
pc Itsa" with the pc talking on and on and on.


    Scientology is the breakthrough that made  the  indefinite  subject  of
Philosophy into a precision tool.


    And pcs get well and go Release when it is applied.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH:nt jh
Copyright � 1966, 1971
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED


[The original issue said "Level 0"  above the title.]
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                         HCO BULLETIN OF 23 MAY 1971
Remimeo     Issue X
Auditors
Supervisors HCO P/L of 1 July 1965 Issue II
Tech & Qual Reissued verbatim as

                           Basic Auditing Series 9

                            COMM CYCLE ADDITIVES

    There are no  additives permitted on the Auditing Comm Cycle.


    Example:     Getting the pc to state the problem after the pc has  said
what the problem is.
    Example:     Asking a pc if that is the answer.
    Example:     Telling pc "it didn't react" on the meter.
    Example:     Querying the answer.


    This is the WORST kind of auditing.


    Processes run best MUZZLED. By muzzled is meant using ONLY TR 0, 1,  2,
3 and 4 by the text.  A pc's results will go to HELL  on  an  additive  comm
cycle.


    There are a hundred thousand tricks that could be added to the Auditing
Comm Cycle. EVERY ONE of them is a GOOF. The ONLY time you ever  ask  for  a
repeat is when you couldn't hear it.


    Since 1950, I've known that all auditors talk too much  in  a  session.
The maximum talk is the standard model session and the TR 0  to  4  Auditing
Comm Cycle ONLY.


    It is a serious matter to get a pc to "clarify his answer".  It  is  in
fact an Ethics matter and if done habitually is a Suppressive  Act,  for  it
will wipe out all gains.


    There are mannerism additives also.


    Example: Waiting for the pc to look at you before  you  give  the  next
command. (Pcs who won't look at you are ARC Broken.  You  don't  then  twist
this to mean the pc has to look at you before you give the next command.)


    Example:     A lifted eyebrow at an answer.
    Example:     A questioning sort of ack.


    The Whole Message is


    GOOD AUDITING OCCURS WHEN THE COMM CYCLE ALONE IS USED AND IS MUZZLED.


    Additives on  the  Auditing  Comm  Cycle  are  ANY  ACTION,  STATEMENT,
QUESTION OR EXPRESSION GIVEN IN ADDITION TO TRs 0-4.


    They are Gross Auditing Errors.


    And should be regarded as such.


    Auditors who add to the Auditing Comm Cycle never make Releases.


    So, that's Suppressive.


    Don't do it!

LRH:nt.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1965, 1971 Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 23 MAY 1971 R
                                 Issue VIII
                           REVISED 4 DECEMBER 1974
Remimeo
Auditors
Students
Tech & Qual
                          Basic Auditing Series 10R


                    RECOGNITION OF RIGHTNESS OF THE BEING

                           Taken from the LRH Tape
                      "Good Indicators", 7 January 1964


    An auditor's tendency is to look for wrongnesses. He is  always  trying
to find something wrong with the pc. That's the nature  of  Scientology;  we
assume that there is something wrong with somebody otherwise he wouldn't  be
here and be dead in his head, and he would be  capable  of   doing  a  great
deal more than he is doing at the particular moment.


    An individual is basically and routinely good, capable of many  actions
and considerable power.


    In the state of a Free Thetan or Native State he is a far more powerful
individual than when he's been complicated up.


    It's the idea of the additive data to the Thetan. Try to give  somebody
something he doesn't want and you  are  going  to  overthrow  his  power  of
choice. His power of choice is the only thing that he  had  to  begin  with,
which gave him power, capability and anything else and that power of  choice
has been consistently and continuously overthrown by giving  him  things  he
didn't want and taking away from him things he didn't want  to  get  rid  of
back and forth. You get the individual pretty overwhelmed and he  goes  down
in power.


    What happened to him actually is he solved something that  didn't  need
solving. There was something he couldn't confront so he  solved  it  and  he
fixed the solution.


    Anytime you fix  these  solutions,  for  ever  and  ever  you  put  the
individual down grade. An individual becomes  aberrated  by  additives.  His
experiences in this universe are usually calculated to degrade  and  depower
him. Now all you have to do is pick up all of these  criss-crosses  and  you
return him to power.


    Man is an added-to being and everything that has been added to him  has
decreased his ability to cope. When you add something to the Being  he  gets
worse.


    We are in the business of deleting wrongnesses from the individual.


    Even the Freudian Analyst realized that some additive  had  been  added
that should be deleted. So the idea of deleting something to bring  about  a
recovery is not new with us.


    Because we are  in  the  business  of  deleting  wrongnesses  from  the
individual we seldom look at rightnesses and that's what's wrong  with  most
auditors. They are so anxious to find the wrongness-and  quite  properly-and
they never really  look  at  the  rightness.  If  they  don't  look  at  the
rightnesses that are present, then they aren't appreciating the  degrees  of
truth that are present that can be promoted into more truth.


    In other words they are starting at a level of no truth present all the
time so of course they never make any forward progress.

    You must realize that there must be truth present and that  this  truth
must be recognized and that this is hand-in-glove  a  part  of  auditing-the
recognition of the fact that truth is present.


    If you only look for wrongnesses  and only recognize wrongnesses   then
you will never be able to pull anything up  a  gradient  because  you  won't
think you have any rightnesses  to work with. It just  all  looks  wrong  to
you.


    You have to be able  to look at the wrongnesses in order to right  them
but we also have to be able to look at the rightnesses in order to  increase
them.


    We  are  only  trying  to  find  wrongnesses  in  order   to   increase
rightnesses, and that's very important. If you have no  rightnesses  present
in a session you will never be able  to  make  any  progress  of  any  kind.
Progress is built on a gradient scale of rightnesses  by  which  you  delete
wrongnesses and they drop and fall away.


    Therefore, Processing is an action by which wrongnesses can be  deleted
from the case to the degree that rightnesses are  present  in  the  session.
You cannot take a case that doesn't have any rightness present and delete  a
wrongness. So you have to realize that there  are  rightnesses  present  and
then you increase those rightnesses That makes it possible for you  to  pick
up the wrongnesses and that's what auditing consists of.


    Auditing is a contest of maintaining rightnesses so that we can  delete
wrongnesses. If you keep on deleting wrongnesses, all the while  maintaining
and increasing the rightnesses you eventually wind  up  with  a  very  right
being. You are  trying  to  get  a  right  being,  therefore  if  you  don't
continually encourage right beingness you never wind up with a right being.


    You must learn to observe an auditing session. You want your pc to wind
up in a right state-in  a  more  native,  more  capable,  less  overwhelmed,
higher power of choice sort of state. You want him  to  wind  up  with  more
rightnesses.


    Therefore, if you audit so that  you  do  not  encourage  and  increase
rightnesses then you won't wind up with a right pc.


    The degree of rightness you have present must exceed the wrongness  you
are going to pick up. It's a proportional action.  If  you've  got  as  much
wrongness in a session as you've got rightness  you're  not  riding  on  any
cushion. It makes a very difficult job of auditing. If you want to  pick  up
this little wrongness, you have to have rightnesses present  which  are  big
enough to engulf it. That makes easy auditing.


    If the rightnesses in the session are very minor and the problem  is  a
tiny one, there isn't enough rightness in the session to handle the  problem
and the pc cannot erase it.


    THE  PC'S  ABILITY  TO  AS-IS  OR  ERASE  IN  A  SESSION  IS   DIRECTLY
PROPORTIONAL TO THE NUMBER OF GOOD INDICATORS PRESENT IN THE SESSION.


    And his inability to cope in a  session  rises  proportionally  to  the
number of bad indicators present in a session.


    Any process has its own series of bad indicators. And the bad indicator
moves in when the good indicator moves out So you have  to  have  a  primary
knowledge of good indicators.


    Don't look for bad indicators on and on and on;  you'll  drive  the  pc
around the bend and suppress the good indicators What  you  want  to  do  is
know your good indicators for the level you are running so  well  that  when
one of them disappears  out  of  the  session,  your  ears  go  up  and  you
instantly look for the bad indicator.  Don't  look  for  the  bad  indicator
until you see  the  vanishment  of  the  good  indicator.  Otherwise  you're
continually prowling around looking for wrongnesses in  a  session  and  you
keep a pc very upset and you get no auditing done of any kind whatsoever.

    Remember this next time you see a pc start to bog and drag and flounder
one way or the other. You've got to get the pc's  good  indicators  back  in
before you can get the pc to handle what you want him to handle.


    What influences the attitude of the pc is an ARC Break (that of  course
is influenced earlier by the auditor's behavior), or the pc has an overt  on
the auditor or the pc has a missed withhold.


    An auditor who never gets in and finds out what is wrong in the session-
the reasonable auditor-messes up pcs like mad.


    If all the good indicators are present the auditor knows he is doing  a
good job of auditing.


LRH: nt .rd      L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright �1971, 1974  Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED





                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                         HCO BULLETIN OF 23 MAY 1971
                                  Issue IX
Remimeo
Auditors
Supervisors
Students    Basic Auditing Series 11
Tech and Qual Staff
Checksheets of all courses
teaching metering
                                  METERING


    One does NOT tell the pc anything about the meter or  its  reads  ever,
except to indicate an F/N.


    Steering a pc with "That-That-That" on something reading is  allowable.
But that isn't putting attention on the meter but on his bank.


    Definition of "In Session" is "Pc interested in own case and willing to
talk to the auditor".


    Saying "That reads", "That didn't read", "That blew down"  is  illegal.
It is no substitute for TR 2. It  violates  the  In  Session  definition  by
putting pc's attention on the meter and can make him very unwilling to  talk
to the auditor!


LRH:act.rd  L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1971 Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED


























































                               Cramming Series
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               22 APRIL 1971R
                         (Reissued 12 December 1971)
Remimeo     Reissued 11 July 1974 as BTB
Qual Sec Hat     Revised 20 November 1974
Cramming Off Hat
Supervisor Course      (Revision in this type style)
Checksheets
Supervisor Hats
                                   CANCELS
                            BTB OF 22 APRIL 1971
                                 SAME TITLE

                             Cramming Series 1R


                                  CRAMMING


PURPOSE:    TO TEACH THE STUDENT WHAT HE HAS MISSED.

                          WHAT HE IS, WHAT HE DOES

    The Cramming Officer should be  the  most  skilled  Supervisor  in  the
place. He should handle only causes- as basic as he can get.  Then  he  sets
the fellow back on the road.


    Cramming requires individual,  skilled  attention  by  someone  who  is
willing to 2-Way Comm and knows the subject under discussion well enough  to
be able to find where specific points are covered.


    Cramming's purpose is to teach the student what he's missed.


    To do that, it must handle both why he missed it and what was missed.

    Stable Data:

1.    Things are CAUSED, they do not "just happen".

2.    The cause lies earlier than the effect.

3.    It is not "human to err" nor is it reasonable  to  forget  things  nor
    are there people who are "naturally slow".

4.    Though stupidity comes in general from charge on the case,  thoroughly
    remarkable changes can be effected in rate  and  thoroughness  of  data
    assimilation,  independent  of  general  auditing,  by  use  of   study
    technology.

5.    Basic, when  blown,  discharges  the  rest  of  the  chain;  Basic  is
    earlier.

    In practice, the "why" of a suddenly slowed rate  of  study  or  of  an
overt product can be found and gotten rid of  by  looking  just  before  the
change and fixing up what you find. (Sometimes one has to carry  the  matter
earlier, especially in the case of improving a study rate that is  generally
slow.)

                                   RESULTS

Another Stable Datum is: If it didn't resolve the situation, it  wasn't  the
right cause of it. You don't know what was bogging the guy  until  you  find
it-it's easy to evaluate what you think must be wrong with the guy  or  sell
your wins or cogs . . . but it's very hard on the guy you're cramming.
The route to 100% results on the students  is  persistence  in  finding  the
actual cause. Hammering the same point over and over just doesn't  find  the
cause of a repeating error (and there shouldn't even be the first error,  if
he did the course properly). When he's  found (not you've  found, when  he's
 found) what's out, you'll have as many VGIs as you could ask  for  and  the
error will not repeat.

                                  LOG BOOK

    Keep a log book giving the date and name of  student,  reason  sent  to
Cramming. This gives a good idea of how the student is doing.

                                   PROGRAM

    The Cramming Officer gets into 2-Way Comm with the student to  estimate
what needs to be done, and lines up a short program of steps to be taken  in
Cramming. This is done in duplicate. The original is handed to the  student.
The Cramming Officer retains the duplicate for his  record  and  so  he  can
trace the student's progress, and  bring  it  to  a  rapid  completion.  The
students should be kept busy.

                                 GRAPH TREND

    Go over the student's daily graph of study stats and from the point  of
downward trend, check the checksheet for what  was  being  studied  at  that
time, or just before.

                                CRAMMING TECH

    The standard of just taking the Bulletin he's hung up on and asking for
a missed  word  in  the  previous  Bulletin  (or  previous  Section  of  the
Bulletin) works great and often simply this would handle the situation.


    Whatever it is, it is something, and  there  are  a  finite  number  of
things it can be.


    Frequently the student will offer a word and then half withdraw  it-yet
usually it's the very first one he offers when asked. So when you ask for  a
word, take  what's offered . . . all too often the word the guy hung  up  on
is one he almost believes, or fully believes, he knows.


                                 BASIC TOOL

    Your most basic tool is the full "cycle of the misunderstood".  A  very
large part of the time you have to use the whole thing.


    Say you're cramming an Auditor who's just goofed. C/S has sent  him  to
Cramming on R3R steps, as in the  middle  of  session  he  started  dropping
commands.


    Your first task is to find what exactly  occurred.  There  can  be  bad
admin or other varieties of false reports.


    Then why that occurred, looking earlier. In many cases  something  else
preceded gross obvious goofs. He did the course, he's got no right  ever  to
goof that data.


    Aha! He wasn't sure if he should have been running that item on the  Pc
... seemed like a narrative.


    Now with the initial goof to hand you find the  principle  that  wasn't
understood. On check, yep, he doesn't understand what it's OK to run or  not
to run in Dianetics.


    Aha, Aha! And what word or term? Yes, he doesn't know what  "narrative"
means.


    Clay Demo of "narrative" (full demo-not  "can  somebody  guess")  after
looking it up . . . a checkout on a couple of HCO Bs . . . and the guy's  in
business. Then you
can assess how much restudy of what is needed and groove him in to not  omit
commands even when flustered. Now he can learn, and will apply.

                                 OTHER TOOLS

    All standard  study  tech  is  at  your  disposal;  HCOB  Feb  21,  66,
"Definition Processes", HC Stress Analysis, etc., will get  many  a  student
out of the soup by themselves.


    Frequently a student proves to be pushed too far along the gradient and
simply needs to be put  back,  to  the  proper  slot.  Often  all  mass  and
doingness get left aside and only theory gets done-the guy never got  an  E-
Meter or looked at a Pc. Sometimes  the  guy's  programmed  onto  the  wrong
course entirely-completely without a purpose on the one he's on.

                    WHEN SIMPLY ASKING FOR A MISSED WORD
                                DRAWS A BLANK

    Sometimes he can't spot one offhand.


    You can simply ask for the prior area the fellow  feels  "weak  in"  or
"disagrees with" or "feels unsure of" and from that easily  get  the  missed
term. Clay of terms which the guy missed and hung up on helps a  lot-whether
in the present or a previous similar subject.


    This approach works very well when cramming in relation  to  a  subject
involving only activity, where there was  no  particular  study  of  printed
matter associated with it.

                     WHEN THERE APPEARS TO BE NO EARLIER

    Counter-Policy and Counter-Tech come  into  this.  Frequently  the  guy
"knows" the data but also "knows" something else  that  is  either  directly
misunderstood or the result of a misunderstood. There's no  obvious  earlier
error, he just all the time erroneously omits the R3R  step  despite  having
been checked out . . . obviously if it's simply a matter of  "Gee!  I  never
saw that before," your job is easy and the  Why  is  simply  didn't  do  the
material in the first place.


    But say the Exec did the course, but still won't ever train his  staff.
He's full of apparent comprehension, but doesn't apply.


    Well there's the overt-won't train-yet he feels he's doing right or  he
wouldn't be doing it. Fine, your approach is, "Why  was  what  you  did  the
right thing to do in those circumstances?" ("What made it OK to  commit  the
overt?") "One's got to cope and get the  product  out."  "Good,  what's  the
policy covering that that you're using-get me a copy, please."


    You take the policy he's using as the reason (whether an actual Policy,
Bulletin, or someone's order, or even an "everybody knows" from  Psychology)
and find the principle not understood and the word missed that  led  to  the
misunderstanding and you're back in business. Maybe,  above,  it  turns  out
the guy didn't know he should have set someone to organize  behind  him  and
finally didn't know what "product" meant at all.


    Repaired, the guy will now at last both cope and train.

                                SLOW STUDENTS

    Often subjects studied earlier (and usually  blown  from)  have  to  be
addressed. E.g. One student couldn't seem to get or find  his  misunderstood
on the Ethics Section of OEC. This was traced back  to  a  term  he'd  never
understood while studying law, and  magically  he  suddenly  understood  the
Ethics Policies he was studying.
Sometimes the student has gone past 20-30 misunderstoods, and each  one  has
to be defined. E.g. One student had never  completed  his  HSDC  because  he
"couldn't read DMSMH". He'd gone 1/3 way through and utterly  bogged.  After
defining word after word he hadn't  understood,  with  the  student  getting
brighter and brighter, he suddenly stated-"Hey, it's easy to read now."

                              CRAMMING AUDITORS

    The first thing to do is to go over  the  C/S,  the  session,  the  C/S
comments and Cramming actions to  be  done.  Trace  back  misunderstoods  to
basic and from that indicate which HCO B(s) to restudy on.


    Often the Auditor will originate  another  area  of  uncertainty.  Take
these up too and handle each one.

                            OTHER STANDARD TOOLS

    Student Rescue Intensives sometimes are a life-saver.


    The Learning Drill, even Op Pro by Dup (with C/S OK), TRs 0-9  and  all
sorts  of  drills  as  issued  (e.g.  101-104)  assist.  TR  errors  are  as
fundamental errors as you can get on an Auditor-except perhaps, can  he  sit
in the chair?

                                 THE COURSES

    A  large  part  of  the  Cramming  Officer's  responsibility  lies   in
correcting the courses that trained the guy being crammed. If  it  had  been
run all that standardly you'd not have expected the fellow  to  wind  up  in
Cramming.


    Sometimes the student himself  isn't  at  fault  at  all-common  course
outnesses which the Cramming  Officer  may  have  to  see  corrected  before
students can get anywhere are:

1.    No Supervisor.

2.    No materials.

3.    No checksheet.

4.    Improper checksheet.

5.    No checkouts available.

6.    All theory, or perhaps Theory with demos or clay  substituted  for  an
    actual Practical section.

7.    No Supervisor 2-Way Comm in use. (Nothing  mystic  here  just  no  one
    talks to anyone. )

8.    Evaluated tech, e.g. by Supervisor or fellow student.

9.    Uneducated Supervisors, in general-not using  or  applying  the  Study
    Tech themselves.

10.   Bad  equipment, especially tape recorders.

11.   Student has never done the Student Hat, not knowing Study Tech at  all
    himself. Doesn't know how to study and so never learns anything!

    The Cramming Officer, in the face of Course and  Supervisor  outnesses,
as above, must firstly unbug the student and get  him  winning  again,  then
call in the Supervisor or Supervisors involved and get  them  corrected.  In
the case of a Course
Admin who can't maintain the tape recorders,  he  is  pulled  in  and  fully
corrected in this area.

                             SUPERVISION AND C/S

    Very  often  the  student  is  having  difficulty   because   of   poor
supervision. He would  be learning well and progressing  if  the  Supervisor
were better trained or crammed.


    The same situation could exist with the C/S-he may  need  training  and
cramming.


    This should not be overlooked by a Cramming Officer who sees  too  many
students or Auditors being sent for the same difficulties.


    It is the Cramming Officer's responsibility  to  keep  Supervisors  and
C/Ses trained as well.

                               THE STUDENT HAT

    The Cramming Officer may find that the student has never learned how to
be a student. He was never  hatted-  never  got  an  R-Factor  on  what  was
expected of him as a student. It is  simple  to  get  him  hatted  with  the
Student Hat.


    This does not apply only to students in  Tech  Training  and  Technical
Personnel but to Admin Students as well. Staff Personnel on  Admin  Courses,
Staff  Status,  OEC,  Hats,  are  also  students  and  require  Hatting  and
Cramming. They should not be neglected by the Cramming Officer.

                            COACHING TO A NO WIN

    Occasionally you will find a coach who can't give himself or another  a
win. He coaches toward a loss. This could go so far as to  not  let  himself
progress just to keep his fellow student back.  Or  he  may  never  let  his
fellow student pass-or pass him when he doesn't deserve it.


    This could require auditing to resolve. But a good Cramming Officer can
handle this by finding the Why and getting it handled. And find the area  he
has losses on and get the misunderstoods off.

                  INVALIDATION AND CORRECTING THE WRONG WHY

    One barrier to study is the conviction that a right datum is  wrong  or
not to be applied. The only resolution to this is finding  and  pulling  off
whatever or however it got invalidated and then rapid restudy of the area.


    A student ordered to "restudy his Finance Pack because 'he doesn't know
his finance policy' " will profit from the  study  best  after  the  Why  is
located  specifically  and  straightened  up.  Once  he's  found,  say,  his
misunderstood in "how to do payroll" he can then study the rest of the  pack
in staff study with profit and certainty. A restudy without  finding  what's
out tends to  leave  him  in  doubt  about  all  his  comprehension  of  the
materials and he ends up  more  uncertain  of  the  materials  than  before,
unless he happens to spot the exact error  in  the  course  of  the  general
review.

                              THERE IS A CAUSE

    Persistence is probably the keynote. Since, (a) HE CAN  DO IT, and  (b)
sometimes the first thing you find and well  handle  does  not  resolve  the
situation, then (c) THERE WAS SOMETHING ELSE AWRY TOO.


    You follow each cycle to  a  VGI/Cog.  A  VGI/Cog  doesn't  necessarily
resolve the whole show, but it ends an action.  Sometimes  you  get  a  good
change as "My God, you know I've never really known  what  an  F/N  was"  or
"You know, I've always avoided
Finance Policy and don't really understand it at all." That  does  end  that
action. But then you still have to find the  misunderstoods in  the  Policy,
and drill, checkout, etc.

                                   BASICS

    The most common misunderstoods of Tech Students and Students  on  Admin
Courses alike lie  in  the  Basics-  METERING,  TRs,  UNDERSTANDING  OF  THE
AUDITOR'S CODE, THE BASIC THEORY OF  THE  HUMAN  MIND,  STRICT  HONESTY  AND
HONOR AS AN AUDITOR.


    These are the things the student should learn early  and  what  a  good
Cramming Officer always looks for, because if  the  student  did  not  learn
them early in his training-or if he had  had  an  earlier  than  Scientology
Misunderstood-his later training will hang up somewhere.


    The Cramming Officer should check for things like:

    What is the Mind?


    What is Charge?


    What is the Time Track?


    What happens when something keys in?


    What happens when something keys out-or erases?


    What is  it that makes the meter read?


    What is mass?

    Questions like this should be asked  and  good  Demos  done.  Then  the
Cramming Officer can go earlier and earlier. He may find  the  misunderstood
in earlier subjects algebra, science, philosophy, simple multiplication,  it
could be anywhere; and the Cramming Officer tracks it down.


    TRs, METERING, AUDITOR'S CODE, THE AUDITOR'S INTEGRITY ARE  DRILLED  SO
THAT THEY APPLY TO THE SESSIONS THE AUDITOR RUNS.  The  student  or  Auditor
will cognite that these are for use and not just for drilling.


    The Cramming Officer is there to unbug the Auditor and student-wherever
the bug or flaw may be. It must be tracked down to basic and cleared up.


    Every Org must  have  a  good  Cramming  Officer.  Without  a  Cramming
Officer, auditing and training are not kept at the  high  quality  our  Tech
requires.


    A good Cramming Officer is one of the Org's most valuable personnel.


    Compiled and written from Flag Cramming and Qual Sec actions by



                                  Reissued as BTB by
                                  Flag Mission 1234
                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow
                                  Commodore's Staff Aides
      Approved by the Board of Issues
BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:JR:GE:JF:LM:mh       for the
Copyright � 1971, 1974 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                8 MARCH 1975
                                   Issue I

Remimeo
                         Revises, Combines & Cancels
                    BTB 21 Jan 72RA, Cramming Series 2RA,
                   BTB 10 June 73RA, Cramming Series 19RA,
               BTB 10 June 73, Issue III, Reissued 19 July 74,
                             Cramming Series 20.

                             Cramming Series 2RB


                              CRAMMING ACTIONS

    The particular areas of expertise a Cramming Officer has  to  have,  in
addition to being a proven Auditor and Supervisor to the level  of  the  Org
are:

    1.      TRs 0-9 & Rapid TR 2
    2.      Metering
    3.      Axioms & Codes
    4.      Coaching
    5.      Mechanics of the Mind
    6.      Problems of Work
    7.      Word Clearing-M2, 3, 4, 6, 7 & 9
    8.      The Tech Materials to the level of the Org
    9.      10 points of Keeping Scientology Working.


                      THE CRAMMING OFFICER'S PROCEDURE

The general procedure in use in handling Auditors sent  to  Cramming  is  as
follows:

A.    Interview the Auditor with the folder and Cramming Order.

B.    Go over the folder  locating  all  errors  in  sequence,  earliest  to
    latest.

C.    Find the Why for the goof on a meter.

D.    Ensure the Cramming Order handles the Why, is  short  and  written  in
    sequence of gradient handling, including basics.

E.    See that the misunderstoods are cleaned up back to  the  BASICS  (e.g.
    errors handling out Ruds traced back through Basic Auditing  Series  to
    the Auditor's Code). Always use WC 1, 2, 4, 6, 7 and 9 in  addition  to
    starrates and clay.

F.    Have the Auditor drill the procedure flubbed until flawless.

G.    Have the Auditor do TRs 0-4 (6-9 if necessary),  debugging  individual
    TRs on a gradient of perfection.

H.    If a chronic error, metering error or low hours, check over his  meter
    position, eyes and his handling of the meter, and OT  TR  0  and  TR  0
    particularly.

I.    Now, with the error corrected and basics  in,  interview  the  Auditor
    and verify that the Why is handled and send to the  Pc  Examiner  as  a
    VGIs F/Ning student.

J.    If no  F/N,  check  him  over  on  the  meter  for  by-passed  why  or
    misunderstoods, isolate the area and get it corrected and Word  Cleared
    M2 & 9 and starrated and drilled.

K.    Write up the "Why" and key  actions  of  the  handling  for  the  C/S,
    attach the F/N Exam form and route to the C/S logged as complete.
Steps A & B have several parts:


        a.       Show me.
        b.       Tell me.
        c.       Obnosis.
        d.       What happened just before that?


                                   SHOW ME

    In many instances, if a person is asked what  was  done,  he  will  not
report exactly what was done, so a Cramming Off should get a person to  SHOW
him what he did.


    A Cramming Off has to hand a Cramming Order. His first action is to get
the person to demonstrate by going through the motions. In  many  cases,  he
won't have to go any further  because  the  demonstration  will  immediately
show what was wrong and requiring correction.


    For example, an Interne is having trouble with assessment, but a simple
demonstration shows that he does not know how to set up for  a  session.  He
has his Meter way over to the left, the worksheets in  the  center  and  the
assessment sheet way over to his right, and thus cannot see  the  list,  the
Meter and the Pc all in one field of  vision.  Such  a  demo  can  take  one
minute and save a Cramming Off 20 minutes of digging.


    In Admin Cramming, Show Me can take the Cramming  Off  into  the  Staff
Member's area.

                                   TELL ME

    When Show Me is not possible,  have  the  person  tell  what  happened.
"Exactly what  did you do?" is a stable datum. Get  the  exact  sequence  of
events not a lot of ramble. If very confused have  the  person  use  a  Demo
Kit. Don't get caught up in reasons or explanations.

                                   OBNOSIS

    The Cramming Officer must be able to pick out the outnesses in what  is
being said or shown. One doesn't have to  be  an  expert  to  recognize  and
follow down something that doesn't make sense.

                       WHAT HAPPENED JUST BEFORE THAT?

    In some cases, particularly in the Tech Cramming area, the Cramming Off
will have to find out what happened just before the goof.


    When checking for what happened just before a goof,  the  Cramming  Off
will find  A.  something  he  didn't  understand,  and/or  B.  something  he
couldn't control.


    A new Interne flubs the commands of  R3R.  Now,  if  the  Cramming  Off
doesn't ask what happened just before that, he may miss out on his  Why.  He
will probably find out that the Interne  realized  he  was  running  out  of
paper, or some such common incidence, which caused him to become  flustered,
TRs to go out, and he flubbed the commands. In this case,  through  his  own
lack of planning and  set-up  actions,  the  Interne  lost  control  of  the
session. So the Cramming  Off  will  cram  the  Interne  on  session  set-up
actions and strengthen his TR 0 through the use of TRs  booklets  and  tapes
and see that he continues daily TRs Training on the Interneship.


    When a look into a situation does not readily show up a Why, go earlier
and find out what happened.

                                   ETHICS

    The  only  hidden  barrier  to  real  success  in  Cramming   is   non-
participation, the indicator of Out Ethics. A Cramming  Off  must  recognize
Out Ethics and get it handled. He may be able to get  the  Staff  Member  to
handle it on the spot, or he may have to send the person to Ethics  or  even
to Integrity Processing. The point is to recognize the barrier  to  progress
and get it removed.

                             SUPERVISOR CRAMMING

    Unless Qual is also correcting Training where needful, Cramming will be
overloaded with flubbed products who didn't get the data in the first  place
and are now goofing on their Tech or Admin post.


    The Qual Sec should inspect Course rooms daily. Does the Super have his
E-Meter set up on his desk ready for an  M2  or  M4?  Is  the  Super  moving
around the class constantly, handling  students,  keeping  them  moving  and
F/Ning? Actual Super two way comm with students should be  listened  to  and
TRs and Supervisor or study tech correction written up.


    Does the Super have a Qual OK to do Word, Clearing  M2  and  4  on  his
students?


    Are there student graphs up and  posted  in  PT?  Are  the  Roll  Books
properly filled in and in PT?


    Are all points of "What is a Course" in?


    Are there any students on strange or irregular schedules?


    Is the Supervisor at least a Mini Course Supervisor Course grad?


    Are  there  other  Supervisors  training  on  HPCSC  and   postgraduate
Supervisor training (HSCSC) or schedules to go for such training?


    Are Supervisor TRs poor or choppy? Do they do daily TRs?


    Are blown students immediately contacted, brought in and handled?


    Can the Supervisor "see" what is happening in  the  Classroom?  Can  he
handle what he sees?


    Any Supervisor with down stats, drop-outs, blows or slow students  must
become bait for a continuing correction program until the  standard  is  way
up and into an acceptable level.


    The value of a good Academy or HSDC Supervisor, who runs snap  and  pop
courses, gets his students  through  rapidly  and  thoroughly  is  extremely
high. In this case, he is personally worth about two times  that  of  a  top
HGC Auditor in terms of beans into the Org. HAS and HQS Course Supers  prove
their worth in future beans and re-sign-ups in the Org. They help to  create
future  business  in  the  Academy  and  the  HGC.  Therefore,  proven   top
Supervisors should not be ignored as areas of facility differential.


    A Supervisor is handled in  Cramming  like  any  other  person  in  for
correction. The Situation is located, the Why found  and  the  handling  for
that Why executed. There are many such Situations and Whys to  be  found  on
most to get them to a point of being flubless Supervisors. It is a  no  more
lengthy cycle than getting an Interne through his Interneship.


    A good Supervisor produces the Org's future Auditors.


                                        Revised by
                                        Msm John Eastment
                                        A/CS-S
                                        Approved by
                                        Guardian WW
                                        FB Ad Council
                                        FB Exec Council
                                        LRH Comm FB
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides
                                        Approved by the Board of Issues
BDCS:CH:JK JE nt.jh    for the
Copyright � 1975 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                8 MARCH 1975
                                  Issue II
Remimeo
                         Revises, Combines & Cancels
               HCO B 12 Feb 71, Issue II, Reissued 12 Dec 71,
               Cramming Series 3, BTB 12 June 73R, Issue III,
         Cramming Series 15R, BTB 7 June 73RA, Cramming Series 16RA


                             Cramming Series 3R



                              TYPES OF CRAMMING
                               ADMIN CRAMMING

                           (Ref: HCO PL 30 Aug 74,
                            "Qual Stat Change".)



    There are two areas of Cramming:

             1.   Tech Cramming.


             2.   Admin Cramming.

    There are two basic types of Cramming:

    A.      To rapidly prepare a  person  for  post  or  technical  action,
        through  intensive  study,  Word  Clearing  and  drilling  on   key
        materials.


    B.      To rapidly correct a person after the fact of an error or flub,
        by finding the Why, and handling  that  Why  with  study  and  Word
        Clearing of the particular data involved and drilling  the  actions
        to a point of  confidence  and  competence.  This  covers  Cramming
        Orders sent to Qual or originated by the Cramming Off or  Qual  Sec
        on Outpoints in the Org.

    The administrative and executive staff of an Org  require  Cramming  as
much as technical personnel. The handlings are analogous.


    The cycle goes like this:

1.    Hat checksheet completed in staff training.

2.    Cramming ordered when a staff member flubs.

3.    Cramming to find and handle the basic reason for the continued  flubs,
    if present.

4.    Ethics, if proven necessary, to no change or  improvement  or  refusal
    to be corrected, overtly or covertly.

    Post duties break down into various skills just as they do for Auditors
or C/Ses or Course Supervisors.

    Sources for Admin staff correction break down into:

A.    Basics of Scientology as applied in life-ARC, cycles of action,  eight
    Dynamics, etc.

B.    Staff Member Basics-Staff Status 0, 1, 2, OEC Volume 0, Org Bd.
C.    Post Hat-Mini Hat, Full Hat.

D.    OEC Volumes by Division. All Policy.

    The Admin Cramming Off has a  vested  interest  in  seeing  that  Staff
Training exists and produces hatted staff members  who  can  do  their  post
duties competently. Where staff training is lacking, he must work  with  the
Qual Sec and STO to get it into operation.


    The steps of handling an Admin Cramming cycle are:

1.    Find out what happened or is happening.

2.    Establish the situation  (biggest  departure  from  what  should  have
    happened or should be happening).

3.    Find the why for that situation on a meter.

4.    Write up the handling to eradicate the why and get  a  return  towards
    the Ideal Scene by Cramming on the key issues for the area and removing
    any blocks to their implementation.

                                ORG OUTPOINTS

    In doing Org outpoint corrections per HCO PL  30  Aug  74,  "Qual  Stat
Change", look at the GDSes first. Take up any and all GDSes with down  stats
or trend, and cram all personnel directly involved with making  the  GDS  on
visible outpoints until the  stat  starts  going  up.  That  means  keep  on
correcting outpoints, by pushing in Policy and Tech until  you  get  a  stat
recovery occurring. Then take up the Dept stats and get them going up.  Then
take up the Section stats and get them going up. Checking  on  stats  before
doing Org outpoint correct actions narrows the target to the  areas  needing
correction.


    There are sometimes more areas which can cause trouble than a  Cramming
Officer may realize. These separate out into:

1.    Staff member's actions, flubs and misunderstoods.

2.    Senior's  actions  and  reports.  (Supplementary  Situation  per  Data
    Series 27, HCO PL 25 May 73, "Supplementary Evaluations".)

3.    Other staff influences. (Supplementary Situation per Data  Series  27,
    HCO PL 25 May 73, "Supplementary Evaluations".)

4.    Out Basics in Scn, staff or post hat duties.

5.    Out Personal Ethics.

6.    Environmental influence. (Supplementary Situation per Data Series  27,
    HCO PL 25 May 73, "Supplementary Evaluations".)

7.    Out Post programming.

8.    Out Personal or Post Org Board.

9.    Wrong purpose or products or products unknown.

    The Cramming Officer does not do all the handling on staff but gets the
person to work with other staff in Cramming or  bring  in  fellow  staff  to
work with and the Cramming Off sees that each step is done correctly.
The only test of successful Admin Cramming is that those staff  crammed  are
now doing better and their stats are up.


    Ideally, an Admin Cramming Officer should be an HPCSC/OEC Graduate.  If
this is not so, then  the  Admin  Cramming  Officer  must  rapidly  complete
his/her hat checksheet and embark on a study program of all OEC  Volumes  in
order to be able to fully function on post. For Why  Finding  he  must  know
the Data Series PLs and how to handle an E-Meter and have an OK to L&N.


                                        Revised by
                                        Msm John Eastment
                                        A/CS-5

                                        Approved by
                                        Guardian WW
                                        FB Ad Council
                                        FB Exec Council
                                        LRH Comm FB
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:CH:JK:JE:nt jh
Copyright � 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                8 MARCH 1975
                                  Issue III
Remimeo     Revises, Combines & Cancels
               BTB 12 Dec 71RA, Issue X, Cramming Series 4RA,
                   BTB 5 Sept 72RA, Cramming Series IIRA,
                   BTB 9 June 73RA, Cramming Series 17RA,
                BTB 10 June 73, Issue V, Cramming Series 22.

                             Cramming Series 4RB

                            HIGH CRIME CHECKOUTS
                              AND TECHNICAL OKs

                       (Ref: HCO PLs 7th & 8th Mar 66,
                                 High Crime)

    All new Bulletins by Class or technical PLs issued are checked  out  on
all HGC Auditors and Internes by the Cramming Officer  within  24  hours  of
receipt. The Cramming Officer has these main actions which  he  ensures  are
done by all HGC Auditors, C/Ses, and Internes:

A.    That they read  the new Bulletin fully.

B.    That all misunderstood words are  fully  cleared,  using  Method  3  &
    Method 4. Starrate checkout is then done by  the  Cramming  Officer  or
    Interne Supervisor.

C.    Clay Demos are done of the key principles in the new Rundown.

D.    That  all  new   procedures  or  Rundowns  are  additionally  drilled,
    including E-Meter drills if required by the procedure, in Cramming.

E.    Writes up a list of "Okays to Audit" for the procedure or Rundown  and
    sends to D of P for use in Pc assignment.

    Any confused  technical  questions,  strange  ideas  or  considerations
expressed are immediately handled with Word Clearing. All  Case  Supervisors
and Tech and Qual personnel on technical posts must also check  out  on  all
new Bulletins and technical Policy Letters. They do A, B and C above.


    The Cramming Officer must have a special High  Crimes  New  Issues  Log
Book. He lists down one side of the page the  names  of  all  the  personnel
involved. Across the top of the page,  he  lists  the  appropriate  HCO  (or
Board) Bulletin or Policy Letter, with a line going down the page.
[pic]
      When a new HCO (or Board) Bulletin or technical Policy Letter  arrives
in the Org, a copy must go immediately to the Cramming Officer. He  logs  it
in his  book  and  ensures  that  sufficient  copies  are  made  immediately
available for checkouts to be done within 24 hours of receipt.


    High Crime checkouts are done by Auditors to their highest  Class.  For
example, Class VIIIs would check out on all new issues. An HDC  would  check
out on any new Dianetic issues. A Class IV would check out on all  Class  IV
issues. Where an issue is not applicable to an Auditor or  staff  member,  a
slash is put on his section of  the  book  when  the  issue  is  entered.  A
Supervisor would be logged to check out on  any  new  Supervision  or  Study
Tech Bulletins or PLs. The C/S checks out on all new issues.


    High Crime Checkouts can be done by the  Cramming  Officer  or  Interne
Super. The Cramming  Officer  will  retain  the  High  Crime  Log  Book  and
continue to be responsible for them being in PT. Any  High  Crime  Checkouts
done by the Interne Super must be logged in the book by  the  Interne  Super
daily.

                                MIMEO DELAYS

    The Cramming Officer must make a special report to CS-7, CS-1 and  CS-5
at Flag if there is a delay in the supply of Bulletins  and  Policy  Letters
into  his/her  Org.  This  is  a  serious  matter  and  must   be   reported
immediately.


    Mimeo Checklists  of  all  issues  are  sent  from  Flag  to  the  Orgs
periodically.

                             ETHICS INSPECTIONS

    The Ethics Officer should inspect the High Crime  Log  Book  weekly  to
ensure that checkouts are in PT.


    If the checkouts are not in PT, he must call an Ethics Hearing  on  the
Cramming Officer and chit the Qual Sec.


    Violations of High Crime Policies are not to be treated lightly and are
handled per HCO PL 8 Mar 66, "High Crime".


    Attestations are not accepted on any High Crime Checkouts.

                                TECHNICAL OKs

    Any person who does a technical action must get an OK  to  do  such  an
action from the Cramming Officer or Interne Super.


    This  includes   Auditors,   Supervisors,   Pc   Examiners,   Personnel
Programmers, all Qual auditing correction actions, Word Clearers,  C/Ses,  D
of P technical actions, such as PTS Interviews, Two-Way Comm,  MLOs  who  do
Assists, etc.


    There are a few terminals outside of Tech and  Qual  who  do  technical
actions who should also get a Qual OK and these are the Ethics  Officer  for
PTS Interviews and handling and the Success Officer on  his  meter  handling
of completions.


    If a new auditing rundown comes out, the C/S is expected to get  an  OK
to C/S that action from Qual.


    The way to put this in on any existing staff who do not have  such  OKs
is to make up a list of what needs to be done and then  give  a  short  time
limit  on  the  completion.  Do  not  use  this  Policy  to  stop   existing
production. If the OKs have not been given, pull them in and get them  done.
In such a case, the Qual Sec, Cramming Officer and Interne  Super  would  be
expected to work together to get it done.


    OKs may be withdrawn by the Qual Sec, Cramming Officer, or C/S if found
to have been falsely issued by reason of repeated flubs.
Attestation is not accepted in Qual for OKs to Audit.


                                        Revised by
                                        Msm John Eastment
                                        A/CS-5

                                        Approved by
                                        Guardian WW
                                        FB Ad Council
                                        FB Exec Council
                                        LRH Comm FB
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

                                        Approved by the Board of Issues

                                        for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
                                        CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY



BDCS:CH:JK:JE:ntjh
Copyright � 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                8 MARCH 1975
                                  Issue IV
Remimeo
                Revises, Combines & Cancels BTB 12 Dec 71RA,
               Issue XI, Cramming Series 5RA, BTB 14 Sept 72R,
                    Cramming Series 12R, BTB 15 Nov 72R,
                            Cramming Series 13R.



                             Cramming Series 5RB



                               TRs IN CRAMMING



    There is no restriction whatsoever on doing TRs in Cramming.


    It is not rote and is done on each Cramming cycle.


    ALL TECHNICAL PERSONNEL ARE EXPECTED TO CONTINUE TO WORK ON AND IMPROVE
THEIR TRS THROUGHOUT ALL TRAINING AND INTERNESHIPS AND SERVICE IN AN ORG  OR
FRANCHISE.


    The LRH Model Auditing Tapes  and  materials  are  the  only  guide  to
perfect TRs.


    Any questions or queries  or  strange  ideas  about  any  TRs  must  be
immediately handled with Word Clearing on the relevant material.


    Beware of quickie TRs or Auditors who do five minutes of TR 0 and  then
say that they have improved their TR 0 and confront. Watch out for  Auditors
who cannot or will not do two hours  of  confront  or  Auditors  who  cannot
deliver 2l/2 hours of auditing and short session.  Be  on  the  lookout  for
Supervisors whose students blow or who have small classroom attendance.


    The Interne Supervisor is responsible  for  forcing  in  daily  TRs  on
Auditors, Internes, C/Ses, Cramming Officer,  Pc  Examiner,  Word  Clearers,
Basic Courses Supervisors, Success Officer, D of P and D of T.


    Auditors and Internes get their TRs training done outside of production
hours and time must be provided daily for this to be  done.  Each  personnel
may not be prevented from doing daily TRs. Technical reports show that  some
Auditors do not get in their minimum 25 WD hours showing the vital need  for
lots of TRs  to  be  done.  Poor  scheduling  keeps  Auditors  waiting,  and
unnecessarily lengthens their auditing day, leaving no time for  daily  TRs.
Daily TRs and Auditor and Interne training times  actually  reduce  time  in
Cramming. Auditors and Supervisors do not have cases  and  are  expected  to
work on their TRs daily.


    Special TRs booklets and tapes have been compiled for Cramming Officers
to assist them to get real correction of TRs done in Cramming.


    These materials comprise all materials on TRs 0 to 4, Upper Indocs  and
the Auditing Comm Cycle, issued as individual booklets on each TR.


    The only way to correct TRs is by  taking  each  one  individually  and
tackling it as a subject on its own.  This  is  made  possible  through  the
individual booklets and tapes.
The tapes also must be listened to  from  the  viewpoint  of  the  TR  being
corrected. The Auditor, Interne or Supervisor has  the  LRH  Model  Auditing
tapes and special LRH


     TRs demonstration tapes to use. They must be taught  to  listen  to  a
single TR in order to correct it.


    The Cramming Off must know these materials cold so that he  can  direct
the person to the exact material every time to resolve the situation.


                                        Revised by
                                        Msm John Eastment
                                        A/CS-5

                                        Approved by
                                        Guardian WW
                                        FB Ad Council
                                        FB Exec Council
                                        LRH Comm FB
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

                                        Approved by the Board of Issues

                                        for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
                                        CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY



BDCS:CH:JK:JE:ntjh
Copyright � 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                8 MARCH 1975
                                   Issue V
Remimeo
                         Revises, Combines & Cancels
               BTB 12 Dec 71R, Issue XII, Cramming Series 6R,
               BTB 12 Dec 71R, Issue XIII, Cramming Series 7R,
               BTB 2 Sept 72R, Issue III, Cramming Series 10,
                   BTB 21 Jan 73RA, Cramming Series 14RA.


                             Cramming Series 6RA


                             CRAMMING EXPERTISE


    All Cramming Officers are to put up a large  well  lettered,  permanent
sign in the Cramming area:

                    GOOD CRAMMING IS THE KEY TO FLUBLESS
                                 AUDITORS AND AUDITING
                                                                         LRH

    A Cramming Officer must be an experienced Auditor  up  to  the  highest
Class of auditing he/she is Supervising. A failed Auditor on post will  only
result in failed correction cycles. Another Cramming  Officer  is  appointed
to handle students and  admin  cramming  cycles.  This  has  been  proven  a
successful action.


    The Cramming Officer keeps a log book of all Cramming actions done  and
weekly reviews the types of Cramming actions going  on  with  the  different
Auditors. He could find at this  point  that  a  certain  Auditor  has  been
crammed on three slightly different but  related  areas.  He  can,  at  this
point, call the Auditor in and handle the more basic outness isolated.


    Packs of materials to do with a subject or action  should  be  compiled
for Cramming-e.g. Rudiments, Listing and Nulling, TRs, etc.  If  an  Auditor
goofs on Rudiments, he reviews the little pack, word clears it,  drills  the
actions, etc.


    Word Clearing is used very heavily in Cramming. Auditors are not  "sent
to Word Clearing" when it is required. They are just  twinned  up  and  word
clear the materials ordered  in  Cramming.  If  a  student  is  consistently
goofing on data contained in  a  particular  level  or  course,  he  can  be
ordered to word clear the entire materials on that checksheet in Cramming.


    When certain materials have already been word cleared and  the  student
is still goofing on the procedure, it must  be  considered  that  he  has  a
confusion re the sequences of actions and the student must be  very  heavily
drilled on that action.


    The Cramming Officer has the whole resources of the Org Library to call
upon. Many books contain key  data  applicable  to  every  level  and  these
should be used liberally in Cramming.


    If an Auditor is showing ignorance of a datum  or  rule,  it  is  quite
possible that he never read it.

    The three main areas investigated in Cramming are:

1.    The student or Auditor never read it.

    The exact data may not have been on an earlier  checksheet  done  on  a
    subject. So one always ensures  that  all  the  data  is  to  hand  and
    reviewed.
2.    The student or Auditor has misunderstoods in the material.

    Handled fully with Word Clearing, always  on  the  whole  text  of  the
    materials goofed.

3.    The student or Interne has confusions on the sequences of actions.

    Handled by drilling. Can also be handled by HC lists.


    One point that the Cramming Officer must  watch  out  for  is  overlong
Cramming Orders. An overlong Cramming Order  would  be  one  that  contained
more than four or five issues. Such a Cramming Order is actually a  training
cycle and should be done in staff training. Overlong  Cramming  cycles  tend
to bring about  a  backlog  because  they  cannot  be  handled  quickly  and
completed. Qual is a corrective Division and should  not  get  into  routine
training actions.  Routine  training  belongs  in  the  Tech  Division.  The
Cramming Officer does NOT accept overlong Cramming Orders.


                               NO F/N AT EXAMS

    Per C/S Series 86RB, BTB 20 Jan 73RB, "The Red Tag Line", the  Examiner
sends a copy of the list of the day's Red Tags to the Cramming Officer.


    A Red Tag Pc report must lead at once to Cramming of the Auditor, the D
of P, the C/S and  the  Tech  Sec.  They  are  immediately  crammed  on  the
appropriate materials with all Mis-U words cleared up and any Why  found  on
the meter as needful.


    Any discovered instance of a non-F/N VGIs folder not being  relayed  to
the C/S, and thus discovered by the Cramming  Officer,  must  result  in  an
immediate Ethics Hearing for No Report.


                                        Revised by
                                        Msm John Eastment
                                        A/CS-5

                                        Approved by
                                        Guardian WW
                                        FB Ad Council
                                        FB Exec Council
                                        LRH Comm FB
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

                                        Approved by the Board of Issues

                                        for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
                                        CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY



BDCS:CH:JK:JE:nt.jh
Copyright � 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                8 MARCH 1975
                                  Issue VI
Remimeo
Cramming Offs
                                   CANCELS
                           BTB 12 DECEMBER 1971 R
                                 Issue XIII
                             Cramming Series 7R

                             Cramming Series 7RA

                         CRAMMING OFFICER STATISTIC


    The statistic of the Cramming Officer is:


    TOTAL CRAMMING POINTS FOR THE WEEK.


    The Cramming Points for the Week are obtained by:

1.    2 points for all Cramming actions  completed  on  Tech,  Qual  or  HCO
    staff including Word Clearing on the  appropriate  materials,  any  Why
    Finding needed, accompanied by an acceptable Success Story.

2.    1 point for  all  Cramming  actions  completed  on  Dissem,  Treasury,
    Distribution and Exec Division staff, including Word  Clearing  on  the
    appropriate materials,  and  Why  Finding  needed,  accompanied  by  an
    acceptable Success Story.

3.    2 points for each issue  or  tape  or  drill  completed  by  Auditors,
    Internes and Tech or Qual personnel on Okay  to  Audit  checksheets  or
    Okay to do technical posts  with  key  materials  fully  Word  Cleared,
    starrated and drilled. Includes Okays to  Audit  for  new  Rundowns  as
    issued so long as any key related HCO  Bs  and  metering  required  are
    studied, drilled, the procedure drilled on a doll,  and  after  a  Tech
    Course in each case.

4.    2 points for each completed Cramming cycle originated by the  Cramming
    Officer which handles a more basic or broader area of situation to  the
    original just handled or a needed Retread in Tech on Tech, Qual or  HCO
    personnel (per Cramming Series 25).

5.    1 point for each completed Cramming cycle originated by  the  Cramming
    Officer which handles a more basic or broader area of situation to  the
    original just handled or Hat or  Series  Retread  in  Tech  on  Dissem,
    Treasury, Distribution or Executive Division personnel.

6.    2 points for each new Bulletin or Technical Policy  starrated  by  all
    concerned within 48 hours of receipt.

Note that there is a penalty of five points for each undone  Cramming  Order
caused by lack of  materials,  Word  Clearers  or  Tech  or  Admin  Cramming
personnel if stale dated 48 hours. Note that this stat is not  the  same  as
the Qual GDS and contains additional points to cover  the  Cramming  Officer
Post duties.


      Ens. Judy Ziff, CS-5
      Approved by the Board of Issues
BDCS:Bof I:JZ:rnhg.ntjh      for the
Copyright � 1975 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                             12 DECEMBER 1971 R

                         Reissued 9 July 1974 as BTB
Cramming Offs    Revised 26 November 1974
C/Ses
                                   CANCELS
                           BTB OF 12 DECEMBER 1971
                                  Issue XIV
                                 SAME TITLE


                             Cramming Series 8R

                               C/S Series 70R


                      HOW TO WRITE UP A CRAMMING ORDER


    There is a certain technology on how to write up a Cramming Order.

    1.      Isolate and state briefly the exact outnesses (in the Pc folder
        or staff member area).


    2.      Order those HCO Bs or PLs crammed.

    The Cramming Officer also looks in a slightly wider circle  around  the
data flunked and locates which basic is involved (e.g. Auditor's Code,  TRs,
metering, handling a session, handling the Pc as a Being, or student  basics
and staff basics) and gets that crammed, too.


    The Cramming Officer is not bound to accept any Cramming Order  if  his
own investigation proves that something else entirely needs  correction.  It
is part of the Cramming Officer's responsibility  to  prevent  Wrong  Target
correction. According to Qual Senior Datum, the Cramming  Officer  must  not
take orders but must do his own  investigation  and  handling.  It  will  be
found that there is usually a valid corrective action to be  made.  He  does
not just waive the cycle if the original order is incorrect.  He  finds  out
what is really wrong and corrects that.


                                        Written & Revised by CS-5
                                        Ensign Judy Ziff

                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:Bof I:JZ:rnh.rd
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               8 DECEMBER 1971
Remimeo
All C/Ses   Reissued 3 July 1974 as BTB
Cramming Officer
Hat   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 8 DECEMBER 1971
                                 SAME TITLE

                              Cramming Series 9

                                C/S Series 68

                         THE C/S AND CRAMMING CYCLES

    A fast way for any C/S to  go  into  Doubt  about  the  skills  of  his
Auditors is to send them to Cramming and get only a "done" back.


    Cramming is there to find the real cause of any error. So if  the  real
WHY is not made known to the C/S he has a "something  is  wrong  with  Joe's
TRs" which hangs up in time and never is resolved.


    A response from Cramming to an order from the C/S to  "check  his  TRs-
Pc's TA went low in session-" which states: "I checked his TRs and they  are
good. But he audited the Pc in a room that was overhot  and  the  cans  were
too big. He has been drilled  on  Auditor's  Code  and  session  environment
handling and HCO Bs on TA Errors and now has this down pat. It won't  happen
again," leaves the C/S in no doubt as to what really happened.  What's  more
he can order this repaired on the Pc by a "2wc  on  times  he  felt  worried
about his TA or F/Ns" taken E/Sim to F/N (which will clear it up).


    Furthermore the Auditor now knows that the  C/S  knows  what  the  real
error was, doesn't get hung with a withhold or a false idea  about  his  TRs
from the C/S.


    In essence one is putting the Exact Truth on the line.


    So the following rule is now mandatory in all HGCs and Quals:


    THE CRAMMING OFFICER IS ALWAYS ON ANY  CRAMMING  ORDER  TO  REPORT  THE
EXACT OUTNESSES FOUND OR THE EXACT SESSION GOOFS, WITH ANY ADDITIONAL  DATA,
IN DETAIL, TO THE C/S.


    A C/S receiving a Cramming Order back giving no Why or  an  unreal  Why
that does not make sense when compared with  the  session  and  its  results
MUST return the Cramming Slip to the Cramming Officer requiring the  Why  be
found or the wrong Why abandoned and the real Why found and corrected.


    A good C/S should know his Data Series down cold and be  able  to  spot
such outpoints at once. He would go  over  the  session  with  the  Cramming
Officer and point out what it is he wants handled.


    This data is  not  theoretical  but  is  taken  from  actual  practical
experience in C/Sing.

                                  Flag Dept 12 C/S
                                  Reissued as BTB
                                  by Flag Mission 1234
                                  Authorized by AVU
BDCS:SW:AL:MH:RL:mh.jh for the
Copyright � 1971,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 10 JUNE 1973RA
                                   Issue I
Remimeo
Qual Secs   REVISED 20 FEBRUARY 1974
Cramming    REISSUED 19 SEPTEMBER 1974
Offs  (Only change is signature)



                            Cramming Series 10 RA




                                  CRAMMING



    The datum that "Qual does not take orders" solves  the  Admin  Cramming
dilemma of the staff member crammed four times on the Dev-T Pack.


    It is up to  Qual  to  handle,  fully  and  totally.  This  means,  not
following the exact order, but finding  the  real  Why  on  the  person  and
handling it at once.


    Qual's function is correction. By policy Qual does not take  orders  on
What to do to correct.


    Where an exec wants certain material covered, that's  okay.  Cover  it.
But find the WHY!  And on a repeat order, realize it was  a  wrong  Why  and
really work it over.


    Several staff have been crammed several times on the Dev-T Pack.  Means
Qual takes orders.


    The PRODUCT of Qual Admin Cramming is  a  functioning  producing  staff
member who can produce on post.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1973, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               10 JUNE 1973RA
                                  Issue IV
                   Revised & Reissued 7 August 1974 as BTB
                          Revised 27 November 1974

Remimeo     CANCELS
Qual Secs   BTB OF 10 JUNE 1973R
Hats Off    Issue IV
Cr Offs     SAME TITLE


                            Cramming Series 11RA


                     CRAMMING OFFICER POST REQUIREMENTS


    A Tech Cramming Officer is not only a top Auditor for his Class but  he
must also be a top Supervisor.


    The minimum requirements for being a Cramming Officer are:

A.    Experienced Classed Auditor of Class IV HDC or above in  a  lower  Org
    and not lower than VIII in an SH or AO Org.

B.    Mini Course Super Course.

C.    Professional Word Clearer's Course Graduate.

D.    Trained in the skills of Cramming and Why Finding per the BPL 12  June
    73R, Rev 31 Aug 74, "Cramming Officer Hat Checksheet".

    Whilst it is known there is a lot of good Cramming being done in  Orgs,
the quality of Cramming needs to be  increased  in  order  to  back  up  the
current expansion occurring in Orgs.


    The Cramming Officer is second  only  to  the  Qual  Sec  in  technical
quality and post expertise.


    In order to upgrade Cramming quality, the following should be done:

    A.       Get  the  current  Cramming  Officer  completed  on  all  post
        requirements and operating efficiently. He handles tech  and  admin
        Cramming.


    B.      Post an  Admin  Cramming  Officer  who  apprentices  under  the
        current Cramming Officer, taking the load  of  Admin  Cramming  and
        allowing the Cramming Officer to take on the full  duties  of  Tech
        Cramming  Officer,  handling   all   Auditors,   C/Ses,   Internes,
        Supervisors, students and technical Cramming actions.


    C.      Both the Tech and Admin Cramming Officers enroll onto the HPCSC
        and get it completed.


    D.      The Tech  Cramming  Officer  does  any  Tech  Courses  not  yet
        completed in his Org, in study time.


    E.      The Admin Cramming Officer does the OEC, commencing with Vol 5,
        in study time.

    And thus, we have expert Tech and Admin Cramming Officers on post.
A busy Cramming Officer needs a  Qual  Page  to  get  people  in  for  their
Cramming cycles and High Crime checkouts, otherwise he  can  waste  valuable
minutes and hours chasing up people. The Qual Page can also  get  needed  Pc
folders or packs and  materials  from  the  Library  as  a  service  to  the
Cramming Officer.


    The high degree of  personal  attention  in  Cramming  brings  about  a
situation whereby a Cramming Officer can handle about  20  students  at  one
time before he will tend to  become  overloaded.  In  this  case,  a  second
Cramming Officer must be added to reinforce the area. The Qual Sec  and  Org
Officer must be alert to this or the area will  get  jammed  and  production
lines slowed.


    The target being worked towards is:

    1.      A Class VIII or IX Ex Dn HPCSC Tech Cramming Officer.


    2.      A Class IV OEC HPCSC Admin Cramming Officer.

    Then you would really see the fur fly. As these levels of post training
are acquired, we will see a gradient and continual improvement in  the  tech
and admin quality, existence of Source and use  of  materials  of  Dianetics
and Scientology in Orgs.


    Orgs will become fully On Tech, On Policy and In  Ethics  and  will  be
truly KEEPING SCIENTOLOGY WORKING.


                                                   Written & Revised by  CS-
5
                                                   Ensign Judy Ziff

                                                   Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:Bof I:JZ:mh.rd
Copyright � 1973, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                12 JUNE 1973
                                   Issue I
Remimeo
Cramming Offs    Reissued 1 July 1974 as BTB
C/Ses
Qual Secs   CANCELS
                        HCO BULLETIN OF 12 JUNE 1973
                                   Issue I
                                 SAME TITLE


                             Cramming Series 12


                            THE TOOLS OF CRAMMING


    A number of LRH Cramming cycles on Auditors,  C/Ses,  Execs  and  Admin
people have been compiled  for  this  Bulletin.  They  should  provide  very
helpful guidance to the specific approach to individual  correction  in  all
spheres by a Cramming Officer.

AUDITORS:

1.    "Auditor's missed an F/N.  Check  meter  position  and  general  admin
    habits that would cause this. She must be able to see the meter, Pc and
    admin in one look. Check eyesight. Also Code and TRs, of course."
            LRH 13 May 72

2.    "Worksheets utterly indecipherable. She  'clarifies'  by  over-writing
    words in blue, instead of correctly printing above  in  red.  Have  her
    practice legible handwriting rapidly until she can."
            LRH 13 May 72

3.    "Does not put enough down in a  worksheet  to  make  sense.  She  must
    learn what to put down, what not to.  Things  that  move  TA,  Dn  step
    numbers, items that fall on 2wc and overts and  withholds.  And  enough
    sense so a C/S can use it and see what happened."
            LRH 13 May 72

4.    "Commits auditing error, blames Pc. Get off her overts on  Pcs.  Check
    her out on Standard Dianetic C/Sing."
            LRH 12 May 72

5.    "Missed first item's F/N on list. L&N laws.  Metering.  Check  it  for
    position during admin."
            LRH 3 June 72

6.    "Metering. Placement of meter may have been upset by concentration  on
    admin. Missed a no-read on the Pc. Or isn't checking. Get metering  and
    admin sorted out as a co-ordination"
            LRH 2 June 72

7.    "Flubbed ARC Break handling. Look at folder. Get the Mis-U  and  drill
    her on ARC Break handling."
            LRH 6 June 72

8.    "WCing over out lists, out ruds. M6 on key words of her  post.  M4  on
    programming sequences. In clay purpose of a program. In clay purpose of
    an Auditor."
            LRH 18 July 72
    9.      "Auditor breaks up when Pcs  say  something  funny  by  report.
    Clobbered the F/N. He also assessed an uncleared list and missed  Mis-U
    words and didn't handle even when it read. TRs the HARD WAY."
            LRH 16 April 72

10.   "D of P is to do C/S Series 57. A little can be done  each  day  until
    he has completed it. It must be reported and metered daily  for  Mis-Us
    and honestly done."
            LRH 15 June 72

11.   "Auditor's Pc is talking long  long  long.  Clear  Invalidation.  Then
    work out in clay what Invalidation is and what it would  do  to  a  Pc.
    Then in clay how a Pc would Itsa overlong on out TR 2. Then TRs."
            LRH 21 May 72

12.   "Cleared words on a Sec Check. Couldn't  follow  an  ARC  Break  chain
    down or pull a withhold. Just sat and watched a meter. Didn't  do  C/S.
    No session control. 'Auditor Rights' unknown. Retread Academy Levels  0
    to IV. TRs."

            LRH 10 Sept 72
C/S I/T:

1.    "C/S Series M4. Then Study it. He missed obvious  things  and  doesn't
    head Auditors into a dead right correction."

2.    "Get this C/S to do C/S Series 57 as a familiarity action on the  HGC.
    It can be done a bit each day. It must be metered as honestly done."

            LRH 15 June 72

3.    "Gave a well done to an Auditor for Word Clearing  over  an  Out  List
    Out Rud Pc. M6 on his post. M4 on C/S Series,  about  sequence  of  Out
    Lists, ruds in programming. In clay on purpose and actions of a C/S  in
    handling cases. In clay on purpose and actions of  a  C/S  in  handling
    Auditors."

            LRH 10 Sept 72
AUDITOR ADMIN CRAMMING:

1.    "Violation of HCO PL 21 Nov 62, CSW.  C/S  opinion  requested  but  no
    folder, no data. Pack of Dev-T PLs star-rate. CSW in clay and how Dev-T
    overloads lines."
            LRH 2 Mar 72

2.    "Dev-T-challenging a cramming order on a Dev-T folder with  more  Dev-
    T."

            LRH 1 Mar 72

3.    "Aside from any Out Tech, this Auditor, out of  two  folders,  has  in
    each one left one item on a list unhandled. Causes C/S  Dev-T.  M4  and
    star-rate Dev-T pack."

            LRH 12 April 72
EXECS AND ADMIN PERSONNEL:

1.    "Sent an incomplete program up. Cram her on PL 'Not Dones, Half  Dones
    and Backlogs'. On Dev-T pack."
            LRH 9 Aug 72

2.    "Is flunking on evaluation. Method 7 WC Handle. Method 4 Data  Series.
    Get him to define a Why per Data Series. Have him rattle  off  all  the
    outpoints until he can, with examples of each."
            LRH 11 July 72
     3.     "There is something adrift here. Possibly  confront  or  people
    or getting people  to work. She operates as an HCO  Expediter.  She  is
    perfectly willing to work personally and does a good job. However,  her
    actions here tell us why her Org fell apart with her  as  Org  Officer.
    Instead  of  organizing-org  boarding  people,  recruiting,   training,
    hatting, putting in Ethics,  etc-she  clears  up  backlogs  as  an  HCO
    Expediter. She does not get people to get the work done  but  does  the
    work. Establish the  fact-(2)  Can  she  handle  PEOPLE?  (2)  Can  she
    recruit? (3) Can she train? (4) Can she compile  packs?  (5)  Does  she
    know theory of org  board  and  posting?  (6)  Does  she  know  Ethics,
    including Investigation? (7) Does she believe she  can  get  people  to
    work? Or is it 'faster to do  it  yourself'?  Straighten  out  what  is
    found."
            LRH 22 Jan 72

4.    "Did not follow orders. (1) Meter check for Mis-Us related to  orders,
    key post terms. Clear up. (2) Check up on his attitude to his post. (3)
    Find the bug on reasonableness on post."
            LRH 10 Feb 72

5.    "Posting with a gap in Qual.  No  formal  coverage  of  Interne  Super
    functions while Interne Super on leave, thus overloading the  QEO  with
    Interne Super. HAS-HCO Cope Off Hat M4. In clay, posting an  org  board
    from the top down to cover all lower functions and why one does,  shown
    in clay."
            LRH 12 Mar 72

6.    "Let her area collapse. (1) Check WCl. (2)  Check  managing  by  stats
    PLs for Mis-Us. (3) WC4 Data Series. (4) Have her do evals  that  don't
    blame wrong targets."

            LRH 27 Jan 72

7.    "Cut a comm line. Messed up an evening schedule by saying she  'didn't
    know'. Is wholly unaware of  an  existing  scene.  Attention  fixed  on
    something, easily upset, withholdy. M4 on 'Policy'. M4 on  post.  Dev-T
    pack star-rate."

                                        LRH 5 Mar 72

8.    "Blames other  activities  for  own  stats  and  failures  instead  of
    policing and handling own area. Does not know a Why  by  definition  is
    something you can use to improve a scene. (1) Check WCI for errors. (2)
    WC4 on Data Series. Get her to do numerous evals that have Whys you can
    handle (that don't put it on God or other Divs)."
            LRH 27 Jan 72

9.    "Data Series M4 and in clay. Gave me an eval  lacking  in  CONSISTENCY
    (Why on one subject area-program on another). Did not locate the  right
    Why."

                                        LRH 9 Mar 72

10.   "She is to be crammed on (1) What files are.  (2)  What  the  uses  of
    files are. (3) What her products are."
            LRH 15 Mar 72

11.   "Is not being a Product Off for his Div. Stats  way  down.  Out  Admin
    and Out Ethics in Div. Find out why he can't get production or quality.
    Cram."

                                        LRH 22 Mar 72

    These are just a few examples of LRH Cramming cycles to  give  Cramming
Officers more real data on how to USE the tools of Qual to get  his  product
of a corrected individual who can now function in his area.


    In all cases, when the basic outnesses were corrected, one or  more  of
the three major stable data of Cramming were present:  (I)  the  person  had
not read or studied
 the materials, or (2) he had misunderstoods in the  materials,  or  (3)  he
had not  drilled  the  actions  or  sequences  of  actions  to  a  point  of
competence.


    In all cases, also, all tech personnel  had  their  TRs  corrected  and
improved while in Cramming.


    All the tools of Tech Cramming are applicable into Admin  Cramming,  as
can be seen by the above examples. Admin  Cramming  is  vital  to  pick  up,
revitalize and get a floundering Division, area  or  Org  on  its  feet  and
operating.


    Word Clearing plays a key role in Cramming, so there must always  be  a
minimum of two Word Clearers in any Org. If an enterprising Qual  Sec  wants
to get some Word Clearers, his best action would be to word  clear  the  HAS
and all HCO staff on their posts and duties until they get  the  message  on
the value of Word Clearing. Any Qual Sec who has no Word  Clearers  or  Word
Clearing being done in his Div should be ordered to extensive Word  Clearing
by his CO or ED, and then crammed in his own Qual on his hat.


    Cramming is not an area for weaklings or persons with no  confront.  It
is probably one of the single most versatile posts in an  Org.  He  has  all
types of staff with all types of flubs and outnesses to handle. He must  use
every  skill  he  has,  every  piece  of  knowledge  about  Scientology  and
Dianetics, every piece of Policy, to handle his everyday  work  cycles.  Any
piece of tech by LRH, if a relevant handling for  the  situation,  is  grist
for the mill of a Cramming Officer.


    A good Cramming Officer, who uses all the tools  of  Qual  to  get  his
product, is worth his weight in gold. He is highly valued.


                                        Ens. Judy Ziff
                                        CS-5

      Reissued as BTB by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                  Authorized by AVU
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:SW:AL:MH:JZ:mh rd
Copyright � 1973, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               12 JUNE 1973RA
                                  Issue II

                   Revised & Reissued 25 July 1974 as BTB
                           Revised 4 December 1974
                        (Revision in this type sty/e)
Remimeo
Cramming Officers
                                   CANCELS
                            BTB OF 12 JUNE 1973R
                                  Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE


                            Cramming Series 13 RA



                     CRAMMING HEAVY HUSSAR HANDLING FOR
                        A BADLY BOGGED TECH PERSONNEL
                               OR STAFF MEMBER



    There comes a time in every Cramming Officer's life when he has to face
the situation of de-bugging a badly bogged tech personnel or staff member.


    This is caused by these factors:


    A.      Staff member refuses to do the  Cramming  Orders  through  post
        overwhelm  or  incorrect  Cramming  Orders  not  corrected  by  the
        Cramming Officer, thus violation of Qual Senior Datum.


    B.      Staff member has done the Cramming Orders to apparent  GIs  and
        F/N but has not been fully honest in  Cramming,  thus  causing  by-
        passed Whys and post inefficiency. This person is  glib  and  lacks
        confront.


    C.      Staff member was never Crammed in the first place.


    There is a way out which can unlock the situation, enable the real data
to be located, so the Why or Whys can be found and handled.


                                 THE METHOD

    This method works in Tech and  Admin  Cramming  quite  efficiently,  if
thoroughly and honestly done.

1.    Tell the person what you  are  going  to  do.  Get  his  agreement  to
    proceed and be assured of his participation.

2.    Get the person to write up a  full  list  of  all  done  or  not  done
    Cramming  Orders,  with  exact  specifics,  and  all  outnesses  listed
    separately. Details may have to be obtained from the Cramming Log Book.
    Every time something is repeated, put a slash alongside the item.

3.    Now ask the person to write up  any  other  Off  Policy  or  Out  Tech
    actions being done or not done on post which have not been picked up.

4.    Add these to the original list, putting a slash every time an item  is
    repeated.
    5.      Now work with the staff member to group the outnesses  together
    by subject area, level or basic.


    A.      Tech personnel outnesses will sort out into training levels  or
        into basics of auditing, course or case supervision, as applicable.


    B.      Admin staff outnesses will sort out into staff  member  basics,
        key hat duties, Scn basics and other categories  listed  in  BTB  7
        June 73 RA, "Admin Cramming".

6.    Add up all the slashes of the combined items.  This  will  locate  the
    Major Situation, as the one with the greatest number  of  slashes,  and
    the Minor Situations, the remainder in order of number of slashes.

7.    Take up the Major Situation and indicate this  to  the  staff  member.
    This should bring in VGIs. If not, go back and redo  the  above  steps,
    adding any missed data, until you do get VGIs.

8.    Now find the Why for the Major Situation. This  must  bring  in  VGIs.
    The Why Finding is done on the Meter.

9.    Work out a Handling for the Why which will handle the hell out of it.

10.   Get the Handling done immediately.

11.   When the Handling has been completed, send the staff member to the  Pc
    Examiner. If no F/N VGIs, find the right Why and complete the  Handling
    indicated by the right  Why.

12.   End off the Handling of the Major Situation to F/N VGIs.

13.   Now take up the Minor  Situations  in  order  of  greatest  number  of
    slashes, and find each Why and handle separately.

14.   There can be an EP  to  this  action.  The  person  has  a  tremendous
    resurgence of post efficiency, stats and morale and he  is  doing  well
    again. End off the Cramming at  that  point,  but  see  that  remaining
    Situations and Whys are handled either in Interne or staff training.

    This action can be done on an old-time Auditor who is anxious to return
to auditing, in order to clean up the past major areas of  failure.  An  old
HPA/HCA could get this action done in Cramming, for a fee, of course,  prior
to doing an Academy Retrain.


    The Cramming Officer must be familiar with all the tools he has at  his
disposal for the handling: HC List, Slow Eval Assessment, C/S 78  Wrong  Why
Finding Correction, Word Clearing, TRs, Admin TRs,  Reach  and  Withdraw,  3
May 72 PL, C/S 53RI, PTS Tech, confront of  MEST  and  work  areas,  various
study and staff correction lists, Pre-PCRD assessment, disagreement  checks,
Integrity Processing, writing drill, plus the  entirety  of  the  Technology
and Policy and Books of Dianetics and Scientology.


    In working with lists which contain training  and  auditing  correction
actions, the relevant training correction actions are done in Qual  and  the
Assessment form is routed to the Pc folder for the auditing  actions  needed
to be done and Staff C/S advised.


    Do not buy case reasons as Whys for staff member post flubs. There  are
always post or staff reasons for flubs. However,  if  the  Cramming  Officer
finds that staff on his lines are mis-audited  or  not  audited,  he  should
chit  the  D  of  P  and  Staff  Training  Officer  for  failure   to   take
responsibility for seeing that staff get regular Intensives on a  rotational
basis, and that staff members in trouble do have their folders  checked  for
Out Tech and do get corrected.
When it is found that the staff member never studied or checked out  on  key
data or post hat material in the first place, the correct Cramming  handling
is to cram in the key material so the person can now function, and see  that
a post training program is written up by Pers Programmer and done  in  staff
training.


    The one to five steps in the method above do not take more than a  half
to one hour at the most.


    Do not hesitate to use  TRs  and  drills  on  staff  members  in  Admin
Cramming. They need TRs and drilling as much as Tech personnel.


                    WHAT TO DO WITH THE STAFF MEMBER WHO
                        HAS NEVER BEEN CRAMMED IN THE
                                 FIRST PLACE

    As Admin Cramming starts being used more regularly  in  Orgs,  Cramming
Officers will find themselves with bogged  staff  who  have  never  had  any
Cramming. He will then be handling an  actual  backlog  situation  which  is
unexpressed.


    In this case, he should get a write-up from the Div  Head  involved  of
exactly how this person has been operating and the outnesses  observed.  The
Cramming Officer should then get the person himself  to  write  up  what  he
considers that he has been or  has  not  been  doing,  plus  a  write-up  of
exactly what post training the person has had The  Cramming  Off  goes  over
the data with the person and they  sort  out  and  group  the  outnesses  as
found, thus locating the key outness to be handled.  For  this  person,  the
handling will be what will rapidly handle  the  Why  found  and  enable  the
person to function on post. This action must be  followed  by  an  immediate
post program by the Personnel Programmer and completed in staff training.


    The Cramming Off must report Div Heads who won't cram  their  staff  to
the Qual Sec for Cramming correction orders on the Div Heads themselves.


    The steps of this Bulletin are remarkably efficient in  locating  major
hidden areas of outness in order to be able  to  handle  them.  The  hardest
part in handling a person who is badly bogged is just where  do  you  start?
These steps give an exact sequence to do this and  are  incredibly  easy  to
do.


                                        Ens. Judy Ziff
                                        CS-5

      Reissued as BTB by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                  Authorized by AVU
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:SW:AL:MH:JZ:mh rd
Copyright � 1973, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 15 OCTOBER 1974
Remimeo
Cramming
Officers
                                  IMPORTANT


                             Cramming Series 14


                           CRAMMING OVER OUT RUDS


    A Cramming Officer can fail in his efforts to correct a flubbing  staff
member if he tries to cram over out ruds.


    Cramming done over an ARC Break, like  Auditing,  will  result  in  the
person getting worse, more out of comm or misemotional.  Cramming  a  person
over a problem or W/H will produce no change so no correction will occur.


    Out ruds are easy to spot. The person with an ARC Break, won't talk  or
is misemotional or antagonistic. A problem produces fixated  attention  that
prevents Cramming from finding the actual area  of  difficulty.  Natter  and
1.1 remarks means a withhold.


    Recently a musician being crammed kept bringing up a dispatch  that  he
was in mystery about concerning the group. Every time it  was  mentioned  it
read or BDed yet the Cramming Officer continued  "Cramming"  him  and  never
handled it. So no product.


    I sat the musician down, told him he was crammed over  a  problem,  the
mystery about the dispatch, cleaned  it  up  by  getting  the  dispatch  and
letting him go over it, made sure the problem was  handled  then  found  the
area of misunderstood and traced it back to an early age and  the  Why  fell
right out.


    And I got the Cramming Officer crammed by the Senior C/S and found  her
Why too.


    So the moral of the story is DON'T CRAM OVER OUT RUDS.


    It is too costly in lost production and flaps.


                           CRAMMING OFFICER FLUBS

    When the Cramming Officer flubs you must get him crammed  fast  because
he will repeat the error on others and there goes your results.


    In such cases, get him crammed immediately by the Qual  Sec  or  Senior
C/S. If it is the Qual Sec who has flubbed, then he  is  crammed  either  by
the Senior C/S or the Keeper of Tech.

                             INCOMPLETE HANDLING

    It is often not enough just to correct a Why and do no further handling
in Cramming. Most Cramming Cycles reveal a broader area of  situation  which
must also be handled.


    An example is the Auditor who flubs on an L4BR and during the  Cramming
reveals he never really listened to the key SHSBC L&N tapes.
The Cramming Officer who does not also program the Auditor for a  review  of
those  tapes  would  not  have  fully  corrected  that  Auditor.  You  could
accurately predict future L&N flubs and pc upsets.


    A subsequent program such as the one above would count as an additional
Cramming Cycle for the Cramming Officer, or a Retread if lengthy  and  would
count as additional points.


    Therefore the maxim of Cramming is:

                         HANDLE THE HELL OUT OF IT.

    Honest correction must be fully and completely done for the sake of the
public and the org as well as the staff member.


                                   SUMMARY

    Cramming success depends on not Cramming over out  ruds  and  on  fully
handling all areas of confusion or weakness.


    Follow these operating rules and you will enjoy rave results  and  real
correction.


    And your org stats will soar.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 18 MARCH 1975

Remimeo

                             Cramming Series 15



                              METER USE IN QUAL


    All Cramming actions done in Qual must be done on a meter.  This  means
metered Why Finding,  checks  for  misunderstoods,  scouting  for  areas  of
uncertainty, completion of clay demos and word clearing.


    Neglect of the full use of the meter has led to half done,  ineffective
and often repeat Cramming cycles as the person's why or M/U was never  found
in the first place. Even worse, a wrong why can act as  a  wrong  list  item
which brings about case chaos.


    Every Cramming Officer must know and use all his tools.  This  includes
metering.


    The meter reveals all.


    Use it.


      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder


LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                             BOARD POLICY LETTER

                                6 APRIL 1972R
                  Revised & Reissued 16 October 1975 as BPL
Remimeo
Cramming
Officers
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO POLICY LETTER OF 6 APRIL 1972
                                  Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE


                             Cramming Series 16


                  HOW TO FIND A WHY ON A PERSON AND HANDLE

            (See HCO PL 19 March 1972, Issue II, Data Series 25,
                      "Learning to Use Data Analysis".)


    The tech of  finding  a  WHY  on  an  individual  person  is  extremely
important and is the fundamental tool of the Est O, Cramming  Officer,  Dept
of Personnel Enhancement and others.


    The resolution of a major broad WHY  can  depend  on  the  finding  and
handling of individual WHYs. EXAMPLE: In  LRH  ED  1  74R  INT  the  WHY  of
failures in Tech and Admin areas was found to be "STUDY TECH NOT IN USE  FOR
INDIVIDUAL WHYS FOR EACH SUPERVISOR AND STUDENT". A similar  example  exists
where tapes with Scientology materials were not in full or proper  use,  the
WHY being "TAPES WITH SCIENTOLOGY MATERIALS NOT IN  USE  FOR  AN  INDIVIDUAL
WHY FOR EACH ORG PERSON CONCERNED". In each case, the tech  of  finding  the
individual WHY is necessary to handling the broad WHY.


    This tech is contained in the DATA SERIES PLs and is restated  here  in
brief form for finding the WHY on a person.

                                    STEPS

1.    Know the Data Series PLs.  (Don't  have  any  misunderstood  words  on
    them.)

2.    Work out exactly what the person should be producing.

3.    Work out the ideal scene.

4.    Investigate the existing scene.

    OBSERVE THE SCENE around the person for outpoints related to  what  the
    person SHOULD be doing in an Ideal Scene.


    Verify that there is a situation with that individual and that you know
    what the situation is. Don't  go  trying  to  find  the  WHY  of  a  no
    situation. (A bad situation  is  measured  by  the  difference  between
    existing scene and an Ideal Scene and threat to Ideal Scene.)

5.    Ask the person exact specific questions pertaining to the situation.

6.    Do not  at any time ask the person for the WHY.  If  the  person  knew
    the WHY, the situation wouldn't exist.

7.    Use the comm  formula  and  get  your  questions  answered.  Don't  be
    diverted by the person's "reasons".
    8.      Note all outpoints.

9.    Be alert for the area(s) with the most outpoints which relate  to  the
    situation.

10.   Verify the data by looking This will often reveal the  major  outpoint
    which leads to the WHY. It must be realized that you are often  looking
    for an OMITTED something, hence a knowledge  of  the  Ideal  Scene  and
    product is required.

11.   When you find a major outpoint, trace down the chain of  outpoints  to
    the WHY. Pull the string by asking more questions in the  area  of  the
    Major Outpoint.

12.   The big crashing outpoint that explains all the other  outpoints  will
    be the WHY.

13.   The WHY must have something to do with the person. If  not,  you  will
    have a "Why is God" and it won't resolve.

14.   Indicate the WHY to the person. Correct WHYs result in Cogs and  VGIs.
    A wrong WHY can make the person feel degraded, will not bring  in  VGIs
    and will not lead to a resolution of the situation.

15.   Look over existing resources.

16.   Get a Bright Idea of how to handle.

17.   Handle or recommend handling so that it stays  handled.  The  handling
    of the WHY must directly relate to the WHY that was found.


                                  EXAMPLES

1.    Situation: Supervisor not using study tech.

    Investigation: Supervisor was observed, found to be  very  casual  with
students.  No  8-C.  Supervisor  questioned.  All  outpoints  in   area   of
Supervisor not wanting to tell students what to do and  himself  not  liking
to be told what to do.

    WHY: Big button on control and does not want to control others. WHY was
indicated with cognitions and VGIs after initial HE&R on the subject.


    Handling: Objective processes especially SCS.

2.    Situation: Student taking forever on study of tapes.

    Investigation: Observed student transcribing tapes so  he  could  later
look up the words. Didn't know why you don't go past a misunderstood word.


    WHY: Never studied the study tech.


    Handling: Primary Rundown.

3.    Situation: Staff member not doing his job. Ineffective on post.

    Investigation: Found out what the person was doing. Found he was  given
and had been doing the functions of another post.


    WHY: Accepting illegal orders.


    Handling: Offload of extraneous functions. Word Clear relevant PLs.

4.    Situation: Folder Page backlogging folders. Not getting  them  through
to C/S.
Investigation: Questioned Folder Page to find her product. Found  it  was  a
C/S not overloaded with folders.


    WHY: Working for a wrong product. Didn't know required product.


    Handling: Product Rundown.

5.    Situation: D of P not doing standard  duties.  Letting  Pcs  stall  on
lines.

    Investigation: Checked hat and flow chart. Found flow  chart  had  been
done but never referred to and missing all the  key  points  where  Pcs  can
stall on lines. Expecting Pcs to arrive back at HGC of their own accord.


    WHY: Unawareness of lines and terminals and how they can be influenced.


    Handling: Line Drills (following pipes and  flow  lines  in  an  engine
room). Make up correct flow chart and drill it.


    After finding  the  WHY  and  getting  the  handling  implemented,  the
situation is again reviewed to see if it still exists. If so,  a  wrong  WHY
was found. The Handling is to redo the steps and get the correct WHY. A  WHY
which cannot be handled or does not lead  toward  attainment  of  the  Ideal
Scene is of course a wrong WHY.


    The finding of individual WHYs on  persons  is  normally  a  very  fast
action. The WHY is simply found and the handling implemented.


    The more you do of them, the faster and more expert you become.


                             METERED WHY FINDING

    When Why Finding is done on a meter, the  above  steps  still  pertain;
however, meter reads are used to help  establish  the  situation  and  track
down the WHY. Falls or a BD would indicate the right area. The  correct  WHY
would result in F/N, Cog, VGIs. (At this point, you would indicate  the  WHY
and continue with steps 14-16.)


    Metered Why Finding should end with an F/N. Worksheets are kept.


    After any  Why Finding, metered or not, the person is sent  to  the  Pc
Examiner. The worksheets are routed to Tech Services so they  can  be  filed
in the person's Pc folder.

      Training & Services Aide
      and Dissem Aide
                                        by order of
                                        L. RON HUBBARD
                                        Founder
      Revised by Msm John Eastment
      A/CS-5
      and
      Molly Gilliam
      Flag Mission 1234 2nd
                                        Reissued as BPL by
                                        Flag Mission 1234 2nd
                                        Molly Gilliam
                                  Approved by the
                                  Commodore's Staff Aides
                                  and the Board of Issues
BDCS:CSA:BofI:BL:RR:JE:MG:mg.rd   for the
Copyright � 1972, 1975 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


























































                          Expanded Dianetics Series
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 15 APRIL 1972

Remimeo
Central Orgs Academies
London
Washington   (Revised issue of
Los Angeles HCOB 31 Mar 72)
Johannesburg
Denmark
Sydney
SHs
                        Expanded Dianetics Series 1R



    EXPANDED DIANETICS is that branch of Dianetics which uses Dianetics  in
special ways for specific purposes.


    It is not HSDC Dianetics. Its position on the  Grade  and  Class  Chart
would be just above Class IV. Its proper number is Class IVA.


    It uses Dianetics to change an Oxford Capacity Analysis (or an American
Personality Analysis) and is run directly against these analysis graphs  and
the "Science of Survival Hubbard Chart of Human Evaluation".


    EXPANDED DIANETICS IS NOT THE SAME AS STANDARD DIANETICS AS IT REQUIRES
SPECIAL TRAINING AND ADVANCED SKILLS.


    The HSDC is qualified to run Standard Dianetics. He is  not  authorized
to run EXPANDED DIANETICS without special training.


    DO NOT MIX EXPANDED DIANETICS INTO STANDARD DIANETICS.


    It  often  happens  that  one  technology's  skills  are  mingled  with
another's. The result is that neither then work.


    Standard Dianetics will go right on producing results.


    The main  difference  between  these  two  branches  is  that  Standard
Dianetics is  very  general  in  application.  Expanded  Dianetics  is  very
specifically adjusted to the pc.


    Some pcs, particularly  heavy  drug  cases,  or  who  have  been  given
injurious psychiatric treatment or who are physically disabled  or  who  are
chronically ill or who have had trouble running  engrams  (to  name  a  few)
require a specially adapted technology.


    A very good Dianetic and Class IV auditor (preferably HSDC & Class  VI)
can be specially trained to run Dianetics against the OCA or  the  Chart  of
Human Evaluation and handle other items of great value to a pc.

                                    STUDY
                             (Subject to Change)

    This training would consist of


            1.   HSDC


            2.   STANDARD DIANETIC INTERNE HGC OK TO AUDIT


            3.   Class 0-IV Academy (or Class VI)

        4.       PRIMARY CORRECTION RD HCOB 30 Mar 72  if  Primary  RD  not
             done
      5.    Full Word Clearer Rating

      6.    FESing

      7.    Expanded Dianetic Tapes and HCOBs

      8.    Programming

      9.    C/S Folder Study

      10.   Active Auditing on the skills taught

      11.   C/Sing Expanded Dianetics.


                                 CERTIFICATE

    The Certificate would be HUBBARD GRADUATE DIANETIC SPECIALIST.


    The Certificate Level is just above Class IV.


    Class IV is required. A Class VI SHSBC may be substituted for Class IV.


                                   CHARGES

    Hours of Expanded Dianetics, because of the skills required, should  be
at least half again or double as  much  as  Standard  Dianetic  Auditing  or
Lower Grade Auditing.


    The cost of the Course would  be  the  same  as  the  HSDC  Course  and
additional to it plus Interne fees.

                                PREREQUISITE

    HSDC and Dianetic Interneship  minimum  with  a  successful  period  of
Standard Dianetic Auditing as an auditor and is Class IV or VI.


    Case gain as a Dianetic pc, and all Lower Grades Triple.


                                 DEVELOPMENT

    Neither the Course nor Expanded Dianetic Auditing may be sold by an org
unless the org has an Expanded  Dianetic  Specialist,  to  be  specific,  an
HGDS.


    WHEN RELEASED THE COURSE  WILL  BE  TAUGHT  IN  CENTRAL  ORGS  (LONDON,
WASHINGTON, LOS ANGELES, JOHANNESBURG, DENMARK AND SYDNEY) AND  SHs.  IT  IS
THE SPECIAL COURSE THE CONTINENTAL CENTRAL ORG TEACHES.


    The HCOBs relating to Expanded Dianetics will be released as a part  of
this series so that orgs will have them when  it  comes  time  for  them  to
acquire the tapes and teach this course.


    In the meanwhile these orgs should be making HSDCs and Class IVs.


    PERSONS NOT TRAINED ON IT MAY NOT RUN IT OR USE IT REGARDLESS OF CLASS.


    To repeat, Expanded Dianetics does not replace  Standard  Dianetics  or
any other Class and is itself and is used for its own specific  purposes  on
special cases.


LRH:nt.rd                                    L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1972                                   Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                3 APRIL 1972R
                                   Issue I
Remimeo
Ex Dn Revised & Reissued 6 June 1974 as BTB
Checksheet
                        HCO BULLETIN OF 3 APRIL 1972
                                  Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE


                        Expanded Dianetics Series 2R


                           CLEARING LISTS AND R3-R


    "A great many people can't go into Dianetics at all. They can't run  an
engram at all.


    "That is uniformly one of two things: it is drugs, or the commands have
not been cleared.


    "This is very interesting to you, that FAILURE  TO  CLEAR  UP  ALL  THE
WORDS IN THE COMMANDS WITH THE PC, AND THE FAILURE TO CLEAR  EVERY  ISOLATED
DIFFERENT WORD IN THE LIST, INCLUDING THE TINY LITTLE  WORDS  ('IS',  'THE',
'FROM', 'SUCH'), CAN CAUSE YOU TO GET READS ON THE ITEMS THE PC HIMSELF  HAS
GIVEN YOU, THAT AREN'T VALID.


    "Now it is not: Do you know what this word means? You ask: WHAT IS  THE
DEFINITION OF________?


    "They can't give it to you? Have your stuff right to hand. Look it up.


    "Have your metering perfect and all the rest  of  that,  but  clear  up
those words and you'll get the pcs that fail."
                                                                         LRH


    The following is a list of the words in R3-R Procedure and  the  L3-ExD
RB.

A     basic communication    do
abandoned   be   connected   drugs
about been  confused   duration
accept      before     continue
actions     beginning  constantly earlier
affinity    black      correct    else
after by    could      emotion
all   by-passed  curious     emotions
an               end
and   can   date enforced
another     causing    death engrams
are   chain demanded   erasing
ARC Break   chains     desired    exterior
assessment  changed    destructive      eyes
audited     changing   Dianetic
auditor     charge     didn't     false
at    close different  feel
attitude    commands   distracted field
first jumped     persistent  stuck
flat  just  picture    suppressed
flow        pictures
flubbed     late place taken
F/N   later point      tell
(Floating   list pressure    than
needle)     locate     prevented  that
for         problem    the
found mass  protest    there
from  me    protesting thing
      medicine         things
go    messed     real  this
going misassessment    reality    through
gone  misrun     really      time
got   missed     reason      to
      misunderstood    recall     too
happened    more refused     trouble
have  move  repair     twice
how         restimulated     two
      new   restimulation
implant     no   run   understanding
impulse     not  running     up
in    nothing          upset
incident         same
incidents   of   saying      was
incorrect   off  scan  went
indicated   okay see   were
inhibited   on   sensation   what
intentions  one  session     when
Int R/D     or   should      while
interiorization  other shouldn't  with
into  others     similar     withhold
invalidated over solid wording
invisible   overrun    something  wrong
is          soon
it    pain  spot you
item  past  stopped    your

    Note that some of these words have several senses, all of  which  would
have to be cleared.


    "IT ISN'T THE HARD WORDS, IT'S THE STUPID ONES."-LRH


                                        List compiled by
                                        Dianetic Specialist Team

      Based on a lecture by L. Ron Hubbard

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                        Authorized by AVU

BDCS:SW:AL:MH:AG:BA:FG:JA:al.rd   for the
Copyright � 1972,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 2 APRIL 1972RB
                                  Issue II
                           (REVISED 17 MARCH 1974)
Remimeo
Ex Dn Chkshts
                              I M P O R T A N T

                        Expanded Dianetics Series 3RB


                                  L3 EXD RB
                       EXPANDED DIANETICS REPAIR LIST




    This list includes the most frequent Exp Dianetic & R3R errors.


    A high or low TA and a bogged case can result from failures to erase  a
chain of incidents.


    DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REPAIR A CHAIN OR ENGRAM WITHOUT USING THIS  LIST  as
it can have different or several errors.


    REMEMBER TO CLEAR EACH WORD ON THIS LIST. IF A QUESTION READS  AND  THE
PC SAYS HE DOESN'T UNDERSTAND IT, CLEAR IT AND REASSESS  (don't  explain  it
and take it as it read on a misunderstood not on a fact).


    RUNNING PCS ON EXP DIANETICS WITHOUT A  FULL  AND  COMPLETE  DN  C/S  I
INDOCTRINATION IS A FOOLISH ACTION.


    TAKE ANY READ FOUND TO F/N BY FULL REPAIR OF IT PER THE INSTRUCTIONS.

1.    There was an Earlier Similar incident. _________
      Indicate it, flatten the chain.

2.    There was no Earlier Similar incident. _________
    Indicate it. Determine if the chain is flat or if the last incident
    needs to be run through again. Complete the chain to F/N by
    indication or D/L if needed, or by flattening it.

3.    There was an earlier beginning.   _________
      Indicate it. Handle with R3R and complete the chain.

4.    There was no earlier beginning.   _________
    Indicate it. Complete the chain with R3R ABCD on last incident
    if unflat.

5.    An F/N was indicated too soon.    _________
      Indicate it. Flatten the last incident.

6.    An F/N was indicated too late.    _________
    Indicate it. Spot the flat point, indicate the overrun, D/L if
    necessary.
7.    An F/N was not indicated at all.  _________
    Indicate it. Spot the flat point, indicate the overrun, D/L if
    necessary.

8.    There was no charge on an item in the first place. _________
    Indicate it, and that it shouldn't have been run, D/L if necessary.

9.    Jumped chains.   _________
      Indicate it. Reorient to the original chain, spot flat point and
      indicate the overrun, D/L if necessary, or flatten the chain.

10.   Flubbed commands.      _________
      Indicate it, E/S to F/N.

11.   Didn't have a command. _________
      Indicate it, E/S to F/N.

12.   Misunderstood on the command.     _________
      Find it and clear it.

13.   Incident should be run through one more time.      _________
      Indicate it. ABCD on the incident, flatten the chain.

14.   Too late on the chain. _________
      Indicate it. Get the Earlier Similar incident and complete the
      chain with R3R.

14A   Wrong Flow.      _________
      Indicate it. Run it the way pc feels it should be run.

15.   Incident gone more solid.   _________
      Indicate it. Check for earlier incident or earlier beginning and
      complete the chain.

16.   Stopped running an incident that was erasing.      _________
      Indicate it. ABCD on the incident and erase it.

17.   Went past basic on a chain. _________
      Indicate it, D/L if necessary.

18.   An earlier misrun incident restimulated.     _________
      Indicate it. Find out what it was and do an L-3RD on it.

19.   Two or more incidents got confused.    _________
      Indicate it, sort it out with an L-3RD on it.

20.   An implant was restimulated.      _________
      Indicate it, if no joy do an L-3RD on the time of the
      restimulation.

21.   The incident was really an implant.    _________
      Indicate it, D/L if necessary or L-3RD on it.
22.   Wrong Item.      _________
      Indicate it was a wrong item and that all other actions
      connected with it were wrong. If it is from an L&N list or if any
      question or difficulty, L-4BR.

22A   It was really  your  attitudes  to  it  that  should  have  been  run.
_________
      Indicate it. List the attitudes, R3R triple and exhaust the list.

22B   It was really the emotions connected with it  that  should  have  been
run   _________
      Indicate it. List the emotions, R3R triple and exhaust the list.

22C    It  was  really  your  intentions  that   should   have   been   run.
_________
      Indicate it. List the intentions, R3R triple and exhaust the list.

23.   Not your item.   _________
      Indicate it, E/S to F/N.

24.   Not your incident.     _________
      Indicate it, E/S to F/N. L-3RD if any trouble.

25.   Same thing run twice.  _________
      Indicate it. Spot the first flat point, indicate the overrun, D/L if
      necessary, or run out the session.

26.   There was a wrong date.     _________
      Indicate it. Get the correct date and flatten the incident if unflat.

27.   There was no date for the incident.    _________
      Indicate it. Get the date and flatten the incident if unflat.

28.   It was a false date.   _________
      Indicate it. Get the correct date and flatten the incident if unflat.

29.   There was an incorrect duration.  _________
      Indicate it. Get the correct duration  and  flatten  the  incident  if
unflat.

30.   No duration was found for the incident.      _________
      Indicate it. Get the duration and flatten the incident if unflat.

31.   There was a false duration.       _________
      Indicate it. Get the correct duration  and  flatten  the  incident  if
unflat.

32.   An earlier Dianetic upset was restimulated.  _________
      Locate what it was,  indicate  it.  Sort  it  out  with  an  L-3RD  if
necessary.

33.   An earlier ARC Break on engrams was restimulated.  _________
      Indicate it. Sort it out with an L-3RD, ARCU CDEINR or an L-1C
      as applicable, or run out the session.

34.   There was an ARC Break in the incident.      _________
      Indicate it. Flatten the incident if unflat. ARCU CDEINR at that
      time if necessary.
34A   Destructive impulse been missed.  _________
      Get it. It should  BD  F/N.  If  this  turns  into  a  listing  action
complete
      the list to BD F/N item.

35.   You were protesting.   _________
      Indicate it, clean it up E/S to F/N.

36.   Auditor demanded more than you could see.    _________
      Indicate it, E/S to F/N. L-1C if necessary, or run out the session.

37.   Auditor refused to accept what you were saying.    _________
      Indicate it, E/S to F/N. L-1C if necessary, or run out the session.

38.   You were prevented from running an incident. _________
      Indicate it, E/S to F/N. Flatten the incident if unflat. L-1C if
      necessary, or run out the session.

39.   You were distracted while running an incident.     _________
      Indicate it, E/S to F/N. Flatten the incident if unflat. L-1C if
      necessary, or run out the session.

40.   Audited over an  ARC Brk    _________
                 Problem     _________
                 Withhold    _________
      Indicate it and handle the out rud. Do not pull W/Hs before the
      engram or chain is repaired or it will mush engrams.

41.   An item was suppressed.     _________
      Indicate it. Get the suppress off E/S to F/N, then run or flatten
      the item.

42.   An item was invalidated.    _________
      Indicate it. Get the inval off E/S to F/N, then run or flatten the
      item.

43.   An item was abandoned. _________
      Indicate it, get the item back and run or flatten it.

44.   The wording of the item was changed.   _________
      Indicate it. Get the correct wording and give it to him. Flatten it
      if unflat.

45.   Stuck picture.   _________
      Indicate it. Do an L-3RD on it. You can also unstick it by having
      him recall a time before it  and  recall  a  time  after  it.  D/L  if
necessary.

46.   All black. _________
      Spot the black field or picture. Get the correct duration. If no go,
      L3RD on it.

47.   Invisible. _________
      Spot the invisible field or picture. L-3RD on it.
48.   Constantly changing pictures.     _________
      Indicate there was a misassessment and a wrong item was taken
      off the list. Get the correct item  and  run  it,  or  L-3RD  on  that
session.

49.   There was a persistent mass.      _________
      L3RD on it, or D/L.

50.   There was trouble with  a  pressure  item  or  pressure  on  an  item.
_________
      L-3RD on it, or D/L.

51.   You went exterior.     _________
      Indicate it, D/L if necessary or rehab. If TA  high  as  a  result  of
this do
      an Int RD Correction List or send to the C/S if pc hasn't had Int RD.

52.   Your Int RD was messed up.  _________
      Indicate it, Int RD Corr List if TA high. If TA OK, 2wc "going
      into things" or clear up any misunderstoods on Int, Ext, etc.

53.   Audited over Drugs or Medicine.   _________
      Indicate it. L3RD on that time, then verify all chains to ensure
      they erased.

54.   A past death restimulated.  _________
      Indicate it, if it doesn't blow run it out.

55.   There was nothing wrong in the first place.  _________
      Indicate it. Continue the action you were on.

56.   The real reason was missed.       _________
      Indicate it. Locate the real reason and handle or do a GF.

57.   Something else wrong.  _________
      Locate what it is and sort it out or do a GF M5 and handle.




                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH: ntm jh
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED

                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 20 APRIL 1972

Remimeo


                         Expanded Dianetics Series 4

                   (Adds C/S Series 76 to HGDS checksheet)

                         SUPPRESSED PCS AND PTS TECH


    (PTS means  Potential  Trouble  Source  which  itself  means  a  person
connected to a Suppressive Person.)


    As the Dianetic Specialist (HGDS) is often called upon  to  handle  pcs
who are not well, it is vital that he knows  all  about  and  can  use  "PTS
Tech".


    All sick persons are PTS.


    All pcs who rollercoaster (regularly lose gains) are PTS.


    Suppressive persons are themselves PTS to themselves.


    If a Dianetic Specialist does not know this, have reality upon  it  and
use it, he will have loses on pcs he need not have.


    There is considerable Administrative Tech connected with  this  subject
of PTS and there is a special Rundown which handles PTS people.


    They get handled if the auditor knows his PTS tech, if he  audits  well
and if he uses both the auditing and Administrative Tech to handle.


    The Administrative Tech requires an interview, usually by the  Director
of Processing or Ethics Officer and the person is  required  to  handle  the
PTS situation itself before being audited. A check  for  stability  is  also
made after being audited on the PTS Rundown.


    For this reason, HCO B 17 April 72 and all the checksheet of HCO P/L 31
May 71 must be fully known to the Dianetic Specialist.


    HCO B 17 April 72 is also C/S Series 76 so as  to  be  sure  that  Case
Supervisors handle the Admin and C/Sing correctly.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder








LRH: mes .rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 24 APRIL 1972
                                   Issue I
Remimeo
D of P
Auditors    C/S Series 79
Ethics
Officers    Expanded Dianetics Series 5

                               PTS INTERVIEWS
                (Reference HCO B 17 April 72, C/S Series 76)


    Interviews to discover a PTS condition are done on  a  meter  with  all
reads marked.


    The Interview asks (a) about persons who are hostile or antagonistic to
the pc, (b) about groups that are anti-Scientology,  (c)  about  people  who
have harmed the pc, (d) about things  that the pc thinks are suppressive  to
the pc, (e) about locations that are suppressive to the pc  and  about  past
life things and beings suppressive to the pc.


    In doing the Interview the Interviewer must realize that a sick  person
is PTS. There are no sick people who are not PTS to someone or  a  group  or
something somewhere.


    A somewhat suppressive pc will find the  good  hats  suppressive.  This
does not relieve his condition. He is PTS to SP people,  groups,  things  or
locations, no matter how SP he is.


    He can have been audited by someone he knew in an earlier life and  who
goofed the session. A few auditors have since  been  declared.  Not  because
they goofed but because they were SP.


    However, some PTS pc will make trouble for good people because that  is
what PTS means (Potential Trouble Source).  So  do  not  buy  all  the  good
people he is PTS to.


    Further, when you do get the person or group or thing or  location  the
PTS person will F/N VGI and begin to get well.


    The PTS condition is actually a problem and a mystery and a  withdrawal
so it is sometimes hard to find and has to be specially processed  (3  S&Ds)
to locate it.


    Usually it is quite visible.


    Don't have a sick, rollercoaster pc appear for Interview and  then  say
"not PTS". It's a false report. It only means the Interviewer did  not  find
it.


    The pc sometimes begins to list  in  such  an  Interview  and  such  an
Interview where a wrong item is found has to  be  audited  to  complete  the
list or find the right item. (See C/S Series 78, HCO  B  20  Apr  72,  Issue
II.)


    So Interview worksheets are VITAL. The Interview should end on an F/N.


    The Interview is followed by the Ethics action of HCO PL 5 April 72  or
other Ethics actions such  as  handling  or  disconnection  and  posting  as
called for in policy.


    An Interviewer has to use good TRs and operate his meter  properly  and
know 2-way comm and PTS tech.


    Some Interviewers are extremely successful.


    Such Interviews and handling count as auditing hours.


    When properly done, plus good auditing  on  the  PTS  RD,  well  people
result.

LRH:mes.rd  L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1972       Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 10 AUGUST 1972
                      (Amended & Reissued 28 March 1974
                         -only change is Series No.)
Remimeo

                         Expanded Dianetics Series 6

                                C/S Series 82


                               DIANETIC HCO B
                                  INTEREST


    On two certain  subjects  the  "Interest?"  question  is  omitted  from
Dianetic R3R patter.


    On drugs and when running Evil Purposes or Intentions one does NOT  ask
the pc if he is interested in running the item.


    The requirement on both drug items and intentions is that the item read
on the meter (suppress and inval can be used) and has not been  run  by  R3R
previously.


    Many pcs, it has now been found, have replied "No, no  interest"  on  a
drug item, the item has not been run and  the  pc  then  continued  to  have
trouble with drugs.


    Checking back pcs who returned to drugs  after  auditing  showed  "drug
rundowns" that were so brief as to be nothing. One pc who had  been  on  LSD
for years had only  a  I  hour  quickie  drug  rundown.  Later  this  person
relapsed.


    Tracing this, in each case the "Interest?" question had been  used  and
the pc had replied "No interest" BUT MEANT  "I'M  NO  LONGER  INTERESTED  IN
DRUGS."


    So Drug items that have read are run R3R without asking  for  interest.
The command is simply omitted.


    In Expanded Dianetics the same  thing  has  occurred  in  running  Evil
Purposes or Intentions. The Auditor asked the pc if  he  was  interested  in
running the item and the pc said "No" and so it went untouched. But  the  pc
had it confused with interest in doing the purpose  and  missed  running  it
and then fell on his head later. Tracing the case back  it  was  found  that
R/Ses and such had not been run due to the pc saying "No Interest".


    Nothing bad will happen if the item is run.


                             C/S RESPONSIBILITY

    The C/S must keep telling his auditors, on drugs or Expanded Dianetics,
"Omit asking for interest on R3R on these (drug) (intentions). Run  them  if
they read on the meter."

                                   REPAIR

    In repairing cases it is good sense to check this point  on  drugs  and
intentions to see if they were neglected in R3R due to "no interest".


    If so, then have them run and the case will suddenly do well.



LRH:nt.ntm jh                                L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1972, 1974                             Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 13 SEPTEMBER 1972

Remimeo     (Amended & Reissued 28 March 1974
All Dn & Ex Dn   -only change is Series No.)
Auditors
Class VIII  DIANETICS
C/Ses
                         Expanded Dianetics Series 7

                                C/S Series 85

                       CATASTROPHES FROM AND REPAIR OF
                             "NO INTEREST" ITEMS


    I have done a review of several failed cases which  blew  or  went  bad
after auditing.


    THE COMMON FACTOR IN EVERY ONE WAS CASE BY-PASSED DUE TO "NO INTEREST".


    The auditor finds a reading drug item or an evil purpose  and  proposes
to run R3R on it. The auditor asks if the pc is interested  in  running  it.
The pc says, "No." The auditor does not run it. BANG, we  have  a  BY-PASSED
CASE.


    The pc will blow or go sour or not recover.


    One of these cases was unchanged after "a drug rundown". He had a  pair
of eyes that looked like blank discs. Check of folder showed all major  drug
items "not run due to no interest". The solution was to recover  the  lists,
run the items that had read R3R triple and complete the case.


    Another one blew. His folder was examined. Every evil purpose had  been
left unrun! Of the items from the "Wants  Handled  Rundown"  the  intentions
were mislisted. The drug rundown failed due to "no interest".


    Each flubbed case I am finding has had his drug items and evil purposes
left unrun on R3R due to "no interest".


    So DON'T ASK FOR INTEREST ON INTENTIONS, EVIL PURPOSES AND DRUG ITEMS.


    IF THEY READ, RUN THEM!

                                   REPAIR

1.    On any stumbling case that  has  had  a  "drug  rundown"  or  Expanded
    Dianetics get the Folder FESed to see if reading items were left  unrun
    on R3R Triple. List them chronologically, early to late.

2.    Get the case back, with an R factor of "Incomplete".

3.    Run  every  one  of  those  unrun  drug  items,  intentions  and  Evil
    Purposes.

4.    If the items don't now read, then get in Suppress  and  Invalidate  on
    them.

5.    If the case bogs do L3RD Method 5 and Handle on that chain only.

6.    Go on with the action and complete it.


LRH:sb.ntm.rd    L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1972,1974  Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               30 AUGUST 1972
                                   Issue I
                            Issued 28 March 1974
Remimeo
Ex Dn C/Ses CANCELS
Ex Dn HCO BULLETIN OF 30 AUGUST 1972
Auditors
                                  Issue II

                         Expanded Dianetics Series 8
                           (Series Number Amended)


                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE A

                                    [pic]

GRAPH-Out of valence and crazy.

CASE NOTES-

        TA High, Quickie W/C 1,  shallow  Dianetics,  has  been  scared  in
        auditing, and body overweight. Grade IV.

EXP DN PROGRAM by Dn Specialist.

        1.       C/S 53 clean and handle.
        2.       W/Clear M 1 C/S 1, WCCL.
        3.       Handle WCCL.
        4.        M1  verified  or  completed;  add:  auditing,   commands,
             sessions.
        5.       W/Clear L3EXD and R3R.
        6.       Assess PT environment buttons and list Attitudes, Emotions
             on reading items, R3R Triple.
        7.       Assess Class VIII auditing list, on reading items  AE  R3R
             Triple. . W/Form-stress losses, R3R Triple.
        9.       LXs R3R Triple.
        10.      OCA.


        LRH "OK".

THE PROGRAM IS STARTED 14.4.72.

The C/S 53  goes  OK  but  not  F/Ning.  Pc  has  sore  back,  hard  to  get
comfortable. Pc tends to have high TA at start  of  session  but  goes  down
right away.

LRH-- "It's probably as simple as she doesn't at first grip the  cans.  Look
it over."
C/S BY AUDITOR-

      "0.   Check can handling of pc."--LRH
      1.    Touch Assist.
      2.    Fly all Ruds.
      3.    Reassess C/S 53 to F/N list.
            4.   Continue program.
            "5.  Havingness."--LRH

Only the touch assist is given. TA is high at exams.  Auditor  C/Ses  for  a
C/S 53.

LRH-- "The C/S will probably handle. Could be PTS Roller Coaster."

NEXT SESSION AUDITOR COMMENT-

When pc back on cans from any break TA is up, but immediately blows down.

LRH-- "Probably cans dry  or  something,  could  be  mass  that  moves.  Not
        important."

AUDITOR'S C/S-

        1.       Cont M 1 W/C to F/N list.
        2.       Hav.

Session goes fine.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT-

        She's doing well. There's a bit of pain in back. I had her hold the
        cans to exams. So she had them in contact after session. And  there
        was no TA trip. TA was 2.75 F/N and no big BD.

LRH-- "Very Well Done. Good on cans.  Back  pn  requires  a  very  extensive
        touch assist using both sides of spine and  also  body  extremities
        and head. (Toe, back, hands, back, head, back, toes, etc, each  one
        several and on both sides.) Your C/S is Okay. Get as a completion a
        cured person."

AUDITOR'S C/S-

        1.       Touch Assist.
        2.       Hav.
        3.       Cont M 1 to F/N list.

Touch Assist only done next session.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS-

        Touch Assist fine. No F/N at exams so I took her  back  and  really
        finished her, to nice cog, pn gone, and F/N VGIs.

LRH-- "Very Well Done. Good to see an auditor auditing the pc."

Pc continues M1. On the subject AUDITING pc goes  E/S  to  CONSULTATION  and
Rock Slams.

LRH-- "Very Well Done-note R/S on Pgm."

8RR clean but not F/Ning. Next session WCCL clean even  with  supp  but  not
F/Ning.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS-
        Something wrong here-no pn at all in back today. (TA  normal  range
        2.7.)

LRH-- "Well Done. No EP as you say.

        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       Assess C/S 53.
        3.       Handle.

        When you assess it, 2wc the earliest read and so on down  the  list
        so you find
        out what's up. If Int, lists or Ruds read, Int Ext Corr  List,  L4B
        or Ruds will have to be handled."

WCCL and 8RR F/N.

A NEW PROGRAM IS WRITTEN-this in accordance with Exp Dn  Tape  3  where  the
actual Exp Dn auditing is programmed as a separate grade and  written  on  a
blue sheet. Intentions are added because the pc R/Sed.

LRH-- "A pc doesn't have to R/S to have intentions added. "

AUDITOR'S PROGRAM-

      a.    Touch Assist if needed each session.
      b.    Hav at end of each session.
      1.    Attest current Ml comp.
      2.    2wc  PT  Environment.  Note  BDs  and  reads.  E.A.I.  on  items
reading.         R3R Triple.
      3.    Assess Cl VIII auditing list E.A.I. R3R Triple.
            4.   WF-stress Emotional Stresses and Losses. R3R Triple.
      5.    LXs. R3R Triple.
      *6.   Sanderson RD (was added later).
      7.    OCA.

      LRH "OK".

Pc was sent to the hospital for X-Ray on back by MO.

LRH-- "One set of X-Rays wasted. You'll get a product here soon."

Pc runs very well for several sessions. At end of session on PT  Environment
Buttons pc says-"One problem with sessions,  face  gets  tired  (smiling  so
much) haven't felt as good as this in a long time," F/N VGI.

AUDITOR INSTRUCTIONS-

        May Declare.


        1.       Have you any doubts or reservations that you have attained
             the ability to handle your PT Environment?
        2.       Would you like to attest PT Environment handling complete?


        Pc does with VGIs.


        LRH-- "Very Well Done."

A few sessions later the auditor is 2wcing at the start  of  a  session  and
picks up an ARC Break. There is no F/N so goes to  GF  and  F/Ns  on  M/W/H.
(Does not complete the ARC Break chain.)

*FOOTNOTE: The "Wants Handled RD" as outlined in Expanded  Dianetics  Series
21, HCO B 28 March 1974, was originally called the "Sanderson RD"  on  Flag.
(TEAM C/S.)
LRH-- "Well Done." LRH adds to the C/S:

        "0.      Repair ARC Break of last session. O/R?, Not there?  Handle
             and F/N."

Running LX lists, pc after session does  not  F/N,  TA  3.6  clean.  Auditor
takes her back and does a C/S 53. "Have you committed  any  Overts",  "False
TA" and "Not Saying" read. Auditor exhausts  possibility  of  False  TA  and
then takes up Overt. VGIs at session end but TA  3.2.  Dial  F/N  at  exams.
Auditor says pc tired.

LRH-- "Well Done by Exams. Please  don't  run  on  wrong  whys.  She  wasn't
        tired, AND we always end a session on an F/N. The reason it took so
        long is you kept saying 'Supp' 'Inval' WHEREAS GROUP C says E/S  to
        F/N.


        Study the C/Ses you do, particularly C/S 53RRR. You have  now  left
        earlier charge unhandled and next session she may natter at you.


        She comes up with an 'I stole a pin from HASI' sort of patty  cake,
        you buy it, no E/S and no F/N."


LRH C/S-

        "1.      R-Factor. On the overt chain we were running, there was no
             F/N. I want to check s'thing.


        Something you didn't do?________(note read)


        Something you did do? ________


        Something someone else did? ________


        Take what read and say, 'It was something________' (whatever read).


        Now what was it? ________


        Get what it is by steering if necessary then when she says  it,  if
        no F/N, go earlier similar.


        If no joy, take the other  read  (on  C/S  53)  and  say,  'There's
        something you're not saying. What is it?' Get it. F/N or E/S F/N.


        If still no joy ask her, 'Well did you murder somebody?'  'Did  you
        rob a bank?' 'Did you forget something that burned the house down?'
        Get the overt !


        2. If 'Not Saying' was not used then ask, 'What is  it  you're  not
        saying?' If it was used above say, 'Is there something  you're  not
        saying to me or others?' E/S to F/N it."

LRH-- "It isn't that you didn't use E/S you just didn't get an overt  first.
        The stuff you bought was  drivel.  You  don't  run  overts  like  a
        phonograph record, you get the overt."

Auditor uses 1. fully and gets the overt. Pc R/Ses on "going  into  action".
On Murder Technique the pc says, "There was a fire  in  store  room.  I  put
stuff next to heater. Don't consider it an overt."

LRH-- "Very Well Done. You did  it.  That's  the  old  Murder  Routine.  The
        mechanism is 'worse than'. This routine is just one version of  it.
        Joburg 1960, earlier DC, it was
        'Tell me something worse  than  (the  body  condition)'  repetitive
        bypassing all F/Ns will cure a cripple.


        This pc (what she considers an overt) has several  Evil  Intentions
        (R/Ses) and will need the Wants Handled RD. Letting ships  on  fire
        is NOT an  overt  to  her!  Sex  is  so  evident.  Psychoanalytical
        background.


        Session is classic."

A few days later pc assigned a personal condition of Danger.

AUDITOR-

      Suggests L1C Recently to handle.

LRH-- "Ethics. Don't audit pcs in Ethics, this isn't right Tech."

LRH-- "Pc in Ethics trouble. We got to her  too  late  and  some  senior  is
        across lines. (If they'd waited a day she wd  have  made  it.)  You
        don't audit a pc in Ethics trouble unless you do a 3rd May  72  P/L
        on her with L&N.

Off auditing until out of Ethics. That's by the book."

MAA- Next day pc has 1 hr 20 min PTS Check by MAA.

PC-Next day pc is upgraded to Emergency. Auditor  asks  if  OK  to  continue
program.

LRH-- "PTS terminals found very extensive for a PTS Check. PTS RD  must  now
        be completed."

LRH C/S-

        " 1.     Fly all ruds Triple.
           2.    Using terminals from interview and any other do PTS RD per
             HCO Bs.
           3.    Run Can't Have on those already R3Red. You R3R Triple  the
             terminals first."

Later in the PTS RD the auditor 2wc to F/N and starts Fl R3R on a  terminal.
It bogs. Auditor goes to L3B but TA  remains  high  and  does  not  resolve.
Auditor suggests C/S 53RC and handle.

LRH-- "Some oddball error here you didn't catch. This is plain Dn repair."

LRH C/S-

        " 1.     Assess M5


        (a)      By-passed an F/N ________


        (b)       Chain  flattened  half  way  thro'   1st   incident   run
        ________


        (c)      Jumped into a new set of pictures ________


        (d)      Item wasn't reading in the first place ________


        (e)      Item already blown    ________

        Handle.


           2.    Handle reads on L3B to F/N.


           3.    Continue PTS RD."

PTS RD and Hav steps completed. Pc declares.

Pc has high TA at Success. High TA a bother.

LRH-- "Use Hi-Lo-you handle a High TA case all ways you can."

TA still high so auditor does C/S 53RC. Int reads so  does  Int  Corr  List.
"You ran went out" reads sF. Auditor runs Int as far as Sec F1 and it bogs.

LRH-- "Hey I never told you to run Int! That wasn't the C/S or any  part  of
        it. She ran leaving  and have to stay  and I'm sure you've run  Int
        the second time."

LRH C/S-

        " 1.     Was the Int RD done before? Spot exact place it was  flat.
              Date to blow. Locate to blow. If you can't do this give to an
              auditor who can and take her back.
           2.    C/S 53RC. Handle to F/Ning list.
           3.    L3EX Dn general to F/N list.

        Don't restim her further! Don't miss any F/Ns."

AUDITOR-finishes LX3, LX2, LX1 items and Sanderson RD.

                                    [pic]

GRAPH when pc complete 12.6.72.

Pc attests to Exp Dn complete. New OCA is up. She is 60 pounds lighter.

Total No. of sessions 48. Total hrs in chair 91 hrs 51 min.


                                  Compiled by:
                                  Ex Dn Spec Team
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY




BDCS:WS:MM:ntmjh
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               30 AUGUST 1972
                                  Issue II
                            Issued 28 March 1974
Remimeo
Ex Dn C/Ses
                                   CANCELs
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 30 AUGUST 1972
                                  Issue III


                         Expanded Dianetics Series 9
                           (Series Number Amended)

                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE B

             (Note: This case was  made  well,  but  not  sane.  This  is  a
             research case and is one of the subjects of HCO B 13  Sept  72.
             It is included to show how a case can become  physically  well,
             yet be by-passed.)


                                    [pic]


CASE NOTES-Chronic illness, glib auditing history, had upper level  auditing
over very unflat Dn. Won't run Dn as "Nothing there".  Tone  1.1.  Professed
Grade OT III but actually not complete on lowest grade Dianetics.

EXP DN PROGRAM by Dn Specialist. Steps added by LRH. 1.4.72.


        0.       "Clear all words on a WC C/S 1 & WC Corr List." LRH.


        1.       Verify or complete Method 1  WC.  Add:  Processing,  Tech,
             Commands, Study.


        2.       Clear all Dn definitions. Clear all R3R words. Clear L3B.


        3a.      2wc PT Environment. Note all LF, BD items. Make a list  of
             these.


        b.       Assess attitudes, emotions on best read from a.


        c.       List from best read of b. and exhaust.


        d.       Repeat b. and c. until item F/Ns.


        e.       Handle all items per b. c. d. and reassess to F/Ning list.
             4a.   Assess  for  best  read.  Auditors,  auditing,  etc.  Add
             pictures, R3R.


        b.       Assess emotions, attitudes, sensations,  on  best  reading
             from a.


        c.       List from b. best read and exhaust, R3R Triple.


        d.       Repeat b. and c. till item F/Ns.


        e.       Reassess a., do b. c. d. e. till whole list F/Ns.


                 NOTE: If nothing comes up on 3 and 4 assess LX3, 2, 1,  in
             b. of each.


        5a.      White Form. Get all emotional stress incidents.


        b.       R3R Narr Triple all from a.


        c.       Handle attitudes to treatment, if reads well,  by  listing
             treatments, SEAs, to F/Ning list.


        d.       Handle attitudes to illness, if reads as in c.


        6.       LX3, 2,1 general.


        7.       New OCA.


        On 8.4.72 LRH added "Hav before and after body of session."

PROGRAM STARTED 1.4.72. The pc clears lots of words.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT-Pc started a  little  gripey  about  clearing  words,  but
became interested when he discovered there were some he didn't know!

LRH-- "Very Well Done. Out WC Ml probably helped cause his  illness.  Ethics
        action was indicated here; WC Ml declared prior to 21.9.71 but  you
        found the list hot. Some WCer couldn't WC. We will let it go;  this
        was excellent."

Next session auditor does clearing of R3R and starts Env buttons.

Next session  auditor  finishes  Env  buttons.  On  the  Class  VIII  C/S  6
assessment list it F/Ns and pc says, "No nothing on that."

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS-He's up out of fear into covert hostility-very  smug  and
joke-cracking in session. Slightly snide. Hands no longer sweaty.

LRH-- "Very well done."

AUDITOR'S C/S-

        1.       Fly a rud.


        2.       Per program note. LX3,  LX2,  LX1  "while  being  audited"
             (omit those items already run).


        3.       Continue Pgm.

Next session pc does not seem to be interested in anything.  Auditor  checks
"No Interest in the first place?" Pc says, "No, none  at  all.  Actually  no
real interest in running Exp Dns. I'm not saying it's  not  going  to  work,
but so far it hasn't got anywhere near what I want handled." LF.
AUDITOR'S  COMMENTS-Pc's  in-session  mannerism   is   a   slightly   covert
amusement, deprecating attitude. Very interestingly this "Nothing there"  is
a recurrent pattern from his very first auditing. Had a lot  of  trouble  on
his XII Rundowns with the same thing. Good TA on  those  attitudes  we  have
run. I feel this needs an undercut but don't know what to suggest.

LRH-- "Well done. But hey! Do you see the hidden standard on page 6 of  your
W/S. Now this is not beyond Exp Dn. It's  great.  It  tells  you  a  fixated
interest. (He's also plenty out ethics by W/S comments.)"

LRH C/S-

        "  1.    2wc MARK ALL READS AND BDs. Get it to F/N.  'What  do  you
             really want handled?'


           2.    Get the best read out of all this. It will be an  item  or
             attitude or emotion or some such thing. Probably  a  condition.
             Express it the way he says it and be sure that's what it  is  &
             the way he says it.


           3.    Put it into R3R chain of when he had or did it. Then chain
             of another had or did it. Then chain of others had or  did  it.
             If it's a doingness like a habit, it's a  did  it.  If  it's  a
             condition like an emotion or attitude it's a had it."

Next session the pc answers 2wc with "To  get  rid  of  these  somatics"  F.
"Started  as  headache"  LFsBD.  "My  knees  hurt"  LF.  Auditor  runs  "The
somatics" R3R Triple.

AUDITOR'S C/S-

        1.       Fly a rud if no F/N.


        1a.      Assess "getting the somatic handled", "The somatics".


        2.       Assess SEA connected with best read.


        3.       List from big read, exhaust, etc.

LRH-- "Very very well done! This one needs hav before and after.  You  chose
        the wrong next somatic. He F/Ned on 'The pain'. List is 'The  pain'
        'Headache' 'Knees hurt'. If you  run  'The  somatics'  again  you'd
        double run."

LRH C/S -

        "  1.    Can squeeze. Find a hav. Get an F/N.


           2.    Check with him if it's handled. If not ask, 'What  remains
             to be handled?'


           3.    If he gives you anything add it to list, get best read and
             check interest and best read R3R Triple.


           4.    If he says all handled, then go to W/F (5a. of Pgm).  Just
             assess.


           5.    Havingness."

Admin Note:      (LRH) "If you use a list in session leave it in  folder.  I
             had to find one to get what it was."

Next session pc says handled so auditor assesses W/F.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS-Strong pc interest in havingness. RSes pages  2,  3.  A1,
A5 of White Form, yet! Also 4 of program isn't actually complete.
LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done. Hey look at that! Note any Evil Purp he  comes  up
        with. Don't try to handle. But get it on edge of Pgm."

AUDITOR'S C/S-

        1.       Hav to F/N.


        2.       Each rud triple including overts. Hav to F/N between  each
             set. (3 way ARC X, Hav, 3 way PTP, Hav, etc.)


        3.       Assess LX2 "While being audited" and handle (omit  "Shame"
             and "Boredom").


        3a.      Hav.


        4.       Assess LX1 as in 3 and handle.


        5.       Hav to F/N.


        6.       Recheck interest in LX3 reads from 6.4.72 session. Handle.


        7.       Hav to F/N.


        8.       Check interest in "No feelings" R3R Triple.


        9.       Assess attitudes, emotions to illness, list and handle R3R
             Triple.


        10.      If nothing runnable out of the above, do a touch assist to
             1st EP. (Added to program as 5e.)

Next session pc has no interest in LX items. A touch assist  was  given.  Pc
goes to the examiner after and says,  "The  same  thing  happened  today  as
yesterday. Headache intensified as day went on. It's pretty bad now.  That's
all." 2.6-2.2 falling and clean, Med GIs.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS-H. Std. remains. R/S on "contemptuous"  on  LX2.  R/S  on
"unemotional".

LRH COMMENT-

        "Well he hasn't made his hidden standard yet. Headaches  are  rough
        to run. Usually (from 1968 Tech) they are taken  apart  by  finding
        what PSEA is connected with the headache and run that.


        Headache is after the fact  of being hit in the head. There's a lot
        on this in earlier Dn.


        He gave it to you and you ran  it  narrative.  Well  okay.  If  you
        recall the earlier materials however, it says a headache  is  after
        the fact of an injury so is not  the  beginning  of  the  incident.
        Headache and this chain you ran all had  E/B!  You  should  realize
        that.


        So now we know (though no real fault) that this pc:

        1.       R/Ses = Psychosis equals succumb.
        2.       A headache is usually after  the engram of injury.  Leaves
             an E/B.
        3.       That aches  are taken apart for PSEA.
        4.        That  the  case  is  slightly  misprogrammed  and   needs
             INTENTIONS not attitudes as the attitudes are after   the  fact
             of an evil purpose in a psycho case.
        So we repair this failed chain headaches. We get the intentions  in
        the head by an L&N list or we look up old Ev Purps run (were  wrong
        or he wouldn't R/S still).


        We reprogram for intentions, not attitudes for reason of the R/S  =
        Intention very strong to die. So pc won't get well until Intentions
        handled.

        BEWARE OF A WRONG LIST.


        An R/S pc is trying to die (evil purpose) and the auditor is trying
        to make him live. This gives you an intention  counter-intention  =
        problem, so all such pcs are problems to audit.


        See C/S Series 22, 28 Nov 70, 'Psychosis'.


        So change the program to include Intentions as a type of attitude.


        Headache is common with out-Int. We have to know before we go."

LRH C/S-

        " 1.     Assess


                  A. This headache is because of a misrun went-in chain


                  B. This headache is after some injury


                  C. This headache comes from an intention


           2.    We handle the best read. Use


           A. = Int Ext Corr List.


           B. = List somatics of injury.


           C. = List Intentions to a BD/F/N Item and R3R it."

Next session pc reads on "This headache comes from an intention".  The  Item
from the L&N step is "An intention to exteriorize".  This  is  run  3  flows
R3R.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT-Your C/S done. Pc really with  session,  very  interested,
truly amazing change. Proposed program written per your instructions.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done. (Brings in my VGIs. That was a  slippery  one  and
        very well executed.)

        Mark the goal on the Pgm to D&L later."

AUDITOR'S NEW PROGRAM-

           1.    LRH C/S 13.4.72 (above).


           2.    Complete handling of H. Std. (Headache).


        3a.      Assess: Work, Post, Flag, The Sea Org, Marriage, The Ship.


           b.    List intentions connected with best read.  R3R  Triple  to
             F/Ning list.


        4a.      List intentions connected with  Auditors,  Auditing,  etc,
             buttons and R3R Triple to F/Ning list.
                  b.   List "What intentions  have  you  had  in  auditing".
             Exhaust R3R Triple.


        5a.       Assess:  Win,  Victory,  Achievements,  Gains,  Conquest,
             Triumph, Success, Mastery.


           b.    List intentions "that enable him to ....." and exhaust  by
             R3R Triple to F/Ning list.


        6a.      Assess SEA, Your Intentions, Another's Intentions, Others'
             Intentions
                 Towards  Others,  "Your  intentions  for  ......"  on  the
             following:            Self,  sex,  family,  children,   groups,
             nations, mankind, the White Race, other races, plants, animals,
             birds,  fish,  growing  things,  energy,  matter,  possessions,
             planets, stars, galaxies, thetans, spirits,  art,  music,  God,
             Infinity.


           b.    List intentions by best read and  exhaust  R3R  Triple  to
             F/Ning list.


           7.    Attitudes from Expanded Gita, clear, assess, and  run  R3R
             Triple.


           8.    2wc "Gains from recent auditing".


           9.    OCA.

AUDITOR'S C/S-

        1.       Hav to F/N.


        2.       Assess: The head, the body, gains, expansion, going OT.


        3.       List from best read and exhaust R3R Triple.


        4.       When H. Std. gone, go to step 3 of Pgm of 13.4.72.

Next session auditor did the  above  C/S  and  also  a  "Danger  Assessment"
ordered on all  crew  as  part  of  a  Danger  Condition  Program.  On  this
assessment on the question "Are you doing something harmful"  the  pc  says,
"Holding on to whatever is making me ill."

AUDITOR'S COMMENT-TA Moving. Lively pc interest!  Hot  item  on  page  3  of
Danger Condition Assessment.

LRH-- "Very well done."

AUDITOR'S C/S-

           1.     Test  out  current  Hav  process  of  pc.  If  no  longer
             increasing can squeeze, find a new one.


           2.    Hav to F/N.


        *3.      List to BD F/N item "What intention would make you hold on
             to whatever is making you ill?" R3R Triple on item.


           4.    If not now handled, do L3Exd on the area M5 1-80 to F/Ning
             list.


           5.    If not now handled, 2wc "What he wasn't able to do because
             of it".

_____________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  This is a borderline L&N question as  it  lists  a  significance
             (intention) with a significance. This is explained in HCO B  28
             Mar 74, Exp Dn Series 21. (TEAM C/S.)
             List all LF, BD items and R3R  Triple  times  he  was  made  to
             ...... times he made another . . . . ., etc.

           6.    If not now handled, 2wc "What it got him  out  of  doing".
             Handle as in 5.


           7.    If not now handled, 2wc "What it would cost to  lose  it",
             R3R Triple
                 "Times he lost a .....", on all LF, BD items.


           8.    When H. Std. blown go to 3 of 13.4.72 Pgm and handle.

Next session on 3 of the C/S pc's item on the Intention list is "To not  get
too powerful so I can't do too much". The pc  on  flow  2  R3R  says,  "It's
blown" and when  after  F3  the  auditor  asks  if  the  thing  handled,  pc
cognites, "I just realized where the  last  of  what  is  left  is  just  me
looking to see if it's gone!" Wide F/N VGIs. The auditor leaves C/S steps 3-
7 and continues the new Pgm at step 3.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT - We blew the H. Std.!!  When  we  got  on  to  the  "Win,
conquest" area, pc started R/Sing, and  got  protesty.  TA  froze  and  then
rose, so just destimmed it and got out. Looks very good otherwise.  He  sure
didn't want to know about area.

LRH COMMENT-

             "Very well done. It was too heavy. Be alert now for  out  lists
             or out Int. (Ext Int may be out.)"

Next session on step 6 of the Pgm while  auditor  is  writing  list  the  pc
itsas about how it shouldn't be called Dianetics and how great  it  is,  the
TA drops to 1.6. The auditor 2wc "Inval". This raises  the  TA  to  1.8  but
instead of continuing the 2wc the auditor changes to Hav process.  Later  pc
talking about Ext.

LRH COMMENT-

             "Well done by Exams. You should have continued  the  2wc  until
             the TA came up. Don't chop a TA off low. This has not F/Ned  on
             the 2wc.


             The low TA goes low when the person feels overwhelmed.  An  Out
             TR can do it. Usually it comes right on  back  up.  You  should
             have carried it on until it did. Don't spook on a  low  TA  and
             don't end one off, anymore than you would a higher TA. Like  on
             2wc the pc's TA goes to 3.2, so you don't stop. You F/N it.


             C/S is OK."

AUDITOR'S C/S-

        1.       Clear and assess Int Corr List and handle.


        2.       Continue Pgm.

Next session nothing is handled on Int Corr List and auditor continues  Pgm.
Pc red-tabs at Exams. Auditor takes pc back in and handles with an L1C  that
leads to an L4B. 11 -"Have you thought of items that you did not put on  the
list" reads and auditor takes it up. The item "To put force into  the  body"
LFBDs and F/Ns.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS-(17.4.72) "Daring auditor rides wall of  death  to  bring
home bacon" (N. Y. Times  18.4.72). Pc has a new  H. Std.

LRH COMMENT-
" Very well done, C/S very OK."

AUDITOR'S C/S-

           1.    Hav to F/N.


           2.    R3R Triple (if interest) the purpose "To  put  force  into
             the body".


           3.    Assess: "You are prevented from exteriorizing because of:
           a.    A misrun went-in chain.
           b.    An intention.
           c.    An opposing intention.
           d.    Times it was dangerous to leave.
           e.    Times it was dangerous to go out."


           4.    Handle
           a.    With an Int Corr List.
            b.     By  listing  "What  intention  would  prevent  you  from
             exteriorizing?" to BD F/N item. R3R Triple.
           *c.   By listing "What intention would oppose 'an  intention  to
             exteriorize'," (previous item pc gave)  to  BD  F/N  item.  R3R
             Triple.


        d. e.    R3R Triple.


           Handle a. first if reading, then by biggest read.


           5.    If  H.  Std.  not  blown,  assess  Cl  VIII  C/S  list  of
             "Exteriorization, death, leaving, etc". Triple assess for  SEAs
             and exhaust.

Next session "To put force into the body" is R3Red 3 flows  to  EP.  On  the
assessment "Times it was dangerous to go out" gave a  F,  and  was  R3Red  3
flows narrative.

"An opposing intention" (gave a sF and was listed  to  an  LFBD  item).  "An
intention to interiorize." This was R3Red 3 flows to a big EP. A  later  2wc
finished the pc off.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT-A product!!!

AUDITOR'S C/S-

        1.       Exams: Attest Exp Dn illness handling.
           ("Is your chronic illness now gone?")

LRH COMMENT-"Hurrah! Very well done!"

MED REPORT-Off MO lines, totally cool and well.

PC'S SUCCESS STORY-

Is my chronic illness handled? It is indeed.

I've had it going more aeons than I can easily remember. And now it's  gone.
No more, finished. Handled. And it feels great.

Thanks to my auditor for the application. Thanks to the  Commodore  for  the
Tech.

___________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  Listing an "Intention" opposing an "Intention" does violate  HCO
             B Exp Dn Series 21. In another folder LRH says, "You are really
             only correctly Exp Dn if you run Intentions on  TERMINALS."  In
             this case the auditor got away with it but in the long  run  it
             tends to restim the bank and can spin a pc. (TEAM C/S.)
GRAPH WHEN PC COMPLETE 18.4.72

                                    [pic]


Total No. of sessions 14. Total hours in chair 25 hrs 35 min.

LRH Final Note: Hidden behind all the effort to get the case  moving  was  a
completely untouched Drug Rundown. Since then the "No Interest" way  of  by-
passing a case has been discovered, in part because of this case.

    This pc was well when completed but not sane and he later blew. The "no
interest" he kept putting out on items defeated a  full  recovery.  A  great
many evil purposes  were  left  unrun,  the  listing  questions  (listing  a
significance from a significance) and failure to R3R  drugs,  by-passed  the
basic case. He got well, he didn't become sane. To repair  and  attain  full
recovery all "no interest" items would have to be run now.

    CASE WAS SIMPLY INCOMPLETE.
                                                                        LRH.
                                  _________


                                  Compiled by:


                                  Flag Dn Spec Team
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:MM:WS:ntm.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              18 SEPTEMBER 1972
                            Issued 28 March 1974
Remimeo
Ex Dn C/Ses
Ex Dn Auditors
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 18 SEPTEMBER 1972

                        Expanded Dianetics Series 10
                           (Series Number Amended)


                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE C


                                    [pic]


CASE NOTES-

        Had upper level Flag auditing, has attested OT III.  Also  has  had
        PTS RD. Pc currently ill in bed. Has to be set up for Exp  Dn.  Get
        him out of bed and then handle misunderstood words.

EXPANDED DIANETIC SET-UP PROGRAM  by  Dn  Specialist.  Step  added  by  LRH.
10.4.72.

           0.    Touch Assist to F/N, daily until MO okays to get up.
         "0a.     HCO PL 9 April 72, Ethics Danger Assessment." LRH.
         0b.     Hav before and after each session.
           1.    When up-Clear all words in rudiments  questions  and  WCCL
             (What is the definition of .......?).
           2.    Assess WCCL and handle to F/N list.
           *3.   Clear all words on 8RR (Ml list).
           4.    Assess and handle M 1 to F/Ning list.
         "4a.     PTS Check" added by LRH on 19.4.72.
           5.    To Exp Dn Program.

PROGRAM is started. Touch assists are given  for  five  days  and  then  the
Ethics PL (Danger Assessment). Pc gets back on post with VVGIs.


_________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  This action is now out-tech as designated by HCO B 30 June  1971
             (Revised 11 May 72), Word Clearing Series 8RB.
Step I of Pgm started 19.4.72, clearing words incomplete, F/N at exams.

AUDITOR'S C/S-

        0.       Hav to F/N.
        1.       Finish clearing words on WCCL.
        2.       Continue Pgm.
        3.       End on Hav.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done. This case roller-coastering like mad, note  4a  on
        Pgm."

Auditor continues program, pc declares Ml verification.

MO REPORT-Pc's temperature is staying low 35.8 (37 normal).

PTS Check done by D of P. D of P says, "He is not PTS Type A or Type 1."

LRH COMMENT on D of P Interview-

        "Not accepted.


        Interview not okay. Merely failed to find it. Redo interview.


        He's been sick, incapable and is terrified of past crimes on track.


        He says he's broken off with everybody.


        D of P's cue should have been  to  query  just  this.  He  has  not
        formally disconnected by the book. Just went into hiding.


        Find out who amongst all these was antagonistic or, in  any  event,
        find the SP group, person or thing.


        For instance, even my slight data on him shows him PTS to the  U.S.
        Navy."

D of P redoes interview. Finds terminal.

LRH-- "Excellent and thank you."

EXPANDED DIANETIC PROGRAM written as further set-up to finish up his PTS  RD
on 6.5.72 by Dn Spec.

        PTS Disconnect written. Has had PTS RD Jan 72. D of P interview Apr
        72 has uncovered new terminal on the case.

        1.       2wc "Attention on" to F/N.


                 2. R3R Triple and Ruds and Overts  on  terminal  if  known
             before this life.


        3.       PTS Correction List to F/Ning list.


        4.       Attest and program for Exp Dn.

Program started. Terminal not known before this life  so  not  run.  Auditor
assesses PTS Corr List and handles. On question  10  "It  can't  be  handled
anyway" pc says, "Has to do with exterior bit we went through before. I  get
down tone every now and then. I want to be exterior with full perception."
AUDITOR'S C/S AND COMMENT-

        Doing okay. List has not F/Ned-may have attention on something.


        He has a Hidden Standard of long duration on going  Ext  with  full
        perception since he was a child.

        1.       Fly each rud.
        2.       R-Factor "We need to take the PTS Corr List to  an  F/Ning
             List."
        3.       Assess and handle the F/Ning list.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Well done.


        You don't fly ruds over an out list.  Int-Lists-Ruds  is  the  only
        handling sequence there is. Don't alter sequence.


        Use suppress and inval on the list and if any trouble do an L4B.


        C/S otherwise okay. (LRH scores out 1 of Auditor's C/S.)"


        The next session the auditor  continues  with  the  PTS  Correction
        List.  Pc  says,  "I'm  not  a  PTS-feel  blowy  occasionally   and
        worthless."

AUDITOR'S COMMENT-

        He now needs PTS interview. He's not any easy  Type  A.  He  hasn't
        spotted himself as a PTS but he feels "worthless" and  "blowy"  and
        has just recovered from sickness.


        MAA does another PTS Interview.


        Pc makes voluntary statement to D of P, after  PTS  Check,  to  the
        effect that he is not PTS, has had all the rundowns,  and  he  lied
        his way through the last interview. Heavily  asserting  he  is  not
        PTS.

AUDITOR'S C/S AND COMMENT-

        MAA PTS Check came up with terminal. Then pc comes to D  of  P  and
        says it was all PR.

           *1.   3 May  PL  including  full  R-Factor.  When  full  formula
             written up-
           2.    Check last terminal found for known before this  life.  If
             so do PTS RD steps and Can't Have on it.
           3.    If not do PTS Corr List to F/N list. Use  Supp  and  Inval
             each line if needed.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Boy, I've seen PTSes before but seldom as much as he is.
        Probably doesn't know the words."

Auditor continues, F/Ns the PTS Corr List and Pc declares.

EXPANDED DIANETIC PROGRAM written 27.5.72.

PTS now handled and declared.

*FOOTNOTE:  When this part of the C/S was done, the auditor could not get  a
             read on the Listing Question. Pc said he was  not  involved  in
             any out-ethics situation F/N, and so the action was dropped.
                  1.   Sanderson RD (Exterior  with  full  perception  is  a
             Hidden Standard).
        *2.      PT Environment Handling.
           3.    Auditors, Auditing, etc handling.
           4.    Emotional White Form and handle.
           5.    Any Ev Purps R3R.
           6.    OCA and Pgm.

AUDITOR'S C/S-

1. Start Sanderson RD with

       **(a)     L&N "What intention wd prevent being  exterior  with  full
             perception" R3R Triple.
        (b)      L&N Intention "another towards you" (F-2) R3R Triple. Then
             F-3.
        (c)      When above done, 2wc "What do you really want handled?"
        (d)      L&N Triple Intentions and R3R on any BD area.

Auditor starts program and continues doing Sanderson RD as stated  in  above
C/S on BD areas.

AUDITOR'S C/S AND COMMENTS-

        Doing fine but he hasn't made his laudable H.  Std.  of  "Ext  with
        full perception". Says the charge is off it but still wants  to  do
        it.


        Seems to me he is sitting at the end of a problem-the  solution  of
        deciding to be Ext with full perception. If so, intentions  prevent
        would only get the other half of the  later  problem  and  not  the
        earlier one.

        If so, the suggest would be:


        1.       L&N "What problem might being ext with full perception  be
             a solution to".
        2.       L&N "What intention of yours is connected with (item)".
        3.       R3R Triple.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

        "You're trying to run 3GAXX and calling it Exp Dn.


        All these prevents on significances. You'll spin him.


        You are really only correctly Exp  Dn  if  you  run  Intentions  on
        TERMINALS.


        You better get all cleared up on this before auditing him again.  I
        don't think you ever read or studied the Sanderson RD.


        There is such a thing as a standard action. It's done the way  it's
        done.


        We're not auditing in Keokuk on hunches  and  alter-ises.  This  is
        Flag.


        You keep this going and you'll be doing R2-12.

________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  This program is a bit sparse as it does not  include  the  depth
             at which the pc is going to be run, for steps 2 and 3.

**FOOTNOTE: This is out-tech as indicated by LRH later in this  HCO  B,  and
             in HCO B 28 March 1974, Exp Dn Series 21, in that it  lists  an
             intention on a significance not a terminal.
        Further the purpose of Exp Dn is to cure people or handle insanity.


        The standard way to handle a hidden standard (which is not  just  a
        physical or mental difficulty but one by which the pc measures  his
        case gains).


        The Sanderson RD is a Wants Handled or Hasn't Been Handled.  Not  a
        hidden standard which by the definition of  its  words  is  a  case
        measurement thing used secretly by the pc.


        We will admit this  is  a  hidden  standard.  It's  different  than
        Intentions behind Somatics.


        To convert this to Exp Dn R3R:

        1.       2wc to F/N.


        2.       L&N 'Who or what would  want  to  be  Exterior  with  full
             perception' (this gets it to a terminal).


        3.       L&N 'What would be the intention of (item found)'.


        4.       R3R Triple on Intention found. (If it goes 'me' for 2  and
             back to 'Want to be Ext', drop it as it will run  late  in  the
             engram like in Ext.)


        5.       Hav."

Auditor does C/S and it goes "me" and back to "Wants to be Ext" in 3.

AUDITOR'S C/S

        1.       PT Env 2wc. Triple assess and R3R.
        2.       C/S-6 list, Triple assess and R3R.
        3.       Emotional White Form and handle R3R Triple.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

        "Well done. We'll try another basic approach.


        1.       2wc to F/N.


        2.       2wc 'What physical situation do you use  to  measure  case
             gain by?'


        3.       Get what it is. Some BD Item. Use same phrasing he uses in
             doing L&N.


        4.       L&N 'What intention is connected to (item in  2).  (If  he
             comes up with the same Ext thing, run it R3R and watch  it,  be
             sure to call E/B.)


        5.       Hav.

        This is auditing by basic definition."

The auditor did the above C/S and continued with the program, doing  PT  Env
and C/S-6.

On 3.6.72 auditor receives note from pc that  auditing  "going  in  circles"
and indication of no-case-gain, and  out-ethics  situation.  This  note  was
from pc to his senior and contained a list of overts and omissions on post.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        All PT Env 2wc items handled.
        He wrote up the note before the session but I did not get  it  till
        after. May still have some ruds there.

        1.       Triple Ruds plus overts "on post". Get it all off.
        2.       Emotional White Form.
        3.       R3R Triple.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

        "Well done. C/S is incorrect. You are about to start a  major  step
        (W/F Emotional) on a pc whose Ethics are out.  Ethics  go  hand  in
        hand with PTS RDs so 3 May PL comes before or after it.


        This is one of your 'In the org SPs' in that he has only 1 SP who's
        in the org. Yet the U.S. Govt and Navy smashed him. Means a  wildly
        PTS OUT OF VALENCE person on a wrong flow.  The  'SPs  are  in  the
        org', get it? So he's outside the Org criticising the Org so ......


        Learn to audit-C/S cases by fundamentals not rules or  orders.  You
        would have missed this product a mile. He's still so PTS  he's  out
        of valence and in an enemy valence. Those overts listed prove it.


        Requires a fast change of Pgm. I wondered where this case  was  at.
        Now I know. And so should you have.


        R-FACTOR: The next thing on your program is a 3 May 72 PL.

        1.       2wc 'What do you have to say about that?'
        2.       R-Factor: You are in Danger due to omissions.
        3.       Step 1.
        4.       Step 2. WC.
        5.       Step 3 L&N to BDF/N.
        6.       R3R Triple on item.
        7.       Step 4 L&N to BDF/N item.
        8.       R3R Triple on item.
        9.       Tell him to write up formula."

Along with this C/S LRH wrote a Pgm 4.6.72.

LRH PROGRAM-

        "PTS to  Org  Terminals  only.  Has  out-ethics  on  post.  PTS  RD
        'complete' but no real item found.

        1.       LRH C/S 4.6.72 (above).
        1a.      Triple Ruds on post.
        2.       Look up every  unhandled  (R3R)  Ev  Purp.  Include  those
             located and D/Led. Use  these.  R3R  Triple.  (Don't  run  ones
             twice.)
        3.       L10 Multiple Flow Ev Purps step.
        4.       R3R Triple.
        5.       PTS Corr List. Any additional and Can't Have.
        6.       Prior Confusion to beginning to goof. Find it and  R3R  it
             Triple.
        7.       OCA.
        8.       To Pgm Include Metalosis."

This  program  was  successfully  completed  by  the  auditor  to   Exp   Dn
completion.

PC'S SUCCESS STORY-

        When the Commodore handles someone he  handles  the  hell   out  of
        them, and the hell that came out of me  was  cracked  by  fantastic
        auditing.

        I've had more case gain than I ever imagined  possible.  Thank  you
        Sir.

GRAPH when pc complete.

                                    [pic]
 Total No. of sessions 26. Total hrs in chair 38 hrs 28 min.

EXP DN TEAM NOTE-

        This pc remained stably off MO lines. The  drop  of  three  of  the
        points on the right-hand side of the graph was due to "no interest"
        in running R3R on all of his Ev Purps. See HCO Bs Exp Dn  Series  7
        and 9.


                                  Compiled by:


                                  Flag Dn Spec Team
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:MM:WS:ntm.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               19 OCTOBER 1972
                            Issued 28 March 1974
Remimeo
Ex Dn C/Ses
Ex Dn Auditors
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 19 OCTOBER 1972


                        Expanded Dianetics Series 11
                           (Series Number Amended)


                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE D

OCA GRAPH-

                                    [pic]


 CASE NOTES-

        In the white on the right of the OCA. But pc has  been  chronically
        ill for a year. Her menopause started 2l/2 years ago and she has  a
        suspected tumor of the uterus. In present time pc is terrified that
        she has a malignant cancer.


        Very low on the Chart of Human Evaluation on  several  points.  She
        attested OT III on 27.3.72 so she is out  of  the  non-interference
        area.


        Medical reports requested re pc's cancer.


        No sign of the pc ever having had a C/S 1.

EXPANDED DIANETIC PROGRAM by Dn Specialist. Approved and added to by LRH  on
2.4.72.

        0.       Havingness before and after each session.


      * "0a.      WCC List, clear words, reassess  and  handle.  WCM1  clear
             words, reassess WCM1, handle." Added LRH 2.4.72.

_________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  By HCO B  30  June  71,  Issue  II,  Word  Clearing  Series  8RB
             (Revised 11 May 72) the list words of M1 are not cleared before
             assessment. The words of the commands  of M1 may be cleared.
             " 0b.     TA Trouble C/S 53RRR" added LRH 8.4.72.

        1.       Full C/S 1, clear all words on L3B and L1C.


        2.       Expanded Dianetics

        (a)      2wc her present time environment. Take best reading  items
             and get her attitudes, emotions and sens  on  it.  R3R  Triple.
             Exhaust list.


        (b)      Auditing-Assess Class VIII list (C/S 6) then Att, Emot and
             Sens on best reading items, R3R Triple. "Intentions"  added  by
             LRH 21.4.72.


        (c)      Do a White Form stressing losses,  R3R  Triple  Narrative.
             R3R Triple  reading  emotions,  and  att  towards  illness  and
             treatment.


        (d)      LX3, LX2, LX1, R3R Triple. PTS  RD  or  PTS  Interview  if
             needed-added 20.4.72. (She is  about  .05  on  Chart  of  Human
             Evaluation.)

        3.       New OCA-new program.

PROGRAM STARTED - M1 going  very  well,  and  huge  amounts  of  charge  and
misunderstoods coming off case. Three sessions later pc finds  misunderstood
which had her stuck in an incident and pc blows it  with  big  win!  Auditor
ends off.

Some trouble at the Examiner with a new one the  pc  doesn't  like.  Re-exam
requested by the pc. Gets wide F/N VGIs on the win. Pc goes to  Success  and
writes voluntary glowing success story.

That night Auditor takes pc back into  session  and  continues  WCM1.  After
session exam TA high.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Pc was doing fine on word clearing M1. I ended on a big  win.  (She
        wrote a success story, I've just received it.) But she  didn't  F/N
        at the Examiner, she did on second exam which she requested. I took
        her in again tonight. We handled misunderstoods and WCCL  and  back
        to M1 but TA up at Exams.

        1.       Indicate WCCL in  last  session  was  unnecessary  action.
             "Rehab win" added by LRH.


        2.       Fly a rud.


        3.       Continue M1 to F/Ning list.


        4.       Continue Program.

LRH COMMENT-

        "You O/R even further past the win by the Correction. When she  did
        F/N (2nd Exam) you should have left it.


        If no joy with 1 send folder to me rush."

Auditor does the C/S, okay on 1 so continues.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        Rehabbed the win and continued M1. Pc started to protest (page 18).
        Her attention was on the big win again  so  I  rehabbed  it  again.
        (Page 26 pc keyed in on counter-postulates she has.)  I  ended  the
        session after the rehab.

             1.   Fly a rud.
        2.       Verify M 1.
        3.       Continue Pgm.

LRH COMMENTS AND C/S-

        TO D OF P AND LEAD AUDITOR


        "Well done by Exams.


        D of P: 'What did the auditor do?'


        Lead Auditor: Re (auditor) please find Why  of  forcing  a  pc  and
        O/Ring and handle.


        (Also pc may be an Advanced Courses pc who doesn't belong  to  you.
        See request in folders if [auditor] can't do the history.)"


        TO AUDITOR


        "Well done by Exams.


        There is an auditing error here. You don't force pcs,  particularly
        sick ones, never. You overrode her protest.


        An auditor mustn't have a  tendency  to  Force  or  O/R  against  a
        protest without getting a Why of it.


        This makes the C/S incorrect here  as  you  would  just  force  her
        further.


        Auditing is for the pc.


        Also when a TA tends to go up there's  something  wrong,  of  which
        protest may be just a symptom.

        1.       C/S 53RRR Assess. Then check for any  misunderstood  words
             on it. (As it hasn't been cleared.) Send  to  me.  (If  it  has
             misunderstoods on it clear them and reassess.)

        Also verify folder if this is a failed  Adv  Cse  pc.  If  so  give
        details."

D OF P INTERVIEW-

        Pc says, "Possibly some overrun that's all."

LEAD AUDITOR-

        Found Why on auditor as having lost sight of her purpose  and  took
        pc back into session "to get her hours up".


        Report on pc in regard  to  Adv  Cses-Audited  10  hrs  on  OT  III
        finished in Review, has not had OT VII or OT IIIX.

LRH-- Orders his "last C/S to be done."

        Auditor assesses 53RRR. Int and lists and others reading-Wrong item
        F, Upset with giving items to auditor  LF,  Int  tick  and  sF,  TA
        between 3.0 and 2.8 during the assessment.


        Auditor also reports pc was seasick during voyage.


        Auditor returns the folder to LRH.
LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

        "A red tab with Out-Lists, was seasick but no dramamine.

       * 1.      Wrong Items L4B.
        2.       Upset with giving items to auditor-L4B.
        3.       Pc withholding-Pull all withholds triple.
        4.       Self auditing between sessions-2wc,  then  get  the  prior
             confusion that began it."

C/S is done the next day. There is a slight overrun at the  end  of  session
and no F/N at Exams.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT-

        Outness was I went by the point of release to get prior  confusion.
        Out obnosis, and auditing the C/S not the pc.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

        "You're an Auditor not a student.  So  don't  act  like  a  student
        learning to audit.

        1.       C/S 53RRR. Reassess with impingement with TRs  in  so  you
             make any reads happen.
        2.       Handle.
        3.       Clear Hi-Lo List backwards, questions backwards from  last
             question up.
        4.       Assess.
        5.       Handle."

The above C/S is completed  to  a  nice  result  and  M1  word  clearing  is
continued and completed and Pgm continued.

Pc running very well on the PT Environment.

In session of 19.4.72 pc says, "Spot on  leg  that  hurts,  want  to  go  to
Doctor."

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        I noticed pc's havingness drops  very  rapidly-would  like  to  run
        havingness after each chain.

        1.  Havingness.
        2.       Touch Assist.
        3.       Continue PT Environ.
        4.       Continue Pgm.
        5.       Hav before ending session.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Well done. C/S suggestion of running havingness after  each  chain
        not OK at all, would run a severe strain on pc  extrovert-introvert
        wise.


        I don't see a PTS Interview or RD on this Pgm.


        The auditing C/S is OK.


*FOOTNOTE:  By Exp Dn Tape 4 Ext/Int reading on a list is handled by 2wc  if
             the TA is in normal  range.  Here  there  is  no  sign  of  Int
             troubles and TA is at 2.8 and Int giving  a  very  small  meter
             read. It is omitted in the face of obvious out lists.
        This pc is running great.


        I notice mixed therapies present."

(On 20.4.72 the PTS RD-if needed on PTS Interview is added  to  Pgm  and  on
21.4.72 Intentions are added to the Pgm by LRH.)

Pc continues Pgm through WF Stressing Losses.  Pc  goes  to  Doctor.  Doctor
can't find any sign of tumor. Pc attests Exp Dn Chronic Illness Handling.

D of P Interview reveals there is more  to  be  handled  so  a  new  Pgm  is
written.

AUDITOR'S NEW PROGRAM AND COMMENTS-

        Per PTS Interview pc is PTS. Her graph has  dropped  on  the  left.
        Original program completed except for LXs  not  yet  done.  Chronic
        Illness now handled.

        1.       Disconnect or handle present PTS Type A situation  through
             MAA.
        2.       Havingness before and after major actions of the session.
        3.       Clear each word on LX 321.
       * 4.      Assess and handle LX lists R3R Triple.
        5.       Check for and handle  hidden  standards  on  the  internal
             trouble. (Sanderson RD added by LRH 2.5.72.)
        6.       Full PTS Rundown.
        7.       D of P Interview after RD.
        8.       Watch pc's folder for any new signs of RC or  illness  and
             if they occur, PTS RD Corr List and handle. New OCA.

The new Pgm is started and pc runs fine through LXs. On the  LXs  a  bit  of
O/R occurs after a huge valence shift.

Auditor does step 5 of Pgm and comes up with more than one hidden std.

LRH COMMENT 2.5.72-

        "Well done. She'll need the Sanderson RD. I put it in."

Pc finishes Sanderson RD and the PTS RD is started with a 3rd May PL.

The day after the pc is ill and writes a note and says she doesn't feel  out
of Danger.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        No session but from pc's note she's rollercoastering. So I suggest:


        1.       L4B.
        2.       Touch Assist.
        3.       Havingness.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

"PTS is from suppression of some sort, is rollercoaster. But-she was put  in
what was to her a wrong condition. Will turn on  somatics  and  is  kind  of
suppressive. So knowing the THEORY of  PTS  makes  all  that  difference  in
C/Sing.

_________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  Per a more recent LRH dispatch, the words of  the  LX  List  are
             cleared before assessing it and the reads taken as they appear.
        KNOW, FIND OUT BEFORE YOU GO IN C/Sing.

        1.       Assess:    Wrong Why
                            Wrong Items
                            Physical Illness
                            Wrong condition assigned
                            Something else
                            PTS to someone

      (Assess by stating it as a fact not as a question.)

        2.       2wc on best read, E/S to F/N. If wrong condition tell  her
             so after the 2wc and tell you'll handle.


        3.       Touch Assist.


        4.       Havingness.

        Complete Pgm or correct it in light of any data above."

The above C/S is done and new data arises on  the  pc's  past  entanglements
with Ethics and conditions over quite a few years. A new Pgm is written.

NEW PROGRAM BY EXP DN AUDITOR 12.5.72-

        This program to be done before step 5 of 25.4.72 Pgm.


        Touch assist was dropped off the last Pgm. Pc has now come up  with
        a new chronic condition of  ear  trouble  (D  of  P  Interview  not
        mentioned  previously).  Present  time  only  2wced   before,   not
        assessed. Intentions weren't stressed.


        1.       Hav run before and after major actions in each session.
        2.       Touch Assist till body well.
        3.       Assess Flag, the  SO,  Ethics,  Out  Ethics,  Being  a  SO
             Member, duties, hats, schedules.
        4.       Get intentions-others to her, hers to  others,  others  to
             others and R3R Triple best reading items. Exhaust the list.
        5.       Assess: Difficulties, being suppressed, attacks,  enemies,
             suppressing, incomplete cycles,  unmocking,  defense,  protest,
             make nothing of, withdrawing from.
        6.       Same as 4 above.

A few sessions later the auditor runs two  items  which  come  from  the  PT
Environment buttons (The SO and Attitude of Morals) and runs into trouble.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Something very wrong here, she came in with F/N VGIs, did  well  on
        havingness and Touch Assist, but rollercoasters on PT  Buttons.  On
        Ethics TA soars on clearing intentions (this also happened  before,
        she protested intentions in an earlier Pgm). I feel this Pgm is too
        heavy for her.
        I think we'll have to handle her current  Ethics  situation  before
        continuing with auditing.


        She is still legally  married  to  a  psycho,  who  has  had  shock
        treatment several times and who she admits has SP  characteristics.
        She has also mentioned she would like to handle her children's  Out
        Ethics.
             1.   Handle all out 2D Ethics situations concerning her  family
             properly- by returning to Australia if necessary for a divorce.
        2.       Report to MAA when this is complete. Fitness Board.
        3.       PTS RD plus Can't Be, Do, Have Steps.

LRH COMMENT 16.5.72-

        "Well done by Exams only.


        The purpose of an auditor is to handle the pc.  You  did  something
        goofy beyond belief.


        Ran 'Interest' as an item. Then had trouble with the pc, then  said
        offload her. To me this means you have decided to offload.


        This is one of the goofiest sessions I've seen  for  a  while.  You
        can't audit out pleasure moments. It  hasn't  been  possible  since
        1950, and I don't know why you chase 'Interest in the Sea Org' as a
        bad thing and tried to R3R it. Positive don't run.  So  Auditor  to
        Ethics for a 3 May 72.


        Pc being audited who is PTS and unhandled. D of P Interview to  see
        if handled in any way.


        Interest as an Item ? Morals as an Item ?"


        At D of P Interview pc says doing very  well,  much  better,  VGIs,
        etc; but needle tight and sluggish and rises from 3.0 to 3.8.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

        "Red tab.


        Probably O/R on 'good' items that would have no aberration in them.

        0.       53 RC to handle.


        1.       List out in chronological order all SP items found.


       * 2.      Run the 'Can't have, enforced have'  motivator  repetitive
             then overt repetitive, then Flow 3, terminal to others,  others
             to terminal. (4 flows of 2 commands each.)"

The auditor queries the C/S and states the PTS RD was mistakenly ticked  off
on the Pgm and not done yet.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 18.5.72-

"All this randomity made me lose my place in the book. The check  off  threw
it. Now I'm not sure where we are on her.

Do a new Pgm picking up the old one and steps already done. Finish  whatever
major cycle she was on in Exp Dn then PTS RD, then Metalosis, then Ev  Purps
from L10.

C/S 1. 53RC and handle.

2. L1C Recently.

3. Havingness."
________________________

*FOOTNOTE: This RD is covered fully in HCO B 9 Dec 1971RA, "PTS Rundown".
It is sometimes referred to as the Can't Have Steps or the Can't Have RD.
Auditor does above C/S and finds a wrong  PTS  item  and  handles  and  also
writes a new Pgm.

LRH COMMENT 18.5.72-

        "Very well done (for session). Pgm OK."

AUDITOR'S NEW PROGRAM-

        New Pgm as per LRH C/S 18.5.72


        Touch assists to be run each session and havingness.


        1.       Complete the Sanderson RD.
       "1a.      LRH C/S 20 May 72" added by LRH on that date (see below).
        2.       PTS RD plus Can't Have Steps.
        3.       Metalosis.
        4.       R3R Evil Purps from L10.
        5.       New OCA, new Pgm or declare.

Next session auditor completes Sanderson RD and begins the PTS RD.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Went fine but on PTS RD she can't remember having had any S&Ds (two
        lots of S&Ds recorded in folder summary, but missing from folder).

        I could start doing R3R on terminals from D of P Interview, while I
        sort out the S&D scene.

        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       Hav.
        3.       Select terminal from 2wc on who she's known this life that
             has troubled or worried her.
        4.       R3R Triple, Ruds and Overts.
        5.       Hav before ending.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

        (Add to Pgm 20.5.72)


        "Well done (C/S error on your C/S).


        She had 2 lots of 3 S&Ds. This could be  out  lists  yet  they  are
        missing.  Look  harder  to  see  if  pulled  forward  for  a   list
        correction. If still can't find still do C/S (i.e. LRH C/S). If can
        find list do C/S.


        An S&D list error can  make a person sort of PTS with a Wrong Item!


        Don't audit over a suspected out list. Not even  touch  assists  or
        Hav.

        1.       Reconstruct (or use) previous S&D lists. Verify  items  or
             correct.
        2.       L4B on S&D lists.
        2a.      Hav.
        3.       When fully assured it's correct and cool, use these  items
             to begin the PTS RD.
        4.       R3R on those Former Life Known.
        5.       D of P Int taken items.
        6.       PTS RD Steps.
        7.       Hav."
Auditor starts PTS RD. Runs fine then on Can't Have  TA  soars  and  doesn't
come down. Auditor runs Hav to F/N and ends.

LRH-- "D of P Rush: 'What did the auditor do?' "

D OF P INTERVIEW-

        Well, could have gone past a sort of Release Point.


        Felt very good at one point, yes  (F/N)  felt  OT  (VGIs  F/N)  was
        playing around OT, yes (F/N IND).


        LRH COMMENT AND C/S-


        "Learn to see F/Ns, you just missed on the F/N that's all.

        1.       Check F3 Jupiter. Did it erase, rehab point of erasure.
        2.       If no joy do L3 ExDn on F3.
        3.       Verify if any further terminals, if so handle.
        4.       If all cool havingness.
        5.       Declare PTS RD complete. (Next is Metalosis RD.)"

C/S is done. Pc declares PTS RD and Metalosis RD is  started.  Next  session
(just cleared words) auditor mentions TA going high, but coming down.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Well done. You worry too much about TA. It has  to go up to get TA
        action."


        Metalosis is continued and completed. Auditor suggests declare.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Well done-25.5.72. Need D of P Interview. MO check and OCA  before
        declare. Question is, is she a cured person."

MO REPORT-

        Pain in tummy on and off. Little bit of bleeding  after  the  pain.
        Either she still has cyst in stomach or she's mocking it up.

D OF P INTERVIEW-

        Indicated something left to handle.
OCA-
                                    [pic]

Very excellent change.
LRH COMMENTS AND PROGRAM 27.5.72-

        "Incomplete product. Remains ill. Obviously PTS  to  other  things.
        Illness- PTS. Could be out ethics and PTS. Metalosis not  finished.
        PTS incomplete.
        Finish what we are on and then do more PTS RD. (Full steps not done
        and
        very shallow.) Then 3 May PL.

       * 1.      2wc 'Tell me about your illness'  (for  data).  2wc  'What
             metal would one have in that area?'  Choose  item  R3R  Triple.
             (Chastity belt is the obvious answer.)
        2.       2wc to fish for electric fields in the area. R3R Triple.
        3.       Recheck all possible angles of field distortion of body in
             ill area.
        4.       When all angles of fields and metal exhausted in area:
        4a.      Ev Purps from L10. R3R Triple.


        5.       Go on with any missing steps of PTS RD. I don't think 'Who
             she's after' was done. Can't Have RD.


        6.       Check a Can't Hav  assessment  on:  Bodies,  babies,  sex,
             Doctors, trouble, upsets, sexual  oddities,  sexual  practices,
             etc. List intention L&N regarding object, R3R Triple.


        7.       Check an enforced have  on:  Bodies,  illnesses,  ovaries,
             womb, guts, sex, etc. Int, L&N, R3R Triple.
        8.       If all cool, 3 May PL.
        9.       2wc 'On how she's doing, what she wants handled'.
        10.      L&N Intention or purpose regarding 9.
        11.      R3R Triple.
        12.      2wc on how she's doing, what she wants handled.
        13.      L&N Intention or purpose re 12.
        14.      R3R Triple.
        15.      2wc on how she's doing."

LRH COMMENTS AND C/S 27.5.72-

        "Well she's still PTS.


        This is just a case of not really completing anything on the pc.


        Pgm calling for Ev Purps from L10 still not done apparently.


        PTS RD short changed (step missing apparently).


        Metalosis not really bled for the works.


        She's also mixing practices. Nothing a Medic can do for her.

        1.       2wc 'Tell me about your illness'.
        2.       2wc 'What metal would one have had in that area?'
        3.       Choose best items R3R Triple.
        4.        Word  clear  electromagnetic  field  fully.  Clear  field
             distortion.
        5.       2wc 'What could cause a field distortion  in  that  area?'
             Get items.


*FOOTNOTE:  This is the "Metalosis RD" and will be covered more fully as  to
             theory and application in HCO Bs later in the Exp Dn Series.
             6.   R3R Triple.
        7.       Havingness."

Pc is sent to the Examiner for "What did the Auditor do". Pc says,  "Overran
me on some things and seems to be handling same stuff and re-running."

LRH NEW C/S AND COMMENTS 28.5.72-

        "Run this before 27 May C/S.


        See Exam report. Pc looks very bad, much  too  bad  for  this  much
        auditing, so sent to Exams by C/S for 'What did the Auditor do'.


        You're O/Ring F/Ns and running things twice. This pc  better  start
        looking good. We've cured 3 of these cysts in the  last  couple  of
        years, a 100% record.

        1.       L1C M3 on Recent Auditing.
        2.       C/S 53RC. Handle.
        3.       L3 ExDn to F/Ning list.

        Then do 27 May and DO NOT by-pass F/Ns or run  unreading  items  on
        this pc or run same chains twice! "

The above C/S 28.5.72 and the 27.5.72 C/S are done and continued and the  pc
doing very well. Metalosis is completed and the PTS RD.

On 11.6.72 the Can't Have, Enforced Hav Assessment steps are completed.

The 3 May PL is done.

The illness is attacked from all quarters with the Sanderson RD.

On 20.6.72 pc attests to Thetan Exterior.

She completes the Wants Handled RD (Sanderson) to F/N VGIs.

The pc is sent to declare Exp Dn complete but fails the Exam.

The next session the PTS Corr List reveals that pc  is  still  dependent  on
her  SP  husband  for  support,  as  divorce  =  loss  of  money.  She   had
disconnected in every way except through this House = Money Line.

Pc has 5 Apr PL handling and decides to get the divorce.

D of P Interview to see how she is doing.  VGIs,  all  illness  fine.  Doing
very well. Tone 3.5.

Pc sent for re-declare. Wide F/N VGIs 21.8.72.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done. Nice change, Love Ron."

SUCCESS STORY-

I was one of those tough cases, but I  knew  if  me  and  the  Auditor  kept
handling the hell out of it that one day we would get the  last  little  bit
holding it in place. Thanks to the Auditor we uncovered it and within a  few
days the illness miraculously disappeared.

My illness has gone.
        Many, many thanks to LRH and my Auditor and the D of P.

TOTAL NO. OF SESSIONS: 56.

TOTAL HOURS IN THE CHAIR: 132 hrs 20 min.


                                  Compiled by:


                                  Flag Dn Spec Team
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:MM:WS:ntm.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               20 OCTOBER 1972
                            Issued 28 March 1974
Remimeo
Ex Dn C/Ses
Ex Dn Auditors
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 20 OCTOBER 1972


                        Expanded Dianetics Series 12
                           (Series Number Amended)


                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE E


OCA GRAPH 3.4.72-

                                    [pic]

CASE NOTES AND EXP DN PGM BY DN SPECIALIST

        Incomplete Dianetic pc with staledate LRH C/S from Dec 6, 71 for Dn
        FFT and L3B RD-R/Sing on "postulate checks"  "spinning"  and  "out-
        ethics".


        OCA low on right, up on left. Per Exp Dn lecture No. 1 FFT are only
        done if it comes up or bogs running triples.

        Case Level OT VII.

        0.       Declare M 1 WCing complete.
        1.       Havingness process found and run at end of each session.
        2.       Clear each word in L3 ExDn and R3R commands.
        3.       L3 ExD Rundown (M5 and handle to F/Ning list).
        4a.      L-10 Ev Purps run R3R Triple. (Added later.)
        4b.      2wc PT Environment and note all BD items.


        5.       Take  best  reading  items  in  4  and  get  emotions  and
             intentions connected to items-R3R Triple to F/Ning list.


        6.       Assess Cl VIII list  (C/S  6),  get  intentions,  emotions
             connected to best reading items R3R Triple.


        6a.      Emotional Stresses WF handle R3R Triple.
             *  7.     Clear and assess LX3 handle R3R Triple.


        *  8.     Clear and assess LX2 handle R3R Triple.


        *  9.     Clear and assess LX1 handle R3R Triple.


        10.      New OCA.

PROGRAM STARTED on 23.4.72.

LRH NOTE-

        "This pc has had lots of Evil Purps found on L-10. These  must  all
        be R3Red Trip."


        (This step added to the Pgm.)


        (On the auditor's C/S LRH writes, "Well Done. C/S omits  this  Note
        which has to be done as it's this environ.")


        The auditor completes the Pgm. The pc runs very fast, so a new  Pgm
        is written.

SECOND PGM BY EXP DN SPEC 25.4.72-

        First program complete. There's still plenty to dig up on him.


        He's not low on the left but has one point on the right that's low.
        He is running engrams and implants well. He wants his O/Ws  handled
        so this should do a good job on it.

        0.       Havingness at start and end of each session.


        1a.      Assess the Admin Scale.


        1b.      Get  intentions  connected  to  best  reading  items,  R3R
             Triple, to F/Ning list.


        2a.       Assess:  Games,  rules,  players,   barriers,   freedoms,
             possibility of winning, possibility of losing.


        2b.      Get intentions connected to best reading items, R3R Triple
             to F/Ning list.


        3a.      Assess: Postulate checks,  Gross  Income,  Income,  bills,
             reserves,  purchase  orders,  crush  sell,  hot  prospect  reg,
             pirates, money, Ethics.


        3b.      Get intentions  connected  with  best  reading  items  R3R
             Triple to F/Ning list.


        4a.      Assess: Orgs,  ASHO,  USLO,  Sea  Org,  AOLA,  Execs,  Org
             Officers, Product Officers, C/Os.


        4b.      Get intentions connected, run R3R Triple to F/Ning list.


      ** 5a.     Slow assess R-1C and note all BD items.


        5b.      Get intentions connected to best reading items R3R  Triple
             to F/Ning list.


        6.       New OCA.

        The auditor does the  entire  program  with  Ev  Purps  coming  off
        nicely. The OCA given at the end of this Pgm showed a slight  drift
        of all traits except G which remained very fixed as the  low  point
        of the whole graph.

 LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done. Somebody missed the Ev Purps on him."
________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  Per a more recent LRH dispatch, the words of the  LX  lists  are
             cleared before assessing it and the reads taken as they appear.

**FOOTNOTE: See HCO B 4 December 1971, "R-1C Assessment by Dynamics".
THIRD PGM BY EXP DN SPEC-

        The right side of his graph is coming up  slowly  but  surely.  But
        there's more work to do-more O/Ws to get off.

        0.       Havingness at start and end of each session.


        1.       Pick up reading items from  Admin  Scale  when  previously
             handled and get "another's intentions towards you connected  to
             (       )".
           Run R3R Triple.


        2.       Pick up reading items from list of games, rules,  players,
             barriers, freedoms,  possibility  of  winning,  possibility  of
             losing. Get "another's intentions towards you  connected  to  (
                )".
           R3R Triple.


        3.       Pick up reading items from  list  (postulate  checks,  GI,
             income, etc). Get "another's intentions towards  you  connected
             to (       )".
           R3R Triple.


        4.       Pick up previously reading items  from  list  (Org,  ASHO,
             USLO, etc). Get "another's intentions towards you connected  to
             (       )".
           R3R Triple.


        5.       Clear and assess Know to  Mystery  Scale.  Get  intentions
             connected to reading items 3 flows to F/Ning list.


        6.       Assess A-R-C-U take biggest read and  Curious  About______
             Desired______Enforced______Inhibited______No______Refused______
             Broken______ Denied______ False______.
           Run R3R Triple on best reading items. Reassess to F/Ning  A-R-C-
             U.


        7.       Clear and assess the Awareness Scale levels.  Run  reading
             items R3R Triple. Reassess and handle to F/Ning list.


        8.       Assess the Havingness Scale. Run reading items R3R Triple.


        9.        Assess:  Failed  havingness,  failed   interest,   failed
             communication, failed  control,  failed  help,  failed  overts,
             failed importance, failed  leave,  failed  protect,  failed  to
             abandon, failed to endure,  inverted  help,  inverted  control,
             inverted comm, inverted  interest,  obsessive  can't  have,  no
             effect. Run reading items R3R Triple.


        10.      Using above buttons substitute "desired" for "failed"  R3R
             Triple. Then substitute "enforced" and "inhibited" and  handle-
             R3R Triple.


        11.      Assess Expanded Tone Scale and handle R3R Triple.


        12.      2wc "What do you really want handled"-on that item L&N  to
             BD F/N item-"What intention would prevent you from (______)".
           R3R Triple on the intention.

        The Pgm is started and goes quickly.  At  step  12  (Sanderson  RD)
        after the session the auditor writes "No real Wow".  The  auditor's
        C/S is to continue the Sanderson RD.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Well done. Being audited over out ruds and M/Us."

        LRH adds to the auditor's C/S:

        "1.       Fly all ruds and overts triple.


        1a.      Check for MisU words M4."

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS (Next Session)-

        He got his wow. Looks like the EP of Exp Dn.
             1.   New OCA.


        2.       D of P Interview.


        3.       If OK declare.

LRH COMMENT 1.5.72-

        "Very well done, Wow!"

D OF P INTERVIEW-

        Very good.

OCA GRAPH-

        Trait G in the same place, unmoving.


        Auditor at this point examines the OCA questions  answered  wrongly
        by the pc and works out the common denominator.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Not  OK to declare. Trait G still down. Looked up the questions  on
        OCA and common denominator is "Can't take  responsibility  for  the
        actions of those close to him, is swayed by personalities".

C/S and PROGRAM are identical.

        1.       2wc to F/N.


        2.       L&N "Intentions regarding (terminal  close  to  pc)".  R3R
             Triple on intention.


        3.       L&N "(Terminal close to pc's)  intention  regarding  you".
             R3R Triple the intention.


        4.       L&N "(Terminal close to pc's) intention regarding others".
             R3R Triple the intention.


        5.       2wc "The group the pc involved with".
        6.       Steps 2, 3, 4, on hot terminals from 5.
        7.       2wc "Personalities you've known".
        8.       Steps 2, 3, 4, on hot terminals from 7.
        9.       PTS RD. Include "What persons have  you  really  liked  or
             admired".

LRH COMMENT-

        "Go ahead and try it.


        That unchanging graph is pretty spooky. If no  shift  then  he  has
        done and is
        doing things. Very ungood."


        Auditor does the Pgm up to the PTS RD (step 9) in one session.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        This didn't bite. Pc showed signs of overrun.

C/S-PTS RD.

LRH PROGRAM 4.5.72-

        "Mess in (U.S. Org) over his funds  handling.  Probably  afraid  of
        Ethics. Something we don't know  about  this  pc.  Need  data.  Not
        getting anywhere. Awful OCA.
        1.       LRH C/S of 4 May 72 (see below).


        2.       Pgm accordingly."

LRH C/S 4.5.72-

        "Well done.


        Both he and (Org Exec) are very worried.


        Note 1.1 remark to Examiner. This guy is Out-Ethics.

        1.       Assess: Out Lists (L4B if so)
             Worried about Flag Worried about (U.S. Org)
             Worried about Ethics
             Concerned over (Org Exec)
             W/Hs from Flag
             Out-Ethics situation
             PTS
             Connected to a hostile person
             Saying things to someone else
             Discussing things out of session
             Concerned about others' intentions
             Afraid of trouble
             Failed purpose
             Want to leave
             Don't feel safe
             O/R on words
             Misunderstoods
             People not saying
             Others withholding from you
             Heard things
             Something unhandled


           2wc to F/N-best to worst reads in turn.


        2.       C/S 53RRR handle."

        The auditor does the full C/S.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        His biggest concern right now is finishing his auditing, getting  a
        post and finding out what's going to happen with him. He's stuck in
        a continuous PTP-Mystery as far as what will happen  to  him.  He's
        also stuck in a win from a session with (....) on 1 May 72.

        1.       Put him to work as an expeditor.


        2.       PTS Check and 5 Apr 72.


LRH PROGRAM-

        "He needs 3 May 72 PL Steps.
        D of P Interview to give him R-Factor C/S 5  May  72.  Handle  what
        comes up."


LRH COMMENTS AND C/S 5.5.72-

        "Well done. Conclusion reached is not the correct one for the case.




        PTPs go with E/S, or Exp Dn. Also after a case F/Ns  on  a  subject
        it's usually blown. The answers tend to be what's wrong and the F/N
        says no longer that wrong. Get it?


        So now we can handle.


        There's an Out-Ethics scene with him. It F/Ned on  worry  about  it
        but not what it was.


        The OCA says he's still bad off and it isn't changing.


        And he was the person making trouble in (U.S. Org) with  borrowings
        and donations.

D OF P  R-FACTOR:

        The Commodore is trying to handle things so you can be sent back to
        (U.S. Org) very soon. In order to do  this  he  has  to  make  sure
        things will be all right with you and (U.S. Org). Your OCA  is  low
        and didn't change.


        There's a new Rundown that handles this by  handling  the  person's
        personal life. If you are willing to co-operate we  will  do  this.
        The Commodore is trying to keep  Ethics  off  your  back  over  the
        donations being irregular. This can be worked out but only  if  you
        co-operate.


        Are you agreeable to do this new Rundown?"


        The D of P R-Factor is done.

LRH C/S 6.5.72-

        "To Cl XII auditor.


        Do it gently.


        Please do the PL 3 May all steps on pc.


        Work it out as you go.


        *Step 3 L&N 'The Out-Ethics scene' item.


        Step 4 L&N 'How it would be a betrayal to Scn and Flag'.


        And get him to apply the formula."

The above C/S is done and gets a VWD and at this point the  folder  goes  to
Dept XII (Class XII auditing) where the pc gets his L-10 and  L-10M  checked
over and fixed, which takes one 7 hr session.

Pc now gets new OCA (11.5.72). This crashes badly.  Trait  C  down  to  -52,
Trait G goes lower to -84 and Point A down also.

LRH COMMENT 12.5.72-

        "May have caved him in or made him more honest or made  him  guilty
        or something.


        Needs Hav every session and  will get the new PTS RD when it  comes
        up."




________________________


*FOOTNOTE:  This is the incorrect L&N  question.  The  correct  question  is
             "What Out-Ethics situation are you involved in?" per HCO  B  10
             June 72, "Refer to HCO PL 3 May 72 'Ethics and Executives' ".
NEW PROGRAM BY CL XII 12 May 72. OKed and added to by LRH.

        OCA Graph crashed after L-10M Corr.


        Something missed.


        Got to finish him off.


        Uneducated pc.


        "Use Hav every session."-LRH.

        0. Standard PTS Check as per HCO PL 5 April 72. Handle.


        1.       Ruds triple of long duration, including overt.


        2.       2wc "Was anything missed in the  last  auditing  that  you
             had".
           Get an answer. Handle what found E/S or by list.


        3.       Method 4 "On auditing" and "Scn in general".
           Really clean up every faintest doubt.


        *4.        Clear  GF  40X  words,  assess  Method  6,  use  2wc  (no
             recall/engram).


        5.       L3B Rundown on earliest engrams run. (L3 ExD.)


        6.       PTS Rundown "with new 'Can't Have' RD"-LRH.
           (Use terminals in PTS Check.)


        6a.      Triple Recall/Engrams of GF 40X.


        7.       Redo Method 1 W/Cing.
           (Was cheated on it as words of assessment were cleared.)


        8.       Full Flow Dn Table to completion.


        9.       Complete Expanded Dianetics started.

Exp Dn Auditor does this program. All goes fine. Pc running and having  very
big wins on PTS RD. On completion of Can't Have RD PTS Corr List,  pc  takes
a new OCA.

The OCA recovers somewhat. The  -52  Trait  C  comes  up  and  the  Trait  G
(Responsible) recovers. But only to its original stuck point.

Auditor continues and completes step 6a of the Pgm.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        He's already had the GF 40X items handled and redoing them  was  an
        O/R. He also was not quickied on either of his two M1 W/Cings so  I
        left it alone.

        1.       2wc to F/N.


        2.       Full Flow Dn Table.


        3.       Havingness.

ANOTHER LRH NOTE-

        "This 'stuck point' of OCA is another Ev  Purp,  fixated.  It  will
        blow off or we'll find it.


        He's going according to standard reaction  except  for  one   stuck
        point on the right."

________________________


*FOOTNOTE: Method 6 is a method of assessment used in Cl XII auditing  where
each question on the list is assessed by looking at the pc  and  asking  him
directly.
LRH COMMENTS AND C/S-

        "Very well done.


        He doesn't need a FF Dn.


        We've sort of lost our place in the book on the Exp Dn RD. I see it
        'started' but no Pgm.


        Do new Pgm.


        I see he's had his L-10 Ev Purps.


        This cat is nearly through.


        He has a stuck viewpoint.


        He has not had metalosis.


        Exp Dn recovers graphs.


        The stuck graph point is Responsibility Irresponsibility.

        R-Factor: You will be here a few more days before  leaving  for  (a
        U.S. Org).

        1.       Fly all ruds Triple (to get the air clean)-(Org associate)
             is leaving.


        2.       2wc mark all reads and BDs as  we  want  THE  ITEM.  'What
             would it be awful to have to  take  responsibility  for?'  (and
             let's not have an everything's okay F/N). WC the  hell  out  of
             the question backwards first.


           There's a trick of impinging such a  Q  after  WCing.  'Now  I'm
             going to ask you a very serious question and I want you to give
             it every thought.' Then ask it.


        3.       When you have the item that really read  well,  L&N  'What
             would be the intention of somebody who would do that?'  If  the
             answer to Q2 above was a goal or intention, omit this.


        4.       R3R Triple on it.


        5.       Havingness."

The auditor does the C/S and  pc  has  huge  win,  and  goes  exterior  with
perception.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 20.5.72-

        WE FINALLY DID IT! ! !


        His graph is beautiful. He totally  changed-Ext + perception  among
        other things. Your C/S hit right where he needed it. He finally got
        the R/S and Ev Purp run that was pinning him down.

        Declare Exp Dns Complete.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done.


        Absolutely classical. Exp Dn at its best!"

SUCCESS STORY-

        I have never achieved so much. Boy!!!


        This is a breakthrough beyond my  belief.  I  feel  clean,  I  have
        changed physically. I feel healthier and more honest.


        Sir, all my thanks.
GRAPH WHEN PC COMPLETE-
                                    [pic]
TOTAL NO. OF SESSIONS: 19.

TOTAL HRS IN THE CHAIR: 46 hrs 20 min.


                                  Compiled by:
                                  Flag Dn Spec Team
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:WS:MM:ntm.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              21 OCTOBER 1972R
Remimeo     Issue I
Ex Dn C/Ses
Ex Dn Auditors   Revised 30 April 1975

                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 21 OCTOBER 1972
                                   Issue I
                       (Revisions in this type style)


                        Expanded Dianetics Series 13R
                           (Series Number Amended)


                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE F


OCA GRAPH 22.12.71 (last graph before Exp Dn available)-

                                    [pic]

CASE NOTES AND SET-UP PROGRAM BY EXP DN SPEC-

        Case Level OT IIIX. Chronic sickie. Bypassed Dn Case. L-11 and L-12
        over very unflat Dianetics. Has run well on emotions.  Misemotional
        about auditing. Refused auditor change. PTS RD done and  corrected,
        but no MAA check done.

        0.       Hav before and after each session.


        1.       D of P do PTS check and handling as necessary.


        2.       Who wd I have to be to audit you? to EP.


        "2a.      What could you talk to me about?" added by LRH.


        3.       Hav + Touch Assists until pc stronger.


        4a.      Clear WCCL and WC M1 C/S 1.


        4b.      WCCL to F/Ning list.


        4c.      WC M1. Add: Processing,  tech,  study,  Orgs,  despatches.
             Handle to F/Ning list.


        5.       WC M2 first materials read or heard:
           (a) In Scientology
           (b) In Admin.


        6.       To Ex Dn.
PROGRAM STARTED 20.4.72

D OF P INTERVIEW-

        On checking for PTS Type A pc says no. However, pc does feel  she's
        PTS to post environment  Pc says, "I am physically sick and because
        of that I'm getting Exp Dn. So far had a lot  of  medical  handling
        and so far not much handled. The Doctor I just  went  to  seems  to
        think he spotted some sort of worm  in  my  system,  but  it's  not
        verified yet. MO should have the data but that's a medical thing. I
        know that  I've  got  an  overactive  colon  and  also  an  ovarian
        infection.


        I don't feel like I'm PTS-if I am it's a case thing."

D OF P COMMENTS-

        Pc really not confronting, obviously she is still sick! But with  D
        of P action could not punch through that and get what  it  was,  or
        is. She's just very strongly blank on it.

LRH COMMENT-

        "No she isn't blank.


        She's PTS to Environment of Post!


        PTS is a Person or Thing.


        New Pgm needed to list this.


        D of P. Do on meter next time."

LRH C/S 20.4.72-

        "Says she was PTS to Env of Post.


        She is PTS.


        She thought you'd debar auditing I'm sure.

        1.       Clear backwards, L&N 'Who or What in your post environment
             were you PTS to?' Check for read. List to BD F/N item.


        2.       R3R Triple on item."

The pc was not audited that day so LRH put the above C/S as Step 3a  on  the
program and C/Sed to do Step 2 first.

LRH C/S 21.4.72-

        "1. Who would I have to be to audit you? F/N.


        2.       What could you talk to me about? F/N.


        3.       Touch Assist.


        4.       Hav."

The C/S was done. In addition the MO gave the pc a couple of  touch  assists
for a pain in the lower tummy. The pc says at the Examiner: "It was  a  nice
session. But there is something with R3R and me  that  don't  agree.  But  I
liked the session." TA 2.2 Normal F/N VGIs.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Pc's in-session mannerisms are so similar  to  (Case  B's)  initial
        sessions it's amazing. The same "Well it's a bit  silly  trying  to
        run engrams on me, but I'll play along" attitude.


        We're not in the pc's area of interest.


        0.       D of P PTS check.
             1.   2wc to F/N.


        2.       Clear L-3 Exd Word.


        3.       L-3 Exd RD to EP.


        4.       2wc "What do you really want handled?"  Note  all  LF,  BD
             items.


        On this day LRH sends a note down for the folder:


        "This pc has had a lot of Evil Purposes found  on  L-10,  etc  that
        will have to be R3Red.


        She has MisUs on and wrongly run Dn."


        The auditor seeing this note writes a note to LRH.

AUDITOR NOTE 23.4.72-

         Dear Sir,


         Per my 21.4.72 session pc is much  stronger,  having  had  regular
         Touch Assists from the MO. She is up most of the day now.


         Suggest my attached C/S.

        1.       D of P PTS check.
        2.       2wc to F/N.
        3.       Clear WCCL and WC C/S 1 words.
        4.       WCCL to F/Ning list.
        5.       Hav to F/N.

LRH REPLY 23.4.72-

        "Hey, no. She just fell on her head yesterday.  See  exam  report."
        (See above.)


        " Do C/S." (See below.)

        The word MO in the note is ringed and LRH writes "She's your pc."

LRH C/S 23.4.72-

        "Well done.


        No initial (LRH) on pgm itself.


        We're out of her depth too soon. This is a detached sort of pc.


        Attention mainly on  body  (2D  history),  she's  not  confronting.
        Possibly even below bank awareness. Possibly just sensation or pain
        registers. This Pgm Step 3 not completed. (Hav  and  Touch  Assists
        until pc stronger.)

        1. 2wc to F/N. (Just to get in comm a bit.)


        2. Touch Assist.


        3. Hav."

        The auditor does the Touch Assist and on his own C/S he draws a box
        with the caption "Space for LRH to write 'See?-I  told  ya,  didn't
        I?'."


         LRH writes in the box "When all else fails do what Ron says."  And
        by the caption he writes "I never say I told you so, I rarely  have
        to."



        The session is given a " Very  well  done"  and  the  next  C/S  to
        continue the Touch Assist and Hav is "Okayed".


        This routine is continued for 3 days. On the 26.4.72  LRH  adds  to
        the auditor's C/S.

AUDITOR'S C/S-

        1.       Hav to F/N.


        2.       Touch Assist to win.


        "2a.      2wc to F/N (just to give her  a  little  bit  of  straight
             auditing to groove her in)," added by LRH.


        3.       Hav to F/N.

        Several sessions of above a day.


        This is continued each day till the 30.4.72. At the Examiner the pc
        says, "I feel like I came out of a terrible death or  something.  I
        had a terrible attack of God knows what."

LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

        "Well done by Exams.


        *This pc had to have another T Assist after this  session.  She  is
        also malingering. Rides motorcycles, dances, yet 'too ill to work'.
        So she goes to SPF and off MO lines.

        1.       Fly all ruds triple.


        2.       PTS C/S 20 April 72.

        We now take gloves off."

The PTS Interview C/S of 20.4.72 was done.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        She's PTS to "People"-oh Boy.

        1.       Hav to F/N.


        2.       L&N "W/W wd represent people?" (Clear backwards and  check
             for read.)


        3a.      Clear R3R words.


        3b.      R3R Triple item.


        4.       Triple ruds and overt item in Fl Basic Incident.


        5.       PTS RD Corr List. Clear and assess to F/Ning list.

        LRH--"OK".

        The auditor does the above C/S. Towards the end of session  the  pc
        says "feeling of being unsafe-don't know if handled or not".

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 8.5.72-

        Handled the item which would represent "people". Good result.

        She had a H. Std at end  of  session-p.  26  on  "doesn't  know  if
        handled yet". Should be handled as part of this program. I suggest:

________________________


*FOOTNOTE: SPF = Stewards Project Force.
        0.       Hav to F/N.


        1.       L&N Intentions connected with "feeling  of  being  unsafe"
             (check for read and if none and if supp and inval  don't  read,
             drop it).


        2.       R3R Triple.


        3.       Clear WCCL and WC M1 commands.


        4.       WCCL to F/N list.


        5.       WC M1 and added subjects.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 9.5.72-

        "Well done.


        C/S suggestion is a serious error.


        You  must  combine   significances   with   terminals,   not   with
        significances. You can't list successfully 'What  is  your  thought
        about a thought?'


        You can list successfully 'What is your thought about a mass?'  (or
        terminal?).


        'What mass could be  connected  to  what  thought'  could  even  be
        listed.


        You start running significances about what  masses  and  you'll  do
        well. If you start running  thoughts  about  thoughts  you'll  pull
        thoughts out of engrams and restim the devil out of the bank.


        You have an Exp Dn Item in 'feeling very unsafe'. What more do  you
        want!


        But this pgming is kind of crazy on this pc. It is sort of  out  of
        sequence. How come we're repairing M1 before we finish the Exp  Dn.
        Why wasn't M1 corrected first.


        Also I don't know what 'Ruds on Basic F1  Inc'  was  all  about.  I
        don't even know what was meant, as can't tell from W/S.


        This pc is being run off pgm. Finish what you have your  hands  on.
        Don't step about.

        1.       2wc 'What she feels unhandled about what we ran?' Note all
             BD F/N Items.


        2.       Touch Assist.


        3.       Hav.

        Reprogram this case. Get R3R or whatever in on the C/S above.  Then
        get the pgm smoothed out. It's jumped the rails."

AUDITOR'S NOTE TO LRH-

        Dear Sir,


        Re your C/S for pc of 9.5.72.


        You mention not digging the Triple Ruds on Basic of F-1 Incident.


        This was done as the L&N was to specify the terminal she was PTS to
        after D of P Interview came out with "PTS to people".


        The HCO B requiring Triple Ruds on Basic of F-1 Incident is 13  Feb
        72, written by OJR and LK. It is attached-refer page  2.  This  was
        applied in this case as the step was to handle PTS terminal.


        As the HCO B is not written by you I am  bringing  it  up  in  case
        there has been an error.


        Love, (Auditor).

LRH REPLY-

        *"Got it. No, it's okay."


At this time the pc comes off the antibiotic (Chloramphenicol) that she  had
been on but temperature went right up again so the MO put her  back  on  the
antibiotic.


The above LRH C/S was done.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Did the 2wc and Touch Assist.


        Per her Itsa she's just short of being fully cured. (Origin to  C/S
        last couple of pages.)


        1.       Rud to F/N.


        2.       R3R Triple on "unsafe" item mentioned. (Get her  to  state
             item.) "Use her wording only when given" added by LRH.


        3.       2wc "How are you doing now?"


        4.       If all well attest Exp Dn complete.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done."

The auditor does the C/S.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Went fine. See 2wc Orig-she has some hidden standards and also some
        attention on PTS and on her effect on body.


        I haven't seen the latest on PTS RD yet but as the last action  was
        the ''final'' step of her last PTS Interview  being  handled  I  wd
        suggest:


        1.       Any further PTS handling (per recent researches).


        2.       To Exp Dn Pgm.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 13.5.72-

        "Well done.


        I don't see a  hidden  standard.  I  do  see  a  PTS  situation  or
        overlooked terminal.


        See in red correct way to clarify words on a W/S. Don't overwrite.

        (diff colour)-TOTALLY


        Example from W/S: Want to get (XXXXXX) well
           Illegible word

        **See (other pc folder) note of this date for new PTS RD steps.


        As these are run a new terminal may show up.

        1.       PTS Can't Have RD."

________________________


*FOOTNOTE:  Above HCO B on running Ruds on F-1 basic was later cancelled  as
             an incorrect procedure.

**FOOTNOTE: This now issued as an HCO B-9 Dec 1971RA, "PTS Rundown".
LRH PROGRAM 13.5 .72-

        "PTS RD incomplete as still ill.


        1.       Can't Have RD.


        2.       When a new item shows up, D of P Int and  PTS  engrams  on
             it, then complete the Can't Have RD.


        3.       Then to Exp Dn."

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S (After doing above C/S)-

        RD going well. Auditor error - slow TRs = underestimating pc =  not
             auditing pc in front of him.


        Also she ran into physical tiredness due to not  having  her  usual
             mineral supplement from MO today. (Obnosis slip.)


        I handled the TRs.


        0. Ensure not tired and well fed.


        "00. Fly all ruds" added by LRH.


        1.       Complete remaining terminals on Can't Have.


        *2.       To D of P to verify or trace other terminals mentioned  in
             end of today's session to which the pc may be PTS.


        3.       PTS RD on any found if known before this L/T.


        4.       Check for any others.


        5.       Repeat 3.


        6.       Can't Have RD on any terminals so handled.


        7.       When complete declare Exp Stability RD complete.

LRH COMMENT 15.5.72-

        "Well done.


        She's very critical. Note the ruds added "


        The PTS RD is extended for several sessions. Then  pc  goes  to  MO
        with heart palpitations.

MO MEDICAL REPORT 21.5.72-

        **Heavy heart palpitations B/P 145/70.


        Did a Touch Assist, brought it back down to normal 120/55.


        Heavy gas pains on left side of chest and left  arm  alleviated  by
        Touch Assist.

________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  This was a D of P type Interview. When  this  comes  up  in  the
             middle of the PTS RD like above this could normally be done  in
             session by the auditor. (The why and handling steps are done in
             HCO or by the D of P per C/S Series 76.)

**FOOTNOTE: Blood Pressure (B/P) is measured as  the  maximum  pressure  the
             heart exerts through the blood system (the top figure) and  the
             minimum pressure the  heart  allows  through  the  system  (the
             bottom figure).
      It is measured as so many centimeters of mercury.  This  is  a  method
             and unit of measuring pressure originally used by physicists.
        For the last days when going to sleep heart  palpitations  started,
        and last night got so bad she could not sleep.


        Given Calcium and Pantothenic Acid.

After the session on the 21.5.72 the auditor writes to LRH, along  with  his
session comments and C/S.

AUDITOR'S NOTE 21.5.72-

        Dear Sir,


        Please note that 2 out of 3 terminals in this session were not this
        L/T terminals but suppressives of  whom  she  was  reminded  by  PT
        Restimulators.


        This may have been an error to run.


        Definite data not in PTS Pack. Is this an error?

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Thought you should see this one. She had had the heart palpitations
        which she was discussing in last session which occurred when  upset
        by (__________) last year.


        As she is in auditing-PTS RD, I suggest:


        1.       PTS RD Corr List, "In your recent  auditing".  Assess  and
             handle to F/N list.


        2.       Verify remaining terminals and run if indicated.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

        "Error here in running 'reminded of' in past for a PT terminal. Has
        recoiled on the pc.


        The C/S is correct.


        Add a 3 May 72 PL to the list soonest. (LRH added  to  the  13.5.72
        Pgm.) Ruds probably out."


        The auditor does the C/S to a good result. The Med Report  for  the
        day says pc is feeling A-OK.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        The BPC was an implant stirred up while running one of  those  past
        SPs.


        This has been repaired-the engram in restim was  R3R  Tripled.  The
        PTS Corr List was done to F/N list. Per her origin she  is  certain
        about not being PTS.


        Suggest we let her have  that  unless  any  sign  of  rollercoaster
        appears.


        1.       HCO PL 3 May 72 in full. (+ L&N, up to 1st Dynamic formula
             to be done herself.)


        2.       2wc "How do you feel about Ethics?" to F/N.


        3.       2wc "How do you feel about your PTS RD?" to F/N.

LRH COMMENTS AND C/S 23.5.72-

        "Your C/S is backwards. Finish a cycle (PTS in  this  case)  before
        entering another.


        1.       5 April 72 PL D of P. Handle anything that needs it on PTS
             RD.


        If okay to auditor:


        2.       2wc 'How do you feel about your PTS  RD'.  (Be  sure  it's
             ended.)


        3.       Declare.
             Then next step do 3 May 72 PL."


The above C/S w as done to good result. The auditor then  wrote  an  Exp  Dn
program.

EXP DN PGM BY DN SPEC 23.5.72-

        0.       Hav = "Notice that".
        "00.      Needs a 3 May 72 PL" added by LRH.
        1.       Clear all terms.
        2.       Sanderson RD.
        3.       PT Environment handling.
        4.       Auditor's auditing handling.
        5.       Emotional Stress WF handling.
        6.       LXes 321 handling.
        7.       OCA.

The 3 May PL is done and the pc has a huge win.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Well the 3 May PL produced a clear list Q and an origination  on  a
        huge win -"an OT thing". Should be identified if possible.

        1.       D of P "What happened in your recent win?" for data.


        2.       Declare if one is in order.


        3.       Do steps 1, 2 and 3 of the Pgm.

The pc has D of P Interview and  declares  Mest  Universe  Release.  The  pc
takes a new OCA.

OCA GRAPH 25.4.72-


[pic]


LRH COMMENT-

        "It's changing anyway."

The Sanderson RD is started and continues very well for several sessions.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-
        There was still charge from the bypassed win and some other points.
        Did a GF-still hot-and cleared all up.


        The one thing she most wants handled  is  "This  Evil  Purpose  I'm
        sitting on", BD 2.0 to 1.8.


        Suggest:


        1. L&N "What evil purpose has been missed?"


        2. R3R Triple.


        3. Hav.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done, you're doing better now."


The next session goes to pieces. The auditor gets off on a  list  correction
and the pc gets very upset and red tags at the Examiner. The  auditor  sends
the pc to the D of P for a "What did the auditor do" to cool her off.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 31.5.72-

        "Same auditor on this pc. They both have to confront it.


        I can't really make it out. Can't read some of the  Admin  and  I'm
        not sure what went on. Change of procedures? I don't know where  it
        came from.


        The C/S for the session, 2nd session, doesn't exist so I guess  you
        were C/Sing in the chair, a grave fault.


        This sort of reaction comes from list errors.


        Essentially she thought you were DENYING HER AN ITEM.


        She's not up to any of this.

        1.       R-Factor: I have some questions here to solve the upset.
           Were you being denied the item?
           Were earlier wrong lists restimulated?
           Do you have a withhold?
           Wouldn't the auditor listen?
           Some other upset?
           You didn't agree with something?
           Was your list suppressed and invalidated?


           2wc the result E/S and handle.


        2.       What part of the session could you confront?
           Repetitive, not 2wc to F/N, VGIs.


        3.       Havingness."

This C/S was done to a moderate result  but  the  lists  were  never  really
picked up and handled properly. The Exp Dn Pgm was continued  but  soon  the
pc was in trouble.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Wow. Seems she's gone past the point where she was cured  and  well
        and has developed a lot of BPC on inval because  Dn  was  continued
        and she feels it was "complete" some time.


        Whole session was getting off BPC  on  being  O/R  as  a  case  and
        protesting further Dianetics.

        1.       Fly a Rud.


        2.        Rehab  big  win  in  Dianetics  recently  (Mest  Universe
             Release).


        3.       Get point where she realized she was no longer ill. Rehab.


        4.       Declare Exp Dn Completion.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 3.6.72-

        "No. Off Exp Dn Lines.

TO CL XII C/S

        This pc is having list trouble by reads 2 sessions back. Early list
        restimmed read. They're not repaired.


        Please have a XII handle her lists, rehab any win and  remove  from
        auditing lines."

LRH PROGRAM 4 June 72-

        "Is exhibiting wrong list behavior  in  recent  sessions,  read  on
        'earlier wrong lists', handling was quickied. Pc still upset.

        Also pc finds only Org terminals as SPs. So she is not PTS, she  is
        .....(see Exp Dn Case C).

        1.       Find and correct all earlier lists. See LRH  C/S  of  June
             72. Don't not do it! Auditor already flunked it.


        2.       3 May 72 PL-2 lists.


        3.       L-3XDn RD.


        4.       Find all  Ev  Purps  gotten  off  on  L-10  or  in  recent
             sessions, even those dated  and  located  and  list  them  from
             earliest one. R3R Triple. Get them all.


        5.       Locate any new ones. R3R Triple.


        6.       PTS Corr List and additional + Can't Have.


        7.       Metalosis.


        8.       OCA."

LRH C/S 4.6.72-

        "See Pgm.


        Locate all uncorrected lists and correct item as she exhibits wrong
        list behaviour in sessions and is very upset on the subject.

        1.       Correct any and all wrong lists from earliest forward.

        Do nothing else until action is complete."

The List Correction is fully done by a Cl XII Auditor and the pc has a  huge
case resurgence. Pc attests Review complete.

SUCCESS STORY 16.6.72-

        This was definitely the best Review I have ever had.


        It changed my life greatly and gave me some  answers  I  have  been
        looking for for a long time.
        It is deeply appreciated.


At this point the LRH Pgm is continued by an Exp Dn Auditor. This  is  still
in progress at this point in time. The last OCA to be taken is on 22.7.72.

PC'S LAST OCA 22.7.72-

                                    [pic]

The present Pgm being worked on is designed to raise the low Trait H point.

TOTAL NO. OF SESSIONS TO DATE: 38.

TOTAL NO. OF HRS IN THE CHAIR TO DATE: 54 hrs 15 min.


                                  Compiled by
                                  Flag Dn Spec Team


                                  Revised by CS-4


                                  Approved by


                                  L. RON HUBBARD
                                  Founder


                                  for the


                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:LRH:RS:MM nt.rdjh
Copyright �1972, 1974, 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               22 OCTOBER 1972
                            Issued 28 March 1974
Remimeo
Ex Dn C/Ses
Ex Dn Auditors
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 22 OCTOBER 1972




                        Expanded Dianetics Series 14
                           (Series Number Amended)




                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE G


OCA GRAPH 6.5.72-


                                    [pic]


This pc had come to Flag for an FCCI. (Flag Case Completion Intensive.)  She
had  been  audited  by  a  Cl  XII  Auditor  on  set-ups  and  higher  level
processing. The pc's case level is OT VI.

NOTE BY THE CL XII C/S TO LRH-

         Dear Sir,


        The pc has "finished" OT III Exp VGIs, good D of  P  Interview  but
        OCA down, from what it was after L-9SX.


        Have done a new Pgm (she wants Dn and Exp Grades  before  she  goes
        home) and first C/S.


        Pgm calls for Exp Dn on her L-9S items. Prior to that a  repair  to
        catch the ARC Bks (dropped graph).


        This is OK.

LRH COMMENT 7.5.72-

        "OK. (On pgm.)


        More honest graph really, but ARC Bk rule holds."
SET-UP PROGRAM BY CL XII C/S-

        1.       Assess: Auditors, auditing, solo, Adv Courses, Flag, Wins.


        2.       L1C on reading items.
        3.       M4 for misunderstood words in Auditing.
        4.       W/Clearing Corr List to F/N List.
        5.       GF M5 and handle.
        6.       To Exp Dn Pgm.

The above  set-up  Pgm  was  done  to  good  result  and  some  longstanding
misunderstoods were cleared up on the pc.

EXP DN PGM BY DN SPEC 8.5.72-

Set-up program complete. Has chronic aches and pains to be handled with  Exp
Dns.

        0.       Havingness each session.


        1.       R3R Triple Ev Purps.


        2.       2wc PT Environment  noting  all  reads.  Take  up  reading
             areas. Handle R3R Triple and get  any  Attitudes  and  Emotions
             connected.


        3.       Emotional Stress White Form-emphasis on losses.


        4.       Clear and assess LX3, LX2 then LX1. Handle reading  items.
             R3R Triple.


        5.       2wc Body  Problems  wants  handled.  Get  As,  Es  and  Is
             connected. R3R Triple.


        6.       New OCA.

        Added: Pc discovered terminal PTS to.

        7.       Triple Ruds.


        8.       Clear and assess PTS Rundown Corr List and handle.


        9.       Can't Have Rundown.


        10.      OCA taken here not at 6.

The program is started and completed to Step 2. The pc  at  Exams  says,  "I
had a beautiful session. I feel so good, so  good.  I  feel  identified.  So
me."

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS-

        We're really hitting right where she wants handling. Handling long-
        term failed help and somatics. (Note exam.)


        She's really winning!


        (I put her on footplates today, she  loves  them  and  no  more  TA
        hassles or attention on cans.) LRH --"Great!"

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done."


        The next session the WF handling is completed and the LX lists  are
        begun.



        The pc says at the Examiner, "Everything is alright. So much  gone!
        Not there any more! Just computing. I wouldn't have  missed  coming
        to Flag for all the World."

AUDITOR'S COMMENT-

        The last exam speaks for itself. She's doing very well!

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done.


        You should frame it! You're doing a good job."


        The next session Step 4 of the program is completed and 5 done.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        She feels  that  there  is  nothing  else  she  wants  handled.  We
        unblocked her ears among other things. She wants  to  go  home  and
        train and  start  auditing.  She  felt  handled  after  yesterday's
        session.

        0.       New OCA.


        1.       D of P Interview.


        2.       Pending results continue  Pgm  or  Declare  Exp  Dianetics
        Complete.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Hey a Product!


        Very well done!"

Pc declares. Then next day 13.5.72 the Host rushes a note to the C/S.

NOTE FROM HOST TO C/S-

        (Pc) has just come to me a little griefy  with  a  headache  (after
        completing her Expanded Dns yesterday).


        She says she knows she is PTS. She says she knows it is not "_____"
        but it may be her CPA (Certified Public Accountant) "_____"


        She itsa'd a bit and remembered he sat on the board of  the  Mental
        Health Organization in "_____" She started to blow a lot of  charge
        and said she felt it blowing.


        *I info'd her of the new PL on PTS and finance. She became VGIs  and
        is going to read it. She then  recognized  that  her  business  and
        Franchise started to get into trouble when they  took  him  on  and
        said they knew the Business was PTS to Someone.


        I said I'd info the D of P and C/S and get it handled for her.  She
        went off VGIs to read the PL but came back a few seconds  later  to
        say the headache had blown-I asked her to get a pc Exam  (so  there
        is a record of whether the item F/Ned).


        Please get her cleaned up with Ethics/D of P and  further  sessions
        on PTS RD if required.
                                  HOST

EXAM REPORT AFTER HOST INTERVIEW-

I spotted our CPA as a one dollar a year man.
_________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  HCO PL 12 May 72, "PTS PERSONNEL AND FINANCE".
        Blew my headache. It affected our Business and I'm sure he  is  the
        Why. Feel great.

        TA 2.25 Wide F/N.

AUDITOR'S NOTE AND C/S (Also these steps added to the Pgm)-

        Her OCA has recovered from its bad dip. She came  up  to  the  Host
        tonight with a terminal she recognized she was PTS  to.  She  feels
        she's complete on her Exp Dianetics but she should  get  this  last
        bit of PTSness cleared up.

        0.       Work out handling for CPA in "_____" she's PTS  to-with  D
        of P.


        1.       Fly all ruds triple + overts.


        2.       PTS Rundown Correction List.


        3.       "Can't Have" Rundown as addition to PTS Rundown.

        Note: I need more data for Step 3-is an HCO B coming out?

LRH REPLY 13.5.72-

        "See attached note."


        *"PTS Steps (Not necessarily in final form).


        Select the terminals already run on R3R in the sequence  they  were
        run in. 1st one, 2nd one, 3rd one, etc.


        Clear 'Can't Have'  'Couldn't  Have'  as  denial  of  something  to
        someone else. 'Enforced Have' as making someone  accept  what  they
        don't want. Have the pc get the idea of these with an example or 2.


        Run on the SP items a 4 way (each to F/N) bracket.

        1.       'What Can't Have did (terminal) run on you?' to F/N.


        2.       'What Can't Have did you run on (same terminal)?'


        3.       'What did (terminal) force on you you didn't want?'


        4.       'What did you try to force on (terminal) that he (she, it)
        didn't want?'

        Each goes to F/N.


        This can also be run alternate repetitive:


        1.2.1.2. etc to F/N. 3.4.3.4. etc to F/N.


        But it may not be cleaned up.


        The theory is that SPs are SPs because they deny  hav  and  enforce
        unwanted hav. They also deny do and enforce unwanted do. They  also
        deny be and enforce unwanted be.


        A very full RD then would be to start with don't  be  must  be,  go
        onto don't do must do, end up with can't have enforced have.


        *A pc has to be told it is experimental as it is not yet in HCO B.


        After EACH item handled with the 2 flows can't and 2 flows enforced
        OBJECTIVE HAV should be run.


_________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  This process and RD is no longer experimental and is covered  in
             HCO B 9 Dec 71 RA, "PTS RUNDOWN".
        This is why we have never before been able to run  subjective  hav.
        It collided with SPs, overts and w/hs on them.


        Hav alone (4 bracket) should handle without resorting to Be or  Do,
        but in rough cases, Be and Do will have to come before Hav.


        End off at once and begin objective Hav if the TA soars or  the  pc
        caves m, and send folder to me.


        A PTS RD can make a clear if fully carried  out,  accurate  in  all
        steps."


        The  pc  handles  her  PTS  connection  by  telexing  to  have  the
        Accountant fired. The auditor then takes the pc into session to  do
        these further auditing steps.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        The "Can't Have" Rundown is a roaring success with her. We  cleaned
        up every last bit of PTSness in her environment, according to  her.
        It's really  incredible  to  see  mass  blow  off  people  and  get
        brighter.


        0.       New OCA.
        1.       D of P Interview on recent auditing, etc.
        2.       If all OK Declare Exp Dn Complete.

LRH COMMENT 14.5.72-

        "Very well done!


        Cheers! A good  product. Can we do 'em or can't we.


        C/S okay."

In the D of P Interview pc wants to give her Business Associate a further R-
Factor con-
cerning the Accountant which she goes off  to  (_____)  to  do.  While  away
doing this the
pc pulls in an old somatic.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        She's  got  an  old  backache  at  (_____)  yesterday-which   needs
        handling. She also did a new OCA "over a backache"  but  there  are
        some interesting changes in the graph. She also is winning with the
        touch assist from the MO.

        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       Touch Assist to a Cog.
        3.       Sanderson Rundown per Pgm. (Added.)
        4.       End with havingness.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 17.5.72-

        "I tole you and tole  you  and  tole  you-when  they  rollercoaster
        they're PTS OR she has been wearing metal.  (Shoes  have  steel  in
        them, belts, garter belts.) (I  just  found  'appendicitis'  was  a
        party belt studded with metal!)


      **1.       Have the pc stand, look her over for metal,  question  her
             about metal stays, girdles she wears or has worn. Find what  it
             is that rests exactly in the somatic areas.


        FIND IT past or present.


        R-Factor: Metal worn  on  the  person  can  cause  your  condition.
        Indicate it.


________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  This process and RD is no longer experimental and is covered  in
             HCO B 9 Dec 71 RA, "PTS RUNDOWN".

**FOOTNOTE: This is the "Metalosis RD" and will be covered more fully as  to
             theory and application in HCO Bs later in Exp Dn Series.
             2.   Put her on a meter. L&N 'What metal object have  you  worn
             in back area'. Check for read. BD F/N Item.


        3.       R3R Triple using the item found-wore a-or whatever.


        4.       L&N 'What metal object have you worn-(Feet, legs, what  it
             is)! BD F/N Item.


        5.       R3R Triple-wore (or used) a_____.


        6.       Hav."

The auditor does the C/S.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Sir, you're a genius! This is exactly  where  she  was  sitting-she
        blew these somatics she thought were "62 yr old somatics".


        I've never seen something work so fast before.


        1.       Declare Exp Dn Complete.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done.


        This was the first Metalosis session!"


The pc attests Exp Dn Complete and says at the Examiner,  "I  had  the  best
night's sleep in a long time. I feel great. Also my  eyesight  has  improved
75%."

PC'S SUCCESS STORY-

        For me Expanded Dianetics is the process that truly enables  me  to
        be OT and an active Scientologist. There are  no  words  to  really
        describe the gains I have had. My awareness is up and I have gained
        that which is necessary to operate truly as an OT.


        PC'S LAST OCA (Taken before Metalosis) 16.5.72-


                                    [pic]

TOTAL NO. OF SESSIONS: 6.

TOTAL NO. OF HRS IN THE CHAIR: 13 hrs 46 min.

      Compiled by:
      Flag Dn Spec Team
BDCS:WS:MM:ntm rd      for the
Copyright � 1972,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               24 OCTOBER 1972
Remimeo     Issued 28 March 1974
Ex Dn C/Ses
Ex Dn Auditors   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 24 OCTOBER 1972

                        Expanded Dianetics Series 15
                           (Series Number Amended)

                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE I

                                    [pic]

CASE NOTES 2.4.72-

        No grade. OCA right side "in the white". Tone range  per  Chart  of
        Human  Evaluation  0.5  -1.1.  Audited  over  out-drugs.  Drug   RD
        (quickie) declared while pc in a spin.  Hot  W/F  quickie  handled.
        Critical of auditors. Half of sessions BER. One point "didn't  need
        auditing". Tends to self audit. Chronic sickie.  Accidents.  Ethics
        (under Comm Ev). Failed on post. Last action W/Cing M 1 and 2.

EXP DN PROGRAM BY A DN SPEC 2.4.72-

        0. Pgm to be started after Comm Ev completed, and  pc  with  Ethics
             OK.


        "00.      Clear ARC Bk and handle LD. WCCL, WC C/S  1  and  redo  M1
             WC." Added by LRH 17.4.72.


        1.       Clear each word in R3R + on L-3B. Clear commands.


        2.       Assess PT environment buttons. Get attitudes and emotions,
             R3R Triple.


        3.       Assess Cl VIII auditing list, get attitudes  and  emotions
             on reading buttons, R3R Triple. "Add LRH" added by LRH 15.4.72.


           If considerations clear up on auditing and auditors omit Step  4
             and go to 5.


        4.       Clear each word in  LXs.  Assess  LXs  "on  auditing"  R3R
             Triple then LX2 + LX1 R3R Triple.


        5.       Clear Drug RD. Reassess Drug list. Handle to  a  real  F/N
             list.


        6.       Prior Assessment.


        7.       New OCA.

To be pgmed accordingly.
AUDITOR'S FIRST C/S 2.4.72-

        Not to be audited until Comm Ev complete. Last action was W/Cing.


        Tends to self audit. Calls it confronting.


        D of P to inform pc that during his Exp Dns Pgm he is to do no more
        "confronting".


        1.       D of P step above.


        2.       Clear each word in R3R and on L-3B.


        3.       Clear R3R commands. Have him give examples. Have him  demo
             E/S and New Beg.


        *4.       Assess attached PT environment list.


        5.       Take best reading item, get attitudes  and  emotions.  R3R
             Triple.


        6.       Continue attitudes and emotions with  reading  items,  R3R
             Triple.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Pgm and C/S OK."


        The auditor starts the word clearing.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 14.4.72-

        Doing fine. Has a bit of a rough time on words. Still a bit fixated
        on you. Usually only GIs on F/Ns-this will improve. He has had  and
        still has a bit of a sore throat.

        1. Touch Assist to a cog.


        2. Complete clearing R3R and L-3B words.


        3. Assess PT  environment  buttons  (attached).  Get  emotions  and
             attitudes on best reading.


        4. R3R Triple.


        5. Havingness.


        Put havingness on Pgm before ending each session.

LRH COMMENT-

         "Very well done.


         You're doing fine. Probably has some overts on me. Not  likely  to
         recover until they're off.


         C/S OK."

The auditor does the C/S and continues the word clearing.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 15.4.72-

        Well hey! No wonder. He  has  M/Us  up  the  kazoo!  TA  goes  low.
        Overwhelmed on words.


        He really dug the Touch Assist and Havingness. And  he  had  better
        inds. Also gave me a compliment. (He's usually super critical.)


        So no wonder he spun!  And  has  had  lots  of  W/Clearing?!!!  I'm
        pleased with his progress.

_________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  PT Environment List is list made up by the auditor of  areas  in
             the pc's environment that may be charged.
             1.   Touch Assist to cog.


        2.       Clear word sensation.


        3.       Complete clearing L-3B and R3R items.


        4.       Continue Pgm.

LRH COMMENT 16.4.72-

        On Auditor's C/S


        "Very well done. There's something wrong with his WCing. If he bogs
        we do a WC Corr List.


        Ha, I know what it is. He had a WC Corr List over Mis/U wds on  the
        list. Needs verifying but I'll bet his WCing is out but list  won't
        detect."


        On separate note


        "Very well done. That's a very bright observation.


        Check his folders for the WC Corr List of 25 Jan 72 (not  available
        to me at this hour). I'll bet anything it F/Ned because he  doesn't
        understand the words on it. This would make a completion that COULD
        HAVE BEEN AN ARC BRK NEEDLE ON THE WCCL ASSMT! AND AT EXAMINER!


        Complete the list you are working on as per your C/S.


        Then look at the 25 Jan session.


        At 1A we will do, if this looks like he didn't really get his WCing
        corrected, clear WCCL words and assess and correct before we plunge
        into any more chains at 2 of Pgm.


        He's been audited too much to be so ill. So there's a  case  bug-as
        above."

The auditor spends the next session clearing  up  one  word  and  ends  with
Havingness "Feel that".

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 16.4.72-

        Words is really where he is. We went on huge chain  3  1/2  hrs  to
        clear sensation!


        I looked at that WCCL 25 Jan 72-doesn't seem he answered 2  of  the
        questions-just said yeh F/N-GIs exam-27 Jan 72 another  WCCL,  only
        tick handled, looks on last Q pc didn't understand, said  yes  then
        no, and got F/N  and  then  8RR  F/Ned-No  comment!-at  exams  GIs,
        declare Q asked -comm lag - yeh small F/N ok inds.

        3 Feb 72 bogs on M2. WCCL done, probable M/Us.


        7 Feb 72 Red tab declare on WCCL, get re-exam  after  some  M2  and
        declares.


        So his WCing IS BAD-you were so correct.


        I would like to change Pgm a bit to clear all words on WCCL and  WC
        C/S 1 -then WCCL-then verify or complete M 1.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 17.4.72-

        On Auditor's C/S


        "Very well done. Your original observation found this. He must have
        been ARC Brk F/Ning on the original actions."

        On separate sheet


        "Very well done.


        You found the original clue to all this.
        So he must have been doing an ARC Brk F/N on  earlier  WCCLs.  This
        means he's been run, possibly, over an ARC Brk. Gives him his  'sad
        effect'.


        Possible Ethics action on the earlier M1 'completion'.


        So this pc is held down only by words. With tons of  auditing,  not
        knowing the words, he's never been audited!


        Means no one ever cleared commands on him.  Thus  he's  a  'chronic
             case'.


        This is a classic really of what we're achieving and how.


        1.       Clear ARC Brk, carefully.


        2.       Check for ARC Brk LONG DURATION.


        3.       Clear word chain.


        4.       Clear all words on WCCL & WC C/S 1.


        5.       WCCL.


        6.       W/Clear M 1 verified as complete."

The auditor does the C/S successfully. WCing is  continued  for  7  sessions
with good results. However in the next session the pc gets sad and red  tabs
at the Examiner. Pc statement, "I was kind of  uncertain  about  just  which
words I didn't U well enough."

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 21.4.72-

        ARC Brk at exam. Pc in sad effect. Not sure  on  words  (which  are
        M/U) bogging a bit.


        He needs WCCL but that's  what  I'm  trying  to  clear  words  for.
        Probably resolve on ARC Brk.


        1.       Fly ARC Brk Rud and "In your last session" ARC Brk Rud. (I
             cleared those words.)


        2.       Clear PTP and M/W/H, fly each and each as  "In  your  last
             session".


        3.       Clear words fraternity,  lodge,  society,  into,  develop,
             form, thematic, motif, cycle, wavelength, thetan, static.


        4.       Complete clearing words on WCCL and C/S 1 for M 1.


        5.       M 1 verified or completed.


        6.       Hav.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 22.4.72-

        "Too bad.


        I see what's going wrong here. You're not WClearing  over  in-Ruds.
        And not getting an F/N amongst the words. TA  went  up  on  FASTEN.
        After that (pg 4) he got dopey and you didn't grab what he'd really
        not understood.


        Also the long haul of this, if no F/Ns, will  move  him  back  into
        IMPLANTS as these contain words, mass and force.


        F/N is a sign of RELEASE. But from what? Look up the  word.  If  no
        Release then no F/N. If no F/N no release.


        Your C/S won't handle because it's BPC stirred up and that responds
        to handling.

        1.       Were there  some  words  you  were  not  sure  about  last
             session? 2wc E/S to F/N.


        2.       Have we by-passed a win? Rehab.
             3.   Fly all ruds Triple.


        4.       2wc Describe your condition to me. E/S  to  F/N.  5.  What
             have you wanted handled in auditing?

        Send folder up with BD statements circled in  green.  (Red  is  for
        R/Ses and Evil Purps and Serv Facs.)"

The auditor does the complete C/S the next session.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT (NO C/S) 22.4.72-

        Here is result of your C/S. Lots of reads and some B/Ds.


        He really liked it.

LRH COMMENT-

"Well done by Exams.

        Good but no C/S. Needs Pgm and C/S.


        Danger Condition assigned auditor as I had to bypass  last  session
        and being asked to  this  session  again.  No  Danger  Cond  Habits
        please."

AUDITOR'S PROGRAM 23.4.72-

        Has big trouble with words. Words not taken to F/N.  Ruds  not  put
        in. Has funny indicators on F/Ns.


        Hav after each session-Ruds each session.

        1.       Clear F/N.


        2.       2wc "What would have to happen for you to F/N?"


        3.       Clear backload of words from previous  session  (that  did
             not F/N).


        4.       Clear words on WCCL and WC C/S 1.


        4a.      WCCL and handle.


        5.       WC M1 (or verify). Add: TRs, auditing, galley.


        6.       WC 8RR and WCCL to F/N list.


        7.       Tech Div Primary RD. (Can be  done  part-time  during  Exp
             Dn.)


        8.       Pgm for Exp Dns.

AUDITOR'S C/S 23.4.72-

        I re-programmed him for Exp Dn set-up. Got to get words handled.


        He has funny inds sometimes on F/Ns like it's not great enough  for
        him to have an F/N.

        1.       Fly all Ruds.


        2.       Clear F/N.


        3.       2wc "What would have to happen for you to F/N?" (Mark  all
             BDs, Fs, R/Ses, etc.)


        4.       Step 3 Pgm.


        5.       Step 4 Pgm.

LRH COMMENT-
        "Pgm OK and C/S OK."

The C/S is done and WCing is continued for three  sessions.  On  26.4.72  in
session (on page 10 of the Worksheet)  the  auditor  is  clearing  the  word
"confused" and the pc says, "I don't feel bad  about  'confused'  but  don't
feel good about something-word 'clearing' that's what it  is."  The  auditor
clears this word.

Later on page 20 & 21 of the Worksheet the  auditor  is  clearing  the  word
"sent". The pc says, "I know what it  means."  Auditor,  "M/U?"  Pc,  "Nope.
Laugh, yeh I don't know what it means, I try to convince  you,  laugh."  The
auditor continues and clears it.

The 26.4.72 session ends on an F/N and an F/N exam.

The next session again WCing the pc red tabs at Examiner.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 27.4.72-

        Pc had a sore throat so ended session and took him in  later.  Hard
        going. Pc had considerations how he should feel, how long it should
        last, how should be done.


        But actual bog was ARC Brk with his  being  considered  Ethics  and
        chronic sickie. He's  worried  about  status  and  being  expelled.
        Decided he should get status made certain by Chaplain. (Doesn't get
        on with MO.)


        Since bits of this have come up before I want it handled  before  I
        continue auditing him.


        Main problem in TA was it was over ARC Brk.

        0.        Pc  to  get  status  verified  with  Chaplain.  When   pc
             satisfied:


        1.       Fly all ruds.


        2.       Complete Step 4 of Pgm.


        3.       Continue Pgm.

LRH COMMENTS AND C/S 28.4.72-

        On Auditor's C/S


        "Well Done by Exams.


        Didn't get his Ruds in fully or you'd have made it."

        On separate sheet


        "You didn't get ruds in. Pc was not in comm. You don't run Ruds any
        old way and you MUST NOT CLEAR WORDS OVER A SOARING TA.


        I just sent down a C/S the other day TO  YOU  22  Apr  72  same  pc
        ordering you to get an F/N between words.


        On 26 Apr pg 20 & 21 of earlier session words got out of  sequence.
        Pc was actually out rud, protesting session." (LRH  had  ringed  "I
        try to convince you, laugh" in green on the worksheet  and  written
        "protest".)


        "Earlier on pg 10 he's  skipping  about  amongst  words.  (Confused
        becomes Clearing.)


        *The cause of all this  weird  action  in  the  session  is  on  the
        earliest pg 8 26 April where the ARC Brk got 2 reads and you didn't
        reassess.


        Pgm outness - Clearing backlog of words was a Pgm error  that  left
        us without a cleared WCCL now needed.


        The general outness is trying to audit someone on Ethics  lines  in
        some way.

*FOOTNOTE:  The auditor had assessed ARCU and gotten a sF on both  C  and  U
             and had indicated U instead of reassessing.
        *Your suggestion is correct. To get it handled by someone acting as
        Chaplain -probably Host.

        But there are errors here of an auditing nature. Moving  to  a  new
        room, pc's attn. Not catching protest.

        0.       Chaplain Interview.


        1.       L- 1 C Recently.


        2.       WCCL M5. Handle."

HOST'S REPORT-

        I interviewed (______ pc) as requested.


        The situation was pretty much all handled by him as he went on  his
        own determinism and spoke  to  the  Chaplain/MO  last  night  after
        session.


        He was concerned that the MO had a worse  opinion  of  his  medical
        history than was in fact the case.


        He felt that as the MO had a big say in whether he is offloaded  or
        not-this was an uncool situation.


        The MO gave him the R-Factor that it is a  combination  of  bad  MO
        history and no production that gives offload. This brought  in  his
        GIs as he felt he was able to produce and  hold  his  own  and  his
        status as a SO Member was no longer in danger  because  of  someone
        else's opinion.


        Says it's all handled. GIs.

The auditor spends two sessions handling the WCCL. It seems  nicely  cleaned
up so auditor suggests going back to WCing and Pgm. However before the  next
session the pc reports to the Examiner:

"Sprained my ankle at exercises-scorched my hands on the  gravel,  going  to
be hard going up and down stairs," 4.4 - 4.0 (pc limps out).

Auditor grabs him and gives him a Touch Assist. Pc red tabs at the  Examiner
(TA 3.5).

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 2.5.72-

        Sprained ankle-scraped hand-limping.


        I can't put him on footplates as he has  bandage  on  foot  and  he
        can't hold cans very well in one hand-so he's a bit false TA now.


        Touch Assist went very well.

        1.       Touch Assist.


        2.       Hav.


        (Repeated later in the day if needed.)

LRH COMMENT 3 May 72-

On Auditor's C/S

"OK. But this  cat is PTS!!!!!!"

On separate sheet

"Proceeding well but:

_________________________

*FOOTNOTE: The Chaplain's hat is worn by the MO who  the  pc  does  not  get
along with.
        Has himself an accident.


        He is obviously PTS as he roller coastered.


        Add PTS Check to Pgm.


        Your C/S of touch assist and Hav is okay."

The touch assist was given and pc's foot getting better. The  Word  Clearing
is continued with a touch assist being given each  session  to  a  win.  The
WCing is continued for several sessions. After the session on 7.5.72 the  pc
comes to the Examiner and says, "Feel alright about that," 2.5 F/N Normal.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 7.5.72-

        Almost done.


        1.       Fly all Ruds "+ overts Triple" added by LRH.


        2.       Complete clearing WCCL and 8RR.


        3.       Hav.

LRH COMMENTS-

        "Very well done.


        He seemed a bit dull at Exams = Heavy on ruds next session."

The next session the auditor completes clearing the WCCL and WC C/S  1.  The
pc is sent to the D of P for a PTS Check. However before he has it  an  EstO
grabs him and does some Product Clearing on him. He  goes  to  the  Examiner
the next morning and says, "(_____ EstO) did some  Product  Clearing  on  me
last night. I didn't feel very good about it. Probably had  a  misunderstood
word," 2.4 D/N.

That day the PTS Check is done and D/Ns at the Examiner.

This arrives back with the auditor who has to spend  two  sessions  clearing
up the botched Product Clearing, and then starts in on clearing up  M/Us  on
the PTS materials.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 17.5.72-

        Put Ethics in on him. Saw him reading Science Fiction book when  he
        has "no" time and can't get through PTS materials. Told him to  get
        through fast and keep Ethics in OR NO AUDITING.


        He could wait.


        This came when I found him  not  doing  it  during  his  study  and
        auditing hrs.


        After completing PTS materials.

        1.       Fly all ruds.


        2.       M/U on PTS materials.


        3.       Fly all ruds on PTS.


        4.       Complete PTS Check.

LRH COMMENT 18.5.72-

        "Very well done.


        Now hear this. You did very well getting  his  Out-Ethics  spotted.
        WITH this you opened the door to a resolution of a sticky case.


        He's no good to man or beast and will get no  case  gain  with  his
        Ethics out. That isn't all he's doing (loafing during study).


        Now he is on one RD (PTS) and we find another needed. So  we  can't
        switch RDs. So we add it to  Pgm  right  after  what  we're  doing.
        Standard Op Procedure.


        So redo this Pgm (it's messy anyway).


        Put in 3 May 72 PL by the auditor (has  2  Lists  L&N  in  it)  and
        handle. We should have done 3 May 72 PL before the PTS RD.


        Your C/S is okay."

The auditor continues the clearing of words to do with PTS  Check  and  then
completes the PTS Check.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 21.5.72-

        All it took was clearing the materials-so he knew  what  was  going
        on. Then went very well. He began to make a sort of  a  list  so  I
        will be alert for out-lists.


        He is not ready for PTS RD. I doubt if I could clear all the  words
        on the L-3B and R3R in 25-50 hrs. So that's why Prim RD.


        Then I'll get him moving on Exp Dn.

        1.       Clear all words and do HCO PL 3 May 72. L&N the two lists.


        2.       Havingness.

AUDITOR'S NEW PROGRAM 21.5.72-

        Is PTS. Needs PTS RD but not set up. Still big problem with words.


        Is Out-Ethics most of the time.

        1.       3 May 72 PL. L&N two lists.


        2.       Method 1 verified or completed-add: TRs, auditing, galley.


        3.       Tech Div Primary RD.


        4.       Pgm on Exp Dns (including PTS RD as soon as set up).

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done.


        Yes (to C/S and Pgm)."

The auditor has trouble with high TA and spends  several  sessions  clearing
the list and getting it assessed and F/Ning. The pc is by this time  on  the
Primary RD and the auditor spends time each session clearing up M/Us.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT 2.6.72-

        May I have OK for him not to do Prim RD part-time. I end  up  using
        session time cleaning up his M/Us.

        1.       Fly all ruds.


        2.       Clear L-4B words.


        3.       3 May PL.


        4.       Hav.

        Then to Dept 13 for M1. He has been  on  lines  too  long  with  no
        product in sight, until words straightened out.

LRH COMMENT 2.6.72-
        "Very well done.


        Finish up 3 May 72 quickly. Then we can tell.


        Off Primary RD until 3 May done and M 1 done.


        OK. (By auditor's note re Dept 13.)"

The next three sessions the auditor spends clearing words on L-4B and up  to
Step 2 of the 3 May PL.

The next session the pc is found to be unsessionable.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 6.6.72-

        Gee-it took me 11 mins to find him unsessionable.


        He slept 6, layed around 3 and was tired!


        I told him 8 hrs tomorrow and sessionable or else.


        I am tired of this, he causes me too much Dev-T.


        "R-Factor: We are getting your Ethics in as you are  in  Danger  of
        offload," added by LRH.

        1.       Fly all ruds.


        2.       Complete 3 May PL.


        3.       Hav.

LRH COMMENT-

        "OK. See addition."

The auditor finishes the 3 May.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT 7.6.72-

        3 May PL done.


        I want him to get PRD before I do Exp Dns. He is not sick. Words is
        his main scene.

        1.       D of P Int. Inform pc before he gets Exp Dns  he  must  do
             Prim RD. That he will be going to Dept 13 first for WCing. When
             he has finished Prim RD he can have Exp Dns.


        2.       To Dept 13. M1 verified or completed.

To date the pc has not resumed his Exp Dn program. No after-intensive  graph
was given. The above case history shows what may be necessary to  get  a  pc
ready for Exp Dn.

TOTAL NO. OF SESSIONS: 33.

TOTAL HOURS IN THE CHAIR: 85 hrs 17 min.

                                  Compiled by:
                                  Flag Dn Spec Team
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:WS:MM:ntm.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               25 OCTOBER 1972
Remimeo
Ex Dn C/Ses Issued 28 March 1974
Ex Dn Auditors

                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 25 OCTOBER 1972


                        Expanded Dianetics Series 16
                           (Series Number Amended)


                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE J

OCA GRAPH-


                                    [pic]


CASE NOTES AND EXPANDED DIANETIC PROGRAM BY EXP DN SPEC-

        She's OT IIIX and still easily overwhelmed. She's had  very  little
        Dianetics run. Needs her Ev Purps run out R3R Triple. Falsely  high
        OCA. Reported still misemotional on work and study.

        0. Clear all words in L3ExD & R3R.
        1.       C/S 1.
        2.       Run all Ev Purps in L10 R3R Triple.
        3.       2wc PT Environment, note all BD items.
        4.       Take up BD items in 3  and  get  intentions  and  emotions
             connected- R3R Triple.
        4a.      Run the Goals Processing out-R3R Triple narrative.
        4b.      Handle intentions connected.
        5.       Assess C/S 6 get intentions connected-R3R Triple to F/Ning
             list.
        6.       Emotional Stress White Form-handle  emotional  stress  R3R
             Triple.
        7.       Clear and assess LX3-handle R3R Triple.
        8.       Clear and assess LX2-handle R3R Triple.
        9.       Clear and assess LX1-handle R3R Triple.

PROGRAM STARTED 28.4.72-

        Pc finishes her C/S 1 and the L10 Evil  Purposes  are  checked  and
        turn out "no interest" and PT Environment is started.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT 29.4.72-

She told me a couple of times how she didn't like  running  Dns  because  it
was "slow"-but she sure blew a lot of grief charge on what we ran today.
LRH COMMENT-

        "VERY WELL DONE.


        She is dispersed so has to work fast and frantically."


        PT Environment is completed. Pc has been continually mentioning  25
        hrs of Goals Processing she received. 4a is added to  the  program.
        Next session auditor completes the rest of the program, most of  it
        turns out "no interest".

AUDITOR'S C/S AND COMMENT 30.4.72-

        We ran out her Goals Processing but it's not handled yet. She  says
        she can handle anything but that area and she tends to not-is it in
        and out of session. She also got bored  in  session-I  checked  ARC
        Brks (didn't check PTP &  MWH).  Turned  out  later  to  be  a  MWH
        concerning the fact that the area had not gone yet.

        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       Havingness.
        3.        Get  what  intention  would  make  one  hold  onto  Goals
             Processing.
        4.       Run best reading item R3R Triple.
        5.       Recheck interest on White Form and LX lists.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S-

        "WELL DONE.


        (C/S would get her messed up as it's an outlist situation really an
        engram but she has attention on it.)

        0.       L4B Method 5. 'On your goals list.'
        00.      Handle.


        Do your C/S.


        She is rather critical. More withholds than that, I think. Also get
        in the who what did he do steps of M W/Hs when you meet a MW/H."

Upper class auditor does list correction. L4B of above C/S only.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT-

        Seems like she might have blown the thing  on  her  goals  list  at
        last.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 2.5.72-

        "Thank you, Very Well Done.


        Back to ______ for Exp Dn.


        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       (6 of Pgm) Emotional Stress White Form.
        3.       Handle emotional stresses R3R Triple.
        4.       Havingness."

Auditor does the above C/S and continues with LX's.

AUDITOR'S C/S AND COMMENTS-

I don't know about this one. She's making gains-they are quite apparent  but
she just gets bored stiff and  dopey  during  Dianetics.  "It's  too  slow."
There's something holding her viewpoint of Dianetics in place. So:

        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2. L3EX DN Rundown to F/Ning list.
        3.       If all OK continue LX1.
        4.       Havingness.
LRH COMMENT AND C/S AND PROGRAM 4.5.72-

        "Well done.


        We've strayed off the rails here. Tired, dopey = stuck in something
        or failed purpose.


        I see we've not run her L10 Ev Purps.


        0.       Touch Assist.
        1.       2wc What do you want handled? Note BD F/N items.
        2.       Hav.

        See Pgm.

        PROGRAM


        Not really responding. Like to feel tired and dopey.  Probably  out
        ethics.
        Plenty touch assists and havingness:


        1.       LRH C/S of 4 May 72 What do you want handled?
        2.       Intentions connected to it L&N. R3R Triple.
        3.       Want handled? Intentions R3R Triple.
        4.       Want handled? Intentions R3R Triple.
        5.       L 10 Ev Purps Interest or no interest.

        Pgm then as needed.

        C/S 53RRR if another BER. Then May 3, 72 P/L."

Auditor does above LRH C/S. Pc doesn't want anything handled,  but  mentions
quite a few different things (see next LRH Pgm).

LRH COMMENT, C/S AND PROGRAM 5.5.72-

        "Well done.


        She says she objects to slow  auditing  indirectly  by  saying  she
        likes it fast.


        There are  things to be handled. SHE IS NOT IN SESSION.

        1.       2wc Who would I have to be to audit you.
        2.       What are you willing to talk to me about.
        2a.      GF Method 5 Handle.
        3.       Method 4 on 'Early words in auditing'. Clean each to F/N.
        4.       Havingness.

        PROGRAM


        Doesn't like auditing.


        'Feeling  slightly  abnormal.'  'Space  not  totally   clean'   BD.
        'Auditing would be an overt' LFBD. 'Don't feel deserve auditing.'


        Lots of Havingness.


        A missing piece of Sanderson Rundown-get her in session!

        1.       LRH C/S 5 May 72 (to get in session and get GF & early Mis
             U's on auditing handled).
        2.       'Auditing as an overt' R3R Triple. Check 'Abnormal' for  a
             read R3R Triple.
        3.       Get intentions re Space L&N. R3R Triple on item.
        3a.      Huge black mass orbiting around head  Intention  on,  L&N.
             Added by LRH 6.5.72.
        4.       2wc on what she wants handled.
        5.       Handle with intention and R3R Triple."
Auditor did steps 1, 2, 2a of LRH  C/S.  Pc  mentions  black  mass  circling
round head. Pc has some tremendous wins on clearing  up  some  misunderstood
words. Auditor's C/S is to continue LRH C/S 5.5.72 and Pgm.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very Well Done.


        That's  better. The W/S's however adds a step  to  Pgm  that  black
        mass circling around is what she wanted handled. Should have been a
        suggest here. Bit of a puzzle how to fit it in.  But  as  it's  now
        come up we can tackle it directly.


        I added it to Pgm.


        Your C/S is OK.


        This is a classic Ex Dn session situation you've just handled."

Auditor does Method 4 on early  words  in  auditing.  The  pc  goes  to  the
Examiner and says, "It's like everything is back in place where it  belongs,
it's perfect." Dial F/N VGIs.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        She's a product. All the remaining stuff she  wanted  handled  blew
        entirely on clearing up these words.


        1.       Declare EXP DN PGM complete.
        2.       Finish PRD.

The pc attested to Exp Dn complete.

SUCCESS STORY 7.5.72

        My overall win was a complete free Scientology and Dianetics  track
        which goes back 11 years.


        It's like starting all over again with a  lot  of  know-how.  Many,
        many other wins too. I used to do things thru a screen of  somatics
        and attitudes galore.


        All gone.


        Understanding restored and much much more.


        A 100 thanks to_______(auditor) and the Commodore.

FINAL OCA-

        Pc did not take a new OCA at this time.


        Note. This is an error as an OCA  must  be  taken  prior  to  a  pc
        attesting Exp Dn.

TOTAL NO. OF SESSIONS: 11.

TOTAL NO. OF HOURS IN THE CHAIR: 19 hrs 25 min.


      Compiled by:

      Flag Dn Spec Team
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:JH:WS:MM:ntm.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               29 OCTOBER 1972
Remimeo
Ex Dn C/Ses Issued 28 March 1974
Ex Dn Auditors
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 29 OCTOBER 1972



                        Expanded Dianetics Series 17
                           (Series Number Amended)



                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE K

OCA GRAPH-

                                    [pic]

Heavily down on  the  right.  (This  graph  done  in  Swedish,  pc's  native
language.)

CASE NOTES-

        Pc Grade 4 quickie. Past bad Dn auditing. Failed attempts  to  "get
        him to go whole track". Probably due to misunderstood words.


        Record of longterm illness, and  some  violence  dramatizations  on
        board. Last ill 27 Mar 72.

EXP DN SET-UP PGM BY DN SPEC 16.4.72-

        He has outstanding unhandled and ignored Int Corr  Items  and  HiLo
        Items. But he has heavy  MisUs.


        Also no-auditing situation since 4.1.72 (except Product RD).


        1.       CLEAR ALL WORDS: Ruds, WCCL, and assess WCCL and handle.
        *2.       Clear and assess WC 1 C/S 1 and M 1 list and handle to F/N
             list.
        3.       IF  TA difficulty comes up clear  C/S  53RRR  and  handle.
             Otherwise continue.
_________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  By HCO B  30  June  71,  Issue  II,  Word  Clearing  Series  8RB
             (Revised 11 May 72) the list words  of  M  1  are  not  cleared
             before assessment. The words of the commands (WC 1 C/S 1 ) of M
             1 may be cleared.
        3a.      PTS Check (added later).
        4.       To Exp Dn Program.

EXP DN PROGRAM BY DN SPEC 16.4.72-

        0.       Havingness-throughout, before and after session. 0a. Clear
             words: R3R, L-3XD.
        1.       Assess PT Environ buttons, get E, A  or  S  on  them.  R3R
             Triple exhaust lists.
        2.        Assess  C/S-6  (VIII  list)-add:  Past  Lives,  Commands,
             Chains, "Product RD", etc. Get Sen, Emotions or Attitudes,  R3R
             Triple, exhaust lists.
        3.       "Emotional Stresses" WF. (Get any treatments, if "Attitude
             to treatment" reads, and get AES on them [i.e. the treatments].
             Likewise "attitudes to illness".)
        4.        Based  on  WF  bleed  it  of  all  emotional   charge-all
             emotions/attitudes on reading areas or Narrative as applicable.
        5.       Then new OCA  to  check  the  left  side  and  program  as
             indicated.

PROGRAM STARTED 17.4.72-

        The word clearing goes OK when a simple dictionary is used. On  the
        WCCL pc starts to have problems about his post.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 20.4.72-

Has a problem getting free to be  audited-caught  between  product  pressure
and watch duty. Handled PTP in mid session again.

Assessment of WCCL mainly over still needle, not F/Ning, not reading.  Exams
was OK. May have been my TR 1 but I thought that was OK.

        0.       Hav to F/N.
        1.       Fly all ruds.
        2.       Reassess WCCL and handle to F/Ning list.
        3.       Clear and handle W/C C/S 1 (M 1 ) to F/Ning list.

LRH. COMMENT-

        "Study this case. Something wrong.


        PTS? Problem?


        You can do C/S but resolve the odd behaviour."

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S NEXT SESSION 21.4.72-

        After a lot of work on ruds and several assessments of WCCL it came
        down to a clean list again.


        Pc  has  continuous  attention  on  senior  (_____)  LF  and  QM  (
        ______)sF.


        Page 4, col 1 and 2, restraining himself. TA sinks, partly  due  to
        sweaty hands.


        Also is very heavy on "don't know so better not say  anything"  and
        "if you can't prove it, keep your mouth shut". (0.5 BD)


        He also has earlier connections to newspapers and a mental hospital
        where he worked as a nurse's aide.



        Has had  "insulin  treatment"  but  not  specified  if  simply  for
        diabetes or for shock purposes.

He should have a thorough PTS Check immediately  after  M1  Verification  is
completed.

As he has some protest on doing the WCCL assessment so  many  times  and  as
the last reads handled were all false or "nothing" reads we may be  cleaning
cleans on him.

        0.       Hav to F/N.
        0a.      2wc Attention on? to F/N.
        1.       Find out what he does during an  assessment  with  2wc  to
             F/N. la. Put in Suppress and Inval "On the list  we  have  been
             assessing".
        2.       Complete C/S of 20.4.72.

        Add PTS Check to program after M 1 Verification at 3a.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 22.4.72-

        "Very well done.


        Now we're getting somewhere.


        Major points:

        1.       He is psychotic by OCA.
        2.       He is not in session.
        3.       His background is at mixed practices (one of  7  Resistive
        Cases).

So reprogram needed.

        1.       Who would I have to be to audit you? 2wc to F/N.
        2.       What wouldn't you mind talking to me about?
        3.       Define Suppressive Person. Mark any BDs.
        4.       Have you ever known a Suppressive Person? (Mark BD or  F/N
             Items.)
        5.       Define a Suppressive thing, get examples, mark any BDs.
        6.       Have you ever known a Suppressive thing? (Mark BD  or  F/N
             Items.)
        7.       Send to D of P for handling as indicated."

LRH PROGRAM 22.4.72-

        "Not in sess. Low left OCA. Former Nurse's  aide  in  mental  home.
        Insulin treatment. Not a good case gain. In Ethics  trouble  often.
        Foreign language. Lots of Hav.

        1.       Who'd have to be to audit-What cd you say.
        2.       2wc Define suppressive person or thing with examples until
             he understands it.
        3.       2wc (mark BD or F/N Items). Have you known  a  suppressive
             person.
        4.       2wc Have you known a suppressive thing.
        5.        D  of  P  PTS  Check  metered  and  handle.  (He  may  be
             suppressive.)
        6.       Sanderson RD.
        7.       Intentions of past areas. Scout int and run."

The auditor does the above C/S and gets good LFBD items. Also an  R/S  turns
on periodically through the session.

AUDITOR'S C/S AND COMMENTS 22.4.72-

Wow. We got him where he lived.

Best items are:
        1.       The Head Nurse at the clinic (who ordered the ECTs).
        2.       A commie writer.
        3.       The ECT machine (not pc's wording here).
        4.       (________Org terminal.)

        He had no more answers but not an F/N on the "Have you ever  known"
        Qs.

        1.       D of P Check for anything  in  PT  Environment,  or  other
             answers on PTS Check. Light touch as he has answered the Q.
        2.       PTS handling (D of P).
        3.       Clear R3R and L-3ExDn words.
        4.       Sanderson RD.

        Doesn't seem to be SP himself-he has thought of it.  Long  itsa  on
        "artistic ambitions" as a writer at end of session.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done.


        You're getting him where he lives now."


        The pc has his D of P Interview but no other SP is  found.  The  pc
        disconnects from three of the SPs found in the session  except  the
        Org terminal which is left. In the interview  the  pc  talks  about
        chronic PTP he has had for almost two  years  about  his  attention
        stuck on going to see his parents that  he  hasn't  seen  for  five
        years. The auditor takes him into session but he continues to  talk
        about this problem with the TA rising, to 4.4. The auditor ends off
        and the pc goes to the Examiner and F/Ns at 3.0. The auditor  C/Ses
        for a C/S 53RRR.

LRH COMMENT 23.4.72-

        "Well done by exams.


        C/S OK. But something is really out. The C/S 53RRR will find if you
        ask what the reads are before acting."

The auditor takes the pc in and clears  and  assesses  the  C/S  53RRR.  W/H
LFBDs, and the auditor begins to handle.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 24.4.72-

        Well we got  another  big   chunk.  He  had  been  sitting  on  the
        discreditable W/H of having been  in   the  hospital  (as  well  as
        working  in it) for a rest cure following  nervous  collapse  as  a
        student! In terror that the SP head nurse would slip  something  in
        his food. And since then afraid of what SO would think.


        Apparently received only light insulin treatment, not as shock type
        dosage.


        I spent some time  looking  for  an  overt  of  commission  in  the
        hospital but the read finally cleared to F/N VGIs on "false".


        This is material for R3R of first order.

        1.       Continue C/S 53RRR to F/Ning list.
        2.       Clear all wds R3R and L-3ExDn.
        3.       Then to Sanderson RD.

LRH COMMENT-
        " Very  well done. C/S OK."

The auditor continues the C/S 53RRR again pulling W/Hs.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 25.4.72-

        Wow. 2 more W/Hs on the mental hospital.

        1.       Forced to go into agreement with psychiatrist on threat of
             being interned if he spoke out.
        2.       Fear of expulsion for being connected with psychiatrist.
        3.       3rd flow engrams of torture by ECT (for political reasons)
             of a girl.

        These all drove TA up and were pulled to F/N VGIs.

        Still needs to complete C/S 53RRR.

        1.       Hav to F/N.
        2.       Assess and handle C/S 53RRR to F/N list.
        3.       Clear R3R and L-3ExDn terms.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done.


        Wild scene! You handled it well. He looks good."


        The C/S 53RRR is continued for several sessions until it  F/Ns  all
        the way through the list.  Next  session  the  auditor  starts  the
        Sanderson RD. The pc says he wants "masturbation" handled.  The  TA
        goes high so auditor handles with a C/S 53RRR.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 2.5.72-

        Ran into another high TA so did C/S 53RRR to F/N list and then  did
        C/S (not complete).


        1.       Each rud to F/N.
        2.       Hav to F/N.
        3.       List intentions connected with masturbation.
        4.       R3R Triple to F/N list.
        5.       Repeat 3 and 4 on "get clear".

        Note: This C/S varies from Sanderson RD by omitting L&N  and  using
        Dianetic listing instead. This is because L&N is out of  class  for
        me as yet. Should handle it but the long way.

LRH COMMENT 3.5.72-

        "Well done. C/S very not correct."


        LRH rings No. 4 of the auditor's C/S and puts "makes no sense".

LRH NOTES AND C/S 3.5.72-

        "Well done.


        C/S alter-ised from Sanderson RD. You would have listed anyway  and
        gotten a wrong item.


        You just flew his ruds. He had one R/S. The  Ev  Purp  lives  under
        that R/S.
             1.   2wc to F/N.
        2.       Hav.
        3.       L&N What Intention is connected with masturbation.  To  BD
             F/N Item.
        4.       R3R Triple.
        5.       Hav.


        Next session again repeat:

            2wc want handled
            L&N Intention
            R3R
            Hav

        You better just learn to L&N before this session time. HGC auditors
        are supposed to audit anything.


        Don't get a wrong item."


        The auditor begins the LRH C/S.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 3.5.72-

L&N went fine. Started R3R by grabbing a narrative of the  subject   instead
of the intention.

On TR 3ing the F- 1 (command 1 ) he took a look and blew himself out of  his
head-a sudden and very amazed looking pc.

        0.       If any TA trouble do Int Corr List and handle (clear words
             first).
        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       Hav to F/N.
        3.       F-2, F-3 and check F-1 or R3R from last session.
        4.       2wc "want handled". (Mark BD Items.)
        5. L&N "Intention connected with_______".
        6.       R3R Triple.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Well done.


        Control it better on a C/S.


        Results are fine.''


        The next morning the pc comes to the Examiner and says, "I  have  a
        pain in my neck and I want to get an assist-terrific pain, I  could
        hardly get up this morning." 3.3 clean BIs. The  auditor  took  him
        back in to repair the list, and spends 4 hours trying to  clean  it
        up. At the end of the day the pc Red tags.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 5.5.72-

        Took him in after he BER'd on orig to Exams following list and Ext.


        C/S 53RRR and L-4B and corrected the list successfully. Then  after
        dinner TA back up again and not certain of item. L4B and C/S  53RRR
        and list corr done and list extended and nulled. TA remained high.


        His back was giving him considerable pain towards end  of  session.
        As I wasn't getting the list handled and it was  getting  to  be  a
        heavy PTP I ended off and sent him to MO for  a  touch  assist  and
        attention to the knotted muscle.
        He now has Red tabbed at Exams  and  his  list,  physical  PTP  and
        possible Int gone out.

        0.       Med attention to muscle until no longer a problem.
        1.       Assess C/S 53RRR, handle per reads. Handle to F/N list.

 LRH COMMENT-

        "Why'd you keep fooling with it after it F/Ned. Repair it."


        The next session the auditor repairs the list to VGIs and continues
        the Sanderson RD. Two sessions later the auditor again  in  trouble
        with the TA soaring.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Out of the pc's gradient. No R level where the L&N would hit so  it
        didn't read and TA climbed.


        Overcharged as he puts his TA up in a  few  seconds  with  a  weird
        thought like "session should be truthful" and sits  on  it  for  an
        hour.


        So he's overcharged, can't spot bank and stuck down the track  this
        lifetime.


        He has had CCHs I-IV and Op Pro by Dup (to F/N VGIs).  But  we  can
        undercut this case with:

      1.    Tone 40 locational CCH 6.
      2.    CCH 7 (8c) "Keep it from going away".
      3.    CCH 8 "Hold it still".
      4.    CCH 9 "Make it a little more solid".
        5. Control TRIO (Notice that____and get  the  idea  of  having  it,
                 permitting it to continue, making it disappear.)

        This is a program change to get him out of his  stuck  bank  points
        (Swedish Army, hospital, etc)  and  under  control  as  he  is  not
        cutting it and I am over-restimulating him too easily with too many
        hours to just get the TA down.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 9 May 72-

        "Well done.


        You're going off Exp Dn. This pc is w/hing heavily for fear he will
        damage something or do something evil. See Psychosis HCO B. That is
        why TA soars on a thought.


        He's just messed up by Evil Intentions not handled.


        His session pgming is a bit ragged. He's a  TA  battle  because  he
        isn't leveling with you.


        Note that Sanderson RD is not complete. You would be breaking  into
        an existing action.


        You are getting desperate because the pc is in a  desperate  state.
        That's the time to go easy, not make a huge change.


        This pc is already too long on our lines without a completion.


        If he's not telling you his thoughts he's not in session. You don't
        have his confidence.

             1.   2wc What are you afraid you might tell me?  to  F/N.  Note
             the BD and F/N items for future reference.
        1a.      Hav.
        *2.       Verify intention found and R3R Triple.
        3.       2wc What have you always wanted handled?
        4.       Hav."

LRH PROGRAM 9.5.72-

        "Pc not really in session. Probably a PT Out-Ethics case. Middle of
        Sanderson RD. Beware of out lists. High TA needs to be nudged  with
        'What have you thought of you haven't told me'.

        1.       LRH C/S 9 May to get pc in session, and complete RD he  is
             started on.
        2.       Complete Sanderson RD.
        3.       What destructive thing might you do?
        4.       Intention behind that. R3R.
        5.       Repeat 3.
        6.       Repeat 4.

Reprogram. "

        The auditor does the C/S as far as verifying the pc's item. Pc says
        item that gave previous session is cool but gives the item  as  "To
        have something to do rather than eating carrots or picking my teeth
        or my nose," LFBD F/N.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        One of us is mad, I think.


        Beginning of session 2 div BD on masturbation.


        2wc BD 2 divs on wanting to get the show  on  the  road  (for  LRH)
        before time runs out.


        On verifying the list 1 div BD on being bored  and  the  matter  is
        handled and feels free about it.


        Then he comes up with a 0.5 BD  and  F/N  Item  which  sounds  like
        Alice's Bad Dream.


        I ended off because I wasn't prepared  to  run  the  item  R3R.  My
        impression of this item was covert blow. As far as I can see it has
        to be.

        1.       Reclear L-4B.
        2.        Assess  and   handle   L-4B   "intention   connected   to
        masturbation".
        3.       Complete last C/S (LRH of 9.5.72).

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 11.5.72-

        "Here is a new Pgm and auditor not following it again.  It  is  the
        correct Pgm.


        The auditor is critical of pc's item.

        1.       2wc to F/N.


_________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  This was the intention found in the  previous  session,  on  the
             Sanderson step.
             2.   R-Factor. If you think of something you can tell me.  When
             you don't tell me what you think it upsets the processing.
        3.       R3R on Item found.
        4.       Hav."

The auditor attempts the C/S unsuccessfully.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        Immediately after 2wc to F/N and R-Factor his TA soared.


        Came down on several areas but climbed again after each one.


        He maintains he is not aware of W/Hing anything yet he has  soaring
        TA on something. Not O/R or protest.


        I didn't go into the R3R chain due to the high TA.


        I believe there is some W/H he is not-ising so heavily  he  doesn't
        believe he has one. He F/Ned at Exams  after  high  TA  in  session
        which is odd. I am unsure how to get him off it so we  can  do  the
        RD.


        If it does not violate the program I would suggest  HiLo  TA  List.
        (Or some other assessment prepared.)

        1.       Clear HiLo words and assess and handle to F/N list.
        2.       R3R Triple (item from L&N done previously).
        3.       Hav.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 13.5.72-

        "Auditors who don't do LRH C/Ses have been known to get very wet.


        Looks like a simple case of false TA with pc  slackening  cans.  Do
        you watch a pc's hands? They sometimes slacken cans.


        If you keep nagging him he'll get desperate.

        1.       False TA HCO B with all additions. Let's see if you can do
             all the checks.
        1a.      Do HiLo if no joy in 1.
        2.       He wants masturbation handled. That's where  it  began  to
             hang up.

        L&N Who or what would masturbate? Item O/W.

            (Item O/W is:    What has item done
      What has item w/h alternate repetitive.)

        If  no  blow,  L&N  What  intention  would  (____item)  have.   R3R
        intention."

The next session the auditor has again high TA troubles.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        False TA checklist done. Put him on foot plates as there was almost
        a div of TA difference when  he  first  tried  them.  As  it  later
        climbed back up it was probably just his shoes being taken off.


        HiLo Assessed 3 times, last time to the  pc.  No   reads.  Per  his
        statements he was getting the commands.  As  if  he  is  below  the
        reality of W/Hing.
        States he has had  a  personality  change  recently  and  is  "more
        exterior to himself".


        This is the second time I have failed to complete a C/S. I did  not
        want to go into another action with the TA that high.  He  said  he
        was feeling great not tired. (His sleep  is  irregular  due  to  QM
        duties.)


        The pattern is usually the TA doesn't  start  to  climb  until  the
        first 20 minutes of the session or so. We should be able to  handle
        this way:

        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       Complete LRH C/S of 12.5.72.

        I don't know where I am erring  on  this  guy,  but  I'll  get  him
        through it.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 13.5.72-

        "Oh well. With this many session errors you won't make it.


        ANYBODY CAN AUDIT AN EASY PC. AN AUDITOR'S FLAWS SHOW UP  GLARINGLY
        ONLY ON ROUGH PCS.


        As a Dn Spec will be auditing a lot of  rough  pcs  he  has  to  be
        flawless in TRs, metering and tech.


        The errors are obvious enough.

        1.       You don't begin a major action or an assessment list until
             you get an F/N. This is called set up. One has to know  how  to
             talk a TA down to do a HiLo. This holds true unless Int is  out
             and that can be tested at once  by  simply  checking  Went  In?
             Exterior? at which you get a BD if it's what's  wrong  and  you
             just handle it. If it's not Int you check lists. If  not  lists
             you check w/hs.

        Actually I can't see how you'd get much of a read with  a  TA  that
        high. Nevertheless a C/S 53RRR works even with a high TA.

        2.       You tried to run an ARC Brk with a high  TA.  You  checked
             it. You NEVER touch ARC Brks on a High TA as  High  TA  is  not
             caused by ARC Brks. And ARC Brks WILL NOT get  a  TA  down  and
             seriously messes up a pc if you try it.


        3.       You are possibly assessing with a lilt-an upswing of  tone
             as in a question. Assessments are done as a statement  -a  down
             tone. [See footnote p. 229]


        4.       You have to have the pc's  attention.  He  has  to  be  in
             session, this means interested in own case and willing to  talk
             to the auditor.


        5.       To be in session a  pc  has  to  have  confidence  in  his
             auditor and an auditor with overts on the pc or doubts  or  who
             makes funny cracks about the pc's items SHOWS IT IN SESSION and
             there goes confidence. Because ARC is gone.


        6.       An auditor's tiny failures in TRs begin a grating  on  the
             pc. This throws a pc out of session.


        7.       The commonest cause of no item  on  an  assessed  list  of
             prepared items is meter reading failure. The  meter  is  placed
             wrongly so the auditor can't  see  it,  pc  and  paper  in  ONE
             glance. This is the usual reason for 'no items' on  a  prepared
             list. Eyesight can be a factor.
             8.   An auditor has to have IMPINGEMENT on a pc to assess.  The
             XIIs run into  this  all  the  time.  Internes  have  'done'  a
             GF40XRR. The pc gets to the XII. The XII reassesses and  has  a
             whole big parade of reads. The lower class auditor just  didn't
             impinge  (or missed the lot).

        There are NO pcs alive such as you  are  presenting  here  in  this
        folder. They do not exist.


        Whenever in the past, we have thought one did we checked it out and
        there was no such animal.


        There was an auditor whose TRs were poor, who  couldn't  or  didn't
        read a meter and who had overts on the pc.


        The pc in question each time responded easily to standard auditing.


        You keep not doing C/Ses  because  you  have  not  done  the  basic
        things.


        Anyone can run a Cadillac pc. It takes a  real  smooth  auditor  to
        handle a Vintage Model T Ford.


        These are not harsh words. I must not let you get the idea that you
        can goof and then blame the pc. You'll just go on losing  if  I  do
        let it slide.


        Did you really check ALL of the False TA  items  or  did  you  just
        shrug it off and grab footplates? And are you using  a  meter  that
        works or a busted one.

        D of P. What does the auditor do, really and truly.


        We'll check this. Then we'll use the murder routine  if  all  other
        points are verified."


The auditor is crammed. The pc has a D  of  P  Interview  and  three  points
arise. 1. Auditor's TR 2  is  out,  2.  Cleaning  Cleans  and  getting  into
protest, and 3. Pc now ready for deeper running.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 14.5.72-

        D of P Interview done.  The  loose  grip  was  spotted  in  the  TA
        checklist. I used the footplates because 0.8 div difference at  the
        time and pc happier with them.


        If D of P's opinion is correct my TR 2 has been short. So I'll pick
        it up, and be careful with the metering and TRs, and cans.


        I have gotten off all the overts I know of off on  this  and  other
        pcs. They include rough TRs and mis-metering.


        I believe we can get him moving along alright. Suggest:

        0.       2wc to F/N.
        1.       L&N Who or what would masturbate? Item O/W.


        If no blow L&N What intention would (______) have. R3R (per LRH C/S
        13.5.72).

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done. I'm truly pleased. There's real  hope  for  a  top
        level auditor in you if you take it this  well  and  handle.  Do  a
        smooth job now."
The auditor does the C/S to a good result. At  Examiner  the  pc  says,  "It
feels great. It feels damn great." (The item O/Wed was "me".)

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 15.5.72-

        Yahoo! Got 'em!


        Change of characteristic-spoke to the Examiner.


        Real Bk Through for me-audited like a well-oiled River! Should have
        taped it.

        0.       2wc to F/N.
        1.       2wc "What do you really want handled?"
        2.       L&N Triple and R3R Triple on reading areas.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 16.5.72-

        "Well hurrah! Very well done.


        The next C/S though to this is different.


        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       L&N What is the Intention of me? BD F/N Item.
        3.       R3R on Item Triple.

        This is to follow through the H Standard using actually  a  XII  RD
        and adapting it to Exp Dn."


        The next session the pc comes in with the TA at  3.1.  The  auditor
        two-way comms the pc to an F/N. Then when the above L&N is  checked
        the TA flies to 4.6 and there it sticks  even  though  the  auditor
        tried to talk it down again.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S-

        Hit the ditch.


        Not cans alone this time as I have checked  those  very  carefully.
        Also he BDs to F/N at Exams on the same sized cans.


        I am missing something on him which he has suppressed.


        A list of areas from this session producing TA is attached.


        D/N and R/S on "me" and on "despatch".


        I took care to see he knew I  had  gotten  what  he  said,  several
        times. He knew I had gotten what he said.


        TA BDed on "someone could take money from  bookstore"  and  started
        climbing when I asked him if he had. Said he never thought of doing
        it and he hadn't.


        Whatever it wasn't it was something I did, as the TA  was  actually
        high at 4.9 even when checking can grip.


        The fact that he BDs and F/Ns at Examiner means to me  that  he  is
        W/Hing or protesting something from me but not at Examiner.


        It could still be TR 2. Something  must be sitting there unacked.

        1.       D of P "In your last session what did the auditor do?"
             2.   D of P "In your last session were you protesting anything?
             Was anything unacknowledged?"
        3.       "Is there anything you haven't told?" (note read).

        Check cans first.

LRH COMMENTS AND C/S 17.5.72-

        "This is what C/Ses are for.


        Since your new skill acquired in Cramming you have not  run  a  C/S
        53.


        Also you challenged him with your 2wc Q. It isn't  a  2wc  Q.  What
        have you been up to is an invalidative auditing  Q.  How  have  you
        been or some social Q is 2wc to F/N.


        You are acting suspiciously. He feels it. He of course  has  overts
        all over the track. You are restimming them  by  being  suspicious.
        You are not running O/W but appear to be trying  to,  so  processes
        are mixing. You should be running standard Dn on him.

        Session probably started on an F/N (cold can). You gave it no  time
        to warm.

        1.       C/S Series 53RC.
        2.       Handle.
        3.       Continue Sanderson RD.


        And don't act like a detective! An auditor is a detective only when
        doing O/W on a pc that won't give."


        The auditor assesses the C/S 53RC and handles "don't like  it".  On
        the next assessment Int reads and so an Int Corr List is  assessed.
        This does not read but the pc is very happy.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        Do what Ron says!


        Pc ext, VVVGIs. The Int Corr List was clean but the area  was  what
        was hanging it up.


        He's had an "Int RD" in 1970 reported as "shallow didn't  bite"  by
        auditor.

        0.       2wc "How do you feel about going into things?" to F/N.
        1.       If all ok, L&N "Intention of 'me'."
        2.       R3R Triple Item.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done!"


        The auditor does the C/S. The L&N item is "to be at cause" and this
        is R3R Tripled.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        Doing fine. L&N went great-hot item.


        The R3R is rough and very shallow and he  tends  to  go  into  long
        situational descriptions on Step 7. Really needs a Dn C/S 1 on  the
        R3R steps with demos.
             0.   R-Factor "We're going to go over the steps of R3R."
        1.       Go over each step of R3R with "apples" having  the  pc  do
             demos of the chain and what happens.
        2.       Dummy run R3R with apples.
        2a.      Rud if no F/N.
        3.       2wc "What do you really want handled on your case?" (Clear
             words backwards and "serious question" R-Factor.)
        4.       L&N Triple Intention + R3R.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 21.5.72-

        "Well done by Exams.


        This Dianetic R3R is too rough. 1-9 A-B look strange.


        The C/S is invalidative of this pc and it still shows  to  the  pc.
        Long long yak is out TR 2 and defensive.

        1.       L-1C In your auditing with me has there been.
        2.       Havingness.

        Then another auditor as I am tired of writing repair Pgms  on  this
        pc."


        The next day the pc reports to the MO sick.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        BER and sick 48 hrs after L&N and R3R session.  (L-1C  C/S  21.5.72
        not done.)


        1.       L-4B.
        2.       If not all handled L3ExDn.
        3.       LRH C/S 21.5.72. (L-1C + Hav.)

        I am very willing to correct this myself. In view of your  note  on
        C/S of 21.5 is this OK?

LRH COMMENT-

        "OK."


        The auditor takes the pc in and  does  the  C/S  fully  to  a  good
        result.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

Pc doing fine now. Says illness came from stops on his bookstore  purchasing
lines.

Also had a big win on a recall going back to age 11/2 or 2 and a glimpse  of
a past life.

        1.       To another auditor.
        2.       Complete Sanderson  RD.  2wc  "What  do  you  really  want
             handled?" Triple L&N (each R3Red Triple).
        3.       Repeat 2 and 3.

LRH COMMENT 23.5.72-

        LRH crosses out step 1 of the C/S.


        "Very well done. Same auditor. Get this pc to a product!"


        The Sanderson RD is continued successfully for two  sessions  until
        pc feels nothing more to handle. The auditor at this  point  writes
        up the program.
EXP DN PGM BY DN SPEC 25.5.72-

Now doing well. Has had Sanderson RD. Happy with progress.

        "0.       3 May PL." Added by LRH 29.5.72.
        1.       "Destructive thing" RD-LRH Pgm of 9.5.72.
        2.       PTS Rundown + Interview. (Include SP Items found 22.4.72.)


        3.       OCA and program.

        He is not sick. Body in  good  shape  when  not  being  damaged  by
        accident.


        He should be phased over to Grade Chart for 0-III to be tripled  up
        and IV Triple to be run.

The pc hurt his foot so the auditor spent 2 sessions  running  the  accident
out.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        Came out ok. R3R Slow. "None on F-2."


        I need to be smoother and faster with this guy  so  he  feels  more
        certain.


        Ruds came up between flows-he had forged himself an OK to go ashore
        for dinner tonight. Very motivatorish about it all.

        1.       Fly each rud.
        2.       2wc  "Is  there  anything  you  want  handled  that  we've
             missed?"
        3.       If so L&N Intention and R3R Triple.
        4.       If no wants handled "What destructive thing might you do?"
             to BD F/N.
        5.       L&N "Intention behind that?"
        6.       R3R Triple.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 29.5.72-

        "Too long in auditing. Out-Ethics on the case won't let it run.

        1.       3 May 72 PL.
        2.       L&N Lists (Steps 3, 4).

        If Why finding been done on him before do it like  C/S  Series  78.
        When this is done he can go on. He's just about to  get  taken  off
        auditing lines so is Out-Ethics. Should have  been  a  Product  way
        back.

        Then your C/S the next day."

The 3 May PL was eventually done to a good result, but then the pc was  sent
to serve in an area of the world that to date has  not  got  Exp  Dianetics.
The Case as such remains incomplete. A second OCA was never  done  prior  to
leaving so there is no record of the change that was brought  about  by  the
auditing as outlined in this BTB.

TOTAL NO. OF SESSIONS: 33.

TOTAL NO. OF HRS IN THE CHAIR: 63 hrs 23 mins.


      Compiled by:
      Flag Dn Spec Team
BDCS:WS:MM:ntm.rd      for the
Copyright � 1972, 1974       BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               30 OCTOBER 1972
Ex Dn C/Ses
Ex Dn Auditors   Issued 28 March 1974

                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 30 OCTOBER 1972


                        Expanded Dianetics Series 18
                           (Series Number Amended)


                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE L



                                    [pic]

CASE NOTES-

        Pc Va. Chronic sickie-chronic  skin  trouble-constantly  in  Ethics
        trouble. 0.5 on Chart of Human Evaluation-thereabouts.  OCA  is  in
        the white on both left and the right.


        He's had quickie W/C M 1 and a quickie  Drug  Rundown.  Not  nearly
        enough Dianetics. Has an almost continual Low TA.

EXPANDED DIANETIC PROGRAM BY DN SPEC 2.4.72-

        1.  Hi-Lo to F/Ning list. (LRH added "Cleared".)
        2.       Complete Primary Rundown. (a) W/C M I-Word Clear W/C  M  1
             C/g 1 and WCCL first. (b)  Continue  with  steps  3  and  4  of
             Primary Rundown - complete Rundown.
        3.       Complete C/S 1.
        4.       W/C each word in R3R commands and each word in the L-3B.
        5.       Triple Assess: Post, action, missions, Ethics,  Comm  Evs,
             Conditions, Study, doctors, medication, sickness, 2-D. Run  the
             attitudes and emotions R3R Triple-cont to F/Ning list.
        6.       Assess Cl VIII list (auditors, auditing, etc) adding  Solo
             and Clearing. Assess attitudes and  emotions  on  best  reading
             item, list and do R3R Triple to F/Ning list.
        7.       Do a new W/F. (a) Take all emotional stresses, losses  and
             deaths R3R Triple Narrative. (b) If attitudes  to  illness  and
             treatment reading-run R3R Triple.
        8.       Clear and assess (in turn) LX3, LX2, LX1  and  handle  R3R
             Triple.
        9.       New OCA and reprogram accordingly.
The pc is under Comm Ev and so it is some time before he is sessionable.

AUDITOR'S C/S 18.5.72-

        Should be out of Ethics tomorrow. Time to start.


        1.       Clear all words on Hi-Lo.
        2.       Hi-Lo to F/N list.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 18.5.72-

        "There's an out of seq in the Pgm.


        The Prim RD and WC1 are out of seq here. He won't get them done and
        he
        hasn't started.


        This is a very bad OCA and a bad (low) TA. C/S 53RC is  better  now
        than
        Hi-Lo.

        1.       Clear all wds on Hi-Lo.
        2.       Hi-Lo to F/N list.
        3.       Hav.
        4.       Clear C/S 53RC.
        5.       C/S 53RC to F/N list.
        6.       Hav."

LRH PROGRAM 18.5.72-

"Bad OCA. Low TA. Blames seniors. Lots Hav and Tch Assist.

        1.       Hi-Lo to F/N list.
        2.       C/S 53RC to F/N list.
        3.       Clear WCCL and handle to F/N.
        (3a.      3 May 72 PL added by auditor 21.5.72 okayed by LRH.)
        4.       Complete C/S 1. Include every wd in R3R.
        5.       Draw Flows Quadruple.
        6.       Draw bank and Clear.
        7.       Assess PT Env List (see 2 Apr Pgm).
        8.       Class VIII List (see 2 Apr).
        9.       Clear all words Sanderson RD. Incl 'Handled'.
        10.      Sanderson RD. (Crossed out by LRH.)
       * 11.     PTS Int.
       * 12.     PTS RD.
       * 13.     D of P disconnect.
       * 14.     Can't Hav RD.
_________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  Correct order per HCO B 17 Apr 72, C/S Series 76, "C/Sing a  PTS
             Rundown" is:
            1. PTS Int            3. PTS RD
      2. Disconnect    4. Can't Have RD
        15.      Metalosis.
        16.      OCA and Interview."

PROGRAM BEGUN 19.5.72-

        Auditor spends the session clearing the words on the Hi-Lo,  ending
        off with Havingness.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 19.5.72-

        Went well.


        Apparently previous auditors had him wipe hands a lot, as at  first
        he'd do so about every 5 minutes. Then he relaxed and quit.

        TA went low but no real problem.

        1.       Hi-Lo to F/N list.
        2a.      Hav.
        2.       Clear C/S 53RC.
        3.       C/S 53RC to F/N list.
        4.       Hav.
        5.       Clear WCCL.
        6.       WCCL to F/N.
        7.       Hav.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done.


        Auditors whose TRs are out substitute a towel. (Joke)"


        The Hi-Lo and C/S 53RC are completed in the  next  three  sessions.
        The 3 May PL, C/S 1 and clearing steps of the Pgm are done.


The next session the C/S 6 list was clean so  auditor  goes  onto  Sanderson
RD. The TA flies up and the auditor handles somehow to F/N, using  C/S  53RC
and WCCL. Also pc tired so 2wc'ed "Failed Purpose".

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 30.5.72-

        "Well done on sess.


        Admin ghastly. Sending you to Cramming to get Admin straight  as  I
        can't really C/S it as don't have data from W/Sheets.

        1.       Clean up the rest of C/S 53RC. Get F/Ning list.
        2.       Finish WCCL Clearing.
        3.       Hav."

The auditor does the C/S 53RC to a good win for pc.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 30.5.72-

        Yesterday's session I 2wc'ed "Failed Purpose". It should be  L&Ned.
        He may have already given it. There is a lot of stuff there.  Sorry
        about last session went over last part again.
             1.   C/S 53RC F/N list.
        2.       Ind pc will L&N for Failed Purpose. Be alert he  may  have
             already
           given it.
        3.       L&N Int connected to it. R3R Triple.
        4.       Check "loneliness on post" for read and interest.
           (See this session W/S pg 4.) R3R Triple.
        5.       Get EAIs on "last (leader) removed yesterday"
           (pg 31, 29 May W/S). R3R Triple.
        6.       Get EAIs on "want it running now it hasn't been"
           (pg 27). R3R Triple.
        7.       "We need a leader" (pg 30) handle as in 5 and 6.
        8.       "Moving people all got changed except me" (pg 26).  Handle
             as above.
        9.       "Still have to repeat process"  (pg  29).  R3R  Triple  on
             EAIs.
        10.      "Wanted to go back to Ops" (pg 25) handle same.
        11.      "I just want it going" (pg 29) handle same.
        12.      "No leader, no team at all" (pg 29) handle same.
        13.      Check "so lonely" for read and int. R3R Triple.
        14.      Check "was sad" for read and int. R3R Triple.
        15.      Hav.

I did not do 2 of your C/S as I've cleared WCCL. I'm not sure what I did  in
admin that showed that.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 31.5.72-

        "Well done.


        You finished the temporary repair caused by an area upset.


        You're cleaning cleans with this  C/S.  The  situation  ended  with
        restoring (old boss) to Post. This wd be a Q&A C/S.


        DON'T VEER OFF PGMS. PGMS MEAN SOMETHING.

        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       Class VIII List RD.
        3.       Hav.

        To D of P for PTS Int."

AUDITOR'S NOTE TO COMMODORE 1.6.72-

        Pc unsessionable 2 days, due to missions.  He  has  been  good  abt
        informing Tech Services.


        I don't think he is trying to get out of session.


        I thought you should know this.


        He'll get session tomorrow.

LRH COMMENT-

        "OK. Maybe he hit an EP. He's doing great or was when  I  last  had
        contact."

The auditor continues with the Pgm. On step 10, PTS Interview, done  by  the
auditor in session, no PTS person is found. The auditor goes on to  the  PTS
RD, does 2 S&Ds and runs the items Triple R3R, Ruds and overts.  However  pc
goes to the Examiner and his TA had dropped to 1.6.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 2.6.72-

        Red Tab. I don't see a session error it went great.

        1.       2wc "Is there anything in your last session  you  did  not
             feel right about". Handle as needed.
        2.       Cont PTS RD.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 3.6.72-

        "Both items are inflow. Could be on same list.


        You had it 1st Item on list. Usually the case.


        There may be a  listing  error.  You  should  have  grabbed  pc  at
        Examiner. He's on a hot spot on post.

        1.       R-Factor: We have to correct the last session.
           Assess:
                 Out Ruds
                 Wrong List
                 Session Error
                 Post Upset
                 Wrong Item
                 An overt to put it on list
                 Auditor overwhelmed you
                 Item was missed
                 Another Item has yet to be found
           +Did both these Items belong on same list
                 (It is 3 S&Ds not 2 )
           +Probably it's the last one
        2.       Handle the above, L-1C if auditor, L4B if list.
        3.       C/S 53RC-Handle.
        4.       Hav."

The auditor does the C/S.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 4.6.72-

        Nothing was wrong. Maybe Examiner.


        He's doing great!

PTS RD DONE.

        1.       D of P Disconnect.
        2.       Can't Hav RD.
        3.       Hav.

LRH PROGRAM 4.6.72-

        "All right. We have him where he lives.


        He has mainly Org terminals as his SPs. So by flow study that makes
        him what? Accounts for earlier Aide failures.

        1.       Auditor's C/S 4 June 72 complete Can't Have RD.
        2.       3 May 72 PL. Preface in the last couple of years.
        3.       Find all Ev Purps ever run or found even if D/Led (L-10 L-
             10M
           W/Sheets etc). Note 2 Apr Pgm. Look at W/Sheets to  see  if  any
             gotten
           off.
        4.       R3R Triple on those that read.
        5.       L&N Triple for Ev Purps per L-10  list  actions  'Multiple
             Flow' if not
           done.
        5a.      Pc not had it so do L-10 Multiple (added  after  the  next
             session).
        6.       R3R Triple on 5a. (We MUST get this  guy  straight.  Could
             cost us a
           million if we flub it as he is handling Orgs!)
        7.       PTS Corr List. Any additional terms + Can't Have.
        8.       Metalosis.
        9.       OCA & Int."

The auditor does the C/S and the 2 L&N lists of 3 May PL. The pc is  F/N  at
the end of session  but  TA  1.5  at  Examiner.  Auditor  has  re-exam  with
different Examiner and pc says, "The session was fantastic  and  thought  it
was great. Handled s'thing that's been bugging me for years."  TA  2.3  Wide
F/N.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 4.6.72-

        He loved the C/S, 3 May PL especially.

        I don't know what the scene is with (_______Examiner).  Every  time
        pc has been red-tab (_______) was Examiner.


        I checked, nothing wrong, sent him  for  new  exam  with  different
        Examiner.

        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       Continue with LRH Pgm 4 June 72.
        3.       Hav.

        Note: He's never had L-10 of any sort. I found Ev Purp  on  an  Int
        Corr List. He is Va.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 5.6.72-

        "C/S not correct. Pc never had  L-l  0  Multiple  or  Single.  (LRH
        alters Pgm and adds step 5a to it.)


        Not well done because of admin. I can't read the W/Ses. The auditor
        does not put down what the pc was talking about. So I can't work it
        out to C/S it.


        I can't make this session out at all. Can't see  what  the  pc  was
        saying. Doesn't make any sense at all.


        Clarifying words is not the problem here. What incident did the  pc
        run? What was it all about? That's what a C/S has to know.  The  pc
        cd be jumping chains, anything, as there's no data.

        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       R3R Trip on the PL 3 May 2 Items.
        3.       Do Multiple Flow Evil Purposes from L-10 Sheet.
        4.       R3R each.
        5.       Hav."

The C/S was done and the Pgm continued over many sessions.  At  the  end  of
the Metalosis RD the pc attests and is sent for a new OCA.

PC'S SUCCESS STORY-

        For about the past 6-8 months I've had one kind of pain or  another
        in my guts-something so bad I couldn't sit still for  more  than  a
        few minutes.


        But now after the RD it's gone-completely! like magic.


        It's a big difference not to be in pain and this is a real win.

OCA GRAPH-

                                    [pic]


The graph is much improved but still down on the right. The pc is  currently
having more Exp Dn to handle this.

TOTAL NO. OF SESSIONS: 24.

TOTAL NO. OF HOURS IN THE CHAIR: 39 hrs 43 mins.


                                  Compiled by:
                                  Flag Dn Spec Team
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:WS:MM:ntm.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               1 NOVEMBER 1972
                            Issued 28 March 1974

Remimeo     CANCELS
Ex Dn C/S   HCO BULLETIN OF 1 NOVEMBER 1972


                        Expanded Dianetics Series 19
                           (Series Number Amended)


                          EXPANDED DIANETIC CASE M



                                    [pic]



 CASE NOTES-

            This  case  OT  VII,  L-9S,  L-10M,  is  recalled  to  Flag  for
auditing.

LRH TIP 3 APR 72 (TECHNICAL INDIVIDUAL PROGRAM)-

            "Assignment: On bd for rapid briefing actions and to  return  as
C/O.

        Study:   Primary RD.


               *The Product Pgm and C/S in (______other pc's) folder which I
               will C/S.


                Promotion Clearing (org is engaged in expensive  lists  and
               promo very poor for cost).

        Auditing: As above."

PROGRAM BY CL XII C/S 4.4.72-

        Primary RD.


        1.       False TA List. C/S 53. WCCL.
        2.       Method One, Verify/Complete.
        3.       Product Pgm C/Sed by LRH per TIP.
________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  This Product Pgm is an Experimental Pgm which in fact never  was
             run on this pc.  It  remains  experimental  and  has  not  been
             released.
The above program is done as far as  completing  Method  One  which  the  pc
attests. Later LRH sends a note to the Tech Sec.

LRH NOTE 22.4.72-

        "Pc is to be run on Exp Dn after Study RD. (Also R3R on  goals,  etc
        from L10 will make him sane.)"

EVAL BY EXP DN AUDITOR 23.4.72-

        SITUATION


        1.       Has just had M 1 verified + C/S 53RRR and handled.
        2.       He is programmed for Exp Dn after Product RD Exp.
        3.       There is an outstanding order from you that he do  Exp  Dn
             after Study RD.

        DATA


        Not audited since 13.4.72 (10 days). Audited without FES.


        Now lined up and waiting for  Experimental  Product  RD  (postulate
        level processing) which should be handled after Exp Dn per Tape Exp
        Dn 1.


        HANDLING


        1.       That his program be revised to the  two  programs  I  have
             written for the case.
        2.       That I do the Study RD assess and handle (any L&N would be
             done by Exp Dn Team Lead Auditor)  and  the  remaining  program
             steps.
        3.       That steps 1 and 2 of the set-up  be  done  while  FES  is
             being drawn up to prevent delay as they are both necessary  and
             as C/S 53RRR has just been handled.

EXP DN SET-UP PGM BY EXP DN SPEC 23.4.72-

        Has had M 1 verified and C/S 53RRR recently handled.


        To prepare for Exp Dn:


        1.       Study Corr List assess and handle.
        2.       Clear all words L-3ExDn and R3R.
        3.       To ExpDn.

EXP DN PGM BY DN SPEC 23.4.72-

        0.       Find Hav-run before and after each session.
        1.       2wc your PT Environment. Note all BD and  F/N  items.  Get
             attitudes, emotions R3R Triple.
        2.       Assess auditing  buttons  (VIII  list  C/S  6)  attitudes,
             emotions R3R Triple.
        3.       LX3, 2, 1 + R3R Triple.
        4.       Items from L-10 R3R Triple.
        5.       OCA.

LRH COMMENT-

"OK."

The auditor assesses the Study Corr List and on the question IQ.  "Have  you
ever cheated on an exam?" the question gets an  LF  and  on  the  assessment
from that point the TA rises to 4.4. The  auditor  checked  O/R  and  got  a
response so rehabbed an earlier study release.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        Cleared Study Corr List and handled ARC Bk.


        Ran into soaring TA on assessment, small reads.



             Rehabbed the O/R and did Hav to F/N.


        Now needs to have the Study Corr List assessed over in-ruds.


        1.       All ruds to F/N.
        2.       R-Factor  on  reassessing  Study  Corr  List-reassess  and
             handle.
        3.       Clear any words on R3R + L3ExDn.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 26.4.72-

        "Well done.


        He hit a w/h and it made the TA soar (by list study)."


        (LRH writes on the List against question IQ "Overt withhold  caused
        TA to Soar.")

        "DON'T BEGIN A MAJOR ACTION WITHOUT GETTING FIRST AN F/N.

        1.       2wc to F/N.
        2.       R-Factor on question IQ, there was a  question  'Have  you
             ever cheated on an exam?' (Watch for read.) 2wc to F/N.
        3.       Fly all ruds. But if no F/N on 2 above assess a C/S 53RRR,
             and return to me.
        4.       R-Factor: We have to get an F/Ning List on study. Reassess
             whole list.
        5.       Handle."

The next two sessions the auditor handles the Study Corr List.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 27.4.72-

        Finished all handling of Study Corr List except 2 L&Ns (to be  done
        by Lead Auditor) and 2 hours TR 0 on "Gothic Books". ( 11 B  "Can't
        you confront books or printed pages?"  What,  TR  0  on  it  for  2
        hours.)

        Went fine.

        1.       Rud if no F/N.
        2.       Handle 8-J and 8-E (two L&Ns).
        3.       2 hours TR 0 on "Gothic Books".
        4.       Attest Study Corr List complete.
        5.       Clear all L-3ExDn words.
        6.       Exp Dn Pgm.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done."


        LRH had crossed out 4 above and written:


        "Reassess SCL to F/Ning List.


        Attest only if it F/Ns. If any reads, handle and reassess."

The SCL is handled to F/N list and the pc attests. The words are cleared  on
R3R and the L-3ExDn and the Exp Dn Pgm is started.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 2.5.72-

        Doing well. Two points:

        1.       Possible error was I did "Emotions" connected to one area,
             R3R to F/N list, then took up next area to F/N list on Emotions
             without checking for any remaining attitudes in first area.


        2.       He is somewhat out of  session  but  is  very  willing  to
             "supply" VGIs- They're there but feels   like  he  is  thinking
             about what to say to please auditor. Very co-operative. It's an
             unchanging characteristic. Probably
             just needs good continued auditing where he is at.  Example  is
             when listing emotions connected to (____wife's name) he had  to
             work on it.

        So it will come out in the wash as long  as  we  keep  getting  him
        where he lives

        0.       Fly each rud.
        1.        Check  Hav  for  effect  with  can  squeeze.  Change   if
             necessary.
        2.       Check for attitudes on first two  areas  handled  ("People
             who don't produce" and "______" wife's name). List and take  to
             F/N list.
        3.       Handle all remaining PT Environment buttons-list + R3R  to
             F/N list.
        4.       Assess C/S 6, attitudes, emotions R3R Triple.
        5.       Continue program.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 3.5.72-

        "D of P Int. What did Auditor do. How do you feel about your case.


        To make up for your 'no okay to L&N' you are avoiding standard  Exp
        Dn.


        This guy has INTENTIONS. He also has OUT RUDS.  He  also  isn't  in
        session.


        So you'll just have to match up to the pc's needs  and  handle.  It
        isn't attitudes you want. It's intentions."

D OF P INTERVIEW-

        (Not done on meter.)

        1.       What did the auditor do?

        (Hesitation) Auditor audited me on R3R. I didn't know anything  was
        out on R3R. (Hesitation.) I think if anything, perhaps the question
        in regard to environment maybe my attention wasn't directed to  the
        right place. Thought it was a good  session.  (Pc  "ahs"  and  "you
        knows" a lot.)

        Q on PT Environment I believe I gave what was  wanted.  That's  the
        only point, the original question.


        (Hesitation) I don't know if that's where the area  of  charge  is.
        Dianetic auditing real good. Pictures erasing. It's cool. (Pc  goes
        thro a lot of mannerisms, hands across face, arm over head, looking
        around, tapping leg, fingering things.)

        ANYTHING ELSE?


        (Hesitation) Only point (comm lag) I think of. I just don't know if
        that's where the charge is. Don't believe that's where  the  charge
        is. (Referring to session.) Charge started earlier  than  Thursday.
        He had TRs in. Ran me. Made sure I erased it.


        (Hesitation) Maybe  the  question  should  have  been  checked.  He
        probably did. I don't recall. He audited me  very  well.  The  only
        thing it could be is the question.

        2.       How do you feel about your case?

        Want to get more into it. (Hesitation) And  handle  whatever  needs
        handling and do whatever I'm supposed to  do.  That's  how  I  feel
        about my case.


        And oh! I feel I have to take  more  responsibility  and  get  more
        charge off my case that's all. I feel that the actions that I  have
        are very thoroughly in, couldn't be shifted by a crane, (laugh) you
        know, like, I feel a tank couldn't take me off my purpose.  Feel  I
        can get from A to B. Want to get more straight to help Scientology.
        No big thing.

        Pc also mentioned before leaving he needed lots of  rest  for  long
        sessions.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 4.5.72-
        "Lousiest and almost the least informative D of  P  Interview  seen
        for some time.


        Leaves a C/S digging his wits for data.


        But apparently pc has something to handle.


        Also he was run on an unreading question.


        Also he is in an ARC Bk (sounds sad) or a failed  purpose  (tired).
        (Needs lots of sleep to be audited.)


        You can't audit over a possible ARC Br  and  a  failed  purpose  is
        heavy on the case.


        This person is also Out-Ethics.

        0.       R-Factor-you were run on an unreading item.
        00.      C/S 53RRR handle.
        1.       Triple Ruds + Overts LD.
        2.       L&N, check for read. What purpose has failed?  to  BD  F/N
             item. R3R Triple.
        3.       2wc What do you want handled? Mark all BDs and F/Ns."

LRH PROGRAM 4.5.72-

        "Not in session PR GIs ARC Brk LD? Failed Purpose. Hidden Standard.
        Run on unreading Item.

        1.       C/S 53RRR handle.
        2.       Triple Ruds LD + Overts.
        3.       L&N What purpose has failed. BD F/N. R3R Triple.
        4.       L&N What do you want handled.
        5.       R3R on BD Item.
        6.       2wc What do you want handled.
        7.       R3R on BD F/N Items.
        8.       All Ev Purps found on case. R3R Triple.
        *9.       Env Prepcheck from list of 2.5.72 reassessed.
        10.       HCO PL 3 May 72.

        (He has Out-Ethics.)


        (Has to be gotten uptone to see them.)"

The next session the auditor alters the C/S, and runs the Triple Ruds  first
and without any Overts. He then does  the  C/S  53RRR  and  gets  into  list
correction.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 5.5.72-

        Corny  auditor errors.


        Did Triple Ruds before  C/S 53-out of sequence.


        Omitted "Overt" after LD Ruds. Altered C/S = Out Tech.


        Did Triple Ruds out of sequence (F-l ARC Bk, F-l PTP, then  2  &  3
        ARC Bk, 2 & 3 PTP, then W/H Triple.)


        Proposed cramming attached.

       "0.  Touch Assist to F/N VGIs (strained a muscle  yesterday)"  added
             by LRH.
        1.       Get correct item on the list of  28.4.72.  (SCL  8E.  What
             mystery are you trying to solve?)
        2.       L4B to F/Ning list.
        3.       C/S 53 to F/Ning list.
        4.       L&N "What purpose has failed" (LRH C/S 4 May 72.)
        5.       R3R Triple.
             6.   2wc "What do you want handled?" Mark all BDs and F/Ns.
       * 7. L&N: "What intentions are connected with     (BD F/N item)".
        8.       R3R Triple.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Seen."


        LRH adds Touch Assist to C/S.


        "Pulled muscle yesterday and went  to  MO,  this  evening,  for  T.
        Assist. MO report attached."

MO REPORT-

        Routed onto MO  lines  for  a  leg  pain  from  pulled  muscle-from
        football on the dock.

The complete C/S was done the  next  session  and  the  pc  says  at  Exams,
"Breathless- Fantastic session."

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done. Surprisingly good result."

The LRH program is continued and completed with a big win and cog.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 7.5.72-

        3 sessions, completed program. He had a big win and cog,  "I'm  not
        motivator hungry any more." EP Exp Dn?


        Also V. mollified but VGI on the L&N 3 May PL.

        1.       OCA and program.

        (Tried to get him to do OCA tonight but he was busy writing up  1st
        Dyn Danger Formula. I'm not sure what he needs next  but  will  see
        from OCA. He could go to Experimental Product RD.)

OCA GRAPH 8.5.72-


                                    [pic]

________________________

*FOOTNOTE:  List of 2.5.72 is list of BD Items from 2wc on PT Environment.

*FOOTNOTE:  Correct listing question is "What intention is connected to  (BD
             F/N item)". Asking for plural Intentions is an invalid  listing
             question because it asks for more than one item.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND NEW PROGRAM 8.5.72-


        Still low column G-new low, probably more honest  than  previously.
        But maybe ARC Bk.

        Exp Dn Pgm.

"0. Hav all sessions" added by LRH.

        1.       Triple Ruds "on Flag".


        2.       Assess: (_____pc's Org),  Los  Angeles,  USLO,  Flag,  New
             York,  co-Executive),  Command  team,   LRH,   The   Commodore,
             Postulate checks, crush sell, Ethics, Tech, Policy, Off Policy,
             Admin,  Establishment,  Products,  VFPs,   Dissemination,   The
             Public, The people, Scientology, Clearing, the planet.
                 L&N Intention connected with reading areas and R3R Triple.


        3.       After each  L&N + R3R, L&N F-2  Intention-"What  intention
             does another have towards you connected with (       item)".
           Then F-3 "What intention do others have towards others connected
             with (_____item)".
                 These all done should care for Dynamic 3.


        4.       Repeat action on: You as a thetan, your mind,  your  body,
             your name, your  rank,  your  case,  eating,  your  life,  your
             language, your communications, your thoughts, your possessions,
             your situation.


        5.       Do the same for: (_____wife's name), your  marriage,  your
             wife, married women,  single  women,  sex,  celibacy,  balling,
             children, offspring, your family,  your  mother,  your  father,
             your   brother,   your   ancestors,   genitals,   masturbation,
             fornication, future generations, your generation.
                 That should handle a lot.


        6.        Then:  The  Race,  The  Planet,  Mankind,  Human  beings,
             humanoids,  fellows,  beings,  Russians,  Americans,  Earthmen,
             aliens, spacemen, other Races.
                 Handle as in 2 and 3.


        7.       2wc How do you feel about your case?


        8.       Program as indicated.

 AUDITOR'S C/S 8.5.72-

OCA still sags on right-probably more honest. But intentions all across  the
board should be looked at.

        "1.       Check Flag for read" added by LRH. Triple Ruds on "Flag".
        2.       Assess list from Pgm and handle.
        3.       Continue Pgm.

LRH COMMENT-

        "OK as noted."

The auditor does the C/S and Pgm down to step 4 of Pgm and pc has  huge  win
and so the auditor ends off.

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 9.5.72-

        Wow, wow.  Never  seen  him  like  this,  so  excited.  L&N  Triple
        Intentions on "The Command Team" + R3R and then on "your mind" tore
        the case wide open.


        Some sort of OT valence shift page 45 and 46.  RESPONSIBILITY  cogs
        left and right. ("My responsibility  is  back.")  He  just  shifted
        beingness in a big way. Looks like we cracked him but good.
        I don't think his OCA would sag anymore.

        0.       2wc to F/N "Tell me about your wins."
        1.       2wc "Is there anything you feel you want handled?" to F/N.
        2.       If all well, OCA and:
        3.       Experimental Product RD.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done. May be unnecessary to go on.  This  C/S  is  okay.
        That may be it. C/S ok."

In the next session the pc gives some items he wants  handled.  At  the  end
the pc says, "To be able to control, control towards  survival  and  optimum
conditions." (F/N VGIs.) "That  is  really  where  my  head  is  at,  proper
control." (F/N VGIs IND.)

AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S-

        Not complete, I guess. He has several areas he wants handled.

        I.       The body: heat, reaction to hot temperatures, nervous  for
             no reason, lower back muscles, lower part  of  body,  pains  in
             body.


        II.      Rollercoasters,  losing  attention  units,  resurgence  of
             being-loss afterwards, diminished life force.


        III.     Pictures not under control, automatic pictures.


        IV.      Failed control is  the item that F/Ned.

        He is noted in the Case Progress sheet as having had the PTS RD  in
        71, but I see no record of the session. He has not  had  it,  I  am
        sure. Can be checked with the pc.


        The first thing to handle would be the PTS RD. Pre-Flag folders and
        LA folders not here.


        0.       Check if he has had it.
        1.       Get him to tell you any past S&D items, if any.
        2.       If none do 3 S&Ds.
        3.       R3R Triple, Triple Ruds and overts.
        4.       2wc "Who he  has  known  this  life  who  has  worried  or
             troubled him". Check for known before this lifetime. R3R Triple
             Ruds + overts.
        5.       2wc "Been after this LT" if known  before,  R3R  Triple  +
             Ruds + overts.
        6.       Places and planets known before this LT. Handle as above.
        7.       Assess PTS Correction List and handle to F/N list.

LRH COMMENT 11 May 72-

        "I won't give you any grade for this session  as  it's  a  goof  in
        Admin, C/Sing and Pgming.


        You must stay on Pgms and complete RDs. (You have decided now to go
        into another RD leaving Sanderson RD incomplete.)


        You ONLY run items in pc's wording. Do  not  change  wording.  (You
        changed his wording to 'Failed Control' which he did NOT say.)


        You must mark BDs plainly when doing one of these 2wcs  for  things
        to handle. Not all TA actions are marked so one is  not  sure  what
        read. I am sure the needle was active. Yet is not noted.


        Having found where his attn is fixated you must now follow through.


        But he did not answer the auditing question.  He  didn't  tell  you
        what he wanted handled. He told you what he wanted to achieve.  And
        you can't run that! It would be trying  to  as-is  ambition,  which
        wouldn't erase and would down curve him and wreck him.
        When you start an RD you finish it.


        Now I'm dead ended as a C/S. I have no real reads  marked.  The  pc
        didn't really tell you. So I can't say  what  to  R3R.  It  is  NOT
        'failed control'. The pc never said a word about  it!  You  put  an
        item of your own on the pc AND THAT IS A LISTING CRIME.


        Also what's this 'E/S' doing on pg 5 mixed into 2wc for  things  to
        handle. You must not mix up actions.


        The report sheet is a false report.  And  a  less  experienced  C/S
        would have been thrown by it.


        The part of this which I have been alerted by, in this,  and  other
        sessions, is a lack of program command. This IS a Rundown  you  are
        doing. It does have steps. You do do them in sequence. One must NOT
        start one thing, break off and start another.


        All these are very basic auditing flaws.


        Reviewing this it appears we did not end off on  the  Pgm  underway
        but are 2 or 3 sessions deep on AN UNPROGRAMMED ACTION!


        In other words, we are running a case now without a  program  WHICH
        IS ILLEGAL AS HELL.


        Apparently things have been done not  ticked  off  on  the  last  2
        programs.


        This case isn't going A to B by a long way.


        Get checked out on this in cramming.


        Pgm the case. Only you know what you've done here. Then  I'll  okay
        it. You have begun the Sanderson RD. Get checked out on it. Get  it
        completed.


        Then a PTS Int and verification.


        Let's finish this case up!"

RE-PROGRAM BY EXP DN SPEC 11.5.72-

        1.       Complete Sanderson RD. Handle all reading items from  last
             2wc.


        2.       If any further H. Std areas show up, to be handled first.


        3.       PTS Check + RD if indicated.


        4.       OCA + Program (if necessary).

The auditor does a series of sessions and completes the Sanderson RD.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 12.5.72-

        Went great. No reading answers to 2wc, has at present time  nothing
        he can think of he wants handled.


        He looks good too-a lot younger.

        1.       Full D of P PTS Check.
        2.       If needed PTS RD.
        3.       OCA (if 2 not needed OCA directly).

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done."


The PTS Interview is done and the PTS RD completed. LRH  adds  Metalosis  RD
and this is done to a good result.
AUDITOR'S COMMENT AND C/S 19.5.72-

        Went fine on Metalosis RD with some great cogs. Realised after  the
        session hadn't made sure there was nothing missed so  took  him  in
        for another 2 minutes and asked him. He was very happy and calm.


        OCA: He has regained an honest, high G trait.

        I recommend he be OK'd to fire at this time.

        1.       Declare Metalosis RD.
        2.       Declare Exp Dn Complete.
        3.       OK to fire.

LRH COMMENT-

        "Very well done."

The pc goes through the  lines  on  his  declare  cycles  successfully.  The
auditor however finds an action not done on the pc's TIP and rushes a  query
to LRH.

AUDITOR'S QUERY 20.5.72-

        In error  I  overlooked  that  his  original  TIP  called  for  the
        Experimental Product RD and I proposed OK to fire without this.

LRH COMMENT AND C/S 20.5.72-

        "No. Abandon the TIP. His failure is that he fails to get Ethics in
        on others and fails to understand Exchange.

        1.       2wc on how he's doing now.


        2.       L&N to BD F/N  item  (clear  words)  'What  would  be  the
             consequences of getting Ethics in on others?'


        3.       R3R Triple any item.


        4.       2wc How do you feel about Ethics  now?  (If  reservations,
             end off the session for a C/S.)


        5.       HCO PL 4 Apr 72 pg 4 & 5 as marked.


             (a)  Clear the Words PRODUCT, EXCHANGE, DYNAMIC, Dyn 1,  2,  3,
                 4, 5, 6, 7, 8. (Clear 1 as a spirit, body as 5.)


             (b)  Have him draw a  big  chart  of  numbered  dynamics  in  2
                 columns vertical:

      1--------------> 1     Draw in arrows only
      1<-------------- 1     as he does them.
      2     2
      2     2
      3     3
      3     3
      4     4
      4     4
      5     5
      5     5
      6     6
      6     6
      7     7
      7     7
      8     8
      8     8


                 (c)   Go through the exchanges. What does he exchange  with
                 his own 1st (spirit).
      1--------------> 1
      What does it exchange with him.
      1<-------------- 1
             (d)  Keep this up to huge cog."

The auditor does the C/S to a tremendous win.

AUDITOR'S COMMENTS AND C/S 21.5.72-

        Now ready to fire for real.


        Valence shift, cogs on all Dynamics, responsibility level  soaring,
        and I have never seen him so present. Now that he's here he can go.

        0.       Declare Exch by Dyn RD Completed.
        1.       OK to fire.

LRH COMMENT 21.5.72-

        " Very  well done.

        It might interest you to know that I brought him back from  (_____)
        just to set him up to rem and run Exchange by Dyn-step 2 of my last
        session C/S.


        Your C/S is correct."


 AUDITOR NOTE 21.5.72-

        (__________pc) has completed his auditing and his OCA is good.


        He looks very good also.

      Request ok for him to fire to (__________).

LRH COMMENT 21.5.72-

        "OK. Wonderful job."

PC'S SUCCESS STORY-

        Expanded Dianetics. Well, what I did was expand immensely by  doing
        Expanded  Dianetics  and  erasing  formidable  chains  which   once
        shackled  me  to  reactive  areas-now   totally   blown.   Especial
        acknowledgement to my auditor and to  LRH  who  charted  the  newly
        discovered "Terra Incognita".


OCA GRAPH 19.5.72-

                                    [pic]
TOTAL NO. OF SESSIONS: 24.

TOTAL HOURS IN THE CHAIR: 67 hrs 09 min.


                                  Compiled by:
                                  Flag Dn Spec Team
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:WS:MM:ntm.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 15 FEBRUARY 1974

                       (Amended & Reissued 28 March 74
                         -only change is Series No.)
Remimeo

                        Expanded Dianetics Series 20


                          SERVICE FACSIMILE THEORY
                           AND EXPANDED DIANETICS


    As a re-study of Service Facsimiles the following theory is released as
background.


    Note that this is background  data  for  Class  IV  but  is  in  actual
practice used on Expanded Dianetics.


    This sheds some light on Evil Purposes.


    And a new approach comes to light for use in Expanded Dianetics.


    NONE OF THIS ALTERS CLASS IV and NONE OF IT CANCELS OR CHANGES CLASS IV
OR EARLIER DATA.


                           AN OUTLINED NEW XDN RD

    Service Facs By Dynamics and sections thereof.


    How to be right on the______Dynamic Triple. (The exact  Question  needs
to be worked out for various pcs.)


    All L&N and therefore very dicey.


    The theory is that a thetan even when  pressed  or  suppressed  to  the
absolute limit of near extinction will still try, even  when  "cooperating",
to some way be right.


    A thetan cannot die. His only out is to try to  stop  something  as  he
himself cannot stop living.


    This gives rise to fixed ideas as he is trying  to  stop-therefore  the
ideas hold in time and continue.


    His efforts to be right continue to stop him in a reverse flow.


    This is true because he is  already  at  near  total  effect.  He  also
becomes the effect of his own fixed idea efforts to handle.


    Just as a man being crushed by a house-size rock  will  still  put  his
hands out to fend it off,  so  will  a  thetan  continue  to  fend  off  his
believed oppressions by stopping them.


    Insistence on rightness is a last refuge of beingness.  Thus  one  gets
some very aberrated ones.


    These he uses in situations where he thinks he might be found wrong.



These are called "Service Facsimiles". "Service" because they  "serve"  him.
"Facsimiles" because they are in mental image  picture  form.  They  explain
his disabilities as well.


    The  facsimile  part  is  actually  a  self-installed  disability  that
"explains" how he is not responsible for not being able to cope.  So  he  is
not wrong for not coping.


    Part of the "package" is to be right by making wrong.


    The service facsimile is therefore a picture containing an  explanation
of self condition and also a fixed method of making others wrong.

    A real handling would have to include:

    A.      What disability he uses to explain how he  is  not  responsible
        for not fully coping with life or given situations.


    B.      A fixed postulate he uses to further assert that in actual fact
        he is still right.


    C.      The computation as contained in B to make others wrong so as to
        be right.

    Handling therefore would include:

    a.      The disability R3R Triple.


    b.      L&N for a fixed postulate on each dynamic he uses to be right.


    c.      A realization he is using this to make others wrong so  he  can
        be right.

    All these conditions would have to be handled to fully handle a Service
Fac to full EP.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder




LRH:ams.ntm jh
Copyright � 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 28 MARCH 1974

Remimeo
Ex Dn C/Ses
Ex Dn Auditors
                        Expanded Dianetics Series 21
               Ref:    Ex Dn Tape Lectures and Case Histories.


                             EXPANDED DIANETICS
                             DEVELOPMENTS SINCE
                            THE ORIGINAL LECTURES


    Since the original lectures on Expanded Dianetics  and  Case  Histories
were released several HCO Bs were issued under  my  name  which  I  did  not
authorize. These have been cancelled.


    I  thought  I'd  better  cover  the  developments  since  the  original
materials and clear up any questions or conflicts that may have arisen  over
the unauthorized HCO Bs.


                       EXPANDED DIANETICS PROGRAMMING

    Expanded Dianetics programming is not rote but each programme  is  laid
out for that individual pc taking him from his  current  state  to  a  shiny
product.


    The programme is worked out from data gotten  by  FES,  OCA,  Chart  of
Human Evaluation and D of P Interviews.


    The product of an Ex Dn complete pc is visible by OCA, Chart  of  Human
Evaluation, and pc satisfaction in having handled what he wanted handled.


    Endless Ex Dn to no product occurs  only  when  the  C/S  violates  the
basics of Ex Dn programming as covered in my  tape  lectures  and  the  Case
Histories, when the pc is run on actions that he  doesn't  need  and  aren't
reading or when the pc was not set up for Ex Dn in the first place.

                         EXPANDED DIANETICS SET-UPS

    Usually a C/S Series 53RF and  a  list  correction  are  needed  set-up
actions if they haven't been done. A thorough C/S-l and full  word  clearing
are vital.


    A Drug RD must be done or completed before Ex Dn is  done  or  it  will
fail. This includes Objectives. You can't do  Ex  Dn  until  Drugs  are  all
handled.


                             TROUBLE ON ENGRAMS

    The pc who cannot run engrams has misunderstoods on  the  commands  and
terms of R3R and Dianetics, or it's drugs. The pc will be able to run  drugs
because that's what he's stuck in. He'll run those automatically as long  as
you've done the necessary Word Clearing.


    Pcs who won't go backtrack are druggies or in recent  shock  of  having
died. This is handled by a thorough Drug  RD  and  if  necessary  the  usual
Dianetic backtrack remedies As and Es double-assessed. Ss and  Ps  could  be
checked as well.

                            LATER EX DN RUNDOWNS

    Class VIII C/S-6 list is useful in running out past bad auditing. It is
fully covered on Tape 1. Other Class VIII lists are not used  as  you  won't
get anywhere running AEIs from a significance.


    Intentions in AEI Treble Assessments are run in order of read. Interest
is not checked. As intentions exist on all 3 flows you could  list  for  the
intentions on the other  2  flows  after  you  have  listed  the  intentions
connected with      and run them R3R Triple.  You  can  only  list  and  run
intentions  connected  with  a  terminal  or  mass  or   somatic   never   a
significance.


    The R3R commands are: F-1 "Locate an incident of another causing you to
have the intention_____." F-2 "Locate an incident of you causing another  to
have the intention_____." F-3 "Locate an incident of others  causing  others
to have the intention      ______."


    Good Intentions are never run. Never. The cure for a pc who is run on a
good intention is a C/S Series 53RF. The cure for the auditor  is  to  fully
define  the  words:  good,  worthy,  positive,  pro-survival,   evil,   bad,
unworthy, negative and contra-survival. Then have him re-study  the  related
materials. If it recurs, get him audited on a 3 May PL and Ex Dn.


    R3R all E. Purps culled from the folder is done as a first action in Ex
Dn. Subsequent E. Purps brought up in sessions are noted and R3R'd later  on
in the programme before any PTS RD is done.


    These E. Purps have to be verified as to wording and checked  for  read
before running, but not interest.


    Considerable charge can be bypassed if E.  Purps  are  missed  so  this
action is thoroughly done.


    R/S Handling, also called the Responsibility RD, is done as OCA  right-
hand side handling. A list of all R/Sing statements is made then each  taken
up. The idea is an R/S will occur in connection with a terminal  which  will
read when checked, and that's what you want to  run.  The  R/Sing  statement
itself will often mention a terminal. If not the auditor can do a brief  TWC
to find out the terminal connected with the statement.


    Once the terminal is obtained the auditor lists (L & N) for the E. Purp
F-l, 2 & 3 R3R Triple on each after it's listed.


    If no terminal can be found the auditor would have to L  &  N  for  the
intention of someone who would (R/S statement).


    The Wants Handled Rundown is shown in Cases B, C and F.  The  important
points of the RD are to run it as a "wants to get rid of", not a  "wants  to
achieve" and to complete each thing the pc wants handled before going on.


    Handling of each thing the pc wants handled is  dictated  by  what  the
"thing" is. A somatic is run R3R Triple. The  intention  connected  with  it
can also be run. An intention is run R3R Triple. If it's a terminal, L  &  N
for the intention connected with it and run it. You can also L & N  and  run
the intentions on the other 2 flows. If it's a condition L  &  N  W/W  would
have it then  list  for  and  run  that  terminal's  intention.  If  it's  a
doingness L & N for the intention of someone who would do that and run it.


    Additional handling could be done such as  PSEAIs  double-assessed  R3R
Triple, handling it as a problem  by  finding  and  running  out  the  prior
confusion or tracing it back to the earlier problem it is a solution to  and
running that R3R Triple. Difficulties on this RD stem from not  getting  the
thing the pc really wants handled which will read very well and run  like  a
bomb, or errors in the L & N or R3R or out ethics holding the  condition  in
place.
The Multiple-Flow E. Purp Rundown is a very high-powered action  which  must
be precisely done. Its use is covered in  C/S  Series  22  and  Case  C.  It
consists of F-l: L & N "What Evil Impulse have others had toward  you?"  R3R
Triple. F-2: L & N "What Evil Impulse  have  you  had  toward  others?"  R3R
Triple. F-3: L & N "What Evil Impulse have others had  toward  others?"  R3R
Triple.


                                   SUMMARY

    An Ex Dn programme is designed for an individual. C/Sing  and  auditing
are done to achieve a product.


    When you're paralleling the mind the meter will be  reading  like  mad,
the pc will be wildly interested and the results will follow big and fast.


    With this broad change in Ex Dn I recommend that you re-listen  to  the
Ex Dn tapes, review DMSMH and The Original Thesis as well as  the  '63  Time
Track and R3R materials and re-study the  Case  Histories  working  out  why
each C/S and pgm was done. Better yet do a thorough Ex Dn C/S Course.


    I'm counting on you to really apply these materials and expect  to  see
lots of good results.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH:amsjh
Copyright � 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 23 APRIL 1974R
Remimeo     REVISED 14 DECEMBER 1974
Ex Dn C/Ses

                        Expanded Dianetics Series 22R


                             EXPANDED DIANETICS
                                 REQUISITES


    The recent review of Expanded Dianetics has shown that  Ex  Dn  can  be
made to fail if the pc is improperly set up for it.


    The following checklist is for use by C/Ses to ensure full set-ups  for
Ex Dn-have been done.


    Attach to the inside left cover of the folder.

                                -------------

1.    Pc has done a full set of TRs 04 and 6-9.

2.    Pc has had a full battery of Objective Processes run to full EP.

3.    Pc has been given a thorough C/S I and is grooved in.

4.    Pc has completed (very) Drug RD which is  FLAT.  No  no  interest  but
    reading items remain unrun. No medicine, drug or stimulant left unrun.

5.    Pc successful at Dianetic Engram running. Can run Dn easily.

6.    Pc has had Word Clearing Method 1 run very flat to F/N list.

7.    Pc has been Word Cleared Method 5 on the L-3ExDRB and R3R words.

8.    Pc has had any high or low TA handled with a C/S 53RI.

9.    Pc is not in the Non-Interference area.

10.   Pc has had any messed-up L & N and Why lists corrected.

11.   Pc has not been left in the middle of a major action or  RD  to  start
    Ex Dn.

12.   Pc is getting Ex Dn after Dn, after Exp Gr 4 or after OT3.  These  are
    the only points Ex Dn is run on a case.

                                -------------

    Only if you make sure each of these points is fully in will the pc  fly
on Ex Dn.


      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder

LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 17 JULY 1974
Remimeo
                        Expanded Dianetics Series 23
                             (Ref. XDn Series 9)

                                 XDN CASE B

Further data on XDn Series 9.

On further data the failure of this case was due to:

1.    PTS to friend of  wife  who  was  violently  invalidative.  He  roller
    coastered = PTS. The PTS  scene  should  have  been  handled  prior  to
    auditing but was not known or suspected at the time.

2.    This case had been a drug addict and was married to a drug addict  who
    had been a prostitute and who persuaded him back  on  drugs.  The  drug
    rundown "no interest items" should have been run  and  he  should  have
    been cleaned up on drugs before beginning XDn. It has been  proven  out
    time and again that when a very full and complete drug rundown  is  not
    done, pcs do not succeed with any  other  type  of  auditing  including
    Expanded Dianetics.

                                FURTHER NOTES

    Further research has shown that  headaches  are  almost  invariably  an
Exteriorization-Interiorization problem. This research case should have  had
his Ext-Int handled fully.


    These items added to the research program,  before  any  others,  would
have brought success:

    i.      Handle Ext-Int by repair or rundown.


    ii.     Handle any out lists L4B.


    iii.    Handle PTS Situation fully and rapidly.


    iv.     Complete Drug RD by culling all "no interest items" and running
        them.

    Further repair of this case would include the above but would add:


    v.      Do an L4B on intentions lists to be sure no lists are  out  and
        repair.


    vi.     Do R3R on all reading evil intentions whether pc interested  or
        not.

                                   SUMMARY

    Data gained from running this Case B has been of  great  assistance  in
handling other cases since the faults found were not repeated.


    Hundreds, probably thousands of cases  are  now  winning  on  XDn  with
permanent gain. This is due to using fully  the  developed  tech  with  full
skill.


LRH:nt.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1974                                   Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               27 MARCH 1975R
                          Revised 10 September 1975
                        (Revision in this type style)
Remimeo
Ex Dn Course
Ex Dn Spclsts

                        Expanded Dianetics Series 24R


                           EX DN AND PTS RD NOTES


    With the issuance of HCOB 17 March 1974,  "TWC  Checksheets-TWC,  Using
Wrong Questions", certain Ex Dn procedures that were  TWC  became  L&N.  The
commands were issued.

                               PT ENVIRONMENT

    The listing question for PT Environment is "What terminals make up your
present time environment?" (LRH). The question is listed  and  the  item  is
handled by getting AEIs connected with it or about it and running  them  R3R
Triple or Quad, to an F/Ning AEI assessment.


    That completes PT Environment handling.


    Where a pc has had PT Environment done by 2WC and later bogs,  the  C/S
would note a possible out list and could have it corrected if it's out.


                                 INTENTIONS

    In doing an AEI Treble Assessment Intentions must be listed, L&N.  This
also follows from the 17 March 74 HCO B.


    The listing question would be "What intention is connected with______?"


    An intention should not be listed from a significance but only  from  a
terminal or mass.  Where  the  item  being  listed  is  a  significance  the
terminal must be found by L&N  and  then  the  intention  of  that  terminal
listed.


    The procedure on AEIs where Intentions has the LARGEST READ   would  be
to L&N for the intention, R3R Triple or Quad, then go on  to  As  or  Es  or
reassess.


    It is  highly  unlikely  that  Intentions  will  continue  to  read  on
reassessment of AEIs. If this does happen suspect a wrong  list  and  verify
or correct.


    It could read on an Intention on another flow, but then Intentions  can
be listed Triple or Quad.

                                 QUAD EX DN

    When catching up unrun Flow 0s on an Ex Dn completion it  is  usual  to
Quad the R3R items, leaving the L&N  questions  alone.  Doing  Flow  0  L&Ns
where Flow 1, 2 and 3 were previously listed and run R3 R, as with  multiple
flow Intentions or Evil Purposes, is not necessary on an  Ex  Dn  completion
and could bypass charge by overrunning the Grade.


    Where Intentions are listed Quad the Flow 0  question  would  be  "What
intention have you had towards yourself about_____?"
                                   PTS RD

The Flow 0 commands on the PTS RD would be as follows:

R3R:      "Locate  a  time  when  you  did  something  to  yourself  because
of________."

ARC BREAKS:     "Did you have an ARC Break with yourself about________?"

PROBLEMS:     "Did you give yourself a problem about________?"

WITHHOLDS:     "Did you withhold anything from yourself about_________?"

OVERTS:     "Did you commit an overt on yourself about_________?"

CAN'T HAVE/ENFORCED HAVE:

1.    "What can't have did you run on yourself because of_________?"

2.    "What did you try to force  on  yourself  because  of________that  you
didn't want?"

Follow with Objective Hav.


      Revised by
      Msm J. Franks
      XDN C/S Flag
      for

                                  W/O Ron Shafran
                                  CS-4


                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS: RS:JF:ah.rd
Copyright � 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED


























                         Integrity Processing Series
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              4 DECEMBER 1972R
                             Revised 13 May 1975
Remimeo
                       Integrity Processing Series 1R


                                 DEFINITIONS


    INTEGRITY PROCESSING is that  processing  which  increases  a  person's
personal integrity and trust in himself and others by freeing  him  of  past
overts, withholds and missed withholds.


    DEFINITION:  Overt-A harmful or contra-survival act Precisely, it is an
act of commission or omission that harms the greater number of dynamics.


    DEFINITION:  Withhold-An undisclosed contra-survival act; a  no  action
after the fact of action, in which  the  individual  has  done  or  been  an
accessory to doing something which is a transgression against some moral  or
ethical  code  consisting  of  agreements  to  which  the   individual   has
subscribed in order to guarantee, with others, the survival of a group  with
which he is co-acting or has co-acted toward survival.


    DEFINITION:  Missed Withhold-An undisclosed contra-survival  act  which
has been restimulated by another but  not  disclosed.  This  is  a  withhold
which another person nearly found out about, leaving  the  person  with  the
withhold in a state of wondering whether his hidden deed is known or not

    INTEGRITY is defined as:

1.    The condition of having no part or  element  taken  away  or  wanting;
    undivided or unbroken state; wholeness.

2.     The  condition  of  not  being  marred  or  violated;  unimpaired  or
    uncorrupted condition; soundness.

3.    Soundness or moral principle; the  character  of  uncorrupted  virtue,
    especially in relation to truth and fair dealing; uprightness, honesty,
    sincerity.

    This relates to ETHICS which is defined as "the principles of right and
wrong conduct and the specific moral choices to be made  by  the  individual
in his relationship with others".


    Thus we see that a person who acts against his own moral codes and  the
mores of the group violates his integrity and is said to be out-ethics.


    Such acts are called overts. A person having  committed  an  overt  and
then withholding the fact  of  that  overt,  and  withholding  himself  from
committing further overts,  will  individuate  from  the  group.  The  group
itself will then lose integrity as it becomes divided and lacks wholeness.


    Integrity Processing is  therefore  that  processing  which  enables  a
person, within the reality of his own moral codes and those  of  the  group,
to reveal his overts so he no longer requires to withhold  and  so  enhances
his own integrity and that of the group.

                                 DEVELOPMENT

    In the ear/y '60s LRH developed the technology known as  Sec  Checking.
As issued it was used for two purposes: as  a  general  processing  tool  to
clean up a pc's overts and withholds and as a security tool to  detect  out-
ethics persons and security risks
In  1970  this  technology  was  refined  and  issued  under  the  name   of
Confessionals.


    In 1972 a complete update was done of basic O/W tech  and  the  earlier
procedures of Sec Checking and  Confessionals.  A  new  technology  emerged-
Integrity Processing.


    Recently Integrity Processing has been reviewed as to  its  workability
and most optimum usage by LRH and certain revisions have been made.

                                    USAGE

    Integrity Processing has two uses. Its basic use is as a  tool  for  pc
case gain, increase in responsibility and case progress. As such it  belongs
at Exp Grade II on the Grade Chart You can't  expect  a  pc  with  unhandled
Drugs, who can't communicate because others don't really  exist  (Grade  0),
and who is caved in by problems (Grade I) that he hasn't even  cognited  on,
to have enough responsibility to answer up on O/Ws  (Grade  II).  Therefore,
Integ as a full RD goes at Exp Grade II. It  is  usually  programmed  to  be
done at or towards the end of the Grade and a full battery  of  Integ  lists
are used. It is not a mandatory Grade II Exp process, but is recommended.


    The second use of Integrity Processing is  as  an  ethics  or  security
measure. It is used here as part of staff requirements or  when  a  security
clearance is needed. As such  it  has  no  case  prerequisites  and  is  not
subject to such things as the Drug RD rule as it is not being  used  for  pc
case gain. Only one or at most two Integ lists would be used.


    When used as an ethics or  security  measure,  Integ  can  be  done  as
auditing in a session (and is therefore subject to the Auditor's  Code),  or
can be done as a straight security action, not "in session" In the  case  of
the latter, the person must be informed that he  isn't  being  audited.  The
technical procedure in either case would be the same.


    It is noted that use of Integ as a non-session security measure  or  in
the case of severe out-ethics is rare, and nothing here condones  misuse  or
abuse of Integrity Processing as a security or ethics  action.  Such  misuse
would be itself subject to immediate and severe Ethics action  as  it  would
constitute an extreme betrayal of trust

                 HISTORICAL PRECEDENCE-RELIGIOUS CONFESSION

    The need for a  person  to  be  able  to  morally  cleanse  himself  by
confession of sins has long been recognized in religion.


    The Buddhist monk 2,500 years ago was permitted  to  confess  and  seek
expiation for "acts of censure". The penalty  for  failure  to  confess  was
loss of the rights and privileges of a monk. This  was  enforcement  of  the
natural law that he who commits actions against the codes or  mores  of  the
group separates himself from that group.


    The Bible, in the Books of James and John, calls for the confession  of
sins.


    Early Christian handling  of  confession  was  largely  concerned  with
disciplinary aspects. The sinner had to wear  sackcloth,  make  his  bed  in
ashes, and fast. This went on for a time proportionate  to  the  gravity  of
the offence, sometimes for years.


    Certain sins were previously considered too serious for forgiveness and
therefore not open to confession, but a gradual  leniency  developed  as  in
the case  of  Calixtus,  Bishop  of  Rome  217-222,  who  decided  to  admit
adulterers to exomologesis (Greek for public confession).


    In  the  4th  Century  at  Rome   and   Constantinople   we   hear   of
"penitentiaries"- priests appointed to act for the  Bishop  in  hearing  the
confession of sins and deciding whether public discipline was necessary.


    Due to some misuse of public confession, individual private  confession
became more prominent in the 5th Century.
In 1215 the Council of the Lateran ruled that everyone must make  confession
at least once a year before his parish priest.


    In  Confession  as  now  administered   in   Christian   Churches   the
disciplinary penance is often little more than nominal,  stress  being  laid
rather on the fullness of the confession.


    Thus for at least 2,500 years confession has played an  important  role
in religious practice.


    Throughout the centuries two points of question have arisen  which  led
to  some  unpopularity  of  confession.  One  was  the  possible  misuse  of
information  disclosed  in  public  confession,  hence  the  development  of
private confession  before  an  authorized  person  whose  code  of  conduct
prevented misuse. The other was the infliction  of  disciplinary  action  as
atonement for the sins confessed. But the latter goes beyond  the  realm  of
personal morals and ethics into justice. Confession  itself,  and  the  need
for some form of confession has not been in question.


    With Integrity Processing  Scientology  follows  in  the  tradition  of
religion. This processing  enables  the  individual  to  confess  to  overts
without duress. It is done with a qualified Auditor bound by  the  Auditor's
Code. Disciplinary action forms no part of the processing.


    The technology by which Integrity Processing is delivered is new. It is
not the same as any  earlier  technology  either  in  Scientology  or  other
religion. It does however follow in the longstanding tradition  of  religion
in providing a means for the individual to admit to and take  responsibility
for transgression against the mores of the group and so regain  a  spiritual
and moral integrity.


      Compiled from LRH briefings
      and materials

      Reissued as BTB by
      Flag Mission 1234

      Revised by
      W/O Ron Shafran
      CS-4

      Approved by
      Commodore's Staff Aides
      Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
BDCS:RS:AL:MG:BL:clb.rd      of the
Copyright � 1972,1974,1975   CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              5 DECEMBER 1972RA
                             Revised 13 May 1975
Remimeo

                       Integrity Processing Series 2RA


                                  PROCEDURE


    Integrity Processing must be done  only  by  a  well  trained  auditor,
skilled in TRs, basic auditing and metering, who can make  a  prepared  list
read, and who has been fully checked out and drilled on these techniques.


    As an auditing action it is done in model session with Rudiments in.


    Every reading question of an Integrity Processing Form  is  F/Ned.  The
actual form question must be taken to F/N, not some other question.


    Here is the basic procedure for Integrity Processing:

1.    Set up the room, chairs, table, etc., as you would  for  any  auditing
    session with all admin to hand, worksheet paper, Integ  Form  you  will
    use, etc.

2.    Make sure your pc's hands are not too dry or moist, the cans  are  the
    correct size and the pc knows how to hold them. Ref. False TA HCO Bs.

3.    Start the session and fly a Rud if no F/N. If TA high or  low  do  not
    try to fly a Rud but do a C/S Series 53RJ, assess and  handle.  If  you
    are not trained in doing a C/S Series 53, end off for C/S instruction.

4.    Put in any needed R-Factor on doing Integrity Processing.

5.    Clear the procedure and the use of the buttons "suppress" and  "false"
    etc. If necessary as an  example  run  a  non-significant  question  to
    demonstrate the procedure (e.g. Have you ever eaten an apple?).

6.    Take up the first question and clear the  words  backwards,  then  the
    full command noting any read while clearing, which is valid. See BTB  2
    May 72R, "Clearing Commands", and HCO B  28  Feb  71,  C/S  Series  24,
    "Metering Reading Items". Then,  as  needed,  groove  in  the  question
    further by asking for the time period the  question  would  cover,  the
    activities and people that would be involved, etc. This will steer  the
    pc to the area and bring it into view.

7.    With good TR 1 give the pc the first question, keeping an eye  on  the
    meter and  noting  any  instant  read.  Even  the  smallest  change  of
    characteristic is checked in Integrity  Processing  and  that  question
    taken up if it develops into an "SF", "F", "LF" or "LFBD".

8.    Take up each reading question getting the who, what,  when  and  where
    of every overt, going  earlier  similar  to  F/N.  Get  specifics,  not
    general or vague answers. If the pc gives off another's overt  ask  him
    if he ever did something like that. You want what the pc has done.

9.    TAKE THE ORIGINAL READING QUESTION TO F/N. Not  some  other  question.
    Always repeat the original question as  part  of  the  earlier  similar
    command to keep the pc on that question.

10.   If the question does not read and does not F/N put in Suppress on  the
    question (and if necessary Invalidate, Abandoned, Not-Is, etc.) asking,
    "On the
    question______has anything been suppressed?"  and  noting  any  instant
    read. If Suppress (or one of the other buttons read) has read it  means
    the read has transferred from the question to the button,  so  take  up
    the question as in 8 above to F/N. If there is no read on  the  buttons
    the question should just F/N) After the question is taken to F/N  there
    is no need to then check Suppress. Just go on to the next question.

11.   If the pc gets critical realize you have missed a  withhold  and  pull
    the MWH.

12.   If an R/S occurs note it large and clear on the  worksheets  and  then
    circle it in red after session with the statement or question on  which
    it occurred. Note the fact on the Auditor Report Form and Program Sheet
    with session date and W/S page.

13.   If a reading question does not go to F/N  and  bogs  or  the  TA  goes
    high, take up an L1 RA (Integ  Repair  List),  assess  and  handle  per
    instructions.

14.    EXAMINER.  All  Integrity  Processing  sessions  must   be   followed
    immediately by a standard Pc Examination.

15.   On any Bad Exam Report (non-F/N, BIs or non-optimum  statement)  after
    an Integ session, or on any pc who gets sick or upset or  does  not  do
    well or has a high or low TA, give an L1 RA as the next action.

    The 24 Hour Red Tag Rule must be strictly enforced.


    In the case of a pc requiring an L1 RA the Case Supervisor  would  also
    look  for  evidence  of  questions  F/Ned  on  something  else,  unflat
    questions, or withholds gotten off more than once.


    A poor or comm lag TR 2, hidden from the view of the C/S, can also mess
    up a pc on Integ as it invalidates his answers and makes  him  feel  he
    hasn't gotten it off. If suspected this could be  checked  by  D  of  P
    Interview or pc to Exams: "What did the auditor do?"

16.   The Integrity Form is complete when all questions  on  the  Form  have
    been handled as above and all reading questions taken to an F/N on that
    question.

                                   SUMMARY

    If this procedure is followed and the Integrity  Processing  done  with
good TRs and metering the pc will get great results and regain abilities.


                                  Originally reissued as BTB
                                  by Flag Mission 1234


                                  Revised & Reissued by CS-4


                                  Approved by
                                  Commodore's Staff Aides
                                  and the Board of Issues
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY



BDCS:RS:AL:MG:clb.rd
Copyright � 1972,1974, 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              8 DECEMBER 1972RA
                             Revised 13 May 1975
Remimeo

                 Integrity Processing Series 3R, 4, 4R, 5RA


                        INTEGRITY PROCESSING AND O/Ws
                                 REPAIR LIST

                                    L1 RA

                (Cancels BTB 6 Dec 72R, Integrity Processing
                Series 3R, "Hi-Lo TA Assessment for Integrity
                       Processing and Confessionals",
              and BTB 7 Dec 72, Integrity Processing Series 4,
                "Mid-Integrity Processing Short Assessment".)


    This is the standard correction/repair list for  O/W  actions  such  as
Confessionals, Integrity Processing, O/W Write-ups,  O/W  Meter  Checks  and
Sec Checks.


    In Integrity Processing this list is used in the event of a  BER  after
an Integ session, if the pc gets sick or upset or falls on his head,  or  if
an Integ session bogs.


    This action is a 24 HOUR REPAIR PRIORITY.


    The list is assessed Method 5 and all reading items  fully  handled  to
F/N per the instructions given.


    Prefix the assessment with a time limiter (e.g. "In this session",  "In
that Integrity Processing", etc.).

PRECLEAR:                                    DATE:

AUDITOR:                                     TA:

0.    WAS THERE SOMETHING WRONG WITH THE METER OR  __________
      CANS?
      False TA handling.
1.    OUT INT.   __________
      Int RD Correction List or Int RD, if Went In or Go In read.
2.    LIST ERROR.      __________
      L4BR and handle.
3.    WERE YOU TIRED OR HUNGRY?   __________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
4.    HAD YOU RECENTLY TAKEN DRUGS
      MEDICINE______ ALCOHOL______?     __________
      2wc E/S to F/N. Note for C/S.
5.    DID YOU HAVE AN ARC BREAK?  __________
      ARCU, CDEINR E/S to F/N.
6.    DID YOU HAVE A PROBLEM?     __________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
7.    HAS A WITHHOLD BEEN MISSED? __________
      Pull it getting who nearly found out, etc. E/S to F/N.
8.    HAD YOU TOLD ALL?      __________
      2wc E/S to F/N. Indicate it if so.
9.    DID YOU HAVE TO GET THE SAME W/Hs OFF MORE
      THAN ONCE? __________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
10.   SOMEONE DEMANDED A W/H YOU DIDN'T HAVE?      __________
      2wc E/S to F/N. Indicate it if so.
11.   WAS THERE A FALSE ACCUSATION?     __________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
12.   WAS ANYTHING SUPPRESSED?    __________
      Clean it up E/S to F/N.
13.   WAS ANYTHING INVALIDATED?   __________
      Clean it up E/S to F/N.
14.   WAS ANYTHING PROTESTED?     __________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
15.   WAS THERE ANY EVALUATION?   __________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
16.   HAS SOMETHING BEEN MISUNDERSTOOD? __________
      Clean it up, clearing any mis-u words each to F/N.
17.   WAS A QUESTION LEFT UNFLAT? __________
      Find out which one, indicate it, flatten it.
18.   HAS AN OVERT BEEN PROTESTED?      __________
      Get what it was and get in Protest button on it, check for E/S.
19.   WAS THERE A WITHHOLD THAT KEPT COMING UP?    __________
      Get who wouldn't accept it, who said it still read. Indicate false
      read. 2wc the concern.
20.   WAS THERE AN EARLIER OVERT UNDISCLOSED?      __________
      Pull it and clean it up E/S to F/N.
21.   ARE YOU WITHHOLDING ANYTHING?     __________
      Get what it is E/S to F/N.
22.   WERE YOU WORRIED ABOUT REPUTATION?     __________
      Clean it up 2wc E/S to F/N.
23.   ARE THERE OPINIONS YOU DON'T DARE SAY? __________
      Get what. 2wc E/S to F/N.
24.   ARE YOU HERE FOR UNDISCLOSED REASONS?  __________
      Find out why he's here, 2wc E/S to F/N. Note for further
      handling.
25.   WERE YOU AFRAID OF WHAT MIGHT HAPPEN?  __________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
26.   WAS THERE AN INJUSTICE?     __________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
27.   WAS THERE A BETRAYAL?  __________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
28.   HAD SOMETHING BEEN OVERRUN? __________
      Get what, rehab.
29.   WAS SOME ACTION UNNECESSARY?      __________
      Find out what it is. Indicate it if so. E/S to F/N.
30.   WAS THERE SOMETHING ELSE WRONG?   __________
      If so and it doesn't clean up on 2wc, GF M5 and handle.
31.   HAS THE UPSET BEEN HANDLED? __________
      2wc. If so indicate it to F/N.
                                        Approved by
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides
                                        Board of Issues
BDCS:RS:clb.rd   for the
Copyright � 1972, 1974,1975  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 9 DECEMBER 1974
Remimeo
                                   Cancels
                HCO B 10 July 1964, Reissued 5 December 1974
                      as Integrity Processing Series 6R

                    HCO B 10 July 1964, "Overts-Order of
                    Effectiveness in Processing" remains
                            as originally issued.

                            Cancels BTB 9 Dec 72,
                              "Why Overts Work"

                       Integrity Processing Series 6RA


                    EFFECTIVENESS OF OVERTS IN PROCESSING

                  (The data in this Bulletin has been taken
                  from HCO B 10 July 1964. It is useful in
                           Integrity Processing.)


                                 ARC BREAKS

    The commonest cause of failure  in  running  overt  acts  is  "cleaning
cleans" whether or not one is using a meter. The pc who really has  more  to
tell doesn't ARC Break when the Auditor continues to ask  for  one  but  may
snarl and eventually give it up.


    On the other hand leaving an overt touched on the case and  calling  it
clean will cause a future ARC Break with the Auditor.


    "Have you told all?" prevents cleaning a clean. On the unmetered pc one
can see the pc brighten up. On the meter you get a nice fall  if  it's  true
that all is told.


    "Have I not found out  about  something?"  prevents  leaving  an  overt
undisclosed. On the unmetered pc the reaction is a sly flinch. On a  metered
pc it gives a read.


    A pc's protest against a question will also be visible in an  unmetered
pc in a reeling sort of exasperation which  eventually  becomes  a  howl  of
pure bafflement at why the Auditor won't accept the answer that that's  all.
On a meter, protest of a  question  falls  on  being  asked  for:  "Is  this
question being protested?"


    There is no real excuse for ARC Breaking a pc by:

    1.      Demanding more than is there or
    2.      Leaving an overt undisclosed that will later make the pc  upset
        with the Auditor.

                               WHY OVERTS WORK

    Overts give the highest gain in raising cause level  because  they  are
the biggest reason why a person restrains himself and  withholds  self  from
action.


    Man is basically good. But the reactive mind tends to  force  him  into
evil actions.  These  evil  actions  are  instinctively  regretted  and  the
individual tries to refrain from doing anything at all. The  "best"  remedy,
the individual thinks, is to withhold. "If I commit evil  actions,  then  my
best guarantee for not committing is to do nothing whatever." Thus  we  have
the "lazy", inactive person.
Others who try to make an individual  guilty  for  committing  evil  actions
only increase this tendency to laziness.


    Punishment is supposed to bring about inaction. And it  does.  In  some
unexpected ways.


    However, there is also an inversion (a turnabout) where the  individual
sinks below recognition of any  action.  The  individual  in  such  a  state
cannot conceive of any action and  therefore  cannot  withhold  action.  And
thus we have the criminal who can't act really but can only  re-act  and  is
without  any  self  direction.  This  is  why  punishment  does   not   cure
criminality but in actual fact creates it; the individual  is  driven  below
withholding or any recognition of any action.  A  thief's  hands  stole  the
jewel, the thief was merely an innocent spectator to the action of  his  own
hands. Criminals are very sick people physically.


    So there is a level below withholding that an Auditor should  be  alert
to in some pcs, for these "have no withholds" and "have done  nothing".  All
of which, seen through their eyes,  is  true.  They  are  merely  saying  "I
cannot restrain myself" and "I have not willed myself  to  do  what  I  have
done".


    The road out for such a case is the same as that for any other case. It
is just longer. The processes for levels above hold  also  for  such  cases.
But don't be anxious to see a  sudden  return  of  responsibility,  for  the
first owned "done" that this person knows he or she has  done  may  be  "ate
breakfast". Don't disdain such answers in Level II particularly. Rather,  in
such people, seek such answers.


    There is another type of case in all this, just one  more  to  end  the
list. This is the case who never runs O/W  but  "seeks  the  explanation  of
what I did that made it all happen to me".


    This person easily goes into past lives for answers. Their reaction  to
a question about what they've done is to try to find out what they did  that
earned all those motivators. That, of course, isn't running the process  and
the Auditor should be alert for it and stop it when it happens.


    This type of case goes into its extreme on guilt. It dreams  up  overts
to explain why. After most big murders the police routinely have a dozen  or
two people come around and confess. You see, if they had  done  the  murder,
this would explain why they feel guilty.  As  a  terror  stomach  is  pretty
awful grim to live with, one is apt to seek any explanation  for  it  if  it
will only explain it.


    On such cases the same approach as given works, but one should be  very
careful not to let the pc get off overts the pc didn't commit.


    Such a pc (recognizable by the ease they dive into  the  extreme  past)
when being audited off a meter gets more and more  frantic  and  wilder  and
wilder in overts reported.  They  should  get  calmer  under  processing  of
course, but the false overts make them frantic and hectic in a  session.  On
a meter one simply checks for "Have you told me anything beyond what  really
has occurred?" Or "Have you told me any untruths?"


    The observation and meter guides given in this section are used  during
a session when they apply but not systematically  such  as  after  every  pc
answer. These observations and meter guides are used always at  the  end  of
every session on the pcs to whom they apply.

LRH:nt.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1964, 1974 Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED

[The 5 December 1974 reissue of HCO B 10 July 1964, which the  above  HCO  B
cancels, was taken verbatim from HCO B 10 July 1964.]
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              10 DECEMBER 1972
                        Reissued 12 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 10 DECEMBER 1972
                                 SAME TITLE


                        Integrity Processing Series 7


                                FUNDAMENTALS


    The most fundamental thing to know about Integrity Processing is that a
case with withholds will not clear. And the next  most  fundamental  element
to know is that: A CASE WITH WITHHOLDS WILL NOT CLEAR. Perhaps, if  this  is
repeated loud enough and long enough, not only Preclears, but  perhaps  even
Auditors will realize that this  is  an  absolute,  unavoidable  truth,  one
which  can  not  be  overlooked  or  neglected  at  any  time,   under   any
circumstances.


    First of all, what is a withhold? A withhold is a no action  after  the
fact of action in which the individual has done  or  been  an  accessory  to
doing something which is a transgression against some moral code  consisting
of agreements to which the individual has subscribed in order to  guarantee,
with others, the survival of a group with which he is co-acting or  has  co-
acted toward survival.


    Because a withhold is a no action or a no motion  after  doingness,  it
naturally hangs up in time and floats in time due  to  the  actions  or  the
overts which preceded the no action  or  no  motion  of  the  withhold.  The
reactive mind is, therefore, the combined withholds  stocked  up  which  the
individual has against groups from which he feels that  he  is  individuated
but from which he has not separated due  to  the  fact  that  he  has  these
withholds in his bank and also all the combined agreements  toward  survival
of all these groups, from which he  is  not  separate,  and  which  he  uses
reactively to solve problems now without inspection.


    Example: The individual belonged at some time to the Holy Fighters. One
of the mores of this group was that all  should  be  destroyed  who  do  not
accept the Word. The  Holy  Fighters  went  out  on  a  punitive  expedition
against a neighboring tribe who would not  accept  the  Word,  but  accepted
some other belief. There was a great  battle  with  much  killing;  however,
during the battle, the individual took pity upon a helpless  child  and  did
not kill him, but took the child off the field of battle, gave him food  and
drink, and left him, returning, himself, to the battle.


    After the battle was successfully won,  the  Holy  Fighters  had  their
usual service during which all  spoke  of  how  they  had  killed  all  non-
believers. Our individual withheld from the  group  that  he  had  not  only
failed to kill, but had saved the life of a non-believer. Thus we  have  the
no action of the withhold after the overt or action  of  saving  the  child,
all of which added up to a transgression  against  the  mores  of  the  Holy
Fighters.


    Because  of  such  similar  transgressions,  the   individual   finally
individuated from the group of Holy Fighters and  became  a  member  of  the
Board of Directors of the Society for Kindness to Humans, which  itself  had
its own agreements  to  survival  and  with  which  the  individual  agreed;
however, when difficulties or problems  arose,  the  individual  instead  of
treating all with kindness tended to covertly try to destroy all  who  would
not accept the  tenets  of  kindness.  So  he  reactively  was  solving  the
problems of the Society of Kindness  with  a  survival  mores  of  the  Holy
Fighters. Due to all his transgressions and  withholds  of  his  destructive
impulses  while  a  member  of  the  Society  for   Kindness,   he   finally
individuated from this group.
Now he is a member of Anti-Emotions, Incorporated,  but  he  finds  that  he
can't rule out all his emotions, but tends to be  destructive  and  kind  at
the same time. So he is still solving problems not only with  the  mores  of
the Holy Fighters, but with those of the Society  for  Kindness  to  Humans.
And so it goes.


    Processing this individual we will find that he has all these withholds
of overts against the Holy Fighters, the Society  for  Kindness  to  Humans,
and Anti-Emotions, Incorporated. After we have pulled all these  overts,  he
will truly be separate from these groups and no longer reactively use  their
survival mechanisms as solutions to problems.


    Further the action of withholding is one point where the Preclear  does
what the reactive mind does. He withholds his own overts  of  transgressions
against the moral code of a group  in  order  to  avoid  punishment,  thusly
enhance his own survival, and he withholds himself from  the  group  finally
in an effort to avoid committing further overts. So  just  as  the  reactive
mind contains all past survival agreements which are used to solve  problems
threatening the survival of the individual, so does  the  individual  decide
to withhold transgressions, in  order  to  survive  himself,  and  withholds
himself from groups to avoid committing overts.


    Withholding and surviving occur at the same time. So the  communication
bridge between the Preclear and the reactive mind is the withhold.


    The pulling of overts which have been withheld then is the  first  step
towards getting the Preclear to take control of the reactive mind. The  more
withholds he gives up, the more the old survival mechanisms of the  reactive
mind are destroyed.


    Further as a withhold of an overt creates a further overt act  of  not-
know on the group with which one  is  co-acting  toward  survival  along  an
agreed upon moral code, so we are running off all the ignorance created  for
others by an individual which results  in  ignorance  to  himself.  In  this
fashion, we  are  processing  the  individual  up  toward  Native  State  or
Knowingness.


    Therefore, in doing Integrity Processing on a Preclear, you are  really
attacking the whole basis of the reactive mind. It is an activity which  the
Auditor should earnestly and effectively engage  upon.  In  doing  this  the
Auditor always assumes that the Preclear can remember  his  overts  and  can
overwhelm the reactive mind. Just  as  with  the  CCHs  so  with  Processing
Checks,  any  objections  raised  by  the  Preclear  as  regards   Integrity
Processing are only a confusion being thrown up by the  reactive  mind,  but
the individual is really trying to  look  for  what  is  there  despite  the
reactive mind's doing this. This is why any failure  to  pull  an  overt  is
considered a crime against the Preclear. The Auditor in failing to  pull  an
overt has given the reactive mind a win and the Preclear a failure, and  has
further given the Preclear  another  overt  against  the  group  he  is  now
associated with, namely, that of Scientology, because he  has  succeeded  in
withholding from it.


    So in Integrity Processing the Auditor must get the Preclear to  answer
the question without developing meter-dependency.  This  creates  confidence
that the Auditor and the Preclear are really working together  to  overwhelm
the reactive mind.


    If the meter gives an instant read to the  question  then  the  Auditor
uses the E-Meter to assist the Preclear in pulling all  further  overts  and
takes it earlier similar to get an F/N ON THE QUESTION BEING ASKED.


    A stable datum as regards this is that if the  question  reacts,  there
are withholds there or not all  about  a  particular  withhold  was  pulled.
Never allow a Preclear to persuade  you  that  it  is  only  already  pulled
withholds which are still reacting. A  withhold  pulled  will  not  cause  a
question to still react; it can only be that not all about the withhold  was
pulled or that there are further undisclosed withholds on that question,  or
it is a false read (withhold of nothing) in which  case  the  question  will
F/N on false.
DO NOT LEAVE  AN  INTEGRITY  PROCESSING  QUESTION  UNTIL  THE  AUDITOR,  THE
PRECLEAR, THE REACTIVE MIND, AND THE E-METER ARE IN


     ABSOLUTE  AGREEMENT  THAT  THERE  IS  NOTHING  MORE  ON  A  PARTICULAR
QUESTION. THIS WILL BE  RECOGNIZED  BY  THE  EP  OF  F/N  COG  VGIs  ON  THE
QUESTION.


    Remember the E-Meter is not bound by the Auditor's Code. If  it  reacts
on a question, then the Auditor must take that question to full EP  with  an
F/N. A question, having once read,  is  NOT  nulled  to  a  no-read.  It  is
audited to an F/N. Obtaining a read and taking the read to  F/N  depends  on
good Auditor presence and excellence of TRs, Basic Auditing and Metering.


    A Processing Check question must never be left without F/Ning.  If  the
Preclear's intensive is terminating, you  must  complete  that  question  no
matter how many extra hours you have to put in on the Preclear. Do  not  end
session without carrying the question you are working on to EP. Any  failure
to pull an overt is a crime against that Preclear.


    Eliminate all "unkind thought" questions in Integrity  Processing.  Use
"done anything to" type questions. Unkind thoughts are merely  tags  telling
you that the Preclear has  actually  done  something.  Unkind  thoughts  are
merely a mechanism of lessening the overt.


    In pulling overts, be careful that you do not  allow  the  Preclear  to
give you his justifications for having committed  it.  In  allowing  him  to
give you motivators or "reasons why" you are  allowing  him  to  lessen  the
overt.


    You are only interested in what the Preclear has done, not what he  has
heard that others have done. So never allow a Preclear to get off  withholds
to you about others, except in the case where he has been an accessory to  a
criminal act.


    "Other people's overts" are handled by asking the Preclear,  "Have  you
ever done anything like that yourself?"


    Remember that your duty as an Auditor is to simply employ your skill to
obtain a greater decency, ability and integrity on the part of  others.  You
do this by performing well your function of clearing the meter  and  getting
off all overts and withholds. An  Auditor  is  not  an  enforcer  of  public
morals. If an Auditor tries to make  a  Preclear  guilty,  he  is  violating
Clause 15 of the Auditor's Code, which says: "Never  mix  the  processes  of
Scientology with those of various other practices".  Punishment  is  an  old
practice which is not part of our activities in Scientology.  Audit  against
the reality of the Preclear and his moral code and do not try  to  make  him
guilty. The value of any withhold is only the value  the  Preclear  puts  on
it.


    As a case improves, his responsibility level will increase, and if  his
responsibility level is increasing he will get off further,  new  withholds.
If an Auditor is not getting new withholds coming off  a  Preclear,  he  had
better look for a gross error in his auditing. He  either  is  disinterested
and unwilling to help the Preclear, or he is technically unskillful  on  his
TRs, Basic Auditing and the E-Meter, or he does not  have  the  Preclear  in
session or he has withholds himself. Only an  Auditor  with  withholds  will
fail to pull them on others.


    The number of withholds a Preclear has  available  at  any  given  time
depends upon those that are available at that given time.  To  clarify  this
point, assume that all Preclears have the  same  set  number  of  withholds.
Well, the number available within the realm of the Preclear's present  state
of reality and responsibility will naturally vary.  Preclears  with  a  high
reality and responsibility level will  have  more  withholds  available  for
pulling than Preclears with a low reality and responsibility level. This  is
why it is so  important  that  Processing  Checks  be  continued  throughout
auditing. His reality and  responsibility  level  will  increase  throughout
processing bringing to light many new
overts.  If  these  are  not  pulled,  the  Preclear  will  be  forced  into
unintentionally withholding  them  and  his  case  will  bog  down  and  not
progress.


    There are prepared Integrity Processing Forms to assist you in  pulling
withholds. In using these, an Auditor must never, never omit a  question  on
any of these, but he  can add questions to them. Then there are  specialized
Integrity Processing Forms tailored  to  fit  the  professional  or  present
activities of the Preclear, and special forms to  cover  the  transgressions
of the Preclear against the moral code of any group with which  he  has  co-
acted. On the latter, as a person in one lifetime only has belonged to  many
different groups, you  can  see  the  tremendous  possibility  of  Integrity
Processing applied to the moral code of all groups on a whole  track  basis.
Particular attention must be paid to the  present  group  with  whom  he  is
currently co-acting, namely Scientology. This is why it is important  to  do
the last two pages* of  the  Basic  Integrity  Processing  Form  and  others
specifically related to the subject of  Scientology  as  applicable  on  all
Scientologists first, because in the first place he is  expecting  something
to help him against which he has overts and to that degree these overts  are
overts against himself as they will, if not pulled, prevent him  from  being
helped, and in the second place  overts  against  current  groups  are  most
important,  then  overts  committed  in  this  lifetime,  and  then   overts
committed on the track, the reason being that he  is  still  connected  with
these current groups and with this lifetime.


    Integrity Processing is a most fruitful source  of  cognition,  because
you are pulling off the Preclear's not-knows on  the  Third  Dynamic,  which
have kept others in ignorance and himself in stupidity.  Besides  this,  you
tremendously increase the Preclear's ability to communicate. And on  top  of
all this you make a Preclear much easier to audit. And if all his  withholds
are pulled, he can be cleared.


    Pretty good gains to work for?


    Well then, let's get busy.


                                  Compiled from LRH briefings
                                  and materials by
                                  Lt. Comdr. Brian Livingston


                                  Reissued as BTB
                                  by Flag Mission 1234


                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow


                                  Authorized by AVU
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BL:mh.rdjh
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED







 [* "The last two pages" refers to questions 71 to 86  of  BTB  24  December
1972R, Issue I, Revised and Reissued  18  July  1974,  Integrity  Processing
Form 1, The Basic Integrity List, page 296.]
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                             11 DECEMBER 1972RA
                             Revised 13 May 1975
Remimeo


                      Integrity Processing Series 8R, 4


                           THE TECH AND ETHICS OF
                            INTEGRITY PROCESSING

                  (Compiled from a Briefing to 3rd Mate and
                   4th Mate Flag given by L. RON HUBBARD.)



    HCO is primarily interested in JUSTICE.


    The method of justice practiced in the 17th and 18th Centuries  was  to
catch the offenders and hang them, thus keeping the countryside "quiet".


    Although useful as a  method  of  quieting  things  down,  however,  it
doesn't do people any good to be hung! You will find  the  remedy  expressed
in this rule:


    WHEN YOU GIVE INTEGRITY PROCESSING TO  A  PERSON  WITHOUT  FINDING  THE
EARLIER BASIC, YOU HANG THEM.


    If you can't chase back an Integrity Processing question to an F/N  you
are going to get continuous Ethics trouble from that  person  from  then  on
until it is remedied.


    When you give  a  guy  Integrity  Processing  and  it  doesn't  produce
anything and the needle is clean you  should  indicate  that  the  Integrity
Processing was unnecessary. You will probably get an F/N.


    HCO's interest in someone is normally in what is going on, what  is  he
up to NOW. So one  tends  to  omit  to  ask  how  come  this  guy  has  been
committing overts for the past two-and-a-half years-the same ones-and it  is
still going on? Back  in  that  earlier  zone  is  one  hell  of  an  overt,
continuous overts against Scientology or LRH. So  what  is  it?  You  should
trace it back and you could find a dilly!


    It's the EARLIEST item available on that chain that will get  the  F/N.
And remember that overts of  Omission  are  always  preceded  by  overts  of
Commission. So you should ask  yourself,  "How  come  all  these  overts  of
omission?" There's an earlier overt of commission, you can be sure.


    This gives us another rule:


    IF YOU CANNOT F/N A QUESTION, YOU HAVEN'T GOT IT.


    Now it could be  the  buttons  are  out  (invalidate,  protest,  action
unnecessary). Did you know you can beef up a TA (send it up high)  by  doing
an unnecessary action? It acts somewhat like forcing a wrong item on  a  pc.
It puts him on a protest, a rejection and an  effort  to  stop  the  action.
That is where a lot of the unpopularity of earlier techniques stems from.


    Of the rudiments ARC Break,  problem,  withhold,  Integrity  Processing
specializes in overts and withholds.  So  the  full  panorama  of  Integrity
Processing buttons is  Ruds  plus  False,  Suppress,  Invalidate,  Evaluate,
Protest, Unnecessary. So if the TA goes up during Integrity  Processing  you
should check buttons. If it doesn't handle rapidly and easily revert to  the
L 1RA (Integ Repair List).
IF YOU CAN'T GET AN F/N ON INTEGRITY PROCESSING AND HAVE TO END SESSION  YOU
MUST HAVE A LINE TO QUAL THAT CLEANS IT UP WITHIN 24 HOURS.


    Every time an Integrity Processing action won't fly it has got to be  a
24-hour urgent repair. The Integrity Processing Repair List consists of  the
ruds and buttons.


    People ARC Break with the physical  universe,  with  fellow  men,  feel
wronged in some way and have to take it out on somebody, and so  commit  the
overt. But the somebody they attack is not the source  of  the  upset.  They
misidentify the source. If their think was straight they would  be  able  to
see what the score was and have no charge on it.


    An overt therefore is preceded by an ARC Break, and you  will  find  an
ARC Break is the result of a problem.


    So each time you don't take a question to F/N you run up against  this.
This gives another way for them to get unpopular. But if it didn't F/N,  you
also know it was necessary to give the person Integrity Processing!


    If you give a person Integrity  Processing  and  you  see  a  trail  of
catastrophes in that person's  wake  afterwards  you  know  it  didn't  fly.
Similarly a person who makes huge overts out of every little  action,  which
is in essence self-invalidation, has behind that somewhere a huge  overt-big
enough to set the police of several galaxies after them !


    If it doesn't F/N you haven't got it!


                        THE E-METER AND THE CRIMINAL


    The joker in all this is that the E-Meter reads on Reality. So you  can
have a guy who reads on none of your questions, but you find  out  the  next
day he had done exactly what you asked him.  Yet  it  didn't  read!  A  real
criminal just doesn't read on having killed his grandmother  in  cold  blood
five minutes before the Processing. Even if he admits it  it  doesn't  read!
But a real criminal won't  clear and  won't   F/N.  Occasionally  they  will
R/S.


    You have to handle it on a gradient of reality.  "Why  wasn't  that  an
overt?" is one way you could try. He would at first  be  very  surprised  at
the very thought of it being an  overt.  But  you  could  get  a  stream  of
justifications off. Another way is to magnify the overt. You  can  use  that
on a "no-overt" case.


    The Tech of it belongs in the field of auditing.


    Anytime Integrity Processing is done the session reports must  go  into
the pc folder otherwise the C/S can make an error in C/Sing because  of  the
omitted data.


    One does not do Integrity Processing in the middle  of  other  auditing
rundowns. The action therefore requires C/S clearance.

                              HCO AND CASE GAIN
                          (See HCO PL 20 July 1970,
                         Cases and Morale of Staff")

    The percentage of people who have case gain will be proportional to the
level of morale in your Org. So it is of interest to HCO to ask the C/S  how
many no-case-gain cases he has (Pile 4), trace them down and  isolate  them.
The names of those not doing well (Piles 2 and 3) should also be  known  and
the numbers so you can make sure the  greater  percentage  is  getting  good
case gain.


HCO can get trouble stemming from lack of staff case progress. For  instance
you find an Exec giving excuses for not doing his job. It can be  due  to  a
no-case-gain under him enturbulating seniors and associates. They  in  turn,
not recognizing him as the source of
the enturbulation, buy the stops and the "can't  be  dones"  and  find  some
other excuse as to why not to do their  job.  Recognize  that  when  someone
dumps his hat on you he has overts, man!

    An Executive instead of reporting that people don't want to work in his
division should be asking,  "How  come  they  don't  want  to  work  in  the
division?"


    Things will get better to the degree that such  cases  producing  stops
and "can'ts" have a line for them to be handled on.


    Begin a campaign to get all these cases winning.


    If there is any query as to  which  of  the  four  categories  of  case
folders (per HCO PL 20 July 70) a person belongs on,  it  goes  on  the  one
lower. For instance a category, Pile 2, queried  as  to  status  immediately
becomes Pile 3.


    Pile 4 cases are given Integrity Processing. Such processing is however
not limited to such cases.


    It is extremely valuable processing to raise the cause level of  staff,
students and others.


                                  Compiled from LRH briefings
                                  and materials by
                                  Lt. Comdr. Brian Livingston


                                  Reissued as BTB
                                  by Flag Mission 1234


                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow


                                  Authorized by AVU
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BL:mh.rdjh
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              12 DECEMBER 1972
                        Reissued 10 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 12 DECEMBER 1972
                                 SAME TITLE




                        Integrity Processing Series 9



                                  RUDIMENTS


    All Integrity Processing must be done in Model Session form with a  rud
flown at start of session if no F/N.


    This is because wildly out rudiments can cause the Pc to be so far  out
of session that the meter will  not  read  on  charged  questions.  This  is
particularly true in the presence of weak TRs.


                                  Compiled from LRH briefings
                                  and materials by
                                  Lt. Comdr. Brian Livingston


                                  Reissued as BTB
                                  by Flag Mission 1234


                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow


                                  Authorized by AVU
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BL:mh.rdjh
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 13 DECEMBER 1972R
                     REVISED & REISSUED 1 NOVEMBER 1974
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                           BTB OF 13 DECEMBER 1972
                                 SAME TITLE


                       Integrity Processing Series 10R


                       INTEGRITY PROCESSING QUESTIONS
                                MUST BE F/Ned


    The main danger of Integrity Processing is not probing a person's  past
but failing to do so thoroughly.


    When you leave an Integrity Processing question "live" and go on to the
next one, you set up a nasty situation that  will  have  repercussions.  The
person may not immediately react. But the least that will happen is that  he
will be more difficult to audit in the future, and will go  out  of  session
more easily. More violently, a  pc  who  has  had  an  Integrity  Processing
question left unflat may leave the session and  do  himself  or  Scientology
considerable mischief.


    About the most unkind thing you could do to a person would be to  leave
an Integrity Processing question unflat and go on to the  next  one.  Or  to
fail to obtain an F/N on withholds in the  rudiments  and  go  on  with  the
session.


    One girl, being audited, was left unflat on a  withhold  question.  The
Auditor blithely went on to the next  question.  The  girl  went  out  after
session, and told everyone she knew the most vicious lies she  could  create
about the immoral conduct of Scientologists. She wrote a  stack  of  letters
to people she knew out of town, telling gruesome tales of sexual orgies.  An
alert Scientologist heard the rumors, rapidly traced them back, got hold  of
the girl, sat her down and checked auditing and found  the  unflat  withhold
question. The withhold? Sexual misdemeanors. Once that was pulled, the  girl
hastily raced about correcting all her previous efforts to discredit.


    A man had been a stalled case for about  a  year.  He  was  violent  to
audit. The special question was finally asked, "What withhold  question  was
left unflat on  you?"  It  was  found  and  handled.  After  that  his  case
progressed again.

    The mechanisms of this are many. The reactions of the pc are many.  The
summation of it is, when an Integrity Processing question is left unflat  on
a pc and thereafter ignored, the consequences are numerous.

                                 THE REMEDY

    The prevention of Integrity Processing  being  left  unflat  is  easily
accomplished:

    1.      Develop excellent TRs and Basic Auditing.
    2.      Know the E-Meter.
    3.      Work only with an approved E-Meter.
    4.      Know the various bulletins on Integrity Processing.
    5.      Get off your own withholds so that you  won't  avoid  those  in
        others.
    6.      Apply correct Integrity Processing procedure  and  handle  each
        reading question to an honest
      F/N on that question.


LRH:nt.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1972, 1974                             Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 14 DECEMBER 1972R
                          REVISED 12 FEBRUARY 1973
                          REISSUED 1 NOVEMBER 1974
                         (Only change is signature.)
Remimeo

                       Integrity Processing Series 11R

                            GENERALITIES WON'T DO


    The most efficient  way  to  upset  a  pc  is  to  leave  an  Integrity
Processing  question  unflat.  This  is  remedied  by  taking  each  reading
question to an F/N on the question.


    The best way to "miss" an Integrity Processing question is to  let  the
pc indulge in generalities or "I thought ...."


    A withhold given as "Oh, I got mad at them lots of  times,"  should  be
pulled down to when and where and the first time "you got mad" and  finally,
"What did you do to them just before that?" Then earlier similar if no F/N.


    The pc who withholds  somebody  else's  withholds  and  gives  them  as
answers is a card. But he isn't helped when the auditor lets him do it.


    Situation: You ask the pc for a withhold about Joe. The pc who says, "I
heard that Joe . . . ," should be asked right there, "What have you done  to
Joe? You. Just you." And it turns out he stole Joe's  last  blonde.  But  if
the auditor had let this pc go on and on about how the pc had heard how  Joe
was this or that, the session would have gone on and on and the Tone Arm  up
and up.


    We have pcs who use "withholds" to spread all manner of  lies.  We  ask
this pc, "Have you ever done anything to the Org?" The pc says,  "Well,  I'm
withholding that I heard . . . ," or the pc  says,  "Well,  I  thought  some
bitter thoughts about the Org." Or the pc says, "I was critical of  the  Org
when . . . ," and we don't  sail  in  and  get  WHAT  THE  PC  DID,  we  can
comfortably stretch a 5-minute item to a session or two.


    If the pc "heard" and the pc "thought" and the pc "said" in  answer  to
an Integrity Processing question, the pc's reactive bank is  really  saying,
"I've got a crashing big withhold and if I can keep  on  fooling  around  by
giving critical thoughts, rumours, and what others  did,  you'll  never  get
it." And if he gets  away  with  it,  the  auditor  has  missed  a  withhold
question.


    We only want to know what the pc did, when he  did  it,  what  was  the
first time he did it and what he did just before that,  and  we'll  nail  it
every time.


                            THE IRRESPONSIBLE PC

    If you want to get withholds off an "irresponsible  pc"  you  sometimes
can't ask what the pc did or withheld and get a meter reaction.


    This problem has bugged us for some time; I finally got very bright and
realized that no matter whether the pc thought it was a crime or not, he  or
she will answer up on "don't know" versions as follows:


    Situation: "What have you done to your husband?" Pc's answer,  "Nothing
bad." E-Meter reaction, nul. Now we know this pc, through our  noticing  she
is critical of her  husband,  has  overts  on  him.  But  she  can  take  no
responsibility for her own acts.
But she can  take responsibility for his not knowing. She is making  certain
of that.


    So we ask, "What have you done that your husband doesn't know about?"


    And it takes an hour for her to spill it all, the quantity is so great.
For the question releases the floodgates. The Meter bangs around.


    And with these withholds off, her responsibility comes up and  she  can
take responsibility on the items.


    This applies to any zone or area or terminal of Integrity Processing.


    Situation: We are getting a lot of "I thought", "I heard", "They said",
"They did" in answer to a  question.  We  take  the  terminal  or  terminals
involved and put them in this blank:

   "What have you done that ______(doesn't) (don't) know about?"

    And we can get the major overts that lay under the blanket of "How  bad
everyone is but me."

    This prevents you missing an Integrity Processing question. It's a  bad
crime to do so. This will shorten  the  labour  involved  in  getting  every
question flat.


    And if your pc is withholdy you can  insert  this  "Have  I  missed  an
Integrity Processing question on you?" while doing the processing.


    Always clear up what was missed.


    A pc can be very upset by  reason  of  a  missed  Integrity  Processing
question. Keep them going up, not down.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH: nt.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1973, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 15 DECEMBER 1972R
                           REVISED 1 NOVEMBER 1974
Remimeo


                       Integrity Processing Series 12R


                              WITHHOLDS, MISSED
                                 AND PARTIAL


    I don't know exactly how to get this across to you except to ask you to
be brave, squint up your eyes and plunge.


    I don't appeal to reason. Only to faith at the moment. When you have  a
reality on this, nothing will shake it and you'll no longer  fail  cases  or
fail in life. But, at the moment, it may not seem reasonable.  So  just  try
it, do it well and day will dawn at last.


    What are these natterings, upsets, ARC Breaks, critical  tirades,  lost
students,  ineffective  motions?  They  are  restimulated  but   missed   or
partially missed withholds. If I could just teach you that and  get  you  to
get a good reality on that in  your  own  auditing,  your  activities  would
become smooth beyond belief.

                                  ________


    It is true that ARC Breaks, present time  problems  and  withholds  all
keep a session from occurring. And we must watch them and clear them.


    But behind all these is  another  button,  applicable  to  each,  which
resolves each one. And  that  button  is  the  restimulated  but  missed  or
partially missed withhold.

                                  ________


    Life itself has imposed this button on us.


    If you know about people or are supposed to  know  about  people,  then
these people expect, unreasonably, that you know them through and through.


    Real knowledge to the average person is only this: a knowledge  of  his
or her withholds! That, horribly enough, is the high tide of  knowledge  for
the man in the street. If you know his withholds, if  you  know  his  crimes
and acts, then you are smart. If you know  his  future  you  are  moderately
wise. And so we are persuaded toward mind reading and fortune telling.


    All wisdom has this trap for those who would be wise.


    Egocentric  man  believes  all  wisdom  is  wound  up  in  knowing  his
misdemeanors.


    IF any wise man represents himself as wise and fails to discover what a
person has done, that person goes into an  antagonism  or  other  misemotion
toward the wise man. So they hang those who restimulate and yet who  do  not
find out about their withholds.


    This is an incredible piece of craziness. But it is observably true.


    This is the WILD ANIMAL REACTION that makes Man a cousin to the beasts.
A good auditor can understand this. A bad one will stay  afraid  of  it  and
won't use it.

                                  ________


    "Have I missed a withhold on you?" can be used in Integrity  Processing
if the preclear gets upset or critical during session.

                                  ________


    Any ARC Broken pc should be asked, "What  withhold  have  I  missed  on
you?" Or, "What have I failed to find out about you?"  Or,  "What  should  I
have known about you?"

                                  ________


    An Integrity Processing Specialist who cannot read a meter is dangerous
because he or she will miss withholds and the pc may become very upset.

                                  ________


    Use this as a stable datum: If the person is upset, somebody failed  to
find out what that person was sure they would find out.

                                  ________


    A missed withhold is a should have known.

                                  ________


    The only reason anyone has ever  left  Scientology  is  because  people
failed to find out about them.

                                  ________


    This is valuable data. Get a reality on it.


                                       L. RON HUBBARD
                                       Founder


LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 16 DECEMBER 1972
                          REISSUED 7 NOVEMBER 1974
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                           BTB OF 16 DECEMBER 1972
                                 SAME TITLE


                       Integrity Processing Series 13


                                 HELP THE PC


    In general, when getting rudiments in or getting off  missed  withholds
or invalidations, help the pc by guiding his attention against the needle.


    This is quite  simple.  The  auditor  asks  the  question,  the  needle
instantly reacts, the pc (as he or she usually does) looks  puzzled  if  the
auditor says "It reacts." The pc thinks it over. As he or she  is  thinking,
the auditor will see the same reaction on the  needle.  Softly  the  auditor
says "That" or "There" or "What's that you're looking at?" As the  pc  knows
what he or she is looking at at that instant, the thing can be dug up.


    This is auditor co-operation, not triumph.


    Most often the pc does not know what it is that reacts as only unknowns
react. Therefore an  auditor's  "There"  when  the  needle  twitches  again,
before the pc has answered, co-ordinates with whatever the pc is looking  at
and thus it can be spotted and revealed by the pc. This is  only  done  when
the pc comm lags for a few seconds.


    Remember, the pc is always willing to reveal. He or  she  doesn't  know
What to reveal. Therein lies the difficulty. Pcs get driven out  of  session
when asked to reveal something yet do not know what to reveal.


    By the auditor's saying "There" or "What's that?" quietly each time the
needle reacts newly, the pc is led to discover what should be revealed.


    Auditors and pcs get into a games condition in Integrity Processing and
rudiments only when the auditor refuses this help to the pc.


    New auditors routinely believe that  in  Integrity  Processing  the  pc
knows the answer and won't give it. This is an error. If  the  pc  knew  all
the answer, it wouldn't react on the meter.


    Old-timers have found out that only if they  steer  by  repeated  meter
reaction, giving the pc "There" or "What's that?" can the pc  answer  up  on
most rudiments questions, missed withholds and so on.


    But don't use steering to harass the pc,  or  cut  his  comm,  or  draw
attention to the auditor.


    This is the only use of reads other than instant reads on the E-Meter.


    Help the pc. He doesn't  know. Otherwise the needle would never react.

LRH:nt.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright �1972, 1974  Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 17 DECEMBER 1972
                          REISSUED 7 NOVEMBER 1974
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                           BTB OF 17 DECEMBER 1972
                                 SAME TITLE


                       Integrity Processing Series 14


                                 HAVINGNESS


    All valences are circuits are valences.


    Circuits key out with knowingness.


    This is the final definition of havingness.


    Havingness is the concept of being able to reach. No-havingness is  the
concept of not being able to reach.


    A withhold makes one feel he or she cannot reach.  Therefore  withholds
are what cut havingness down and made runs  on  havingness  attain  unstable
gains. In the presence of withholds havingness sags.


    As soon as a withhold  is  pulled,  ability  to  reach  is  potentially
restored but  the  pc  often  does  not  discover  this.  It  requires  that
havingness be run to get the benefit of having pulled most withholds.


    Therefore  havingness  may  be  run  in  conjunction   with   Integrity
Processing but may NOT be used to hide or obscure the  fact  of  failure  to
F/N an Integrity Form question.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder



LRH: nt.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              18 DECEMBER 1972R
                             Revised 13 May 1975
Remimeo
                         (Revised to omit 1st para)



                       Integrity Processing Series 15R


                       ASPECTS OF INTEGRITY PROCESSING


    Integrity Processing is a specialized type of auditing, and it takes  a
lot of skill and at times some courage to do it well. Auditors must  not  be
kind nor yet unkind. This does not mean that you  steer  a  lukewarm  middle
course between kindness and unkindness. Neither of these two impostors  have
anything to do with it. You just go in and audit,  you  go  in  to  find-and
that means dig for-OVERTS. If you go in with  Pc's  needle  clean  and  your
questioning can get that needle to react, then you are winning.


    The success of an Auditor can be measured by the extent to which he can
get reactions on the needle and then cleaning those reactions  getting  more
reactions and cleaning those and so on. The  skilled  Auditor  gets  to  the
root of the trouble and clears up  a  whole  batch  of  overts  at  once  by
handling chains of overts to F/N.


    Integrity Processing is done in Model Session. The beginning  rudiments
are put in and by the time you start the body of the session, in  this  case
the Integrity Processing, the Pc should have an F/N. The next  thing  is  to
tell the Pc that you are going to help him to clean  up,  and  really  clean
up, the questions on the Form  that  you  are  using.  REMEMBER  IT  IS  THE
QUESTION YOU ARE GOING TO CLEAN-NOT THE NEEDLE. You've already got  a  clean
needle and you could probably keep it from reading on questions  by  bad  TR
1, failure to dig, or just sheer bad auditing.


    The next action is to announce the first question that you are going to
handle, at the same time watching the meter for any read on  first  calling.
It can be important to groove in the question. There are a variety  of  ways
to do this, e.g. ask what the  question  means.  What  period  or  time  the
question covers. What activities would be included. Where the  Pc  has  been
that might be something to do with the question. If  any  other  people  are
likely to be involved. In other words, you are steering the  Pc's  attention
to various parts of his bank and getting him to  have  a  preliminary  look.
When this has been done using very good TR 1,  you  give  him  the  question
again. A small tick may now have developed into a real LF or  BD.  You  take
your Pc's answer and get the specifics. If he gives  you  a  general  answer
you ask him for a specific  time  (or  a  specific  example).  DON'T  ACCEPT
MOTIVATORS. If he gives you a motivator you say, "OK, but what  did  you  do
there?" and you want something before the motivator.  Example:  Pc:  "I  got
mad at him because he kicked my foot." Aud: "What had  you  done  before  he
kicked your foot?" In this case the Pc is giving an overt,  "I  got  mad  at
him," but in fact he is cunningly selling the motivator  "He  kicked  me  in
the foot." So the rule here is, "Go earlier than the  motivator."  Similarly
you don't accept criticisms, unkind thoughts, explanations.  You  want  what
the Pc has done and you want the Time, Place, Form and Event.


    When you have succeeded in this you don't leave it there. You  ask  for
an earlier time he had done something like it and you  keep  going  earlier.
What you are after is the earliest time he stole, hit  somebody,  got  angry
with a Pc or whatever is his "crime". Get the  earliest  one  and  you  will
find that the others will blow off like thistledown.


    Keep a sly eye on your meter and you can tell when you  are  in  a  hot
area. Use it to help you to know where to dig, but don't  use  it  to  steer
the Pc at this stage. This
encourages laziness on the part of the Pc. You want him  in  there  foraging
about and digging up his bank in the process.


    Having once gotten a read on the question, the question is not  further
checked on the meter. One simply follows  the  chain  back  earlier  similar
(same chain). Use standard Integrity Processing procedure until  an  F/N  is
obtained with cognition and VGIs.


    If you do this properly you will have a well satisfied Pc.  If  he  ARC
breaks then you have missed something, so  pull  your  missed  withholds.  A
rising TA is a clue to something missed or  a  bypassed  F/N.  If  Pc  isn't
happy-very happy-at the end of a question then you  have  missed  something.
Pcs will tell you a  hundred  and  one  things  that  are  wrong  with  your
auditing, the D of P's instruction, the form  of  the  question,  etc.,  but
they all add up to the same thing-something has been missed.


    One word of warning. If you leave a question unflat, mark  it  on  your
Auditor's Report and TELL YOUR PC it isn't flat. It is very bad practice  to
end session on a question without first F/Ning that question.


    Good digging.


                                  Compiled from LRH briefings and materials


                                  Reissued as BTB by
                                  Flag Mission 1234


                                  Revised by
                                  W/O Ron Shafran, CS-4


                                  Approved by
                                  Board of Issues
                                  Commodore's Staff Aides
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:RS:AL:MG:BL:clb.rd
Copyright �1972, 1974, 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               6 JUNE 1968 RA
                             Revised 13 May 1975

Remimeo
               (Cancels HCO B 6 June 68, "Sec Checking Info",
             and BTB 19 Dec 72, Integrity Processing Series 16,
                 "Auditing Errors in Integrity Processing".)



                      Integrity Processing Series 16RA



                          INTEGRITY PROCESSING INFO


1.    Use the question as a guide  for digging, not as a rote question.

2.    Follow  each  non-reading   question  with  suppress  and  leave  each
    reading question only when it has been taken to EP (per HCO  B  13  Dec
    72R, Integrity Processing Series 10R, "Integrity  Processing  Questions
    Must Be F/Ned"). If suppression is found, start the cycle over with the
    question itself after suppress is clean. Realize that withholds  exist,
    that they can be suppressed and  that  they  can  be  restimulated  and
    pulled. Once you have EP, however, don't recheck the question.

3.    Suppress is always asked "repetitively" and not as a "fast check".

4.    An R/S means CRIMES that MUST be pulled. A sporadic R/S can be  turned
    on full by varying the question that produced it; the R/S  will  become
    wider and more chronic as the exact crime is approached. When the crime
    is found the R/S will become very pronounced, and then  vanish.  That's
    CRIMES, not "failed to wash the car".

5.    A DR (Dirty Read) is not an R/S but can sometimes turn into an R/S  by
    probing if a crime is present. It is noted on the worksheet as  a  "DR"
    though, never as an R/S.

6.    The specific details  of  each  misdeed  must  be  gotten.  Don't  buy
    generalized overts, motivators and justifications.

7.    You still use a comm cycle. Avoid heavy accusation.

8.    ARC Breaks must be clean-you can't audit over an ARC Break.

9.    Check for missed withholds every few questions.

10.   Clean up the Integrity Processing Form at the end with such  questions
    as ''l/2 truth" and "Have you gotten away with anything?" etc.

11.   Follow questions with "Have you told me more than was there?" on a  Pc
    who tends to dub in overts or motivators.

12.   Limit the Pc to this life if he takes up running track  in  an  effort
    to avoid this life offenses.

13.   Clean up any DN as soon  as  it  appears  by  checking  for  a  missed
    withhold or getting all? of the one you're on.

14.   Watch the Pc's indicators, e.g. for signs of missed withholds.
    15.     Keep track of the TA position during Integrity Processing. If a
    question sends the TA higher and if it then remains  higher,  something
    was missed on that question.

16.   Pursue each chain to basic.

17.   Pat "No's" can be handled by asking for overwhelmingly  large  overts,
    e.g. "Have you robbed any banks?"  (Murder  technique)  or  by  reverse
    questions such as "Tell me about when you have not stolen something."

18.   A question that reads sporadically  isn't  quite  the  right  one  and
    needs to be varied.

19.   Keep aware of the needle-especially when a question is  first  called.
    Also, questions sometimes will show a need to  be  compartmented,  e.g.
    "Have you ever stolen (read)  anything?"  Here  the  read  on  "stolen"
    should be pursued. A Pc with a known withhold can have a prior read and
    not an instant one-this is something to watch for.

20.   Keep your TR 1 in. Otherwise questions will not read due  to  lack  of
    Auditor impingement.

21.   Keep your TR 2 in. Otherwise the Pc will feel his answer has not  been
    accepted and it can put a Pc on a withhold of nothing.

22.   Help the Pc give a withhold he's having trouble  presenting.  One  way
    is by having him tell you what subject it's  about  or  "part  of  it",
    another is by use of the overwhelmingly large  overt  approach:  "Well,
    did you murder someone?"

23.   Cut any natter line, pin down the  critical  thoughts  and  motivators
    and get the prior overt. The person getting Integrity  Processing  must
    not be allowed to sit and natter about a person or an Org, etc.

24.   A person who has a valid EP on an Integrity Processing  Form  has  the
    whole form ended off. It's the subject of the Integrity List which EPs,
    not just one question.

25.   Beware of a "false read",  which  is  thinking  something  read  which
    didn't. Protest can then give you  a  read.  Clean  up  questions  with
    "Protest", "Suppress",  "Inval"  buttons  where  the  Pc  says  there's
    nothing there. Then if it still reads  on  check,  there  is  something
    there. False reads (saying something  read  which  really  didn't)  can
    wreck a case. Can also check for demanding a withhold he doesn't have.

26.   Make sure you get the question answered-question: "Did you  steal  the
    tools from the tool shed?" is not answered by "I  have  a  thing  about
    keys."


                                        Reissued as BTB by
                                        Flag Mission 1234

                                        Revised by
                                        W/O Ron Shafran
                                        CS-4

                                  Approved by
                                  Commodore's Staff Aides
                                  Board of Issues
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
BDCS:RS:MH:AL:nt.rd
Copyright � 1968,1974, 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              23 DECEMBER 1972R
                             Revised 13 May 1975
Remimeo
                     (Cancels BTB 23 Dec 72, same title,
                     Integrity Processing Series 20, and
               BTB 20 Dec 72, Integrity Processing Series 17,
             "Sequence and Use of Integrity Processing Forms".)



                       Integrity Processing Series 17R



                         C/Sing INTEGRITY PROCESSING


    Integrity Processing as auditing is  C/Sed.


    The C/S ensures Integrity Processing is not entered into a  Pc  pgm  in
the middle of another rundown or auditing action. When required  it  may  be
entered into a pgm at a suitable rest  point  but  any  current  process  or
rundown in progress on the Pc would be completed first. The C/S  should  not
use this to unduly delay Integrity Processing when  required,  as  a  person
withholding overts will not make gains until those overts have been pulled.


    The Auditor  must  be  qualified  as  a  Hubbard  Integrity  Processing
Specialist. This is  a  new  tech.  Its  practitioners  must  be  specialist
trained.


    Standard C/Sing  rules  apply.  In  addition  the  C/S  looks  for  the
following key points.

    1.      Any non-sequitur F/N on some other subject. Ensures  that  each
        question is F/Ned on the subject being asked  about.  This  is  the
        primary thing the C/S inspects.


    2.      Check that each reading question was taken to an F/N.


    3.      Check that any R/Ses were recorded clearly  and  noted  at  the
        front of Pc folder for future use.


    4.      Ensure that an Integrity Processing Repair List (L1RA) is  used
        if session ends with no F/N or Pc at all upset or gets sick shortly
        after  Integrity  Processing.  Examiner  24  Hour  Rule   must   be
        rigorously applied.

    No. 1 above is of prime importance. Don't permit Auditors  to  go  into
some unusual solution such as checking the question after it has been  taken
to F/N. That could wreck a case. The Auditor simply audits, keeps the Pc  on
the right chain going earlier as necessary to an F/N.  It  is  the  C/S  who
checks to see that it was in fact the question being asked that F/Ned.  This
is done by checking for any non-sequitur answers that F/Ned  on  some  other
subject.


    If a person falls on his head after an Integrity Processing session  an
L1RA is given. However an FES  to  find  missing  questions  that  F/Ned  on
something else is done.


    The whole essence of this is contained in F/Ning  every  item;  getting
question asked to F/N, not some  other;  Integrity  Processing  Repair  List
LIRA; fines  for  missing  withholds;  and  Expanded  Dianetics  for  R/Sers
(revealing and recording R/Ses and R/Sing statements for later  use  in  Exp
Dianetics). This is what has made this a major new tech that gives  fabulous
case gains too.
It is the duty of the  C/S  to  ensure  the  tech  is  known  and  correctly
applied.


                                  Compiled from LRH briefings and  materials
                                  by
                                  Lt. Comdr. Brian Livingston

                                        Reissued as BTB by
                                        Flag Mission 1234

                                        Revised by
                                        W/O Ron Shafran, CS-4

                                  Approved by
                                  Commodore's Staff Aides
                                  Board of Issues
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:RS:AL:MG:BL: clb.rd
Copyright � 1972,1974, 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              21 DECEMBER 1972
                         Reissued 1 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 21 DECEMBER 1972
                                 SAME TITLE



                       Integrity Processing Series 18



                      FORMULATING INTEGRITY PROCESSING
                                  QUESTIONS


    Withholds add up to overts, secrecies, individuation; they  add  up  to
games conditions and a lot more things than just O/W.


    Although we call  them  withholds  we're  really  asking  a  person  to
straighten out his interpersonal  relationships  with  other  terminals  and
groups.


    Our normal Integrity Processing is addressed to the  individual  versus
the society or his family or group because it's what people  would  consider
reprehensible that makes a withhold.  That  is  the  basic  center  line  of
Integrity Processing, transgressions against the mores of the group.


    You can have a special  mores  between  the  individual  and  different
groups, between the son and the mother, between the husband  and  the  wife,
between the staff member and the organization, or between  the  Auditor  and
the Preclear (to which the Auditor Integrity Processing Form is directed).


    It's a moral code that you are processing one way or the other.  You're
straightening out somebody on the "now  I'm  supposed  to's"  against  which
they  have  transgressed.  And  having  so   transgressed   they   now   are
individuated. If their individuation is  too  obsessive  they  snap  in  and
become the terminal and can assume the characteristics of that person.


    In dealing with this you go straight to the person's handling of masses
and changes of spaces or into his  most  confused  motional  areas  (not  e-
motional).


    A person has been a recluse and stayed inside a house ever since he was
20. You don't start running houses in his  Integrity  Processing.  You  find
what area he was in before he was 20. Staying in the house is a solution  to
something. We find an area of considerable activity that lies prior  to  the
difficulty and then run Integrity Processing on that area.


    We find there was one boarding school  he  absolutely  detests.  That's
what we handle. Every question would have to do with that  boarding  school.
There are students and boys and instructors and coaches and headmasters  and
buildings and athletic equipment, etc. Write them all down  (you  don't  ask
the Pc) then work out all the types of crimes he might  have  been  able  to
commit against those items. In  this  way  you  compile  a  whole  Integrity
Processing Form to suit the situation.


    Most often one takes the most appropriate issued form and simply adds a
few questions to cover the  special  situation.  You  can  always  add  some
questions but don't omit any. When you want to handle  a  specific  area  or
activity it can be more satisfactory to compile a special form covering  all
the things you think of that he could have done in  that  area  that  he  is
never going to tell anybody.
This is particularly so when the area has its own  special  tight  mores  he
has cut up against and so has individuated himself from  that  area,  cannot
as-is any part of the track and of course gets trapped  in  that  particular
zone and activity.


    Forget is a version of Not Know. So any sensory perceptic  shut-off  is
an effort not to know and you have a target.


    So you can do little special Integrity Processing  Forms  to  go  along
with a special zone of activity and eventually you'll get  a  "What  do  you
know!" There is no use telling him what he has been doing wrong. He  is  too
in the thing to see it. You can see it because you're outside it.


    You just put "Have you ever done anything to_____" to a whole list  and
you've got a formulized method of getting together an  Integrity  Processing
Form.


    A cognition is totally dependent upon a freedom  to  know.  Overts  and
withholds are dedicated to Not Knowingness. It takes  the  guidance  of  the
Integrity Processing Form list of questions to handle this.


    The formula then is to just make a list of all the items you can  think
of that have anything to do with the target and write up a list of  possible
overts against them or questions that call for overts. Has he done  anything
to_____Has  he  interfered  with  anything  about_____etc.   Don't   include
questions that call for motivators or justifications.


    The first rule is-any area or zone of  life  with  which  a  person  is
having difficulty in life, or has had difficulty, is  a  fruitful  area  for
Integrity Processing. You'll find out every time he's got withholds in  that
zone or area.


    The second rule is to break the problem down to  its  most  fundamental
expression. Then write down those nouns associated with it and  those  basic
doingnesses associated with this fundamental expression.  Then  just  phrase
up your processing questions on the basis of "Have you  ever_____"  and  any
other verb you want to put in. "Have you ever done_____"  "_____prevented  "
etc. You don't have to get too fancy as the needle will fall  when  you  get
close to it.


    That area where an  individual  is  having  difficulty  he  is  stupid.
Stupidity is Not Knowingness. Not Knowingness  occurs  through  overts.  But
the overt has to be hidden so it must be an overt which is  withheld.  These
withholds then add up to stupidity, so  of  course  he  has  trouble.  There
isn't anything complicated about it at all.


                                  Compiled from LRH briefings
                                  and materials by
                                  Lt. Comdr. Brian Livingston


                                  Reissued as BTB by
                                  Flag Mission 1234


                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow


                                  Authorized by AVU
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BL:mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              22 DECEMBER 1972R
                             Revised 13 May 1975
Remimeo
C/S
Staff C/S
                       Integrity Processing Series 19R


                            ORDERING PERSONNEL TO
                            INTEGRITY PROCESSING


    Integrity Processing may be required on any Academy student, org  staff
member, or HGC pc where lack of progress,  effectiveness  or  case  gain  is
evident due to overts or withholds from the organization, or where there  is
a possibility of a threat to a Scientology Organization.


    HCO or Executives may request such processing of their  staff  members.
Neither Tech nor Qual are bound by such requests  as  an  FES  could  reveal
that  the  trouble  stems  from  "out  lists"  or  other   matters   needing
correction. They should however take cognizance of such requests and do  all
possible to get the person handled and the  Integrity  Processing  delivered
with minimum delay when warranted.


    Integrity Processing is not punishment in any way. It is auditing, must
be C/Sed, must be delivered by  a  qualified  Hubbard  Integrity  Processing
Specialist and will help the person by giving fabulous case gains when  done
correctly.


                                  Compiled from LRH
                                  briefings and materials

                                        Reissued as BTB by
                                        Flag Mission 1234

                                        Revised by
                                        W/O Ron Shafran
                                        CS-4

                                  Approved by
                                  Commodore's Staff Aides
                                  Board of Issues
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:RS:AL:MG:BL:clb.rd
Copyright � 1972,1974, 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                             24 DECEMBER 1 972R
                                   Issue I
                   Revised & Reissued 18 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 24 DECEMBER 1972
                                   Issue I
                                 SAME TITLE

           (The only revision is on this page, paragraph 1: HCO B
                 5 DEC 72 is revised to read BTB 5 DEC 72.)


                         Integrity Processing Form 1


                          THE BASIC INTEGRITY LIST


For  use  in  Integrity  Processing  by  a  Hubbard   Integrity   Processing
Specialist. See BTB 5 DEC 72 for procedure.

AUDITOR:    PRECLEAR:

ORG:  DATE:

1.    Have you ever lived or worked under an assumed name?    _________
2.    Have you given me your right name?     _________
3.    Are you here for a different purpose than you say? _________
4.    Have you ever stolen anything?    _________
5.    Have you ever forged someone else's signature?     _________
6.    Have you ever blackmailed anybody?     _________
7.    Have you ever done  anything  for  which  you  could  be  blackmailed?
_________
8.    Have you ever smuggled anything?  _________
9.    Have you ever been in prison?     _________
10.   Have you ever indulged in drunkenness? _________
11.   Have you ever done any reckless driving?     _________
12.   Have you ever burglared any place?     _________
13.   Have you ever embezzled money?    _________
14.   Have you ever assaulted anyone?   _________
15.   Have you ever told lies in court? _________
16.   Have you had anything to do with pornography?      _________
17.   Have you ever committed arson?    _________
18.   Have you ever been a drug addict? _________
19.   Have you ever peddled dope? _________
20.   Have you had any dealings with stolen goods? _________
21.   Do you have a police record?      _________
22.   Have you ever raped anyone? _________
23.   Have you ever been involved in an abortion?  _________
24.   Have you ever committed adultery? _________
25.   Have you ever practiced homosexuality? _________
26.    Have  you  ever  had  intercourse  with  a  member  of  your  family?
_________
27.   Have you ever been sexually unfaithful?      _________
28.   Have you ever made a practice of sexual perversion?     _________
29.   Have you ever slept with someone you shouldn't have?    _________
30.   Have you ever committed culpable homicide?   _________
31.   Have you ever bombed anything?    _________
32.   Have you ever murdered anyone?    _________
33.   Have you ever kidnapped anyone?   _________
34.   Have you ever traded illegally?   _________
35.   Have you ever betrayed anyone for money?     _________
36.   Have you ever threatened anyone with a firearm?    _________
37.   Have you been in illegal possession of firearms?   _________
38.   Have you ever been paid for giving evidence? _________
39.    Have  you  ever  destroyed  something  belonging  to  someone   else?
_________
40.   Have you ever been a spy for an organization?      _________
41.   Have you ever been an informer?   _________
42.   Have you ever been a member of an illegal organization? _________
43.   Have you ever falsely reported?   _________
44.   Have you ever had intercourse while  under  the  influence  of  drugs?
_________
45.   Have you ever had intercourse while under the  influence  of  alcohol?
_________
46.   Have you ever used drugs or alcohol to procure sex?     _________
47.   Have you ever ill-treated children?    _________
48.   Have you ever taken  money  for  giving  someone  sexual  intercourse?
_________
49.   Have you ever had any connection with a brothel?   _________
50.   Have you ever gotten another  into  trouble  for  something  you  did?
_________
51.   Have you ever been a spy for the police?     _________
52.   Have you done something you  are  afraid  the  police  may  find  out?
_________
53.   Have you ever  falsified  the  books  in  any  firm  you  worked  for?
_________
54.   Have you ever disclosed confidential data?   _________
55.   Have you ever done anything your mother would be ashamed to
      find out about?  _________
56.   Have you ever purposely injured yourself?    _________
57.   Have you committed any overts against yourself?    _________
58.   Have you committed any overts against your family? _________
59.   Have you ever harmed an organization?  _________
60.   Have you ever betrayed the trust of a group? _________
61.   Have you ever killed or maimed animals for pleasure?    _________
62.   Have you ever mistreated animals? _________
63.   Have you ever administered electric shock?   _________
64.   Have you ever tried to make someone insane?  _________
65.   Have you ever maliciously destroyed trees or plants?    _________
66.   Have you ever destroyed or damaged another's property?  _________
67.   Have you ever taken part in sabotage?  _________
68.   Have you ever harmed a religion?  _________
69.    Have  you  ever  persecuted  another  for  their  religious  beliefs?
_________
70.   Have you ever violated the tenets of a religion to which you
      belonged?  _________
71.   Have you ever injured Dianetics or Scientology?    _________
72.   Have you ever committed any  overts  on  a  Scientology  Organization?
_________
73.    Have  you  ever  belonged  to  a  group   opposed   to   Scientology?
_________
74.   Have  you  ever  stolen  anything  from  a  Scientology  Organization?
_________
75.   Do you have any overts on LRH?    _________
76.    Have  you  done  anything  you  wouldn't  want  LRH  to  know  about?
_________
77.   Do you have any overts on Mary Sue Hubbard?  _________
78.   Is  there  something  Mary  Sue  Hubbard  shouldn't  know  about  you?
_________
79.   Have you ever injured any Scientologists?    _________
80.   Have you ever betrayed Scientology?    _________
81.   Do you know of any secret plans against Scientology?    _________
82.   Have you ever taken money to injure Scientology?   _________
83.   Have you ever used Dianetics or Scientology to force sex on
      somebody?  _________
84.   Do you know  of  any  plans  to  injure  a  Scientology  Organization?
_________
85.   Have you done something that should never be found out? _________
86.   Is there something you have avoided telling me?    _________


      Compiled from LRH
      briefings and materials by
      Lt. Comdr. Brian Livingston

      Revised & Reissued as BTB

BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BL:mhrd        by Flag Mission 1234
Copyright � 1972,1974        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
by L. Ron Hubbard            2nd: Molly Harlow
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
            Authorized by AVU
            for the
[Questions 57 and 58 on the previous page have been
corrected  per  HCOPL  7  April  1961RA,  Revised  30            BOARDS   OF
DIRECTORS
May 1975, Johannesburg Confessional List-Revised, a      Of the
complete copy of which  is  in  Volume  VIII,  page  419.]      CHURCHES  OF
SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                             24 DECEMBER 1 972R
                                  Issue II
                   Revised & Reissued 18 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 24 DECEMBER 1972
                                  Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE

           (The only revision is on this page, paragraph 1: HCO B
                 5 DEC 72 is revised to read BTB 5 DEC 72.)



                         Integrity Processing Form 2



                        GENERAL STAFF INTEGRITY LIST


    For use in Integrity  Processing  by  a  Hubbard  Integrity  Processing
Specialist. See BTB 5 DEC 72 for procedure.


AUDITOR:                          PRECLEAR:

ORG:  DATE:


1.     Have  you  stolen   anything   from   a   Scientology   Organization?
_________
2.    Are you here only to get free processing?    _________
3.    Do you intend to leave this Organization once trained?
4.    Have you audited outside Pcs for money while a member of this
      Org?  _________
5.    Have you fed Org Pcs to outside Auditors?    _________
6.    Have you broken contract with an Org?  _________
7.    Have  you  ever  shifted  the  blame  to  an  innocent  staff  member?
_________
8.    Have you offered or delivered free service?  _________
9.    Have you accepted services from this Organization without being
      invoiced?  _________
10.   Have you ever advised anyone against joining staff of a
      Scientology Organization?   _________
11.   Have you ever advised anyone not to take services at a Scientology
      Org?  _________
12.   Have you ever given Scientology materials to a group opposed to
      Scientology?     _________
13.   Have you ever said discreditable things to the press or public
      concerning Scientology?     _________
14.   Have you ever refused to comply with the legal orders of your
      senior?    _________
15.   As a staff member have you given false reports?    _________
16.   Have you falsified a statistic?   _________
17.   Have you given false evidence to an Ethics body?   _________
18.   Have you ever obstructed an Ethics investigation?  _________
19.   Have you withheld data to protect yourself or another?  _________
20.   Have you ever third partied a staff member?  _________
21.   Have you feigned illness to avoid work?      _________
22.   Have you caused upset to a public Pc or student?   _________
23.   Have you prevented another from wearing his hat?   _________
24.   Have you done anything to get another removed from post for your
      own personal gain?     _________
25.   Have you ever engaged in a power  push  against  a  senior  executive?
_________
26.   Have you ever used a Scientology position to  obtain  unusual  favors?
_________
27.   Have you ever personally accepted a commission, percentage, bribe
      or gift for giving any firm or person  this  Organization's  business?
_________
28.   Have you ever advised anyone against following policy?  _________
29.   Have you prevented another from learning his post? _________
30.   Have you prevented another from studying or training?   _________
31.   Have you ever slowed things down just because your seniors
      wanted them speeded up?     _________
32.   Have you done anything to get another  staff  member  in  bad  repute?
_________
33.   Have you ever damaged Org property?    _________
34.   Have you wasted Org supplies?     _________
35.   Have you juggled Org accounts?    _________
35A. As a staff member have you produced any overt products?  _________
36.   Have you taken credit for the work done by another?
36A.  Have  you  maligned  another   to   enhance   your   own   reputation?
_________
37.   Have you caused or contributed to an Org mutiny?   _________
38.   Have you encouraged another to blow?   _________
39.   Have you done anything to damage the repute of a senior Scientology
      Org?  _________
40.   Have  you  done  anything  to  damage  the  repute  of  the  Sea  Org?
_________
41.   Have you discouraged Org Pcs or students from advancing to a senior
      Org?  _________
42.   Have you falsely reported to a Sea Org Missionaire?     _________
43.   Have you ever falsely reported to Flag?      _________
44.   Have you knowingly violated policy?    _________
4S.   Have you blamed others for not doing your job?     _________
46.   Are you here purposely to upset or damage Scientology?  _________
47.   While on staff of a Scientology Organization have you committed any
      civil crime?     _________
48.   Is there  something  an  Ethics  Officer  shouldn't  know  about  you?
_________
49.   Have  you  done  something  you  wouldn't  like  LRH  to  know  about?
_________
50.   As a staff member have you committed some overt that hasn't been
      revealed?  _________


                                  Compiled from
                                  LRH briefings and materials by
                                  Lt. Comdr. Brian Livingston


                                  Revised & Reissued as BTB
                                  by Flag Mission 1234


                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow


                                  Authorized by AVU
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BL:mh rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              24 DECEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue III
                   Revised & Reissued 18 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 24 DECEMBER 1972
                                  Issue III
                                 SAME TITLE

           (The only revision is on this page, paragraph 1: HCO B
                 5 DEC 72 is revised to read BTB 5 DEC 72.)


                         Integrity Processing Form 3


                           AUDITOR INTEGRITY LIST


    For use in Integrity  Processing  by  a  Hubbard  Integrity  Processing
Specialist. See BTB 5 DEC 72 for procedure.

AUDITOR:                          PRECLEAR:

ORG:  DATE:


1.    Have you ever evaluated for a preclear?      _________
2.     Have  you  ever  invalidated  or   corrected   a   preclear's   data?
_________
3.    Have you ever told a preclear about his case?      _________
4.    Have you discussed a preclear's case with others?  _________
5.    Have you disclosed a preclear's withholds?   _________
6.    Have you made a preclear guilty?  _________
7.    Have you altered or misapplied tech?   _________
8.    Have you failed to keep an auditing appointment?   _________
9.    Have you audited a preclear who was tired or hungry?    _________
10.   Have you permitted a frequent change of Auditors?  _________
11.   Have you sympathized with a preclear?  _________
12.   Have you followed a preclear's instructions? _________
13.   Have you refused to accept a preclear's data?      _________
14.   Have you allowed a preclear to end session  on  his  own  determinism?
_________
15.   Have you ever walked off from a preclear in session?    _________
16.   Have you ever refused to audit  a  preclear  you  could  have  helped?
_________
17.   Have you gotten angry with a preclear in session?  _________
18.   Have you not taken a process or rundown to full EP?     _________
19.   Have you overrun a preclear?      _________
20.   Have you mixed practices or advised other practices?    _________
21.   Have you cut a preclear's communication?     _________
22.   Have you failed to acknowledge a preclear?   _________
23.   Have you failed to handle a preclear's originations?    _________
24.   Have you harassed or distracted a preclear?  _________
25.   Have you explained or justified auditing errors?   _________
26.   Have you audited without folder study? _________
27.   Have you failed to follow C/S instructions?  _________
28.   Have you falsified auditing reports?   _________
29.   Have you falsely called F/Ns?     _________
30.   Have you fed a preclear cognitions or EPs?   _________
31.   Have you failed to call F/Ns or give a Pc his win? _________
32.   Have you failed to fly a rudiment?     _________
33.   Have you left a preclear ARC Broken?   _________
34.   Have you failed to pull a withhold?    _________
35.   Have you left a preclear with a problem?     _________
36.   Have you failed to F/N all reading items?    _________
37.   Have you given a preclear a wrong item?      _________
38.   Have you audited without checking out on the materials? _________
39.   Have you run processes above your training level?  _________
40.   Have you failed to follow the Grade Chart?   _________
41.   Have you had a 2-D involvement with a preclear?    _________
42.   Have you falsified auditing hours?     _________
43.   Have you not done or completed cramming orders?    _________
44.   Have you omitted vital data from worksheets? _________
45.   Have you delayed or not handled red-tags?    _________
46.   Have you audited without handing in worksheets?    _________
47.   Have you accepted incorrect C/S instructions?      _________
48.   Have you audited without a program?    _________
49.   Have you falsely reported your classification level?    _________
50.    Have  you  failed  to  clear  commands  or  all  words  in  commands?
_________
51.   Have you neglected to handle your own misunderstoods?   _________
52.   Have you neglected to study the C/S Series HCO Bs? _________
53.   Have you given free auditing to public Pcs?  _________
54.   Have you audited Pcs for private gain? _________
55.   Have you disclosed confidential data?  _________
56.   Have you been critical of Pcs to others?     _________
57.   Have you been critical of other Auditors to Pcs?   _________
58.   Have you used tech for some other purpose?   _________
59.   Have you continued to repair a Pc doing well?      _________
60.   Have you given verbal tech data?  _________
61.   Have you failed to apply study tech?   _________
62.   Have you been insecure with materials? _________
63.   Have you falsified Auditor bonus claims?     _________
64.   Have you failed to study your hat?     _________
65.   Did you violate policy?     _________
66.   Have you failed to complete intensives?      _________
67.   Have you C/Sed in the chair?      _________
68.   Have you wasted auditing time?    _________
69.    Have  you  assumed  you  knew  instead  of  using   prepared   lists?
_________
70.   Have you failed to drill TRs regularly?      _________
71.   Have you ever out of curiosity allowed a preclear to give up
      withholds of another?  _________
72.    Have  you  ever  failed  to  improve  your  ability  as  an  Auditor?
_________
73.   Have you ever used the wrong process on a preclear?     _________
74.   Have you ever audited badly?      _________
75.   Have you  ever  done  anything  weird  or  strange  with  a  preclear?
_________
76.   Have you ever advised someone not to be audited?   _________
77.   Is there anything about your auditing activities which shouldn't be
      known?     _________
78.   Have you ever falsely represented your  achievements  as  an  Auditor?
_________
79.   Have you ever made false promises to a preclear?   _________
80.   Do you have overts against the subject of Dianetics?    _________
81.   Do you have overts against the subject of Scientology?  _________
82.   Do you have overts on the subject of the mind?     _________
83.   Do you have overts against a C/S? _________
84.   Do you have overts against a D of P?   _________
85.   Do you have overts against a Tech Sec? _________
86.   Do you have overts against other staff members?    _________
87.   As an  Auditor  have  you  done  anything  you  shouldn't  have  done?
_________
88.   As an Auditor is there something you have failed to do? _________
89.    Do  you  still  have  your  attention  on  any  of  these  questions?
_________
90.   Have you thought of something you haven't told me? _________


                                  Compiled from
                                  LRH briefings and materials by
                                  Lt. Comdr. Brian Livingston


                                  Revised & Reissued as BTB
                                  by Flag Mission 1234


                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow


                                  Authorized by AVU
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BL:mh rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              24 DECEMBER 1972R
                                  Issue IV
                   Revised & Reissued 13 July 1974 as BTB

                        (Revision in this type style)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 24 DECEMBER 1972
                                  Issue IV
                                 SAME TITLE



                         Integrity Processing Form 4



                          SUPERVISOR INTEGRITY LIST


    For use in Integrity  Processing  by  a  Hubbard  Integrity  Processing
Specialist. See BTB 5 DEC 72 for procedure.

AUDITOR:                          PRECLEAR:

ORG:  DATE:

1.    Have you ever given a student verbal data?   _________
2.    Have you taught a course without a checksheet?     _________
3.    Have you given students checksheets other than those officially
      approved?  _________
4.    Have you deleted materials from an approved checksheet? _________
5.    Have you failed to provide course materials? _________
6.    Have you failed to update and correct checksheets before issuing to
      new students?    _________
7.    Have you permitted a student to falsely attest?    _________
8.    Have you attested to a student's course completion without verifying
      his ability to apply the materials?    _________
9.    Have you ever permitted a student to blow?   _________
10.   Have you blamed others for poor course attendance? _________
11.   Have you become sexually involved with a student?  _________
12.   Have you falsified statistics?    _________
13.   Have you ever gotten angry with a student?   _________
14.   Have you ever interrupted a student who was doing well? _________
15.   Have you ever failed to handle a bogged student?   _________
16.    Have  you  ever  made  a  student  redo  checkouts  to  boost  stats?
_________
17.   Have you ever lied to a student?  _________
18.   As a Supervisor have you ever left a course unattended? _________
19.    Have  you  ever  failed  to  refer  a  student  to   the   materials?
_________
20.    Have  you  ever  failed  to  keep  a  course  exactly  on   schedule?
_________
21.   Have you failed to apply Word Clearing tech? _________
22.   When Word Clearing students have you ignored reads?     _________
23.   Have you pretended you can read a meter?     _________
24.   Have you  ever  used  Supervisor  status  to  obtain  unusual  favors?
_________
25.   Have you passed a student just to be kind?   _________
26.   Have you ever failed to correct a student's mistakes?   _________
27.   Have you done something you wouldn't like your students to know
      about?     _________
28.   Have you ever failed to fully apply study tech?    _________
29.   Are you pretending that you know study tech? _________
30.   Have you failed to use Word Clearing?  _________
31.   Have you done admin or other duties during course time? _________
32.   Have you ever allowed a course to be interrupted?  _________
33.    Have  you  ever  permitted  a  student  to   enturbulate   a   class?
_________
34.   Have you ever offloaded students instead of handling?   _________
35.   Have you ever failed to recover a blown student?   _________
36.   Have you ever used your position as a Supervisor to procure students
      for another group?     _________
37.   Have you ever subjected a student to ridicule?     _________
38.   Have  you  C/Sed  student  sessions  when  not  qualified  to  do  so?
_________
39.    Have  you  ever  flunked  a  student  who  really  knew   the   data?
_________
40.   Is there something a student might find out about you?  _________
41.   Have you ever run a slow course?  _________
42.   Have you not studied your hat?    _________
43.   Have you pretended qualifications not attained?    _________
44.   Have you personally studied past misunderstoods?   _________
45.   Have you ever invalidated study tech?  _________
46.   Have you ever invalidated Scientology materials?   _________
47.   As a Supervisor have you produced any overt products?   _________
48.   Have you ever condoned out-tech?  _________
49.   As a Supervisor have you ever done anything you wouldn't want
      LRH to know about?     _________
50.   Concerning study or supervision have you committed any overt
      that hasn't been revealed?  _________


                                        Robin Hubbard
                                        Flag DofT and
                                        Lt. Comdr. Brian Livingston
      Revised & Reissued
      as BTB by Flag Mission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow
                                        Authorized by AVU

BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BL:RH:mh.rd    for the
Copyright �1972,1974   BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              24 DECEMBER 1972R
                                   Issue V
                   Revised & Reissued 18 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 24 DECEMBER 1972
                                   Issue V
                                 SAME TITLE


           (The only revision is on this page, paragraph 1: HCO B
                 5 DEC 72 is revised to read BTB 5 DEC 72.)



                         Integrity Processing Form 5



                           STUDENT INTEGRITY LIST


    For use in Integrity  Processing  by  a  Hubbard  Integrity  Processing
Specialist. See BTB 5 DEC 72 for procedure.

AUDITOR:                          PRECLEAR:

ORG:  DATE:

1.    Are you here for some purpose other than what you say?  _________
2.    Have you falsified your qualifications?      _________
3.    Are you trying to upset or damage Scientology?     _________
4.    Have you done something you don't want this Organization to find
      out about? _________
5.     Have  you  had  a   sexual   relationship   with   another   student?
_________
6.     Are  you  here  to  procure  Pcs  or  students  for  another   group?
_________
7.    Are you here to get data for someone else?   _________
8.    Have you ever cheated in an examination?     _________
9.    Have you ever upset a classroom?  _________
10.   Have you ever made trouble for a teacher?    _________
11.   Do you have overts against students?   _________
12.   Have you falsely attested to passing something?    _________
13.   Have you ever given a twin a false pass?     _________
14.   Have you allowed yourself to be passed on something you didn't
      fully understand?      _________
15.   Have you pretended to know? _________
16.    Have  you  ever  falsely  signed  off  an  item  on   a   checksheet?
_________
17.   Have you argued with a Supervisor?     _________
18.   Have you ever refused to comply with a cramming order?  _________
19.   During study have you ever failed to look up a word you didn't
      know? _________
20.   Have you ever checked out a  student  without  demanding  application?
_________
21.   Have you  ever  flunked  a  student  for  something  he  really  knew?
_________
22.   Have you ever interrupted a student while studying?     _________
23.   Have you ever disturbed a class?  _________
24.    Do  you  have  overts  against  the   subject   you   are   studying?
_________
25.    Have  you  done  something  that  makes  you   not   deserve   study?
_________
26.   Have you not paid your course fees?    _________
27.   Do  you  have  unpaid  debts  to  this  or  another  Scientology  Org?
_________
28.   Have you ever studied in order to harm others?     _________
29.   Have you ever used punishment to make others study?     _________
30.   Do you intend using what you learn here for some unworthy
      purpose?   _________
31.   Have you violated student rules?  _________
32.   Have you stolen anything belonging to another student?  _________
33.   Have you taken Org materials without authorization?     _________
34.   Have you given another student verbal tech data?   _________
35.   Have you been insecure with confidential materials?     _________
36.   Have you read classified materials?    _________
37.   Have you given Scientology materials to the press? _________
38.   Are you a member of a group opposed to Scientology?     _________
39.   Have you ever caused a student to blow?      _________
40.   Have you badly audited a fellow student?     _________
41.   Have you ever made Scientology or a Scientology Organization look
      bad?  _________
42.   Have you done something you don't want this Organization to know
      about?     _________
43.   Do you have any overt connected with study or this Organization that
      you haven't revealed?  _________


                                  Compiled from
                                  LRH briefings and materials by
                                  Lt. Comdr. Brian Livingston


                                  Revised & Reissued
                                  as BTB by
                                  Flag Mission 1234
                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow


                                  Authorized by AVU

BDCS:sw:AL:MH:BL:mh.rd for the
Copyright � 1972,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY






















                                Study Series
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                   HCO POLICY LETTER OF 18 SEPTEMBER 1967

Remimeo
Academies
SHSBC
                                    STUDY

                         COMPLEXITY AND CONFRONTING


    In some researches I have been doing recently on the field of study,  I
have found what appears to be the basic law on complexity.


    It is:

        THE DEGREE OF COMPLEXITY IS PROPORTIONAL  TO  THE  DEGREE  OF  NON-
        CONFRONT.

    Reversing this:

        THE DEGREE OF SIMPLICITY IS PROPORTIONAL TO THE DEGREE OF CONFRONT
                                     and


        THE BASIS OF ABERRATION IS A NON-CONFRONT.

    To the degree that a being cannot confront he enters substitutes which,
accumulating, bring about a complexity.


    I found this while examining the subject  of  NAVIGATION  in  order  to
teach it and clarify it.


    I found that  Man  had  based  the  subject  on  an  incorrect  primary
assumption. A11 subjects have as their basis a point  of  first  assumption.
In Man's technology this is usually weak and  non-factual  which  makes  his
technology very frail and limited. To reform a subject one has to find  this
primary assumption and improve it. This reforming of technical  subjects  is
of great interest to us because our subject  Scientology  is  advanced  even
beyond the space travel technologies of very high civilizations. Yet  it  is
flanked on all sides by Man's corny  antique  technology  in  the  field  of
physics, chemistry, "mathematics" and so on. This  tends  to  hold  us  back
somewhat. We strained his tech forward to get the E-Meter, the one thing  we
had to have.


    In Navigation, Man bases the whole subject on the assumption  that  one
can't confront where he came from or is going or where he is. It assumes  he
is lost.


    This is a basis assumption of non-confront. He can't directly see where
he has been or where he is going at sea-it is so large-so he takes off  from
a point of no-confront in all his reasoning in the subject.


    Therefore he goes into a series of symbols  and  begins  to  substitute
symbols for symbols. This winds him up in a mass of complexity.  One  spends
90% of his time in studying this subject trying to  find  out  what  symbols
the symbols are meant to represent. He says in his texts "G.H.A." On  search
we find this means "Greenwich Hour Angle". On further search  we  find  this
means what angle some heavenly body  forms  when  related  to  Greenwich  as
Zero. On further search we find the idiocy that the navigator's clock  tells
angles in HOURS when all he needs is a clock face giving 360  degrees.  This
is of course complete nonsense. Why hours,  and  two  sets  of  12  at  that
(midnight to Noon and Noon to midnight) when what he is trying to  find  out
is how many degrees of time have passed. He  refers  his  time  to  the  Sun
which, because of the rotations of Earth  every  24  hours,  appears  at  an
increasing number of degrees from Greenwich England as the day advances.


    Because he starts from a no-confront of ship or plane position he  then
carries no-confront through the whole subject. If a man  isn't  lost  as  he
begins to "navigate" he very often is when he finishes!


    Actually no ship or plane is ever lost as to position. One knows he  is
on Earth and in what ocean and on what side of what ocean  and  the  subject
really should be one which merely lets one CORRECT his position a bit.
Man in this subject of navigation even scorns direct observation  (confront)
and calls it "jackass navigation!"


    In actual fact  real  navigation  is  the  science  of  recognition  of
positions and objects  and  estimation  of  relative  distances  and  angles
between them.


    The subject is made complex because it has become, in Man's hands,  the
substitution of symbols for symbols all based  on  the  assumption  that  he
can't confront his departure, his current spot or his point of arrival.


    Out of this, with further study in  other  fields,  I  found  that  any
complexity stemmed from an initial point of non-confront.


    This is why looking at or recognizing the source of  an  aberration  in
processing "blows" it, makes it vanish.


    Mental mass accumulates in a vast complexity solely because  one  would
not confront something. To take apart a problem requires only  to  establish
what one could not or would not confront.


    The basic thing Man can't or won't confront is evil.


    These people who always rationalize evil  behavior-"He  wasn't  feeling
well which is why he murdered the policeman,"  etc.-can  be  counted  on  to
voice  some  theetieweetie  (goodie-goodie)  justification  for   somebody's
thoroughly evil conduct. Mr. X wrecks a house and you remark on it and  Miss
Theetie Weetie will feel compelled to say, "Oh, Mr. X had a  poor  childhood
and he didn't mean any wrong ...." She can't confront the  simple  but  evil
fact that Mr. X is a complete dog. One feels his  hair  stand  on  end  when
Miss Theetie Weetie does this because  one  is  observing  a  complete  non-
confront on the part of Miss Theetie Weetie. She is too unreal to  do  other
than make one feel he has had an ARC Break.


    One will also find that Miss Theetie Weetie leads  a  horribly  complex
life-adjusting her thinking to agree with  "air  spirits"  and  leaving  her
family because there might be mice in the basement.


    When no-confront enters, a chain may be set up  which  leads  to  total
complexity and total unreality.


    This, in a very complex form, we call an "aberrated condition".


    People like that can't solve even rudimentary problems and  act  in  an
aimless and confused way.


    To resolve their troubles requires more than education  or  discipline.
It requires processing.


    Some people are so "complex" that their full aberration does fully  not
resolve until they attain a high level of OT.


    A large number of people de-aberrate just by the education contained in
Scientology as they find in our subject the natural laws of life and  seeing
(confronting)  them,  "blow"  huge   holes   in   their   complexities   and
aberrations.


    Therefore the above laws are very important ones as they  explain  what
aberration really is and why processing really works.


    Aberration is a chain of vias based on a primary non-confront.


    Processing is a series of methods  arranged  on  an  increasingly  deep
scale of bringing the preclear to confront the no-confront  sources  of  his
aberrations and leading him to a simple, powerful, effective being.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH:jp.rd
Copyright � 1967
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 21 SEPTEMBER 1970
Remimeo
Student Hat
All Courses
HC Checksheet
                               Study Series 1



                              STUDY DEFINITIONS



    The  following  definitions  are  applicable   to   Scientology   study
technology:


    CHECKSHEET: A list of materials, often divided into sections, that give
the theory and practical steps which,  when  completed,  give  one  a  study
completion. The items are selected to add up to the  required  knowledge  of
the subject. They are arranged in the sequence necessary to  a  gradient  of
increasing knowledge of the subject. After each item there is  a  place  for
the initial of the student or the person checking the student out. When  the
checksheet is fully initialed it is complete, meaning the  student  may  now
take an exam and be granted the award for completion. Some  checksheets  are
required to be gone through twice before completion is granted.


    CHECKLIST: A list of actions or inspections to  ready  an  activity  or
machinery or object for use or estimate the needful repairs or  corrections.
This is erroneously sometimes  called  a  "checksheet",  but  that  word  is
reserved for study steps.


    CHECKOUT: The action of verifying a  student's  knowledge  of  an  item
given on a checksheet.


    TWIN CHECKOUT: When two students are paired they check each other  out.
This is different than a Supervisor checkout.


    SUPERVISOR CHECKOUT: A checkout done by the Supervisor of a  course  or
his assistants.


    THEORY: The data part of a course where the data as in books, tapes and
manuals is given.


    PRACTICAL: The  drills  which  permit  the  student  to  associate  and
coordinate theory with the actual items and  objects  to  which  the  theory
applies. Practical is application of what one knows to  what  one  is  being
taught to understand, handle or control.


    TWIN: The study partner with whom one is paired. Two students  studying
the same subject who are paired to check out or help each other are said  to
be "Twinned".


    TWO-WAY COMM: The precise technology of a process used to clarify  data
with another for the other. It is not chatter. It is governed by  the  rules
of auditing. It is used by Supervisors to clear  up  blocks  to  a  person's
progress in study, on post, in life or in auditing. It is  governed  by  the
communication cycle as discovered in Scientology.


    METER CHECK: The action of  checking  the  reaction  of  a  student  to
subject  matter,  words  or  other  things,  isolating  blocks   to   study,
interpersonal relations or life. It is done with an E-Meter.


    COURSE SUPERVISOR: The  instructor  in  charge  of  a  course  and  its
students.
COURSE ADMINISTRATOR: The course  staff  member  in  charge  of  the  course
materials and records.


    TECH  SERVICES:  The  activity  which   enrolls,   routes,   schedules,
distributes the mail of and assists the housing of students.


    STARRATE CHECKOUT: A very exact checkout which verifies  the  full  and
minute knowledge of the student of a portion of study  materials  and  tests
his full understanding of the data and ability to apply it.


    ZERO RATE: Material which is only checked out on the basis  of  general
understanding.


    BLOW:  Unauthorized  departure  from  an  area,   usually   caused   by
misunderstood data or overts.


    LEAVE OF ABSENCE: An authorized period of absence from a course granted
in writing by a  Course  Supervisor  and  entered  in  the  student's  study
folder.


    ROLL BOOK: The master record of a course  giving  the  student's  name,
local and permanent address and the date  of  enrollment  and  departure  or
completion.


    QUAL: The Qualifications Division (Division V  of  an  org)  where  the
student is examined and where he may receive cramming or special  assistance
and  where  he  is  awarded  completions  and  certificates  and  where  his
qualifications as attained on courses or in auditing are  made  a  permanent
record.


    CRAMMING: A section in the Qualifications Div where a student is  given
high pressure instruction at his own cost after being found  slow  in  study
or when failing his exams.


    PROGRAMMING: The overall planning for a person of the courses, auditing
and study he should follow for the next extended time period.


    STUDENT CONSULTATION: The personal  handling  of  student  problems  or
progress by a qualified consultant.


    HC:  A  HUBBARD  CONSULTANT  is  skilled  in  testing,  two-way   comm,
consultation,  programming  and  interpersonal  relations.   This   is   the
certificate especially awarded  to  persons  trained  to  handle  personnel,
students and staff. These technologies and special training  were  developed
to  apply  Scientology  auditing  skills  to  the  field  of  administration
especially. An HC is not an auditor but a consultant. HC is a requisite  for
Course Supervisors and Student Consultants.


    SCHEDULING: The hours of a course or the designation of  certain  times
for auditing.


    OUT: Things which should be there and aren't  or  should  be  done  and
aren't are said to be "Out", i.e. "Enrollment Books are out."


    IN: Things which should be there and are or should be done and are, are
said to be "In", i.e. "We got scheduling in."


    PACK: A pack is  a  collection  of  written  materials  which  match  a
checksheet. It is variously constituted-such as loose leaf  or  a  cardboard
folder  or  bulletins  in  a  cover  stapled  together.  A  pack  does   not
necessarily include a booklet or hardcover book that may be  called  for  as
part of a checksheet.


    MANUAL: A booklet of instruction for a certain object or  procedure  or
practice.


    POINTS: The arbitrary assignment of a credit value to a part  of  study
materials. "One page equals one point." "That drill is worth 25 points."
POINT SYSTEM: The system of assigning and counting  up  points  for  studies
and drills that give the progress of a student  and  measure  his  speed  of
study. They are kept track of by the student and  Course  Administrator  and
added up each week as the student's statistic. The statistic of  the  course
is the combined study points of the class.


    COMPLETION: A "completion" is the completing of a specific course or an
auditing grade,  meaning  it  has  been  started,  worked  through  and  has
successfully ended with an award in Qual.


    SUCCESS STORY: The statement of benefit or gains  or  wins  made  by  a
student or a preclear or pre-OT to the Success Officer  or  someone  holding
that post in an org.


      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder


LRH:rr.rd
Copyright � 1970
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                         HCO BULLETIN OF 2 JUNE 1971
                                   Issue I
                   (Corrected and Reissued 30 December 72.
                      Corrections in this type style.)
Remimeo

                               Study Series 2


                                 CONFRONTING


    The first requisite of any subject  is  the  ability  to  confront  the
various components (things) (parts) (divisions) of the subject itself.


    All misunderstoods, confusions, omissions,  alterations  of  a  subject
begin with failures or unwillingness to confront.


    The difference between a good pilot and a bad pilot depends  of  course
on consistent study and practice, but underlying this,  determining  whether
the person  will  study  and  practice,  is  the  ability  to  confront  the
components of study and airplanes.


    A "quick study", by which is meant a student who learns  rapidly  or  a
person who grasps a subject quickly, has a high  ability  to  confront  that
subject.


    In a dramatic profession, the wild animal trainer  who  could  confront
wild animals remained alive. The one who couldn't confront was too  slow  of
perception to live long.


    In a more common line of work, the fast typist could confront study and
typing in the first place and the slow typist couldn't and can't.


    The confusions  about  "talent"  and  "native  ability"  and  such  are
resolved to no small extent when one  recognizes  the  role  played  by  the
ability to confront.


    Basically, if one can just be there with it, he can  then  achieve  the
skill of communicating with whatever "it" is and handling it.


    Thus, before  communicating  with  the  components  of  a  subject  can
properly  begin,  one  must  be  able  to  be  there  comfortably  with  the
components of the subject.


    All power depends upon the ability to hold a location.  To  communicate
one must be able to hold to a location.


    This is even true in the physical universe.  You  can't  move  a  chair
unless you can hold a  position  yourself  near  the  chair.  If  you  don't
believe it, try it.


    Thus the ability to communicate with precedes the  ability  to  handle.
But before one can communicate with something one must be able to  be  in  a
location near it.


    The age-old puzzle of how some scholars can get "A" on a  subject  they
have studied and then not be able to apply even  a  scrap  of  the  data  is
resolved by this fact of confronting. They can confront the book, the  class
and the thought. But they haven't  attained  the  ability  to  confront  the
physical objects of the subject.


    At least such "glib" students can confront the  book,  the  paper,  the
thought. They are partway there.


    Now all they need to do is confront as  well  the  physical  things  to
which the subject is applied and they would  be  able  to  apply  what  they
know.
Some people are not so lucky as to be "glib" students. They have to work  up
to "being there" with the book, paper, classroom and teacher.


    Thus "confronting" is actually the ability to be there comfortably  and
perceive.


    Amazing reactions occur when conscious  effort  is  made  to  do  this.
Dullness, perception trouble, fogginess, sleep and even pains, emotions  and
convulsions  can  occur  when  one  knowingly  sets  out  to  BE  THERE  AND
COMFORTABLY PERCEIVE with the various parts of a subject.


    These reactions discharge and vanish as one perseveres (continues)  and
at last, sometimes soon, sometimes after a long while, one can be there  and
perceive the component.


    As one is able to confront one part he then finds it easier to confront
other components.


    People have mental tricks they use to get around actual  confronting-to
be disinterested, to realize it's not important, to be sort  of  half  dead,
etc-but these discharge (run out) as well eventually and at  last  they  can
just be there and comfortably perceive.


    Eye blinks, swallows,  twitches,  aches,  pains,  are  all  systems  of
interrupting confronting and are the symptoms of discomfort. There are  many
of these. If they  are  present  then  one  is  not  just  being  there  and
perceiving.


    Confronting on a via (using a relay point) is another method of ducking
out of it.


    The worst off  cannot  even  tolerate  the  idea  of  being  there  and
perceiving anything. They run away, even go into emotional fits rather  than
be there and perceive. Such people's lives are  a  system  of  interruptions
and vias, all substitutes for confronting. They  are  not  very  successful.
For success in life depends not on running away from it but by  being  there
and perceiving it and then being able to communicate with it and handle it.

                                    TERMS

    "A gradient scale" means a gradual increasing condition of, or a little
more of, little by little.


    A "skipped gradient" means taking on a higher degree or amount before a
lesser degree of it has been handled. One has to  go  back  and  handle  the
missed degree or thing or else one  will  have  just  losses  on  a  subject
thereafter.


    "Flattening" something means to do it until it  no  longer  produces  a
reaction.


    "Overrunning" something means accumulating protests and upsets about it
until it is just a mass of stops. Anyone can do anything forever  unless  he
begins to stop it.


    "Invalidation" means a refuting or degrading or discrediting or denying
something someone else considers to be a fact.

                                  GRADIENTS

    Some of the things one would have to be able to be there  and  perceive
in order to study, placed on a  graduated  scale  of  increasing  difficulty
are:


    Beginning at all.


    The classroom or work space.


    Paper.
Books.


    Writing materials.


    Sounds.


    A Student.


    The Supervisor.


    The area of the study subject's physical components.


    The motionless equipment of the subject.


    The moving equipment of the subject.


    Masses  connected with the subject.


    The subject as a whole.

    The next stages  would  have  to  be  confronting  while  moving.  This
requires a consecutive  being  there  and  perceiving  even  though  one  is
occupying different locations.


    The next stages would be confronting selectively while  moving  despite
other things seeking to distract.


    This Bulletin is not an effort to  set  out  the  numerous  confronting
drills. It is intended to set out the various axioms or  laws  necessary  to
an understanding of the subject of confronting itself.


    From these brief notes all the axioms can be derived.


    The fundamental and basic simplicities of  confronting  itself  is  the
first thing that must be grasped. All complexity surrounding any subject  or
action is derived (comes from) a greater or lesser inability to confront.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder



LRH: sb.nt.rd
Copyright  � 1971, 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                22 JULY 1971
                                  Issue II
                         Reissued 9 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                        HCO BULLETIN OF 22 JULY 1971
                                  Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE


                               Study Series 3



                            CONFRONTING, ADDITION

                (Reference: HCO B 2 June 71, Study Series 2,
                                CONFRONTING)


    In reference to the gradient of study objects to  confront,  under  the
item "paper" the following procedure applies:


    The student would confront an HCO PL or an HCO B. It is tacked  to  the
wall upside down so it can't be read.  The  student  sits  in  a  chair  and
confronts it. It is not the significance of the bulletin  that  the  student
is confronting, it is the bulletin itself,  the  physical  object.  This  is
continued until the student is able to be  there  and  comfortably  perceive
the upside-down bulletin. It is usually done  for  2  hours,  no  blink,  no
swallow, no twitch. Once this is accomplished,  the  student  moves  to  the
next gradient per the list in HCO B 2 June 71, CONFRONTING, Study Series 2.


                                        Hatted Scn Expeditor
                                        Taken from an LRH Note

      Reissued as BTB by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:SW:AL:MH:NR:mh.rd
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO POLICY LETTER OF 13 MAY 1972

Remimeo
                               Study Series 4

                       Establishment Officer Series 17

                              Language Series 4


                               CHINESE SCHOOL

    As very few Westerners have ever seen  a  Chinese  or  Arab  school  in
progress, it is very easy for them to miss the scene when one says  "Chinese
School".


    The term has been used to designate an action where  an  instructor  or
officer, with a pointer, stands up before an  assembled  class  and  taps  a
chart or org board and says each part of it.


    It is very funny to one who knows or has heard a real Chinese school to
see the class sitting there silently. This is strictly  a  Western  pattern.
This is how teacher does it in Omaha or Cornell. But never in Shanghai!


    A Chinese class sings out in unison (all together) in response  to  the
teacher. They participate!


    The only Western near equivalent  is  a  German  beer  hall  where  the
audience choruses items sung out by the song leader.


    Chinese School, then, is an action of class vocal participation. It  is
a very lively loud affair. It sounds like chanting.


    In a real Chinese School the response is so timed that although  spoken
by many voices it is quite easy to tell what answer is being chorused.


    It is essentially a system that establishes instant  thought  responses
so that the student, given "2x2" thinks instantly "4".


    For example, the instructor, tapping a big multiplication  chart  cries
"Two Times Two". The class in one  voice  cries  "Four".  Instructor:  "Five
times Two". Class: "Ten". And so on and on and on by the hour.


    This gets more complex when, let us say, the maxims of good conduct  or
the Koran are being taught. In such cases the tablets or scrolls are on  the
wall. The teacher calls Chapter and verse and the students chant it.


    You could teach the Laws of Listing and Nulling,  The  Auditor's  Code,
Axioms and so on in this way.


    The tools are the same-an instructor, a pointer,  a  chart  or  set  of
pictures or big scrolls, a class.


    There are two steps in such teaching.


    A. The Instructor taps and says what it is. Then asks the Class what it
is and they chant the answer.


    B. When the  Class  has  learned  by  being  told  and  repeating,  the
Instructor now taps with the pointer and  asks  and  the  class  chants  the
correct answer.

                                    DRILL

    The Instructor himself has to grasp the drill.


    Here is how it would go on an org bd.
                                     A.


    Instructor taps Div 1. "This is Division One HCO Division."


    Class chants "Division One HCO Division".


    Instructor taps Div 6. "This is Division 6 Distribution Division."


    Class: "Division 6 Distribution Division."


    And so on until all divisions have been named a few times.

                                     B.

    Instructor taps Div 1. "What is this?"


    Class: "Division One HCO Division."


    Instructor taps Div 4. "What is this?"


    Class: "Division Four Tech Division."


    And so on and on. The divisions are then considered trained in  on  the
Class.


    Next one  would  go  to  Departments.  Then  to  philosophic  names  of
Departments. Then to Sections. Then one would  go  to  the  titles  of  each
Division Head. Then to Dept Heads. Etc. Etc.


    If one had a function org board of what each  div  and  department  and
post did one would go on with the same thing.


    A Chinese School drill run for a short period each day will  eventually
cover an enormous amount of org bd.


    Newcomers to the drill have to be schooled in to catch up or join a new
class.


    Anything can be taught by Chinese School that is to be learned by rote.
The parts and actions are always the same.


    There is also a version that uses a text, preferably with a copy of  it
in each student's hands. It sounds the same.


    One is limited only by what he can put on a chart or  even  in  a  text
where each student has a copy of the text open before him.


    Crude charts are easy to draw up with a felt (heavy ink) pen. The  size
of a chart is determined by the ability of the  students  furthest  away  to
see it easily.


    Cloud types, pictures to be named in a foreign language, even slides of
airplane types, anything can be Chinese  Schooled  that  is  to  be  learned
verbatim. And you'd be surprised how many things  should  be.  And  if  they
aren't the person has a shaky foundation under the subject.


    Care should be taken to define strange words. But it is  not  really  a
problem or exercise in word clearing. It is verbatim rote teaching.


    And it works.


    And is lots of fun.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH: nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 30 MARCH 1972
                                   REVISED
                             (Revised 30 May 72)
Remimeo
                               Study Series 5R


                       THE PRIMARY CORRECTION RUNDOWN
                                   REVISED

      Reference: LRH ED 174 INT   Study and Tech Breakthrough
            LRH ED 178 INT   Super-Literacy
            of 30 May 72
                       HCO B 4 Apr 72        The Primary Rundown
                       Revised 30 May 72
                       HCO B 25 Oct 71       The Special Drug Rundown
                       HCO B 20 Apr 72       C/S Series 78
                                        (Repairing Whys)
                       HCO PL 3 May 72       Ethics & Executives
                       HCO PL 5 Apr 72       PTS Type A Handling
                       HCO B 4 Feb 72        Study Correction List
                       HCO B 21 Jun 72       Method 7
                       Issue III
                       HCO B 21 Jun 72       Method 8
                       Issue IV


                                 WHAT IT IS

    The Primary Correction Rundown is a rundown given


    (a)     To a person who fails the Primary Rundown because  of  High  or
        Low TA or Study Troubles.


    (b)     To every Course Supervisor regardless of his TA.


    (c)     To persons whose literacy level  is  not  adequate  to  do  the
        Primary Rundown.


    (d)     To persons on drugs or who have been on drugs.


    (e)     To auditors who go too often to Cramming.


    (f)     Auditors whose auditing errors show up later on pcs.


    (g)     Staff members who are not able to maintain stats.


    (h)     Staff members who get into Ethics trouble.


    (i)     Students with low study stats.


    (j)     Blown students.


    (k)     Members of the public who wish to purchase  a  "Study  Rundown"
        but who are not going to be auditors  and  who  are  not  on  major
        Courses (HSDC, Academy Class IV, or above).

    The Rundown consists  of  Ethics  orientation  on  the  first  dynamic,
Potential Trouble  Source  from  connections  with  hostile  elements,  drug
handling, case handling, the why of not  using  Study  Tech  or  study,  the
Study Correction List and handling, Method 7, a review of Grammar, and  then
back to a Primary RD consisting of Method  I  Word  Clearing,  Method  8  on
Study Tapes and Student Hat.


    The Primary Correction Rundown is actually a checklist where  each  one
of these is done.
This checklist is kept in his pc folder on the  inside  of  the  left  front
cover and marked off.

______________________________    _____________________
            Student's Name                         Date Begun

      _____________________
                                             Org

1.    C/S 53RC (HCO B 31 Dec 71 Revised to 16 May  72).  Assess  and  Handle
    fully. DECLARED AT EXAMINER.

2.    HCO PL 3 May 72 with 2 lists Listing & Nulling on steps  3  and  4  of
    the PL. By an auditor. May require the repair of past Whys found by C/S
    78. DECLARED AT EXAMINER.

3.    PTS Check by Auditor. Is he connected to anyone hostile  to  Dianetics
    or Scientology? Handle by PL 5 Apr 72. (It isn't necessary he leave  to
    handle. A letter will do.) More extensive action can be done later when
    he gets a full PTS RD. Such persons can  also  be  run  as  a  Problem.
    DECLARED AT EXAMINER.

4.    Drug Handling. HCO B 25 Oct 71, The Special Drug Rundown. DECLARED  AT
    EXAMINER.

5.    Case Handling. Pgm by C/S to cover obvious outnesses, GF Method 5,  GF
    40XR and other actions needful. (If chronically ill or has a  psychotic
    history should be run on Expanded Dianetics if  available,  if  not  by
    objective processes and Dianetics.) (Can  also  be  run  on  Triple  or
    Expanded Grades.) DECLARED AT EXAMINER.

6.    The Why of not Studying if never studied  before  in  an  org  or  not
    using Study Tech. Done as a BD F/N Item. DECLARED AT EXAMINER.

7.    The Study Correction List HCO B 4 Feb 72. Assess Method  5  with  good
    TRs, good Impingement, good metering. Handle in full. If PTS  shows  up
    again do full PTS RD. Handle to a full F/Ning list on final assessment.
    DECLARED AT EXAMINER.

8.    Method 7 HCO B 21 June 72 Issue III. Done by a Word Clearer.  DECLARED
    AT EXAMINER.

9.    Review of Grammar by a Word Clearer M4 with student  studying  between
    checks by himself and reporting daily. Use a  simple  grammar  such  as
    that developed for foreign language students. Do not  use  an  American
    dictionary and an English Grammar or vice versa, either  both  American
    or both English. Must check out  clean  on  Method  4  and  know  about
    grammar. DECLARED AT EXAMINER.

10.   Method 1 Word Clearing HCO B 30 June 71 Revised to  11  May  72,  Word
    Clearing Series 8RB. A11 the  misunderstood  background  words  of  all
    words on the list must be cleared.  The  list  must  F/N.  DECLARED  AT
    EXAMINER.

11.   Method 8, HCO B  21  June  72  Issue  IV,  Study  Tapes.  DECLARED  AT
    EXAMINER.

12.   Method 8, Student Hat. DECLARED AT EXAMINER.

      WITH A FINAL CHECKOUT AT EXAMINER THE PERSON MAY  BE  DECLARED  SUPER-
LITERATE.

      This is the whole of the Primary Correction Rundown.


      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder


LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 3 APRIL 1972
Remimeo

                               Study Series 6


                            PRIMARY RUNDOWN NOTE
                          Reference HCO B 30 Mar 72
                               LRH ED 174 Int


    In going through the Study Tapes the first time, the student  looks  up
every word.


    On this first time he does not study for the sense  of  what  is  being
said. He only listens to words.


    In this and in Method 4 word clearing, when being checked he  is  asked
"What is the definition of       (word)?" He is NOT asked "Do you  know  the
meaning of
    (word)?" To this he could answer "Yes" and believe  he  did.  But  when
asked for the definition that he must then give, it  is  a  different  story
entirely.


    This is also the right way to handle any defining of words. M2, M4.  As
well as Methods I & 3.


    Never let the student be unsure. Make him look it up.


    You will find that it is the simple word, "as",  "such",  "from",  that
really bogs reading, not technical terms.


    In the Study  Tapes  there  are  some  photographic  terms.  Any  photo
dictionary can give these. Almost any camera store has such dictionaries.

                                 SECOND TIME

    The second time through the Study Tapes the  student  listens  for  the
sense of the sentences.
                                  _________


    It is very revealing to do the Primary Rundown in this fashion.


    Some students are actually getting meaning out of  something  heard  or
read for the first time in their lives.
                                  _________


    No wonder schoolchildren, by test, get more stupid each additional year
of school. This has been established by actual  test,  that  they  do.  Each
year they just have a higher mountain of misunderstood words!

    The Primary Rundown done HONESTLY is quite an adventure in  opening  up
one's Communication Channels with life!



LRH:mes.rd  L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1972 Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 4 APRIL 1972
                             REVISED 30 MAY 1972
Remimeo
Tech Div

                               PRIMARY RUNDOWN
                                  (REVISED)

        References:    LRH ED 178 INT   SUPER-LITERACY
                       LRH ED 174 INT   HIGHEST PRIORITY
            STUDY AND TECH BREAKTHROUGH
      HCO B 30 Mar 72  THE PRIMARY CORRECTION RUNDOWN
      Revised 30 May 72     REVISED
      HCOB 3() Jun 71  Word Clearing Series 8RB
      Revised Issue II STANDARD C/S FOR WORD CLEARING
      Revised 9 Aug 71 IN SESSION METHOD 1
      Revised 11 May 72
      HCO B 21 July 71 Word Clearing Series 35
      Revised    WORD CLEARING CORRECTION LIST
      Revised 9 Aug 71 REVISED
      Revised 31 Mar 72
      HCO B 21 Jun 72  Word Clearing Series 41
      Issue IV   METHOD 8
      HCO B 16 Apr 72  HANDLING OF NO INTERFERENCE AREA
      Issue II   PERSONS ORDERED TO A PRIMARY
      [now canceled]   CORRECTION RUNDOWN AND DELIVERY
            OF TECH DIV PRIMARY RUNDOWN
      HCO B 25 Oct 71  THE SPECIAL DRUG RUNDOWN
      Issue II   [now BTB]
      HCO PL 19 Mar 72 Word Clearing Series 34
      Issue III  HIGH CRIME POLICY AND WORD CLEARING
                       HCO B 3 Apr 72   Study Series 6
                                  PRIMARY RUNDOWN NOTE


    To know about the importance of the Primary Rundown  read  LRH  ED  178
Int.


    The Primary Rundown consists of word clearing and Study Tech. It  makes
a student SUPER-LITERATE.


    The Primary Rundown is given in the TECH DIVISION (Div IV, Dept 11).


    (The TECH DIV may also give that  portion  of  the  Primary  Correction
Rundown which calls for Method 1 and Method  8  of  the  Primary  Correction
Rundown which is described in HCO B 30 March 72 Revised 30 May 72.)


    SIMPLICITY


    The Primary Rundown is very simple in its steps. Do NOT add things onto
it. Do not do something else.

                                   HONESTY

    The keynote of the Rundown is Honesty. The whole rundown can be  wasted
and the student fail and the  End  Phenomena  missed  if  the  student  goes
dishonest or he is just pushed for student points by the Supervisor.


    If done dishonestly the whole future study career of the  student  will
be not only more difficult but may fail entirely.
Honesty means don't skip, don't brush it off, don't say it was done when  it
wasn't.


    Later checks of auditing or administrative failures contain  checks  of
the Primary Rundown errors and honesty. The whole rundown would have  to  be
done again.

                                    STEPS

    1.      Verify if student's Tone Arm on  a  meter  is  usually  between
position 2 and 3. If so he may proceed. If not he at once  is  sent  to  the
Primary Correction Rundown as his case needs repair or  handling  before  he
can do the Rundown as mental mass will get in his way and he may get  upset.
This step is checked by the Supervisor.


    (The Primary Correction Rundown is covered by HCO B 30 March 72 REVISED
30 May 72. It consists of auditing and study correction actions.)


    2.      If the Tone Arm is usually between 2 and 3 on  the  meter  dial
the person is made into a Word Clear using Method 1 Word  Clearing.  (HCO  B
30 June 71 Revised Issue II, Revised 9 Aug  71,  Revised  11  May  72,  WORD
CLEARING SERIES 8RB.) This is done in the HGC or Dept 13 of Qual or  may  be
done in a student Co-Audit. Failure to do this step or do it well will  make
Study Tech difficult. A good job  on  this  Method  One  will  give  back  a
person's education and send his  Intelligence  Quotient  up.  It  is  not  a
quickie action. The person doing Word Clearing  Method  1  on  a  person  is
doing an auditing action. It has to  be  done  well  to  achieve  the  final
result of becoming a Word Clear.


    If any errors are made or the person  does  not  F/N  at  the  Examiner
(where he goes after each session for a meter  check),  HCO  B  21  July  71
Revised (Revised 9 Aug 71, 31 Mar 72), WORD CLEARING  SERIES  35,  the  Word
Clearing Correction List, is used. It can be used  as  often  as  there  are
upsets.


    This step should be done before the next step is begun as it makes  the
next step so much easier.


    HCO P/L 19 Mar 72 Issue  III,  Word  Clearing  Series  34,  HIGH  CRIME
POLICY, also applies.


    3.      If in doing Method 1 the person was found to be very  deficient
in Grammar and vocabulary, even though Method One was finished  but  took  a
very long time or couldn't be finished due to case, the person  is  sent  to
Dept 13 for the Primary Correction Rundown.


    4.      If the person did all right on Method 1, he is now put on Study
Tapes. This is NOT just listening to Study Tapes,  heaven  forbid.  This  is
HCO B 21 June 72 Issue IV, Word Clearing Series 41, METHOD 8.


    This is a long and careful cycle.


    It is completed in full.


    It consists of looking up every new word on the tape in  a  grammar  or
large dictionary and then listening to the tape.


    The full directions are given in HCO  B  21  June  72  Issue  IV,  Word
Clearing Series 41, Method 8.


    5.      The Student Hat is now done Method 8.


    This completes the Primary Rundown.


    If correctly done, the person will  achieve  the  condition  of  Super-
Literacy. This is fully described in LRH ED 178 International of 30 May 72.


                              COURSE SUPERVISOR

    It is up to the Course Supervisor to hold this line  in.  His  students
will not prosper if their study is begun without a Primary Rundown.


    It is a high crime to omit this vital step.
                            NO INTERFERENCE ZONE

    Persons who are on Solo Auditing between R6EW and OT III may not be put
on a Primary Rundown or a Primary Correction Rundown. See HCO B  16  Apr  72
Issue II.


    They may not be given Method 1 Word Clearing. They may only  be  Method
4ed on Solo Instruction Materials.


    BUT THEY MAY NOT BE DEBARRED FROM STUDY.


    To all but those in the No Interference Area THE PRIMARY RUNDOWN IS THE
REQUIRED FIRST STEP TO ALL STUDY.


    When on or after OT III, such persons must now do the  Primary  Rundown
before any continuance of study. It now becomes Mandatory.


                                CORRECTION RD

    The Primary Correction Rundown takes care of people who have trouble on
the Primary Rundown.


    But do not lightly order the person to the Primary  Correction  RD.  If
they can get through the Primary Rundown with a bit of Supervisor time,  let
them go on through.


    But if they are nattery or upset or desperate even when given help,  it
is the Primary Correction Rundown which will handle.


    Do not just get rid of a Class to Qual.


                                    DRUGS

    Students who are or have been on  Drugs  need  a  Drug  Rundown  before
tackling Method 1. Drugs fog up a student and prevent gains.  And  he  loses
the gains he gets.


    The answer is a full Drug Rundown. (See HCO B 25 Oct 71,  "The  Special
Drug Rundown".) This will end off the drugs and let him live way  above  any
plane he thought drugs put him on.


    We handle drug cases so easily it is foolish not to take  this  obvious
step. The reason he went on drugs or alcohol also comes off.


    Then he can study and retain what he learns.


                                  OPEN DOOR

    The Primary Rundown is the open door to brilliance.


    Super-Literacy is a new state for Man, existing in the past only  in  a
few, accidentally, who became the geniuses and great names of the race.



      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder


LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 20 JULY 1972
                                   Issue I
Remimeo


                     PRIMARY CORRECTION RUNDOWN HANDLING

              (Refers to HCO B 30 March 72, Revised 30 May 72,
                        "Primary Correction Rundown")



    Students who struggle with the Primary Rundown (HCO B 4 Apr 72, Revised
30 May 72) are given the PRIMARY CORRECTION RUNDOWN.


    Steps 1 to 9 of the PCRD (per HCO B 30 March 72, Revised 30 May 72) are
paid for by the pc quite in addition to his Primary Rundown.


    IF available auditors exist on Course of a proper class and the pc is a
student then these steps I to 9 PCRD may be done on a  co-audit  basis.  BUT
IF NOT WELL DONE OR MESSED UP OR DELAYED MUST  BE  DONE  BY  A  PROFESSIONAL
AUDITOR AT THE STUDENT'S OWN EXPENSE.


    A STAFF MEMBER stalled on the Primary Rundown is put through  the  PCRD
in Qual or Qual and HGC for different steps.


    Qualifications is the Correction Division. PCRD is a Correction action.
There should be word clearers in Qual. And these as  Class  IIIs  should  be
competent to do steps I to 9 of the PCRD.


    The object of a PCRD is not to stall the person and keep  him  off  the
PRD.


    The purpose of the PCRD is to get the person through the PRD.


    Where people have been put off the PRD  for  any  reason  and  are  not
industriously going through the PCRD IT IS UP TO QUAL TO MAKE SURE  THEY  DO
GET THROUGH PCRD AND PRD.


    Orgs that off load pcs or students on  the  thinnest  excuses  or  Qual
Divisions that will not service and speed the lines have to  be  watched  as
the discovery of trouble on the PRD can be used to simply halt  the  student
or pc. Instead of picking up the ball, a Qual has been known  to  just  send
students back to class without handling or  put  students  to  "doing  their
hats" or other nonsense.


    The idea is to complete somebody on what they are supposed to complete.


                                FOLDER STUDY

    If you study the person's folder, particularly a  staff  member's,  you
will probably find that several of the steps 1 to 9 have already been done.


    These are checked off as done on the PCRD checklist.


    Any org that is worthy of the name has folder summaries in  the  inside
left-hand cover of the current folder. It is very easy to locate  what  have
been done.


                                  OUT LISTS

    It is not at all rare to find that various "whys have been  found"  but
that the person is not doing well. This is a case  of  WRONG  ITEMS  and  is
handled by C/S Series 78. Thus steps I, 2, 3 and 6 of the PCRD  may  consist
mainly of correcting botched up lists.

                                IDLE STUDENT

    The problem of putting someone off the PRD onto the PCRD is that he  is
now "idle as a student". He cannot go forward on his studies as he  has  not
done his PRD.


    In fact going on studying without the PRD is a waste of  time  as  it's
mainly misunderstood, glib and won't be applied. It is  actually  faster  to
do a PRD (or a PCRD) and then study than it is to study without the  PRD  or
PCRD. And it is certainly far more effective.


    The thing to do is to get the student  who  is  assigned  to  the  PCRD
through the PCRD.


    As noted above he may have several points already done.  And  the  rest
can be done easily and fast.

                             RESISTIVE STUDENTS

    There are situations where you have students  or  even  executives  who
will not even go to study.


    These are of course people who need the PCRD worst.


    But how to get them available even for that?


    In the case of a senior executive who will not  study  you  can  get  a
disarrangement of the study lines as they won't push and  will  even  impede
study-for instance by not making staff go to study time or  preventing  them
from going. Also policy and HCO Bs fall out or are not enforced and form  of
org is not held since reading and study  are  similar  actions  so  standard
actions are not known.


    Naturally such a thing has to be handled very fast.


    Because cooperation from such a student is VERY limited, time to  do  a
whole PCRD is not possible.

                                  PRE-PCRD

    There is a PRE-PCRD action that handles this.


    It has 2 steps.

    A.      Assess Method 5 C/S 53RC. Take the LFBD item and INDICATE it to
        the person. Don't handle it or the rest of 53RC. Just  Indicate  it
        to the pc. He will usually agree and cognite. The TA will come down
        further and the needle will float. That's it.


    B.      Now take the Study Correction List. Assess it  Method  5.  Pick
        out the biggest LFBD you got.  Indicate  it  to  the  pc.  He  will
        cognite, the TA will drop down and an F/N will occur. That's it.


    C.      Put these 2 sheets in his pc folder for full  handling  of  all
        reads by his auditor and add them  to  the  pc's  auditing  program
        sheet inside the left front cover of the pc's folder.

The result will often be magical. The  person  will  become  more  agreeable
about study or the Primary Correction Rundown.


    Of course they should now get a Primary Correction Rundown of which C/S
53RC is the first step anyway.


    This Pre-PCRD gets them started. And it only takes a little while.


    The End Phenomena of a  Primary  Correction  Rundown  is  "Can  he  now
quickly and easily do the Primary Rundown?" If yes, and if it works  out  in
practice that he can, that's it. Let him onto the  Primary  RD.  But  if  he
bogs, back to the PCRD.


                                    MORAL

    The moral of this HCO B is get them through  the  Primary  Rundown.  If
they can't or don't go, do the PCRD. And if they're shunted to the PCRD  get
it DONE. And get them to the real EP which is SUPER LITERACY. The moral  is,
get them through. Don't idle about. Get it DONE.


    Then  they  will  whizz  along  on  fast  flow  study  and  you've  got
COMPLETIONS.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              4 FEBRUARY 1972RD
                  Revised & Reissued 7 February 1975 as BTB
                               (5th Revision)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 4 FEBRUARY 1972
                                 SAME TITLE


                               Study Series 7


                        STUDY CORRECTION LIST REVISED


    Ref:    HCOB       19 Jan 66  Danger Conditions-Technical Data
                 for Review Auditors
          HCOB    9 Nov 67   Revision of Remedy A, Remedy B,
                  and S and Ds
          HCOB    1 Aug 68   The Laws of Listing and Nulling
          HCOB    23 Nov 69R III  Student Rescue Intensive
          Revised      26 Jun 73
          HCOB    19 Mar 71  L1C
          HCOB    30 Jun 71  Word Clearing Series 8RB
          Revised      9 Aug 71
          Revised      11 May 72
          HCOB    9 Dec 71RA      PTS Rundown
          Revised      21 Oct 74
          HCOB    20 Jan 72  PTS RD Addition
          BTB     14 Aug 68R      Remedy B-Environment and "New Style"
          BTB     1 Dec 71RIV     Effort Processing
          BTB     21 Jul 71RD     Word Clearing Correction List Revised
          BTB     1 Dec 71RBII    Triple Ruds Long Duration
          Revised      6 Jan 75
          BTB     1 Dec 71 III    Rising Scale Processing

    This Correction List is first assessed throughout on the Meter with all
reads and blowdowns properly noted (Method 5). It is then handled by  taking
up any Section I (rudiment type question) that read  (ARC  Brk,  PTP,  W/H).
Thereafter it is handled on the basis of biggest reads first,  then  smaller
reads until each read has been F/Ned by doing the action  called  for  under
the Question.


    Clear all words before assessment.


    Put in "R-Factor": "We are going to go over a list  of  possible  study
troubles. I am going to call out the question to see if  it  reacts  on  the
Meter. Then after this action is done, we will take up the items one by  one
that were found to  be  active.  You  need  not  say  anything  during  this
assessment of the list.

1A.   HAS THERE BEEN AN UPSET ABOUT STUDY?   _________
      Fly all ruds triple "In study has there been _____ ?"

1B.   HAVE THERE BEEN UPSETS IN GETTING WORDS
      CLEARED UP?      _________
      W/C Corr List and handle.

1C.   HAVE YOU BEEN UPSET BY EARLIER STUDY REPAIRS?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

1D.   DO YOU FEEL THAT IT WON'T DO ANY GOOD TO TRY
      TO HANDLE STUDY? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
1E.   HAVE THERE BEEN UPSETS IN STUDY?  _________
      L1C "On study _____" each reading item to F/N.

1F.   DO YOU HAVE AN ARC BREAK WITH ANOTHER
      STUDENT?   _________
      Triple      "Do you have an ARC/B with another student" to F/N.
      Flow 2 "Does another student have an ARC/B with you" to F/N.
      Flow 3 "Does another have an ARC/B with another or other
              students" to F/N.

1G.   DO YOU HAVE AN ARC BREAK WITH AN EXAMINER?   _________
      Triple      "Do you have an ARC/B with an Examiner" to F/N.
      Flow 2 "Does an Examiner have an ARC/B with you" to F/N.
      Flow 3 "Does another have an ARC/B with an Examiner" to F/N.

1H.   DO YOU HAVE AN ARC BREAK WITH A COURSE?      _________
      Triple      "Do you have an ARC/B with a course" to F/N.
      Flow 2 "Does another have an ARC/B with a course" to F/N.
      Flow 3 "Do others have an ARC/B with a course" to F/N.

1I.   HAVE YOU HAD A PTP WHILE STUDYING?     _________
      Triple      "Have you had a PTP while studying" to F/N.
      Flow 2 "Has another had a PTP while studying" to F/N.
      Flow 3 "Have others had a PTP while studying" to F/N.

1J.   IS STUDY A SOLUTION TO A PROBLEM? _________
      What problem, 2wc E/S problem to F/N.

1K.   IS A SUBJECT MAKING A PROBLEM THAT DIDN'T EXIST?   _________
      What problem, 2wc E/S to F/N.

1L.   DO YOU HAVE A W/H FROM A SUPERVISOR?   _________
      What, who missed it, what was his action that made you
      think he knew, E/S W/H to F/N.
      Flow 2 "Does a Supervisor have a W/H from you" to F/N.
      Flow 3 "Do others have a W/H from a Supervisor" to F/N.

1M.   DO YOU HAVE A W/H FROM A STUDENT? _________
      Handle as in 1L.
      Flow 2 "Does a student have a W/H from you" to F/N.
      Flow 3 "Does another have a W/H from a student" to F/N.

1N.   HAVE YOU EVER COMMITTED OVERTS ON A
      TEACHER OR SUPERVISOR? _________
      Triple      "What overt has a teacher or Supervisor committed
              on you" E/S to F/N.
      Flow 2 "What overt have you committed on a teacher or
              Supervisor" E/S to F/N.
      Flow 3 "What overts have others committed on teachers or
              Supervisors" E/S to F/N.

1O.   HAVE YOU EVER COMMITTED OVERTS ON STUDENTS?  _________
      Triple      "What overts have students committed on you" E/S to F/N.
      Flow 2 "What overts have you committed on students" E/S to F/N.
      Flow 3 "What overts have others committed on students" E/S to F/N.

1P.   HAVE YOU EVER LIED TO A TEACHER?  _________
      Triple      "What lie has a teacher told to you" E/S to F/N.
      Flow 2 "What lie have you told to a teacher" E/S to F/N.
      Flow 3 "What lies have others told to a teacher" E/S to F/N.

1Q.   HAVE YOU EVER CHEATED ON AN EXAM? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

1R.   HAVE YOU EVER DAMAGED STUDY MATERIALS OR
      BOOKS?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

1S.   HAVE YOU EVER FAILED TO APPLY WHAT YOU
      LEARNED?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

1T.   ARE YOU STUDYING FOR SOME OTHER REASON?      _________
      What, 2wc E/S to F/N.

1U.   HAVE YOU STUDIED SOMETHING OUT OF SEQUENCE?  _________
      What, 2wc E/S to F/N.

1V.   ARE YOU DOING THINGS THAT AFFECT YOUR STUDY? _________
      What, 2wc E/S to F/N.

1W.   HAVE YOU OMITTED DOING PARTS OF A CHECKSHEET?      _________
      What, 2wc E/S to F/N.

1X.   HAVE YOU GIVEN ANOTHER STUDENT A FALSE PASS? _________
      Who, 2wc E/S to F/N.

1Y.   HAVE YOU PASSED A CHECKOUT, TEST OR EXAM
      FALSELY?   _________
      What, 2wc E/S to F/N.

1Z.   ARE YOU FALSIFYING YOUR STUDY STATS?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

1AA.  ARE YOU NOT REALLY TRYING?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

Note: Take up the above Section 1 questions and clean up each  one  to  F/N.
      The remainder of the list is done by biggest reads  first.  The  whole
      assessment may be done before taking up any Q. But if the  student  is
      misemotional do Section 1 above, handle, then assess the remainder  of
      the list and handle.

1BB.  IN STUDY HAS THERE BEEN ANY MISREPRESENTATION?     _________
      What, by whom, 2wc E/S to F/N.

1CC.  IN STUDY HAS THERE BEEN ANY NON-INVOLVEMENT? _________
      What, by whom, 2wc E/S to F/N.

1DD.  ARE YOU HAVING TROUBLE WITH YOUR STUDY TWIN? _________
      Mutual ruds "Do you have an ARC/B with_____"
      "Does _____have an ARC/B with you"
      "Do you have a problem with_____"
      "Does _____have a problem with you"
      "Do you have a W/H from _____"
      "Does _____have a W/H from you"
      "Have you committed an overt on_____"
      "Has _____committed an overt on you"
      (In extreme cases showing misemotion on this add to PTS R/D  (a).)  In
      case of "No study twin" as the answer, do only 2wc E/S to F/N.

1EE.  HAS THERE BEEN NO ONE TO SUPERVISE YOUR STUDY?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
1FF.  HAVE YOUR QUESTIONS NOT BEEN ANSWERED?       _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

1GG.  DID THE SUPERVISOR NOT SEEM TO CARE?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

1HH.  DID NO ONE SHOW ANY INTEREST IN YOUR PROGRESS?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

1JJ.  HAVE YOU NOT BEEN GIVEN WHAT WAS PROMISED?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

1KK.  IS YOUR POST MORE IMPORTANT?      _________
      Fly all ruds including overts "On your post_____"

1LL.  IS YOUR ATTENTION ON YOUR POST?   _________
      Handle as in 1KK.

1MM.  ARE YOU HAVING TROUBLE WITH YOUR AUDITING?   _________
      What, 2wc E/S to F/N. If it's Lists, do an L4BR and handle.
      If this Q reads, note it for C/S.

2A.   HAS THERE BEEN A MISUNDERSTOOD WORD?   _________
      Find it, get it looked up and corrected.

2B.   HAVE THERE BEEN MISUNDERSTOOD SUBJECTS?      _________
      Give person Word Clear M1 or get the W/C M1 already done
      with the missing subjects added to the W/C M1 Standard C/S.

2C.   HAVE MISUNDERSTOODS BEEN NOT-ISED?     _________
      Find it, get it looked up and corrected, each one found.

2D.   ARE THERE PARTIAL MISUNDERSTOODS?      _________
      Find them, get them looked up and corrected.

2E.   ARE YOU READING OR STUDYING SOMETHING APART
      FROM YOUR COURSE MATERIALS THAT YOU
      MISUNDERSTAND?   _________
      What, find the m/u/stoods, get them looked up and corrected.

2F.   DO YOU HAVE A MISUNDERSTOOD FROM AN EARLIER
      STUDIED SUBJECT?       _________
      Handle as in 2B.

2G.   DID YOU SUBSTITUTE A WORD?  _________
      Find the original word, handle it as a misunderstood.

2H.   COULDN'T YOU SEE HOW IT COULD BE THAT WAY?   _________
      Find the m/u/stoods, get them looked up and used in sentences.

2I.   DID YOU STOP YOUR STUDY OF A SUBJECT AT
      SOME POINT?      _________
      Handle as in 2B.

2J.   WERE THERE TECHNICAL TERMS WITH NO
      EXPLANATION AVAILABLE? _________
      Find them, get them looked up and used in sentences.

2K.   DID THE SAME WORD MEAN SOMETHING ELSE IN
      ANOTHER SUBJECT? _________
      Find it, handle as a misunderstood word in both subjects by
      getting the word used with the definition of each subject.
2L.   HAVE YOU STUDIED AN INCOMPREHENSIBLE SUBJECT?
      Handle as in 2B.

2M.   HAVE YOU MEMORIZED DATA WITHOUT
      UNDERSTANDING IT?      _________
      What, find and handle the misunderstoods.

2N.   IS THERE A DEFINITION YOU DISAGREE WITH?     _________
      Get off the disagreement by 2wc, then when cooled off, find
      and handle the misunderstood connected with it.

20.   IS THERE A NAME OR TITLE OF SOMETHING YOU
      DISAGREE WITH?   _________
      Handle as in 2N.

2P.   WERE THE NAMES OR TITLES GIVEN THINGS IN
      A SUBJECT MEANINGLESS? _________
      What, 2wc to F/N, looking for any misunderstood also.

2Q.   HAS THERE BEEN AN INCORRECT DEFINITION?      _________
      What, get off any disagreement, then get it defined
      correctly and used in sentences to F/N.

2R.   WERE YOU NOT ABLE TO FIND A DEFINITION?      _________
      What, handle it as a misunderstood.

2S.   DO YOU HAVE MORE THAN ONE INCOMPLETE
      CHECKSHEET?      _________
      Find the earliest one, find and handle the misunderstoods
      connected with it. Do the same with each incomplete
      checksheet up to the latest one.

2T.   DO YOU HAVE MISUNDERSTOODS IN THE SUBJECTS
      OF DIANETICS AND SCIENTOLOGY?     _________
      Remedy A, then W/C M2 on earliest materials read or
      heard in Dn and Scn.

2U.   ARE YOU HAVING ANY TROUBLE STUDYING
      DIANETICS AND SCIENTOLOGY?  _________
      Remedy B, then handle as in 2B.

2V.   HAVE YOU FAILED TO COMPLETE COURSES YOU TOOK?      _________
      2wc "Tell me about courses you have failed to complete" E/S
      to F/N. Followed by W/C M 1 actions on courses named.

2W.   DO YOU HAVE A MISUNDERSTOOD SYMBOL?    _________
      Find it, get it looked up and corrected. Then check for any more
      misunderstood symbols and handle.

3A.   HAVE THE BASICS OF A SUBJECT BEEN OMITTED?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3B.   HAVE STUDY MATERIALS BEEN UNAVAILABLE? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3C.   HAS THERE BEEN NO TRAINING AVAILABLE?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3D.   HAVE COURSE MATERIALS BEEN MISSING?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3E.   HAVE YOU BEEN TRYING TO STUDY A LOST
      TECHNOLOGY?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3F.   DID THE MATERIAL OF A SUBJECT NOT CONTAIN
      HOW YOU DO IT?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3G.   ARE YOU STUDYING WITH NO PROGRAM?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3H.   ARE YOU GETTING NOWHERE?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, be alert for misunderstoods.

3I.   DO YOU HAVE NO STUDY TWIN?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3J.   WAS THE SUBJECT OF NO USE?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, be alert for misunderstoods.

3K.   DID THE SUBJECT HAVE NO APPLICATION?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3L.   HAS STUDY NOT LED TO A FINITE RESULT?  _________
      What subject, look for m/u/stoods in it and handle.

3M.   HAVE THERE BEEN INSUFFICIENT TERMS TO
      DIFFERENTIATE ASPECTS OF THE SUBJECT?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3N.   HAVE YOU NOT HAD ANY REASON TO STUDY?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, be alert to any natter and pull the M/W/Hs.

30.   HAVE YOU FAILED TO ACHIEVE A STUDY TARGET?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3P.   WAS THE DOINGNESS CONVERTED TO SIGNIFICANCE?       _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3Q.   WAS THE SIGNIFICANCE DETACHED FROM THE ACTION?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3R.   WAS IT ALL DOINGNESS AND NO SIGNIFICANCE?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

3S.   HAS THERE BEEN NO MASS WITH THE SIGNIFICANCE?      _________
      With what piece of data, scout for any m/u/stood word, handle.
      Then get the data demonstrated in the session-use a demo kit.
      2wc it as needed.

3T.   WAS IT TOTAL SIGNIFICANCE AND NO DOINGNESS?  _________
      Handle as in 3S.

3U.   HAVE YOU BEEN STUDYING SOMETHING WITH ITS
      MASS ABSENT?     _________
      Handle as in 3S.

3V.   WAS THE MASS OF THE SUBJECT NOT AVAILABLE
      TO STUDY?  _________
      Handle as in 3S.

4A.   WAS THE GRADIENT TOO STEEP? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

4B.   DID YOU SKIP A GRADIENT?    _________
      2wc to find the m/u/stood word around the area Pc was
      studying when he was last doing well and handle.

4C.   HAVE YOU STUDIED SOMETHING ON THE WRONG
      GRADIENT?  _________
      Find out if too steep, if so, handle as in 4A. If too shallow 2wc
      E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

4D.   DID YOU GO ON TO A MORE ADVANCED ACTION
      BEFORE ABLE TO HANDLE THE EARLIER ONE?       _________
      Find the earlier one, then find the misunderstood word and handle.

4E.   HAS THERE BEEN A WRONG EMPHASIS?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

4F.   DID YOU HAVE TO LEARN TOO MANY OTHER THINGS
      BEFORE YOU COULD LEARN WHAT YOU WANTED TO?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

4G.   WAS A SUBJECT RELAYED TO YOU OVER TOO LONG A
      PERIOD?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

4H.   DID YOU STUDY A SUBJECT FOR A LONG LONG TIME?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, handle any m/u/stood found.

4I.   IS YOUR STUDY PROGRAM INCORRECT?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

4J.   WAS THE ORDER OF ACTION INCORRECT?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

4K.   DID YOU FEEL YOU HAD TO STUDY TOO MUCH TOO
      FAST? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

4L.   DO YOU HAVE TOO MUCH TO DO? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

4M.   HAVE THE TERMS USED IN A SUBJECT BEEN CHANGED?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

4N.   HAVE YOU NEVER STUDIED THE BASIC FUNDAMENTALS
      OF A SUBJECT?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

40.   HAVE RELATIVE IMPORTANCES NOT BEEN EVALUATED?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, look for misunderstoods and handle.

4P.   HAS THERE BEEN A LACK OF THE RELATIVE
      APPLICABILITY OF THE DATA?  _________
      Handle as in 40.

4Q.   HAVE YOU STUDIED THE SAME SUBJECT MORE THAN
      ONCE?      _________
      "Why did you have to study the same subject more than once"
      2wc E/S to F/N.

4R.   DIDN'T YOU KNOW HOW TO STUDY A SUBJECT?      _________
      What subject, find and handle misunderstood words.

4S.   DID YOU ALREADY HAVE TO BE AN EXPERT IN ORDER
      TO STUDY SOME SUBJECT?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

4T.   DID YOU KNOW ALL THERE WAS TO KNOW?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

4U.   DID YOU THINK YOU KNEW ALL ABOUT IT BUT
      COULDN'T APPLY IT AND GET RESULTS?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any inval.

4V.   DID YOU STUDY WITH FIXED OPINIONS?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

4W.   DID YOU ALREADY KNOW ALL ABOUT IT?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any inval.

5A.   WAS A SUBJECT'S PURPOSE NOT DESCRIBED?       _________
      What subject, find and clear its purpose. If it doesn't have
      a purpose, prepcheck it to F/N.

5B.   DID YOU NOT BELIEVE A SUBJECT'S PURPOSE?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

5C.   WAS A SUBJECT'S PURPOSE NOT REAL TO YOU?     _________
      Find and handle the misunderstoods on it.

5D.   WAS THE PURPOSE OF A SUBJECT NOT ATTAINABLE?       _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

5E.   WAS THE PURPOSE OF A SUBJECT NOT UNDERSTOOD?       _________
      Handle as in 5C.

5F.   IS YOUR PURPOSE IN STUDYING A SUBJECT CONFLICTING
      WITH THE SUPERVISOR'S OR THE SUBJECT'S PURPOSE?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N. (Note well for Ex Dn C/S to Pgm E/Purp
      handling or upper level C/S to Pgm for L9S as case may R/S.)

5G.   DID THE STUDY OF A SUBJECT NOT END UP IN A
      DOINGNESS?       _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

5H.   WERE YOU NEVER REQUIRED TO DO THE
      DOINGNESS OF A SUBJECT?     _________
      Handle as in 5G.

5I.   DID YOU STUDY WITHOUT APPLYING THE SUBJECT
      TO LIFE?   _________
      2wc on how the subject applies or can be applied to life.

 5J.  HAVE YOU HAD TO STUDY SOMETHING YOU WOULD
      NEVER NEED TO APPLY?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

6A.   HAVE YOU PRETENDED TO HAVE STUDIED THINGS
      YOU HADN'T?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

6B.   HAVE YOU PRETENDED TO HAVE QUALIFICATIONS
      YOU DID NOT ACTUALLY ATTAIN?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

6C.   HAVE YOU STUDIED A TECHNOLOGY THAT
      PRETENDED TO DO SOMETHING?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

6D.   HAVE YOU EVER PRETENDED TO KNOW A SUBJECT?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

6E.   ARE YOU JUST PRETENDING TO STUDY? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get why.

6F.   HAVE YOU STUDIED JUST TO LEARN A FEW GIMMICKS?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

6G.   WERE YOU REALLY STUDYING ONLY TO PASS AN
      EXAM? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get why.

6H.   DID YOU HAVE SOME UNDISCLOSED REASON FOR
      STUDYING A SUBJECT?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N (Note well for Ex Dn C/S to Pgm for E/Purp
      handling or upper level C/S to Pgm for L9S as case may R/S.)

6I.   DID YOU HAVE TO PRETEND YOU KNEW IT?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get why. (In extreme cases showing misemotion
      on this note any names mentioned and their reads for C/S to Pgm
      for full PTS R/D.)

7A.   DID THE MATERIALS CONTAIN INCORRECT DATA?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

7B.   HAVE YOU STUDIED A FALSE TECHNOLOGY?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

7C.   WAS THE DATA INCORRECT?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

7D.   HAVE YOU BEEN STUDYING SOMETHING THAT WAS
      FALSE?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

7E.   IN STUDY HAS ANYONE TAUGHT OR GIVEN YOU
      FALSE DATA?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest. (In extreme cases showing
      misemotion on this note any names mentioned and their reads
      for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.)

7F.   WERE YOU NOT TAUGHT THE ESSENTIALS OF A
      SUBJECT NECESSARY TO GETTING IT APPLIED?     _________
      Handle as in 7E by getting who.

7G.   WERE YOU NOT ALLOWED TO OBSERVE, UNDERSTAND
      AND DO?    _________
      Handle as in 7E by getting who.

7H.   DID THE DATA NOT APPLY IN PT?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, get off any protest.

7I.   DID YOU UNDERSTAND THE NAME BUT NOT THE
      THING?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, be alert for any misunderstood word
      connected with it and handle.

7J.   WAS IT TOO DIFFERENT FROM WHAT EVERYONE
      BELIEVES?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

7K.   WOULD SOMEONE ELSE WIN IF YOU BECAME
      EDUCATED?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N. (In extreme cases showing misemotion
      on this note any names mentioned and their reads for C/S
      to Pgm for full PTS R/D.)

7L.   WOULD KNOWLEDGE MAKE YOU TOO POWERFUL? _________
      Run   (1) "What have you done with knowledge"
            (2) "What have you withheld". Alternate repetitive.
      (Note well for Ex Dn C/S to Pgm for E/Purp handling or
      upper level C/S to Pgm for L9S as case may R/S.)

7M.   WILL KNOWLEDGE CREATE PROBLEMS FOR YOU?      _________
      What, 2wc E/S problem to F/N.

7N.   DO YOU HAVE DISAGREEMENTS IN STUDY?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N. Then 2wc E/S to F/N "Tell me about
      things you agree with in study".

70.   DO YOU DISAGREE WITH THE DATA?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N. Then "Tell me about data you agree with"
      2wc E/S to F/N.

7P.   DO YOU INVALIDATE YOURSELF IN STUDY?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N, followed by "Tell me about confusion
      that came before that" 2wc E/S to F/N.

7Q.   DID YOU INVALIDATE A DATUM?
      Handle as in 7P.

7R.   HAVE YOU NEVER BEEN ABLE TO APPLY DATA?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N. The C/S Pgms W/C M1 or gets the
      W/C M1 already done, redone adding any subjects Pc
      mentions in the 2wc, after this List EPs.

7S.   ARE YOU NOT ABLE TO SUPPORT YOURSELF
      FINANCIALLY WHILE STUDYING? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

7T.   DIDN'T YOU DARE BELIEVE IT WAS THAT WAY?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

7U.   WAS IT UNBELIEVABLE?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

7V.   HAVE YOU CONTINUED TO STUDY A SUBJECT YOU
      HAD ALREADY GRASPED?   _________
      Find the point of win. Rehab it. (Upper level Auditor,
      date to blow-locate to blow point of win.)

7W.   IN STUDY HAS SOMETHING BEEN OVERRUN?   _________
      Handle as in 7V.

8A.   ARE YOU HAVING TROUBLE IN YOUR ENVIRONMENT?  _________
      Environment Remedy B.

8B.   IS YOUR ATTENTION ON SOMETHING IN YOUR
      ENVIRONMENT?     _________
      Handle as in 8A.

8C.   IS THERE A PARTICULAR SUBJECT YOU ARE HAVING
      TROUBLE WITH?    _________
      What, Remedy B New Style on it.

8D.   ARE YOU TRYING TO DO SOMETHING ELSE WITH
      STUDY?     _________
      L&N to BD F/N item "What are you trying to do with study".
      (Upper level Auditor, date to blow-locate to blow item.)

8E.   ARE YOU TRYING TO SOLVE SOME MYSTERY?  _________
      L&N to BD F/N item "What mystery are you trying to solve".
      (Upper level Auditor, date to blow-locate to blow item.)

8F.   ARE YOU TRYING TO FORGET SOMETHING?    _________
      L&N to BD F/N item "What are you trying to forget".
      (Upper level Auditor, date to blow-locate to blow item.)

8G.   HAVE YOU EVER STUDIED FOR STATUS? _________
      L&N to BD F/N item "Who or what would study for status".
      O/W on item to F/N.

8H.   IS THERE SOMEONE WHO WILL BENEFIT
      FROM YOUR KNOWLEDGE?   _________
      L&N to BD F/N item "Who will benefit from your knowledge".
      O/W on item to F/N.

8I.   IS THERE A SUBJECT THAT SHOULDN'T BE STUDIED?      _________
      L&N to BD F/N item "What subject shouldn't be studied".
      O/W on item to F/N.

8J.   IS THERE A SUBJECT YOU DISAGREE WITH?  _________
      What. L&N to BD F/N item "On____what do you disagree with".
      Then run "What part of that disagreement could you be
      responsible for?" repetitive to F/N.

8K.   HAVE YOU FELT STUPID ABOUT A SUBJECT?  _________
      2wc to find what subject, what confusion existed just before that,
      find what was misunderstood at that time and clear it. Go E/S
      to F/N if required.

9A.   HAVE YOU BEEN TAUGHT BY SOMEONE YOU DIDN'T
      LIKE OR HATED?   _________
      L&N "Who has tried to teach you that you didn't like"
      and L&N "Who have you taught that you didn't like"
      and L&N "Who has taught others that they didn't like".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9B.   HAS ANYONE EVER CONSIDERED THAT YOU WERE
      STUPID?    _________
      L&N "Who has considered you stupid (or mentally retarded)"
      and L&N "Whom have you considered stupid"
      and L&N "Who has considered others stupid".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9C.   DID SOMEBODY MAKE YOU FEEL STUPID FOR NOT
      KNOWING IT?      _________
      L&N "Who has made you feel stupid"
      and L&N "Who have you made feel stupid"
      and L&N "Who has made others feel stupid".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9D.   HAVE YOU EVER BEEN INVALIDATED BY AN AUTHORITY
      OF A SUBJECT?    _________
      L&N "Who has invalidated you"
      and L&N "Who have you invalidated"
      and L&N "Who has invalidated others".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9E.   HAS SOMEBODY TOLD YOU YOU DON'T KNOW HOW TO
      STUDY?     _________
      L&N "Who has told you you don't know"
      and L&N "Who have you told he doesn't know"
      and L&N "Who has told others they don't know".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9F.   WERE YOU TOO EMBARRASSED TO FIND OUT?  _________
      L&N "Who has embarrassed you"
      and L&N "Who have you embarrassed"
      and L&N "Who has embarrassed others".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9G.   HAS SOMEBODY TRIED TO CORRECT YOUR STUDY
      WHEN THERE WAS NOTHING WRONG?     _________
      L&N "Who tried to correct you when there was nothing wrong"
      and L&N "Who did you try to correct when there was nothing wrong"
      and L&N "Who tried to correct others when there was nothing wrong".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9H.   WERE YOU MADE TO FEEL INCOMPETENT?     _________
      L&N "Who has made you feel incompetent"
      and L&N "Who have you made feel incompetent"
      and L&N "Who has made others feel incompetent".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9I.   HAS A WIN BEEN INVALIDATED? _________
      L&N "Who has invalidated your wins"
      and L&N "Whose wins have you invalidated"
      and L&N "Who has invalidated others' wins".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9J.   WERE YOU MADE TO FEEL UNCONFIDENT?     _________
      L&N "Who has made you feel unconfident"
      and L&N "Who have you made feel unconfident"
      and L&N "Who has made others feel unconfident".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9K.   WOULD YOU HAVE LOWERED YOUR STATUS IF
      YOU ADMITTED YOU DIDN'T REALLY KNOW?   _________
      L&N "Who have you not wanted present when your status was
      lowered"
      and L&N "Who did not want you present when his status was
      lowered"
      and L&N "Who have others not wanted present when
      their status was lowered".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9L.   HAS SOMEONE EVALUATED AND GIVEN YOU THE
      WRONG ORDER OF IMPORTANCES? _________
      L&N "Who has evaluated for you"
      and L&N "Who have you evaluated for"
      and L&N "Who has evaluated for others".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9M.   HAVE YOU BEEN INVALIDATED FOR STUDYING IT?   _________
      Handle as in 9D.

9N.   WAS A SUBJECT TAUGHT TO YOU SUPPRESSIVELY?   _________
      L&N "Who has taught you suppressively"
      and L&N "Who have you taught suppressively"
      and L&N "Who has taught others suppressively".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

90.   HAS SOMEONE TOLD YOU YOU CAN'T STUDY?  _________
      L&N "Who has told you you can't study"
      and L&N "Who have you told he can't study"
      and L&N "Who has told others they can't study".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9P.   WAS A SUBJECT MADE TOO DANGEROUS TO DO?      _________
      L&N "Who made something too dangerous for you"
      and L&N "Who did you make something too dangerous for"
      and L&N "Who made something too dangerous for others".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9Q.   DID YOU HAVE TO LEARN THINGS YOU WOULD
      NEVER DO?  _________
      L&N "Who made you learn things you would never do"
      and L&N "Who have you made learn things he would never do"
      and L&N "Who has made  others  learn  things  they  would  never  do".
Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9R.   WERE YOU NOT ALLOWED TO COMPLETE A COURSE
      OF STUDY?  _________
      L&N "Who has not allowed you to complete something"
      and L&N "Who have you not allowed to complete something"
      and L&N "Who has not allowed others to complete something".
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

9S.   WAS IT ALL CHANGED AFTER YOU LEARNED HOW
      TO DO IT?  _________
      Handle as in 9R.

10A.  HAVE YOU EVER BEEN PUNISHED BECAUSE YOU
      WOULDN'T LEARN?  _________
      R3R Narrative Triple
      Flow 1: "Locate  an  incident  when  you  were  punished  because  you
      wouldn't learn." Going earlier: "Is there an earlier incident when you
      were punished because you wouldn't learn?"
      Flow 2: "Locate an incident  when  you  punished  another  because  he
      wouldn't learn." Going earlier: "Is there an earlier incident when you
      punished another because he wouldn't learn?"
      Flow 3: "Locate an incident when another punished others because  they
      wouldn't learn." Going earlier: "Is there  an  earlier  incident  when
      another punished others because they wouldn't learn?"

10B.  HAVE YOU EVER GOTTEN IN TROUBLE BECAUSE
      YOU KNEW SOMETHING?    _________

      R3R Narrative Triple
      Flow 1: "Locate an incident when another got you  in  trouble  because
      you knew something." Going earlier: "Is there an earlier incident when
      another got you in trouble because you knew something?"
      Flow 2: "Locate an incident when you got another in trouble because he
      knew something." Going earlier: "Is there an earlier incident when you
      got another in trouble because he knew something?"
      Flow 3: "Locate an incident when another got others in trouble because
      they knew something." Going earlier: "Is  there  an  earlier  incident
      when another got in trouble because they knew something?"

10C.  DO YOU TRY TO GET OUT OF CLASSROOMS OR
      SCHOOLS?   _________
      R3R Narrative Triple
      Flow 1: "Locate a time when you were made to go to school  or  class."
      Going earlier: "Is there an earlier time when you were made to  go  to
      school or class?"
      Flow 2: "Locate a time when you made someone go to school  or  class."
      Going earlier: "Is there an earlier time when you made someone  go  to
      school or class?"
      Flow 3: "Locate a time when  another  made  others  go  to  school  or
      class." Going earlier: "Is there an earlier time another  made  others
      go to school or class?"

10D.  HAVE YOU BEEN FORCED TO BE EDUCATED?   _________
      Do a full Student Rescue Intensive using "Be educated".

10E.  HAVE YOU BEEN FORCED TO BE TRAINED?    _________
      Do a full Student Rescue Intensive using "Be trained".

10F.  HAVE YOU BEEN FORCED TO LEARN?    _________
      Do a full Student Rescue Intensive using "learn".

10G.  HAVE YOU BEEN FORCED TO STUDY?    _________
      Do a full Student Rescue Intensive using "study".

10H.  WAS THE SUBJECT OVERWHELMING?     _________
      R3R Narrative Triple
      Flow 1: "Locate a time when someone  or  something  overwhelmed  you."
      Going earlier: "Is there an earlier time  when  someone  or  something
      overwhelmed you?"
      Flow 2: "Locate a time when you  overwhelmed  someone  or  something."
      Going earlier: "Is there an earlier time when you overwhelmed  someone
      or something?"
      Flow 3: "Locate a time when someone or something overwhelmed  others."
      Going earlier: "Is there an earlier incident when someone or something
      overwhelmed others?"

10I.  WERE YOU INVALIDATED BY AN EXAMINATION
      FAILURE?   _________
      R3R Narrative Triple
      Flow 1: "Locate an incident  when  another  invalidated  you  with  an
      examination failure." Going earlier: "Is  there  an  earlier  incident
      when another invalidated you with an examination failure?"
      Flow 2: "Locate an incident  when  you  invalidated  another  with  an
      examination failure." Going earlier: "Is  there  an  earlier  incident
      when you invalidated another with an examination failure?"
      Flow 3: "Locate an incident when another invalidated another or others
      with an examination failure." Going  earlier:  "Is  there  an  earlier
      incident  when  another  invalidated  another  or   others   with   an
      examination failure?"

10J.  DO YOU GET ANXIOUS OR MISEMOTIONAL ABOUT
      EXAMS?     _________
      R3R Narrative Triple
      Flow 1: "Locate a time when another  caused  you  to  be  misemotional
      about exams." Going  earlier:  "Is  there  an  earlier  incident  when
      another caused you to be misemotional about exams?"
      Flow 2: "Locate a time when you  caused  another  to  be  misemotional
      about exams." Going earlier: "Is there an earlier  incident  when  you
      caused another to be misemotional about exams?"
      Flow 3: "Locate a time when another caused another  or  others  to  be
      misemotional  about  exams."  Going  earlier:  "Is  there  an  earlier
      incident when another caused another  or  others  to  be  misemotional
      about exams?"

10K.  HAVE EXAMINATIONS NOT BEEN IN LINE WITH THE
      DATA STUDIED?    _________
      Handle as in 10J, or 2wc E/S to F/N if 10J already handled.

11A.  DO YOU HAVE BAD EYESIGHT OR EYESTRAIN? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N. C/S Pgms for Effort Processing and Rising
      Scale. (Upper level C/S & Pgms, if this persists, L10.)

11B.  CAN'T YOU CONFRONT BOOKS OR PRINTED PAGES?   _________
      2wc E/S to F/N. Note what pc can't confront so C/S can
      Pgm TR 0 on it for 2 hours.

11C.  ARE YOU PROTESTING HAVING YOUR STUDY
      REPAIRED?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

11D.  ARE YOU UPSET ABOUT THIS STUDY REPAIR? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

11E.  ARE YOU TOO PHYSICALLY UPSET TO STUDY? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
      Refer to Registrar for case handling or treatment.

11F.  IS YOUR MIND IN BAD CONDITION?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.
      Refer to Registrar for case handling.

11G.  IN YOUR STUDIES HAVE THERE BEEN ANY IGNORED
      ORIGINATIONS?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

11H.  IN YOUR STUDIES HAVE COGNITIONS BEEN INVALI-
      DATED?     _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

11I.  HAVE YOU EVER KNOWN A SUBJECT WELL AND
      THEN HAD YOUR PASS OR TRAINING INVALIDATED?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N. Get off any protest. (In extreme cases
      showing any misemotion on this, note any names mentioned
      and their reads for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.)

11J.  HAVE YOU EVER FALSELY ATTESTED TO A COM-
      PLETION WHEN YOU HAD NOT REALLY PASSED?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

11K.  HAS THERE BEEN NO STUDY?    _________
      L&N "W/W would prevent study?" Note item for C/S to
      Pgm for full PTS R/D.
11L.  IS IT DANGEROUS TO STUDY?   _________
      Why? 2wc E/S to F/N.

11M.  HAS THERE BEEN LACK OF TIME TO STUDY?  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

11N.  HAS THERE BEEN INCORRECT SEQUENCE OF STUDY
      DATA? _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

11O.  IN A SUBJECT HAS THERE BEEN OMITTED DATA?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

12A.  ARE YOU CONNECTED TO SOMEONE WHO IS
      ANTAGONISTIC TO SCIENTOLOGY?      _________
      PTS R/D and handle PT connection through Ethics.

12B.  IS SOMEONE CAUSING YOU ENTURBULATION?  _________
      L&N "Who has caused you enturbulation"
      "Who have you caused enturbulation"
      "Who has caused others enturbulation".
      Handle any PT connection through Ethics.
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

12C.  IS SOMEONE TRYING TO STOP YOU FROM BEING MORE
      ABLE? _________
      L&N "Who has tried to stop you from being more able"
      "Who have you tried to stop from being more able"
      "Who have others tried to stop from being more able".
      Handle any PT connection through Ethics.
      Note items for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

12D.  WOULD SOMEONE CAUSE TROUBLE IF THEY KNEW
      WHAT YOU ARE DOING?    _________
      2wc E/S to F/N. Handle any PTS situation through Ethics.
      If PTS situation evident note any names mentioned and their
      reads for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

12E.  HAS SOMEONE SAID YOU SHOULDN'T BE HERE?      _________
      2wc E/S to F/N. Handle any PTS situation through Ethics.
      If PTS situation evident, note names mentioned and their reads
      for C/S to Pgm for full PTS R/D.

13A.  THERE IS SOME OTHER REASON NOT GIVEN.  _________
      2wc E/S to F/N.

13B.  THERE WAS REALLY NOTHING WRONG WITH STUDY IN
      THE FIRST PLACE. _________
      Indicate to pc.

13C.  REPAIRING STUDY WAS AN UNNECESSARY ACTION.   _________
      Indicate to pc. Rehab when he felt okay about study.


                                        Revised by order of
                                        L. RON HUBBARD
                                        Founder
                                        Authorized by AVU
BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BL:JW:mh rd                   for the
Copyright   �   1972,1975                                       BOARDS    OF
DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 26 APRIL 1972

Remimeo

                               Study Series 8



                              THE GLIB STUDENT



    The Glib Student can confront the words and ideas.


    He cannot confront the physical universe or people around  him  and  so
cannot apply.


    He does not see Mest or people.


    The reason for this is that he is below non-existence on  one  or  more
dynamics and so cannot align with the others.


    As a spirit or being in a body he has no past or future and so is  just
a social machine.


    Getting him up the dynamics by conditions by "Conditions by  Dynamics",
HCO PL 4 April 72 (Establishment Officer Series  14),  fourth  page,  having
him do general confronting and do TR Courses the Hard  Way  and  having  him
run on the Objective Processes cures this  condition.  It  takes  a  lot  of
work, a lot of auditing but it can be cured.


    Unless it is fully handled he will never  see   enough  more  than  the
paper and words to be more than a glib student who cannot apply.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH:mes jh
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED





[A copy of HCO PL 4 April 1972, Establishment Officer Series 14, Ethics,  is
in Volume VIII, page 78.]
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 4 JANUARY 1973

                          (Reissued 6 April 74-Only
                        change made is in signature)
Remimeo


                               Study Series 9



                                  CONFRONT


    There are several choices in English  on  the  meaning  of  "confront".
These include the right one: To  face  without  flinching  or  avoiding.  An
example in a sentence: "The test of  a  free  society  is  its  capacity  to
confront rather than evade the vital questions of Choice."


    There is another meaning "To stand facing or  opposing,  especially  in
challenge, defiance or accusation."


    English is a pretty limited  language  in  many  ways.  I  imagine  the
thought  of  facing  something  (which  is  what  the  word  came  from  and
originally meant way back-"fron" being "face")  was  so  horrifying  to  the
types who write dictionaries they knew it would be bad!


    In essence it is an action of being able to face.


    If one cannot, if he avoids, then he is not AWARE.


    Awareness  is  the  ability  to  perceive  the  existence  of.  In  the
dictionary it also fails to confront that and says "Awareness:  the  quality
or  state  of  being  aware."  And  Aware  means:  "marked  by  realization,
perception or knowledge."


    So these chaps couldn't confront  and  so  conceived  awareness  to  be
figure-figure.


    We are moving out of the range of language when we want to say:


    "He could stand up to things and  wasn't  always  shrinking  back  into
himself and avoiding, so he could be fully conscious of  the  real  universe
and others around him."


    And that's what Confront means.


    If one can confront he can be aware.


    If he is aware he can perceive and act.


    If he can't confront he will  not  be  aware  of  things  and  will  be
withdrawn and not perceiving. Thus he is unaware of things around him.


    That's the tech of it.



LRH:ntmjh   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1973, 1974       Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
























                             Tape Course Series
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 20 NOVEMBER 1971
                                  Issue II
                          REISSUED 23 OCTOBER 1974
                         (Only change is signature)
CenOCon

                            Tape Course Series 1

                         COURSE TRANSLATION TO TAPE

                   (HCO Policy Letter of 16 November 1970
                  Revised and Reissued as an HCO Bulletin.
                       (Changes in this type style. )


    Translating  Dianetic,  Scientology  study   materials   into   foreign
languages  is  inexpensively  and  effectively   done   by   using   "sight"
(instantaneous) translation of bulletins,  policy  letters  and  tapes  onto
tapes.


    The tape original is made, a copy master is made and thereafter  copies
can be run off for courses which can be attended  by  students,  using  only
excellent tape copies and excellent reproduction equipment, and listened  to
with high fidelity earphones. Word Clearing Technology is  used  to  prevent
the student losing interest because of misunderstood words.


    The tape players used must be equipped with  a  foot  pedal  start-stop
control.


    The voice of the "sight" translator should be  clear  and  the  diction
should be sharp and the tone should not be monotonous.


    A "sight" translator is one equally good in 2 languages  who  can  hear
one language and speak the  translation  into  the  other  language  without
hesitation. (They are employed in the UN.)


    The material copied onto tapes can also be  broken  down  into  smaller
reels for independent study.


    By taking exact notes of the ''auditing commands" and  important  rules
the student will have the texts he needs for later reference.


    The exact rundown of this is given:


    In translating the materials of a course from a textbook  or  materials
in one language to another, the following steps are taken.


                              PRIMARY TARGETS:

1.    A person fully competent in both the languages and their  cultures  is
    found and retained.

2.    The materials to be translated are made available.

3.    A tape recorder which  can  be  started  and  stopped  easily  without
    leaving clicks on the tape is procured. (Not a dictation machine.)

4.    An adequate supply of regular recording tape is made available.

5.    Other materials such as paper and ball-points are made available.

6.    A quiet place where interruptions and outside  noises  will  not  ruin
    the tapes is found and the person is set up there.

7.    A person knowledgeable in the subject and the language  in  which  the
    original is written is retained and assists the translator.
                             OPERATING TARGETS:

1.    The translator (using Word Clearing Technology  and  a  dictionary  to
    clear  up  any  misunderstoods)  rapidly  reads  or  goes  through  the
    materials to get a general grasp of the subject.

2.    The technical  assistant  who  knows  the  subject  and  the  original
    language now goes through the  materials  with  the  translator.  Every
    technical word or phrase or cultural idiom is underlined.

3.    While underlining, the two persons decide on the  correct  translation
    of the technical word or phrase.

4.    As these are decided, they are written  down  on  note  paper  with  a
    complete definition.

5.    Each word, phrase and definition is translated into the  language  and
    written down on a separate sheet of paper.

6.     The  translated  words,  phrases  and  definitions  will   become   a
    mimeographed glossary for the eventual student.

7.    Each section and paragraph in the material is numbered.

8.     With  this  glossary  to  hand,  the  translator  now  begins  direct
    translation of the text onto tape. The  number  of  the  tape  and  its
    materials is given at the beginning of each tape used  or  new  chapter
    begun.

9.    The translator must be sure to read the  materials  in  an  interested
    voice and not let any hesitation or  note  of  mystery  creep  in.  The
    translator is actually lecturing and must sound so.

10.   When the materials are complete, good production  masters  are  copied
    off of the master tape. The master tape  is  set  aside  and  not  used
    further.

11.   The production master is  now  cut  into  chapter  lengths  which  are
    numbered the same as the book chapters.

12.   Several sets of the Chapter Copies are  now  made  and  put  in  their
    boxes. Both tracks can be used. Even 4 tracks (not stereo) can be used.

13.   The  glossary  in  both  the  original  language  and  the  translated
    language  is  printed  up  along  with  course  directions  (which  are
    described in another technical paper). The checksheet and course  rules
    are also translated and printed in the local language.

14.   The course is boxed in sets with the glossary and course directions.

    Following this system one can rapidly produce sets of materials without
the delays always experienced in printing as well as with cost reduction.


    The tapes are listened to on  individual  tape  players  equipped  with
earphones and a foot pedal start-stop control so  the  student's  hands  are
free for taking notes and looking up words in the dictionary, etc).


    Learning rate in an aural society is much  higher  than  in  a  society
accustomed to print.


    Even an illiterate person or a slow reader can be taught such a means.


    A dictionary in the translated language must also  be  available  in  a
classroom.


    The quality of the translator's voice  and  clear  diction  are  highly
desirable.


LRH:nt.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1971,1974                              Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 21 NOVEMBER 1971
                                   Issue I
Remimeo
(Translate
into the    IMPORTANT
various
Languages)
                            Tape Course Series 2


                          DIANETICS AND SCIENTOLOGY
                             IN OTHER LANGUAGES
                      (HCO Policy Letter of 11 May 1971
                        Reissued as an HCO Bulletin)

    Tapes and book translations of Dianetics and Scientology are being made
into other languages than English.


    It is necessary to know the MINIMUM materials an org in  a  non-English
speaking country would need to function.


    It is not enough to have one book published. It creates  a  demand  for
services. The demand for service must be met. An HAS Course in the  language
is not enough since it is not income  producing.  Thus  the  org  could  not
survive financially. It must survive financially to deliver the service.


    Even in a total socialism the service would have to be given.


    Giving service depends on an org having the means of training  auditors
who can audit well and establishing the organization.  Then  the  org  could
audit preclears as well as train more auditors.


    If the auditors who are trained  can  audit  well,  they  will  produce
excellent results and public repute will spread.


    An org must  produce  to  survive.  By  production  is  meant  training
auditors who can audit, auditing pcs to a good result and making  money,  or
in a total socialism, obtaining adequate support in ratio to production.


    If an org just teaches an HAS Course or tests people, it  will  not  be
able to survive for it will not be able to obtain enough funds  or  support.
For this it is vital to train lots of auditors and audit lots of pcs.


    Without its staff knowing the basic data of organization, the org  will
have difficulties in giving service. The  technology  of  administration  is
important.


    Thus we get the MINIMUM materials in the language  vital  to  an  org's
survival:

                              PRINTED MATERIAL

    The book DIANETICS: THE MODERN SCIENCE OF MENTAL  HEALTH  printed  with
hard covers in the language is vital.


    When members of the public read it and take an  HAS  Course  they  want
training or processing or both.


    This book placed in bookstores, advertised in magazines,  and  sold  by
Field Staff Members and the org itself not only reaches the public but  also
in hardcover form pays for its own distribution. As a paperback it does  not
pay for itself.
To this add testing materials printed in the language for  intelligence  and
personality testing and their marking directions.

                               RECORDED TAPES

    Recorded tapes and tape players in the org to play  to  individuals  in
classes is the easiest form in which to deliver data.


    From such tapes students may take notes.


    As time goes on the tapes will be transcribed and the material  printed
or mimeographed. (This is not to be done by the individual  orgs.)  It  will
be found however that tapes will always  be  necessary  even  when  some  is
printed as the volume of data is very great.


    Students should not be permitted to print copies  of  their  notes  and
sell them as time has shown that such notes  are  not  accurate  enough  and
spread errors that show up in training and auditing failures.


    In reviewing, a student must be sent back to the original, not  to  his
notes, so he can correct his notes and get the data accurately.


    Nearly all no-results are traced to altered data or  poor  training  of
the student, which amounts to the same thing.


    The MINIMUM list of tapes is:

            1.   Mini Course Supervisor Hat

            2.   HAS Course

            3.   HDC Course

            4.   Academy Courses Levels 0 to IV

            5.   Original Thesis

            6.   Notes on the Lectures

             7.  Hat of a Scientologist

            8.   Staff Status I

            9.   Staff Status II

            10.  A Translated Org Bd

                                  _________


    Given these bare essentials and teaching them well and using them  will
give an org sufficient survival to deliver results.


    If every bit of the above is known and used by a staff  they  will  not
have too much trouble.


    Set up and functioning and solvent, an org can then think about further
materials.


    Class VI, a Class VII, a Class VIII and a Class IX Course materials  on
tape should exist in a Saint Hill org in the language of that country.


    For the org itself a Volume Zero of the  OEC  Course  should  exist  on
tape.
After that the full Course Supervisor's Course should exist.


    Then further books such as Dianetics '55!, Science of Survival and  The
Creation of Human Ability should come out as  tape  and  then  in  published
hardcover form.


    The full OEC should now be acquired on tape.


    The full Study Tapes should be to hand.


    The org will now be ready to use all  the  FEBC  series  and  the  FEBC
tapes.

                                  _________


    The hardest idea for an org staff to get is the idea of  production  in
terms of auditors trained who can audit, pcs audited  to  excellent  results
and money or support  produced  to  keep  the  staff  members  and  the  org
solvent.


    Because of this it is best for 2 or more bilingual executives to attain
full FEBC training.


    However, with the above minimum materials fully studied and in use,  an
org can survive until it is ready to prosper.


                                  _________




    Note, at this writing many are working  hard  to  complete  the  listed
materials. They are not yet available in all languages.


    There is only one other type of item needed by an org and that is the E-
Meter. Supplies of these must be arranged for. A  country  running  in  very
high volume will probably  manufacture  its  own  meters  against  an  exact
prototype under existing international patents.

                                  ON SOURCE

    It will be found in all countries where Dianetics and  Scientology  and
orgs have been successful that a key part of the  success  was  keeping  the
subject "on source".


    The public at once distrusts persons or groups who alter the  materials
or "use some of them" or attribute them to others.  This  is  quite  factual
and the public is right.


    All great and lasting successes have been made by  orgs  that  were  on
source and whose materials were straight and correct and used that way.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder
LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1971
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                     HCO BULLETIN OF 21 NOVEMBER 1971 R
                                  Issue II
Remimeo     REVISED 23 OCTOBER 1974
Supervisors
                       Cancels BTB 21 November 1971 RA

                       (Revisions in this type style)


                            Tape Course Series 3R


                           TEACHING A TAPE COURSE

                   (HCO Policy Letter of 6 December 1970,
                 Issue II, Revised and Reissued as an HCOB.
                        Changes in this type style.)


    The instruction  of  students  by  tape  is  done  by  individual  tape
playbacks equipped with earphones and a foot pedal start-stop control.


    It is imperative that the earphone quality be of the highest,  and  the
tape copy have very good sound quality. Otherwise students go to sleep  over
misunderstood words.


    The individual tape player method is used because (a) it can  handle  a
large or small number of students, (b) it works where there is a trickle  of
students starting at different times, (c) it works where  students  studying
subjects different from each other are using the same classroom. I  t  takes
more tape players and must be earphone equipped  but  it  prevents  students
going past misunderstoods as can occur if they are all listening to a  group
tape play.


    The foot controlled start-stop pedal is necessary so  the  student  can
use his hands freely to take notes and look up words in the  dictionary.  It
also enables the tape to be stopped instantly without the time lag it  takes
to reach for and push a finger button-thus going past the  place  where  the
stop is desired.


                             RULES & DESCRIPTION

    Only  the  Glossary,  course  rules  and   checksheets,   with   course
description are translated into the language being  used  for  teaching  and
mimeographed or printed into small booklets.


    The description must include how to handle  tape  players  and  caution
against machine or tape damage and inadvertent erasure of a tape. (To  guard
against actual erasure it is wisest  to  tape  over  the  record  button  or
preferably, to have the recording unit disengaged.  Also,  it  is  sometimes
possible to buy, at cheaper prices, playback units only  (tape  machines  in
which the recording unit hasn't been installed). They  must  however  be  of
good quality.

                                 ENROLLMENT

    Enrollment is done no matter how informal the course is.  A  waiver  of
accident or damage holding the school not responsible,  must  be  signed  by
the student and, if a minor, by his parents or guardian on any tape course.


    An enrollment invoice showing full course payment must be in the  hands
of the supervisor, giving the date of enrollment,  home  address  and  local
address.
A roll book has every student's name, address and  the  course  enrolled  in
and date. This must not be omitted as it is the only  permanent  record  and
is often resorted to to prove contentions.

                                    FILES

    A student file system must exist. A folder with the student's  name  on
it and which will receive his  completed  checksheets,  exam  results,  etc,
must be made up at once.


                                 CHECKSHEET

    A checksheet for the course must exist, breaking the course  down  into
small easily attained segments of Theory and Practical.


    It must be in the student's language.


    It has blanks opposite each segment so that a student checkout  can  be
initialed with date by the person checking him out.


                                  NOTEBOOKS

    A student is expected to keep a notebook from his tape listening.  This
should be neat and complete. The student never copies out  the  whole  tape.
He takes exact verbatim notes of any Process Commands  or  Lists  and  notes
down also the important technical rules.


    A sample notebook should be provided.


    A student should leave frequent spaces so he can enter new notes  on  a
second and third play of the materials.

                                  CHECKOUT

    Where only tapes exist and a checkout is required students  check  each
other out from the actual tape, not from their notes.


    "Give me an example," is the keynote of such a checkout.  (a)  What  is
the , (b) Give me an example.

                                  PRACTICAL

    Each area of the course has demonstration and practical drills.


    These drills must be written up  and  must  match  the  basic  personal
skills required by the materials.

                                 CLAY TABLE

    Clay table training is a vital part of the Course curriculum.


    The materials must be available.


    And clay, not just modelling clay, can be used.


    Flat surfaces must be provided.


    The  description  of  clay  table  training  must  be  part  of   early
checksheets in the school.

                                 DEFINITIONS
A student is drilled and does clay table on the glossary after he  has  been
through the course once.


                             CHECKSHEET SEQUENCE

The student is required to go in sequence through the entire checksheet  HCO
PL of 31 August 1974, issue II, "Fast Flow Training Reinstated", applies  to
Translated Tape Courses.

The checksheet is arranged double-spaced for Tape Counter Reading, date  and
initial in the first of the three columns.

For example:

"Tape Counter

Reading Column         Retread    Retrain

______________     1. Chapter III-The   ______     ______     ______
                         Goal of Man


                              COURSE COMPLETION

    See HCO PL 31 August 1974, Issue II, ''Fast Flow Training Reinstated''


                               PROGRESS BOARD

    A student's progress is posted on a "progress board".


                                SLOW STUDENTS

    Any student falling asleep or being very  slow  is  handled  with  Word
Clearing which is the subject of the  Word  Clearing  Series  Bulletins  and
later issues in these Tape Course Series Bulletins.


      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder


LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              22 NOVEMBER 1971
                                  Issue II
                       Reissued 11 August 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
(Translate
to Various
Languages)
Course
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 22 NOVEMBER 1971
                                 SAME TITLE



                            Tape Course Series 4


                      TAPE PLAYERS-DESCRIPTION AND CARE



    Tape Players are the machines used on a Tape Course for playing back on
already recorded magnetic tape.


    Tape Recorders are the machines used to record the tapes in  the  first
place.


    Some tape machines will do both actions of recording and playback. On a
Tape Course if  these  machines  are  used  the  button  that  is  used  for
"recording" should be removed or sealed up so it can not be  used.  It  will
wipe the tape clean  and  lose  the  valuable  course  materials  if  pushed
accidentally by a student. (This button is usually colored red.)


    Tape players come in many makes and models. The controls  and  switches
are arranged in various places and styles but are all pretty much  the  same
in function.
[pic]









    1.      Plug  to electricity mains.
2.    Power inlet plug  to tape machine.
3.    Plug in to  foot pedal start-stop control.
4.    Start-stop  foot pedal.
5.    Start-stop  foot switch.
6.    On/Off  switch and volume control.
    7.      Power on  indicator light.

8.    Tone  control.

9.    Plug in  for earphones.

10.   Hi fidelity  earphones.

11    New Tape  to be played.

12.   Playing head  sensitive to magnetic sound impressions on the tape.

13.   Tape passed through  between playing head and felt pad.

14.   Tape passed round  roller protecting guides.

15.   Empty tape spool. (Tape is wound onto this.)

16.   Tape Counter  window and zero setting button.

17.   Recording key  removed or sealed up.

18.   Start key  for starting tape by hand.

19.   Stop key  for stopping tape by hand.

20.   Pause key  (stops tape while held down only-tape continues to play  as
    soon as released).

21.   Fast wind key  forward.

22.   Rewind key  (fast backward).

23.   Track Selector  Switch (some tapes have several sound tracks  recorded
    on the one side).

24.   Speed Selector  Switch (tapes can be recorded at different speeds  and
    so some must be played at different speeds to others).

25.   Indicator dial  and buttons connected  with  recording-not  used  when
    playing tapes.

    Here are some points to help you use the tape player:

(a)   When placing a tape on the machine, an arrow on top of the  tape  reel
indicates an opening in which you place the tape end.  Keep  this  end  very
small. Long loose ends break off and can jam the machine.

(b)   The dull  brown colored side of the  tape  must  always  face  inwards
against the playing head when threading the tape.  This  is  the  side  that
Ron's lectures are recorded on.

(c)   To wind back or fast wind  the  machine  always  press  the  stop  key
first. Harm is done if  the  playing  tape  is  suddenly  switched  over  to
reverse or fast forward by-passing the stop button.

(d)   The magnetic materials of the earphones can harm  the  tape  so  never
leave the earphones lying on top of an uncovered tape player.

(e)   Keep all dirt out of the tape player and when  away  from  the  player
replace the lid to avoid dust entering into the machine.
(f)   Every care must be taken to avoid rough  handling  of  tapes.  Do  not
misplace tapes into incorrect boxes and never permit loose ends to  protrude
out of the closed box.

(g)   Switch off the tape player when not in use (break time) and  when  you
have finished with the machine. This prevents  overheating  of  inner  parts
and drive belts.

(h)   The tape counter indicator should be set at zero when you first  start
playing the tape. This counter will register your place  whenever  you  stop
the tape. Do not insert a piece of paper or anything else between  the  tape
as a method of registering your place.

(i)   At the first sign of any fault with the tape player  please  call  the
Supervisor and report what it is to him or her.

(j)   Twisting or knotting the earphone cord is strictly forbidden  as  this
leads to inner wire breakage, which results in a concealed  fault  that  can
be difficult to locate.

(k)   The metal "playing head" across which  the  tape  moves  when  playing
must be cleaned at regular intervals as it  picks  up  dust  from  the  tape
resulting in blurred  poor  quality  sound.  This  playing  head  should  be
cleaned after every 8 hours of playing time or whenever  the  sound  becomes
blurred. The playing head is cleaned by use of a cotton swab on the  end  of
a toothpick and cleaning fluid. This is wiped with firm pressure across  the
playing head until the dirt and dust are removed  and  the  metal  is  clean
again. Great care must be taken not to scratch the playing head as the  tape
would then be damaged as it passed across.

(l)   The tape player must also be demagnetized after every 8 hours  playing
time. This is done with a special demagnetizer  designed  for  the  purpose.
The  playing  head  and  all  the  metal  parts  on  the  tape  "path"   are
demagnetized in this manner.

    These parts build up a magnetic attraction with continuous tape playing
and this can be harmful to the quality of sound on the tape if  not  handled
and removed as above.


    It is the Supervisor's  or  Course  Administrator's  responsibility  to
learn to do this action and to do it at least  once  per  day  on  all  tape
players.

(m)   The moving parts of the  tape  machine  mechanism  also  need  regular
cleaning and lubrication with a very fine lubricant. This procedure  can  be
carefully learned by the Course Administrator from  a  professional  at  the
job and can be done by him thereafter.


                                        Training & Services Aide

      Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BW:mh.rd
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              21 NOVEMBER 1974
Remimeo
(Translate to    CANCELS
European    BTB OF 24 NOVEMBER 1971
Languages)  originally issued as
All Students     HCO BULLETIN OF 24 NOVEMBER 1971
Tech & Qual "COURSE MATERIALS"
Tech
                                   CANCELS
                          BTB OF 24 NOVEMBER 1971R
                            originally issued as
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 24 NOVEMBER 1971
                                  Issue III
                     "ADMINISTRATIVE AND HAT MATERIALS"

                                   CANCELS
                           BTB OF 22 NOVEMBER 1971
                            originally issued as
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 22 NOVEMBER 1971
                         "TRANSLATION TAPES, USE OF"

                            Tape Course Series 5

                              TRANSLATED TAPES
                          FOR STAFF AND STUDENT USE


    Translated tapes shipped to Orgs and Missions are primarily  for  staff
and student use. As follows:

                        TRANSLATED ADMINISTRATIVE AND
                                HAT MATERIALS

    Translated administrative and hat materials are translated onto tape in
the item by item sequence of the hat checksheet or staff course  checksheet.
The checksheets are themselves not translated onto tape but onto  paper  and
accompany the translation  tapes  along  with  a  mimeographed  glossary  of
technical terms and phrases, and course rules.


    Every Org with non-English speaking staff members needs translated tape
copies of at least Staff Status I and II, OEC Vols 0-7 and the  Professional
Salesmanship Course BPL 22 July  74  with  their  accompanying  checksheets,
glossaries and course instructions translated onto paper.


    Training of staffs on admin and hat materials is done in  the  Academy,
Div 4, Dept 11, under a  Supervisor  and  in  accordance  with  "What  is  a
Course?" PL 16 March 1971.


    Translated administrative and hat materials may not be  played  to  the
Public. They are not for public issue or distribution free or for charge.


                         TRANSLATED COURSE MATERIALS

    Use of Course Study Tapes is well covered in  HCO  B  10  November  71,
Revised 21 Sept 74, "Tapes, How to Use", Tape Course Series  6R.  This  same
issue applies to admin and hat materials also.


    Course materials may  be  heard  by  those  persons  who  have  legally
enrolled on and paid for the course concerned.
Students and course graduates can buy translation course tapes from Pubs  DK
or their Org. Evidence of  course  enrollment  or  graduation  from  a  Tape
Course must accompany the tape order.


    Translated Course tapes may not be played to the general Public who are
not enrolled on a  specific  course.  They  are  not  for  public  issue  or
distribution, free or for charge.

                                 TAPE NOTES

    A notebook is to be used and kept neat and complete by each student.


    In order for the student to quickly find any reference on a tape  after
he has listened to it, he must mark  down  in  his  notebook  the  "counter"
number on the tape machine at the beginning of  each  HCOPL,  HCO  B,  Book,
Chapter, etc, and also identify the type of machine.


    IMPORTANT: AT THE START OF  THE  TAPE,  THE  STUDENT  MUST  ENSURE  THE
COUNTER ON THE TAPE MACHINE READS AT 0.


    When checkouts are required, students check each  other  out  from  the
actual tapes not from the notes.


    Tape notes may not be recopied by another or distributed amongst  other
students. They are for the  student's  own  use,  and  are  not  for  public
distribution. Such notebooks may never be mimeographed or published as  they
often contain errors.


                                 PROTECTION

    To guard against any possibility of  students  reissuing  their  course
notes in printed form or allowing  another  to  recopy  the  tape  notes,  a
Waiver is to be drawn up and signed by the student, or  by  his  parents  or
guardian, if a minor, before commencing the Tape Course. The  Waiver  states
that he understands the material is given him  for  training  purposes  only
and should he reissue his notes to anyone outside the Org, or allow  another
to recopy he will be billed for $1,000.


    NO TRANSLATION TAPES MAY BE TRANSCRIBED IN WRITTEN FORM. THE TAPES  ARE
PROTECTED BY COPYRIGHT FROM PRINTED OR TAPE COPYING.

                                   CARE OF

    Translated tape packages are filed as a  complete  package  altogether-
NEVER split up and filed by date order or in some other fashion.


    The Master Card File kept by the Course Admin is a record of what items
are on what tapes. Each tape has its own Card File with contents listed  and
is the index of the actual translated tape package itself.  Card  Files  can
be made up from the tape box which has listed on the back the tape  contents
for sides one and two. Course and Hat Checksheets are  filed  alphabetically
in file folders with their glossaries and course instructions and rules  for
student use.


    Qual needs their own Master Card File system for Library contents filed
in alphabetical order which says where each tape and checksheet, etc, is  to
be located.


                                  CRAMMING

    Cramming of students and staff on translated tape material is  done  in
Qual Div, Dept 15.



Staff do not have to be enrolled on any  course  in  order  to  be  crammed.
Public course students are sent to Cramming by their  Course  Supervisor  or
by the Student Examiner.

    The Cramming Officer checks out staff and students from the  translated
tapes NEVER from the tape notes as  notes  are  too  far  removed  from  the
Source material and subject to misduplication.  Before  a  Cramming  Officer
could give a checkout from a tape he must have listened to that  section  on
the tape himself.


    In addition to Tech, Qual have their own  tape  players  equipped  with
foot pedal start-stop control situated in Qual for student and staff  member
use in Cramming and Word Clearing.

                                QUAL LIBRARY

    A special tape listening area needs to be set up in  the  Qual  Library
space where Org staff members can come and go at  their  own  free  will  to
listen to any taped HCO Bs, HCO PLs, etc, undisturbed.


    At least two  copies  of  every  translated  tape  package  along  with
checksheets and glossaries are filed  alphabetically  in  the  Qual  Library
easily accessible  for  Auditors,  C/Ses  and  student  and  staff  Cramming
purposes, Word Clearing and for staff who need to refer to or check  out  on
individual issues contained within the translated tapes.


                                  STAY PUT

    Translated tape courses and translated administrative and hat materials
on tape are the responsibility of and under the protection of Tech and  Qual
Divs. They may NEVER be removed from these  areas  as  they  invariably  get
lost or misplaced or damaged.

                                AVAILABILITY

    Every effort must be made to make translated admin  and  hat  materials
and translated course materials readily  available  for  student  and  staff
member use and to remove any stops or arbitraries which might prevent  staff
or students knowing and applying the tech of Dianetics and Scientology.


    It is of vital interest to Keepers of Tech to ensure that full sets  of
translated Tech and Admin materials exist and are used.

                                        Lt. Comdr. Robin Roos
                                        CS-2

                                        In co-ordination with
                                        Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
                                        CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
BDCS:Bofl:AL:MH:RR:mh.rd
Copyright � 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                     HCO BULLETIN OF 10 NOVEMBER 1971 R
                          REVISED 21 SEPTEMBER 1974

Remimeo
                                   URGENT


                          Word Clearing Series 25R

                            Tape Course Series 6R


                              TAPES, HOW TO USE

                     (Reissued 23 November 1971 verbatim
                additionally as a Tape Course Series HCO B.)


                                  FOREWORD

    The most appalling  ignorance  has  existed  on  the  use  of  magnetic
recording tapes.


    It is therefore of the greatest possible importance that the subject of
tape use be grasped and gotten rapidly into effect.


    Probably half the technology of admin and tech exists only on tape.


    Tapes, incorrectly used, can be the source of  endless  misunderstoods.
Because tapes  have  been  almost  uniformly  misused  in  the  past,  these
misunderstoods have added up to a general misunderstood on  the  subject  of
tapes themselves.


    Students have been known to copy down the  whole  tape  so  they  could
study it. This is a complete waste of  time  and  misuse  of  student  study
hours.


    Some orgs even played advanced study tapes to the public.


    European orgs have even played translation quality tapes  (usually  not
auditorium quality) of OEC Volumes as raw public lectures! (And  lost  their
audience through lack of quality and inaudible and strange words.)


    Casual staff briefing tapes, not okay for release, of very bad quality,
have been played to staffs of other orgs and the public.


    There is no end to the abuses.


    Therefore, for the benefit of understanding words alone,  it  is  VITAL
that tapes be properly used and not abused.

                               TYPES OF TAPES

    There are four classes of tapes. These are:


    1.      Course study tapes.


    2.      Public lecture tapes.


    3.      Briefing tapes.


    4.      Model performance tapes.
                             COURSE STUDY TAPES

    Tapes made for courses are of two varieties:


    (a)     English, usually by LRH.


    (b)     Translations, done by translators.


    They are FOR COURSE USE. This is what the org sells-training on Tech or
Admin.

    These tapes appear on  checksheets  and  are  done  at  the  points  of
checksheets where they are called for, and are done by Method  2  for  tapes
or Method 3 for tapes as required.


    The foreign  language  tape  courses  are  done  from  a  special  tape
checksheet and are done exactly as laid down by Method 2 or Method 3.


    None of these tapes are  all  written  out  by  the  student  and  then
studied. This is a waste of time.


    Further, such tapes are NOT played straight through  with  the  student
making notes of any misunderstood words "to look up later". This will  blank
out the tape content on the student's mind and knock out the student.


    So to play a course tape straight through to any student is to  risk  a
stupidity and a blow. IT IS  NOT  DONE.  It  does  not  matter  whether  the
student takes notes of misunderstoods or not. A COURSE TAPE  IS  NOT  PLAYED
STRAIGHT  THROUGH.  Only  the   earphone,   footpedal   start-stop   control
procedures are used.


    A course tape is NEVER PLAYED TO A GROUP OF STUDENTS.  When  played  to
more than one student, some student is going  to  get  a  misunderstood  and
there goes a blank student.


    Two students don't even listen to a tape even on  Method  2  Tape  Word
Clearing! One has the meter and footpedal and the other the  earphones.  The
word clearer stops at each read. He does not otherwise listen.


    Course tape quality must be good. All the words must  be  hearable  and
not inaudible. They must not be slurred or hard to make out.


    The earphones and tape player used must be high fidelity just  any  old
earphones won't do.


    The tape player "playing head" across which the  tape  passes  must  be
clean-done by a cotton swab on a toothpick  and  cleaning  fluid.  The  tape
coating comes off on the playing head and after a time the  sound  is  badly
blurred.


    Using a course tape any other way is now FORBIDDEN.  Tests  have  shown
that violations of this are the reason for student failures  and  blows  and
out-Ethics.


    It goes without saying that the general handling of  tape  players  and
tapes  must  be  well  learned  and  practiced  by  Course  Supervisors  and
students.


                            PUBLIC LECTURE TAPES

    The  probable  reason  stats  fall  after  tape   congresses   is   the
misunderstood word.


    Congresses seldom use really high  fidelity  equipment.  Further,  tape
copying is often done by outside firms and the tape  copies  themselves  may
be of poor quality. The combination is deadly.
We looked for the reason for stat drops after tape congresses  and  this  is
the only explanation which has come forth.


    Doingness  congresses  that  are  mainly  seminars   have   been   very
successful. (By doingness is meant TRs-training drills-and  other  ACTIONS.)
The relay of data to a public whose vocabulary is usually inadequate is  not
likely to win, as it hits their faulty vocabulary for  one  thing  and  uses
new words for another. You can show somebody how to  do  things  far  better
than you can tell him.


    This then extends into Div 6 Introductory Actions as well. The relay of
data comes AFTER the demonstration in action terms.


    The possibility of possible bad playing  speakers,  possible  low  tape
copy quality, the barriers of languages not learned in the first  place  and
the introduction of new mental concepts combine into  a  hurdle  that  makes
tape or film public presentation adventurous.


    Listening to public type tapes,  by  using  footpedal  start-stop  tape
players, is being put in a special public course category.


    Raw public tape and film presentations are however a must to  keep  the
flavor and  meaning  of  Dianetics  and  Scientology.  So  ensure  excellent
quality tapes and equipment are used with correct tapes for that public  and
you will have success.


                               BRIEFING TAPES

    These are not to be confused with Special Briefing Course Tapes.


    A briefing tape is done to brief or debrief missionaires or to record a
conference or to record special instructions to a person or  group.  It  can
then be used for reference or to settle any dispute. It can also be used  to
inform a staff or several staffs.


    A briefing tape is then a tape designed  for  a  special  and  informed
audience.


    If the tape quality is good and the audience is already a  familiar  or
trained audience, a briefing tape can be played ONLY  TO  THE  AUDIENCE  FOR
WHICH IT WAS INTENDED.


    To do otherwise is to risk misunderstood words and non-comprehension of
what it is all about in general.


    "Ron's Journals" were staff briefing tapes. They began to be  used  for
public. While they were not without  success,  one  could  no  longer  brief
staffs on this line and the line was therefore cut. One could not make  them
with a security that they would be played to staffs.


    An isolated briefing to a single executive on  "these  are  our  future
hopes" has been thereafter used as a staff briefing of many orgs  as  "these
are your orders".


    Any tape is designed for a specific public.


    Briefing tapes are especially subject to abuse by being played to wrong
publics.


    Any briefing tape which contains specific orders and plans which  could
be misunderstood should be played only to the individuals concerned  with  a
stop-start footpedal  and  Method  3  Word  Clearing,  not  going  past  any
misunderstood.


    After a person has been briefed verbally, it is very revelatory to then
Word Clear 2 the tape made at the same time. It will  often  be  found  that
misunderstood words lead to potential alter-is in the actions required.
Tape in this instance is  an  enormous  help  in  assisting  and  clarifying
briefings.


    A group can be briefed if thereafter each is Word Cleared Method 3 or 2
on the tape afterwards, using standard tape word clearing.


    Needless to say such tapes must be of good quality.


                           MODEL PERFORMANCE TAPES

    Tapes exist which give a standard of performance.


    In Dianetic and Scientology Auditing student auditors have  never  been
known to achieve a high standard of session presence and Communication  (and
accordingly high results)  without  the  careful  study  of  tapes  made  of
similar sessions by high level auditors.


    A student musician is  unlikely  to  achieve  professional  performance
level unless he has heard a professional play.


    It would take a film  or  live  demonstration  to  communicate  a  high
standard of performance  in  a  purely  action  subject.  For  instance  for
centuries no one believed that Robin  Hood  could  split  his  first  target
arrow with a second until a new generation worked on it and a few  painfully
recovered the lost art of archery and then demonstrated how it was done  for
others to see.


    Tapes and films serve a vital  purpose  in  maintaining  a  performance
standard.


    As these tapes and films show HOW it is done  and  the  ATMOSPHERE  and
RHYTHM of ACTION they are not subject to word clearing.


                                 CONCLUSION

    Tape and film training is vital, valuable and has its role.


    But like showing a child how to open a book and read,  there  is  exact
technology in USING tapes and films.


    The first thing one must realize is that the use of tape  and  film  is
itself a technical subject that must be studied and learned.  One  does  not
naturally know it.


    The failures of universities to make  educated  and  civilized  men  is
because their own professors know nothing  of  misunderstood  words  and  so
lectured happily on and on to a  snoring  student  body.  One  professor  of
physics used to open the classroom windows wide in freezing winter "to  keep
his students from going to sleep in  HIS  class".  And  then  stood  on  the
platform and defined nothing as he rambled on. All it did for his class  was
give them coughs between snores!


    The handling and use of tape and film in training and administration IS
a subject.


    By failing to know it and use that information, one can block the  road
for himself and all others to being learned and being free.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH:nt jh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              25 NOVEMBER 1971R
                         Reissued 7 July 1974 as BTB
                     Revised & Reissued 21 November 1974
(Translate to
Languages)  CANCELS
Supervisors BTB OF 25 NOVEMBER 1971
Students    SAME TITLE
Word Clearers
Course Admin
                (This issue has been changed from TC Series 9
              to TC Series 7. Points 10-19 have been revised.)


                            Tape Course Series 7

                     SETTING UP AND USING A TAPE PLAYER


    Tapes of course materials must  always  be  listened  to  through  high
quality  high  fidelity  earphones.  This  permits  the   listener   to   be
undisturbed by other noises in the area, as well  as  prevents  others  from
being disturbed by the tape being played.  High  fidelity  earphones  permit
the listener to have his undivided attention  on  the  tape  and  produce  a
pleasant and easy to listen  to  sound  which  closely  duplicates  what  is
spoken on the tape.


    The tape player used must also be of  high  quality  to  reproduce  the
sound without adding to or distorting what is  on  the  tape.  Poor  quality
sound is difficult and annoying to listen to and  causes  misunderstoods  by
preventing the listener from hearing exactly what is  said.  Properly  cared
for and regularly maintained, a high quality player will last several  times
as long as one costing half as much which never does produce a good  quality
sound.


                         SETTING UP THE TAPE PLAYER

1.    The tape player is set up on a steady bench, table or  platform  at  a
    comfortable height so the student can operate the controls easily  when
    seated in front of it.

2.    If possible, the tape machines should be set up so  that  the  student
    is facing the Supervisor of the Course, rather than the student  having
    his back to the Supervisor. This enables the Supervisor to spot  easily
    if the student has gone dull or sleepy from a misunderstood word.

3.    The tape machine is plugged in, switched on, to check if the power  is
    on and that the machine is operating.

4.    The tape machine must be the type that is set up  to  operate  with  a
    start/stop foot pedal switch. These can easily be obtained  and  fitted
    to existing tape players that do not already have them.

      This is very important as the machine  will  be  started  and  stopped
    many times by the student (with his foot on  the  pedal)  while  he  is
    using his hands to look  up  words  in  the  dictionary,  fill  in  his
    checksheet, etc.

      The connected foot pedal is placed where it is in easy  reach  of  the
    student's foot.

      Test it to ensure it is working.

5.    The tape player "playing  head"  across  which  the  tape  passes,  is
    checked to ensure that it is clean. The tape coating comes off  on  the
    playing head and after a time the sound is badly blurred.

      If the playing head appears dirty or the sound is  blurred,  the  tape
    head must be cleaned. This is done using a cotton swab on  a  toothpick
    and cleaning fluid. It is rubbed across the playing head until all  the
    tape coating is removed.

6.    The tape that is to be heard is obtained and put  on  the  player  and
    set up for start-by passing the "coloured leader" on the tape past  the
    playing head and onto the empty spool. Make sure it  is  passed  around
    the "roller guides" (designed to ensure  it  runs  freely  and  doesn't
    catch and tear on any sharp edges).

    7.      Plug in the earphones, put them on, and switch on the  tape  to
    test them (to ensure they are working  and  the  quality  of  sound  is
    good). Adjust the tone and volume to suitable levels.  Switch  off  the
    tape.

8.    Place a good dictionary, a "demonstration kit", the Course  checksheet
    and a notebook and pen where they are in easy reach while seated at the
    tape machine.

9.    Set the "tape counter" at zero and  the  tape  at  the  beginning  (by
    winding it back if it has started into the Course  lecture  during  the
    tests).


                            USING THE TAPE PLAYER

10.   Play the tape at its correct  speed.

11.   Listen to the tapes in the order  they  are  entered  on  your  Course
    checksheet.

12.   Mark off each item on your Course checksheet as you  finish  listening
    to it (or when you have checked out on it if a checkout is required).

13.   Mark the "tape counter reading" of each item  on  your  checksheet  as
    that item begins on the tape. This gives you a reference by  which  you
    can find any item later on. You may be required to restudy  some  items
    by the Supervisor and you may want to hear some of them again  yourself
    to clarify them with later tapes.

14.   If a word(s) or phrase on a tape cannot be understood,  call  for  the
    Supervisor. The  Supervisor  listens  to  the  tape  and  if  he  can't
    distinguish what is being said, with the help of the Course Admin, gets
    hold of the English text and locates the word or phrase, then  using  a
    good foreign language dictionary translates the word or phrase for  the
    student. This cycle should only take a couple of minutes.

15.   If a student bogs on listening to a translated tape, he is first  Word
    Cleared. Should the confusion not clear  up,  the  translated  tape  is
    compared to the English material and if found to be a translation error
    the Supervisor or Word Clearer, with the  use  of  a  good  dictionary,
    translates the English text correctly for the student.  The  Supervisor
    makes a note of the translation error by entering the error on  a  card
    which is placed in the Tape Box for student use, and sends a report  to
    TU Chief Pubs DK.

16.   When rewinding a tape back a bit wait until the tape stops before  you
    press the start button otherwise the tape is liable  to  break  through
    mishandling.

17.   Rewind each tape onto its correct spool as you finish listening to  it
    and turn off the tape machine. Replace it in its box and return  it  to
    its correct place from which it came.

18.   Replace the cover on the  tape  machine  when  the  machine  has  been
    finished with.

19.   Use BTB 26 November 1971R, Rev. 17  Aug  74,  "Handling  Misunderstood
    Words on Tape Recorded Materials", and BTB 27 Nov 71R, "Method  2  Word
     Clearing on Tapes and Tape Courses".


      Revised by CS-2
      Lt. Comdr. Robin Roos

      In co-ordination with

      Flag Mission 1234

      I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow
      Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues

BDCS:Bofl:AL:MH:RR:BW:mh rd  for the
Copyright � 1971,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                             26 NOVEMBER 1971RA

Remimeo     Revised & Reissued 17 August 1974 as BTB
All Tape    Revised 21 November 1974
Course
Students    CANCELS
Translate   BTB OF 26 NOVEMBER 1971
into the    SAME TITLE
various
languages

                            Tape Course Series 8


                          Word Clearing Series 26RA


                       HANDLING MISUNDERSTOOD WORDS ON
                           TAPE RECORDED MATERIALS


    Method 3 Word Clearing must be done routinely by any Course student. It
is done by the student himself and also by the Supervisor on his students.


                       METHOD 3 WORD CLEARING ON TAPES

1.    The tape machine and tape are  set  up  exactly  as  per  Tape  Course
    Series 7, BTB 25 Nov 71 R, Rev. 21 Nov 74, "Setting Up and Using a Tape
    Player".

2.    Whilst listening to the tape, if the student hears a word he does  not
    understand, he immediately stops the tape by means of  the  foot  pedal
    start-stop control.

3.    He writes the word down in his notebook and immediately looks  up  the
    word exactly per BTB 4 Sept 71R, Rev. 15 Dec 73, Word  Clearing  Series
    22R, "How to Use a Dictionary", clearing all definitions  and  any  not
    understood or misunderstood words in the definitions, and putting  each
    into sentences.

4.    Student then checks the tape for the exact use  of  the  word  in  the
    tape.

5.    Student then rewinds the tape to just before the  word  cleared  above
    and relistens to the section to ensure that it is understood.

6.    The student continues  listening  to  the  tape  until  he  encounters
    another word which he does not understand, at which point he  does  the
    actions outlined in 3, 4 and 5 above.

7.    If at any point the student becomes bored, feels  blank,  washed  out,
    not there, starts  yawning,  dopes  off  or  wants  to  blow,  he  must
    recognize that he has gone past a misunderstood word.

8.    The student must turn  the  tape  back  to  the  point  where  he  was
    interested and alert and check the section  just  after  that  for  the
    misunderstood word or words, and clear them according to steps 3, 4 and
    5.

9.    The student then rewinds the tape back  to  the  end  of  the  section
    where he felt fine and relistens  to  the  tape  from  that  point  on,
    picking up and clearing any other words found.
    10.     If the student  starts  to  feel  squashed,  gets  a  headache,
    stomach feels funny, gets dizzy from time to time,  or  eyes  start  to
    hurt, the student should locate the section on the tape where he had  a
    lack of mass, and either go and find the actual mass  under  discussion
    and feel and inspect it, if  possible,  or  find  a  photo  of  it,  or
    demonstrate the mass in clay with  labels,  or  use  his  demo  kit  to
    demonstrate the mass. The student should then relisten to the  rest  of
    the tape from that section on.

 11.  The Supervisor must be alert to the manifestations  of  lack  of  mass
    and misunderstood words and quickly see that the  correct  handling  is
    done rapidly. If he does not handle, he will shortly  end  up  with  no
    students.

12.   If a student cannot locate the  misunderstood  word  using  Method  3,
    either on his own or with the Supervisor, the Supervisor  should  apply
    Method 2 Word Clearing to that section of the tape  to  quickly  locate
    and handle the misunderstood words. If the student's TA is above 3.5 or
    below 2.0, end off and send the student to Qual for a C/S 53RI.

13.   A Supervisor should check students who have just completed a tape  and
    look tired or not there, by asking questions about  the  tape.  If  the
    student  cannot  answer  or  gives  a  wrong  or  altered  answer,  the
    Supervisor should make the student go back and relisten to the tape and
    find and clear the misunderstood words.

The above procedure is very simple and the  essential  ingredients  to  have
F/Ning students who know and can apply their materials.


                                        Revised by CS-5
                                        Ens. Judy Ziff

                                        In co-ordination with
                                        FlagMission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:BW:DM:mh.rd
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              27 NOVEMBER 1971R
                 Revised & Reissued 21 November 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
(Translate
to Various  CANCELS
Languages)  HCO BULLETIN OF 27 NOVEMBER 1971
Supervisors SAME TITLE
Students

                            Tape Course Series 9

                          Word Clearing Series 27R

                       METHOD 2 WORD CLEARING ON TAPES
                              AND TAPE COURSES


    Method 2 Word Clearing is  done  on  the  student  by  another  student
trained to do so or the Supervisor or a Word Clearer.


    The person doing the Method 2 Word Clearing must be trained in the  use
of an E-Meter and instant reads.


    There are two ways in which Method 2 Word Clearing can be used.


    As a study remedy  on the area of current difficulty.


    As a study method  on the whole material currently  being  studied  (or
the whole of previously studied materials!-


    When used as a study remedy on the area of current difficulty, Method 2
is simply used to locate the misunderstood word or words that could  not  be
located by Method 3 Word  Clearing.  It  is  done  then  and  there  in  the
classroom or Qual and does not require C/S OK.


    This is done by locating and clearing the word that caused the  E-Meter
needle to read (small fall, fall, etc).


    The student having Method 2 Word Clearing done on him holds the cans of
the E-Meter (E-Meter electrodes) while he  listens  to  the  tape.  He  does
nothing else, other than listen to the tape.



             PROCEDURE FOR RESOLVING STUDY DIFFICULTY ON A TAPE,
                         WITH METHOD 2 WORD CLEARING

1.    The tape machine has been set up as in BTB  25  Nov  71R,  Reissued  7
    July 74 as BTB, Revised 21 Nov 74, Tape Course Series  7,  "Setting  Up
    and Using a Tape Player".

2.    The student, the classroom Word  Clearer  and  the  Course  Supervisor
    have been using Method 3 Word Clearing as in Tape Course Series 8,  BTB
    26 Nov 71R, Revised & Reissued 17 Aug 74 as BTB,  Revised  21  Nov  74,
    "Handling Misunderstood Words on Tape Recorded Materials".

3.    The student is having trouble  with  the  tape  or  the  subject.  The
    difficulty hasn't been resolved and the word causing the trouble hasn't
    been located.

4.    The Course Supervisor or a trained Word  Clearer  now  takes  over  to
    handle the difficulty with Method 2 Word Clearing.
    5.      The student either takes the tape he is having trouble with  to
    the Supervisor/Word Clearer's desk (where another tape machine and an E-
    Meter are set up)-or the Supervisor takes an E-Meter and sets it up  at
    the student's tape machine.

6.    The student is asked at which point on the tape he became  bogged.  He
    is then asked for the point on the tape when he was doing OK. The  tape
    is then reversed to the exact end point of where he was doing well. The
    first MU will be just after that and there may be others.

7.     The  Supervisor/Word  Clearer  operates  the  foot  pedal  start-stop
    control of the tape machine as well as the E-Meter, and does worksheets
    of the Word Clearing.

8.    The student listens to the tape. He also holds  the  cans  of  the  E-
    Meter while he is listening to the tape. If the student's TA  is  above
    3.5 or below 2.0, send the student to Qual for rapid  C/S  Series  53RI
    handling and return to course.

9.    As the tape plays,  the  Supervisor/Word  Clearer  watches  his  Meter
    needle. As soon as  the  needle  reads  (small  fall,  fall,  etc)  the
    Supervisor/Word Clearer stops the machine by use of the foot pedal, and
    asks the student for the misunderstood word.

      It is extremely important that the Supervisor/Word  Clearer  stop  the
    tape player at the exact moment of the Meter read, otherwise he may  be
    asking the student for three or four or even six or eight  words  later
    than the reading word, and thus cause undue difficulty for the student.

10.   If the student  can't  spot  the  word,  the  Supervisor/Word  Clearer
    replays the last short section to assist the student to find the MU.

11.   If the student still can't spot the word, the Supervisor/Word  Clearer
    turns the tape back a little further and replays  that  whole  section,
    using the tape counter numbers  to  guide  his  stopping  and  starting
    actions. He locates the MU.

12.   All misunderstood words on tapes are cleared according to BTB  4  Sept
    71R, Rev. 15 Dec 73,  20  July  74,  WC  Series  22R,  "How  to  Use  a
    Dictionary", clearing each word to F/N.

13.   The student keeps hold of the cans  and  the  Supervisor/Word  Clearer
    locates the word in the dictionary, understands the definition  himself
    and then holds it for the student to read.

14.   The student reads all definitions out loud  whilst  the  Word  Clearer
    watches the needle in order to pick up any MUs in the definitions.

15.   The Word Clearer ensures that the student puts  each  definition  into
    sentences to ensure the word is fully understood, to F/N.

16.   The Word Clearer ensures that the  student  has  clarified  the  exact
    definition of the word as used in the tape, and plays back that section
    of the tape for the student, in order to ensure it is cleared.

17.   The tape is now turned back to the beginning of the section where  the
    student ran into trouble to double check that it is now resolved. There
    should be no reads, and F/N, on that section of the material.

      If there are any more reads, these are picked up and cleared, and  the
    section replayed again, until there are no more reads on that  section,
    and F/N on the repair.

18.   The trouble is now resolved and the  student  is  returned  to  normal
    study, where he is expected to  apply  Method  3  Word  Clearing  as  a
    routine.
    19.     If the student's difficulty has not resolved,  the  student  is
    sent to Qual for a Word Clearing Correction List, which will locate the
    cause of the trouble.

20.   The student is  returned  to  Course  when  the  difficulty  has  been
    located and handled, resulting in an F/Ning student.


                  METHOD 2 WORD CLEARING AS A STUDY METHOD
                              ON TAPE MATERIALS

    On some professional checksheets or special staff training actions, all
the materials of the course are required to be done Method 2 Word  Clearing.
Also when earliest materials are being Word Cleared Method 2.


    Method 2 done for this purpose has steps as follows.

A.    The Case Supervisor OK must be obtained to ensure that the student  is
    not in the middle of a major auditing rundown or process or due for  an
    Interiorization Rundown, etc. (Word Clearing M2 can be done between the
    processes of a program.)

B.    The tape player is set up as given earlier.

C.    Note:   If the student has a high or low TA on the  Meter  (above  3.5
    or below 2.0 after the Meter has been turned on for a  few  minutes  to
    warm up and the cans have been warmed by the student holding them for a
    few minutes) or if the student is in pain  or  upset-the  Word  Clearer
    does not start metered Word Clearing.  The  Word  Clearer  informs  the
    student, "I'm sorry we will not  be  starting  Word  Clearing  at  this
    time." The Word Clearer reports this in writing with the  student's  TA
    position to the Supervisor who forwards the report to the DPE  so  that
    the needed C/S Series 53RI session can be given the student. This  must
    be done quickly so he can be  gotten  on  to  his  Word  Clearing.  The
    student is immediately called in for C/S 53RI handling to the result of
    an F/Ning student at which point the student is returned to his course.

D.    Starting the Word Clearing is done by informing  the  student,  "I  am
    not auditing you." The tape is then started and  the  procedure  is  as
    given earlier in this BTB for Method 2. The only difference being  that
    the whole materials are covered in this manner with  the  Word  Clearer
    taking up and clearing all reading words (and any words  originated  by
    the student as misunderstood).

E.    Each word handled is cleared to Floating Needle on the Meter.

F.    The Word Clearing period is ended on Floating Needle.

G.    Note:  If the Word Clearing bogs down and it can't  be  resolved,  the
    Word Clearer or Supervisor must end off and send the Worksheets to  the
    Review Auditor in Dept 14 at once, who will  handle  by  doing  a  Word
    Clearing Correction List.

                                        Revised by CS-5
                                        Ens. Judy Ziff
                                        In co-ordination with
                                        FlagMission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides
      Approved by the
      Board of Issues
BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:BW:mh.jh  for the
Copyright � 1971, 1974 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 17 AUGUST 1972R
                             REVISED 8 JULY 1974
Remimeo
(Translate to
European    (Revision in this type style)
Languages)
                          (Reissued 24 October 1974
                          as a Tape Course Series)


                          Word Clearing Series 42R


                            Tape Course Series 10


                               METHOD 4 NOTES


    Too generalized a question in using Method 4 defeats its  use  and  can
restimulate a person badly.


    Example: "Is there anything in college you  didn't understand?" That of
course is just  plain  ridiculous  as  a  question.  "Have  you  ever  heard
anything you didn't understand?" would be similarly silly.


                          BREAK DOWN THE MATERIALS

    When doing Method 4 you have to break down the materials (put them into
small separate units) in order to ask questions.


    Example: We have Papers 1 & 2, both on  the  same  subject.  The  wrong
question for Method 4 would be "Is there  anything  in  Papers  1  &  2  you
didn't understand?" and not even give him the papers to see! The  right  way
to do it would be to take Paper  1  and  break  it  down  into  its  obvious
sections, give the person Paper 1 and let him look at it. Point to  its  1st
section and say, "Is there anything you didn't understand in this  section?"
while watching the meter. Then point to next section, do  the  same.  Finish
Paper 1. Then go to Paper 2 and do it the same.


    A person has to know what he's being asked about and has to be thinking
of it when asked the question.

                                    TAPES

    Just as it would be ridiculous to ask,  "Have  you  ever  misunderstood
anything you ever read?", it would be silly to ask, "Did  you  ever  have  a
misunderstood on Tape?"


    The right way is to take the tape and put it on a machine  and  play  a
bit of it. And ask, "Is there anything in the first  section  of  this  tape
you didn't understand?" while watching the meter. Then high speed  the  tape
forward to another area and do the same. Thus the tape is covered.


    This can also be done from any tape notes, section by section.


                                    BOOKS

    Books are done chapter by chapter.
                                 QUICKIE M4

    Method 4 is defeated utterly by:

      1.    Bad metering,

            2.   Too general a question,

            3.   Not having the material to hand,

            4.    Not  getting  the  person's  attention  on  parts  of  the
material,

            5.   Not taking each word found to F/N.

    Quickie M4 misses. It sets the person up for a loss in his studying.


    And we want him to actually succeed in his study, don't we?


      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder


LRH:ntjh
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               6 APRIL 1972RA
Remimeo     Revised & Reissued 22 November 1974 as BTB
(Translate  Corrected 17 October 1975
to Various
Languages)  CANCELS
Cramming Offs    HCO BULLETIN OF 6 APRIL 1972
                                 SAME TITLE


                           Tape Course Series 11R


                             BASIC TAPE RUNDOWN


                  REF: Tape Course Series HCO Bs and BTBs:

TC Series 1 HCO B      20 Nov 71  Issue II Reissued 23 Oct 74
                 COURSE TRANSLATION TO TAPES

TC Series 2 HCO B      21 Nov 71  Issue I DIANETICS AND SCIENTOLOGY
                 IN OTHER LANGUAGES

TC Series 3R     HCO B 21 Nov 71R Issue II Revised 23 Oct 74
                 TEACHING A TAPE COURSE

TC Series 4 BTB  22 Nov 71   Issue II Reissued 11 Aug 74 as BTB
                 TAPE PLAYERS-DESCRIPTION AND
                 CARE

TC Series 5 BTB  21 Nov 74   TRANSLATED TAPES FOR STAFF
                 AND STUDENT USE

TC Series 6R     HCO B 10 Nov 71 R      Revised 21 Sept 74
                 TAPES, HOW TO USE

TC Series 7 BTB  25 Nov 71 R Reissued 7 July 74 as BTB
                 Revised & Reissued 21 Nov 74
                 SETTING UP AND USING A TAPE
                 PLAYER

TC Series 8 BTB  26 Nov 71 RA     Revised & Reissued 17 Aug 74 as BTB
                 Revised 21 Nov 74
                 HANDLING MISUNDERSTOOD WORDS
                 ON TAPE RECORDED MATERIALS

TC Series 9 BTB  27 Nov 71 R Revised & Reissued 21 Nov 74 as BTB
                 METHOD 2 WORD CLEARING ON
                 TAPES AND TAPE COURSES

TC Series 10     HCO B 17 Aug 72R Revised 8 July 74 & Reissued 24 Oct 74 as
                 TC Series 18
                 METHOD 4 NOTES

TC Series 11 R   BTB   6 Apr 72RA Revised & Reissued 22 Nov 74 as BTB
                 Corrected 17 Oct 75
                 BASIC TAPE RUNDOWN

TC Series 12R    BTB   18 Feb 72R Issue I Reissued 3 Aug 74 as BTB
                 Revised 23 Nov 74
                 TAPE TRANSLATIONS TO TAPE

TC Series 13     BTB    9 Jan 74R Revised 21 Nov 74
                 TAPE COURSE CHECKSHEETS
It has been found, in many cases, that tapes with Scientology materials  are
not in use because of an individual WHY for each Org person concerned.


    As a great amount of the data  of  Scientology  is  contained  only  on
tapes, especially in Europe where the written materials are also  translated
onto tape, it is vital that those concerned fully understand  tape  use  and
the operation of tape machines and that any individual WHY  for  non-use  of
tapes be found and handled.


    This BTB gives a rundown to handle the individual WHY and to  get  tape
use understood and applied.


    The rundown is done in Qual by the Cramming  Officer  as  a  corrective
action. HCO PL 30 August 74, Issue II, "Qual Stat Change", applies.


                             BASIC TAPE RUNDOWN

1.    FIND WHY he did not use tapes in the first place  using  BPL  6  April
    1972R, Cramming Series 16, "How to Find a Why on a Person and  Handle".
    There will be an individual WHY. It is seldom only misunderstoods.

2.    HANDLE THE WHY. Handling of the Why is directly  related  to  the  Why
    that was found. It may require hatting, confront and reach and withdraw
    drills or other action as indicated.

3.    WORD CLEAR METHOD 6 the individual words and symbols  printed  on  the
    actual tape machines used in the Org by that person.

4.    CRAM on appropriate Tape Course Series per standard  Cramming  Officer
    Tech.

5.    WORD CLEAR METHOD 4 the person on Tape  Operator's  manual  if  he/she
    has read one.

6.    If required, WORD CLEAR METHOD 2 the first tape materials ever heard.

7.    Get Supervisors who fail to use translation tape  courses  crammed  on
    HCO B 21 Nov 71R, Issue  II,  Revised  23  Oct  74,  "Teaching  a  Tape
    Course", and onto BPL 11 Dec 71 R, Revised 10 Apr 75, Issue I, "Hubbard
    Mini Course Supervisor Course", with special attention to section XI-A,
    "Tape Course Data for Supervisors".

8.    Verify that the Situation of not using tapes is now handled.  If  not,
    verify the Why and correct or add to the Handling  steps.  If  the  Why
    does not verify, find the more basic Why and handle that.

The end product is a  person  who  can  and  will  fully  and  properly  use
Scientology tapes.

The actions must be done rapidly to TOTAL END PRODUCT. If you don't get
the end product all the work is wasted. So use it well.

      Training & Services Aide
      by order of
      L. RON HUBBARD
      Founder
      Revised by CS-2
      Lt. Comdr. Robin Roos
      In co-ordination with
      FlagMission 1234
      I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow
      Commodore's Staff Aides
      Approved by the Board of Issues
BDCS:Bofl:AL:MH:RR:BL:mh.rd  for the
Copyright � 1972,1974,1975   BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              18 FEBRUARY 1972R
                                   Issue I
Remimeo
                        Reissued 3 August 1974 as BTB
                          Revised 23 November 1974

                                   CANCELS
                           BTB OF 18 FEBRUARY 1972
                                  Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE

                        (Tape Course Series 13 is now
                           Tape Course Series 12R)

                           Tape Course Series 12R

                          TAPE TRANSLATIONS TO TAPE

                 (Adds to HCO B 20 Nov 71, Issue II, "Course
                Translation to Tape", due to additional data
                    on the subject of tape translations.)


    When translating tape lectures to tapes it has been found  that  higher
quality translations are achieved by using tape transcripts instead  of  the
actual taped lecture. A  secondary  factor  is  that  using  transcripts  is
easier for the Sight Translator and consequently  speed  of  production  and
morale are increased.


    The method for translating taped lectures is as follows:

1.    The Translator is provided  with  a  typed  transcript  of  the  taped
    lecture. Transcripts used must be expertly done and edited so they read
    well.

2.    The Translator (using Word Clearing Technology  and  a  dictionary  to
    clear  up  any  misunderstoods)  rapidly  reads  or  goes  through  the
    transcript to get a general grasp of the subject.

3.    The Technical  Assistant  who  knows  the  subject  and  the  original
    language now goes through the transcript  with  the  Translator.  Every
    technical word or phrase or cultural idiom is underlined.

4.    While underlining, the two persons decide on the  correct  translation
    of the technical word or phrase.

5.    As these are decided, they  are  written  down  on  notepaper  with  a
    complete definition.

6.    Each word, phrase and definition is translated into the  language  and
    written down on a separate sheet of paper.

7.     The  translated  words,  phrases  and  definitions  will   become   a
    mimeographed glossary for the eventual student.

8.    With this glossary to hand, the Translator then takes  the  transcript
    to the recording booth and begins direct translation of the  transcript
    onto tape. At the beginning of the tape the tape is copyrighted,  title
    of the tape and number are given.

9.    The translated master tape is then given  to  the  recording  engineer
    who handles the making of  Production  Masters,  editing,  copying.  In
    other words, gets the tape prepared for distribution.

    10.     Pre-taping of transcripts before making the Translation  Master
    tape is allowed and is covered in HCO PL 2 April 71, "Sight Translating
    Expertise".

    What is NOT  done:

A.    Translating an English tape transcription into a foreign  language  on
    manuscript and then translating from the foreign language transcription
    onto a Master Tape.

B.     Transcribing  an  LRH  tape  into  a  foreign   language   and   then
    transferring that onto  tape.  Correct  sequence  is  transcription  to
    English first, and then the translating onto tape.

C.    Translating directly  from the taped  lecture onto tape.

D.    Using transcriptions which are not  expertly  done.  To  do  otherwise
    will  result  in  alter-is  and   confusion   of   the   material   and
    misunderstoods for the student or staff member.

E.    Trying to sound as Ron would sound on one of his taped lectures.  This
    is not required. Reading the materials in an interested voice  and  not
    letting any hesitation or  note  of  mystery  creep  in  is  sufficient
    enough. The test is the translator must sound as though he is  actually
    lecturing.


                                        Revised by CS-2
                                        Lt. Comdr. Robin Roos

                                        In co-ordination with
                                        FlagMission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
                                        CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:RR:mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               9 JANUARY 1974R
                          REVISED 21 NOVEMBER 1974
Remimeo
Translation (Only revision is change
Pubs Orgs   of Series No. from 17 to 13)


                            Tape Course Series 13


                           TAPE COURSE CHECKSHEETS


    Translated Tape Courses differ from standard English  courses  in  that
the translated HCO Bs and PLs are recorded on tape  instead  of  mimeoed  on
paper.


    Because of this difference, the checksheets must be laid out in such  a
manner that the student can easily find where each HCO B and HCO  PL  begins
on the tapes. He must be able to do this without having to listen to all  of
the tapes or a whole tape each time he wants to find a particular  piece  of
data from an issue.


    Tape counters are used by  students  listening  to  a  translated  tape
course to keep a record of where the issues are located on the tape. As  the
student listens to the items through the tape, he writes  the  tape  counter
reading (as the item begins) beside the item on the checksheet.


    This gives him a tape counter reference for each item and makes it easy
for any specific item on the tape to be  located  swiftly  if  he  needs  to
listen to it again.


    So tape course checksheets contain the tape numbers of each tape, and a
space for the tape counter reading.


    The following is the exact procedure  used  by  Translations  Units  in
making tape course checksheets.

A.    The translator takes the English  checksheet  of  the  course  he  has
    translated onto tape and translates  the  checksheet  onto  paper  with
    these additions:

    1.      Just before the  first  item  on  the  checksheet  is  a  brief
        explanation of the tape course. (See attached sample for text.)


    2.      The translator leaves more space than usual  between  items  on
        the checksheet so there will be room to include the tape numbers on
        the checksheet.


    3.      An extra  column  is  put  at  the  beginning  margin  of  each
        checksheet item for noting the tape counter reading of each item on
        the tape.

B.    Next, the tape numbers themselves must be entered on  the  checksheet,
    designating where each tape begins.

    For example: 12 09 71 would be the number of the tape made on  the  9th
day of the 1 2th month (Dec.) 1971.


    In addition to the tape number, the course and sequence are written out
on the checksheet, with the tape number below it, i.e: HSDC-Tape 1 Side A
                                  Tape Number (120971)

    All of this is entered in a "square" on the checksheet. An addition  is
made alongside this square as below:
eg.   HSDC-Tape l Side A                Note: (Be sure to reset your tape
      Tape Number (120971)                   counter reading to Zero.)

    The procedure for entering the tape numbers on  the  checksheet  is  as
        follows:


    1.      A full set of the tape copies (NOT Master tapes  or  Production
        Masters) for that particular course is obtained. The copies must be
        arranged in the proper sequence (Tape 1, Tape 2, etc), and must  be
        in their labelled tape boxes.


    2.      The first tape is picked up, and the label on the back  of  the
        tape box is read. This label will list the items that  are  on  the
        tape in the order they occur on the tape.


      The translator (or another person who speaks the language)  looks  at
        this label to determine the first item on the  first  side  of  the
        tape (Side A).


    3.      He then locates the same item on the checksheet, and enters the
        tape number just above that item on the checksheet.


    4.      He puts a "square" around the tape number on the checksheet.


    5.      Alongside the square he adds:  (Be  sure  to  reset  your  tape
        counter reading to Zero.)


    6.      He then looks at the side B of the tape box label  and  repeats
        steps 2-5.


    7.      The same steps 2-6 are done with each tape for that course.

C.    The final checksheet is checked on all the above points  before  being
    given OK to go to mimeo for issue.

D.    The checksheet is sent to  mimeo,  where  it  is  typed  on  stencils,
    proofread, and run off.

    The final product is in the same format as the attached sample.


                              ADDITIONAL NOTES

    It must not be assumed that tape course checksheets for the same course
will be alike from language to language.


    Translators speak at varying speeds, so the number  of  items  on  each
tape will also vary. Thus the first item on each tape will be different  for
each language.


    All of the above steps must be done for each course in each language.


    This special format for tape translated course checksheets  appears  on
the attached sample. It is to be used in all tape course translations.

                                   SAMPLE

TAPE COURSE CHECKSHEET FORMAT:

                                (COURSE NAME)

Usual  Course introduction plus

__________________________   ____________________
(Student's Name) (Org Name)

etc, etc.
The material on this checksheet has been translated onto tape into your  own
language.


    Play the tapes in the order shown on the checksheet  and  indicated  on
the tape boxes.


    Sign your initials for every  recorded  item  (bulletin,  etc)  on  the
checksheet when you have finished listening to it.


    The name of every separate item is given on the tape before the item is
recorded.


    Fill out the column "tape counter" with the numbers at the beginning of
every item. This makes it possible for you to easily find a particular  item
if you wish to listen to it again.


    Make sure the tape counter is set at 0 before  you  start  playing  the
tape, so that you can use the tape counter with success.


    Set up the tape recorder the way you have learned, and start.  We  wish
you a very successful course.

    START!


Course Name Tape 1 Side A    Note: (Be sure to reset your tape
Tape Number (            )   counter reading to Zero.)


      A                R
      T                E
      T                T
      E                R
      S                E
Tape Counter     T                A
Reading Column                    D

      1.    HCO B

      2.    HCO B

      3.    HCO B

      4.    LRH Lecture



Course Name Tape 1 Side B    Note: (Be sure to reset your tape
Tape Number (            )   counter reading to Zero.)


      5.    HCO PL

      6.    HCO B

      7.    HCO B

      8.    HCO PL

      9.    HCO B

      10.   DRILL

Course Name Tape 1 Side B    Note: (Be sure to reset your tape
Tape Number (            )   counter reading to Zero.)


      5.    HCO PL


                               ---------------


                                  Sherene Hull
                                  Flag Mission 1248 I/C


                                  Revised by
                                  CS-2 Lt. Comdr. Robin Roos


                                  In co-ordination with
                                  Flag Mission 1234
                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow


                                  Commodore's Staff Aides


                                  Approved by the Board of Issues
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:RR:SH:ah.mh.jh
Copyright � 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              23 NOVEMBER 1974
Remimeo
                            Tape Course Series 14


                        TAPE COURSE SERIES REVISIONS
                              AND CANCELLATIONS


    The Tape Course Series has been  reviewed  chronologically  and,  as  a
result, some Issues were revised and reissued and some  were  cancelled  out
altogether. In addition, the Tape Course  Series  has  been  renumbered  for
numerical sequence.

The following is the list of Issues as they now exist:

1.    HCO B 20 Nov 71  Issue II   Reissued 23 Oct 74
                       Tape Course Series 1
                       COURSE TRANSLATION TO TAPES

2.    HCO B 21 Nov 71  Issue I    Tape Course Series 2
                       DIANETICS AND SCIENTOLOGY
                       IN OTHER LANGUAGES

3.    HCO B      21 Nov 71R  Issue II   Revised 23 Oct 74
                       Tape Course Series 3R
                       TEACHING A TAPE COURSE

4.    BTB   22 Nov 71  Issue II   Reissued 11 Aug 74 as BTB
                       Tape Course Series 4
                       TAPE PLAYERS-DESCRIPTION
                       AND CARE

5.    BTB   21 Nov 74        Tape Course Series 5
                       TRANSLATED TAPES FOR STAFF
                       AND STUDENT USE

6.    HCO B 10 Nov 71 R           Revised 21 Sept 74
                       Tape Course Series 6R
                       TAPES, HOW TO USE

7.    BTB   25 Nov 71R       Reissued 7 July 74 as BTB
                       Revised & Reissued 21 Nov 74
                       Tape Course Series 7
                       SETTING UP AND USING A TAPE PLAYER

8.    BTB   26 Nov 71 RA          Revised & Reissued 17 Aug 74 as BTB
                       Revised 21 Nov 74
                       Tape Course Series 8
                       HANDLING MISUNDERSTOOD WORDS
                       ON TAPE RECORDED MATERIALS

9.    BTB   27 Nov 71R       Revised & Reissued 21 Nov 74 as BTB
                       Tape Course Series 9
                       METHOD 2 WORD CLEARING ON TAPES
                       AND TAPE COURSES

10.   HCO B 17 Aug 72R       Revised 8 July 74 & Reissued 24 Oct 74
                       as Tape Course Series 18
                       Tape Course Series 10
                       METHOD 4 NOTES

11.   BTB   6 Apr 72R        Revised & Reissued 22 Nov 74 as BTB
                       Cancels HCO B 6 Apr 72 Same Title
                       Tape Course Series 11
                       BASIC TAPE RUNDOWN
12.   BTB   18 Feb 72R Issue I    Reissued 3 Aug 74 as BTB
                       Revised 23 Nov 74 as
                       Tape Course Series 1 2R
                       TAPE TRANSLATIONS TO TAPE

13.   BTB   9 Jan 74R        Revised 21 Nov 74
                       Tape Course Series 13
                       TAPE COURSE CHECKSHEETS

                                CANCELLATIONS

The following Issues are cancelled:

1.    BTB   20 Nov 71R       Revised 12 Jan 74
                       Reissued 8 July 74 as BTB
                       Tape Course Series 1 R
                       COURSE TRANSLATION TO TAPE

2.    BTB   21 Nov 71 RA          Revised & Reissued 20 Aug 74 as BTB
                       Tape Course Series 3RA
                       TEACHING A TAPE COURSE

3.    BTB   22 Nov 71  Issue I    Revised & Reissued 8 July 74 as BTB
                       Tape Course Series 4
                       TRANSLATION TAPES, USE OF

4.    BTB   24 Nov 71  Issue II   Reissued 3 July 74 as BTB
                       Tape Course Series 7
                       COURSE MATERIALS

5.    BTB   24 Nov 71 R      Issue III  Revised & Reissued  28  July  74  as
BTB
                       Tape Course Series 8R
                       ADMINISTRATIVE AND HAT MATERIALS

6.    HCO B 11 Jan 72        Tape Course Series 12
                       THE TAPE REFERENCE SYSTEM

7.    HCO B 6 Apr 72         Tape Course Series 14
      (Note: Rev. & Reissued as BTB,
      BASIC TAPE RUNDOWN
      TC Series 11. See above.)

8.    BTB   12 Sept 72       Reissued 18 Sept 74 as BTB
                       Tape Course Series 15
                       TAPE PLAYERS-HOW TO KEEP THEM
                       OPERATIONAL

9.    HCO B 22 Sept 72       Tape Course Series 16
                       THE BASIC PRINCIPLES OF
                       TRANSLATING


      Lt. Comdr. Robin Roos
      CS-2

      In co-ordination with
      Flag Mission 1234

      I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow

      Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
BDCS BofI:AL MH:RR:mh-rd     or the
Copyright � 1974 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
























                            WORD CLEARING SERIES
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                23 JUNE 1971
Remimeo
All Students     Reissued 24 November 1974 as BTB
Tech & Qual
Course Supers
Word Clearers    CANCELS
                        HCO BULLETIN OF 23 JUNE 1971
                                 SAME TITLE

                           Word Clearing Series 1

                         THE SECRET OF FAST COURSES

                                    [pic]
                                    [pic]

                                    [pic]




                      "I've been to the Word Clearer!"

       ("And I use the 'Misunderstood Word Tech' when studying too!")


                               WORD CLEARING!

    If it's used, your courses start  running  fast,  your  students  start
learning quickly-with all stats going well.-LRH.

      Training & Services Aide
      and Flag Artist

      Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

                                        Approved by the Board of Issues

BDCS:Bofl:AL:MH:BW:RG:mhjh   for the
Copyright � 1971, 1974 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 24 JUNE 1971
Remimeo
All Students
Tech & Qual
Course Supervisors
Course Supers Checksheet
Cramming Officers
Word Clearers
                           Word Clearing Series 2



                                WORD CLEARING


    If anyone has "word cleared" you without these steps it is incorrect.

(1)   By Meter in Session: A full assessment of many many subjects is  done.
The auditor then takes each reading subject and clears  the  chain  back  to
earlier words and/or words in earlier subjects until he gets an F/N VGIs.

(2)   By Meter in Classroom: The earlier passage  is  read  by  the  student
while on a meter and the misunderstood word  is  found.  Then  it  is  fully
defined by dictionary. The word is then used several times in  sentences  of
the student's own verbal composing. The misunderstood area  is  then  reread
until understood.

(3)    Verbal  in  classroom:  The  student  says  he  does  not  understand
something.  The  Supervisor  has  him  look  earlier  in  the  text  for   a
misunderstood word, gets the student to look it up, use it verbally  several
times in  sentences  of  his  own  composition,  then  read  the  text  that
contained it. Then come forward in the text to the area of  the  subject  he
did not understand.

    If any other word clearing is going on it is OUT tech.


    There is a C/S on HCOB 30 June  71  to  be  followed  exactly  on  word
clearing in a session. Do not follow any other version or excerpt. There  is
NO other way to do it.


    If you are not auditing this way or using word clearing this way or  if
words are not being cleared this way, report it to Ethics.


    Once development and issue has occurred the next  step  is  to  get  it
understood and applied EXACTLY.


    Then in both Tech and Admin we have successes.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder







LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1971
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 25 JUNE 1971 R
                          REVISED 25 NOVEMBER 1974
Remimeo
Tech & Qual
All Students
Supervisors Word Clearing Series 3R
Supervisor's Course
Cramming
Word Clearers
                              BARRIERS TO STUDY



    There are three different sets of physiological  and  mental  reactions
that come from 3 different aspects of study. They are three  different  sets
of symptoms.


    (1)     Education in the absence of the mass in  which  the  technology
will be involved is very hard on the student.


    It actually makes him feel squashed.  Makes  him  feel  bent,  sort  of
spinny, sort of dead, bored, exasperated.


    If he is studying the doingness of  something  in  which  the  mass  is
absent this will be the result.


    Photographs help and motion pictures would do pretty good as they are a
sort of promise or hope of the mass but the  printed  page  and  the  spoken
word are not a substitute for a tractor if he's studying about tractors.


    You have to understand  this  data  in  its  purity-and  that  is  that
educating a person in a mass that they don't have and which isn't  available
produces physiological reactions. That is what I am trying to teach you.


    It's just a fact.


    You're trying to teach this fellow all about tractors  and  you're  not
giving him any tractors-well he's going to wind up with a  face  that  feels
squashed, with headaches and with his stomach feeling funny. He's  going  to
feel dizzy from time to time and very often his eyes are going to hurt.


    It's a physiological datum that has to do with processing and the field
of the mind.


    You could therefore expect the greatest incidence of suicide or illness
in that field of education most devoted to studying absent masses.


    This one of studying the something without its mass ever  being  around
produces the most distinctly recognizable reactions.


    If a child felt sick in the field of study and it were traced  back  to
this one, the positive remedy would be to supply the mass-the  object  or  a
reasonable substitute- and it would clear it up.
                                -------------


    (2)     There is another series of physiological phenomena  that  exist
which is based on the fact of too steep a study gradient.


    That's another source of physiological study reaction  because  of  too
steep a gradient.
It is a sort of a confusion or a reelingness that goes with this one.


    You've hit too steep a gradient.


    There was too much of a jump because he didn't understand what  he  was
doing and he jumped to the next thing and that was too  steep  and  he  went
too fast and he will assign all of his difficulties to this new thing.


    Now differentiate here-because gradients sounds terribly like  the  3rd
one of these study hang-ups, definitions-but remember that  they  are  quite
distinctly different.


    Gradients are more pronounced in the field of doingness but they  still
hang over into the field of understanding. In gradients however  it  is  the
actions we are interested in. We have a plotted course of forward motion  of
actions. We find he was terribly  confused  on  the  second  action  he  was
supposed to do. We must assume then that he never  really  got  out  of  the
first one.


    The remedy for this one of too steep a gradient is cutting  back.  Find
out when he was not confused on  the  gradient,  then  what  new  action  he
undertook to do. Find what action he understood well.  Just  before  he  was
all confused what did he understand  well-and  then  we  find  out  that  he
didn't understand it well.


    It's really at the tail end of what he understood and then he went over
the gradient you see.


    It is most recognizable and most applicable in the field of doingness.


    That's the gradient barrier and one full set of  phenomena  accompanies
that.
                                -------------


    (3)      There  is  this  third  one.  An  entirely  different  set  of
physiological reactions  brought  about  through-a  bypassed  definition.  A
bypassed definition gives one a distinctly blank  feeling  or  a  washed-out
feeling. A not-there feeling and a sort of nervous hysteria will  follow  in
the back of that.


    The manifestation of "blow" stems from this 3rd aspect of  study  which
is the misunderstood definition or  the  not  comprehended  definition,  the
undefined word.


    That's the one that produces the blow.


    The person doesn't necessarily blow on these  other  two-they  are  not
pronouncedly blow phenomena. They are simply physiological phenomena.


    This one of the misunderstood definition is  so  much  more  important.
It's the make-up of human relations, the mind and subjects.  It  establishes
aptitude and lack of aptitude and it's what psychologists have  been  trying
to test for years without recognizing what it was.


    It's the definitions of words.


    The misunderstood word.


    That's all it goes back to and that produces such a  vast  panorama  of
mental effects that it itself is the prime factor  involved  with  stupidity
and the prime factor involved with many other things.


    If a person didn't have misunderstoods his talent might or might not be
present but his doingness would be present.


    We can't say that Joe  would  paint  as  well  as  Bill  if  both  were
unaberrated in the field of art, but we can say that the  inability  of  Joe
to paint compared with the ability of
Joe to do the motions of painting is dependent  exclusively  and  only  upon
definitions-exclusively and only upon definitions.


    There is some word in the field of art that the  person  who  is  inept
didn't define or understand and that is followed by an inability to  act  in
the field of the arts.


    That's very important because it tells you what  happens  to  doingness
and that the restoration of doingness depends only upon the  restoration  of
understanding on the misunderstood word-misunderstood definition.


    This is very fast processing. There is a very  swift  wide  big  result
obtainable in this.


    It has a technology which is a very simple technology.


    It enters in at the lower levels because it has to. This  doesn't  mean
it is unimportant,  it  means  it  has  to  be  at  the  entrance  gates  of
Scientology.


    It is a sweepingly fantastic discovery in the field  of  education  and
don't neglect it.


    You can trace back the subject a  person  is  dumb  in  or  any  allied
subject that got mixed up  with  it.  The  psychologist  doesn't  understand
Scientology. He  never  understood  a  word  in  psychology  so  he  doesn't
understand Scientology.


    Well that opens the gate to Education. Although I've given this one  of
the misunderstood definition last it is the most important one.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder









LRH:nt.rd jh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 26 JUNE 1971R
Remimeo                 Issue II
Tech & Qual      REVISED 30 NOVEMBER 1974
All Supervisors       (Revision in this type style)
Super's Course
Cramming Officers
Word Clearers
                           Word Clearing Series 4R


                         SUPERVISOR TWO-WAY COMM AND
                           THE MISUNDERSTOOD WORD

                 (From LRH taped briefing to Lt Bill Foster
                                 14 June 71)


    Two-way comm where it has been described has been described for the use
of an auditor, not a Supervisor of a Course.


    Supervisors not knowing this then run around itsa-ing students.


    They let the students itsa and they think they are going  to  get  some
place.


    It's the most incredible scene that you ever  heard  of  and  the  boom
could go bust only on this one point. I've got it narrowed down to this.


    Apparently no matter how many times the study tapes have  been  played,
nobody has ever heard of them.


    I watched a recent course run to find out how deep they would  let  the
students struggle-how long it would stay bogged-and  it  would  have  stayed
bogged from here on out !


    And do you know what's out?


    It's the study data tapes just that-and that's  all  that's  out  on  a
course.


    So when they say "2-way comm the students" you'll find the  Supervisors
instantly start to itsa them and are  using  auditor  2-way  comm  on  these
courses. It doesn't belong on these courses.


    I'll give you now the total dialogue of a Supervisor:


    The Supervisor shows interest. There can be a little  bit  of  chatter,
like-"I see you've just completed. Great!"-something like that, or he  shows
interest-"How are you doing?"


    Student replies-"Ah well, I'm doing all right."


    Supervisor-"Now are there any  words  there  in  that,  that  you  have
misunderstood?"


    Student-"No ... no...."


    Supervisor-"Well what is the word that you didn't quite understand?"


    Student-"Ah well . . . ah . . . this one."


    Supervisor-"Good. Now look that word up.... Now what's the word in  the
paragraph above that, where's that? . . . Alright let's look  that  up.  Now
use it in a sentence a couple of times and I'll be back in a minute."


    He comes  back,  the  student  gives  him  the  sentences  for  it  and
straightens it out and he sees the student's got it.
That's the 2-way comm of a Supervisor.


    If a Supervisor does any other thing you've got a wrecked course.  I've
got the proof of it.


    The way you teach a TR Course is you give the student the bulletin  and
you have him read it. You don't check the guy out on the bulletin,  he  just
reads it.


    When you come back you say, "Alright, have you read it?"


    "Yeah. I've read it."


    "What word don't you understand on it?"


    You will find things like HCO B and TR, and you get those  cleared  up,
etc.


    I am having some roaring success stories from  FEBC  students  who  are
through this.


    One had gone through the bulletin 10  times  and  had  found  words  he
didn't know all 10 times, and he was all of a sudden finding new  things  on
the bulletin that he'd never heard of before.


    Another student had gone through it 20 times with the same  result  and
they were doing fine and getting down to TRs and passing them.


    On a TR Course you give them the bulletin and let them read it and  you
find what word they didn't understand. That's the routine.


    Now that sounds so impossible-and it's been on the study tapes  for  so
long-that you wouldn't believe that this thing is the key.


    Do you know there were students there  for  15  or  20  days  until  we
started doing this, then all of a sudden there was a breakthrough and  their
enthusiasm started coming up.


    They had been just going lose,  lose,  lose,  out  the  bottom  because
Supervisors were letting them itsa.


    Maybe Supervisors thought they were auditors.


    They aren't.


    Neither are they supposed to give advice or tell  students  how-or  ask
them if they blinked or anything else.


    The other thing they were doing was only emphasizing all the "can'ts".


    The students just went into despair.


    This was because the Supervisors were inviting all kinds  of  itsa  and
criticizing and so forth.


    You may say, "Gee! Everybody knows it's a misunderstood word."


    Yeh-but they don't use it.


    Now I'll give you another one.


    I set up a test so that each student was brought up to the D of  T  who
had a meter on his desk  and  he'd  ask  them  if  they  had  anything  they
misunderstood-and see if they got a read on the meter.


    If it didn't  clear  up  at  once  he'd  send  them  back  to  get  the
definitions and look the thing up and of course use the word in a couple  of
sentences and then if it didn't clear up he'd send them to the word  clearer
and really let them get worked over because it goes way back.


    They even found a student who had a misunderstood word clear back  into
his last life.
There wasn't any other 2-way comm and no other interest and they just  about
blew the roof off with student stat points.


    This is the action  of  a  Supervisor  and  that's  ALL  the  action  a
Supervisor does-and he can do that.


    The course has plenty of dictionaries and so on.


    But, the main point is, it is the misunderstood  word.  This  has  been
proven again.


    On  a  TR  practical  course  it's  the  misunderstood  word  and   the
misunderstood action.


    On other courses it's just misunderstood words and misunderstood  words
and misunderstood words, one right after the other.


    As fast as they clear this up-up the student's production goes.


    It's painfully slow on  some  of  them  at  first  and  I  suppose  the
Supervisors have so many misunderstood words of their  own  that  they  just
won't key into doing this action and that's what's wrecking courses.


    It's elementary, and it's the wildest discovery of all  time  but  they
don't use it.


    If it is used, your courses start running  fast,  your  students  start
learning quickly and all starts going well.


    Other course outnesses like Supervisors not giving anybody a pack or no
one to give checkouts are all Administrative outnesses.


    As far as actual Supervision is  concerned  it's  this  other  line  of
handling misunderstood words.


    The second that line is in there are wins all over the place.


    The second that line is out there is no delivery.


    If auditors are goofing, then in their training they have not been made
to look up the misunderstood word and a lot of itsa has gone on  and  people
have evaluated for them. Then  these  auditors  having  made  mistakes  they
never corrected with this tech, think they need  something  new  to  run  on
pcs, but they just wreck new tech too.


    We are shooting for a target, using just this misunderstood word  tech,
of a reduction of time by about a third on all major courses.


    Just using this misunderstood word tech. That's all.


    If some student is a totally slow student, you can get him back to  the
first bulletin or book he ever read and make him get every  word  in  it  he
didn't understand, and it will go up in a chain.


    People on courses were being itsa'd to death.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH:ntjh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 27 JUNE 1971R
All Students
Tech & Qual        REVISED 2 DECEMBER 1974
Course Supervisors            (Revision in this type style)
Course Super Chksht
Cramming Offs
Word Clearers
                           Word Clearing Series 5R


                      SUPERVISOR TWO-WAY COMM EXPLAINED

                       (From LRH Lecture Tape 16/6/71
                         Briefing to Aides Council)


    I don't think from the day they were  spoken  until  now,  anybody  has
understood or used "The Study Tapes".


    This is the only  piece of Technology that you use  on a course.


    There is no other teaching technology of any kind used on a course.


    The 2-way comm HCOBs are Auditor 2-way comm.


    The Supervisor  has to know 2-way comm simply so that he can ask  these
burning questions:


    "How are you doing?" (Not with a lot of student itsa.)


    "Is there any word you haven't understood?"


    "Look it up."


    "Use it in a sentence a few times."


    That's the TOTALITY. That's all  there is to teaching a course  as  far
as the technology goes.


    It's contained in the few words  which  I  have  just  given  you   and
there's no  other technology.


    That's all there is to teaching a  course  because  that's  all  that's
wrong with students.


    You can monitor it this way. You can watch a  student's  stats  day  to
day. His stats are down today compared with yesterday's so you go  over  and
talk to him. He says, "Yes. I had a hard night  last  night,  up  all  night
arguing with my wife," etc-which could go on for hours.


    But  the Supervisor says, "Now yesterday or today what word did you run
across that you didn't understand?"


    The meter gives a LF.


    He says, "Yes! Well I didn't understand the word 'waffle-waffle'."


    The Supervisor says, "Well let's look it up and get it defined."
The student says, "Well it wasn't that word, it was the word before that."


    Supervisor, "Good-let's get this looked up and used a couple  of  times
in a sentence."


    The student does and he gets an F/N and it's all fine.


    His study stats go back up.


    That's all there is to it!


    There are two ways to fail to communicate the tech. One is not to  read
the HCO Bs and the other is not to use the misunderstood word tech.


    (Of course you can have no course and nobody there even trying.)


    The worst thing would be to pretend to have a course but  have  missing
materials and Supervisors giving verbal advice or tech. That is  deadly  and
will turn any Academy sour.


    Verbal tech comes about when course  materials  are  not  available  to
students and no or faulty Word Clearing is used.


    As long as the Administration of the course is in and  all  the  course
materials are available, the sole course Tech  is  this  misunderstood  word
tech.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH:nt.jh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                28 JUNE 1971R
Remimeo     Reissued 1 July 1974 as BTB
Tech & Qual Revised 20 November 1974
Supervisors CANCELS
Checksheets BTB OF 28 JUNE 1971
Cramming Off     SAME TITLE
Checksheet  (Revision in this type style)
Word Clearers

                           Word Clearing Series 6R

                                 METHOD TWO
                            METERED WORD CLEARING
                             IN THE COURSE ROOM


    This method of Word Clearing is covered in HCO B 13 June 70, Issue  II,
"Hubbard Consultant Study Stress Analysis"-numbers 3 and 4.


    The student gets into study difficulty.


    He is put on the meter and the Word Clearer (or Supervisor)  gives  him
the R-factor "I am not auditing you."


    He has the student read over the EARLIER passage on his study materials
and the Misunderstood Word is found by meter read.


    The word is then fully defined by dictionary and is used several  times
in sentences composed by the student.


    The misunderstood area is then re-read until understood.


    If it does not fully resolve you may have to start the student  reading
earlier on the HCO B to locate an even earlier Misunderstood Word.


    It may go back to the previous HCO B or an  earlier  one  on  the  same
subject.


    The Word Clearer can 2-Way Comm  ONLY  to  locate  the  material  being
studied when the trouble started.


    The student finds THAT material and brings it to the Word Clearer where
the word is located and handled as above.


    On occasions a student has had to put a  word  into  6  or  8  or  more
sentences before he finally connects with it and owns it and  the  TA  comes
down and F/N VGIs. Each word cleared is taken to F/N


    This method of Word Clearing is not attempted if the  student's  TA  is
above 3.5 or below 2.0 and  the  student  is  sent  to  Qual  for  C/S  53RI
handling.

      From data of the
      Flag Word Clearer
      Training & Services Aide
      Revised by CS-5
      Ens. Judy Ziff
      In co-ordination with
      Flag Mission 1234
      I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow
      Commodore's Staff Aides
      Approved by the Board of Issues
BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:BW:mh.jh  for the
Copyright � 1971, 1974 BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                29 JUNE 1971R
                          REVISED 17 NOVEMBER 1974
Remimeo
Tech & Qual
Supervisors CANCELS
Cramming Offs    BTB OF 29 JUNE 1971
Word Clearers    SAME TITLE

                           Word Clearing Series 7R

                                  IMPORTANT

                     STEPS TO SPEED STUDENT PRODUCT FLOW

                 (FOR SUPERVISORS AND TECH PRODUCT OFFICERS)


    Let us consider each student who is tearing along successfully  in  his
studies to be an F/Ning student.


    As a Supervisor, you would want  to  handle  anything  that  slowed  or
interfered with such a student's F/N.


    Using dope-off as the only detection of misunderstoods  is  Supervising
at a below F/N level. The F/N went off long before the student  reached  the
point of dope-off, so waiting for  dope-off  to  occur  before  handling  is
waiting too long.


    Let us look at this from the point of view of the tone scale.


    If you consider that each student who is not at tone 5.0  during  study
has a misunderstood WORD-and if you do  something  about  the  misunderstood
word-then you can drive up study velocity so that all  students  are  flying
along as F/Ning students.


    (It's not a misunderstood phrase or idea or concept but a misunderstood
WORD.) This always occurs before the subject itself is not understood.


    In comparison with waiting for dope-off to occur  before  handling  the
misunderstoods, this method is like high level auditing  where  slowed  F/Ns
are taken as reads-rather than TA rise being the read.


    An estimation of the tone level of students on one course  showed  them
at about plus or minus 2.5.


    This would mean many students had a  very  tight  meter  needle  if  we
compare them to the F/Ning student who is flying along successfully.


    This could be remedied.


    If you had this problem of a group of students at tone 2.5 it could  be
approached this way:

1.    Set up one or more Word Clearers in the classroom.

2.    Start with the faster study students, but not those  at  tone  5.0  or
    above.

3.    If TA above 3.5 or below 2.0 send to Qual for a C/S 53RI.

4.    Word Clearer inspects student stats graphs  and  locates  with  simple
    two-way comm what was being studied at the specific period just  before
    the graph levelled or started to go down. If the  graph  has  not  done
    either but just maintained at a low level, the Word Clearer selects out
    the earliest materials on the course.
    5.      Do Method 4 on the materials selected on each  student,  taking
    each word to F/N.

6.    Any student with BIs which do not clear up, or who runs  into  trouble
    on Method 4 is sent to Qual for WCCL.

7.    Push back the action so it's done within the first few days of  course
    for all new students, once all existing students are handled.

8.    Keep in the M4 for all new students within the first  few  days  as  a
    standard action.

9.    Do Method 4 or use other  Methods  of  Word  Clearing  on  all  course
    students at the first sign of a non-F/Ning student.

    By eliminating all these slows  (misunderstood  WORDS),  the  students'
average points will rise and you will  get  all  students  flying  along  as
F/Ning students.


    The above actions can be done on all students who are not at tone 5  or
above on courses, whether Super literate or on Fast Flow courses.


    These are organizing actions to speed production  flow,  which  can  be
done without shattering stops such as "all students off course onto TRs".


    Quality will rise as well as speed.


                                  Training & Services Aide

                                  Revised by CS-5
                                  Ensign Judy Ziff

                                  In co-ordination with
                                  Flag Mission 1234

                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow

                                  Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:BW:mh.jh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                    HCO BULLETIN OF 30 JUNE 1971 REVISED
Remimeo     Issue II
Tech & Qual (Revised 9 Aug 71 )
Auditors    (Cancels HCOB 30 June 71 Issue II,
Word Clearers    8R and 8RR)

                          Word Clearing Series 8RB

                  STANDARD C/S FOR WORD CLEARING IN SESSION
                                  METHOD I

0.    Clear the words in the Word Clearing Correction List so as to have  it
    ready for use in case of bog.

1.    Fly a rud if no F/N. If TA High or Low do not try to fly an  ARC  Brk.
    Do a C/S 53RRR instead. (See Auditor's  Rights  C/S  Series  1  if  any
    trouble with this pc. If errors in previous  word  clear  sessions  use
    HCOB 21 July 1971 REVISED to handle word clearing corrections needed.)

2.    Do not clear these words before assessment

    ASSESS.

    R Factor: We are going to go over a list of subjects to see if there is
any word you didn't understand while studying these  subjects.  (Assess  the
whole list rapidly and clearly, good TR 1 and noting  every  read  from  the
meter.)

Religion         The Mind
Ministers        The Spirit
Church           Bodies
College          Sex
Schools          The Insane
Sacrifices       Psychiatry
Surgery          Psychoanalysis
Medicine         Psychology
Electronics      Rituals
Physics          Rites
Technical Subjects           Ships
Dianetics        The Sea
Scientology      Military
Theology         Armies
Theosophy        Navies
Philosophy       Stars
Law         Heavenly Bodies
Organization           The Universe
Government       Planes
Written Materials            Vehicles
Text Books       Machinery
Practice         Motors
Science          Administration
Music       Healing
Arithmetic       Illnesses
Grammar          Spoken Words
The Humanities         TAPES
Add items dealing with this specific Pc's life.












3.    Ask the  Question,  "Is  there  any  word  on  this  list  you  didn't
    understand?" Clear it. Then do Step 5 on it before going  on.  (Do  not
    reassess this list because there was a list word not understood.)

4.    Take the remaining reading items from the best read on down  and  with
    E/S pull each one to F/N. Get each word you find to F/N. There  can  be
    many F/Ns per subject End off with a win on the subject

5.    "In the subject of  ________ what word has been misunderstood?"

      He MUST look them up, so have a good dictionary handy. Do  not  accept
    "I know the meaning" if the subject or word reads. CLEAR  "GRAMMAR"  or
    grammatical words out of a simple book of grammar, not a dictionary.

      It isn't an earlier time he misunderstood that word. It's  an  earlier
    word in that subject and it can be an earlier subject.

      Considerations about it and other questions are not touched.

      Overts, W/Hs, etc are neglected. They are not done on the  subject  of
    the word. They are done in the session ruds.

      Just do the process and it will eventually F/N on each chain.

6.    When all reads on the first assessment are handled  to  F/N,  REASSESS
    the whole list. Do not take off the list items already handled.

7.    Repeat Step 4.

8.    Repeat Step 5.

9.    Repeat Step 6, etc.

10.   IN CASE OF ANY BOG OR SOMATIC USE THE WORD  CLEARING  CORRECTION  LIST
    TO CORRECT THE BOG.

11.   A persistent F/N should be attained on assessing  the  whole  list  as
    the End Phenomena of the Word Clearing sessions.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH: nt.bh
Copyright � 1971,1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                 1 JULY 1971
                                   Issue I
                      Reissued 21 September 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
Tech & Qual CANCELS
Supervisors HCO BULLETIN OF 1 JULY 1971
Supervisor  Issue I
Checksheets SAME TITLE
Cramming Off
Checksheets
Word Clearers
                           Word Clearing Series 9



                       THE THREE TYPES OF WORD CLEARING



                                    [pic]


"Verbal in Classroom: The student says he  does  not  understand  something.
The Supervisor has him look earlier in the text for  a  misunderstood  word,
gets the student to look it up, use it verbally several times  in  sentences
of his own composition, then read the text  that  contained  it.  Then  come
forward in the text to the area of the subject he did not  understand."  LRH
(HCOB 24 June 71, WC Series 2, WORD CLEARING)

































                                    [pic]




























"By Meter in Classroom: The earlier passage is read by the student while  on
a Meter and the misunderstood word is found. Then it  is  fully  defined  by
dictionary. The word  is  then  used  several  times  in  sentences  of  the
student's own verbal composing. The misunderstood area is then reread  until
understood." LRH (HCO B 24 June 71, WC Series 2, WORD CLEARING)









                                    [pic]






"By Meter in Session: A full assessment of many many subjects is  done.  The
auditor then takes each  reading  subject  and  clears  the  chain  back  to
earlier words and/or words in earlier subjects until he gets an  F/N  VGIs."
LRH (HCO B 24 June 71, WC Series 2, WORD CLEARING)


      Training & Service Aide
      and Flag Artist

      Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY



BDCS:SW:AL:MH:BW:RG:nt.mh.jh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                1 JULY 1971R
Remimeo
Tech & Qual               Issue II
Supervisors      Reissued 20 August 1974 as BTB
Super Courses           Revised 23 November 1974
Cramming Off
Word Clearers                 CANCELS
                             BTB OF 1 JULY 1971
                                  Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE


                          Word Clearing Series 10R


                          SPEEDING UP A SLOW COURSE

                    Refer BTB 29 June 71 R, Word Clearing
                    Series 7R, "Important-Steps to Speed
                            Student Product Flow"


Situation-Course is slow-down-tone not  winning  enough.  Students  are  not
F/Ning students.

Solution-The Word Clearer calls the students up (starting  with  the  faster
students). Gives an R-Factor: "I am not auditing you," and does Method 4  on
selected materials which precede the student slow.

                                    [pic]

    1.      If there is no meter read the Word Clearer  sends  the  student
        directly back to study.
         2.      If the meter reads the Word Clearer does M4 Word Clearing.

    Student after that returns to study.














                                    [pic]






















    3.      If the student has real Bad Indicators or TA at 3.5 or above or
        at 2.0 or below, or trouble with M4, the  Word  Clearer  sends  him
        directly to the Qual Word Clearer for a WCCL or C/S 53RI by a  Qual
        Auditor.
                                    [pic]




                               ---------------


    Result  of these combined actions = Average student points rise and all
students flying along. Quality will rise as well as speed.


                                        Training & Services Aide
                                        Revised by CS-5
                                        Ens. Judy Ziff
                                        In co ordination with
                                        Flag Mission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides
                                        Approved by the Board of Issues
BDCS:BofI:AL MH:JZ BW:RG:mh.jh    for the
Copyright � 1971,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               2 JULY 1971 RA
Remimeo
Tech & Qual Issue I
All Students     Revised & Reissued 27 July 1974 as BTB
Supervisors Revised 20 November 1974
Supervisor
Courses     CANCELS
Cramming Cksheet BTB OF 2 JULY 1971R
Word Clearers    SAME TITLE
All Staff   Issue 1

                     (Revisions are in this type style)

                         Word Clearing Series 11 RA


                           WORD CLEARING SUCCESSES


A.    WORD CLEARING SUCCESS FROM FLAG D OF T:

    "When Ron put in full Word Clearing technology the FEBC  daily  student
points average was greatly increased.


    "First  a  Supervisor  finds  the  misunderstood  word  using  M3  Word
Clearing. If he can't and doesn't resolve  it  then  another  Supervisor  or
Word Clearer would find it using the meter (M4).


    "If we couldn't find the word and resolve it,  the  student  would  get
other methods of Word Clearing.


    "The word was always found on one of these steps.


    "The students soon became conscious of exactly what caused them to bog-
even slightly-before full dope-off.


    "It's another incredible piece of technology.
                                                                 Jon Horwich
                                                                Flag D of T"

B.    SUCCESSES FROM SUPER VISOR-WORD CLEARING:

    "I found out meanings for words that I hadn't known before. It's a good
 action.

                                                                       W.T."

    "What a maze of unbelievable confusion can lead back to a simple little
misunderstood word. Wow! What a win. Thank you.
                                                                       S.T."

    "The only reason a person gives up a study or feels bored about  it  is
because of misunderstood words. Since  I  started  clearing  all  the  words
things are different. I was  planning  to  leave  the  OEC-now  I'm  looking
forward to finishing it.

                                                                       W.P."

    "Word Clearing! Again when LRH says a misunderstood word or  symbol  is
behind all problems in study he means it. Clear them  up  and  start  seeing
straight again.

                                                                       S.S."
C.    SUCCESSES FROM METERED WORD CLEARING IN THE COURSE ROOM:

    "I just had some Word Clearing. I really cognited on what  product  and
organize mean. It's fantastic.
                                                                       A.T."

    "Having the Word Clearer on course is really great.  He  has  saved  me
what could have been many miserable hours wrestling with misunderstoods.

    "Use him. It's magic.
                                                                       D.G."

    "My last Word Clearing was on the cans and boy did I come  out  bright!
Damn- just do it like it says and what a winner!!! It was so good I told  my
friend and she's going in to get some too. Boy you can really have  enormous
wins doing this Word Clearing as per HCO B. Yes Sir! !
                                                                       S.C."

    "I just want to put down in a success form the wins I've had  from  the
Word Clearer. Having him available to find  that  one  word  has  helped  me
speed through the courses I've had. He may just sit in  the  course  out  of
the way seeming to be unimportant at times but he is truly a big aid to  all
students. If you're having trouble-use the Word Clearer.
                                                                       C.T."

D.    SUCCESSES FROM SESSION WORD CLEARING:

    "I just cleared up a whole load of misunderstoods on targeting and also
on the Bureaux  System.  I  was  amazed  how  problems  on  targeting  could
originate from basic misunderstoods on photography (of all things)  and  how
Bureaux went  back  to  problems  in  filling  out  my  tax  forms  for  the
Government (Jeez! Those tax forms are really screw-ball).


    "Thanks to Ron and my Word Clearer.
                                                                       J.B."

    "I just had a great Word Clearing session. It really cleared  some  big
things up. I really loved it. It's very very basic and powerful.

                                                                       R.L."

    "It was fantastic! I found a basic  big  fat  'rat'  (laughing)  called
enforced religion and blew it.  A  lot  of  things  were  intermingled  with
disagreement and protest. I  reached  several  basics  and  felt  tremendous
relief to cast off another lie. Thank you Ron for this tech.
    M.O."


    "The Word Clearing session I had  was  really  terrific.  I  thought  I
didn't  have  any  misunderstoods  as  I  always  'look  them  up   in   the
dictionary', but in the session I unearthed basic misunderstoods  which  had
caused me to go into apathy about  discovering  things  about  life-and  the
reason for blowing from earlier subjects and throwing  away  old  abilities.
I'm very excited about what Word Clearing can do. It's like a  Grade  as  it
restores ability.


    "My thanks to LRH, for this great tech, and to my Word Clearer,  for  a
great session.
                                                                       P.M."

    "What an experience! I had done it on a Pc and I  saw  his  gains,  but
having had it done on me really gives a totally new reality.
"It reached so far and into such depths that I  couldn't  help  but  end  up
exteriorizing.


    "Since then I haven't stopped noticing things I had never seen  before.
It is the real proof that a block was removed from my ability  to  duplicate
and understand.


    "ARC for the environment increased no end.
                                                                       P.D."

E.    SUCCESSES OF WORD CLEARERS:

    "Meter Word Clearing is a gas. Students are finding misunderstoods  all
over the track and blowing tons of  charge-brightening  up  and  getting  on
with it.

                                                                       W.V."

    "If you consider the main  purpose  of  Word  Clearing  to  assist  the
student to study faster and easier, then it's always but always  successful.
Yet in the time I've  been  doing  it  I've  seen  case  changes  and  other
phenomena which I  can  only  describe  as  fantastic  through  finding  and
clearing words by any of the 3 methods.


    "In a great percentage of students I've seen  major   case  changes.  A
year's hang-up on a Dynamic disintegrate on locating and clearing  a  couple
of words. A remarkable exteriorization on  finding  a  very  basic  word.  A
renewed  enthusiasm  for  a  five-year  contemptuously  discarded   subject,
achieved in less than half an hour. The 'sourest' of  people  turns  into  a
very cheerful person. Several 'chronic high TA' cases blow  down  from  5.0+
and float. Extreme natter and upset gradually fade right away as words  were
found and located. An amazing return of recall (whole track) and  certainty,
and many more I could name.


    "It's the first time I've spent so much time on a  specialized  rundown
and it sometimes takes a great deal  of  confront  and  persistence  to  get
through a student's confusion but you can be certain that by persisting,  no
matter which method you're using, you will  always  always  always  increase
that student's understanding.


    "And often as a bonus give him a major  case  win  (especially  in  the
auditing rundown).


    "I wouldn't have missed it for the world.
                                        Love,
                                                                        R.H.


                                  Compiled by
                                  Training & Services Bur
                                  Revised by CS-5
                                  Ensign Judy Ziff
                                  In co-ordination with
                                  Flag Mission 1234
                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow
                                  Commodore's Staff Aides
                                  Approved by the Board of Issues
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:Bofl:AL:MH:JZ:BW:mhjh
Copyright �1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               27 JULY 1971RA
Remimeo
All Staff   Issue I
Students    Revised & Reissued 20 November 1974 as BTB
Qual  CANCELS
Supervisor  HCO BULLETIN OF 27 JULY 1971R
Courses     Issue I
Cramming Off     SAME TITLE
D of P, C/S
Word Clearers
                                (Points 1-10
                             have been revised)


                          Word Clearing Series 12RA


                                  IMPORTANT
                              ALLOW NO BUGS ON
                           WORD CLEARING PROCEDURE



    Word Clearing technology is vital tech and must not become  the  effect
of stops or slows of any kind.


    The requirement is that staff and students do get Word Cleared and that
the technology is always in use on courses and  that  there  is  always-from
this point onwards-someone in the Org who is qualified to  do  full  session
Word Clearing (M1) AND THAT IT DOES GET DONE.


    It is up to the D of T and the Tech and Qual Secs to see that  it  does
get done.


    YOUR supreme test is to see that it does get done in spite of  all  the
reasonableness as to why it can't or why it's not being done.


    Word Clearing is not a fad technology that goes out  of  fashion-it  is
vital to all successful study. Word Clearing is as vital  to  study  as  TRs
are to auditing.


    If you can't get Word Clearing done in your Org, you should telex  your
nearest FOLO and complain of the fact. If it is  not  remedied  then,  telex
Flag and report the matter.


    Here are some specific points to prevent bugs:

1.    That all Org Word  Clearers  are  trained  on  the  Professional  Word
    Clearer's Course and obtain an OK to Word Clear prior to Word  Clearing
    in Tech or Qual.

2.     That Method One Word Clearers who are Class III or above  are  posted
    in the Tech Div to deliver  Method  One  Word  Clearing  to  staff  and
    students and Pcs in the HGC.

3.    That Tech has its own Word Clearers for students on courses.

4.    That Qual has its own Word Clearers, including one or more  who  is  a
    Class III or above Professional Word Clearing Course Graduate, who  has
    the required Okays to Audit on WCCL.

5.    That students and staff who wish to do  the  Method  One  Co-Audit  on
    Course be allowed and encouraged to do so.
    6.      That Course Room Method Two Word Clearing does not require  C/S
    OK and is used by Word Clearers in Tech.

7.    That Word Clearing Method 2 on large bodies of data does  require  C/S
    OK.

8.    That C/Ses who Case Supervise Word Clearing do the  Professional  Word
    Clearer's Course and do  the  Okay  to  Audit  checksheet  plus  C/Sing
    exercises by the Cramming Officer to get an Okay to C/S  Word  Clearing
    Method One. The subject of Word  Clearing  is  a  particular  technical
    subject and therefore the Course must be studied by all who deliver and
    Case Supervise Word Clearing Method One and the WCCL.

9.    That all metered Word Clearing takes each word to F/N.

10.   That all  definitions of each word are fully cleared using  sentences,
    per WC Series 51, BTB 16 Dec  73,  Rev.  19  July  74,  "Word  Clearing
    Errors".


                                  Training & Services Aide

                                  Revised by CS-5
                                  Ens. Judy Ziff

                                  In co-ordination with
                                  Flag Mission 1234

                                  I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                  2nd: Molly Harlow

                                  Commodore's Staff Aides

                                  Approved by the Board of Issues
                                  for the
                                  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
                                  of the
                                  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:BW:mh.jh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                         HCO BULLETIN OF 2 JULY 1971
Remimeo     Issue III
Tech and Qual
Students
Course Supervisors
Supervisor's Course
Cramming off     Word Clearing Series 13
Word Clearers

                         WORD CLEARING CLARIFICATION

                 Reference HCO B 24 June 71, "Word Clearing"


    Method No. 1 Word Clearing has yet to foul up any other auditing.  When
Method No. 2 is done it is far more likely to foul up auditing.


    Persons just reporting to courses are the  first  candidates  for  Word
Clearing.


    Qual usually gets itself across numerous lines when it begins  to  Word
Clear. I don't know why it should. The most fantastic  figure-figure  occurs
around this action.


    It is wholly unlimited. If No. 1 Method is done on Monday,  it  can  be
done again, same actions, same list assessed, same items left on  the  list,
on Tuesday-and Weds and Thurs!


    It can even be done with no folder to hand.


    The only change would be to add some subjects if one wishes.  But  even
that isn't vital.


    A pc has spoken millions of languages.


    The EP is not "He was word cleared once". It would be a persistent  F/N
on the whole list.


    Who knows what the word clearing will lay bare in  other  languages  or
when one will attain the EP forever.


    But there are too many strings being put into it like needing a folder,
using tech pages, etc, etc. The action is in V. Well, why is Div IV  getting
in on it unless Div V is pulling it in?


    You frankly have no idea what it takes to get tech really applied.  The
simplicity of hats, lines and tech actions gets overlaid with complexities.


    Probably misunderstoods attract complexities.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder




LRH:sb.rd
Copyright � 1971
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                                27 July 1971
Remimeo     Issue II
Tech & Qual Revised & Reissued 9 July 1974 as BTB
All Supers  (Revision in this type style)
Courses
Auditors    CANCELS
Cramming Off     HCO BULLETIN OF 27 JULY 1971
Word Clearers    Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE


                           Word Clearing Series 14

                             EP OF WORD CLEARING



    This BTB  gives an observation by the Flag Word Clearer  and  some  LRH
C/S'd Word Clearing Sessions to clarify the EP required  from  full  session
Word Clearing.

      A)    From the Flag Word Clearer:

    "The true EP of Word Clearing is an 'F/Ning List',  meaning  the  whole
list (all items and any added ones) F/N throughout  the  assessment  of  the
fun list with no reads or slows in the F/N as all the items are called.


    "As a point of interest I notice in looking back  through  the  folders
that TA action ceased as much as two or three  sessions  prior  to  a  final
full EP.


    "The majority of sessions have been about an hour to 2 hours  long  and
have ended on a very big cog and wide, persistent F/N.


    "I've not then reassessed in that session but have done a  new  session
the next day with the same phenomena. Finally  on  assessing  the  list  the
whole list has F/Ned with no reads on anything.


    "It's taken a number of sessions and in the last one or two  the  reads
have been just stops or slows in an otherwise floating needle.


    "I recently heard of someone getting EP in one session. From what  I've
experienced on the LRH C/S'd  sessions  that  sounds  suspicious.  It's  not
really harmful as from what LRH  says  you  can  always  reassess  the  list
later.


    "The still TA and the F/N that just slows as a 'read'  when  items  are
called is to me a good indicator that we're getting  close  to  EP-not  that
we've made it yet.

                                                                       R.H."


    B)      Some LRH C/Ses from Word Clearing sessions are included here to
        give you a better reality on the EP that is to be attained.

    i)      "Well Done

        Several Reading subjects not handled-List not F/Ned.
        1.       Fly a Rud if no F/N.
        2.       Reassess Subject List, leave all items on it always.
        3.       Clear it up.

                                                                        LRH"
        ii)      "Well Done

        The EP is an F/Ning list.
        No evidence the whole list F/Ned.
        THAT is the EP. (May just be an admin error but it's an error.)
        1.       Fly a Rud if no F/N.
        2.       Assess Subjects List. If it does  not  fully  F/N,  handle
             those that read.
        3.       Reassess list.
        Get your EP. An F/Ning list.

                                                                        LRH"

    (On one specific case the following C/Ses were given.)

    iii)    "Well Done

          TO WORD CLEARING


          Add     'Bulletins'
            'Policy Letters'
            'Despatches'
          to the list.
          Full clearing.

                                                                        LRH"

    iv)     "V. Well Done

        1.       Fly a Rud. Check Protest.
        2.       Ask if any other subjects ought to be on list. Add.
        3.       Reassess whole list.
        4.       Continue to EP.

                                                                        LRH"



    Make sure you get full EP on Word Clearing.


                                        Training & Services Aide

      Reissued as BTB by
      Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
BDCS: SW AL MH BW:mhjh
Copyright �1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 26 FEBRUARY 1972

Remimeo


                          Word Clearing Series 15R

                   (Cancels HCO B 21 Aug 71, the original
                    WC Series 15 by a Testing personnel)

                  Reference HCO B 19 Dec 71, C/S Series 71,
                          "D of P Operates by OCAs"

                       HCO B 24 Feb 72, C/S Series 71
                                 Additional



    WORD CLEARING ANY WORDS ON ANY TEST AT ANY TIME IS A HIGH CRIME.


    It suppresses tech results and obscures them.


    The whole of HCO B 24 Feb 72, C/S Series 71A, explains  fully  why  one
never word clears tests or even  tells  a  person  being  tested  to  use  a
dictionary.


                          FOREIGN LANGUAGE PERSONS

    When testing persons who speak a different language than that in  which
the test is written, GET A TRANSLATED TEST INTO THEIR LANGUAGE OR  TRANSLATE
THE TEST WITHOUT ANY WORD CLEARING.


                               MIS Us ON TESTS

    Where a person has a misunderstood word on a test, it  usually  remains
misunderstood on the second test. Thus the test  remains  VALID  as  nothing
has changed in it.


    If the person's IQ rises during processing he may very well also figure
out the misunderstood word now on the second test  and  improve  the  graph.
But that is a valid  PROCESSING  result,  not  a  false  one  introduced  by
clearing test words.


                                   SUMMARY

    Auditing works when properly done and it does not need a side action of
word clearing a test to better the graph.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH:ne.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 31 AUGUST 1971
                                   REVISED
Remimeo



                          Word Clearing Series 16 R



                               CONFUSED IDEAS



    Whenever a person has a confused idea of something or believes there is
some conflict of ideas IT IS ALWAYS TRUE THAT A  MISUNDERSTOOD  WORD  EXISTS
AT THE BOTTOM OF THAT CONFUSION.


    Example: "I just don't understand this idea of opposing forces. I think
it all ought to be rewritten and ...."


    Method 2 Word Clearer: "Is there any word there you don't  understand?"
READ! STUDENT: "Oh no, I understand all the words. It's ...." "What word  is
this that's reading on the meter?" "Er. . . ah . .  .  Forces?"  "Yes,  that
reads and blows down. Let's look it up." "Oh no, I know what it means.  It's
the idea that ...." "Let's look it up!" "Well, all right. Let's see D . .  .
E . . . F . . . FO . . . FORCES. Here it is. 'That which changes the  motion
of a body on which it acts.' " WD CLEARER: ''Use it in  a  sentence  several
times.'' Student does. ". . . er . . . ah. I've got it. Hell  I  thought  it
meant police brutality! Couldn't figure out  why  two  police  forces  would
fight!" Word Clearer: "Now how do you  feel  about  this  idea  of  opposing
forces?" "Oh, let's see. Why that's clear enough. Just like I'd  never  read
it before!" METER: F/N.


    Every green body of  students  will  argue  and  fuss  about  ideas  or
confusions in the directions or material they are given to read.


    They will generate weird ideas and erroneous concepts of what the  text
says. They do wrong things and say the text said to. They ask strange  ideas
of their instructors. They clamor for "clarifications".


    AND AT THE BOTTOM OF ALL THIS IS SIMPLY MISUNDERSTOOD WORDS.


    There is not also misunderstood ideas. There is only the  misunderstood
word which breeds, then, huge towering wrong ideas.


    A MISUNDERSTOOD WORD BREEDS STRANGE IDEAS.
                                    [pic]




             Picture of A
          Students Mind






                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             FOUNDER


LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1971
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 2 SEPTEMBER 1971
Remimeo
                           Word Clearing Series 17

                               WORDS AND POSTS


    Those who do not want their posts generally  do  not  know  what  their
posts are.


    The reason they do  not  know  what  their  posts  are  is  a  host  of
misunderstood basic words connected with that post.


    Put a person on a meter: Have the person  read  some  of  the  material
relating to his post or hat, beginning with the most  basic  material  about
it and starting at the very top  of  the  first  page,  including  even  the
heading and issue numbers.


    Watch the meter carefully.


    Halt the person at each read and whether he says he knows  the  meaning
or not, if it read, have him look it up in a good (big) dictionary.


    Have him use the word in sentences of his own invention.  Make  him  do
this as long as it is bringing the TA down. If you  get  into  trouble  with
him go back and find the misunderstood you missed.


    Keep hunting and keep working at it and his  misunderstood  words  will
blow and his inability to understand the post will blow.

                                 EXPLANATION

    Failed posts and duties trace back to misunderstood  words.  Until  you
see it you won't believe it.


    One student who had studied his post for a third of a  year  was  given
Method 2 on its materials.


    It took 15 hours of Method 2 work, protests, blows, upsets  to  finally
discover that he did not know what POST meant! OR  what  the  words  in  the
title meant.


    Another person studied half a year to be an administrator. Yet when  he
was given his personnel orders appointing him, and  Method  2  was  done  on
them, in the first 50 words of the personnel order there were 13  individual
misunderstood words each one of which related to the post  and  were  simple
English. A similar ratio continued throughout the personnel order.


    He  was  about  to  fail  with  a  fanfare.  Behind  post  failure  the
explanation IS misunderstood words.


    Psychosis (evil intention) is the only other  reason  for  failure  but
even this can be handled by auditing today. And even psychosis lessens  when
misunderstood words are handled.


                                  SUCCESSES

    It is not difficult to use Method 2 Word Clearing.


    One must be able to handle ARC Breaks, Problems and withholds and  read
a meter.


    One must have a very big dictionary available when little ones fail.


    One must be persistent and not buy explanations or let the  person  run
away.


    And the Successes one has are fantastic!


LRH:sb.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
copyright � 1971 Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              4 SEPTEMBER 1971R
                                   Issue I
                 Revised & Reissued 21 November 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
Tech & Qual HCO BULLETIN OF 4 SEPTEMBER 1971
Supers      Issue I
Super Courses    SAME TITLE
Cramming Off
Word Clearers
                       (Revisions in this type style)


                          Word Clearing Series 18R

                           FAULTS IN WORD CLEARING
                                COMMONLY MET


    Word Clearing is a tremendously successful  and  simple  activity  when
done correctly.


    The following faults have  been  isolated  and  are  listed  to  assist
students and Supervisors to increase their successes with Word Clearing.

1.    METHOD NO. 2: A WORD READS. STUDENT SAYS HE KNOWS THE MEANING  OF  THE
    WORD AND WORD CLEARER DOES NOT TAKE IT UP.

      When a word is isolated as having read always get all its  definitions
     defined with the dictionary and used in several sentences.

2.    METHODS NO. 2 & NO. 3: ASKING THE STUDENT  FOR  THE  MEANING  OF  WORD
    FOUND.

      Always get it defined with the dictionary.

3.    ALL METERED METHODS: PUTTING THE STUDENT  ON  CANS  AND  STARTING  HIM
    READING BEFORE TA HAS SETTLED. LOSES EARLY READS BY ADJUSTING TA.

4.    ALL METERED METHODS: NOT CONTINUING TO USE A WORD  IN  SENTENCES  WHEN
    DOING SO IS BRINGING THE TA DOWN.

5.    ALL METERED METHODS: NOT HAVING STUDENT ON CANS TO INTERROGATE HIM  AS
    TO WHICH TEXT MUST BE LOCATED TO WORD CLEAR.

6.    ALL METERED METHODS: NOT USING SUFFICIENT 2WC  TO  LOCATE  THE  BOGGED
    AREA.

7.    ALL METERED METHODS: WORD CLEARER CALLING WORD TO METER TO  CHECK  "IF
    IT READ OR NOT".

8.    ALL METERED METHODS: TELLING STUDENT "THAT WORD READ".

9 .   ALL METHODS: ABANDONING A WORD.

      If  it's not in your dictionary, get another or get the reference  for
    the word from the Supervisor. Never leave it and try to carry on.

10.   ALL METERED METHODS: ALLOWING STUDENT OFF THE CANS TO LOOK UP WORDS.

11.   ALL METHODS: NOT ASKING A STUDENT WHO STILL DOESN'T  COMPREHEND  AFTER
    READING DICTIONARY, WHAT  WORD  IN  THE  DEFINITION  HE  DOESN'T  FULLY
    UNDERSTAND.

      If that doesn't handle, go back to the word just cleared and  pick  up
    any by-passed definition. Clear it up with dictionary  definition,  use
    in sentences and come back to original word.
    12.     ALL METHODS: USING OR ACCEPTING "WAITING FOR A METHOD NO. 1" AS
    AN EXCUSE NOT TO STUDY OR TO DO WORD CLEARING.

13.   ALL METHODS: ALLOWING EXCESSIVE ITSA OR TALK.

      Note: Don't cut cognitions that occur after clearing a word.

14.   METHODS 2, 3, 4, 7,  9:  NOT  OBSERVING  WHEN  YOU  HAVE  HANDLED  THE
    CURRENT DIFFICULTY (AND ENDING OFF).

15.   ALL METHODS: NOT GOING EARLIER ON SOMEONE WHO IS  "ALWAYS  LOOKING  UP
    THAT WORD".

      Find an earlier time on the course he encountered that word. Have  him
    read just prior to it. Clear the word found. You should now be able  to
    terminatedly clear the troublesome word in the usual way.

16. ALL METERED METHODS: NOT REPORTING TO THE C/S ANY CASES WHOSE  TA'S  ARE
    HIGH AND DON'T COME DOWN OR WHOSE TA'S ARE BELOW 2.0 OR WHO ROCK SLAM.

17.   METHODS 2-9: ABANDONING WORD CLEARING BECAUSE "HE NEEDS A  METHOD  NO.
    1".

18.   ALL METERED METHODS: NOT TAKING EVERY WORD TO F/N.

19.   ALL METHODS: NOT RECOGNIZING WHEN A  PERSON  NEEDS  A  WCCL  AND  WORD
    CLEARING OVER THE TROUBLE.

    Every student and  staff  member  should  get  a  Method  1.  They  are
different techniques and "needing a Method No. 1 " is no  justification  for
rabbiting on a student on Method 2 or other methods.


    Once you have begun a Method No. 2 you do not ever abandon it until you
have found a word that considerably brightens up the student.

                       CRAMMING OFFICERS & SUPERVISORS

    Cramming Officers are of course experts in  Word  Clearing  and  should
have a meter permanently set up-though most Word Clearing  for  Cramming  is
done by Qual Word Clearers.


    In  handling  misunderstoods  as  a  Supervisor  or  Cramming  Officer,
particular note should be given to HCO PL 24 Oct 19-68,  "Tips  in  Handling
Students" and BTB 22 April 1971, "Cramming". Their points can and should  be
used in Word Clearing.


    Last but not least

20.   ALL METHODS: NOT KNOWING COLD, THE STUDY TAPES.


                                        Flag Word Clearer

                                        Revised by CS-5
                                        Ens. Judy Ziff

                                        In co-ordination with
                                        Flag Mission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues for the

      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:RH:mh.rd  of the
Copyright � 1971, 1974 CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 4 SEPTEMBER 1971
                                  Issue II
Remimeo

                           Word Clearing Series 19

                                 ALTERATIONS


    There is a basic law in Word Clearing:


                 AT THE BOTTOM OF ALL ALTERATION OF MEANING
                     OR ACTION IS A MISUNDERSTOOD WORD.


    This law at once  explains  why  communication,  ideas  or  application
become falsified, twisted and corrupted.


    This law is of great use in Word Clearing:


    A.      It indicates who has to be word cleared  FAST,  at  once,  NOW,
before duties go off the rails any further.


    B.      It detects the area just before which there is a  misunderstood
word.


    A is useful to the administrator. Knowing it and knowing Word  Clearing
and being able to do it himself or get  it  done,  he  can  avoid  wholesale
dismissals,  frantic  transfers,  general  inefficiency  and  organizational
strain.


    B is very useful to the Word Clearer.


    Example of B. A person can do everything on an order except  "File  the
Folder's" which he insists on delivering to a  wrong  room.  Look  over  the
order and find where in it talks about filing folders. Just above or  beside
that will be a misunderstood word. Locate it,  get  it  identified,  defined
and used in sentences. The person can suddenly file folders!


    Just BEFORE or WITH the point a person begins to alter will be found  a
misunderstood word.

    Thus

    1.      Discover what a person alters.
    2.      Find what came just before that.
    3.      Find the misunderstood word.
    4.      Get it looked up.
    5.      Get it used in sentences as long as it moves a meter tone arm.
    6.      End off on F/N VGIs.

    The ability to do it straight will have been returned.


    It is very magical.


LRH:sb.rt   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1971 Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 4 SEPTEMBER 1971
                                  Issue III
Remimeo


                           Word Clearing Series 20


                                SIMPLE WORDS


    You might suppose at once that it is the BIG  words  or  the  technical
words which are most misunderstood.


    This is NOT the case.


    On actual test, it was English  simple  words  and  NOT  Dianetics  and
Scientology words which prevented understanding.


    For some reason Dianetics and Scientology words are more easily grasped
than simple English.


    Words like "a", "the", "exist",  "such"  and  other  "everybody  knows"
words show up with great frequency when doing  a  Method  2  Word  Clearing.
They read.


    It takes a BIG dictionary to define these simple words fully.  This  is
another oddity. The small dictionaries also suppose everybody knows.


    It is almost incredible to see that  a  university  graduate  has  gone
through years and years of study of complex subjects and yet does  not  know
what "or" or "by" or "an" means. It has to be seen to be believed. Yet  when
cleaned up his whole education turns from a solid mass of question marks  to
a clean useful view.


    A test of schoolchildren in Johannesburg once showed that  Intelligence
DECREASED with each new year of school!


    The answer to the puzzle was simply that each year  they  added  a  few
dozen more crushing misunderstood words onto an already confused  vocabulary
that no one ever got them to look up.


    Stupidity is the effect of misunderstood words.


    In those areas which give Man the most trouble you will find  the  most
alteration of fact, the most confused and conflicting ideas  and  of  course
the greatest number of misunderstood words. Take "economics" for example.


    The subject of psychology began its texts by saying they did  not  know
what the word means. So the subject itself never  arrived.  Professor  Wundt
of Leipzig University in 1879 perverted the term. It really  means  just  "a
study (ology) of the soul (psyche)". But Wundt, working  under  the  eye  of
Bismarck, the greatest of German military fascists, at the height of  German
war ambitions, had to deny Man had a soul. So there went the whole  subject!
Men were thereafter animals (it is all right to kill animals)  and  Man  had
no soul, so the word psychology could no longer be defined.


    THE EARLIEST MISUNDERSTOOD  WORD  IN  A  SUBJECT  IS  A  KEY  TO  LATER
MISUNDERSTOOD WORDS IN THAT SUBJECT.


    "HCO B" (Hubbard Communications Office Bulletin), "Remimeo" (Orgs which
receive this must mimeograph it again and  distribute  it  to  staff),  "TR"
(Training Drill),
"Issue I" (first issue of that  date),  are  the  commonest  misunderstoods.
Because they occur at the beginning of an HCO B!


    Then come words like "a", "the" and other simple English  as  the  next
words that often read.


    In studying a foreign language it is often found that the grammar words
of one's own language that tell about the grammar in  the  foreign  language
are basic to not being able to learn the foreign language.


    The test of whether the person understands a word is "does it  read  on
the meter as a fall when he reads the word in the material being cleared".


    That a person says  he knows the meaning is not  acceptable.  Have  him
look it up no matter how simple the word is.



                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH:sb.rd
Copyright � 1971
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 6 SEPTEMBER 1971
Remimeo


                           Word Clearing Series 21


                              CORRECT SEQUENCE
                       QUALIFICATIONS OF WORD CLEARERS


    The principal methods of word clearing are numbered No. 1 for the  full
in-session rundown, No. 2 for the metered action of  clearing  up  words  in
specific materials and No. 3 for looking up words seen  and  not  understood
by the student or reader.


    This is correct sequence for doing the three types of word clearing.


    By doing No. 1 in full session, using  the  list  for  assessment,  one
obtains the basic word and meaning errors of the past. By getting these  out
of the way, it is now possible to  clean  up  current  materials  much  more
rapidly with Method 2, where the person is put on  a  meter  and  reads  the
material to another who is watching the meter and catching each read.


    With Method I out of the way, Method 2 becomes more rapid.


    Method 3 will then be done by the person himself because he  now  knows
better.


    No. 2 and No. 3 can be used on and on one or the other.


    If you do it backwards, beginning with Method No. 3, much more time  is
consumed. If Method No. 2 is used without No. I being done, much  more  work
has to be done to clean up an existing piece of study material or text.


    So the correct sequence is No. 1, No. 2 and then No. 3.


    This does not mean you cannot start with No. 3 or No. 2. It just  means
it is much faster to do them in correct sequence.

                              PURPOSE CLEARING

    When purpose of the post is to be cleared it is done after Method No. 1
in general and Method No. 2 has been done on the duties  and  texts  of  the
post.


    With all such material handled with word clearing it is time then to do
a Purpose Clearing of the person's job or situation in life.

                                   PROGRAM

    Thus a general program could be laid down as

    1.      Handle all ARC Breaks, present time problems and withholds,  or
        set up the case with a Progress Program.


    2.      Method No. 1 Word Clearing.


    3.      Method No. 2 Word Clearing  on  the  materials  or  duties  the
        person has.


    4.      Purpose Clearing of the purpose of the post.
(In choosing the materials to be cleared in No. 3 above  choose  the  texts,
handbooks or materials most closely related to the post and  most  basic  to
the post.)


    (In choosing the post, if the person  is  not  employed  remember  that
"student", "housewife" and even "a human being" are posts.)

                           WD CLEARING WD CLEARERS

    When there is no qualified word  clearer  to  word  clear  others,  the
program is changed for the word clearer to:

    1.      Choose 2 word clearers who then work on each other.


    2.      Any Progress Program for each one.


    3.      Word Clear the Word Clearing Series by Method 2.


    4.      Check out on the auditing required for Method 1.


    5.      Do Method No. 1 on each other.


    6.      Do Purpose Clearing on each other.


    This greatly reduces any errors in application.


    (Note: A "Progress Program" or a  "Repair  Program"  is  a  Scientology
auditing program to clean up upsets in life.)


    ("ARC Break" means A-Affinity, R-Reality, C-Communication, a  break  in
any one of the three which has caused upset in the past.)


    (A Class III Academy Auditor qualification is required to do Method No.
I as the action requires assessing and the handling of ARC Breaks,  problems
and withholds, for which a Class III is  trained.  Anyone  who  is  able  to
handle a meter is qualified to do Method No. 2. Any  person  can  do  Method
No. 3.)


    (Purpose Clearing also requires a Class III Academy Auditor.)


    (By "meter" throughout this series is meant an "E-Meter" which means an
"electro-psychometer", an instrument which measures  emotional  reaction  by
tiny electrical impulses generated by thought.)


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder




LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1971
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              4 SEPTEMBER 1971R
                          Revised 15 December 1973
                        Reissued 20 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 4 SEPTEMBER 1971R
                                 SAME TITLE

                          Word Clearing Series 22R

                           HOW TO USE A DICTIONARY

    YOU USE A DICTIONARY when Word  Clearing.  The  misunderstood  word  is
looked up in the dictionary and the meaning read out loud and they tell  you
what the word means so that they know it  WITHOUT  AGAIN  REFERRING  TO  THE
DICTIONARY. Then the  word  is  used  in  several  sentences  which  clearly
indicate that it consults their understanding.


    WORDS SOMETIMES HAVE DIFFERENT OR MORE THAN ONE MEANING.  YOU  HAVE  TO
KNOW EVERY DIFFERENT MEANING SO ALL DEFINITIONS ARE LOOKED UP AND  THE  WORD
IS FULLY DEFINED. YOU  ALSO  MUST  CHOOSE  THE  DEFINITION  IN  USE  IN  THE
SENTENCE SO THAT THE MATERIALS ARE UNDERSTOOD.

                                THE ALPHABET

    Knowledge of the alphabet is the key  to  finding  words  quickly.  The
alphabet must be known cold. The Word Clearer who has to  figure  out  which
letter comes first, M or N or U or V, wastes  many  precious  minutes  which
add up to many wasted hours.


    Words are arranged in alphabetical order in all dictionaries. All words
beginning with the letter A  would  be  in  the  first  section,  all  words
beginning with the letter B in the second section, and so on.  Within  these
sections the words themselves are arranged so that  each  second  letter  in
the word is in alphabetical order. (For example, the word fall precedes  the
word few, which precedes the word field, etc.)


    Near the top of each page, printed in bold type, are the first word and
the last word on the  page  (in  very  large  dictionaries  it's  every  two
columns). You can use this  as  a  guide  to  quickly  find  the  page  that
contains the word you are looking for.

                           HOW TO BREAK UP A WORD

    Many words are in a combined form and by separating the  word  you  can
look up each part in the dictionary. By doing this, the meaning of the  word
often becomes clearer. Take the word Theo-logy. The first part, Theo-  means
god or gods and the second part  of  the  word,  -logy  means  discourse  or
expression or the science, theory or study of. When you put  the  two  parts
together, you have the  science,  theory  or  study  of  god.  Sometimes  in
combining forms of words, a letter is changed, as in the word  in-dividu(e)-
ate.

                       LOOK UP WORDS IN THE DEFINITION

    Many times when looking up a word, you  will  find  in  its  definition
other words which need to be looked up in order to  understand  the  meaning
of the original word. Therefore, each word  given  in  the  definition  must
also be clearly defined and understood  so  that  there  are  no  underlying
misunderstood  words  on  the  word  you  are  looking  up.  Large   child's
dictionaries are good as the definition words are simple.


The so-called "Merriam Webster" dictionaries in the U.S. are almost  useless
and give out  more  misunderstoods  in  definitions  than  they  clarify  in
clearing, don't bother with
them.  The  World  Book  Dictionary   available   from   Field   Enterprises
Educational Corporation, Merchandise Mart Plaza, Chicago,  Illinois,  60654,
U.S.A. is a huge and very good  child's  dictionary.  In  the  U.K.  the  18
volume Oxford series are good.

                         USE A BIG ENOUGH DICTIONARY

    The smaller dictionaries (paperback or junior) seldom contain  complete
definitions of a word. Sometimes a  most  vital  part  of  a  definition  is
omitted. This can involve running around to look for another  dictionary  or
missing  the  real  meaning  of  the  word.  So  always  use  a  big  enough
dictionary.

                       GET THE WORD USED IN SENTENCES

                            AS LONG AS IT HAS TA

    The word, when it reads  on  the  meter,  is  used  over  and  over  in
sentences until it has no more TA. It doesn't matter if the word was  looked
up  in  the  dictionary  as  the  word  will  still  read  if  the  word  is
misunderstood.


    The dictionary usually has several  examples  of  use.  These  are  not
enough. The person has to make up several of his own before he really  knows
the word.

       WORDS OF A SPECIAL TECH REQUIRE A DICTIONARY OF IT IF POSSIBLE.

    Many students have been or are engaged in technical professions outside
of Scientology such  as  engineering,  computer  programming,  architecture,
etc, and you will need a glossary or dictionary of  the  terms  involved  in
these technologies.


    When Word Clearing someone on his post hat aboard  the  Flagship  or  a
stationship you would need a nautical dictionary.

             BACK TRACK WORDS-GET THE EARLIER MISUNDERSTOOD WORD

    Very often you will get a word off the track and you won't find  it  in
any dictionary or  glossary  on  this  planet.  You  must  get  the  earlier
misunderstood word until you get the basic word that was misunderstood.

               FOREIGN WORDS-GET A DICTIONARY OF THAT LANGUAGE

    There are  two  kinds  of  foreign  language  dictionaries.  One  is  a
dictionary  entirely  in  the   foreign   language.   The   other   is   the
English/Foreign language dictionary, in which one half of the dictionary  is
English words with the foreign word next to it, and the other  half  is  the
foreign word with its English counterpart next to it. You would use the  all
foreign dictionary only with a person who knew that language fluently.

    YOU USE A DICTIONARY. IT  IS  ALWAYS  A  MISUNDERSTOOD  WORD,  NEVER  A
CONCEPT OR IDEA.


      Revised by
      W/O Ron Shafran
      Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234
      I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow
      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
BDCS SW:AL MH RS:mh.jh CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
Copyright � 1971, 1973, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 13 SEPTEMBER 1971
Remimeo

                           Word Clearing Series 23

                              TROUBLE SHOOTING


    In Word Clearing the troubles are actually very few.


    However there are a few.


    It is possible for an auditor or student doing word clearing on another
to get misunderstood words himself unless he also looks at  the  definitions
and understands them at the same time he  is  clearing  them  on  the  other
person. This requires no extra step. In fact it would be rather hard not  to
also see the definition of the word.


    A person trying to "blow" (leave) and refusing  further  Word  Clearing
almost always has a HUGE misunderstood on some word  not  yet  located.  The
correct action is to get him back and FIND AND CLEAR THE WORD.


    Not getting a good result using Methods 1, 2 or 3 is cured by using the
Word Clearing Correction List, HCO B 21 July 71, Revised 9 August 71.


    This Correction List applies to all methods of word clearing.


    For instance, if Method 2 goes sour and the student "knew all the words
anyway"  or  "doesn't  understand  it  any  better"  or   is   critical   or
demonstrates any other unfavorable  reactions  which  do  not  win  through,
there is always Word Clearing Correction List.


    This list is done by  a  Class  III  or  above  auditor.  It  is  quite
miraculous.


    Example: Student badly bogged after Method 2 by his twin.  Handling:  A
Class III auditor does the Word Clearing Correction List on him.


    The  Correction  List  is  handled  as  per  HCO  B  14  Mar  71,  "F/N
Everything". In other words, one takes all reads on it to  Floating  Needle.
Any other list called for by reads on the Correction List is  taken  to  F/N
and when that  called-for  list  F/Ns  then  one  considers  that  the  Word
Clearing Correction List line has F/Ned. (Correction List reads on  4.  List
Error. The auditor takes a list called L4B which corrects  lists  and  makes
every read on "L4B" F/N. Then "4. List Error" is marked "F/N".)


    The technology of handling a  Word  Clearing  Correction  List  is  all
covered in the general materials of auditing.


    Not knowing how to use a Meter can cause trouble.


    A special Course in using an E-Meter is available.  The  E-Meter  Drill
Book gives all the drills. It does not take long  to  learn.  Also  E-Meters
are abundantly available today.


    Learning to be a Class III or preferably a Class IV Academy Auditor  is
not difficult IF one uses word clearing!


    All word clearing is done under the discipline of The Auditor's Code.


    One's "TRs" (TR = Training drills for auditing) can be straightened out
on a TR Course on which one learns to confront,  to  speak  so  one  can  be
heard, to  acknowledge,  to  be  able  to  repeat  commands  and  to  handle
originations by the student.
Troubles in word clearing, then  can  be  listed  as  coming  from  lack  of
training. So anyone doing word clearing should organize himself to (I) Do  a
TR Course, (2) Learn to use and acquire an E-Meter, (3) Learn the  Auditor's
Code and, (4) If not one already, learn to be an Academy Class III Auditor.


    Knowing how to do 1 to 3  above  is  essential  to  do  Method  2  Word
Clearing. And the skills  under  (1)  to  (3)  are  very  easy  to  acquire.
Further, it is not all that difficult to become a Class III Auditor.


    People sometimes think only someone who  wants  to  be  a  professional
auditor studies in the Academy, a false impression. One can't imagine how  a
father or businessman or mother or clerk or official could  succeed  without
knowing the basics of human reaction and how to handle them. Someone who  is
a Class III or Class IV knows how. The real professional usually  becomes  a
Class VI and the real experts are the VIIIs, IXs and Xs. It's  a  matter  of
how expert you want to be. A Flag Ship Class XII could turn a severe  mental
case from raving lunacy to not only sane but bright and normal  in  about  8
or 9 hours and a normal person to a genius in 15 to 20 hours.


    But here we are dealing with the whole range of the human mind.


    In word clearing Method 2 one certainly  should  know  his  "TRs",  his
Auditor's Code and his Meter. And for Method I it takes a Class III  Academy
Auditor.


    Almost all troubles will be found to stem from  an  omission  of  these
requirements AND not using Word Clearing on the materials  one  is  studying
to achieve these skills.


    Very few troubles actually  will  be  encountered  if  this  HCO  B  is
followed.


    Word Clearing IS a precision technology and there IS something to  know
about it as it has never before been known.



                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder




LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1971
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 17 SEPTEMBER 1971
Remimeo

                           Word Clearing Series 24

                                   LIBRARY


    You will begin to get an idea of how much library you  will  need  when
you have done a large number of word clearings.


    The important thing is to realize that a library is necessary.


    In an org this will be in Department 14 under the Librarian.


    The greatest demand will be for dictionaries of many kinds.


    First there is the consideration of just English dictionaries. Several,
including large ones, should be to hand. Those that use big words to  define
words  keep  a  pc  chasing  around  and  around  and  are  of  course  poor
dictionaries. Often one dictionary gives a better definition  than  another.
So an assortment of English dictionaries is a first requirement.


    Then come technical dictionaries or texts  like  engineering,  physics,
medical, chemistry, mechanics, seamanship,  aviation,  astronomy,  military,
etc, etc.


    Then come philosophical, psychiatric and religious dictionaries if they
can be found.


    Foreign language dictionaries Latin, Greek, French, etc are a must.


    An auditor doing  word  clearing  can  come  up  with  some  remarkable
demands.


    Texts or dictionaries covering the subject given on the assessment list
(Word Clearing Series 8RR) are a basic starter.


    I can see a word clearing auditor poking about in old mouldy  bookshops
and coming up with triumph-"Ah, look! Priceless. A slang dictionary  on  oil
fields published in 1932! Priceless!"


    If you get too stopped and are in a  major  city,  you  could  end  the
session and send the pc to the local library. But if so have him  write  the
definition down. It is not recommended but can be done.


    The best solution is to have  a  good  library  covering  the  assessed
subjects.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder






LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1971
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 10 NOVEMBER 1971R
                          REVISED 21 SEPTEMBER 1974
Remimeo
                                   URGENT


                          Word Clearing Series 25R
                            Tape Course Series 6R


                              TAPES, HOW TO USE

                     (Reissued 23 November 1971 verbatim
                additionally as a Tape Course Series HCO B.)


                                  FOREWORD

    The most appalling  ignorance  has  existed  on  the  use  of  magnetic
recording tapes.


    It is therefore of the greatest possible importance that the subject of
tape use be grasped and gotten rapidly into effect.


    Probably half the technology of admin and tech exists only on tape.


    Tapes, incorrectly used, can be the source of  endless  misunderstoods.
Because tapes  have  been  almost  uniformly  misused  in  the  past,  these
misunderstoods have added up to a general misunderstood on  the  subject  of
tapes themselves.


    Students have been known to copy down the  whole  tape  so  they  could
study it. This is a complete waste of  time  and  misuse  of  student  study
hours.


    Some orgs even played advanced study tapes to the public.


    European orgs have even played translation quality tapes  (usually  not
auditorium quality) of OEC Volumes as raw public lectures! (And  lost  their
audience through lack of quality and inaudible and strange words.)


    Casual staff briefing tapes, not okay for release, of very bad quality,
have been played to staffs of other orgs and the public.


    There is no end to the abuses.


    Therefore, for the benefit of understanding words alone,  it  is  VITAL
that tapes be properly used and not abused.


                               TYPES OF TAPES

    There are four classes of tapes. These are:


        1.       Course study tapes.


        2.       Public lecture tapes.


        3.       Briefing tapes.


        4.       Model performance tapes.
                             COURSE STUDY TAPES

    Tapes made for courses are of two varieties:

        (a)      English, usually by LRH.


        (b)      Translations, done by translators.

    They are FOR COURSE USE. This is what the org sells-training on Tech or
Admin.


    These tapes appear on  checksheets  and  are  done  at  the  points  of
checksheets where they are called for, and are done by Method  2  for  tapes
or Method 3 for tapes as required.


    The foreign  language  tape  courses  are  done  from  a  special  tape
checksheet and are done exactly as laid down by Method 2 or Method 3.


    None of these tapes are  all  written  out  by  the  student  and  then
studied. This is a waste of time.


    Further, such tapes are NOT played straight through  with  the  student
making notes of any misunderstood words "to look up later". This will  blank
out the tape content on the student's mind and knock out the student.


    So to play a course tape straight through to any student is to cause  a
stupidity and a blow. It also  does not matter  whether  the  student  takes
notes of misunderstoods or  not.  A  COURSE  TAPE  IS  NOT  PLAYED  STRAIGHT
THROUGH. Only the earphone,  footpedal  start-stop  control  procedures  are
used.


    A course tape is NEVER PLAYED TO A GROUP OF STUDENTS.  When  played  to
more than one student, some student is going  to  get  a  misunderstood  and
there goes a blank student.


    Two students don't even listen to a tape even on  Method  2  Tape  Word
Clearing! One has the meter and footpedal and the other the  earphones.  The
word clearer stops at each read. He does not otherwise listen.


    Course tape quality must be good. All the words must  be  hearable  and
not inaudible. They must not be slurred or hard to make out.


    The earphones and tape player used must be high fidelity just  any  old
earphones won't do.


    The tape player "playing head" across which the  tape  passes  must  be
clean-done by a cotton swab on a toothpick  and  cleaning  fluid.  The  tape
coating comes off on the playing head and after a time the  sound  is  badly
blurred.


    Using a course tape any other way is now FORBIDDEN.  Tests  have  shown
that violations of this are the reason for student failures  and  blows  and
out-Ethics.


    It goes without saying that the general handling of  tape  players  and
tapes  must  be  well  learned  and  practiced  by  Course  Supervisors  and
students.


                            PUBLIC LECTURE TAPES

    The  probable  reason  stats  fall  after  tape   congresses   is   the
misunderstood word.


    Congresses seldom use really high  fidelity  equipment.  Further,  tape
copying is often done by outside firms and the tape  copies  themselves  may
be of poor quality. The combination is deadly.
We looked for the reason for stat drops after tape congresses  and  this  is
the only explanation which has come forth.


    Doingness  congresses  that  are  mainly  seminars   have   been   very
successful. (By doingness is meant TRs-training drills-and  other  ACTIONS.)
The relay of data to a public whose vocabulary is usually inadequate is  not
likely to win, as it hits their faulty vocabulary for  one  thing  and  uses
new words for another. You can show somebody how to  do  things  far  better
than you can tell him.


    This then extends into Div 6 Introductory Actions as well. The relay of
data comes AFTER the demonstration in action terms.


    The possibility of possible bad playing  speakers,  possible  low  tape
copy quality, the barriers of languages not learned in the first  place  and
the introduction of new mental concepts combine into  a  hurdle  that  makes
tape or film public presentation adventurous.


    Listening to public type tapes,  by  using  footpedal  start-stop  tape
players, is being put in a special public course category.


    Raw public tape and film presentations are however a must to  keep  the
flavor and  meaning  of  Dianetics  and  Scientology.  So  ensure  excellent
quality tapes and equipment are used with correct tapes for that public  and
you will have success.


                               BRIEFING TAPES

    These are not to be confused with Special Briefing Course Tapes.


    A briefing tape is done to brief or debrief missionaires or to record a
conference or to record special instructions to a person or  group.  It  can
then be used for reference or to settle any dispute. It can also be used  to
inform a staff or several staffs.


    A briefing tape is then a tape designed  for  a  special  and  informed
audience.


    If the tape quality is good and the audience is already a  familiar  or
trained audience, a briefing tape can be played ONLY  TO  THE  AUDIENCE  FOR
WHICH IT WAS INTENDED.


    To do otherwise is to risk misunderstood words and non-comprehension of
what it is all about in general.


    "Ron's Journals" were staff briefing tapes. They began to be  used  for
public. While they were not without  success,  one  could  no  longer  brief
staffs on this line and the line was therefore cut. One could not make  them
with a security that they would be played to staffs.


    An isolated briefing to a single executive on  "these  are  our  future
hopes" has been thereafter used as a staff briefing of many orgs  as  "these
are your orders".


    Any tape is designed for a specific public.


    Briefing tapes are especially subject to abuse by being played to wrong
publics.


    Any briefing tape which contains specific orders and plans which  could
be misunderstood should be played only to the individuals concerned  with  a
stop-start footpedal  and  Method  3  Word  Clearing,  not  going  past  any
misunderstood.


    After a person has been briefed verbally, it is very revelatory to then
Word Clear 2 the tape made at the same time. It will  often  be  found  that
misunderstood words lead to potential alter-is in the actions required.


    Tape in this instance is an enormous help in assisting  and  clarifying
briefings.


    A group can be briefed if thereafter each is Word Cleared Method 3 or 2
on the tape afterwards, using standard tape word clearing.


    Needless to say such tapes must be of good quality.


                           MODEL PERFORMANCE TAPES

    Tapes exist which give a standard of performance.


    In Dianetic and Scientology Auditing student auditors have  never  been
known to achieve a high standard of session presence and Communication  (and
accordingly high results)  without  the  careful  study  of  tapes  made  of
similar sessions by high level auditors.


    A student musician is  unlikely  to  achieve  professional  performance
level unless he has heard a professional play.


    It would take a film  or  live  demonstration  to  communicate  a  high
standard of performance  in  a  purely  action  subject.  For  instance  for
centuries no one believed that Robin  Hood  could  split  his  first  target
arrow with a second until a new generation worked on it and a few  painfully
recovered the lost art of archery and then demonstrated how it was done  for
others to see.


    Tapes and films serve a vital  purpose  in  maintaining  a  performance
standard.


    As these tapes and films show HOW it is done  and  the  ATMOSPHERE  and
RHYTHM of ACTION they are not subject to word clearing.




                                 CONCLUSION

    Tape and film training is vital, valuable and has its role.


    But like showing a child how to open a book and read,  there  is  exact
technology in USING tapes and films.


    The first thing one must realize is that the use of tape  and  film  is
itself a technical subject that must be studied and learned.  One  does  not
naturally know it.


    The failures of universities to make  educated  and  civilized  men  is
because their own professors know nothing  of  misunderstood  words  and  so
lectured happily on and on to a  snoring  student  body.  One  professor  of
physics used to open the classroom windows wide in freezing winter "to  keep
his students from going to sleep in  HIS  class".  And  then  stood  on  the
platform and defined nothing as he rambled on. All it did for his class  was
give them coughs between snores!


    The handling and use of tape and film in training and administration IS
a subject.


    By failing to know it and use that information, one can block the  road
for himself and all others to being learned and being free.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH:nt jh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                             26 NOVEMBER 1971 RA
Remimeo
All Tape    Revised & Reissued 17 August 1974 as BTB
Course      Revised 21 November 1974
Students
Translate   CANCELS
into the    BTB OF 26 NOVEMBER 1971
various     SAME TITLE
languages
Students
Supervisors
Word Clearers
                            Tape Course Series 8

                         Word Clearing Series 26 RA



                       HANDLING MISUNDERSTOOD WORDS ON
                           TAPE RECORDED MATERIALS


    Method 3 Word Clearing must be done routinely by any Course student. It
is done by the student himself and also by the Supervisor on his students.


                       METHOD 3 WORD CLEARING ON TAPES

1.    The tape machine and tape are  set  up  exactly  as  per  Tape  Course
    Series 7, BTB 25 Nov 71 R, Rev. 21 Nov 74, "Setting Up and Using a Tape
    Player".

2.    Whilst listening to the tape, if the student hears a word he does  not
    understand, he immediately stops the tape by means of  the  foot  pedal
    start-stop control.

3.    He writes the word down in his notebook and immediately looks  up  the
    word exactly per BTB 4 Sept 71R, Rev. 15 Dec 73, Word  Clearing  Series
    22R, "How to Use a Dictionary", clearing all definitions  and  any  not
    understood or misunderstood words in the definitions, and putting  each
    into sentences.

4.    Student then checks the tape for the exact use  of  the  word  in  the
    tape.

5.    Student then rewinds the tape to just before the  word  cleared  above
    and relistens to the section to ensure that it is understood.

6.    The student continues  listening  to  the  tape  until  he  encounters
    another word which he does not understand, at which point he  does  the
    actions outlined in 3, 4 and 5 above.

7.    If at any point the student becomes bored, feels  blank,  washed  out,
    not there, starts  yawning,  dopes  off  or  wants  to  blow,  he  must
    recognize that he has gone past a misunderstood word.

8.    The student must turn  the  tape  back  to  the  point  where  he  was
    interested and alert and check the section  just  after  that  for  the
    misunderstood word or words, and clear them according to steps 3, 4 and
    5.

9.    The student then rewinds the tape back  to  the  end  of  the  section
    where he felt fine and relistens  to  the  tape  from  that  point  on,
    picking up and clearing any other words found.
    10.     If the student  starts  to  feel  squashed,  gets  a  headache,
    stomach feels funny, gets dizzy from time to time,  or  eyes  start  to
    hurt, the student should locate the section on the tape where he had  a
    lack of mass, and either go and find the actual mass  under  discussion
    and feel and inspect it, if  possible,  or  find  a  photo  of  it,  or
    demonstrate the mass in clay with  labels,  or  use  his  demo  kit  to
    demonstrate the mass. The student should then relisten to the  rest  of
    the tape from that section on.

11. The Supervisor must be alert to the manifestations of lack of  mass  and
    misunderstood words and quickly see that the correct handling  is  done
    rapidly. If he does  not  handle,  he  will  shortly  end  up  with  no
    students.

12.   If a student cannot locate the  misunderstood  word  using  Method  3,
    either on his own or with the Supervisor, the Supervisor  should  apply
    Method 2 Word Clearing to that section of the tape  to  quickly  locate
    and handle the misunderstood words. If the student's TA is above 3.5 or
    below 2.0, end off and send the student to Qual for a C/S 53RI.

13.   A Supervisor should check students who have just completed a tape  and
    look tired or not there, by asking questions about  the  tape.  If  the
    student  cannot  answer  or  gives  a  wrong  or  altered  answer,  the
    Supervisor should make the student go back and relisten to the tape and
    find and clear the misunderstood words.

    The above procedure is very simple and  the  essential  ingredients  to
have F/Ning students who know and can apply their materials.


                                                   Revised by CS-5
                                                   Ens. Judy Ziff

                                                   In co-ordination with
                                                   FlagMission 1234

                                                   I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                                   2nd: Molly Harlow

                                                   Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:Bofl:AL:MH:JZ:BW:DM:mh.rd
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              27 NOVEMBER 1971R
                 Revised & Reissued 21 November 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                      HCO BULLETIN OF 27 NOVEMBER 1971
                                 SAME TITLE

                            Tape Course Series 9

                          Word Clearing Series 27R

                       METHOD 2 WORD CLEARING ON TAPES
                              AND TAPE COURSES


    Method 2 Word Clearing is  done  on  the  student  by  another  student
trained to do so or the Supervisor or a Word Clearer.


    The person doing the Method 2 Word Clearing must be trained in the  use
of an E-Meter and instant reads.


    There are two ways in which Method 2 Word Clearing can be used.


    As a study remedy  on the area of current difficulty.


    As a study method  on the whole material currently  being  studied  (or
the whole of previously studied materials).


    When used as a study remedy  on the area of current difficulty,  Method
2 is simply used to locate the misunderstood word or words  that  could  not
be located by Method 3 Word Clearing. It is  done  then  and  there  in  the
classroom or Qual and does not require C/S OK.


    This is done by locating and clearing the word that caused the  E-Meter
needle to read (small fall, fall, etc).


    The student having Method 2 Word Clearing done on him holds the cans of
the E-Meter (E-Meter electrodes) while he  listens  to  the  tape.  He  does
nothing else, other than listen to the tape.


             PROCEDURE FOR RESOLVING STUDY DIFFICULTY ON A TAPE,
                         WITH METHOD 2 WORD CLEARING

1.    The tape machine has been set up as in BTB  25  Nov  71R,  Reissued  7
    July 74 as BTB, Revised 21 Nov 74, Tape Course Series  7,  "Setting  Up
    and Using a Tape Player".

2.    The student, the classroom Word  Clearer  and  the  Course  Supervisor
    have been using Method 3 Word Clearing as in Tape Course Series 8,  BTB
    26 Nov 71R, Revised & Reissued 17 Aug 74 as BTB,  Revised  21  Nov  74,
    "Handling Misunderstood Words on Tape Recorded Materials".

3.    The student is having trouble  with  the  tape  or  the  subject.  The
    difficulty hasn't been resolved and the word causing the trouble hasn't
    been located.

4.    The Course Supervisor or a trained Word  Clearer  now  takes  over  to
    handle the difficulty with Method 2 Word Clearing.
    5.      The student either takes the tape he is having trouble with  to
    the Supervisor/Word Clearer's desk (where another tape machine and an E-
    Meter are set up)-or the Supervisor takes an E-Meter and sets it up  at
    the student's tape machine.

6.    The student is asked at which point on the tape he became  bogged.  He
    is then asked for the point on the tape when he was doing OK. The  tape
    is then reversed to the exact end point of where he was doing well. The
    first MU will be just after that and there may be others.

7.     The  Supervisor/Word  Clearer  operates  the  foot  pedal  start-stop
    control of the tape machine as well as the E-Meter, and does worksheets
    of the Word Clearing.

8.    The student listens to the tape. He also holds  the  cans  of  the  E-
    Meter while he is listening to the tape. If the student's TA  is  above
    3.5 or below 2.0, send the student to Qual for rapid  C/S  Series  53RI
    handling and return to course.

9.    As the tape plays,  the  Supervisor/Word  Clearer  watches  his  Meter
    needle. As soon as  the  needle  reads  (small  fall,  fall,  etc)  the
    Supervisor/Word Clearer stops the machine by use of the foot pedal, and
    asks the student for the misunderstood word.

      It is extremely important that the Supervisor/Word  Clearer  stop  the
    tape player at the exact moment of the Meter read, otherwise he may  be
    asking the student for three or four or even six or eight  words  later
    than the reading word, and thus cause undue difficulty for the student.

10.   If the student  can't  spot  the  word,  the  Supervisor/Word  Clearer
    replays the last short section to assist the student to find the MU.

11.   If the student still can't spot the word, the Supervisor/Word  Clearer
    turns the tape back a little further and replays  that  whole  section,
    using the tape counter numbers  to  guide  his  stopping  and  starting
    actions. He locates the MU.

12.   All misunderstood words on tapes are cleared according to BTB  4  Sept
    71R, Rev. 15 Dec 73,  20  July  74,  WC  Series  22R,  "How  to  Use  a
    Dictionary", clearing each word to F/N.

13.   The student keeps hold of the cans  and  the  Supervisor/Word  Clearer
    locates the word in the dictionary, understands the definition  himself
    and then holds it for the student to read.

14.   The student reads all definitions out loud  whilst  the  Word  Clearer
    watches the needle in order to pick up any MUs in the definitions.

15.   The Word Clearer ensures that the student puts  each  definition  into
    sentences to ensure the word is fully understood, to F/N.

16.   The Word Clearer ensures that the  student  has  clarified  the  exact
    definition of the word as used in the tape, and plays back that section
    of the tape for the student, in order to ensure it is cleared.

17.   The tape is now turned back to the beginning of the section where  the
    student ran into trouble to double check that it is now resolved. There
    should be no reads, and F/N, on that section of the material.

      If there are any more reads, these are picked up and cleared, and  the
    section replayed again, until there are no more reads on that  section,
    and F/N on the repair.

18.   The trouble is now resolved and the  student  is  returned  to  normal
    study, where he is expected to  apply  Method  3  Word  Clearing  as  a
    routine.

    19.     If the student's difficulty has not resolved,  the  student  is
    sent to Qual for a Word Clearing Correction List, which will locate the
    cause of the trouble.

20.   The student is  returned  to  Course  when  the  difficulty  has  been
    located and handled, resulting in an F/Ning student.


                  METHOD 2 WORD CLEARING AS A STUDY METHOD
                              ON TAPE MATERIALS

On some professional checksheets or special staff training actions, all  the
materials of the course are required to be  done  Method  2  Word  Clearing.
Also when earliest materials are being Word Cleared Method 2.

Method 2 done for this purpose has steps as follows.

A.    The Case Supervisor OK must be obtained to ensure that the student  is
    not in the middle of a major auditing rundown or process or due for  an
    Interiorization Rundown, etc. (Word Clearing M2 can be done between the
    processes of a program.)

B.    The tape player is set up as given earlier.

C.    Note:     If the student has a high or low TA on the Meter (above  3.5
    or below 2.0 after the Meter has been turned on for a  few  minutes  to
    warm up and the cans have been warmed by the student holding them for a
    few minutes) or if the student is in pain  or  upset-the  Word  Clearer
    does not start metered Word Clearing.  The  Word  Clearer  informs  the
    student, "I'm sorry we will not  be  starting  Word  Clearing  at  this
    time." The Word Clearer reports this in writing with the  student's  TA
    position to the Supervisor who forwards the report to the DPE  so  that
    the needed C/S Series 53RI session can be given the student. This  must
    be done quickly so he can be  gotten  on  to  his  Word  Clearing.  The
    student is immediately called in for C/S 53RI handling to the result of
    an F/Ning student at which point the student is returned to his course.

D.    Starting the Word Clearing is done by informing  the  student,  "I  am
    not auditing you." The tape is then started and  the  procedure  is  as
    given earlier in this BTB for Method 2. The only difference being  that
    the whole materials are covered in this manner with  the  Word  Clearer
    taking up and clearing all reading words (and any words  originated  by
    the student as misunderstood).

E.    Each word handled is cleared to Floating Needle on the Meter.

F.    The Word Clearing period is ended on Floating Needle.

G.    Note:  If the Word Clearing bogs down and it can't  be  resolved,  the
    Word Clearer or Supervisor must end off and send the Worksheets to  the
    Review Auditor in Dept 14 at once, who will  handle  by  doing  a  Word
    Clearing Correction List.


                                        Revised by CS-5
                                        Ens. Judy Ziff
                                        In co-ordination with
                                        FlagMission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides
      Approved by the Board of Issues
BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:BW:mhjh   for the
Copyright � 1971,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              10 OCTOBER 1971R
                   Revised & Reissued 31 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
Word Clearing    (Revision in this type style)
Auditors
and C/Ses
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 10 OCTOBER 1971
                                 SAME TITLE

                 (Reissued 10 Dec 71-previously incorrectly
                      called Word Clearing Series 24.)

                          Word Clearing Series 28R

                   TECH POINTS ON A WORD CLEARING FESTIVAL

                 CAUTION: THE FESTIVAL IS A DEPT 14 ACTION.
                  DO NOT PERMIT IT TO STOP ALL PRODUCTION.


    The whole  cycle under way in a  Word  Clearing  Festival  involving  a
whole staff is handled as a major auditing  cycle. Ruds are  flown and  each
 session is case supervised by the C/S to Festival Completion.


    Method 2 is not done on someone incomplete on Method I-this  is  mixing
cycles on the same type of subject matter. Normally, Method  2  can  and  is
done any time.


    If a Pc is having a Review auditing action, Method 2 should not be done
as this may interfere with Int or List correction actions.


    When a Word Clearing Festival is under way, no other auditing  rundowns
are done on staff, barring accidents requiring assists. Only set-up  actions
for Word Clearing are done.

    In a Word Clearing Festival, the following  actions  are  done  on  all
staff:

    1.      Method 1 to EP. Completion declared.
    2.      Method 2 on hat. Completion declared.
    3.      Post Purpose Clearing. Completion declared, plus:
    4.      Declare Festival Completion.

    Any staff who were not F/N VGIs in last exam or who are not at  a  rest
point in a program, must either get set-up actions or complete the  case  to
a rest point and F/N VGIs before C/Sed for Method 1. So be  prepared  for  a
number of Review actions at the start of the Festival.


    One final point, Method 2 is done with the Pc reading the hat materials
aloud and each reading word is taken to F/N before re-reading  the  relevant
section and proceeding with the hat.

      Revised & Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow
                                        Authorized by AVU
BDCS:sW:AL:MH:JZ mh.jh for the
Copyright � 1971,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              10 DECEMBER 1971R
                 Revised & Reissued 17 November 1974 as BTB
All Qual
D of T      CANCELS
Supervisors HCO BULLETIN OF 10 DECEMBER 1971
Word Clearers    SAME TITLE
Students

                          Word Clearing Series 29R


                           WORD CLEARING-OK TO DO


    The following points concerning Course Word Clearing have recently been
clarified by Ron.

1.    Course Word Clearing  can   be  done  on  a  student  currently  being
    audited.

2.    An F/N does not  have to be obtained (by rudiments or talking  the  TA
    down) before Course Room Word Clearing can be started.

3.    If the TA is high (above 3.5) or low (below 2.0)  or  the  student  is
    upset (or becomes upset) this must  be reported at once  to  Department
    14 and handled by a Word Clearing Correction List or C/S 53RI.

4.    Course Room Word Clearing must be started with  the  statement  "I  am
    not auditing you".

5.    Course Room Word Clearing does not have to be C/Sed. (Worksheets  must
    be made however, and sent to the student's preclear folder.)

6.    The student does not have to see the Pc Examiner after having  metered
    Word Clearing on course; but the Student C/S should be  alert  for  any
    flubs, especially words not cleared to F/N.

7.    If a Tech Word Clearer flubs or causes upsets on  Word  Clearing,  the
    correct action is for the  Supervisor  to  send  the  Word  Clearer  to
    Cramming. Qual crams all flubs in Word Clearing.

8.    All metered Classroom Word Clearing takes each word to F/N.

9.    A Supervisor can order any student who is not  an  F/Ning  student  to
    Word Clearing.

10.   Methods 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8 and 9 can be done in the Classroom.


                                        Revised by CS-5
                                        Ensign Judy Ziff
                                        In co-ordination with
                                        Flag Mission 1234
                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides
                                        Approved by the Board of Issues

BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:BW.mh.jh  for the
Copyright � 1971,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 2 JANUARY 1972
Remimeo

                           Word Clearing Series 30


                               WC1 COMES FIRST


    Don't try to Word Clear Materials by Word Clearing Method 2 before  the
person has had a Word Clear Method 1.


    Actual experience shows that doing WC2 without WC1 restimulates earlier
charge on words that have been misunderstood in the past.


    When a person has not had Word Clear Method 1  and  tries  to  do  Word
Clear Method 2 on materials, it can go very  slowly,  the  student  (due  to
earlier charge on words) can become quite misemotional.


    Using Method 3 (going back to  find  the  misunderstood  word)  is  all
right. And using common ordinary "Look up, don't  go  past  a  misunderstood
word" is all right.


                                 METHOD 2 EP

    The End Phenomena (what occurs at the end) of Word Clearing Method 2 is
a continuing F/N on the materials.


    When the person is  constantly  F/Ning  on  the  materials  being  word
cleared Method 2, that is the time to end off. The "EP" has been reached.


    When the word clearer forces the student to  go  on  beyond  this,  the
reads gotten are often false or are from protest.


    Reads that  are  false  come  from  cognitions  (realizations)  on  the
material. Protest reads come from just plain annoyance  with  having  to  go
on.


    When the EP of 2 is reached on a specific set of materials, the student
is then permitted to go on by himself, looking up words he doesn't  know  or
going back to find one that was missed.


    A person who enters a new subject or a new branch of a  subject  should
be given WC2 on it. A person who begins a higher level of a  subject  should
be given WC2 on it.


    If thereafter there is any bog or failure to  understand  or  apply  or
pass an exam on the subject, a WC Correction List can be done on it and  the
bog found and handled.


    This EP is only valid if the person has had WC Method 1 before  the  WC
Method 2 was begun.


    The EP of Method 2 can be many times repeated on different subjects  or
branches of subjects.

                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                        Founder
LRH: nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              7 FEBRUARY 1972RA
Remimeo     Issue II
Students    Revised & Reissued 29 July 1974 as BTB
Supervisors Revised 19 December 1974
Tech & Qual
Hats  CANCELS
                           BTB OF 7 FEBRUARY 1972R
                                  Issue II
                           "Method 3 Word Clearing
                           by the Student's Twin"

                          Word Clearing Series 31RA

                           METHOD 3 WORD CLEARING


    A  student  must  know  how  to  keep  himself  F/Ning  (tearing  along
successfully in his studies). He should be  able  to  handle  anything  that
slows or interferes with such an F/N.


    Students don't put themselves or each other on  a  meter  to  locate  a
misunderstood word. It's the Supervisor  who meters a student  to  find  the
misunderstood word(s) as per  these  Bulletins,  using  the  F/Ning  student
system:

      HCOB  22 Feb 72RA      WC Series 32RA  Word Clearing Method 4

      BTB   28 Jun 71R WC Series 6R     Method Two Metered Word
                       Clearing in the Course Room

      BTB   29 Jun 71R WC Series 7R     Steps to Speed Student
                       Product Flow

      BTB      1 Jul 71      WC Series 9     The Three Types of
                       Word Clearing

      BTB      1 Jul 71R     WC Series 10R   Speeding Up a Slow Course

    For a student using dope-off as the only detection of misunderstoods is
studying at below F/N level. The  F/N  went  off  long  before  the  student
reached the point of dope-off, so  waiting  for  dope-off  to  occur  before
handling is waiting too long. As soon as your study stats dropped  for  half
a day or you aren't quite so "bright" as you were a few minutes ago  is  the
time to look for the misunderstood word. (It's not  a  misunderstood  phrase
or idea or concept but a misunderstood WORD.) This always occurs before  the
subject itself is not understood.


    This is Method 3 Word Clearing:

1.    The student notices he is not flying along and is not "bright"  or  it
    could be just plain lack of enthusiasm or too long on one item  on  the
    checksheet or yawning or disinterest or doodling or daydreaming, etc.

2.    He then looks earlier in the text for a misunderstood word.  There  is
    one always, there are no exceptions. It may be that  the  misunderstood
    word is two pages or more back, but it is always earlier  in  the  text
    from where he is now.

3.    The word is found. He recognizes it in looking back  for  it.  If  the
    student can't find the misunderstood by looking back for it, he can get
    another student to spot check him. The other student takes  words  from
    the text that could be misunderstood and asks: "What is the  definition
    of the word       ?" seeing if the student gives a correct definition.
    4.      The student looks up the word found in a dictionary, thoroughly
    clears each definition and uses it verbally several times in  sentences
    of his own composition until he  has  obviously  demonstrated  that  he
    understands the word by the composition of his sentences-and feels fine
    about it.

5.    Then the student reads  the  text  that  contained  the  misunderstood
    word. If he isn't now "bright", eager to get on with it, back up  tone,
    etc, then there is another misunderstood word earlier in the text. This
    is found by repeating steps 2-5.

6.    When he is bright, up tone,  etc  (an  F/Ning  student),  the  student
    comes forward from where the misunderstood word was in the text to  the
    area of the subject he did not understand (where step 1 began).

    He will now be enthusiastic with his study  of  the  subject  unless  a
misunderstood word was missed, not fully cleared, or there's an earlier  one
in the text. If so, do steps 2-5. If the student  is  now  enthusiastic,  he
continues on with studying.


    Students do NOT have to be Word Cleared Method 2 on the  total  of  any
course.


    Method 3 Word Clearing can be used by students on each other  or  by  a
Supervisor or Word Clearer whenever necessary.


                                        Training & Services Bureau

                                        by order of

                                        L. RON HUBBARD
                                        Founder

                                        Revised by
                                        Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                        Approved by the
      Commodore's Staff Aides and
      The Board of Issues
                                        for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
BDcs:CSA:BofI:JW,AL,MH:mh.jh
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                     HCO BULLETIN OF 22 FEBRUARY 1972RA
Remimeo
All Supervisors         (Revised 26 March 1972
HPCSC           and 8 July 1974.
Mini Crse         (Changes in this type style. )
Super Crse
Word Clearing
Crse        Word Clearing Series 32RA
Est Off Crse
Dept 13
Personnel
                           URGENT-IMPORTANT-URGENT

                         Vital for all Supervisors,
                       Est-Os, and Cramming Officers.

                           WORD CLEARING METHOD 4


    Tech and Admin Cramming Officers, Word Clearers and Course  Supervisors
use Method 4 Word Clearing when  fishing  for  a  misunderstood  word.  E.g.
Cramming Officers use it to fish for  misunderstood  words  concerning  what
the person is being crammed on. Word Clearers use it  on  Interns  when  the
Intern needs a retrain  or  retread  or  even  if  the  Intern  is  sent  to
Cramming. Course Supervisors use it in the classroom  CONTINUOUSLY  ON  NON-
F/N STUDENTS or queries.


    The whole idea is the person requiring the Method 4 Word Clearing has a
Cramming Order or is not an F/Ning student because of confusion as a  result
of a misunderstood  word,  as  per  Word  Clearing  Series  16R  or  omitted
materials.


    Method 4 fishes for the misunderstood word, finds it, clears it to F/N,
looks for another in the area until there are no  more  with  an  F/N  VGIs,
then moves to another area, handles that-eventually all  the  misunderstoods
that resulted in the Cramming Order or non-F/N student are handled.


    It requires no C/S OK for it to be done. Method I is not a prerequisite
to Method 4.


    E-Meter Drill No. 21 is the E-Meter Drill to be drilled  on  Method  4.
It's the method of fishing for a cognition.


    Requires proper application of TRs and metering. All Supervisors,  Est-
Os, and Dept 13 personnel to check out on, drill, and apply this tech AS  IT
IS VITAL STUDY TECH.




                           METHOD 4 WORD CLEARING

1.    Give person the cans, state, "I am not auditing you."

2.    Ask while watching the meter:

    "Is there any part of what you're studying you did not fully get?"


    Trace the read. Use "fishing for a cog" drill (per HCO B  25  June  70,
    Issue III) if needed.
    If no read the question may be varied, e.g.


    "Is there any part of the materials you're studying you disagree with?"


    or
    "Is there any part of what you're  studying  you  feel  you  could  not
    apply?"
    or
    "In (material being checked) is there anything you didn't understand?"


    Let the student tell you briefly. Do NOT tell him the data.


    Verify that his study pack is complete as  the  data  might  have  been
    omitted.


    Also he might never have read the pack at all.
    If the data was missing do not go on to Step 3. See that  he  gets  the
    complete pack and reads it. Then repeat Method 4.


    If the person just has not read the materials do not go on to 3 but get
    him to read the materials. Then repeat Method 4.

3.    Get what it is then ask:

    "What word was misunderstood just before that?"


    Meter reads, Word Clearer finds the word, never accepting  a  confusion
    but finds the word giving the read (SF, F, LF, BD), gets it  looked  up
    in a dictionary and used in sentences until it can  be  seen  from  the
    sentences that the student now understands the word and the word  F/Ns.
    All the tools of Study Tech and Word Clearing are at the Word Clearer's
    disposal to take the word to F/N. The Word Clearer does not stop at one
    misunderstood but makes sure all are cleared.

4.    Repeat 2 & 3 until the materials are fully cleared up and any and  all
    misunderstoods or confusions handled.

5.    If the action bogs when used in the  classroom  the  student  must  be
    sent to Qual for  handling  and  Supervisor  to  Cramming  on  TRs  and
    metering and drilling on this procedure.

    The correct action is a W/C CORRECTION LIST DONE  ON  THE  STUDENT  AND
HANDLED.


    Of course if the above question F/Ns  on  asking,  there  would  be  no
misunderstoods  on  the  material  being  checked,  but  the  person  is  in
Cramming, not  an  F/Ning  student  or  whatever,  so  there  obviously  are
misunderstood words to be found and handled.


    Look at HCO PL 16 Feb  72,  "The  Purpose  of  the  Dept  of  Personnel
Enhancement". It says this Dept "reaches and looks  for  business  all  over
the org and brings it in".  So  someone  with  stats  down-student  or  post
stats, confusion about what to do, overloaded, can't seem to handle it,  how
do you do this, etc, etc, are all indicators of misunderstood words  as  the
person is saying confusion, confusion. Well, underneath the confusion  is  a
misunderstood word just as Word Clearing 1 6R says.


    Method 4 Word Clearing is what is  used  in  doing  and  achieving  the
purpose of the Dept of Personnel Enhancement, HCO PL 16 Feb 72.


    One of the ways the Word Clearers in this Dept  do  the  job  is  using
Method 4 Word Clearing.


    METHOD 4 IS USED BY COURSE SUPERVISORS TO HANDLE  ALL  STUDENT  QUERIES
ABOUT CONTENTS OF COURSE MATERIALS.


    The reason students ask questions about "What is meant" is  because  of
omitted pack materials from their checksheet,  failure  to  read  what  they
have OR BECAUSE OF A MISUNDERSTOOD WORD JUST BEFORE THEY GOT CONFUSED.


    The Super has to know only where the materials are and BE SMART  ENOUGH
TO DO METHOD 4 INSTEAD OF GIVING THE STUDENT ALTER-ISED  ANSWERS  THAT  STOP
SCIENTOLOGY WORKING.


    Word Clearing, especially Method 4, is how to get in HIGH CRIME HCO  PL
7 Feb 1965, Reissued 15 June 70, "KEEPING SCIENTOLOGY WORKING".


    SUCCESSFUL COURSE SUPERVISION  AND  SUCCESSFUL  CRAMMING  REQUIRE  THIS
ACTION BE FULLY KNOWN AND U-S-E-D.

                              **K * E * E * P**

                **S * C * I * E * N * T * O * L * O * G * Y**

                        **W * O * R * K * I * N * G**


LRH: clb.nt.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright �1972, 1974  Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               14 MARCH 1972RA

Remimeo     Revised & Reissued 24 June 1974 as BTB
Word Clearers    Revised 20 November 1974
Supervisors
Cramming
Dir Correction   CANCELS
Dir Pers Enh     BTB OF 14 MARCH 1972R
Qual I and I     SAME TITLE

                       (Revisions in this type style)


                          Word Clearing Series 33RA


                             WORD CLEARING LINES


    All students or staff in Dept 14 Dept of Personnel Enhancement for Word
Clearing must be sent immediately to the Pc Examiner at the end of the  Word
Clearing. The Exam Form and all worksheets in all cases  are  sent  to  Tech
Services for inclusion in the person's Pc Folder.


    Any Red Tagged Word Clearing or Qual Pc must be handled within 24 hours
with the Word Clearing Correction List or appropriate correction  for  other
actions and the Word Clearer  crammed.


    Qual has many tools to handle a bogged or failed student:

1.    Word Clearing Correction List, and handle.

2.    Method One for Staff Students (where not done earlier). (Requires  C/S
    clearance.) Now done in Tech Div.

3.    Method 2 on first materials or tape and  on  early  materials  on  the
    current or earlier level or Course to EP. (Requires C/S clearance.)

4.    Methods 4-9 on study or hat materials or subjects.

5.    Disagreement Remedy.

6.    Send to the HGC for full Study Correction List handling.

7.    Learning Drill.

8.    Confront Drills.

9.    Cramming (including metered  Why Finding).

10.   Pre-PCRD Assessment (from  HCO  B  20  July  72,  "Primary  Correction
    Rundown Handling").

11.   PRD in Tech Div.

12.   Enroll on to the PCRD, if all above tried to no avail.

13.   C/S Series 53RI (per HCO PL 30 Aug 74, "Qual Stat Change").

    When Qual gets a bogged student, the student is routed to the  Cramming
Officer. One of the first areas investigated is  Word  Clearing  (correction
required or just not done
earlier). The Cramming Officer also ensures  that  the  Supervisor  or  Word
Clearer is brought in and crammed on errors or omissions in Word Clearing.


    Word Clearing Method 1, Method 2 on  Hat  plus  Post  Purpose  Clearing
cycles require C/S clearance and OK first. When scheduling  a  staff  member
for this, the appropriate C/S gets the Pc Folder from  Tech  Services  Staff
Section and checks the staff member's Pc  programme  for  the  inclusion  of
Method One, Method 2 on Hat and Post Purpose  Clearing.  This  must  not  be
done whilst the staff member is on a major level or rundown.


                                        Revised by CS-5
                                        Ensign Judy Ziff

                                        In co-ordination with
                                        Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

                                        Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:mh.rd
Copyright �1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               19 MARCH 1972RA
Remimeo     Revised & Reissued 17 November 1974 as BTB
Word Clearers    Revised 10 March 1975
Qual Secs
Cramming Offs
                                   CANCELS
                             BTB 19 MARCH 1972R
                                 SAME TITLE



                          Word Clearing Series 34RA


                     HIGH CRIME POLICY AND WORD CLEARING

                     (Paragraph 3, re: Cramming Off not
                      authorized to issue OK's to Word
                          Clear, has been deleted.)


    Word Clearing is a technical subject and is mastered in the Academy  on
the Professional Word Clearer's Course.


    The course graduate then goes to Qual, gets his Qual OK to Operate an E-
Meter, then the Qual OK to Word Clear, naming which methods, at which  point
the Word Clearer is eligible for posting in Tech or Qual. Naturally, the  OK
to Word Clear is monitored by the Class of the Auditor and only  Class  IIIs
or above are granted the OK to do Method One Word Clearing in the HGC.


    All OKs to Word Clear already issued to persons who have not  done  the
Professional Word Clearer's Course are considered temporary and  the  Course
must be done rapidly to retain the OK.

    Naturally all Word Clearers check out on all new Word  Clearing  Series
HCO Bs as they come out. Any new Word  Clearing  technique  issued  is  Word
Cleared, star-rated and drilled and an additional Qual OK to Word  Clear  on
that action is issued by the Cramming Officer.


                                        Revised by
                                        Flag Mission 1234 I/C
                                        CPO Andrea Lewis

      Approved by the
      Commodore's Staff Aides and
      The Board of Issues for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:CSA:BofI:AL:JZ:mh.jh
Copyright �1972, 1974, 1975
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               21 JULY 1971RD
Remimeo
Word Clearers    (Revised 9 Aug 71)
C/Ses (Revised 31 Mar 72)
                             (Revised 30 Dec 72)
                             (Revised 1 Dec 74)

                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 21 JULY 1971RC
                                 SAME TITLE
                       REISSUED 1 DECEMBER 1974 as BTB


                          Word Clearing Series 35RD


                    WORD CLEARING CORRECTION LIST REVISED
                     (Use to correct upsets, high or low
                TA occurring in all Word Clearing sessions.)


    It is totally essential that this Word Clearing Correction List be used
to handle ANY AND ALL TROUBLE ON ANY WORD CLEARING.


    If a student or staff member runs into trouble during or shortly  after
any Word Clearing, it is the Word Clearing Correction List which is used  to
correct the situation. It would be a programme violation  to  introduce  any
other method of handling than the Word Clearing Correction List.


    It is hereby firmly established that any trouble on Word Clearing  must
be handled with the Word Clearing Correction List and no other action.


    NOTE: WORDS SOMETIMES HAVE DIFFERENT OR MORE THAN ONE MEANING. YOU HAVE
TO KNOW EVERY DIFFERENT MEANING SO ALL DEFINITIONS ARE  LOOKED  UP  AND  THE
WORD IS FULLY DEFINED. YOU ALSO MUST CHOOSE THE DEFINITION  IN  USE  IN  THE
SENTENCE SO THAT THE MATERIALS ARE UNDERSTOOD.


    Assess this list once through noting reads (Method 5).


    Carry all reads to an F/N or get the reading  item  fully  repaired  to
F/N.

1.    UNFLAT INT/EXT   _________
      (If TA in normal range, 2WC to F/N. If TA high or low assess
      Int Corr List and handle.)

2.    OVERRUN INT/EXT  _________
      (If TA in normal range, 2WC to F/N. If TA high or low assess
      Int Corr List and handle.)

3.    AUDITED OVER EXTERIOR  _________
      (If TA high or low and Int not run, handle per HCO B 17 Dec
      71R, C/S Series 23RA, "Interiorization Summary". If Int
      previously run, handle per 1.)

4.    LIST ERROR _________
      (Use L4BR and handle.)
    4a.     WRONG WHY FOUND _________
      (Indicate. Handle with an L4BR.)

5.    UNFLAT ENGRAM CHAIN    _________
      (Get which chain and flow and handle with L3RD.)

5a.   IMPLANT BEEN RESTIMULATED   _________
      (Handle with L3RD.)

6.    ARC BREAK  _________
      (Use ARCU CDEINR E/S to F/N or L1C M3 if it does not
      clean up.)

7.    PTP (PRESENT TIME PROBLEM)  _________
      (Handle by Itsa E/S Itsa.)

8.    WITHHOLD   _________
      (Pull it-what, all, who E/S.)

9.    OVERT _________
      (Pull it E/S.)

10.   UNREADING SUBJECT      _________
      (Get which one Pc thought didn't read-put in buttons sup-
      press, invalidate, and protest and clean it up.)

11.   READING ON PROTEST     _________
      (Get which word, clean off protest and indicate by-passed
      charge.)

12.   OVERRUN A WORD   _________
      (Get which one and rehab.)

13.   COULDN'T HEAR THE WORD CLEARER    _________
      (2WC E/S and clean it up.)

14.   DIDN'T UNDERSTAND WHAT THE WORD CLEARER
      SAID  _________
      (2WC E/S and clean it up.)

15.   DIDN'T UNDERSTAND THE ACTION BEING DONE      _________
      (Work it out by 2WC and E/S.)

16.   CONFUSED BY SOMETHING  _________
      (Work it out by 2WC and E/S.)

17.   A WORD ON THE LIST OF SUBJECTS WAS MISUNDER-
      STOOD _________
      (Clear it to F/N.)

18.   OVERRUN A SUBJECT      _________
      (Get which one and rehab release point.)
    19.     WORD STILL MISUNDERSTOOD    _________
      (Get it cleared up with a dictionary and take E/S word/
      subject to EP. F/N each word.)

20.   SUBJECT STILL MISUNDERSTOOD _________
      (Get which subject and which word and handle per usual
      Word Clearing Tech. F/N each word.)

 21.  AUDITOR EVALUATION     _________
      (Clean up with eval button E/S to EP.)

22.   WORD CLEARING IN THE MIDDLE OF ANOTHER
      INCOMPLETE AUDITING CYCLE   _________
      (2WC E/S to F/N. Get which cycle Pc is on and by folder
      inspection evaluate which one needs to be completed first-
      make sure it is fully noted on Pgm to complete Word
      Clearing if the other action is handled first.)

23.   WORD CLEARING WHILE DOING TR COURSE    _________
      (2WC E/S to F/N. Have Pc finish the Course.)

24.   INCOMPLETE TR COURSE   _________
      (2WC E/S to F/N. Complete TR Course.
      Then complete Word Clearing cycle.)

25.   NOT GETTING THE BASIC WORD  _________
      (Find which subject/word is incomplete by 2WC and then
      take it to EP. F/N each word.)

26.   NOT GETTING THE BASIC SUBJECT     _________
      (Find which subject is incomplete by 2WC and then take
      it to EP. F/N each word.)

27.   AUDITOR FORGOT TO GO EARLIER SIMILAR   _________
      (Get which subject/word and take to EP-if several subjects have
      been started, take first one semi-run and flatten, then next, etc.)

28.   TOLD THE WORD CLEARER IT WAS UNDERSTOOD JUST
      TO GET RID OF HIM      _________
      (Get the word plus any others and clear them each to F/N.)

29.   TA WAS IN A FALSE RANGE     _________
      (Handle with False TA Checklist per HCO B 29 Feb 72R, then
      clean up the by-passed charge with 1. Assess for best read a. TA
      worries, b. F/N worries. 2. Then 2WC times he was worried
      about (item) E/S to F/N. 3. Rehab any overrun due to false TA.)

30.   USED THE WRONG SIZED CANS   _________
      (False TA Checklist. Work out the right sized cans with the Pc.)

31.   HANDS GET TIRED IN AUDITING _________
      (Handle with False TA Checklist. 2WC E/S to F/N.)

32.   PUZZLED ABOUT WHY THE AUDITOR KEPT ON WORD
      CLEARING   _________
      (Find out what with 2WC and rehab win or handle E/S to F/N)
    33.     AUDITOR WAS OVERWHELMING    _________
      (Find out what happened and clean up E/S to F/N. Indicate any
      by-passed charge. L1C on that auditing.)

34.   FEEL ATTACKED    _________
      (Clean up with 2WC E/S to F/N.
      If it's the Auditor, L1C that auditing.)

35.   FELT THERE WAS SOMETHING WRONG WITH THE F/Ns
      INDICATED  _________
      (Find out what happened and clean up E/S.)

36.   DIDN'T THINK WORDS REALLY READ    _________
      (Clean up with False E/S to F/N.)

37.   HAD EARLY BAD AUDITING      _________
      (L1C Method 3 on early auditing.)

38.   MISUNDERSTOOD SUBJECT MISSED      _________
      (Get the subject and which words and take E/S word/subject
      to EP, F/Ning each word.)

39.   SUBJECT WHICH SHOULD HAVE BEEN ON THE LIST
      BUT WASN'T       _________
      (Get the subject and which words and take E/S word/subject
      to EP, F/Ning each word.)

40.   A WORD IN A DEFINITION WAS MISUNDERSTOOD     _________
      (Get which word or words and clear-F/Ning each word.)

41.   GOT DISTRACTED DURING WORD CLEARING    _________
      (Find out what happened and clean up E/S to EP. L1C if upset.)

42.   TRIED TO MAKE THE LIST F/N  _________
      (Put in ruds on Word Clearing to F/Ns.)

43.   NOT YOUR MISUNDERSTOOD      _________
      (Clean it up by 2WC E/S to F/N.)

44.   INVALIDATION OF KNOWINGNESS       _________
      (Clean up using inval E/S to F/N.)

45.   BY-PASSED A WIN  _________
      (Rehab it.)


      Revised by CS-4
      W/O Ron Shaffran
                                        Reissued as BTB by
                                        Flag Mission 1234 I/C
                                        CPO Andrea Lewis
      Approved by the
BDCS:CSA:BofI:AL:JZ:mh.jh    Commodore's Staff Aides and
Copyright �1972, 1974, 1975  The Board of Issues for the
by L. Ron Hubbard      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    of the CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                         HCO BULLETIN OF 9 JUNE 1972

Remimeo


                           Word Clearing Series 36



                                   GRAMMAR


    In all word clearing all Grammatical Words and small  words  SHOULD  BE
LOOKED UP IN A SIMPLE GRAMMAR TEXTBOOK.


    Very few dictionaries have full definitions for  such  words  AND  THEY
HAVE NO EXAMPLES .


    Words like "a" "the" "and" are really parts  of  language  construction
and are more complex than they at first appear.


    A Word Clearing Auditor should have a simple grammar book  to  hand  as
well as dictionaries.


    The best Grammar textbooks are those compiled for persons foreign to  a
language, like immigrants. These do not contain  the  supposition  that  the
student is already an English professor.


    Lots of EXAMPLES is the real test of a good grammar.


    When doing the Study Tapes or Student Hat  lack  of  a  simple  grammar
textbook can really throw the student off.


    Those "simple" words can be the huge rocks that stand on the highway to
becoming a WORD CLEAR.


    So a Grammar is needed.


    If a student is VERY deficient (lacking) in grammar it is best to  make
him do a whole simple grammar text first before he begins to get  into  just
words. The words won't hang together for him.


    It takes less time to do a short textbook in Grammar than  it  does  to
struggle with grammar all the way through.


    Grammar can look like a ghastly subject until one really looks  at  it.
Then it's easy.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder




LRH: nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 19 JUNE 1972
Remimeo

                           Word Clearing Series 37


                             DINKY DICTIONARIES

                       (Dinky: Small, insignificant.)


    In learning the meaning of words small dictionaries are  very  often  a
greater liability than they are a help.


    The meanings they give are  often  circular:  Like  "CAT:  An  Animal."
"ANIMAL: A Cat." They do not give enough meaning to escape the circle.


    The meanings given are often inadequate to get a real  concept  of  the
word.


    The words are too few and even common words are often missing.


    HUGE dictionaries can also be confusing as the words they use to define
are often too big or too rare and make one chase through  20  new  words  to
get the meaning of the original.


    The best dictionaries are the very large child's dictionaries like  THE
WORLD   BOOK   DICTIONARY   (A   Thorndike-Barnhart   Dictionary   published
exclusively for Field Enterprises Educational Corporation, Merchandise  Mart
Plaza, Chicago, Illinois 60654 or Doubleday and Company.  Thorndike-Barnhart
has a whole series of dictionaries of which this is  a  special  one.  Field
Enterprises has offices in  Chicago,  London,  Rome,  Sydney,  Toronto.  The
World Book Dictionary is in two volumes, each 28l/2 cm [11  1/4  inches]  by
22 cm  [8  5/8  inches]  by  5.8  cm  [21/4  inches],  so  it  is  no  small
dictionary!) (Also it defines Dianetics correctly and isn't determined on  a
course of propaganda to  re-educate  the  public  unlike  Merriam  Webster's
dictionaries.)


    Little pocket book dictionaries may have their uses for  traveling  and
reading newspapers, but they do get people in trouble. I  have  seen  people
find a word in them and then look around in total confusion. For  the  dinky
dictionary did not give the full meaning or the second meaning  they  really
needed.


    So the dinky dictionary may fit in your pocket but not in your mind.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder










LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 21 JUNE 1972
                                   Issue I
Remimeo

                           Word Clearing Series 38


                                  METHOD 5


    Method 5 Word Clearing is a System wherein the word clearer feeds words
to the person and has him define  each.  It  is  called  Material  Clearing.
Those the person cannot define must be looked up.


    This method may be done without a meter. It can also  be  done  with  a
meter.


    The reason the Method is needed is because the person  often  does  not
know that he does not know. Therefore Method 4 has its  limitations  as  the
meter does not always read.


    The actions are very precise.


    The word clearer asks "What is the definition  of  _____?"  The  person
gives it. If there is any doubt whatever of it, or  if  the  person  is  the
least bit hesitant, the word is looked up in a proper dictionary.


    This method is the method used to clear words or auditing  commands  or
auditing lists.



                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder




LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 21 JUNE 1972
                                  Issue II
Remimeo
                           Word Clearing Series 39

                                  METHOD 6

    Method 6 Word Clearing is called KEY WORD CLEARING.


    It is used on posts and specific subjects.


    It is a heavier form than Method 5.


    Method 6 is used without a meter.


    Where a person is new on post or new to a subject or  where  there  has
just been a goof, an error or an Ethics action, these steps are done in  the
following manner.

    1.      The Word Clearer makes a list of the KEY  (or  most  important)
words relating to the person's duties or post or the new subject.


    This is made up as a list. The Word Clearer looks up each word  in  the
dictionary and writes down the definitions.


    The list may have as few as three words or as many as twenty or thirty.


    (Example: A bank clerk's key words  would  be  "bank"  "clerk"  "money"
"cash" "drafts" "teller" "accounts" "customer" etc.)


    (Example: There has just been a goof resulting in an  upset.  The  goof
centered  around  "radio"  "repairs"  "operation"  "operator"  "electronics"
etc.)


    2.      The Word Clearer, without showing the person  the  definitions,
asks him to define each word.


    3.      The Word Clearer checks the definition on his list for  general
correctness not word for word but meaning.


    4.      Any slow or hesitancy or misdefinition is met with  having  the
person look the word up and look up any word in the  definition  the  person
does not have a grasp of.


    5.      One completes his list.


    6.      By then the person has been jarred into looking further by  the
above actions. The Word Clearer asks "What other word relating to your  post
(or subject or error) didn't you understand?"


    7.      Each one mentioned is now defined by looking it up.


    8.      The person can now be Method 4ed relating to  his  post  to  be
sure all is clean and there are no upsets.

    Note: Where the person has just had an accident or ethics action it may
be necessary to delay the action until the person is calmer or not so  upset
as the action  can  be  a  heavy  distraction  if  the  person  is  hurt  or
frightened and will not be successful.


    IT WILL BE FOUND THAT LAZINESS, INACTIVITY, SLOWNESS AND  ERRORS  ON  A
POST OR IN USING A SUBJECT TRACE TO MISUNDERSTOOD KEY WORDS.


    THE REMEDY IS WC METHOD 6.

LRH:nt.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1972 Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 21 JUNE 1972
                                  Issue III
Remimeo

                           Word Clearing Series 40

                                  METHOD 7


    Whenever one is working with children or foreign  language  persons  or
semiliterates Method 7 READING ALOUD is used.


    In this method the person is made to read aloud to find out what he  is
doing.


    It is a very simple method. It is done without a meter.


    It is used on such persons before other methods in  order  to  get  the
person untangled.


    If a person does not seem to be progressing by studying  silently,  one
has him read aloud.


    Another copy of the same text must also be followed by the Word Clearer
as the person reads.


    Startling things can be observed.


    The person may omit the  word  "is"  whenever  it  occurs.  The  person
doesn't read it. He may have some  strange  meaning  for  it  like  "Israel"
(actual occurrence).


    He may omit "didn't" each time it occurs and the reason traced  to  not
knowing what the apostrophe is (actual occurrence).


    He may call one word quite another word such as "stop" for "happen"  or
"green" for "mean".


    He may hesitate over certain words.


    The procedure is

    1.      Have him read aloud.


    2.      Note each omission or word change or hesitation or frown as  he
        reads and take it up at once.


    3.      Correct it by looking it up for him or explaining it to him.


    4.      Have him go on reading, noting the next omission,  word  change
        or hesitation or frown.


    5.      Repeat steps 2 to 4.

    By doing this a person can be brought up to literacy.


    His next actions would be learning how to use a dictionary and look  up
words.


    Then a simple grammar.


    A very backward student can be boosted up to literacy by this method.


LRH: nt.rd  L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1972       Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 21 JUNE 1972
                                  Issue IV

Remimeo

                           Word Clearing Series 41


                                  METHOD 8


    (If a student has trouble with this Method he should do Method 7 first.
Method One should also be done.)


    Method 8 is an action used  in  the  "Primary  Rundown"  where  one  is
studying Study Tech or where one is seeking a full grasp of a  subject.  Its
End Product is SUPER-LITERACY.


    The steps are these:


    Usually an alphabetical list of every word or term in  the  text  of  a
paper, a chapter or a recorded tape is available or provided.

    1.      The person looks up each word on the alphabetical list and uses
each in sentences until he has the meaning conceptually.


    The words are looked up in a big dictionary.


    The grammatical words or small words are looked up in a simple grammar.
If the person has too much trouble with  grammar  he  should  do  the  whole
simple grammar text before going on.


    Any technical terms not in the dictionary are looked up in a  technical
dictionary  or  glossary  or  in  bulletins  on  the   materials,   i.e.   a
photographic dictionary.


    This is not done for the whole subject, it is done for  a  paper  or  a
chapter or one tape of a series.


    2.      One then reads or listens to the paper, chapter or tape for its
sense or general meaning.


    3.      Method 4 is then done on the person to find any misunderstoods.


    4.      These are cleared up per Method 4 procedure.


    5.      The person reads or listens to the material again.


    6.      The person is again checked for any misunderstoods.


    7.      If there are any misunderstoods the person again does steps 4 &
5.


    8.      When the material is fully heard or  understood  as  per  above
steps and checks, end off on that paper, chapter, tape  and  go  on  to  the
next one.


    9.      An alphabetical list is made or  exists  for  the  next  paper,
chapter or tape. Steps 1 to 8 are done on it.


    10.     Each succeeding paper or chapter or tape is done with  steps  I
to 8.
When all the material has been done in this way, the person  will  be  fully
able to apply all the material.


    Usually Method 8 is reserved for  the  Scientology  Study  Tapes  which
contain how to study and the Student Hat.


    It can also be used to master a major subject.


    IT WILL BE FOUND THAT METHOD 8 (or Method 2 or 3 or 4 or  6)  ARE  VERY
LENGTHY AND HARD TO DO UNLESS ONE HAS FIRST HAD A METHOD ONE WORD CLEARING.


    A Word Clearing Correction List is used on Method 8 whenever a  student
bogs heavily. This list will, when assessed on a meter properly, locate  the
errors and they can be corrected.


    When used on the Study Tech itself and Student Hat, Method  8  HONESTLY
DONE makes a person SUPER-LITERATE.  It  is  like  hearing  and  seeing  and
reading for the first time!


    Reading a text or instruction or book is comfortable.  One  has  it  in
conceptual form. One can APPLY the material learned.


    It is a new state.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder




LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 17 AUGUST 1972R
                             REVISED 8 JULY 1974
Remimeo
(Translate to    (Revision in this type style)
European
Languages)
                          (Reissued 24 October 1974
                          as a Tape Course Series)



                          Word Clearing Series 42R

                            Tape Course Series 10

                               METHOD 4 NOTES



    Too generalized a question in using Method 4 defeats its  use  and  can
restimulate a person badly.


    Example: "Is there anything in college you didn't understand?" That  of
course is just  plain  ridiculous  as  a  question.  "Have  you  ever  heard
anything you didn't understand?" would be similarly silly.


                          BREAK DOWN THE MATERIALS

    When doing Method 4 you have to break down the materials (put them into
small separate units) in order to ask questions.


    Example: We have Papers 1 & 2, both on  the  same  subject.  The  wrong
question for Method 4 would be "Is there  anything  in  Papers  1  &  2  you
didn't understand?" and not even give him the papers to see! The  right  way
to do it would be to take Paper  I  and  break  it  down  into  its  obvious
sections, give the person Paper 1 and let him look at it. Point to  its  1st
section and say, "Is there anything you didn't understand in this  section?"
while watching the meter. Then point to next section, do  the  same.  Finish
Paper 1. Then go to Paper 2 and do it the same.


    A person has to know what he's being asked about and has to be thinking
of it when asked the question.

                                    TAPES

    Just as it would be ridiculous to ask,  "Have  you  ever  misunderstood
anything you ever read?", it would be silly to ask, "Did  you  ever  have  a
misunderstood on Tape?"


    The right way is to take the  tape and put it on a machine and  play  a
bit of it. And ask, "Is there anything in the first  section  of  this  tape
you didn't understand?" while watching the meter. Then high speed  the  tape
forward to another area and do the same. Thus the tape is covered.


    This can also be done from any tape notes, section by section.


                                    BOOKS

    Books are done chapter by chapter.
                                 QUICKIE M4

      Method 4 is defeated utterly by:

      1.    Bad metering,

            2.   Too general a question,

            3.   Not having the material to hand,

            4.    Not  getting  the  person's  attention  on  parts  of  the
material,

            5.   Not taking each word found to F/N.

    Quickie M4 misses. It sets the person up for a loss in his studying.


    And we want him to actually succeed in his study, don't we?



LRH:ntjh    L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1972, 1974 Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 18 AUGUST 1972
Remimeo

                           Word Clearing Series 43


                             GRAMMAR DEFINITION


    The following Definition of Grammar was taken from  the  Dictionary  of
Contemporary American Usage by  Bergen  and  Cornelia  Evans,  published  by
Random House, New York, in 1957. (It is not a complete Dictionary and  would
require another larger dictionary for  full  word  clearing.  But  it  gives
American usages of words and phrases, which could be important as  Dianetics
and Scientology are written in American English.)


    It was sent to me by an SHSBC  Student  who  found  its  definition  of
Grammar was very helpful to other students.


    This definition also tells you why some college or school texts are  so
ghastly hard to read-they are not in standard English.  It  also  tells  you
why, in 1950, the head of the English Department in an  American  University
hailed Dianetics: The Modern Science of Mental Health as marking a  new  era
of scientific writing. One reason is that it was written by a writer, not  a
professor. The other was that it was written in  the  English  that  was  in
use.


    But read the definition:

                                   GRAMMAR

    GRAMMAR is a systematic description of the ways in which words are used
in a particular language. The grammarian groups words that behave  similarly
into classes and then draws  up  rules  stating  how  each  class  of  words
behaves. What classes are set up and how the rules are phrased is  a  matter
of convenience. A grammarian is free to classify his  material  in  any  way
that seems reasonable to him. But he is  never  free  to  say  that  certain
forms of speech are unacceptable merely because there is no place  for  them
in the system he has designed.


THE CLASSES

    Most grammarians are interested in a number of  languages.  As  a  rule
they set up classes that are useful in handling many languages but that  may
have very little  meaning  for  a  particular  language.  For  example,  the
distinction between the dative him and the accusative him  is  important  in
the Indo-European languages generally. But in a grammar designed  solely  to
teach English, this distinction does not have to be made.  Similarly,  there
is an etymological or historical difference between the  English  gerund  in
-ing and the participle in -ing. But  it  is  sometimes  impossible  to  say
whether a given word is a gerund or a participle; for example,  in  journeys
end in lovers meeting. For this reason, some grammarians  prefer  to  handle
these forms together under one name, such as "participle" or "-ing".


    The familiar terms of classical grammar are defined in this  dictionary
for the convenience of persons who need to use these concepts.  But  a  much
simpler classification, based on the structure of  present-day  English,  is
employed in all the discussions of usage.

THE RULES

In order to say how words  are  used,  the  grammarian  must  examine  large
quantities of spoken and written English. He will  find  some  constructions
used so consistently that the exceptions have to be classed as  errors.  But
he will also find competing, and even  contradictory,  constructions,  which
appear too often to be called mistakes. He must  then  see  whether  one  of
these expressions is used by one kind of person and not  by  another  or  in
one kind of situation and not in another. If he can find  no  difference  of
this sort he accepts the two constructions as interchangeable. In  this  way
he assembles a body of information on how English words are  used  that  may
also show differences, such as those between one locality  and  another,  or
between spoken and written  English,  or  between  literary  and  illiterate
speech. Studies of  this  kind  are  called  "scientific"  or  "descriptive"
grammars. This is a relatively new approach to the problems of language  and
the information brought to light in this way is sometimes surprising.

    The  first  English  grammarians,  writing  in  the   seventeenth   and
eighteenth centuries, did not attempt to describe the English of their  day.
On the  contrary,  they  were  attempting  to  "improve"  English  and  they
demanded Latin constructions which were not characteristic of English.  They
objected to the expression I am mistaken, because if translated  into  Latin
this would mean I am misunderstood. They  claimed  that  unloose  must  mean
tie, because un is a Latin negative. They objected to the "double  negative"
which was good Old English, and also good Greek, but not good Latin.


    These eighteenth  century  rules  of  prescriptive  grammar  have  been
repeated in school books for two hundred years. They are  the  rules  for  a
curious, Latinized English that has never been spoken and is seldom used  in
literature, but that is now highly respected in some places, principally  in
scientific writing. It should  be  recognized  that  these  rules  were  not
designed to "preserve" English, or keep it "pure".  They  were  designed  to
create a language which would be "better" simply because it  was  more  like
Latin. Dryden, writing in the seventeenth century, said: "I am often put  to
a stand in considering whether what I write be the idiom of  the  tongue  or
false  grammar  and  nonsense,  couched  beneath  that  specious   name   of
Anglicism, and have no other way to clear my doubts but  by  translating  my
English into Latin and thereby trying what sense the words will  bear  in  a
more stable language." One  result  of  this  double  translation  was  that
Dryden went through his earlier works and rewrote  all  the  sentences  that
had originally ended in a preposition or adverb. A generation  later,  Swift
complained that the English of  his  day  "offends  against  every  part  of
grammar". Certainly this is blaming the foot  because  it  doesn't  fit  the
shoe!


    Because some people would like to write the language of the  textbooks,
the entries  in  this  dictionary  not  only  tell  what  standing  a  given
construction has in current English but also explain how the  rules  of  the
prescriptive  grammarian  would  apply,  wherever  the  rules  and  standard
practice differ. But in such cases the  rules  are  never  simple,  and  the
person who has to use this type of English may feel that it would be  easier
to follow Dryden's example and write in Latin first.


THIS BOOK

    The grammar entries in this book are designed  for  persons  who  speak
standard English but who may be confused about certain isolated points.  The
entries are arranged so that the answer  to  a  particular  problem  can  be
found in  the  least  possible  time.  But  anyone  who  wishes  to  make  a
systematic study of English grammar, using this book, can do so by  starting
with the entry parts of speech and following  the  references  to  more  and
more detailed discussions of each concept.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder
LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 6 NOVEMBER 1972
Remimeo

                           Word Clearing Series 44


                             ILLITERACY AND WORK


    I have been engaged in a study of applications of  tech  to  illiteracy
and illiterate or semi-literate populations and found some simple levels  of
approach.


    I investigated U.S. AID educational efforts and data to  find  out  why
they failed. For instance, in one project, the U.S. spent over  one  million
dollars to educate 105 persons  from  an  "underdeveloped"  country  of  low
literacy and surveyed it later to find that none of the data taught  was  in
use and that no progress had been made by the person or  the  country  as  a
result.


    Using their data and my own personal investigation in the same country,
I evaluated the situation and found they  had  not  consulted  the  existing
scene before or during the program. Their training was for  a  sophisticated
environment.


    The country of the program  is  just  emerging  from  a  nomadic  level
civilization  into  agricultural  and  the  agriculture  done  is  extremely
primitive, erodes whole plains with non-contour  plowing  and  doesn't  even
know about irrigation.


    To these people they  taught  the  highly  complex  technology  of  the
electronic age!


    The people went back home, found no computers whatever, listened to the
goats and sat down and did nothing.


    U.S. AID had no explanation for this. But give them credit-the students
liked the U.S. and U.S. AID did honestly survey and  admit  the  failure,  a
rare humility.


    From this point I did a local study and found that instead of computers
these people needed-guess what?


    TR 2! Acknowledgement. (Training Drill No.  2,  How  to  Acknowledge  a
Communication.)


    This primitive area had never heard of TR 2!


    "Good", "fine", "thank you" were unknown in all their work culture.


    Before they saw any need of any technology, they had first to see  that
there was any reason to get any work done at all!


    Further, their cultural pattern contained dishonesty as a virtue!  This
is antipathetic to basic morale no matter what the culture and so they  were
in a cultural attitude  or  pattern  which  kept  them  sad,  depressed  and
miserable! So they couldn't work.


    The program, then, had to (a) recover honesty to increase  morale,  (b)
introduce acknowledgement for accomplishment, (c) establish the  possibility
that one could work, (d) introduce  statistics  so  that  something  existed
that could be acknowledged and (e) establish bonuses for statistics so  that
acknowledgement could be real and stay that way.


    These items are all very elementary and simple portions  of  our  basic
technology:
(a) Security checking, (b) TRs especially 2, (c)  Problems  of  Work  Course
using tape and Word Clearing, (d) Statistical policies and tech,  (e)  Bonus
policies.


    So in U.S. AID Programs there was a skipped gradient in culture (nomad-
agrarian skipped to electronic-nuclear) and a skipped gradient in  training-
Why learn when there is no reason to work? So why be literate? Or study?


    Any sophisticated technical layout would break down  in  the  hands  of
these people-and does.


    But this program would lift them up. Then they would have  some  reason
to study.


    Factually, one cannot just sail into a culture blind  and  bash  around
with no data. It is costly and it accomplishes very little.


    A basic knowledge of Man is essential to any improvement in any area of
the human race.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder




LRH:nt.rd
Copyright � 1972
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              30 JANUARY 1973RA
                                   Issue I
                   Revised & Reissued 24 June 1974 as BTB
                          Revised 20 November 1974

Remimeo
Word Clearers    CANCELS
Qual Secs   BTB of 30 JANUARY 1973R
Execs Issue I
Hats Offs   SAME TITLE

                        (Revision in this type style)

                         Word Clearing Series 45 RA

                      WORD CLEARING-THE KEY REPAIR TOOL
                                 FOR AN ORG

    Word Clearing is a brilliant repair  tool  for  an  Org  to  raise  Org
production and delivery quality.


    In order to get any area  or  individual  producing,  there  are  three
simple actions which will handle (per LRH 5 Sept 71 Qual Tape):

    1.      Make sure the person has actually READ the material he needs to
        know.


    2.      If he has read the material and cannot apply it, WORD CLEARING,
        in its different forms, used correctly, with good TRs will clean up
        any and all misunderstoods.


    3.      The only other thing which can prevent application is that  the
        person needs to be DRILLED and have CONFRONT RAISED on that area or
        action. Drilling on Admin post actions  is  just  as  important  as
        drilling Tech post actions.

    If the above actions do not handle, though carefully done,  the  person
has out Ethics and needs Ethics handling and probably Integrity Processing.


    This does not eradicate the need for Executive inspections, evaluations
and handlings for non-working installations, but when the Why is  found  and
stops removed, simply taking each staff member in the area and  putting  him
through the 1, 2 and  3,  in  that  order,  will  really  create  a  working
installation.


    This applies in the area of Tech or Admin.


    As the competence of Word Clearing increases, so does the  traffic  for
it and additional Word Clearers must be added to handle the traffic so  that
staff, Internes and students do get good service.


    Qual really is the staff's best friend if they use  loads  of  no  flub
Word Clearing and  Qual  correction  actions  to  get  them  through,  being
successful and producing.


    Word Clearing is no minor technology to be  used  sometimes.  It  is  a
major technology which can make or break an Org.


      Revised by Ens. Judy Ziff
      CS-5
      In co-ordination with
      Flag Mission 1234
      I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow
      Commodore's Staff Aides
      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:mh rd     of the
Copyright �1973, 1974  CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              30 JANUARY 1973RA
Remimeo     Issue II
Word Clearers    Revised 29 December 1973
                         Reissued 5 July 1974 as BTB
                          Revised 20 November 1974

                                   CANCELS
                           BTB OF 30 JANUARY 1973R
                                  Issue II
                                 SAME TITLE

                        (Revision in this type style)


                         Word Clearing Series 46 RA



                                  METHOD 9



    Method 9 Word Clearing is CORRECTIVE  Word  Clearing,  as  compared  to
Method 7  which  is  EDUCATIONAL  Word  Clearing,  and  has  its  own  exact
procedure.


    Method 9 is done on any specific written text, usually by subject,  for
example, the C/S Series, the Data Series, or one or more PLs or HCO Bs on  a
related subject, for example, Listing and Nulling, Rudiments, or a  key  Hat
PL or PLs.


    The procedure is:

    1.      Student or staff member reads the text out loud. He is  not  on
        the meter.


    2.      The Word Clearer has a copy of the text and  reads  along  with
        the student silently.


    3.      If the student leaves out a word or stumbles  or  exhibits  any
        physical or verbal manifestation while reading the text,  the  Word
        Clearer immediately asks for the misunderstood  word  or  term  and
        gets the meanings cleared with a dictionary and put into  sentences
        until the word is understood and VGIs are present.


    4.      Student rereads the last section and   continues  the  text  to
        completion, picking up and handling  all  misunderstood  words,  as
        evidenced by verbal or physical manifestations.


    5.      Student or staff member is sent to Pc  Examiner  for  F/N  VGIs
        check. If no F/N VGIs, student or  staff  member  returns  to  Word
        Clearer to complete to F/N VGIs or WCCL, if required.


    6.      The text is now restudied by the student or staff member.

    Method 9 can be used before or after the fact of a flub.  For  example,
any upper level C/S  to get an OK to C/S should M9 the C/S  Series,  restudy
and starrate and do in clay as a basic action in Qual. Or an Auditor who  is
flubbing on Assessment gets M9 on the Assessment pack. Or a  Supervisor  who
is flubby gets M9 on key MCSC materials. In each case,  the  materials  word
cleared must be restudied and starrated.


    Word Clearers must be specifically and extensively drilled to do M9 (or
M7) so that they  can  read  a  text  and  pick  up  any  and  all  physical
manifestations at the same time. Only then  is  an  OK  to  do  M9  (or  M7)
issued.
The fact of having had material word cleared using a different  method  does
not prevent M9 being used. In fact, it would not  be  unusual  for  specific
material to be handled first with M6, then M9 then M4, if one wanted  to  be
very thorough.


    In order to ensure application, all Word Clearing must be followed by a
restudy of the materials word cleared. Word Clearing clears the material  so
it can now be studied and applied.


    Method 9 is extremely powerful and effective.


                                                   Ens. Judy Ziff
                                                   CS-5

                                                   As ordered by LRH

      Revised in co-ordination with
      Flag Mission 1234

                                                   I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                                   2nd: Molly Harlow

                                                   Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:mh.jh
Copyright � 1973, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              30 JANUARY 1973R
                                  Issue III
                         Reissued 5 July 1974 as BTB
                          Revised 20 November 1974
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                           BTB OF 30 JANUARY 1973
                                  Issue III
                                 SAME TITLE


                        (Revision in this type style)


                          Word Clearing Series 47 R


                       DIFFICULTIES WITH WORD CLEARING


    The first and major reason for difficulties in Word Clearing is failure
to immediately use a Word Clearing Correction List  at  the  first  hint  of
trouble.


    The second is Word Clearing over  the  fact  of  no  Method  One.  Word
Clearing can become lengthy until Method One is completed.


    Some people have severe difficulty with  all  forms  of  Word  Clearing
until a full and complete M1 with additional applicable subjects  added  and
fully handled. The symptom of a person requiring M1 or M1 Expanded would  be
approaching all forms of Word Clearing on a  "subject"  basis  and  handling
chains on each word approached. This  makes  these  shorter  forms  of  Word
Clearing very lengthy. This can happen on the PRD causing a bogged  or  very
slow student. He can be cleaned up  with  a  WCCL  in  Qual  followed  by  a
completed  Method  One.  If  this  doesn't  handle  it,  the  student  needs
additional correction or  the  Primary  Correction  Rundown.  Everyone  runs
better on all forms of Word Clearing when Method  One  is  fully  completed.
Others may require a full Primary Correction Rundown before they can  easily
tackle day to day Word Clearing, as is required in any Org.


    In some rare cases, there may be a misunderstood symbol in the alphabet
itself. M7, as the major undercut Word  Clearing  process,  may  require  an
undercut, by a direct address to the alphabet. This can easily  be  done  by
getting the person to rattle off the alphabet and handling  it  itself  with
M7, handling all letters on which a person has difficulty,  can't  remember,
stumbles on,  etc,  until  the  person  can  rattle  them  all  off  without
hesitation. The  full  New  World  Dictionary  contains  a  section  at  the
beginning of each letter, which may be of  assistance  in  cleaning  up  the
alphabet.


                            INTERRELATED USES OF
                                WORD CLEARING

    All forms of Word Clearing can be utilized to get a result. The fact of
using  one  form  does  not  mean  that  another  will   not   locate   more
misunderstoods.


    For example, a staff member could have M7 Word Clearing to improve  his
reading to an EP, then have M6 on the key words of his  post,  then  M7  the
one or two key PLs of his post, then study them and have a  final  M4  check
before starrating.


    Don't drop out M2 as one of the effective forms of  Word  Clearing.  It
has a specialized use on whole texts of materials or tapes. The clearing  of
first or earlier materials plays a key factor in  unlocking  some  PT  study
problems or situations. A
person will actually do better on M2 if he has done M7  on  a  general  text
first. In some cases, when the person's vocabulary is very poor, M7  has  to
be done before M1.


    USE ALL FORMS OF WORD CLEARING IN VOLUME AND EVERYBODY WILL WIN.


                                                   Ens. Judy Ziff
                                                   CS-5

                                                   As ordered by LRH

      Revised in co-ordination with
      Flag Mission 1234

                                                   I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                                   2nd: Molly Harlow

                                                   Commodore's Staff Aides

      Approved by the Board of Issues
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY

BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:JZ:mh.jh
Copyright � 1973, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               30 JANUARY 1973
                                  Issue IV
Remimeo
Word Clearers    Reissued 5 July 1974 as BTB
Staff C/S
                                   CANCELS
                       HCO BULLETIN OF 30 JANUARY 1973
                                  Issue IV
                                 SAME TITLE


                           Word Clearing Series 48


                      WORD CLEARING ON FOREIGN LANGUAGE
                           STUDENTS, PCS OR STAFF


    Very careful handling of foreign language students on Word Clearing  is
required.


    The first requirement is Method One in the person's basic language.  If
the person speaks several languages, or  lived  in  several  countries,  the
languages would be handled in the sequence they were encountered.


    To do Method One in English on a French person without first  doing  M1
in French is more or less a waste of time.  The  person  won't  make  it  in
English  until  the  earlier  misunderstoods  connected  with  the   earlier
language are fully handled.


    When Word Clearing a person  who  speaks  a  foreign  language,  it  is
imperative to have a proper dictionary in that language to hand. Do not  use
the  English/French  or  English/German  "dictionary"  for  it  is   not   a
dictionary but a reference manual only and does not contain full and  proper
definitions.


    The most charged language(s) will be that first learned and  that  used
in school.


    Obviously, it is best for a foreign language person to be audited on M1
by an Auditor who  speaks  the  same  language.  However,  if  one  was  not
available, it could be done by writing up the M1 list  phonetically  in  the
language concerned and running a standard M1, making sure that the Pc  keeps
the Auditor very well informed on the definitions in the dictionary.


    Foreign  language  students  on  Courses  are  usually  provided   with
translated tape courses. In this case, the full technology on handling  tape
courses and their repair must be fully applied. M2 and 4 on  tapes  must  be
set up for immediate handling in Tech and Qual.


    It could be also that a foreign language student  cannot  read  English
because of unhandled problems on reading  his  own  language  and  so  would
greatly benefit from an M7 on a reading text in his own language.


    If a foreign language student is studying an English text, he must have
an English and the foreign language dictionary to hand, so that if  he  runs
into difficulty on the English definition, he can check up  on  the  foreign
language  definition  difficulty,  straighten  that  one,  then  handle  the
English definition.


    We can get any student, Pc or staff member through IF we fully use  all
forms of
    Word Clearing fully.

      Ens. Judy Ziff, CS-5
      Reissued as BTB
      by Flag Mission 1234
      VC: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow
      Authorized by AW
BDCS:SW:AL:MH:JZ:mh.jh for the
Copyright �1973, 1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              30 JANUARY 1973 R
                                   Issue V
Remimeo     Reissued 4 July 1974 as BTB
Qual Sec    Revised 20 November 1974
Cr Offs
Word Clearers    CANCELS
                           BTB OF 30 JANUARY 1973
                                   Issue V
                                 SAME TITLE

                       (Revisions in this type style)

                          Word Clearing Series 49R

                       BUILD UP POWERFUL WORD CLEARERS

    It is essential to build up a powerful team of Word Clearers  in  order
to really honestly restore lost tech in an Org.


    Word Clearers are specialists in their area. They are Auditors who have
specialized in the application of the technology of Word Clearing, our  most
powerful repair tool!


    One makes Word Clearers in Tech  and  Qual  in  the  same  way  that  a
crackerjack Auditor is made in Tech.

1.    They study all materials on the subject, and  do  TRs  and  drills  on
    the individual actions on the Professional Word Clearer's Course in the
    Tech Division.

2.    They get a Qual OK to Audit to do individual Word Clearing actions.

3.    They get crammed every time they goof or red tag a Pc.

4.    They are handled per C/S Series 84.

5.    They  do  daily  TRs  along  with  all  Auditors  and  Tech  and  Qual
    personnel.

6.    They deliver volume no flub Word Clearing to be truly effective.

7.    They use a WCCL at the first sign of any trouble in Word Clearing.

    Word Clearers who are not Class III can be put  onto  Academy  Training
part-time and trained up to III or IV so they can then take  on  Method  One
and Word Clearing Correction List, specialized correction actions, e.g.  Int
Rundown Correction.


    Word Clearers must have excellent TRs or they will  miss  out  as  Word
Clearers and back off really finding the word  or  words  and  Quickie  Word
Clearing will creep  in.  Nothing  will  put  Word  Clearing  or  Qual  into
disrepute faster than Quickie Word Clearing, other than refusal  to  deliver
Word Clearing.


    Qual Secs and Tech Secs, handle your Word Clearers as the Auditors that
they are and build them up into a powerful team.


    Remember, there is no limit to how far an Org can go with  a  powerful,
effective Qual doing its job, and effective Word Clearers on courses and  in
Qual.

      Ens. Judy Ziff CS-S
      Revised in co-ordination with
      Flag Mission 1234
      I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
      2nd: Molly Harlow
                                        Commodore's Staff Aides
      Approved by the Board of Issues
BDCS:BofI:AL:MH:jz mh.jh     for the
Copyright � 1973,1974  BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
by L. Ron Hubbard      of the
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED    CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                              16 DECEMBER 1973
                        Reissued 19 July 1974 as BTB
Remimeo
Word Clearers    CANCELS
Course Supervisors     HCO BULLETIN OF 16 DECEMBER 1973
Cramming Officers      SAME TITLE


                           Word Clearing Series 51


                            WORD CLEARING ERRORS



    A way of quickying Word Clearing  has  sprung  up  from  time  to  time
whereby a word being looked up in the dictionary  is  incompletely  defined.
Example: The PRD Student who guesses at the context the word is used in  and
only looks up one of several definitions. As a Superliterate this person  is
later found to have trouble with study and checkouts  though  "certain"  she
knew what the words meant. Example: The M4 Word Clearer in Qual says,  "Look
at definition No. 5." The Student does and gets it  but  later  has  trouble
with the same word or HCO B due to incompletely defined words. Example:  The
PCRD Student who looks up words until she's "got the concept",  incompletely
defines half the words on the PCRD and  utterly  defeats  its  purpose,  and
hers.

                                  PROCEDURE

    In clearing words the Student looks up  every  definition,  using  each
meaning of the word in sentences until he's got  it.  When  all  definitions
have been cleared, the context of the sentence the  word  was  found  in  is
consulted and the Student chooses the definition that  applies  and  ensures
he understands it. At this point the word has been cleared, and not before.

                                     PRD

    This procedure applies especially to  the  PRD  where  the  context  is
unknown. The PRD can  be  made  to  fail  through  neglect  of  proper  Word
Clearing procedure. And that will cost us our  Study  Tech,  and  with  that
goes Scientology.


                                        W/O Ron Shafran
                                        Training & Services Aide

      Reissued as BTB by
      Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY
BDCS:SW:AL:MH:RS:mhjh
Copyright � 1973, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                B O A R D  T E C H N I C A L  B U L L E T I N

                               6 JANUARY 1974
                                   Issue I
Remimeo
Translator Word Clearer
Hats

                           Word Clearing Series 52




                          WORD CLEARING TRANSLATORS

              (Taken from LRH Taped Conference on 23 June 1971
                        concerning Tape Translations)



    It is often necessary that more  time  be  spent  in  word  clearing  a
translator than would normally be spent on a student.


    A translator is the  relay  point  between  LRH's  technology  and  the
foreign student. Therefore, it is doubly important that the translator  look
up everything he doesn't understand, and that he gets the  material  totally
straight in his head. Any misduplication on the part of the translator  will
result in mistranslations which will cause great confusion to  the  eventual
student.


    When word clearing a translator, it will normally  be  found  that  his
basic misunderstood will be from the time he started to learn the  language.
Something is very funny about learning foreign languages; it  won't  be  the
foreign language the person doesn't understand. It will be  the  grammatical
terms in their own language used to learn the foreign language.


    You could spend days, for example, working with a person who can't seem
to learn French; and then all of a sudden find out it wasn't a  French  word
he was having trouble with at all-it was "Subjunctive mode" or something  of
that sort.


    This works the same way for another language back into English.


    A word clearer could  go  on  forever  working  with  a  person  having
difficulty with English if he didn't know this one question:

1.    "What word in your own language that described how you  spoke  English
    didn't you understand?"

      This question is  asked  off  the  meter.  The  word  clearer  accepts
    whatever answer the translator gives.

2.    The word clearer has the translator look  up  the  words  found  in  1
    above in a simple grammar book in his own language. There may be one or
    two words, or there may  be  many.  The  word  clearer  gets  them  all
    thoroughly looked up and fully understood by the translator.

3.    If the translator cannot find  an  answer  to  the  question,  yet  is
    having difficulty, the word clearer should realize that there are words-
    unseen-misunderstood. Have the translator go through a simple  book  in
    his own language that teaches English, looking up every word he is  the
    least bit unsure of. Have him do this until  he  is  no  longer  having
    difficulty.
The above steps can be done for any languages the translator  may  speak  in
addition to English, if he is  multilingual.  Merely  substitute  the  other
language for "English" in the question.


    Optimumly, a translator should have full  Word  Clearing  Method  l  in
session to EP in his native language, English, and any  other  languages  he
may speak.


                                        Sherene Hull
                                        FMO 1248 I/C

                                        Taken from LRH Taped
                                        Conference of 23-6-71

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:LRH:SW:SH:jg.jh
Copyright � 1971, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 8 JULY 1974R
                                   Issue I
                            REVISED 24 JULY 1974
Remimeo

                          Word Clearing Series 53R

                       (Revisions in this type style)

                                CLEAR TO F/N

                (Word Clearing Series 32R has been corrected
                 as 32RA to require the F/Ning of all words
                      and forbids W/Cing on a high TA.)


    Do NOT try to Word Clear a person Method 1, 2 or 4 whose TA is high  at
session start. Use  standard  auditing  procedures  by  an  Auditor  of  the
required class to get the TA down to normal range.  (Usually  a  C/S  Series
53RG and handling.)


    If the TA is high at start of session one of course cannot F/N a TA  on
Word Clearing when it is high for some other reason.


    ALWAYS F/N a word being cleared on the meter. It may happen there is  a
chain and the word has to be earlier similared.  But  even  then,  when  the
chain is F/Ned, the words on the chain that didn't F/N must F/N.


    Example: A chemical type word reading.  Doesn't  F/N.  E/S  it  on  E/S
words, comes down to a lecture in school. The Mis-U  word  there  F/Ns.  Now
check the words touched while going E/S. Usually they just F/N.


    Do NOT do a lot of words to "Clean" and say the person has  been  "Word
Cleared". Cases are messed up because the Word  Clearing  may  be  over  out
rudiments or even out lists or out Int.


    A Word Clearing worksheet must show truthfully all words F/Ned.


                                   RED TAB

    Where a pc has been Word Cleared on the meter  without F/Ning  or  with
or to a high or low TA, THE WHOLE FOLDER MUST BE RED TABBED.


    W/Cing worksheets must go into the pc's folder, just as why finding and
touch assists and other auditing actions must be put in the folder.


    A pc red tabbed because of Word Clearing must  be  repaired  within  24
hours, as in the case of any other red tab.
                                  _________

    Stalled cases have been traced to Word Clearing errors. Repair of these
will get them going again.



LRH:nt.rd   L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1974 Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                      HCO BULLETIN OF 7 SEPTEMBER 1974
                (Adapted from LRH ED 178 INT of 30 May 1972)
Remimeo
All Staff
All Auditors
All Students
All Scientologists
                           Word Clearing Series 54




                     SUPERLITERACY AND THE CLEARED WORD




    SUPER-Superiority in size, quality, number or degree.


    LITERACY-The ability to read and write.


    Almost everyone these days is able to read and write. This was not true
a century ago but, with modern stress on education, it is true today.


    But is this enough today?


    It is an instruction book world. The civilization in which we  live  is
highly technical.


    Education today goes into the twenties.


    That's a third of one's life.


    And what happens when one leaves school?


    Can he do what he studied?


    Does he have all his education or did it get left behind?


    Literacy is not enough.


    Today's schools and today's world require a new ability-the ability  to
look at a page without any strain and absorb what it says and then apply  it
right now without any stress at all.


    And is that possible?


    Am I talking about speed reading?


    No. That is just being able to read rapidly. It does  not  improve  the
comfort of reading and it does not improve the ability to apply.


    What is really needed is the ability to COMFORTABLY  and  QUICKLY  take
data from a page and be able at once to APPLY it.


    Anyone who could do that would be SUPER-LITERATE.


    What happens?
The average person-literate-is  able  to  read  words  and  mentally  record
words.
                                    [pic]
                                    [pic]







And he thinks in concepts to which he can fit words easily and so can  write
clearly.


    In other words, when one is Super-Literate, one  reads  not  words  but
understandings. And so one can act.


                                  CONCEPTS

    The idea of grasping word meanings conceptually is something new to the
field of Linguistics. The endless Semantic circles pursued by Korzybski  and
company (see Data Series 1, "The Anatomy of Thought") never  really  led  to
the realization that a word and its  meanings  are  embodied  in  the  basic
concept or idea symbolized by that word.


    That conceptualization of meanings is foreign to dictionary writers and
"experts" is evidenced by the fact that definitions are so subject to alter-
is and change with the passage of time.
For example, modern definitions of the word "understand"  are  found  to  be
largely inadequate. A really full and  meaningful  definition  of  it  could
only be found in a First Edition of Webster's Dictionary of Synonyms, 1942:

        "Understand. To have a clear and true idea or conception,  or  full
        and exact knowledge, of something. In general it may be  said  that
        understand refers to the result of a mental process or processes (a
        clear and exact idea or  notion,  or  full  knowledge).  Understand
        implies the  power  to  receive  and  register  a  clear  and  true
        impression."

                                CLEARED WORDS

    Operating within a society steeped  in  misunderstood  words  and  mis-
definitions, Study Tech is subject to arbitraries. Thus, a CLEARED  WORD  is
defined as follows:


        A WORD WHICH HAS BEEN CLEARED  TO  THE  POINT  OF  FULL  CONCEPTUAL
        UNDERSTANDING.


    In Metered Word Clearing this translates as:

        F/N, VGIs.

    There are many ways and combinations to achieve this EP. Using the word
in sentences until the meaning is grasped conceptually is the  most  common.
Diagrams, demos, clay, in fact  the  entire  body  of  Study  Tech  and  its
methods are applicable.


    These are vital tools. For  use.  Protect  them  and  KEEP  SCIENTOLOGY
WORKING.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder

LRH:nt.rs.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED


















































                                 Art Series
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                       HCO BULLETIN OF 30 AUGUST AD15

Remimeo
Saint Hill Executives
Saint Hill Students
                                Art Series 1

                                     ART


    For some fifteen years I have been studying, amongst other branches  of
philosophy, the subject of ART.


    The reason for this is: Art is the least codified  of  human  endeavors
and the most misunderstood. What is Art? is  one of the  least  answered  of
human questions.


    Art abounds  with  authorities.  It  was  chosen  because  "that  field
containing the most authorities contains the least codified knowledge".  The
obvious invitation is to answer the question and codify  the  subject.  This
has now been done.


    The subject was originally brought up in a conversation with Donald  H.
Rogers at 42 Aberdeen Road, Elizabeth, New Jersey, in 1950.


    As this zone of human activity seemed to stand  outside  the  field  of
Dianetics and Scientology, I thereafter worked with it on a casual basis.


    Having published 15,000,000 words between 1929  and  1941,  I  was  not
unacquainted with the arts. Since 1950 I have worked with  other  arts  than
that of literature in order to make an advance on  the  general  subject  of
ART.


    I have made a breakthrough at last in this matter. And  I  find  it  is
applicable to what we are doing and therefore also has practical value.


    To make it a matter of record rather than a filed sheaf of notes, I  am
publishing these findings as an HCO B. I also feel  they  will  be  of  some
assistance in forwarding Scientology.


    As in the case of all "pure research" (by which is meant study  without
thought of possible application) there is a sudden pay-off in these  answers
including the better dissemination of Scientology and the rehabilitation  of
the artist.


    My incidental studies in the fields of photography and music materially
assisted these discoveries.


    Approaching the state of Clear has also assisted in comprehending  this
rather vast subject of ART. It is adventurous to state one has solved   such
a sweeping subject but here at least are the fundamentals and basics.


    The following are rough notes but are in fact the basis of that  branch
of activity we call ART.

                           THE FUNDAMENTALS OF ART

                              BASIC DEFINITION

    ART is a word which summarizes THE QUALITY OF COMMUNICATION.


    It therefore follows the laws of communication.
Too much originality throws the audience into  unfamiliarity  and  therefore
disagreement, as communication contains  duplication  and  "originality"  is
the foe of duplication.


    TECHNIQUE should not rise  above  the  level  of  workability  for  the
purpose of communication.


    PERFECTION cannot be attained at the expense of communication.


    Seeking perfection is a wrong target in art. One should primarily  seek
communication with it  and  then  perfect  it  as  far  as  reasonable.  One
attempts  communication  within  the  framework  of  applicable  skill.   If
perfection greater than that which can  be  attained  for  communication  is
sought, one will not communicate.


    Example: A camera that shoots perfectly but is not mobile enough to get
pictures. One must settle for the  highest  level  of  technical  perfection
obtainable below the ability to obtain the picture.


    The order of importance in art is:

    1.      The resultant communication,


    2.      The technical rendition.


    2 is always subordinate to 1. 2 may be as high as possible but never so
high as to injure 1.

    The communication is the primary target. The technical quality of it is
the secondary consideration. A person pushes 2 as high  as  possible  within
the reality of 1.


    A being can take a lot of trouble with 2 to achieve 1 but  there  is  a
point where attempting 2 prevents 1.


    If the ardures of 2 prevent 1, then modify 2, don't modify 1.


    Perfection is defined as the quality obtainable which still permits the
delivery of the communication.


    Too much time on 2 of course prevents 1.


    It is usually necessary to lower a standard from absolute perfection to
achieve communication. The test of the artist is how little  it  is  lowered
not how high it is pushed.


    A professional in the arts is one who obtains  communication  with  the
art form at the minimum sacrifice of  technical  quality.  There  is  always
some sacrifice of quality to communicate at all.


    The reduction of mass or time or impedimenta or facilities  toward  the
ability to render a result is the exact measurement of  how  much  technical
perfection  can  be  attempted.  The  rule  is   if   one   is   being   too
perfectionistic to actually achieve a communication, reduce the mass,  time,
impedimenta or facilities sufficiently low to accomplish  the  communication
but maintain the technique and perfection as high as  is  reconcilable  with
the result to be achieved and within one's power to act.


    No communication is no art. To not do the  communication  for  lack  of
technical perfection is the primary error. It is also an error not  to  push
up the technical aspects of the result as high as possible.


    One measures the degree of perfection to be achieved by the  degree  of
communication that will be accomplished.



This is seen even in a workman and tools. The workman who cannot  accomplish
anything but must have tools is an artistic failure.


    "Art for art's sake" is a complete paradox as a remark.  "Art  for  the
sake of communication" and "Attempted perfection without communicating"  are
the plus and minus of it all.


    One can of course communicate to oneself if one wishes to be both cause
and effect.


    One studies art only if one wishes to communicate and  the  search  for
artistic perfection is the result of past failures to communicate.


    Self-improvement is based entirely on earlier lack of communicating.


    Living itself can be an art.


    The search for freedom is either the  retreat  from  past  failures  to
communicate or the effort to attain new communication. To that  degree  then
the search for freedom is a sick or well impulse.


    Searching for and discovering one's past failures to communicate an art
form or idea about it will therefore inevitably rehabilitate the artist.


    However, due to the nature of the Reactive Mind, full rehabilitation is
achieved only through releasing and clearing.


    How much art  is  enough  art?  The  amount  necessary  to  produce  an
approximation of the desired effect on its receiver or beholder, within  the
reality of the possibility of doing so.


    A concept of  the  beholder  and  some  understanding  of  his  or  her
acceptance level is necessary to the formulation of a  successful  art  form
or presentation. This includes an approximation of what is familiar  to  him
and is associated with the desired effect.


    All Art  depends  for  its  success  upon  the  former  experience  and
associations of the beholder. There is no pure general form  since  it  must
assume a sweeping generality of former experiences in the beholder.


    Artists all, to a greater or lesser degree, need comprehension  of  the
minds and viewpoints of others in order to have their work  accepted;  since
the acceptability of a communication depends upon the mental composition  of
the receiver. Scientology then is a must for any artist if he would  succeed
without heartbreak.


    In any art form or activity one must conceive of the beholder (if  only
himself). To fail  to  do  so  is  to  invite  disappointment  and  eventual
dissatisfaction with one's own creations.


    An artist who disagrees thoroughly with the "taste"  of  his  potential
audience cannot  of  course  communicate  with  that  audience  easily.  His
disagreement  is  actually  not  based  on  the  audience  but   on   former
inabilities to communicate with such audiences or rejections  by  a  vaguely
similar audience.


    The lack of desire to communicate with an art form  may  stem  from  an
entirely different inability than the one supposed to exist.


    Professionals often get into such disputes on how to  present  the  art
form that the entirety becomes  a  technology,  not  an  art,  and,  lacking
progress and newness of acceptance, dies. This is probably the genus of  all
decline or vanishment of art forms.


     The idea of contemporary communication is lost. All old  forms  become
beset by technical musts and must nots and so cease to communicate. The  art
is the form that
communicates not the technology of how, the last contributing  to  the  ease
of creating the effect and preservation of the steps used  in  doing  it.  A
form's reach, blunted, becomes  involved  with  the  perfection  alone,  and
ceases to be an art form in its proper definition.


    A communication can be blunted by suppressing its  art  form:  Example,
bad tape reproduction, scratched film, releasing bits not  authorized.  This
then is the primary suppression.


    On the other hand, failing continuously  to  permit  a  non-destructive
communication on the grounds of its lack of art is also suppressive.


    Between these two extremes there is communication and the  task  is  to
attain the highest art form possible that can be maintained in  the  act  of
communicating. To do otherwise is inartistic and objectionable.


    These, therefore, are the fundamentals of ART.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD

LRH:Ml jh
Copyright � 1965
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 29 JULY 1973
Remimeo
                                Art Series 2

                               ART, MORE ABOUT
                         Ref: HCOB 30 Aug AD15, ART


    How good does a professional work of art have to be? This would include
painting, music, photography, poetry,  any  of  the  arts  whether  fine  or
otherwise. It would also include presenting oneself as an art form  as  well
as one's products.


    Yes, how GOOD does such a work of art have to be?


    Ah, you say, but that  is  an  imponderable,  a  thing  that  can't  be
answered. Verily, you say, you have just asked a question  for  which  there
are no answers except the sneers and applause of critics.  Indeed,  this  is
why we have art critics! For who can tell how good good is. Who knows?


    I have a surprise for you. There IS an answer.


    As you know, I searched for many years, as a sort of minor counterpoint
to what I was hardwork doing, to dredge  up  some  of  the  materials  which
might constitute the basis of art. Art was  the  most  uncodified  and  most
opinionated subject on the planet after men's ideas about women and  women's
ideas  about  men  and  Man's  ideas  of  Man.  Art  was   anyone's   guess.
Masterpieces have gone unapplauded, positive freaks have gained raves.


    So how good does a work of art have to be to be good?


    The painter will point out all the tiny technical details known only to
painters, the musician will put a score through the Alto  horn  and  explain
about valve clicks and lip, the poet will talk about meter types, the  actor
will explain how the position and wave of one hand per the  instructions  of
one school can transform a clod into an actor. And so it goes, art  by  art.
bit by bit.


    But all these people will be discussing  the  special  intricacies  and
holy mysteries of technique, the tiny things only the initiate of  that  art
would recognize. They are talking  about  technique.  They  are  not  really
answering how good a work of art has to be.


    Works of art are viewed by people. They are heard by people.  They  are
felt by people. They are not just  the  fodder  of  a  close-knit  group  of
initiates. They are the soul food of all people.


    One is at liberty of course to challenge that wide purpose of art. Some
professors who don't want rivals tell  their  students  "Art  is  for  self-
satisfaction" "It is a hobby." In other words,  don't  display  or  exhibit,
kid, or you'll be competition! The world  today  is  full  of  that  figure-
figure. But as none of this self-satisfaction art meets a definition of  art
wider than self for the sake of self, the professional is not interested  in
it.


    In any artistic production, what does one have as an audience?  People.
Not, heaven forbid, critics. But people. Not experts in that  line  of  art.
But people.


    That old Chinese poet who, after he wrote a poem, went down out of  his
traditional garret and read it to the flower-selling old lady on the  corner
had the right idea. If she understood  it  and  thought  it  was  great,  he
published. If she didn't he put it in the bamboo trash can. Not  remarkably,
his poems have come down the centuries awesomely praised.
Well, one could answer this now by just saying that art  should  communicate
to  people  high  and  low.  But  that  really  doesn't  get  the   sweating
professional anywhere as a guide in actually putting  together  a  piece  of
work and it doesn't give him a yardstick whereby he can say "That is  that!"
"I've done it." And go out with confidence that he has.


    What is technique? What is its  value?  Where  does  it  fit?  What  is
perfectionism? Where does one stop scraping off the paint and erasing  notes
and say "That is that"?


    For  there  is  a  point.  Some  artists  don't  ever  find   it.   The
Impressionists practically spun in as a group trying to develop  a  new  way
of viewing and communicating it. They made  it-or  some  of  them  did  like
Monet. But many of them never knew where to stop and they  didn't  make  it.
They couldn't answer the question "How good does a piece of  art  work  have
to be to be good?"


    In this time of century, there are many communication lines  for  works
of art. Because a few works of art can be shown so easily to so  many  there
may even be fewer artists. The competition is  very  keen  and  even  dagger
sharp. To be good one has to be very good. But in what way and how?


    Well, when I used to  buy  breakfasts  for  Greenwich  Village  artists
(which they  ate  hungrily,  only  stopping  between  bites  to  deplore  my
commercialism and bastardizing my talents for the  gold  that  bought  their
breakfasts) I used to ask this question and needless to say  I  received  an
appalling variety of responses. They avalanched me with  technique  or  lack
of it, they vaguely dwelt on inherent  talent,  they  rushed  me  around  to
galleries to show me Picasso or to a board  fence  covered  with  abstracts.
But none of them told me how good a song had to be to be a song.


    So I wondered about this. And a clue came when the late Hubert Mathieu,
a dear friend, stamped with  youth  on  the  Left  Bank  of  the  Seine  and
painting dowagers at the Beaux Arts in middle age, said to me "To do any  of
these modern, abstract, cubist things, you have to first be able to  paint!"
And he enlarged the theme  while  I  plied  him  in  the  midnight  hush  of
Manhattan with iced sherry and he finished up the First Lady of  Nantucket's
somewhat swollen ball gown. Matty could PAINT. Finally he dashed me  off  an
abstract to show me how somebody who couldn't paint would do it and  how  it
could be done.


    I got his point. To really make one of these too too modern things come
off, you first had to be able to  paint.  So  I  said  well,  hell,  there's
Gertrude Stein and Thomas Mann and ink splatterers like those. Let's see  if
it really is an art form. So I  sharpened  up  my  electric  typewriter  and
dashed off the last chapters of a novel in way far out acid  prose  and  put
THE END at the bottom and shipped it off to an editor  who  promptly  pushed
several large loaves down the telephone wire and had me to lunch and  unlike
his normal blase self said, "I really got a big bang (this was decades  ago,
other years, other slang) out of the way that story  wound  up!  You  really
put it over the plate." And it sent his circulation rating up. And this  was
very odd because you see the first chapters were straight since they'd  been
written before Matty got thirsty for sherry and called me to come  over  and
the last chapters were an impressionistic stream of consciousness that  Mann
himself would have called "an advanced rather adventurous  over-Finneganized
departure from the ultra school."


    So just to see how far this sort of thing could go, for a short while I
shifted around amongst various prose periods just to see what was going  on.
That they sold didn't prove too much because I never had  any  trouble  with
that. But that they were understood at all was surprising to  me  for  their
prose types (ranging from Shakespeare to  Beowulf)  were  at  wild  variance
with anything currently being published.


    So I showed them to Matty the next time he had a ball  gown  to  do  or
three chins to paint out and was thirsty. And he looked  them  over  and  he
said, "Well, you proved my  point.  There's  no  mystery  to  it.  Basically
you're a trained writer! It shows through."
And now we are getting somewhere, not just with me  and  my  adventures  and
long dead yesterdays.


    As time rolled on, this is what I began to see: The  fellow  technician
in an art hears and sees the small technical points. The artist  himself  is
engrossed in the exact application of certain exact actions  which  produce,
when done, his canvas, his score, his novel, his performance.


    The successful artist does these small things so well that he also then
has attention and skill left to  get  out  his  message,  he  is  not  still
fiddling about with the cerulean blue  and  the  semiquaver.  He  has  these
zeroed in. He can repeat them and  repeat  them  as  technical  actions.  No
ulcers. Strictly routine.


    And here we have three surrealist paintings. And they each  have  their
own message. And the public wanders by and they only look with awe  on  one.
And why is this one  different  than  the  other  two?  Is  it  a  different
message? No. Is it more popular? That's too vague.


    If you look at or listen to any work of art, there is  only  one  thing
the casual audience responds to en masse, and if this has it  then  you  too
will see it as a work of art. If it doesn't have it, you won't.


    So what is it?


    TECHNICAL EXPERTISE ITSELF ADEQUATE TO PRODUCE AN EMOTIONAL IMPACT.


    And that is how good a work of art has to be to be good.


    If you look this over from various sides, you will see that the general
spectator is generally unaware of technique.  That  is  the  zone  of  art's
creators.


    Were you to watch a crowd watching  a  magician,  you  would  find  one
common denominator eliciting uniform response. If he is a good  magician  he
is a smooth showman. He isn't showing them how he does  his  tricks.  He  is
showing them a flawless flowing performance. This  alone  is  providing  the
carrier wave that takes the  substance  of  his  actions  to  his  audience.
Though a far cry from fine art, perhaps, yet there is  art  in  the  way  he
does things. If he is good, the audience is  seeing  first  of  all,  before
anything else, the TECHNICAL EXPERTISE of his  performance.  They  are  also
watching him do things they know they can't do. And they  are  watching  the
outcome of  his  presentations.  He  is  a  good  magician  if  he  gives  a
technically flawless performance just in terms of scenes and  motions  which
provide the channel for what he is presenting.


    Not to compare Bach with a  magician  (though  you  could),  all  great
pieces of art have this one factor in  common.  First  of  all,  before  one
looks at the faces on the canvas or hears the meaning of the song, there  is
the TECHNICAL EXPERTISE there  adequate  to  produce  an  emotional  impact.
Before one adds message or meaning, there is this TECHNICAL EXPERTISE.


    TECHNICAL EXPERTISE is composed of all the little  and  large  bits  of
technique known to the skilled painter,  musician,  actor,  any  artist.  He
adds these things together in his basic presentation. He knows  what  he  is
doing. And how to do it. And then to this he adds his message.


    All old masters were in there nailing canvas on frames  as  apprentices
or grinding up  the  lapis  lazuli  or  cleaning  paintbrushes  before  they
arrived at the Metropolitan.


    But how many paintbrushes do you have to clean?  Enough  to  know  that
clean paintbrushes make clean color. How many clarinet reeds do you have  to
replace? Enough to know which types will hit high C.
Back of every artist there is technique.  You  see  them  groping,  finding,
discarding, fooling about. What are they hunting for? A new blue?  No,  just
a constant of blue that is an adequate quality.


    And you see somebody who can really paint still stumbling about looking
for technique-a total overrun.


    Someplace one says, "That's the TECHNICAL EXPERTISE adequate to produce
an emotional impact." And that's it. Now he CAN. So he  devotes  himself  to
messages.


    If you get this tangled up or backwards, the art does not have  a  good
chance of being good. If one bats out messages without a TECHNICALLY  EXPERT
carrier wave of art, the first standard of the many spectators seems  to  be
violated.


    The nice trick is to be a technician and retain one's  fire.  Then  one
can whip out the masterpieces  like  chain  lightning.  And  all  the  great
artists seem to have managed that. And when  they  forked  off  onto  a  new
trail they mastered the technique and then erupted with great works.


    It is a remarkable thing about expertise. Do you know that some artists
get by on "Technical expertise adequate  to  produce  an  emotional  impact"
alone with no messages? They might not suspect that. But it is true.


    So the "expertise adequate" is important enough to be itself art. It is
never great art. But it produces  an  emotional  impact  just  from  quality
alone.


    And how masterly an expertise? Not very masterly. Merely adequate.  How
adequate is adequate? Well, people have been  known  to  criticize  a  story
because there were typographical errors in the typing. And  stories  by  the
non-adept often go pages before anyone  appears  or  anything  happens.  And
scores have been known to  be  considered  dull  simply  because  they  were
inexpertly chorded or clashed. And a handsome actor has been  known  not  to
have made it because he never knew what to do with his  arms,  for  all  his
fiery thunderings of the Bard's words.


    Any art demands a certain expertise.  When  this  is  basically  sound,
magic! Almost anyone will look at it and say Ah! For quality  alone  has  an
emotional impact. That it is cubist or dissonant or  blank  verse  has  very
little bearing on it; the type of the art form is no limitation to  audience
attention generally when it has, underlying it  and  expressed  in  it,  the
expertise adequate to produce an emotional impact.


    The message  is  what  the  audience  thinks  it  sees  or  hears.  The
significance of the play, the towering clouds of sound in the symphony,  the
scatter-batter of the current pop group, are what the audience thinks it  is
perceiving and what they will describe, usually, or which  they  think  they
admire. If it comes to them with a basic expertise itself  able  to  produce
an emotional impact they will think it is great. And it will be great.


    The artist is thought of as enthroned in some special heaven where  all
is clean and  there  is  no  sweat,  eyes  half  closed  in  the  thrall  of
inspiration. Well maybe he is sometimes. But every one I've seen had ink  in
his hair or a towel handy to mop his brow or a throat spray in his  hand  to
ease the voice strain of having said his lines twenty-two times to the  wall
or the cat. I mean the great ones. The others were loafing  and  hoping  and
talking about the producer or the unfair art gallery proprietor.


    The  great  ones  always  worked  to  achieve  the  technical   quality
necessary. When they had it they knew  they  had  it.  How  did  they  know?
Because it was technically correct.


    Living itself is an art form. One puts up a mock-up. It doesn't  happen
by accident. One has to know how to wash his nylon shirts and girls have  to
know what mascara runs and that too many candy bars  spoil  the  silhouette,
quite in addition to the pancreas.
Some people are themselves a work of art  because  they  have  mastered  the
small practical techniques of living that give them a  quality  adequate  to
produce an emotional impact even before anyone  knows  their  name  or  what
they do.


    Even a beard and baggy pants require a certain art if they  are  to  be
the expertise adequate to produce an emotional impact.


    And some products produce a bad misemotional impact without fully being
viewed. And by this reverse logic, of which you can think of  many  examples
such as a dirty room, you can then see  that  there  might  be  an  opposite
expertise, all by  itself,  adequate  to  produce  a  strong  but  desirable
emotional impact.


    That is how good a work of art has  to  be.  Once  one  is  capable  of
executing that technical expertise for that art form  he  can  pour  on  the
message. Unless the professional form is there first, the message  will  not
transmit.


    A lot of artists are overstraining to obtain a quality far  above  that
necessary to produce an emotional  impact.  And  many  more  are  trying  to
machine gun messages at the world without any expertise at all to  form  the
vital carrier wave.


    So how good does a piece of art have to be?


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                        Founder




LRH:nt.mh
Copyright � 1973
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 10 APRIL 1974
Remimeo


                                Art Series 3



                                STAGE MANNERS



    An actor, performer or musician should have a good command of  what  is
called "Stage Manners".


    While it is not possible here to give a full text on the subject, these
basics should suffice.

1.    The performer purpose is basically Communication.

    (a)     To Communicate one must have R (Reality)-which is  to  say  one
        must be visible.


    (b)     To Communicate one must have R that there is an audience  there
        to be Communicated to.


    (c)     A  degree  of  Affinity  with  or  for  the  audience  must  be
        physically expressed. (One cannot treat an audience with  contempt,
        for instance.) (A perpetual smile is not a must, a respectful look,
        a friendly look does as well.)

    If you look over the above ABCs you will see that the general basic  of
Stage Manners is the ARC Triangle. From this almost  anything  else  can  be
derived.


    However, there are some traditional rules.

    I.      You accept  applause. This is the contribution of the audience.
        You do not cut it off.  You  acknowledge  it  with  bows  or  other
        physical actions. But you accept  it. You don't dodge it.


    II.     You never turn your back on the audience. (An exception  is  an
        actor in play stage situations.) You turn in such a way as to  turn
        facing the audience. You do not turn the other way  around  and  so
        give them your back.


    III.    Never express embarrassment or stage fright even when you  feel
        it. Force yourself into a physical  appearance  and  expression  of
        poise.


    IV.     If you goof, ride  right  over  it.  Do  not  break  off,  call
        attention to it or look helpless or foolish. Just ride  right  over
        it and go on.


    V.      If you do not know what to do with your hands or feet, don't do
        anything with them. Avoid twisting your feet or legs  or  hands  or
        arms around. Don't fiddle with things. Be positive in motion.


    VI.     During breaks or silent periods remember you are still on stage
        and Stage Manners still apply.


    VII     Always appear to be in control of the place and the audience.
        VIII     Never let your poise be shattered by  a  sudden  surprise.
        Ride over it and handle.


    IX.     A performer DOMINATES an audience:

            (a)  By his comm,

            (b)  By his art,

            (c)  By his technical perfection,

      (d)   By his Stage Manners.

    None of this means that one cannot clown, joke, act  superior  or  even
seem austere. These are the arts of  presence.  But  even  in  doing  these,
Stage Manners are observed.


    If as a small child one was always  cautioned  about  his  manners  and
resented it one should get a clear idea of what manners are:


    In a culture manners are the lubrication that  ease  the  frictions  of
social contacts.


    On the stage, Stage Manners are the means of smoothing the problems  of
interchange between audience and performer.


    The hallmark of  the  professional  performer,  next  to  his  art  and
expertise, is flawless Stage Manners.


    Stand before a full-length mirror. (Or  use  Video  Tape.)  Assume  the
postures of your act. Accept  applause  gracefully.  Bow  gracefully.  Smile
pleasantly. Laugh. Be  dignified.  Demonstrate  poise.  Assume  the  posture
needed for a non-applauding audience. Ride out boos. Demand  more  applause.
Do the postures to end your performance after applause.  Accept  a  standing
ovation. Deplore not being able to give an encore. Appear at the  start  for
a first part of a performance. Assume  the  postures  and  poise  needed  on
stage during a one minute break between numbers.  Accept  a  plaque.  Accept
flowers. Ride over a bad goof.  Be  respectful  to  the  audience.  Kid  the
audience out of it. Do each one of the IX rules. AND ALL  WITHOUT  SAYING  A
WORD. Do it with physical motions or lack of them.


    When you can do all these things and look right to  yourself  and  feel
easy about them you will have and be confident of your Stage Manners.


                                             L. RON HUBBARD
                                             Founder


LRH:ntm.rd
Copyright � 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
                        HUBBARD COMMUNICATIONS OFFICE
                  Saint Hill Manor, East Grinstead, Sussex

                        HCO BULLETIN OF 25 APRIL 1974
Remimeo
                                Art Series 4

                                   RHYTHM


    RHYTHM: Any kind of movement characterized by the regular recurrence of
strong and weak elements. Rhythm denotes the  regular  patterned  flow,  the
ebb and rise of sounds and movement in speech, music, writing, dance and  in
other physical activities. Meter basically means measure and  applies  to  a
system or pattern of measured recurrence  of  length,  beat  or  numbers  in
poetry or music.


                               TYPES OF MUSIC
                                   RHYTHM

    There are SIX distinct types of rhythm in music. These are:


    REGULAR: Meaning the evenly accented (stressed) beat.


    SYNCOPATED: The placing of upbeats along with downbeats at  regular  or
irregular intervals.


    STOPPED: In a stopped rhythm there are regular distinct  halts  to  the
flow of melody, but all the beats  are  there,  they  are  simply  regularly
halted for an interval. (The term comes from choreography as in tap  dancing
where the dancer taps fill the stops.)


    ACCENTED: Where one or more beats in  a  measure  received  a  stronger
stress (beat) or  accent.  Accent  in  a  rhythm  can  be  done  by  volume,
duration, pitch or tone quality (timbre).


    OMITTED BEAT: The regular omission of one or more  beats  in  measures.
Time may have to be counted over two or more measures in order to  regularly
omit. (Soul, Motown. )


    ADDED BEAT: Additional strong or, generally, weak beats  are  added  to
the rhythm in a consistent or inconsistent manner. (Bongos, Congas, etc.)


                                    USAGE

    Any and all rhythms are made up of the six basics above.  One,  two  or
more can be employed in complex patterns.


                                 REPETITION

    Rhythm is rhythm because of repetition (recurrence).


                                   RAPPORT

    RAPPORT: Relationship, especially, one of mutual trust or affinity.


    An audience in rapport is different than an audience of spectators.


    An audience in rapport PARTICIPATES in small or  large  ways  with  the
performer or the artist or work of art, often by vocal or body motion.
Such participation is achieved by:


    1.      Reliance on the even recurrence of the rhythm.


    2.      Ability to predict it will recur.


    3.      Formation of agreement by such reliable prediction.


    4.      Permitting the audience to fill gaps or significances.  Regular
        omission of a beat or step or full explanation causes the  audience
        to fill it for themselves  and  brings  about  physical  or  mental
        participation.


                                   RHYTHM

    All life is a repeating pulse and ebb and surge of motion.


    Life becomes difficult when rhythmic prediction cannot  occur.  Anxiety
sets in. It is a relief to participate  in  predictable  rhythm  in  an  art
form. It is safe and reassuring. If  the  rhythm  is  exciting  it  is  also
exciting. Therefore participation in  predictable  rhythm  is  pleasure  and
even joy.

                                 IMPINGEMENT

    When one changes rhythm within a single work one "makes wrong"  because
the person has predicted the rhythm but the prediction is not met.  Thus  he
is wrong. If the rhythm recurs, the person is made right.


    A new rhythm attracts attention. If it is agreed  with  and  recurs  it
gets participation.

                                  ART FORMS

    The above materials, while written from the viewpoint of  music,  apply
to any art form.


    Even prose has a rhythm. Not all rhythms are pleasant or acceptable.


    Many ways exist to utilize these observations on  rhythm-i.e.  one  can
begin an unwanted rhythm, using the audience objection to impinge  and  then
turn it into a wanted rhythm.


    As life itself is going through time and as time  is  recurrence,  some
rhythms are too dull to attain any attention.


    Rhythm, used in art forms, must therefore slow or speed or  change  the
expected rhythms of ordinary life in order to command attention.


    Rhythm can sooth, lull, excite, arouse to any point  of  the  emotional
tone scale.


    A rhythm one half to one tone below  the  usual  rhythm  in  life  will
depress or degrade an audience.


    A rhythm one half to one tone above the usual rhythm will dominate  and
interest.


    Rhythm and its expression is the basic key to all art forms.


LRH:ntm.rd  L. RON HUBBARD
Copyright � 1974 Founder
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
               B O A R D   T E C H N I C A L   B U L L E T I N

                                7 APRIL 1972R
                   Revised & Reissued 23 June 1974 as BTB
                        (Revision in this type style)
Remimeo
                                   CANCELS
                        HCO BULLETIN OF 7 APRIL 1972
                                 SAME TITLE


                                TOUCH ASSISTS
                                CORRECT ONES


    Touch Assist Bulletins are right enough as to the data  in  them.  Many
were written by others than myself.


    Accordingly, to correct certain outnesses and GET  REAL  RESULTS  EVERY
TIME, I gave a correct demonstration to the Medical Officers at  Flag.  They
were also told by someone else it needed a Case Supervisor clearance and  by
another that it had to be known by a Class IV Auditor. Both  of  these  data
were false and were cancelled.


    Being alerted now that students learning it do it all over a doll  with
no idea of balance, I wish to make sure the correct data is  known  so  this
tech, very powerful when CORRECTLY DONE, is better understood  as  to  exact
use.


    I know no better way of giving the real  scene  than  publishing  these
correct notes by one of the Medical  Officers  who  took  notes  during  the
demonstration.


           TALK BY LRH TO FLAG MEDICAL OFFICERS ON TOUCH ASSISTS,
                             WITH DEMONSTRATION


    On assists when you are speaking with medicos you talk to them in terms
of restoring comm in blood and nerve channels.


    I've recently observed nobody does a correct touch assist. Hence I want
to show you how to get real results.


    Normal errors in a touch assist are: (1) Don't go to  extremities,  (2)
Don't equal balance to both sides, (3)  Don't  carry  through  (they  go  to
release point only), (4) Don't repeat on following days if needed.


    A guy stubs a toe, the other toe is where it is locked up.


    There is a balance of the nerve energy of the body on 12 nerve channels
going up and down the spine. The type of energy in the body  travels  at  10
ft a second.


    The energy from a shock will make a standing wave in the body.


    The brain is a shock cushion, that is all. It absorbs the shock from  a
large amount of energy. The neuron-synapse is a disconnection.


    A wave one way will  have  a  wave  reacting  the  other  way.  In  the
sympathetic system the wave locks up on  both  sides  of  the  body.  So  do
assist thoroughly on both sides. Get both sides and  unlock  standing  wave.
The purpose of a touch assist is to  unlock  the  standing  waves  that  are
small electronic ridges of nervous energy that is not flowing as it should.


    You can unlock an impulse in the leg and it can get into spine and lock
up. So this is where you get the Chiropractor fixing people. But the  nerves
are "telling the muscles" to hold the bone out of place.
A shock puts, via the nerves, a permanent command into  a  set  of  muscles,
all different "commands" going out from  the  shock.  The  system  functions
through stops to try to hold that shock back. It's actually nerve to  muscle
to bone.


    Light massage along nerve channels will get muscles unlocked to  permit
bone to go in place. You unlock nerve channels.


    The trick is standing waves. The wave is slowed down as it goes through
body, like at each joint. There are brain cells at each joint absorbing  the
shock.


    Inertia-when enough heavy charge goes through a nerve it stops  passing
the charge through and just builds it up. A  touch  assist  will  bring  the
flow back and the  suspended  pain,  cold,  electrical  charges  and  muscle
command will blow through.


    Shock impulse goes tearing down nerve in huge volume, all  accumulating
nodules of standing waves all over body, trying to stop the  nerve  impulse.
The nerve goes into apathy with the huge volume  of  impulse.  Like  100,000
volts of electricity over a small wire, something goes.


    With auditing you are bringing back the nerve "from apathy" up  through
the tone scale. Like getting apathy of nerve up through the pain  explosion.
So the touch assist is short sessioned and always balanced.


    At first you might just get an awareness of the area, then maybe  after
the 3rd or 4th assist (third or fourth day or many more days with  one  done
each day) there is a large jolt that will go through.


    The comm cycle is not as important in the touch assist as  it  is  with
thetan auditing. But it must be present. Here we are dealing with the  body.
You do give the command, get an answer  from  the  patient  and  acknowledge
each time.

THE ASSIST DEMO done on Arthur Hubbard

    (Arthur had a wound on his right  foot  right  side  at  ball  of  foot
location, wound not healing quickly.)


    You want to get the guy where he is available. (Arthur was  sitting  on
chair with legs straight and feet on LRH's knees [one foot  on  each  knee],
and Arthur's hands palms down  on  his  shins.  Arthur  was  comfortable-LRH
asked about his comfort.)


    The target of all this touch assist is the pain in  the  wound  in  the
side of the foot. The extremity is the top end of the big  toe.  Both  hands
and especially finger tip are also extremities. It's a sympathetic system.


    On the assist you must go to corresponding extremities.


    (R factor) I'm going to touch  you  like  this  (LRH  touched  Arthur's
foot). When you feel it well tell me, okay? Okay.


    Feel my finger.  Yes  (Arthur).  Good  (LRH).  This  was  done  rapidly
alternating from one side of body to other, one command and answer  and  ack
for each touch; assist done on each toe back and forth left  to  right,  one
for one touch on one side, touch on other side. Up foot, each toe,  over  to
hands, left hand to right hand,  one  touch  for  one.  This  was  done  for
several minutes.


    LRH then had Arthur bend over to get to the spine. Arthur said  he  had
some numbness in the lower spine when LRH asked about this  area.  LRH  then
did the spine touching 3 inches from spine on one side then to three  inches
on the other side alternately, up the head and around the neck and head.


    LRH asked, "How's that?" Arthur said, "Better," gave cognition on pants
being same ones he had on during accident, and LRH ended off.
SPINE

    Arthur during assist had numbness in kidney  back  area.  This  is  the
midpoint between the extremities on the sympathetic system.  In  the  future
if the assist hadn't been done he might have had kidney trouble.


    The impulse locks up in the spine, so you have to do the spine  too  to
release that charge.

EXTREMITY

    The extremity is beyond the point of the body injury.  Really  handling
the extremity furthest from the injury, the legs, would  strip  the  blocked
energy out (if you get the extremity). (During the assist  LRH  did  not  do
the legs, or arms, only toes, feet, hands, fingers and back.)

      "The way you run the touch assist is
                 give the command
            then touch.
      "Do not touch and then give the command as it's backwards.
      "This requires a drill
            'Feel my finger.'
                 Then touch a point"

                       LRH

SCHOOLS OF HEALING

    The thing that's wrong with each school of healing is that it  says  it
can do the job totally. It can't. An example of this is  a  Swedish  masseur
saying he can cure a person. But in addition to massage,  let  us  say,  the
person doesn't eat. It's not part of the cure, so doesn't cure.


    The doctor's bug is diagnosis. He is even setting up a computer  system
in the country to figure out what is with the person. But  they  don't  have
logic or the Data Series to program from so they won't make it.


    There is a big hole in Adele Davis's book on dieting. She doesn't  talk
enough about iodine on diets, but  that  is  what  activates  thyroid  which
burns up the food. So her reducing diets don't always reduce.


    If you block out the fields of knowledge you won't get anywhere.


    To cure things a doctor should use  a  number  of  things  (schools  of
healing) and do each one right.


    Regard body with a question mark in your mind.


    There is a "brain" at each joint. This is why  acupuncture  works.  One
can paralyze a whole body area with it  by  touching  these  minor  "brains"
with a needle. It can do other things as well if you know how.

MESMERISM

    Mesmerism is no relation to  hypnotism  at  all.  Mesmerism  is  animal
magnetism. It's a physiological rapport. Not a concentration on  mental  but
on mental-physiological.


    To have rapport with something you can be it.
Hypnotism is the reduction and absorption of mental power of the person.  In
hypnotism one takes over the person. The subject has no control.


    When doing physical healing, if you stroke sympathetically (both sides)
alternately  inducing  a  rhythmic  motion  which  is  monotonous,  you  can
mesmerize a person.


    In Mesmerism there is an imposition on  feeling.  If  you  mesmerize  a
person and pinch your back, he will get red in the same place and  feel  the
pain of the pinch. This is physiological rapport. No words are  said  during
mesmerism.


    In assists you don't want rapport;  avoid  a  rhythm;  on  stroking  in
massages keep person talking; keep him saying  Yes  and  you  acking  in  an
assist. Keep him in comm with you. That is why you use the  comm  cycle,  or
else all feeling can go out of the body. The comm cycle prevents a  mesmeric
trance occurring that would leave the patient in rapport.


    Rapport is mutual feelingness.


    In an assist (1) Keep talking, (2) Break rhythms, (3) End off. This  is
important.


    Mesmerism is the transfer of the  feeling  and  fault  of  operator  to
patient. A woman doing massages quietly and  rhythmically  could  be  giving
her patient her disjointed hip. A doctor with  bad  eyesight  can  make  his
patients worse or vice versa possibly, if  he  had  good  eyesight,  patient
could get good eyesight.


                                        Notes of Flag Medical Officer

      Amended & Reissued as BTB by
      Flag Mission 1234

                                        I/C: CPO Andrea Lewis
                                        2nd: Molly Harlow

      Authorized by AVU
      for the
      BOARDS OF DIRECTORS
      of the
      CHURCHES OF SCIENTOLOGY


BDCS:SW:AL:MH:JD:mes.mh.rd
Copyright � 1972, 1974
by L. Ron Hubbard
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED


                                SUBJECT INDEX

                               AUDITING SERIES


                             art(s) (cont.)
                             A          general spectator is generally
unaware of tech                                          nique; that is
zone of art's creators, 495
aberration(s), aberrate,          least codified of human endeavors and
most mis-
      are hard to keep, one has to work at it, 65             understood,
489
      basis of, is a non-confront, 309, 310        living itself can be
an art, 491
      is a chain of vias based on a primary non-confront,           no
communication is no art, 490
            310              originality, too much can be a liability,
489, 490
      training,howitcande-aberrate,310       perfection, defn., quality
obtainable which still
      why looking at or recognizing source of ~ in pro-
permits delivery of communication, 490
            cessing "blows" it, makes it vanish, 310
professional form must be there first, or the mes
acknowledgement cycle, 69               sage will not transmit, 497
acknowledgements, premature, result of, 78         professional in arts
is one who obtains communi
actor, "stage manners", 498             cation with art form at minimum
sacrifice of
administration,              technical quality, 490
      defn., formation and handling of lines and termi-       quality
alone has an emotional impact, 496
            nals involved in production, 3, 5            quality and
form, 496
      auditing requires administration, 5          technique should not
rise above level of worka
      auditor admin cramming, 113            bility for purpose of
communication, 490
      auditor administration,what it includes, 3         to be good must
have technical expertise itself
      auditor's responsibility for , 3             adequate to produce an
emotional impact, 495
      cramming, 96           works of, are soul food of all people, 493
      details in folder, 21  artist(s)('s),
      personnel need TRs and drilling as much as tech         how to
rehabilitate, 491
            personnel, 118        must work to be good at it, 496
Advance (Return) Program, defn., major actions to be          relation to
his audience, 491
            undertaken to get case back on Class Chart        Scientology
is amust, if hewould succeed without
            from wherever he has erroneously gotten to on
heartbreak, 491
            it; written on blue sheet, 27          technically flawless
performance provides channel
      repair while doing, 27            for what he is presenting, 495
AEI Treble Assessment(s), 252, 256      artistic perfection, search for,
is result of past failures
alteration(s), 426                to communicate, 491
      at the bottom of all alteration of meaning or      artistic
production, one has an audience of people,
            action is a misunderstood word, 426               not
critics, 493
APA, American Personality Analysis; see OCA/APA    assess, auditor has to
have impingement on pc to, 224
application, what can prevent, 472      assessment,
aptitude, relation to misunderstood definitions, 394          Dianetic
assessment list; see Dianetic assessment
ARC break(s), ARC broken, 268; see also rudiments             list
      defn., A-affinity, R-reality, C-communication, a        list, you
don't begin, until you get an F/N, 224
            break in any one of the three which has caused
Method 6 is a method of ~ used in Cl XII auditing
            upset in the past, 430                 where each question on
list is assessed by look     high percentage of ARC breaks occur because
of               ing at pc and asking him directly, 180
            failure to understand pc, 76           Treble Assessment,
AEI, 256
      never touch ARC breaks on a high TA, 224     attitude, C/S and
auditor, 5
      overt, ~, problem, relation between, 275     attitudes are after
the fact of an evil purpose in a
      overt, leaving overt touched on case and calling it
psycho case, 149
            clean will cause a future ~ with auditor, 268     audience,
basics of appearing before, 498
      pc ARC broken, how to check for M/W/Hs, 282  audience in rapport is
different than an audience of
art(s), defn., a word which summarizes the quality of
spectators, 500
            communication, 489    audit, auditing,
      audience, art for self-satisfaction vs. audience,       defn., an
action by which wrongnesses can be
            493                   deleted from case to degree that
rightnesses are
      communication, art follows the laws of, 489             present in
session, 83
      communication is primary target, 490         defn., a series of
methods arranged on an increasing form or activity, one must conceive of
the be-                ly deep scale of bringing pc to confront the no
holder, 491                  confront sources of his aberrations and
leading
      forms, rhythm in, 501             him to a simple, powerful,
effective being, 310
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


audit, auditing (cont.)      auditor(s)('s) (cont.)
      administration, auditing requires, 5         handwriting, how to
handle, 44
      as reach and withdraw, 64         impingement on pc, auditor has to
have, to assess,
      audit perfectly, what it means, 66                 224
      bad, running out, 251        Integrity List, 300
      basic auditing is called basic auditing because it      is a real
auditor when his or her pcs don't overtalk
            goes prior to the technique, 64              or undertalk but
answer auditing question and
      command; see command              happily now and then originate,
79
      communication cycle, 69, 73        "letting the pc itsa", cure for,
79
            additives on auditing comm cycle are any          line to
thepc, what's-it line, 68
                  action, statement, question or expression         must
look at rightnesses of pc, not just wrong     given in addition to TRs
04, 81                 nesses, 82
            no additives are permitted on, 81            never repeats
anything pc says after him, no mat cycle, six communication cycles which
make up                ter why, 75
            one auditing cycle, 71           not in comm with pc means no
cognition, 66
      difficulties are difficulties of the communication      pc and ~ as
two pole system to as-is mass, 63
            cycle, 63        pcs and auditors get into a games condition
only
      don't drive in pc's anchor points by shoving things
when auditor refuses help to pc, 283
            at or gesturing toward pc, 76          pc's somatics, auditor
doesn't get, 63
      fundamental of ~ is communication cycle, 64        plus pc versus
bank is a lot more than the bank,
      goes in two stages: form a communication line; do             when
auditor is part of a third dynamic, 6
            something for the pc, 65         repeating not only does not
show pc he heard but
      is a team activity, 5             makes him feel auditor is a
circuit, 75
      muzzled, defn, using only TR 0, 1, 2, 3 and 4 by        Report
Form; see Auditor's Report Form
            the text, 81          response when he doesn't understand pc,
75
      reports of whatever type of action are simply filed
session, auditor is responsible for, 75
            chronologically in current HGC folder, 14         steering
pc, 283
      rightness, degree of rightness present must exceed      training is
not only for professional auditors, 434
            wrongness you are going to pick up, 83       TRs, auditor who
can't do his TRs can't audit, 78
      wrongnesses, auditing is only trying to find, in
TRs,auditorwithlowhoursneeds, 102
            order to increase rightnesses, 83            who tries to
make pc guilty is violating Clause 15
auditor(s)('s), defn, listener or one who listens             of
Auditor's Code, 272
            carefully to what people have to say; person      working
alone, decline of, 6
            trained and qualified in applying Scientology
worksheets,44
            processes to others for their betterment, 3  Auditor's Report
Form, 39, 40
      administration (admin), defn, 3        defn, outline of what
actions were taken during
            cramming, 113               session, made out at end of each
session, 10
            responsibility for admin, 3      commands are written out in
full on, 42
      attitude, 5, 285 authorities, that field containing the most ~
contains
      attitude on Integrity Processing, 285              the least
codified knowledge, 489
      auditor's C/S, defn, sheet on which auditor writes awareness, defn,
ability to perceive existence of, 346
            the C/S instructions for next session, 10, 29
      basics: metering, TRs, understanding of Auditor's
            Code, basic theory of human mind, strict
            B
            honesty and honor as an auditor, 91
      can't control pc, cure for, 80    backtrack, preclears who won't
go, reasons for, 251
      causes a restimulation and then pc needs to answer bad indicator;
see indicator, bad
            question to get rid of restimulation, 69     basic auditing;
see auditing, basic
      command, auditor must know when pc has fin-  Basic Program, defn,
laid out in Classification and
            ished answering, 73              Gradation Chart, 27
      comm cycle, auditor watches pc's comm cycle;
beingness,insistenceonrightnessisalastrefugeof,249
            auditor's own is perfect, 73     being, recognition of
rightness of, 82
      comm line to pc, process doesn't work until  being, when you add
something to the being he gets
            auditor has a, 66                worse, 82
      crammingauditors,90, 112    blow, defn, unauthorized departure from
an area,
      does not grade his own session, 29                 usually caused
by misunderstood data or overts,
      evaluation-auditor repeating what pc says, 75                 312
      flaws show up glaringly only on rough pcs, 224          only reason
anyone has ever left Scientology is
      goofing, what it means regarding training, 398
because people failed to find out about them,
      group, advantages of being part of, 6              282
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


body, nerve system, 502      children or foreign language persons or
semiliterates,
bogged, Qual tools to handle a bogged or failed stu-                use
Word Clearing Method 7, 463
            dent, 452  Chinese School, 318, 319
books, Word Clearing Method 4 of, 466   chopping pc's communication, 70
"brain" at each joint, 504   circuits, all valences are circuits are
valences, 284
brain is a shock cushion, 502     circuits key out with knowingness, 284
briefing tape, defn, tape designed for a special and in- Classification
and Gradation Chart, Basic Program is
            formed audience, 366, 438              laid out in, 27
                             Class Vlll C/S-6 list, 251
                             clay table, 355
                             C    cleaning cleans, commonest cause of
failure in run                                           ning overt acts,
268
case; see also preclear      cleaning cleans, how to prevent, 268
      fundamental entrance to, 64 cleared word(s), 486
      gain,                  super-literacy and the cleared word, 483
            drugs prevent, 325    clearing lists and R3R, 129
            morale, case gain and, 275  coaching to a no win, 91
            preclears itsa on and on and on and on with no    cognition
and flattening of process, 67
                  gain, cause of, 77    cognition, auditor not in comm
with pc means no
            preclears who roller-coaster (regularly lose
cognition, 66
                  gains) are PTS, 136   color flashes, preclear folder
tape, 13
      post flubs, do not buy case reasons as Whys, 117   command, each
word of, is cleared before clearing
      withholds, case with, will not clear, 270               command as
whole, 42
Case Progress Sheet, 17, defn, sheet which details command, is pc ready
to receive it, 70
            levels of processing and training pc has     commands are
written out in full on Auditor's Report
            achieved; lists incidental rundowns and set-up
Form, 42
            actions pc has had, 9,16    communicate, communication,
Case Supervisor(s),          ability to communicate precedes ability to
handle,
      attitude, 5                 314
      cramming C/S l/T, 113       art follows the laws of communication,
489
      cramming cycles and the C/S, 108       art is a word which
summarizes the quality of,
      Cramming Officer to report the real Why to C/S,               489
            108        breakdowns in session, auditor has to assume re
cramming Supervisor and C/S, 90              sponsibility for all, 75
      folders, how C/S can tell if he has all, 14        chopping pc's
communication, 70
      key points C/S looks for on Integrity Processing,       cycle(s),
defn, cause, distance, effect with inten           289
 tion, attention, duplication and understand       misunderstoods from
worksheets, 44                     ing, 71
      must insist on good legible handwriting of audi-
auditing comm cycle; see auditing communica              tors, 44
             tion cycle
      responsibility of, regarding programs, 27               fundamental
of auditing is ~, 64
      worksheet must communicate to C/S what actions                in
auditing, 73
            were taken during session, 42                magic of, 63
charge blows off bank to degree that it's confronted                must
exist before technique can exist, 64
            and this is represented by itsa line, 68                pc's
results will go to hell on an additive comm
checklist, defn, list of actions or inspections to ready
 cycle, 81
            an activity or machinery or object for use or
six comm cycles which make up one auditing
            estimate needful repairs or corrections, 311
 cycle, 71
checkout, 355, defn, action of verifying a student's                use
of in Touch Assist, 505
            knowledge of an item given on a checksheet, 311
within the auditing cycle, 69
      High Crime checkouts, 99          is simply a familiarization
process based on reach
      zero rate, defn, material which is only checked               and
withdraw, 64
            out on basis of general understanding, 312        lines
depend upon reality and communication and
checksheet, defn, list of materials, often divided into
affinity and where an individual is too de   sections,thatgive the theory
and practical steps               manding the affinity tends to break
down
            which, when completed, give one a study com-
slightly, 65
            pletion, 311          lines, three important, 68
      is translated and printed in local language, 350        to
communicate one must be able to hold to a
      sequence, 356               location, 314
      tape course checksheets, 381           two-way comm of a
Supervisor, 396, 397, 399
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


completion, defn., completing a specific course or CourseSupervisor
(cont.)
            auditing grade, meaning it has been started,      course is
slow, Supervisor uses Word Clearing
            worked through and has successfully ended
Method 4, 409
            with an award in Qual, 313       cramming, 95
complexity,      student queries, how to handle, 451
      basic law on complexity, 309           supervising at a below F/N
level, 402
      degree of complexity is proportional to the degree      Supervisor
Integrity List, 303
            of non-confront, 309        total dialogue of, 396
      non-confront, any complexity stems from an ini-         two-way
comm explained, 397, 399
            tial point of, 310          two-way comm vs. auditor two-way
comm, 396
      study-complexity and confronting, 309        use of Word Clearing
Method 4, 451
      surrounding any subject or action is derived from a     cramming,
87, 93, 109, 362, defn, section in Qualifi   greater or lesser inability
to confront, 316             cations Div where a student is given high
conceptualization of meanings, 485                 pressure instruction
at his own cost after being
condition assignment, wrong, can turn on somatics             found slow
in study or when failing his exatns,
            and is kind of suppressive, 166-67                312
confession, religious-historical precedence, 262         auditors, 90,
112
confront(ed)(ing),           C/S I/T, 113
      defn., the ability to be there comfortably and per-
cycles, 108,112
            ceive, 315       done in Qual must be done on a meter, 121
      defn, to face without flinching or avoiding, 346        execs and
admin personnel, 113
      defn., to stand facing or opposing, especially in       finds the
real Why of an auditor error, 108
            challenge, defiance or accusation, 346       good cramming is
the key to flubless auditors and
      an HCO B or HCO PL (drill), 317              auditing, 104
      charge blows off bank to degree that it's con-          handling
staff member never crammed before,
            fronted, 68                 118
      complexity and confronting; see complexity         heavy hussar
handling, 116
      misunderstoods, confusions, omissions, alterations      log book,
104
            of a subject begin with failures or unwillingness       maxim
of: handle the hell out of it, 120
            to confront, 314      most cramrning cycles reveal a broader
area of
      on a via (using a relay point), 315                situation which
must also be handled, 119
      symptoms of having trouble with, 315         orders, how to write
up, 52,107
confused ideas stem from misunderstoods, 421       over out ruds, 119
Consultant, Hubbard; see Hubbard Consultant        purpose of Cramming,
87
copperplate longhand, 44          red tag pc report must lead at once to
cramming of
correction list(s), defn, list of prepared questions on
auditor, D of P, C/S and Tech Sec, 105
            a mimeoed sheet which is used by auditor for      success,
what it depends on, 120
            repair of a particular situation, action, or run-
Supervisor and C/S, 90
            down, 10, 45          tools, 88,112, 117
      relation to worksheet admin, 45        TRs in Cramming, 102
      word cleared ~ noted on a Yellow Sheet, 10         Word Clearing in
Cramming, 104
Corrective Word Clearing, Word Clearing Method 9 is,     Cramming
Officer('s),
            473        areas of expertise a ~ has to have, 93
counter-policy and counter-tech, 89          check for basics, 92
course(s); see also training      flubs, 119
      fast courses, secret of, 389           is not bound to accept any
cramming order, 107
      outnesses which must be corrected, 90        must report the real
Why to the C/S, 108
      slow course, speeding up, 409          post requirements, 104, 110
      tapes are never played to a group of students, 365,
procedure for handling auditors, 93
            437        statistic, 106
      translation to tape, 349    criminal and the E-Meter, 275
Course Administrator, defn, course staff member in criminality, why
punishment doesn't cure, 269
            charge of course materials and records, 311
Course Supervisor, defn., instructor in charge of
            course and its students, 311
D
      actions, 398
      checking students for misunderstoods on E-Meter,   declare?, 52
            397        definition, by-passed, effect of, 394
      checkout, defn, is a checkout done by Supervisor   definition,
student must look up every definition of
            of a course or his assistants, 311                the word
being cleared, 479
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


Dianetic(s); see also R3R    E-Meter, meter(ed) (cont.)
            assessment list, defn, list of somatic items given
cleaning cleans, 268
            by pc and written down by auditor with reads      criminal
and the E-Meter, 275
            marked that occur on meter, 11, 51           needle, help pc
by guiding his attention against, 283
            Expanded; see Expanded Dianetics       ps most often does not
know what it is that reacts
            Flow Table, 55, defn., chronological list of Dn
as only unknowns react, 283
                 items run, from earliest to latest, with flows
putting pc's attention on, violates in session defini
that have been run, 11            tion, 84
            example of, 55        reads on reality, 275
            Full Flow Table is only done if it comes up or          use
in Qual of, 121
            bogs running Triples (Ex Dn), 174            Why finding on,
124
            is very general in application, 127    emotional impact in
art, 495, 496
            "no interest" items, 138    engrams, pc trouble on, 251
dictionary, big dictionary needed to define simple engrams, pc who cannot
run, reasons for, 251
            words fully, 427, 460 Ethics, 94, defn, 261
dictionary, foreign words-get a dictionary of that       cycles, details
of, should be entered by auditor in
            language, 432               Folder Summary, 22, 54
dictionary, how to use, 431       Director of Processing handling pc's
Ethics cycles,
dinky dictionaries, 460                 54
Director of Processing handling pc's Ethics cycles, 54        go hand in
hand with PTS RDs so 3 May PL comes
Director of Processing Interviews, 52              before or after it,
160
DMSMH printed with hard covers in foreign language       inspections of
High Crime log book, 100
            is vital, 351         reports, 53
D of P; see Director of Processing           situation noted on auditor's
C/S form, 30
drill(ed); see also training evaluation by auditor repeating what pc
says, 75
      action is drilled to raise confront, 31 1, 472     evil actions,
making an individual guilty for commit Learning Drill, 90
ting, only increases tendency to laziness, 268
drug items that have read are run R3R without asking     evil purposes;
see Expanded Dianetics, evil purposes
            for interest, 138     evil, the basic thing man can't or
won't confront is
Drug Rundown can fail by asking for interest on               evil,310
            items, 139 Examiner ratio, F/N-no F/N, what it tells, 6, 7
Drug Rundown is a must before Ex Dn, 255     Examiner's Form, 34; see
also Exam Report
Drug Rundown needed before Method 1 if student on        how to fill in,
31
            or has been on drugs, 325   Exam Report, 21, 31
drugs cause inability to run engrams, 129          defn, report made out
by Qual Examiner when pc
drugs fog up student and prevent gains, 325              goes to Exams
after session or goes on his own
Duplication, Opening Procedure by; see Opening Pro-
volition; contains meter details, pc's indicators
            cedure by Duplication            and pc's statement, 10, 31
Dynamics, Exchange by, 247        location in folder, 33
dynamic, 3rd dynamic is stronger than 1st ~, 6           red tag exam,
defn, 32
                             Exchange by Dynamics, 247
                             Expanded Dianetics (Ex Dn) (XDn), defn, that
                             E               branch of Dianetics which
uses Dianetics in
                                        special ways for specific
purposes, 127
earphones and tape player used must be high fidelity,         auditor
prerequisites for, 128
            365, 437         case histories, 140-248
education,       does not replace Standard Dianetics or any other
      illiterate or semiliterate populations, 470             class, 128
      importance of misunderstood words, 395       Drug Rundown is a must
before, 255
      must not skip gradients in culture or in training,      evil
purposes, 252
            471              attitudes are after the fact of an evil
purpose in
      suicide or illness in field of, cause of, 393
 a psycho case, 149
      super-literacy and education, 483            have to be verified as
to wording and checked for
E-Meter, meter(ed), 84                   read before running, but not
interest, 252
      auditor does not tell the pc anything about, except
marking of evil purposes and R/Ses, 28
            to indicate an F/N, 84                 Multiple-Flow E. Purp
Rundown, 252
      check, defn action of checking reaction of student            R/S
pc is trying to die (evil purpose), 150
            to subject matter, words or other things, isolat-
running of, don't ask for interest, 138
            ing blocks to study, interpersonal relations or
R3R all E. Purps culled from folder is done as
            life, 311                    first action in Ex Dn, 252
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


Expanded Dianetics (cont.)   floating needle, F/N, F/Ned, F/Ning, defn,
32
      FFT, when it is done, 174          dial wide F/N, defn, floating
from one pin to the
      folders are marked with red colored tape, 13            other right
across the dial, 32
      further data on XDn Series 9, 255       Examiner ratio, F/N-no F/N,
what it tells, 6, 7
      intentions,            flopping F/N (floating F/N, TA F/N), defn,
can't
            don't ask for interest, 138            get needle on dial,
just falls over, 32
            goodintentionsareneverrun,252           Integrity Processing
question must be taken to
            handling, 256               F/N, 274
            in AEI Treble Assessment, 252          major action, don't
begin without getting first, 239
            must only be run on terminals, never a signifi-
sizes, 32
                  cance, 153,158, 252              normal, 2" to 3", 32
      Int/Ext reading on a list is handled by 2wc if TA is
small, 1" to 2", 32
            in normal range, 165             wide, 3" to 4", 32
      is very specifically adjusted to the pc, 127       students,
F/Ning, 402, 448
      L3 EXD RB-Expanded Dianetics Repair List, 131           supervising
at a below F/N level, 402
      Metalosis Rundown, 171,199        Word Clearing, all words must be
F/Ned in Word
      OCA/APA must be taken prior to pc attesting Ex
Clearing on meter, 482
            Dn, 214    Flow Table; see Dianetic Flow Table
      program is written on green sheet, 27  F/N; see floating needle
      programming, 251 folder(s), 13, defn,folded sheet foolscap size, of
card
      PT Environment, 256               board which encloses all session
reports and
      PTS Rundown; see PTS Rundown                 other items, 9
      purpose is to cure people or handle insanity, 159       all
auditing reports of whatever type of action are
      Quad Ex Dn, 256             simply filed chronologically in current
HGC
      requisites, 254             folder, 14
      R/S handling, also called Responsibility RD, 252        Case
Supervisor, how he can tell if he has all the
      rundowns, 251               folders, 14
      Sanderson RD, Wants Handled RD was originally           contents,
9,10
            called Sanderson RD, 142         Expanded Dianetic folders
are marked with red
      service facsirnile theory, 249               colored tape, 13
      set-ups, 251, 254           front cover items, 9
            checklist, 254        "mail slip" system, to ensure that
folders are not
      significances, you must combine significances with            lost
in transit, 15
            terminals, not with significances, 187       Solo folders,
only separate category of folders, 14
      Standard Dianetcs vs. Expanded Dianetics, 127           study, 326
      terminals, run intentions only on terminals, 153,       tape color
flashes, 13
            158        Why finding worksheets must go into pc ~, 482
      thoughts, why one doesn't run thoughts about       Word Clearing
worksheets must go into pc's~,
            thoughts, 187               482
      training, 127    Folder Error Summary, 56, defn, summary of audit
      Treble Assessment, AEI, 256            ing errors in folder and on
pc's case not cor
      two-way comm, certain Ex Dn procedures that             rected at
time summaryis done, 11
            were TWC became L&N, 256    Folder Summary, defn, adequate
summary of actions
      usesDianeticsto change an OCA/APA, 127             taken on pc in
consecutive order written on
      Wants Handled RD, 252             sheets located inside front cover
of folder, 10,
            was originally called Sanderson RD, 142                 21
      who needs it,127       Ethics cycles, details of, should be entered
by
                                        auditor in, 54
                                  form, 24, 25
                             F          sample, 23
                             foot pedal, tape players used must be
equipped with,
failed purpose or stuck in something = tired, dopey,                349
            213        foreign language,
failure to understand pc, high percentage of ARC
personsorsemiliterates, use Word Clearing Method
            breaks occur because of, 76            7, 463
FES; see Folder Error Summary           persons use translated tests, 420
FFT; see Dianetics, Full Flow Table          Word Clearing on, 477
flattening, defn, to do it until it no longer produces a      words-get a
dictionary of that language, 432
            reaction, 315    free service = free fall, 59
      cognition and flattening of process, 67      Full Flow Table; see
Dianetics, Full Flow Table
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


                             high TA, see  tone arm, high
                             G    Hubbard Consultant (HC), defn, 312
                             Hubbard Graduate Dianetic Specialist, 128
gain; see case gain    Hubbard, L. Ron, "Ron's Journals" were staff brief-

generalities in Integrity Processing, 279                ing tapes, 366,
438
glib student(s), 314, 345    hypnotism, defn, is the reduction and
absorption of
            can confront the words and ideas; he cannot con-
mental power of the person; in hypnotism one
            front the physical universe or people around            takes
over the person; the subject has no con            him and so cannot
apply, 345             trol, 505
      handling, 345          and mesmerism, difference between, 504
good indicator; see indicator, good
good intentions are never Nn, 252
gradient,                                                I
      of confronting study, 315
      skipped gradient means taking on a higher degree   ideas, confused,
and misunderstood words, 421
            of amount before a lesser degree of it has been   illiteracy
and work, 470
            handled, 315     ill people are PTS to someone or a group or
some symptoms of too steep a gradient, 394               thing somewhere,
136,137
      too steep, is most recognizable and most applic-   impingement,
auditor has to have ~ on pc to assess,
            able in field of doingness, 394              224
gradient scale, defn, gradual increasing condition of,   in, defn, things
which should be there and are or
            or a little more of little by little, 315
should be done and are, 312
grammar, grammatical, 459    inactive and lazy, how person becomes, 268
      defn, a systematic description of the ways in
incompletehandling,119
            which words are used in a particular language,
indicator(s),
            468        bad, don't look for bad indicator until you see
      Course before Word Clearing, 459             vanishment of good
indicator, 83
      definition, 468        bad, moves in when good indicator moves out,
83
      textbooks, 459         good, pc's ability to as-is or erase in a
session is
      types of,469                directly proportional to the number of
good
      words and small words should be looked up in a
indicators present in the session, 83
            simple grammar textbook, in Word Clearing,        scale of pc
indicators, 32
            459        insanity, Expanded Dianetics' purpose is to cure
                                        people or handle insanity, 159
                             in session; see  session, in
                             H    integrity, defn, 261
                             Integrity Processing (IP), defn, processing
that
handwriting illegible,how to handle,44             enables a person,
within reality of his own
"Have I missed a withhold on you?" can be used in             moral codes
and those of the group, to reveal
            Integrity Processing if pc gets upset or critical
his overts so he no longer requires to withhold
            during session, 282              and so enhances his own
integrity and that of
havingness, defn, the concept of being able to reach;               the
group, 261
            no-havingness is the concept of not being able
aspects of, 285
            to reach, 284         basic procedure for, 264
      must be run to get the benefit of having pulled         buttons,
274
            most withholds, 284         C/S clearance, IP requires, 275
      withholds cut havingness down, 284           C/Sed as auditing, 289
HC; see Hubbard Consultant        E-Meter, auditor who cannot read a
meter is dan
HCO and case gain, 275            gerous, why, 282
headache and Int-Ext, 255         E-Meter, use of, 285
headache is common with out-Int, 150         end phenomena of an
Integrity question, 272
headache is usually after the engram of injury, 149           form,
compiling an Integrity Processing Form to
heavy hussar cramming handling steps, 116                suit the
situation, 291
HGC, how to get results in, 5           Forms, use of, 273
hidden standard, defn, not just a physical or mental          help the
pc, 283
            difficulty but one by which pc measures his       key points
C/S looks for on ~, 289
            case gains, 159       List,
High Crime checkouts, 99,100            Auditor Integrity List, 300
High Crime policy and Word Clearing, 454                 Basic Integrity
List, 294
High Crimes new issues log book, 99                General Staff
Integrity List, 297
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


Integrity Processing (cont.) itsa,
      List (cont.)           letting a pc itsa, 78
            Integrity Processing and O/Ws Repair List-        line is a
report on what has been as-ised, 68
                  L1 RA, 266      line is pc's line to the auditor, 68
            Student Integrity List, 305      maker line is invisible,
don't cut it, 68
            Supervisor Integrity List, 303         maker line is pc's
line to his bank, 68
      Model Session, IP must be done in, 277       what itsa is, 78, 79
      new auditors routinely believe that in IP pc knows
            the answer and won't give it; this is an error, 283
      ordering personnel to, 293                              K
      pc gets upset or critical, how to handle, 282
      pc withholdy, insert "Have I missed an Integrity   Key Word
Clearing; see Word Clearing Method 6
            Processing question on you?" while doing pro-
knowingness, circuits key out with, 284
            cessing, 280     knowledge, basic knowledge of man is
essential to
      points to keep in during, 287                any improvement in any
area of human race,
      question must be taken to F/N, 274, 278                 471
      questions, formulating, 291 knowledge to the average person is only
this: a
      questions, what happens when they are left unflat,
knowledge of his or her withholds, 281
            278
      R/S means crimes that must be pulled, 287
      tech and ethics of, 274                                 L
      unflat, how to prevent, 278
intelligence decreased with each new year of school,     language, first
~ encountered is handled first in Word
            why, 427              Clearing, 477
intentions,      languages, Dianetics and Scientology in other, 351
      Expanded Dianetics, run intentions only on termi-  language, Word
Clearing on foreign language persons,
            nals, 1 53,1 58, 252             477
      Expanded Dianetics running, don't ask for inter-   lazy and
inactive, how person becomes, 268
            est, 138   Learning Drill, 90
      good intentions are never run, 252     leave of absence, defn,
authorized period of absence
      handling, 256               from course granted in writing by
Course
      in AEI Treble Assessments, 252               Supervisor and entered
in student's study folinterest,              der, 312
      as an item, can't run on R3R, as positive don't    library,435
            run, 168   life becomes difficult when rhythmic prediction
can drug items that have read are run R3R without             not occur,
501
            asking for interest, 138    list(s),
      Drug Rundown can fail by asking for interest on         assessment
list, you don't begin it until you get an
            items, 139            F/N,224
      no-interest items, effects of, 154           correction list; see
correction list
interiorization, Int-lists-ruds is only handling se-          Dianetic
Assessment List; see Dianetic Assessment
            quence, 157                 List
Int-Ext and headache, 255         out lists, wrong item handling, 326
Int-Ext reading on a list is handled by 2wc if TA is in       out list,
you don't fly ruds over an out list, 157
            normal range, 165     listing and nulling list(s), defn.,
list of items given by
invalidation, defn., refuting or degrading or discredit-            pc in
response to listing question and written
            ing or denying something someone else con-              down
by auditor in exact sequence that they
            siders to be a fact, 315               are given to him by
pc; each list is done on a
      avoid use of "you" to pc, 75                 separate sheet, 10, 49
      correcting, 91         Search and Discovery list error can make a
person
invoice form, defn, summary sheet of how much                 sort of PTS
with a wrong item, 169
            auditing pc has signed up and paid for, and how   literacy,
defn., ability to read and write, 483
            much of that has been delivered, 1 1   living itself can be
an art, 49 1, 496
      and routing form, 58   low TA; see tone arm, low
invoices for staff services, 59   LX Lists, words of, are cleared before
assessing it and
IP; see Integrity Processing            reads taken as they appear, 175
"irresponsiblepc",howtogetwithholdsoff,279   LlRA, Integrity Processing
and O/Ws Repair List,
items, you only run items in pc's wording, 245                266
item, wrong, from Search and Discovery can make a  L3 EXD RB-Expanded
Dianetics Repair List, 131
            person sort of PTS, 169     L3 EXD RB, list of words in, 129
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


                             music, six distinct types of rhythm in, 500
                             M    muzzled auditing; see auditing, muzzled
                             M (number); see Word Clearing Method
major action, don't begin without getting first an
            F/N, 224, 239
man is an added-to being, result of, 82                             N
man is basically good, but reactive mind tends to
            force him into evil actions, 268 "native ability" and
"talent", ability to confront remanners, stage manners, 498
lated to, 314
manual, defr~, booklet of instruction for a certain
natterings,causeof,281
            object or procedure or practice, 312   navigation, subject
of, 309
mass, symptoms of studying without, 393 needle; see E-Meter; needle
characteristics by name
Material Clearing; see Word Clearing Method 5      nerve system of the
body, 502
medical data goes in Folder Summary, 22 no-confront leads to aberration,
310
Medical Exam Reports, 33     no-interest items, 138,139,154
Medical Officer Reports, 53  No Interference zone, 325
mental mass accumulates in vast complexity solely
            because one would not confront something,
            310                                    O
mesmerism, defn., is animal magnetism; it's a physio
            logical rapport; it is no relation to hypnotism   obnosis
(observation of the obvious), 73, 94
            at all, 504      OCA/APA graph, defn., specially prepared
graph
      and hypnotism, difference between, 504             which plots 10
traits of pc's personality from a
Metalosis Rundown, 171, 199             Personality Test taken by pc, 10,
26
methods of Word Clearing; see Word Clearing        Expanded Dianetics
uses Dianetics to change, 127
miscellaneous report, defn., report such as an MO
mustbetakenpriortopcattestingExDn,214
            Report, a D of P Interview, an Ethics Report,     OKs,
technical OKs and High Crime checkouts, 99
            success story, etc., which is put in pc's folder  OK to Word
Clear system, 446, 454
            and gives C/S more information about case,   Opening
Procedure by Duplication, 90
            11, 52     organizations should be selling more training than
mis-declare, 52              processing, 8
missed withhold, defn, 261; see also rudiments     organize to improve
results, 6
      is a should have known, 281, 282  org outpoint corrections, 97
      symptoms of, 281 org wins and stats, 7
misunderstood(s); see also Word Clearing     origination cycle, 72
      are cleaned up with Word Clearing, 472 out, defn., things which
should be there and aren't or
      blow is usually caused by or overts, 312                should be
done and aren't, 312
      confusion, ~ exists at the bottom of, 421    out lists, 157, 326
      doingness and misunderstood word, 395  overrunning, defn,
accumulating protests and upsets
      earliest ~ word in a subject is a key to later ~              about
it until it is just a mass of stops; anyone
            words in that subject, 427             can do anything
forever unless he begins to stop
      effects of misunderstood word, 394, 397, 398            it, 315
      failed posts and duties trace back to, 423         theory of
overrun, 67
      simple ones, 427 overt(s), defn., 261
      student's stat down, check for ~ words, 399        ARC break,
problem and overt, 275
      stupidity is the effect of ~ words, 427            auditor ARC
breaks pc by demanding more than is
      tape recorded materials, handling on, 370               there or
leaving overt undisclosed that will later
      tech is the sole course tech when course admin is             make
pc upset with auditor, 268
            in and materials are available, 400          blow is usually
caused by, 312
      tests, misunderstoods on, 420          cause level is raised by
getting off, why, 268
model performance tapes, 367, 439       failure in running, commonest
cause is "cleaning
morale and case gain, 275               cleans", 268
mores of a group, transgressions against, 270, 291       get off by using
a gradient of reality, 275
motivator, persons looking for overt to explain moti-         how to
pull, 272
            vator, 269       of omission are always preceded by overts of
commotivators, how to handle when pulling withholds,
mission, 274
            285              pc who dives into past lives when asked for,
269
MU;seemisunderstood    O/Ws, Integrity Processing and O/Ws Repair
Multiple-Flow E. Purp Rundown, 252                 List L1RA, 266
"murder routine", withhold pulling using, 143      Oxford Capacity
Analysis; see OCA/APA
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


                             preclear(s)('s) (cont.)
                             P          beginning intensive, 58
                                  considers himself mesty or massy so
second
pack, defn., a collection of written materials which
terminal is required to discharge energy, 63
            match a checksheet, 312          critical, upset, ARC breaky,
handling of, 282
pain explosion, 503          E-Meter, most often pc does not know what it
is
past lives, preclear who dives into, when asked for                 that
reacts as only unknowns react, 283
            overts, 269           engrams, pc who cannot run, reasons
for, 251
pc; see preclear       folder; see folder
PCRD; see Primary Correction Rundown         hidden standard is not just
a physical or mental
perfection in art; see art              difficulty but one by which pc
measures his
performer purpose is basically communication, 498             case gains,
159
personality test; see OCA/APA           indicators, bad vs. good, 83
pleasure moments, you can't audit out, 168         indicators, scale of,
32
points, defn, arbitrary assignment of credit value to         is always
willing to reveal, 283
            part of study materials, 312           itsa line is pc's line
to the auditor, 68
policy, counter-policy and counter-tech, 89        itsa maker line is
pc's line to his bank, 68
post(s),                     itsa on and on and on and on with no gain,
cause
      failed posts and duties trace back to misunder-               of,
77
            stood words, 423      justifying himself and trying to uphold
status is
      flubs, do not buy case reasons as Whys, 117             not in comm
with auditor, 66
      not wanting, cause of and handling, 423            originates by
throwing down cans; that's still an
      trouble remedied by Word Clearing Method 6, 462
origin, 71
Post Purpose Clearing is done after M1 in general and         overts, pc
who dives into past lives when asked for,
            M2 on duties and texts of post, 429               269
potential trouble source; see also PTS Rundown           protest against
a question, how it shows up, 268
      defn., person connected to a suppressive person,        roller-
coaster pcs (regularly lose gains) are PTS,
            136                   136
      all sick persons are PTS, 136,137      session, pc in session means
pc is interested in own
      characteristics of, 136                case and willing to talk to
auditor, 84
      condition is actually a problem and a mystery and       suppressed
pcs and PTS tech, 136
            a withdrawal, 137           withholds, pc giving another's,
279
      interviews to discover PTS condition are done on   premature
acknowledgements, result of, 77, 78
            meter with all reads marked, 137 present time problems, ARC
breaks and withholds all
      is a person or thing, 184              keep a session from
occurring, 281
      is from suppression of some sort, is roller-coaster,    Primary
Correction Rundown, 320, 326
            166        checklist, 320
      pcs who regularly lose gains are PTS, 136          end phenomena
of, 328
      pc will make trouble for good people, 137          pre-PCRD steps,
327
      suppressive persons are themselves PTS to them-         purpose of,
326
            selves, 136      Primary Rundown, 322, 323
      to SP people, groups, things or locations, 137          consists of
Word Clearing and study tech; it makes
      when you do get person or group or thing or             a student
super-literate, 323
            location the PTS person will F/N VGI and          every
definition of a word must be looked up,
            begin to get well, 137                 479
      who finds the "good hats" suppressive, 137         handling of
Study Tapes, 322
power depends upon ability to hold a location, 314       is given in Tech
Division, 323
practical, 355, defn., drills which permit student to         keynote of,
is honesty, 323
            associate and coordinate theory with actual       steps, 324
            items and objects to which theory applies;        students
who struggle with, aregiven Primary Cor   practical is application of
what one knows to                 rection Rundown, 326
            what one is being taught to understand, handle          super-
literacy is end product of ~, 464
            or control, 311       Word Clearing Method 8 is an action
used in ~,
PRD; see Primary Rundown                464
preclear(s)('s); see also case    problem, how to take apart, 310
      ability to as-is or erase in a session is directly
problem,overt,ARCbreak,relationbetween,275
            proportional to the number of good indicators     process,
cognition and flattening of ~, 67
            present in the session, 83  process doesn't work until
auditor has a comm line to
      attention, don't put it out of session, 67              pc, 66
      backtrack, pcs who won't go, reasons for, 251      processing; see
auditing
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


production, three actions to increase, 472   Qual('s) (cont.)
program,                     does not take orders on what to do to
correct, 109
      defn., sequence of actions, session by session, to      function is
correction, 109
            be undertaken on a case by C/S in his directions
library, 363
            to auditor or auditors auditing case, 27          meter use
in Qual, 121
      defn., any series of actions designed by C/S to         tools to
handle abogged or failedstudent,452
            bring about definite results in pc, 27       Word Clearer,
use of, 410, 411
      evil purposes and R/S items are marked on left-    quality, stats
depend on volume and quality of ser
            hand edge of topmost program in red with date
vice, 7
            and worksheet page number, 28
      Sheet, defn, sheet which outlines sequence of
            actions, session by session, to be run on pc to
                 R
            bring about a definite result, 10
      three types of, 27     rapport, defn., relationship, especially,
one of mutual
      what it consists of, 27                trust or affinity, 500
programming, defn, overall planning for person of  reach and withdraw,
communication is simply a
            courses, auditing and study he should follow
familiarization process based on, 64
            for next extended time period, 312     reach and withdraw in
auditing, 64
      Expanded Dianetic programming, 251     reach, withhold makes one
feel he cannot, 284
progress board, 356    reactive mind, charge blows off bank to degree
that
Progress (Repair) Program, defn., to eradicate case                 it's
confronted and this is represented by itsa
            mishandling by current life or auditing errors;
line, 68
            written on red sheet, 27    reactive mind, if you start
running thoughts about
protest,               thoughts you'll pull thoughts out of engrams
      overrunning and protest, 315                 and restim the devil
out of the bank, 187
      pc's protest against a question, how it shows up,  reactive mind,
man is basically good, but reactive
            268              mind tends to force him into evil actions,
268
      reads come from just plain annoyance with having   red tab; see red
tag
            to go on, 447    red tag(s),
      reads in Word Clearing, 447       Exam, defn, 32
psychology, perversion of the term, 427      pc report must lead at once
to cramming of audipsychosis and misunderstood words are the only
      tor, D of P, C/S and Tech Sec, 105
            reasons for post failure, 423          Word Clearing red
tags, 482
psychosis equals succumb = rock slams, 149   religious confession,
historical precedence of, 262
PTS; see potential trouble source repair while doing an Advance Program,
27
PTS Rundown,     repeating not only does not show pc auditor heard
      administrative tech of, 136            but makes him feel auditor
is a circuit, 75
      Ethics go hand in hand with PTS RDs so 3 May PL    report(s),
            comes before or after it, 160          all auditing reports
of whatever type of action are
      Flow O commands onthe PTS RD,257             simply filed
chronologically in current HGC
      yellow card is clipped to outside of folder by C/S
folder, 14
            untilpcfinishes PTS RD, 54       Auditor's Report Form; see
Auditor's Report
public lecture tapes, 365, 437               Form
punishment doesn't cure criminality, why, 269            miscellaneous
reports, 52
punishment is supposed to bring about inaction, 269           Summary
Report Form, 35
purpose clearing of person's job or situation in life,   resistive
students; see students, resistive
            429  responsibility,
purpose, failed, or stuck in something = dopey, tired,        R/S
Handling, also called the Responsibility RD,
            213                   252
                                  withholds and responsibility level, 272
                             restimulation, auditor causes a ~ and then
pc needs
                             Q               to answer question to get
rid of it, 69
                             results, organize to improve, 6
Quad Ex Dn, 256  rhythm, defn, any kind of movement characterized
Qual('s),              by regular recurrence of strong and weak ele defn,
Qualifications Division (Division V of an org)                ments, 500
            where student is examined, crammed and award-           in
art forms, 501
            ed completions and certificates and where his
rightness(es),
            qualifications are made a permanent record, 312
auditing, degree of rightness you have present must
      Admin, product of, 109            exceed wrongness you are going to
pick up, 83
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


rightness(es)(cont.)   Search and Discovery list error can make a person
      auditing is a contest of maintaining rightnesses so
sort of PTS with a wrong item, 169
            that we can delete wrongnesses, 83     service facsimile,
defn., picture containing an explana auditing, we are only trying to find
wrongnesses in               tion of self condition and also a fixed
method
            order to increase rightnesses, 83                 of making
others wrong, 250
      insistence on ~ is a last refuge of beingness, 249      by
Dynamics, 249
      recognition of rightness of the being, 82          facsimile part
is actually a self-installed disability
rock slam,             that "explains" how he is not responsible for
      equals psychosis equals succumb, 149               not being able
to cope; so he is not wrong for
      Handling, also called the Responsibility RD, 252              not
coping, 250
      Integrity Processing, R/S means crimes that must        handling,
250
            be pulled, 287        theory, 249
      items are marked on left-hand edge of topmost           why it's
called that, 249
            program in red with date and worksheet page  session,
            number, 28       auditor does not grade his own, 29
      pcistryingtodie(evilpurpose),150       in session, defn, pc
interested in own case and
      why a person who rocks slams on Scientology or
 willing to talk to auditor, 84
            auditors or the like can't audit well, 76
putting pc's attention on E-Meter violates in
roll book, defn, master record of course giving stu-
 session definition, 84
            dent's name, local and permanent address and      preclear's
attention, don't put it out of session, 67
            date of enrollment and departure or comple-  set-up
checklist, Ex Dn, 254
            tion, 312  set-ups, Expanded Dianetics, 251
roller-coaster preclears (regularly lose gains) are PTS, shock, effect
of, on muscles, 503
            136  shorthanding session actions on worksheets, 42
Ron; see Hubbard, L. Ron     sick; see ill
routing form, 58 significances, you must combine significances with
      defn, form that lists the org terminals pc has to
terminals, not with significance, 187
            check through in order to arrive in HGC and in    skipped
gradient; see gradient, skipped
            auditing chair, 11    Solo folders, only separate category of
folders, 14
R/S; see rock slam     somatics, auditor doesn't get pc's, 63
rudiments, 277; see also ARC break; missed withhold;     SP; see
suppressive person
            present time problem  staff, cause of badly bogged, 116
      out ruds, how to spot, 119  stage manner(s), 498
      you don't fly ruds over an out list, 157           drills, 499
R3R, R3Ring; see also Dianetic(s) starrate checkout, defn, very exact
checkout which
      drug items that have read are run R3R without
verifies full and minute knowledge of student of
            asking for interest, 138               a portion of study
materials and tests his full
      evil purposes, R3R all Ev Purps culled from folder
understanding of data and ability to apply it, 312
            is done as first action in Ex Dn, 252  stat of student down,
check for misunderstood word,
      "interest", can't run on R3R, as positive don't               399
            run, 168   stats depend on volume and quality of service, 7
      items R3R'd, marking of, 51 steering a pc, 84
      L&N item, 50     steering in withhold pulling, use of, 283
      list of words in R3R procedure, 129    student(s); see also study;
training
      two certain subjects the "interest?" question is        apply,
student who can't, reason for, 314
            omitted from, 138           ask questions about "What is
meant", reason for,
                 451
                                  consultation, defn., personal handling
of student
                             S               problems or progress by a
qualified consultant,
                                        312
S and Ds; see Search and Discovery           Course Supervisor checking
students for misunder
Sanderson RD (Expanded Dianetics), Wants Handled              stoods
on E-Meter, 397
            RD was originally called, 142          drugs fog up student
and prevent gains, 325
scheduling, defn, hours of course or designation of           drugs,
students who are or have been on drugs
            certain times for auditing, 312              need a Drug
Rundown before tackling Word
Scientology, only reason anyone has ever left ~ is            Clearing
Method 1, 325
            because people failed to find out about them,           E-
Meter check, action of checking reaction of ~ to
            282              subject matter, words or other things,
isolating
Scientology, raw public tape and film presentations are
blocks to study, interpersonal relations or life,
            a must to keep flavor and meaning of, 366, 438
311
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


student(s)(cont.)      super-literacy, super-literate, 464, 465, 483
      glib students, 314, 345           Primary Rundown consists of Word
Clearing and
            handling, 345               study tech; it makes a student
super-literate,
      idle student, 327                 323, 464
      must look up every definition of the word being         what it is,
483
            cleared, 479          when one is superliterate, one reads
not words but
      point system is system of assigning and counting
understandings, and so one can act, 485
            up points for studies and drills that give pro-   Supervisor;
see Case Supervisor; Course Supervisor
            gress of ~ and measure his speed of study,   Supervisor
Integrity List, 303
            312  suppressed pcs and PTS tech, 136
      Primary Rundown, students who struggle with, are   suppression of
some sort, PTS is from, 166
            given Primary Correction Rundown, 326  suppressive person,
potential trouble source is a per product flow, steps to speed, 402
      son connected to, 136
      Qual tools to handle a bogged or failed ~, 452     suppressive
persons are themselves PTS to themselves,
      queries, Method 4 is used by Course Supervisors to            136
            handle, 451      survival mechanisms and withholds, 271
      resistive students, 327
      slow students, 89
            totally slow student, how to handle, 398
            T
      stat down, check for misunderstood word, 399
      stats, trend of stats, use of, 88 TA; see  tone arm
      who learns rapidly has a high ability to confront  "talent" and
"native ability", ability to confront
            that subject, 314                related to, 314
      who will not even go to study, handling of, 327    tape(s),
Student Hat, 91        basic tape rundown, 377
Student Integrity List, 305       course checksheets, 381, 382
study(ing); see also student      course translation to tape, 349, 379
      barriers to, 393       file, 362
      complexity and confronting, 309        four classes of, 364, 436
      cramming and study, 312           how to use, 364, 436
      definitions, 311       misunderstood words on, handling of, 440
      gradient of confronting study, 315           notes, 362
      gradient, too steep, 393          raw public tape and film
presentations are a must
      mass, study without, symptoms of, 393              to keep flavor
and meaning of Dianetics and
      point system, 312                 Scientology, 366, 438
      procedure for resolving study difficulty on a tape,           Study
Tapes, 322, 399
            with Method 2 Word Clearing, 372       teaching a tape
course, 354
      starrate checkout, defn, 312           Word Clearing Method 2 on,
372
      stats, trend of stats, use of, 88      Word Clearing Method 3 on,
370
      students or even executives who will not even go        Word
Clearing Method 4 of, 466
            to study, handling of, 327  tape player(s),
      tapes, Primary Rundown handling of Study Tapes,         description
and care, 357, 368
            322        diagram, 358
      tapes, use of Study Tapes, 399         used must be equipped with
foot pedal start-stop
      three different sets of physiological and mental
control, 349
            reactions that come from 3 different aspects of   technical
OKs, 100
            study, 393 technique, defn, what button has to be pressed,
what
Study Correction Iist, 329              has to be as-ised and how you go
about it,
stupidity is the effect of misunderstood words,               63
            427        communication cycle must exist before technique
success story, defn, statement of benefit or gains or               can
exist, 64
            wins made by a student or preclear or pre-OT technology
(tech),
            to Success Officer, 313          counter-tech and counter-
policy, 89
Summary Report, 37           done in proper administrative framework,
works, 8
      Form, 35, defn, written by auditor after session        results, to
improve, you must improve administra
            on fill-in type standard form, it is an exact
tion, 5
            record of what happened and what was ob-          savvy, 79
            served during session, 10        two areas of cramming: tech
and admin, 96
super, defn., superiority in size, quality, number or         verbal tech
is deadly, result of, 400
            degree, 483           Word Clearer actions illustrated, 411
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


Tech Services, defn, activity which enrolls, routes,     translators,
word clearing translators, 480
            schedules, distributes mail of and assists hous-  Treble
Assessment, AEI, 252, 256
            ing of students, 312  TRs, defn, training drills for
auditing, 433
terminal, pc considers himself mesty or massy so         admin personnel
need, as much as tech personnel,
            second ~ is required to discharge energy, 63            118
terminals, run intentions only on terminals (Ex-         auditor who
can't do his TRs can't audit, 78
            panded Dianetics), 153,158       errors are as fundamental
errors as you can get on
terminals, you must combine significances with termi-               an
auditor, 90
            nals, not with significance, 187       in Cramming, 102
test, foreign language persons use translated tests, 420      TR Course,
how to handle student study of bulletest, misunderstoods on tests, 420
            tins, 397
test, word clearing any words on any test at any time         TR Course,
what is learned on, 433
            is a High Crime, 420        TR training, 102
theory, defn., data part of course where data as in      truth, part of
auditing is recognition of fact that truth
            books, tapes and manuals is given, 311            is present,
83
thetan(s)('s),         twin, defn, study partner with whom one is paired,
      cannot die; his only out is to try to stop something
311
            as he himself cannot stop living, 249  twin checkout, defn,
when two students are paired
      consideringhimselfmest, liability of, 63                they check
each other out; different than a
      efforts to be right continue to stop him in a
Supervisorcheckout,311
            reverse flow, 249     two-way comm; see communication, two-
way
      even when pressed or suppressed to the absolute
            limit of near extinction will still try, even when
            "cooperating" to some way be right, 249
            U
      power of choice, how it has been overthrown, 82
thoughts, if you start running thoughts about      understand, defn, to
have a clear and true idea or
            thoughts you'll pull thoughts out of engrams
conception, or full and exact knowledge, of
            and restim the devil out of the bank, 187
something; in general it may be said that under
tired, dopey=stuck in something or failed purpose, 213              stand
refers to result of a mental process or
tone arm,              processes (a clear and exact idea or notion, or
      high TA, never touch ARC breaks on, 224                 full
knowledge); understand implies power to
      low, TA goes, carry on till it comes up, 152            receive and
register a clear and true impression,
      must be in normal range to start Word Clearing on             486
            meter, 482 upset, if person is upset, somebody failed to find
out
      talking down, in order to do a Hi-Lo List, 224                what
that person was sure they would find out,
      Word Clearing Method 1, 2 or 4, don't use on            282
            person whose TA is high at session start, 482
      Word Clearing, never clear words over a soaring
            TA, 206                                V
Touch Assist(s), 502
      errors, 502      valences, all valences are circuits are valences,
284
      importance of balance, 502  verbal advice or tech is deadly and
will turn any
      is short sessioned and always balanced, 503             Academy
sour, 400
      you don't want rapport, 505
      you must go to extremities, 503
training; see also course; drill; student; study
      W
      auditors are goofing, what it means regarding train
            ing, 398   Wants Handled Rundown, 252
      drills; see TRs        was originally called Sanderson RD, 142
      how it can de-aberrate, 310 W/H; see withhold
transgressions against mores of a group, 270, 291  what's-it line is
auditor's line to the pc, 68
translated,      Why finding,
      checksheet and course rules are also translated and
examples of finding Why on a person and hand   printed in local language,
350              ling, 123
      materials, 351, 361         how to find a Why on a person and
handle, 122
      tapes, minimum list of, 352       invalidation and correcting the
wrong Why, 91
translator, "sight" translator is one equally good in 2       metered Why
finding, 124
            languages who can hear one language and speak           "Whys
have been found" but person is not doing
            translations into other language without hesita-
well; this is a case of wrong items, 326
            tion, 349        worksheets must go into pc folder, 482
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


withhold(s),defn, 261, 270   Word Clearing(cont.)
      ARC breaks, present time problems and withholds         key repair
tool for an org, 472
            all keep a session from occurring, 281       library, 435
            case with withholds will not clear, 270           lines, 452
      general withholds and other people's withholds,         lists for
prepared lists, 46
            handling, 279         Method 1, 392
      havingness is cut down by, 284               comes first, 447
      Havingness must be run to get the benefit of hav-             end
phenomenon of, data on, 417, 418
            ing pulled most withholds, 284               full in-session
rundown, 429
      knowledge to the average person is only this: a               has
yet to foul up any other auditing, 417
            knowledge of his or her withholds, 281            is not a
prerequisite to Word Clearing Method 4,
      makes one feel he cannot reach, 284                      450
      missed and partial, 281                is unlimited, 417
      overts give highest gain in raising cause level be-
Post Purpose Clearing is done after M1 in general
            cause they are biggest reason why person
and M2 on duties and texts of posts, 429
            restrains himself and withholds self from ac-
produces a Word Clear, 324
            tion, 268             students who are or have been on drugs
need a
      pc giving another's, 279                      Drug Rundown before
tackling, 325
      pulled will not cause a question to still react, 271
symptom of a person requiring, 475
      pulling,               Word Clearing can become lengthy until
Method
            data on, 27 1, 272                      One is completed, 475
            "don't know" version, 279        Method 1, 2 or 4, don't use
on person whose TA is
            motivators, how to handle when pulling ~, 285
high at session start, 482
            "murder routine", 143       Method 2, defn., 392
      responsibility level and withholds, 272                 defn,
metered action of clearing up words in
      survival mechanisms and withholds, 271                   specific
materials, 429
withholding, there is a level below ~ that an auditor               as a
study method on tape materials, 374, 444
            should be alert to in some pcs, for these "have
don't do, before Method 1, 447
            no withholds" and "have done nothing", 269              EP of
Method 2 can be many times repeated on
word(s);see also misunderstood; Word Clearing
different subjects or branches of subjects,
      classes, 468                       447
      cleared word is a word which has been cleared to
example of clearing up a confusion with Word
            point of full conceptual understanding, 486
 Clearing Method 2, 421
      meanings are embodied in basic concept or idea                in
the course room, 401
            symbolized by that word, 485                 is likely to
foul up auditing, 417
      simple words are often misunderstood, 427               is not done
on someone incomplete on M1,445
      test of whether the person understands it, 428                on
tapes, 372, 442
      undefined or misunderstood produce blows, 394                 Post
Purpose Clearing is done after M1 in gen
Word Clear, Word Clearing Method 1 produces a ~,                     eral
and M2 on duties and texts of post, 429
            324                   procedure, 401
Word Clearer training, 434, 478              two uses of, 442
Word Clearing, 392           Method 3, 392, 448
      basic law in Word Clearing, 426              looking up words seen
and not understood by
      briefing tape, word clear on tape afterwards, 438
 student or reader, 429
      can become lengthy until Method One is com-             on tapes,
370, 440
            pleted, 475                 steps of, 448
      chain of words, all words must F/N, 482                 use of, 447
      Correction List must be used at the first hint of       Method 4,
450
            trouble in Word Clearing, 475                correct question
to use, 322
      Correction List revised, 455                 course is slow,
Supervisor uses, 409
      Correction List, use of, 433                 E-Meter Drill No. 21
is to be drilled for use on,
      difficulties with, 475                  450
      errors, 479                 errors in, 376, 467
      Festival actions, 445             is used by Course Supervisors to
handle student
      F/N, always F/N a word being cleared on meter,
 queries, 451
            482              limitations, 461
      F/N, get an F/N between the words, 204, 206             Method 1 is
not a prerequisite to, 450
      foreign language persons, 477                of books, 375, 466
      Grammar Course before Word Clearing, 459                of tapes,
375, 466
      in Cramming, 104
                        SUBJECT INDEX-AUDITING SERIES


Word Clearing (cont.)  wrongness, 83
      Method 4 (cont.) W/S; see worksheet
            procedure, 450   Wundt, 427
            requires no C/S OK for it to be done, 450
            Supervisor's use of, 451
            use of, 450                                  Y
      Method 5, Material Clearing, 461
            procedure,461    yellow card is clipped to outside of folder
by C/S
      Method 6, Key Word Clearing, 462             until pc finishes PTS
RD, 54
            procedure, 462   Yellow Sheet, defn., sheet detailing each
correction
      Method 7, Educational Word Clearing, 473                list or set
of commands which have been word
            as the major undercut Word Clearing process,
cleared; lists pc's current Havingness Process
                  may require an undercut, by a direct address
      and type of cans pc uses, 10, 20
                  to alphabet, 475
            children or foreign language persons or semi
                 literates, use Word Clearing Method 7, 463
                 Z
            is reading aloud, 463
            procedure, 463   zero rate, defn., material which is only
checked out
      Method 8, 464               on basis of general understanding, 312
            is an action used in the Primary Rundown, 464
            procedure, 464
      Method 9, Corrective Word Clearing, 473
      Numerals
            procedure, 473
      OK to do, 446    2-way comm; see communication, two-way
      OK to Word Clear system, 454      3 May PL comes before or after
PTS RDs, 160
      pc red tabbed because of Word Clearing must be     24 hour rule,
Integrity Processing, 275
            repaired within 24 hours, 482
      pc word cleared on meter without F/Mng or with
            or to a high or low TA, whole folder must be
            red tabbed, 482
      person trying to "blow" (leave) and refusing fur
            ther Word Clearing almost always has a huge
            misunderstood on some word not yet located,
            433
      program, 429
      protest reads, 447
      steps to speed student product flow, 402
      success from Flag D of T, 412
      TA must be in normal range to start Word Clearing
            on meter, 482
      TA, never clear words over a soaring TA, 206
      tests, word clearing tests is a High Crime, 420
      translators, word clearing of, 480
      troubles, 433
      use of Qual Word Clearer, 410
      word clearing Word Clearers, 430
      worksheets must go into pc's folder, 482
      Yellow Sheet, sheet detailing each correction list
            or set of commands which have been word
            cleared; lists pc's current Havingness Process
            and type of cans pc uses, 10, 20
work, illiteracy and, 470
worksheet(s), 41,
      defn., sheets on which auditor writes a complete
            running record of session from beginning to
            end, page after page, as session goes along, 10
      C/S misunderstoods from, 44
      must communicate to C/S what actions were taken
            during session, 42
      Word Clearing ~ must go into pc's folder, 482
                         ALPHABETICAL LIST OF TITLES


Admin Cramming-Types of Cramming  96    Dianetics and Scientology in Other
Allow No Bugs on Word Clearing               Languages   351
      Procedure-Important    415  Difficulties With Word Clearing   475
Alterations 426  Dinky Dictionaries     460
Art   489   Effectiveness of Overts in Processing  268
Art, More About  493   EP of Word Clearing   418
Aspectsof IntegrityProcessing     285   Examiner's Form  34
Auditor Admin Series for Use by All          Exam Report, The 31
 Auditors, The   3     Ex Dn and PTS RD Notes      256
Auditor Failure to Understand     75    Expanded Dianetic Case A    140
Auditor Integrity List 300   Expanded Dianetic Case B    146
Auditor Report Form, The     39   Expanded Dianetic Case C    155
Auditor's C/S, The     29    Expanded Dianetic Case D    162
Auditor's Worksheets   44    Expanded Dianetic Case E    174
Barriers to Study      393   Expanded Dianetic Case F    183
Basic Integrity List, The    294  Expanded Dianetic Case G    195
Basic Tape Rundown     377   Expanded DianeticCase I     201
Build Up Powerful Word Clearers   478   Expanded Dianetic Case J    211
Case Progress Sheet (BTB)    16   Expanded Dianetic Case K    215
Case Progress Sheet (BPL)    17   Expanded Dianetic Case L    230
Catastrophes From and Repair of         Expanded Dianetic Case M    237
      "No Interest" Items    139  Expanded Dianetics-Developments Since
Chinese School   318         the Original Lectures 251
Clearing Lists and R3-R      129  Expanded Dianetics Repair List-L3 EXD RB
131
Clear to F/N     482   Expanded Dianetics Requisites     254
Comm Cycle Additives   81    Expanded Dianetics Series IR     127
Communication Cycle in Auditing, The    73   Faults in Word Clearing
Commonly Met     424
Communication Cycles Within the         Folder, The      13
      Auditing Cycle   69    Folder Error Summaries      56
Complexity and Confronting-Study  309   Folder Summary, The   21
Confront    346  Formulating Integrity ProcessingQuestions    291
Confronting 314  Fundamentals     270
Confronting, Addition  317   Generalities Won't Do 279
Confused Ideas   421   General Staff Integrity List      297
Correction Lists 45    Glib Student, The     345
Correct Sequence-Qualifications of Word      Grammar     459
      Clearers   429   Grammar Definition    468
Course Translation to Tape   349  Handling Misunderstood Words on Tape
Cramming(BTB)    87          Recorded Materials    370, 440
Cramming(HCO B)  109   Havingness 284
Cramming Actions 93    Help the Pc      283
Cramming Expertise     104   High Crime Checkouts and Technical OKs 99
Cramming Heavy Hussar Handling for           High Crime Policy and Word
Clearing    454
      a Badly Bogged Tech Personnel or       How to Find a Why on a Person
and Handle  122
      Staff Member     116   How to Get Results in an HGC     5
Cramming Officer Post Requirements      110  How to Use a Dictionary
431
Cramming Officer Statistic   106  How to Write Up a Cramming Order  107
Cramming Over Out Ruds 119   Illiteracy and Work   470
C/S and Cramming Cycles, The 108  Important-Allow No Bugs on Word Clearing
C/Sing Integrity Processing  289        Procedure  415
Definitions 261  Integrity Processing and O/Ws Repair
Dianetic Assessment Lists    51         List-LlRA  266
Dianetic Flow Table, The     55   Integrity Processing Info   287
Dianetic HCO B-Interest      138  Integrity Processing Questions Must Be
F/Ned 278
                     ALPHABETICAL LIST OF TITLES (Cont.)


Interest-Dianetic HCO B      138  Student Integrity List 305
Invoice Form and Routing Form     58    Study-Complexity and Confronting
309
L&N Lists   49   StudyCorrection List Revised      329
"Letting the Pc Itsa"-The Properly Trained         Study Definitions
311
      Auditor    78    Summary Report   37
Library     435  Summary Report Form,The     35
L1 RA-Integrity Processing and O/Ws          Superliteracy and the Cleared
Word  483
      Repair List      266   Supervisor Integrity List   303
L3 EXD RB-Expanded Dianetics Repair List     131   Supervisor Two-Way Comm
and the
Magic of the Communication Cycle, The   63         Misunderstood Word
396
Metering    84   Supervisor Two-Way Comm Explained 399
Meter Use in Qual      121   Suppressed Pcs and PTS Tech 136
Method Two-Metered Word Clearing in the      Tape Course Checksheets
381
      Course Room      401   Tape Course Series Revisions and
Method 1-Standard C/S for Word Clearing in               Cancellations
385
      Session    404   Tape Players-Description and Care 357
Method 2 Word Clearing on Tapes and          Tapes, How to Use      364,
436
      Tape Courses     372, 442   Tape Translations to Tape   379
Method 3 Word Clearing 448   Teaching a Tape Course      354
Method 4 Notes   375, 466    Tech and Ethics of Integrity
Method 5    461   Processing, The 274
Method 6    462  Tech Points on a Word Clearing Festival 445
Method 7    463  Three Important Communication Lines, The     68
Method 8    464  Three Types of Word Clearing, The 406
Method 9    473  Tools of Cramming, The 112
Miscellaneous Reports  52    Touch Assists-Correct Ones  502
OCA Graphs  26   Translated Tapes for Staff and Student Use   361
Ordering Personnelto Integrity Processing    293   Trouble Shooting 433
Pc Folder and Its Contents, The   9     TRs in Cramming  102
Premature Acknowledgements   77   Two Parts of Auditing, The  65
Primary Correction Rundown Handling     326  Types of Cramming-Admin
Cramming    96
Primary Correction Rundown Revised, The 320  WC1 Comes First  447
Primary Rundown (Revised)    323  Withholds, Missed and Partial     281
Primary RundownNote    322   Word Clearing   392
Procedure   264  Word Clearing Clarification 417
Program Sheet, The     27    Word Clearing Correction List Revised  455
PTS Interviews   137   Word Clearing Errors  479
Qualifications of Word Clearers-Correct      Word Clearing Lines    452
      Sequence   429   Word Clearing Lists for Prepared Lists 46
Recognition of Rightness of the Being   82   Word Clearing Method 4 450
Rudiments   277  Word Clearing-OK to Do 446
Rhythm      500  Word Clearing on Foreign Language
Secret of Fast Courses, The  389        Students, Pcs or Staff      477
Service Facsimile Theory and Expanded        Word Clearing Series 15R
420
      Dianetics  249   Word Clearing Successes     412
Setting Up and Using a Tape Player      368  Word Clearing-The Key Repair
Tool for an
Simple Words     427         Org  472
Speeding Up a Slow Course    409  Word Clearing Translators   480
Stage Manners    498   Words and Posts  423
Standard C/S for Word Clearing in       Worksheets, The  41
      Session-Method 1 404   XDN Case B 255
Steps to Speed Student Product Flow     402  Yellow Sheet, The      20